blob: 1b57c6969dba18ddd16ebbdf30ffeeaace0bab44 [file] [log] [blame]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau8317b282014-04-23 01:49:41 +02002 HAProxy
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003 Configuration Manual
4 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau73dec762021-11-23 15:50:11 +01005 version 2.6
Willy Tarreau37033252022-05-14 16:05:50 +02006 2022/05/14
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007
8
9This document covers the configuration language as implemented in the version
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010specified above. It does not provide any hints, examples, or advice. For such
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011documentation, please refer to the Reference Manual or the Architecture Manual.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012The summary below is meant to help you find sections by name and navigate
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013through the document.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015Note to documentation contributors :
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040016 This document is formatted with 80 columns per line, with even number of
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017 spaces for indentation and without tabs. Please follow these rules strictly
18 so that it remains easily printable everywhere. If a line needs to be
19 printed verbatim and does not fit, please end each line with a backslash
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020020 ('\') and continue on next line, indented by two characters. It is also
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021 sometimes useful to prefix all output lines (logs, console outputs) with 3
22 closing angle brackets ('>>>') in order to emphasize the difference between
23 inputs and outputs when they may be ambiguous. If you add sections,
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020024 please update the summary below for easier searching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020025
26
27Summary
28-------
29
301. Quick reminder about HTTP
311.1. The HTTP transaction model
321.2. HTTP request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100331.2.1. The request line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200341.2.2. The request headers
351.3. HTTP response
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100361.3.1. The response line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200371.3.2. The response headers
38
392. Configuring HAProxy
402.1. Configuration file format
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200412.2. Quoting and escaping
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200422.3. Environment variables
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100432.4. Conditional blocks
442.5. Time format
452.6. Examples
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020046
473. Global parameters
483.1. Process management and security
493.2. Performance tuning
503.3. Debugging
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100513.4. Userlists
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200523.5. Peers
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200533.6. Mailers
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +0200543.7. Programs
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +0100553.8. HTTP-errors
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +0200563.9. Rings
William Lallemand0217b7b2020-11-18 10:41:24 +0100573.10. Log forwarding
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020058
594. Proxies
604.1. Proxy keywords matrix
614.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
62
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100635. Bind and server options
Willy Tarreau086fbf52012-09-24 20:34:51 +0200645.1. Bind options
655.2. Server and default-server options
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +0200665.3. Server DNS resolution
675.3.1. Global overview
685.3.2. The resolvers section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020069
Julien Pivotto6ccee412019-11-27 15:49:54 +0100706. Cache
716.1. Limitation
726.2. Setup
736.2.1. Cache section
746.2.2. Proxy section
75
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200767. Using ACLs and fetching samples
777.1. ACL basics
787.1.1. Matching booleans
797.1.2. Matching integers
807.1.3. Matching strings
817.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
827.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
837.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
847.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
857.3. Fetching samples
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200867.3.1. Converters
877.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
887.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
897.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
907.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
917.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +0200927.3.7. Fetching samples for developers
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200937.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020094
958. Logging
968.1. Log levels
978.2. Log formats
988.2.1. Default log format
998.2.2. TCP log format
1008.2.3. HTTP log format
Remi Tricot-Le Breton98b930d2021-07-29 09:45:52 +02001018.2.4. HTTPS log format
Willy Tarreauec5c1102021-11-06 09:18:33 +01001028.2.5. Error log format
1038.2.6. Custom log format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001048.3. Advanced logging options
1058.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
1068.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
1078.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
1088.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
1098.4. Timing events
1108.5. Session state at disconnection
1118.6. Non-printable characters
1128.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
1138.8. Capturing HTTP headers
1148.9. Examples of logs
115
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02001169. Supported filters
1179.1. Trace
1189.2. HTTP compression
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +02001199.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +01001209.4. Cache
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +02001219.5. fcgi-app
Miroslav Zagoracdc32cd92020-12-13 18:32:57 +01001229.6. OpenTracing
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200123
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020012410. FastCGI applications
12510.1. Setup
12610.1.1. Fcgi-app section
12710.1.2. Proxy section
12810.1.3. Example
12910.2. Default parameters
13010.3. Limitations
131
Emeric Brunce325c42021-04-02 17:05:09 +020013211. Address formats
13311.1. Address family prefixes
13411.2. Socket type prefixes
13511.3. Protocol prefixes
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200136
1371. Quick reminder about HTTP
138----------------------------
139
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100140When HAProxy is running in HTTP mode, both the request and the response are
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200141fully analyzed and indexed, thus it becomes possible to build matching criteria
142on almost anything found in the contents.
143
144However, it is important to understand how HTTP requests and responses are
145formed, and how HAProxy decomposes them. It will then become easier to write
146correct rules and to debug existing configurations.
147
148
1491.1. The HTTP transaction model
150-------------------------------
151
152The HTTP protocol is transaction-driven. This means that each request will lead
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100153to one and only one response. Traditionally, a TCP connection is established
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100154from the client to the server, a request is sent by the client through the
155connection, the server responds, and the connection is closed. A new request
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200156will involve a new connection :
157
158 [CON1] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [CLO1] [CON2] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO2] ...
159
160In this mode, called the "HTTP close" mode, there are as many connection
161establishments as there are HTTP transactions. Since the connection is closed
162by the server after the response, the client does not need to know the content
163length.
164
165Due to the transactional nature of the protocol, it was possible to improve it
166to avoid closing a connection between two subsequent transactions. In this mode
167however, it is mandatory that the server indicates the content length for each
168response so that the client does not wait indefinitely. For this, a special
169header is used: "Content-length". This mode is called the "keep-alive" mode :
170
171 [CON] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO] ...
172
173Its advantages are a reduced latency between transactions, and less processing
174power required on the server side. It is generally better than the close mode,
175but not always because the clients often limit their concurrent connections to
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200176a smaller value.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200177
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100178Another improvement in the communications is the pipelining mode. It still uses
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200179keep-alive, but the client does not wait for the first response to send the
180second request. This is useful for fetching large number of images composing a
181page :
182
183 [CON] [REQ1] [REQ2] ... [RESP1] [RESP2] [CLO] ...
184
185This can obviously have a tremendous benefit on performance because the network
186latency is eliminated between subsequent requests. Many HTTP agents do not
187correctly support pipelining since there is no way to associate a response with
188the corresponding request in HTTP. For this reason, it is mandatory for the
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100189server to reply in the exact same order as the requests were received.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200190
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100191The next improvement is the multiplexed mode, as implemented in HTTP/2. This
192time, each transaction is assigned a single stream identifier, and all streams
193are multiplexed over an existing connection. Many requests can be sent in
194parallel by the client, and responses can arrive in any order since they also
195carry the stream identifier.
196
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100197By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
198connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
199leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100200start of a new request. When it receives HTTP/2 connections from a client, it
201processes all the requests in parallel and leaves the connection idling,
202waiting for new requests, just as if it was a keep-alive HTTP connection.
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200203
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +0200204HAProxy supports 4 connection modes :
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100205 - keep alive : all requests and responses are processed (default)
206 - tunnel : only the first request and response are processed,
Christopher Faulet6c9bbb22019-03-26 21:37:23 +0100207 everything else is forwarded with no analysis (deprecated).
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100208 - server close : the server-facing connection is closed after the response.
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +0200209 - close : the connection is actively closed after end of response.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100210
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100211
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200212
2131.2. HTTP request
214-----------------
215
216First, let's consider this HTTP request :
217
218 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100219 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200220 1 GET /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2 HTTP/1.1
221 2 Host: www.mydomain.com
222 3 User-agent: my small browser
223 4 Accept: image/jpeg, image/gif
224 5 Accept: image/png
225
226
2271.2.1. The Request line
228-----------------------
229
230Line 1 is the "request line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
231
232 - a METHOD : GET
233 - a URI : /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
234 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
235
236All of them are delimited by what the standard calls LWS (linear white spaces),
237which are commonly spaces, but can also be tabs or line feeds/carriage returns
238followed by spaces/tabs. The method itself cannot contain any colon (':') and
239is limited to alphabetic letters. All those various combinations make it
240desirable that HAProxy performs the splitting itself rather than leaving it to
241the user to write a complex or inaccurate regular expression.
242
243The URI itself can have several forms :
244
245 - A "relative URI" :
246
247 /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
248
249 It is a complete URL without the host part. This is generally what is
250 received by servers, reverse proxies and transparent proxies.
251
252 - An "absolute URI", also called a "URL" :
253
254 http://192.168.0.12:8080/serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
255
256 It is composed of a "scheme" (the protocol name followed by '://'), a host
257 name or address, optionally a colon (':') followed by a port number, then
258 a relative URI beginning at the first slash ('/') after the address part.
259 This is generally what proxies receive, but a server supporting HTTP/1.1
260 must accept this form too.
261
262 - a star ('*') : this form is only accepted in association with the OPTIONS
263 method and is not relayable. It is used to inquiry a next hop's
264 capabilities.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100265
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200266 - an address:port combination : 192.168.0.12:80
267 This is used with the CONNECT method, which is used to establish TCP
268 tunnels through HTTP proxies, generally for HTTPS, but sometimes for
269 other protocols too.
270
271In a relative URI, two sub-parts are identified. The part before the question
272mark is called the "path". It is typically the relative path to static objects
273on the server. The part after the question mark is called the "query string".
274It is mostly used with GET requests sent to dynamic scripts and is very
275specific to the language, framework or application in use.
276
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100277HTTP/2 doesn't convey a version information with the request, so the version is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100278assumed to be the same as the one of the underlying protocol (i.e. "HTTP/2").
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100279
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200280
2811.2.2. The request headers
282--------------------------
283
284The headers start at the second line. They are composed of a name at the
285beginning of the line, immediately followed by a colon (':'). Traditionally,
286an LWS is added after the colon but that's not required. Then come the values.
287Multiple identical headers may be folded into one single line, delimiting the
288values with commas, provided that their order is respected. This is commonly
289encountered in the "Cookie:" field. A header may span over multiple lines if
290the subsequent lines begin with an LWS. In the example in 1.2, lines 4 and 5
291define a total of 3 values for the "Accept:" header.
292
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100293Contrary to a common misconception, header names are not case-sensitive, and
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200294their values are not either if they refer to other header names (such as the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100295"Connection:" header). In HTTP/2, header names are always sent in lower case,
Willy Tarreau253c2512020-07-07 15:55:23 +0200296as can be seen when running in debug mode. Internally, all header names are
297normalized to lower case so that HTTP/1.x and HTTP/2 use the exact same
298representation, and they are sent as-is on the other side. This explains why an
299HTTP/1.x request typed with camel case is delivered in lower case.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200300
301The end of the headers is indicated by the first empty line. People often say
302that it's a double line feed, which is not exact, even if a double line feed
303is one valid form of empty line.
304
305Fortunately, HAProxy takes care of all these complex combinations when indexing
306headers, checking values and counting them, so there is no reason to worry
307about the way they could be written, but it is important not to accuse an
308application of being buggy if it does unusual, valid things.
309
310Important note:
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000311 As suggested by RFC7231, HAProxy normalizes headers by replacing line breaks
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200312 in the middle of headers by LWS in order to join multi-line headers. This
313 is necessary for proper analysis and helps less capable HTTP parsers to work
314 correctly and not to be fooled by such complex constructs.
315
316
3171.3. HTTP response
318------------------
319
320An HTTP response looks very much like an HTTP request. Both are called HTTP
321messages. Let's consider this HTTP response :
322
323 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100324 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200325 1 HTTP/1.1 200 OK
326 2 Content-length: 350
327 3 Content-Type: text/html
328
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200329As a special case, HTTP supports so called "Informational responses" as status
330codes 1xx. These messages are special in that they don't convey any part of the
331response, they're just used as sort of a signaling message to ask a client to
Willy Tarreau5843d1a2010-02-01 15:13:32 +0100332continue to post its request for instance. In the case of a status 100 response
333the requested information will be carried by the next non-100 response message
334following the informational one. This implies that multiple responses may be
335sent to a single request, and that this only works when keep-alive is enabled
336(1xx messages are HTTP/1.1 only). HAProxy handles these messages and is able to
337correctly forward and skip them, and only process the next non-100 response. As
338such, these messages are neither logged nor transformed, unless explicitly
339state otherwise. Status 101 messages indicate that the protocol is changing
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -0400340over the same connection and that HAProxy must switch to tunnel mode, just as
Willy Tarreau5843d1a2010-02-01 15:13:32 +0100341if a CONNECT had occurred. Then the Upgrade header would contain additional
342information about the type of protocol the connection is switching to.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200343
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200344
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003451.3.1. The response line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200346------------------------
347
348Line 1 is the "response line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
349
350 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
351 - a status code : 200
352 - a reason : OK
353
354The status code is always 3-digit. The first digit indicates a general status :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100355 - 1xx = informational message to be skipped (e.g. 100, 101)
356 - 2xx = OK, content is following (e.g. 200, 206)
357 - 3xx = OK, no content following (e.g. 302, 304)
358 - 4xx = error caused by the client (e.g. 401, 403, 404)
359 - 5xx = error caused by the server (e.g. 500, 502, 503)
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200360
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000361Please refer to RFC7231 for the detailed meaning of all such codes. The
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100362"reason" field is just a hint, but is not parsed by clients. Anything can be
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200363found there, but it's a common practice to respect the well-established
364messages. It can be composed of one or multiple words, such as "OK", "Found",
365or "Authentication Required".
366
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100367HAProxy may emit the following status codes by itself :
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200368
369 Code When / reason
370 200 access to stats page, and when replying to monitoring requests
371 301 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
372 302 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
373 303 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +0100374 307 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
375 308 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200376 400 for an invalid or too large request
377 401 when an authentication is required to perform the action (when
378 accessing the stats page)
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200379 403 when a request is forbidden by a "http-request deny" rule
Florian Tham9205fea2020-01-08 13:35:30 +0100380 404 when the requested resource could not be found
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200381 408 when the request timeout strikes before the request is complete
Florian Tham272e29b2020-01-08 10:19:05 +0100382 410 when the requested resource is no longer available and will not
383 be available again
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -0400384 500 when HAProxy encounters an unrecoverable internal error, such as a
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200385 memory allocation failure, which should never happen
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -0400386 501 when HAProxy is unable to satisfy a client request because of an
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +0100387 unsupported feature
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200388 502 when the server returns an empty, invalid or incomplete response, or
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200389 when an "http-response deny" rule blocks the response.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200390 503 when no server was available to handle the request, or in response to
391 monitoring requests which match the "monitor fail" condition
392 504 when the response timeout strikes before the server responds
393
394The error 4xx and 5xx codes above may be customized (see "errorloc" in section
3954.2).
396
397
3981.3.2. The response headers
399---------------------------
400
401Response headers work exactly like request headers, and as such, HAProxy uses
402the same parsing function for both. Please refer to paragraph 1.2.2 for more
403details.
404
405
4062. Configuring HAProxy
407----------------------
408
4092.1. Configuration file format
410------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200411
412HAProxy's configuration process involves 3 major sources of parameters :
413
414 - the arguments from the command-line, which always take precedence
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100415 - the configuration file(s), whose format is described here
Thayne McCombscdbcca92021-01-07 21:24:41 -0700416 - the running process's environment, in case some environment variables are
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100417 explicitly referenced
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200418
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100419The configuration file follows a fairly simple hierarchical format which obey
420a few basic rules:
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100421
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100422 1. a configuration file is an ordered sequence of statements
423
424 2. a statement is a single non-empty line before any unprotected "#" (hash)
425
426 3. a line is a series of tokens or "words" delimited by unprotected spaces or
427 tab characters
428
429 4. the first word or sequence of words of a line is one of the keywords or
430 keyword sequences listed in this document
431
432 5. all other words are all arguments of the first one, some being well-known
433 keywords listed in this document, others being values, references to other
434 parts of the configuration, or expressions
435
436 6. certain keywords delimit a section inside which only a subset of keywords
437 are supported
438
439 7. a section ends at the end of a file or on a special keyword starting a new
440 section
441
442This is all that is needed to know to write a simple but reliable configuration
443generator, but this is not enough to reliably parse any configuration nor to
444figure how to deal with certain corner cases.
445
446First, there are a few consequences of the rules above. Rule 6 and 7 imply that
447the keywords used to define a new section are valid everywhere and cannot have
448a different meaning in a specific section. These keywords are always a single
449word (as opposed to a sequence of words), and traditionally the section that
450follows them is designated using the same name. For example when speaking about
451the "global section", it designates the section of configuration that follows
452the "global" keyword. This usage is used a lot in error messages to help locate
453the parts that need to be addressed.
454
455A number of sections create an internal object or configuration space, which
456requires to be distinguished from other ones. In this case they will take an
457extra word which will set the name of this particular section. For some of them
458the section name is mandatory. For example "frontend foo" will create a new
459section of type "frontend" named "foo". Usually a name is specific to its
460section and two sections of different types may use the same name, but this is
461not recommended as it tends to complexify configuration management.
462
463A direct consequence of rule 7 is that when multiple files are read at once,
464each of them must start with a new section, and the end of each file will end
465a section. A file cannot contain sub-sections nor end an existing section and
466start a new one.
467
468Rule 1 mentioned that ordering matters. Indeed, some keywords create directives
469that can be repeated multiple times to create ordered sequences of rules to be
470applied in a certain order. For example "tcp-request" can be used to alternate
471"accept" and "reject" rules on varying criteria. As such, a configuration file
472processor must always preserve a section's ordering when editing a file. The
473ordering of sections usually does not matter except for the global section
474which must be placed before other sections, but it may be repeated if needed.
475In addition, some automatic identifiers may automatically be assigned to some
476of the created objects (e.g. proxies), and by reordering sections, their
477identifiers will change. These ones appear in the statistics for example. As
478such, the configuration below will assign "foo" ID number 1 and "bar" ID number
4792, which will be swapped if the two sections are reversed:
480
481 listen foo
482 bind :80
483
484 listen bar
485 bind :81
486
487Another important point is that according to rules 2 and 3 above, empty lines,
488spaces, tabs, and comments following and unprotected "#" character are not part
489of the configuration as they are just used as delimiters. This implies that the
490following configurations are strictly equivalent:
491
492 global#this is the global section
493 daemon#daemonize
494 frontend foo
495 mode http # or tcp
496
497and:
498
499 global
500 daemon
501
502 # this is the public web frontend
503 frontend foo
504 mode http
505
506The common practice is to align to the left only the keyword that initiates a
507new section, and indent (i.e. prepend a tab character or a few spaces) all
508other keywords so that it's instantly visible that they belong to the same
509section (as done in the second example above). Placing comments before a new
510section helps the reader decide if it's the desired one. Leaving a blank line
511at the end of a section also visually helps spotting the end when editing it.
512
513Tabs are very convenient for indent but they do not copy-paste well. If spaces
514are used instead, it is recommended to avoid placing too many (2 to 4) so that
515editing in field doesn't become a burden with limited editors that do not
516support automatic indent.
517
518In the early days it used to be common to see arguments split at fixed tab
519positions because most keywords would not take more than two arguments. With
520modern versions featuring complex expressions this practice does not stand
521anymore, and is not recommended.
522
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200523
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +02005242.2. Quoting and escaping
525-------------------------
526
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100527In modern configurations, some arguments require the use of some characters
528that were previously considered as pure delimiters. In order to make this
529possible, HAProxy supports character escaping by prepending a backslash ('\')
530in front of the character to be escaped, weak quoting within double quotes
531('"') and strong quoting within single quotes ("'").
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200532
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100533This is pretty similar to what is done in a number of programming languages and
534very close to what is commonly encountered in Bourne shell. The principle is
535the following: while the configuration parser cuts the lines into words, it
536also takes care of quotes and backslashes to decide whether a character is a
537delimiter or is the raw representation of this character within the current
538word. The escape character is then removed, the quotes are removed, and the
539remaining word is used as-is as a keyword or argument for example.
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200540
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100541If a backslash is needed in a word, it must either be escaped using itself
542(i.e. double backslash) or be strongly quoted.
543
544Escaping outside quotes is achieved by preceding a special character by a
545backslash ('\'):
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200546
547 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
548 \# to mark a hash and differentiate it from a comment
549 \\ to use a backslash
550 \' to use a single quote and differentiate it from strong quoting
551 \" to use a double quote and differentiate it from weak quoting
552
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100553In addition, a few non-printable characters may be emitted using their usual
554C-language representation:
555
556 \n to insert a line feed (LF, character \x0a or ASCII 10 decimal)
557 \r to insert a carriage return (CR, character \x0d or ASCII 13 decimal)
558 \t to insert a tab (character \x09 or ASCII 9 decimal)
559 \xNN to insert character having ASCII code hex NN (e.g \x0a for LF).
560
561Weak quoting is achieved by surrounding double quotes ("") around the character
562or sequence of characters to protect. Weak quoting prevents the interpretation
563of:
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200564
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100565 space or tab as a word separator
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200566 ' single quote as a strong quoting delimiter
567 # hash as a comment start
568
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100569Weak quoting permits the interpretation of environment variables (which are not
570evaluated outside of quotes) by preceding them with a dollar sign ('$'). If a
571dollar character is needed inside double quotes, it must be escaped using a
572backslash.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200573
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100574Strong quoting is achieved by surrounding single quotes ('') around the
575character or sequence of characters to protect. Inside single quotes, nothing
576is interpreted, it's the efficient way to quote regular expressions.
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200577
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100578As a result, here is the matrix indicating how special characters can be
579entered in different contexts (unprintable characters are replaced with their
580name within angle brackets). Note that some characters that may only be
581represented escaped have no possible representation inside single quotes,
582hence the '-' there:
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200583
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100584 Character | Unquoted | Weakly quoted | Strongly quoted
585 -----------+---------------+-----------------------------+-----------------
586 <TAB> | \<TAB>, \x09 | "<TAB>", "\<TAB>", "\x09" | '<TAB>'
587 <LF> | \n, \x0a | "\n", "\x0a" | -
588 <CR> | \r, \x0d | "\r", "\x0d" | -
589 <SPC> | \<SPC>, \x20 | "<SPC>", "\<SPC>", "\x20" | '<SPC>'
590 " | \", \x22 | "\"", "\x22" | '"'
591 # | \#, \x23 | "#", "\#", "\x23" | '#'
592 $ | $, \$, \x24 | "\$", "\x24" | '$'
593 ' | \', \x27 | "'", "\'", "\x27" | -
594 \ | \\, \x5c | "\\", "\x5c" | '\'
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200595
596 Example:
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100597 # those are all strictly equivalent:
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200598 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
599 log-format "%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r"
600 log-format '%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r'
601 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s %{-Q}r'
602 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s'\ %{-Q}r
603
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100604There is one particular case where a second level of quoting or escaping may be
605necessary. Some keywords take arguments within parenthesis, sometimes delimited
606by commas. These arguments are commonly integers or predefined words, but when
607they are arbitrary strings, it may be required to perform a separate level of
608escaping to disambiguate the characters that belong to the argument from the
609characters that are used to delimit the arguments themselves. A pretty common
610case is the "regsub" converter. It takes a regular expression in argument, and
611if a closing parenthesis is needed inside, this one will require to have its
612own quotes.
613
614The keyword argument parser is exactly the same as the top-level one regarding
Thayne McCombscd34ad72021-10-04 01:02:58 -0600615quotes, except that the \#, \$, and \xNN escapes are not processed. But what is
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +0500616not always obvious is that the delimiters used inside must first be escaped or
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100617quoted so that they are not resolved at the top level.
618
619Let's take this example making use of the "regsub" converter which takes 3
620arguments, one regular expression, one replacement string and one set of flags:
621
622 # replace all occurrences of "foo" with "blah" in the path:
623 http-request set-path %[path,regsub(foo,blah,g)]
624
625Here no special quoting was necessary. But if now we want to replace either
626"foo" or "bar" with "blah", we'll need the regular expression "(foo|bar)". We
627cannot write:
628
629 http-request set-path %[path,regsub((foo|bar),blah,g)]
630
631because we would like the string to cut like this:
632
633 http-request set-path %[path,regsub((foo|bar),blah,g)]
634 |---------|----|-|
635 arg1 _/ / /
636 arg2 __________/ /
637 arg3 ______________/
638
639but actually what is passed is a string between the opening and closing
640parenthesis then garbage:
641
642 http-request set-path %[path,regsub((foo|bar),blah,g)]
643 |--------|--------|
644 arg1=(foo|bar _/ /
645 trailing garbage _________/
646
647The obvious solution here seems to be that the closing parenthesis needs to be
648quoted, but alone this will not work, because as mentioned above, quotes are
649processed by the top-level parser which will resolve them before processing
650this word:
651
652 http-request set-path %[path,regsub("(foo|bar)",blah,g)]
653 ------------ -------- ----------------------------------
654 word1 word2 word3=%[path,regsub((foo|bar),blah,g)]
655
656So we didn't change anything for the argument parser at the second level which
657still sees a truncated regular expression as the only argument, and garbage at
658the end of the string. By escaping the quotes they will be passed unmodified to
659the second level:
660
661 http-request set-path %[path,regsub(\"(foo|bar)\",blah,g)]
662 ------------ -------- ------------------------------------
663 word1 word2 word3=%[path,regsub("(foo|bar)",blah,g)]
664 |---------||----|-|
665 arg1=(foo|bar) _/ / /
666 arg2=blah ___________/ /
667 arg3=g _______________/
668
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +0500669Another approach consists in using single quotes outside the whole string and
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100670double quotes inside (so that the double quotes are not stripped again):
671
672 http-request set-path '%[path,regsub("(foo|bar)",blah,g)]'
673 ------------ -------- ----------------------------------
674 word1 word2 word3=%[path,regsub("(foo|bar)",blah,g)]
675 |---------||----|-|
676 arg1=(foo|bar) _/ / /
677 arg2 ___________/ /
678 arg3 _______________/
679
680When using regular expressions, it can happen that the dollar ('$') character
681appears in the expression or that a backslash ('\') is used in the replacement
682string. In this case these ones will also be processed inside the double quotes
683thus single quotes are preferred (or double escaping). Example:
684
685 http-request set-path '%[path,regsub("^/(here)(/|$)","my/\1",g)]'
686 ------------ -------- -----------------------------------------
687 word1 word2 word3=%[path,regsub("^/(here)(/|$)","my/\1",g)]
688 |-------------| |-----||-|
689 arg1=(here)(/|$) _/ / /
690 arg2=my/\1 ________________/ /
691 arg3 ______________________/
692
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -0400693Remember that backslashes are not escape characters within single quotes and
Thayne McCombscd34ad72021-10-04 01:02:58 -0600694that the whole word above is already protected against them using the single
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100695quotes. Conversely, if double quotes had been used around the whole expression,
696single the dollar character and the backslashes would have been resolved at top
697level, breaking the argument contents at the second level.
698
Thayne McCombscd34ad72021-10-04 01:02:58 -0600699Unfortunately, since single quotes can't be escaped inside of strong quoting,
700if you need to include single quotes in your argument, you will need to escape
701or quote them twice. There are a few ways to do this:
702
703 http-request set-var(txn.foo) str("\\'foo\\'")
704 http-request set-var(txn.foo) str(\"\'foo\'\")
705 http-request set-var(txn.foo) str(\\\'foo\\\')
706
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100707When in doubt, simply do not use quotes anywhere, and start to place single or
708double quotes around arguments that require a comma or a closing parenthesis,
Thayne McCombscd34ad72021-10-04 01:02:58 -0600709and think about escaping these quotes using a backslash if the string contains
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100710a dollar or a backslash. Again, this is pretty similar to what is used under
711a Bourne shell when double-escaping a command passed to "eval". For API writers
712the best is probably to place escaped quotes around each and every argument,
713regardless of their contents. Users will probably find that using single quotes
714around the whole expression and double quotes around each argument provides
715more readable configurations.
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200716
717
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02007182.3. Environment variables
719--------------------------
720
721HAProxy's configuration supports environment variables. Those variables are
722interpreted only within double quotes. Variables are expanded during the
723configuration parsing. Variable names must be preceded by a dollar ("$") and
724optionally enclosed with braces ("{}") similarly to what is done in Bourne
725shell. Variable names can contain alphanumerical characters or the character
Amaury Denoyellefa41cb62020-10-01 14:32:35 +0200726underscore ("_") but should not start with a digit. If the variable contains a
727list of several values separated by spaces, it can be expanded as individual
728arguments by enclosing the variable with braces and appending the suffix '[*]'
Willy Tarreauec347b12021-11-18 17:42:50 +0100729before the closing brace. It is also possible to specify a default value to
730use when the variable is not set, by appending that value after a dash '-'
731next to the variable name. Note that the default value only replaces non
732existing variables, not empty ones.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200733
734 Example:
735
736 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
737
Willy Tarreauec347b12021-11-18 17:42:50 +0100738 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG-127.0.0.1}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200739
740 user "$HAPROXY_USER"
741
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200742Some variables are defined by HAProxy, they can be used in the configuration
743file, or could be inherited by a program (See 3.7. Programs):
William Lallemanddaf4cd22018-04-17 16:46:13 +0200744
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200745* HAPROXY_LOCALPEER: defined at the startup of the process which contains the
746 name of the local peer. (See "-L" in the management guide.)
747
748* HAPROXY_CFGFILES: list of the configuration files loaded by HAProxy,
749 separated by semicolons. Can be useful in the case you specified a
750 directory.
751
752* HAPROXY_MWORKER: In master-worker mode, this variable is set to 1.
753
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -0500754* HAPROXY_CLI: configured listeners addresses of the stats socket for every
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200755 processes, separated by semicolons.
756
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -0500757* HAPROXY_MASTER_CLI: In master-worker mode, listeners addresses of the master
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200758 CLI, separated by semicolons.
759
Willy Tarreaua46f1af2021-05-06 10:25:11 +0200760In addition, some pseudo-variables are internally resolved and may be used as
761regular variables. Pseudo-variables always start with a dot ('.'), and are the
762only ones where the dot is permitted. The current list of pseudo-variables is:
763
764* .FILE: the name of the configuration file currently being parsed.
765
766* .LINE: the line number of the configuration file currently being parsed,
767 starting at one.
768
769* .SECTION: the name of the section currently being parsed, or its type if the
770 section doesn't have a name (e.g. "global"), or an empty string before the
771 first section.
772
773These variables are resolved at the location where they are parsed. For example
774if a ".LINE" variable is used in a "log-format" directive located in a defaults
775section, its line number will be resolved before parsing and compiling the
776"log-format" directive, so this same line number will be reused by subsequent
777proxies.
778
779This way it is possible to emit information to help locate a rule in variables,
780logs, error statuses, health checks, header values, or even to use line numbers
781to name some config objects like servers for example.
782
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200783See also "external-check command" for other variables.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200784
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100785
7862.4. Conditional blocks
787-----------------------
788
789It may sometimes be convenient to be able to conditionally enable or disable
790some arbitrary parts of the configuration, for example to enable/disable SSL or
791ciphers, enable or disable some pre-production listeners without modifying the
792configuration, or adjust the configuration's syntax to support two distinct
793versions of HAProxy during a migration.. HAProxy brings a set of nestable
794preprocessor-like directives which allow to integrate or ignore some blocks of
795text. These directives must be placed on their own line and they act on the
796lines that follow them. Two of them support an expression, the other ones only
797switch to an alternate block or end a current level. The 4 following directives
798are defined to form conditional blocks:
799
800 - .if <condition>
801 - .elif <condition>
802 - .else
803 - .endif
804
805The ".if" directive nests a new level, ".elif" stays at the same level, ".else"
806as well, and ".endif" closes a level. Each ".if" must be terminated by a
807matching ".endif". The ".elif" may only be placed after ".if" or ".elif", and
808there is no limit to the number of ".elif" that may be chained. There may be
809only one ".else" per ".if" and it must always be after the ".if" or the last
810".elif" of a block.
811
812Comments may be placed on the same line if needed after a '#', they will be
813ignored. The directives are tokenized like other configuration directives, and
814as such it is possible to use environment variables in conditions.
815
Maximilian Maderfc0cceb2021-06-06 00:50:22 +0200816Conditions can also be evaluated on startup with the -cc parameter.
817See "3. Starting HAProxy" in the management doc.
818
Willy Tarreauca818872021-07-16 14:46:09 +0200819The conditions are either an empty string (which then returns false), or an
820expression made of any combination of:
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100821
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100822 - the integer zero ('0'), always returns "false"
823 - a non-nul integer (e.g. '1'), always returns "true".
Willy Tarreau42ed14b2021-05-06 15:55:14 +0200824 - a predicate optionally followed by argument(s) in parenthesis.
Willy Tarreau316ea7e2021-07-16 14:56:59 +0200825 - a condition placed between a pair of parenthesis '(' and ')'
Kunal Gangakhedkard0bacde2021-08-17 11:55:45 +0530826 - an exclamation mark ('!') preceding any of the non-empty elements above,
827 and which will negate its status.
Willy Tarreauca818872021-07-16 14:46:09 +0200828 - expressions combined with a logical AND ('&&'), which will be evaluated
829 from left to right until one returns false
830 - expressions combined with a logical OR ('||'), which will be evaluated
831 from right to left until one returns true
832
833Note that like in other languages, the AND operator has precedence over the OR
834operator, so that "A && B || C && D" evalues as "(A && B) || (C && D)".
Willy Tarreau42ed14b2021-05-06 15:55:14 +0200835
836The list of currently supported predicates is the following:
837
838 - defined(<name>) : returns true if an environment variable <name>
839 exists, regardless of its contents
840
Willy Tarreau58ca7062021-05-06 16:34:23 +0200841 - feature(<name>) : returns true if feature <name> is listed as present
842 in the features list reported by "haproxy -vv"
843 (which means a <name> appears after a '+')
844
Willy Tarreau6492e872021-05-06 16:10:09 +0200845 - streq(<str1>,<str2>) : returns true only if the two strings are equal
846 - strneq(<str1>,<str2>) : returns true only if the two strings differ
847
Willy Tarreau0b7c78a2021-05-06 16:53:26 +0200848 - version_atleast(<ver>): returns true if the current haproxy version is
849 at least as recent as <ver> otherwise false. The
850 version syntax is the same as shown by "haproxy -v"
851 and missing components are assumed as being zero.
852
853 - version_before(<ver>) : returns true if the current haproxy version is
854 strictly older than <ver> otherwise false. The
855 version syntax is the same as shown by "haproxy -v"
856 and missing components are assumed as being zero.
857
Willy Tarreau42ed14b2021-05-06 15:55:14 +0200858Example:
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100859
Willy Tarreau42ed14b2021-05-06 15:55:14 +0200860 .if defined(HAPROXY_MWORKER)
861 listen mwcli_px
862 bind :1111
863 ...
864 .endif
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100865
Willy Tarreau6492e872021-05-06 16:10:09 +0200866 .if strneq("$SSL_ONLY",yes)
867 bind :80
868 .endif
869
870 .if streq("$WITH_SSL",yes)
Willy Tarreau58ca7062021-05-06 16:34:23 +0200871 .if feature(OPENSSL)
Willy Tarreau6492e872021-05-06 16:10:09 +0200872 bind :443 ssl crt ...
Willy Tarreau58ca7062021-05-06 16:34:23 +0200873 .endif
Willy Tarreau6492e872021-05-06 16:10:09 +0200874 .endif
875
Willy Tarreau316ea7e2021-07-16 14:56:59 +0200876 .if feature(OPENSSL) && (streq("$WITH_SSL",yes) || streq("$SSL_ONLY",yes))
Willy Tarreauca818872021-07-16 14:46:09 +0200877 bind :443 ssl crt ...
878 .endif
879
Willy Tarreau0b7c78a2021-05-06 16:53:26 +0200880 .if version_atleast(2.4-dev19)
881 profiling.memory on
882 .endif
883
Willy Tarreauca56d3d2021-07-16 13:56:54 +0200884 .if !feature(OPENSSL)
885 .alert "SSL support is mandatory"
886 .endif
887
Willy Tarreau7190b982021-05-07 08:59:50 +0200888Four other directives are provided to report some status:
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100889
Willy Tarreau7190b982021-05-07 08:59:50 +0200890 - .diag "message" : emit this message only when in diagnostic mode (-dD)
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100891 - .notice "message" : emit this message at level NOTICE
892 - .warning "message" : emit this message at level WARNING
893 - .alert "message" : emit this message at level ALERT
894
895Messages emitted at level WARNING may cause the process to fail to start if the
896"strict-mode" is enabled. Messages emitted at level ALERT will always cause a
897fatal error. These can be used to detect some inappropriate conditions and
898provide advice to the user.
899
900Example:
901
902 .if "${A}"
903 .if "${B}"
904 .notice "A=1, B=1"
905 .elif "${C}"
906 .notice "A=1, B=0, C=1"
907 .elif "${D}"
908 .warning "A=1, B=0, C=0, D=1"
909 .else
910 .alert "A=1, B=0, C=0, D=0"
911 .endif
912 .else
913 .notice "A=0"
914 .endif
915
Willy Tarreau7190b982021-05-07 08:59:50 +0200916 .diag "WTA/2021-05-07: replace 'redirect' with 'return' after switch to 2.4"
917 http-request redirect location /goaway if ABUSE
918
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100919
9202.5. Time format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200921----------------
922
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100923Some parameters involve values representing time, such as timeouts. These
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100924values are generally expressed in milliseconds (unless explicitly stated
925otherwise) but may be expressed in any other unit by suffixing the unit to the
926numeric value. It is important to consider this because it will not be repeated
927for every keyword. Supported units are :
928
929 - us : microseconds. 1 microsecond = 1/1000000 second
930 - ms : milliseconds. 1 millisecond = 1/1000 second. This is the default.
931 - s : seconds. 1s = 1000ms
932 - m : minutes. 1m = 60s = 60000ms
933 - h : hours. 1h = 60m = 3600s = 3600000ms
934 - d : days. 1d = 24h = 1440m = 86400s = 86400000ms
935
936
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +01009372.6. Examples
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200938-------------
939
940 # Simple configuration for an HTTP proxy listening on port 80 on all
941 # interfaces and forwarding requests to a single backend "servers" with a
942 # single server "server1" listening on 127.0.0.1:8000
943 global
944 daemon
945 maxconn 256
946
947 defaults
948 mode http
949 timeout connect 5000ms
950 timeout client 50000ms
951 timeout server 50000ms
952
953 frontend http-in
954 bind *:80
955 default_backend servers
956
957 backend servers
958 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
959
960
961 # The same configuration defined with a single listen block. Shorter but
962 # less expressive, especially in HTTP mode.
963 global
964 daemon
965 maxconn 256
966
967 defaults
968 mode http
969 timeout connect 5000ms
970 timeout client 50000ms
971 timeout server 50000ms
972
973 listen http-in
974 bind *:80
975 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
976
977
978Assuming haproxy is in $PATH, test these configurations in a shell with:
979
Willy Tarreauccb289d2010-12-11 20:19:38 +0100980 $ sudo haproxy -f configuration.conf -c
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200981
982
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009833. Global parameters
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200984--------------------
985
986Parameters in the "global" section are process-wide and often OS-specific. They
987are generally set once for all and do not need being changed once correct. Some
988of them have command-line equivalents.
989
990The following keywords are supported in the "global" section :
991
992 * Process management and security
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200993 - ca-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200994 - chroot
Frédéric Lécaille372508c2022-05-06 08:53:16 +0200995 - cluster-secret
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200996 - crt-base
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200997 - cpu-map
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200998 - daemon
Willy Tarreau8a022d52021-04-27 20:29:11 +0200999 - default-path
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001000 - description
1001 - deviceatlas-json-file
1002 - deviceatlas-log-level
1003 - deviceatlas-separator
1004 - deviceatlas-properties-cookie
Amaury Denoyelled2e53cd2021-05-06 16:21:39 +02001005 - expose-experimental-directives
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09001006 - external-check
Willy Tarreau2df1fbf2022-04-25 18:02:03 +02001007 - fd-hard-limit
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001008 - gid
Willy Tarreau10080712021-09-07 10:49:45 +02001009 - grace
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001010 - group
Cyril Bonté203ec5a2017-03-23 22:44:13 +01001011 - hard-stop-after
William Lallemandcfabb352022-05-12 10:51:15 +02001012 - httpclient.resolvers.id
1013 - httpclient.resolvers.prefer
1014 - httpclient.ssl.ca-file
1015 - httpclient.ssl.verify
Christopher Faulet0f9c0f52022-05-13 09:20:13 +02001016 - h1-accept-payload-with-any-method
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02001017 - h1-case-adjust
1018 - h1-case-adjust-file
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +01001019 - insecure-fork-wanted
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +01001020 - insecure-setuid-wanted
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +01001021 - issuers-chain-path
Amaury Denoyellebefeae82021-07-09 17:14:30 +02001022 - h2-workaround-bogus-websocket-clients
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +02001023 - localpeer
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001024 - log
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001025 - log-tag
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +01001026 - log-send-hostname
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001027 - lua-load
Thierry Fournier59f11be2020-11-29 00:37:41 +01001028 - lua-load-per-thread
Tim Duesterhusdd74b5f2020-01-12 13:55:40 +01001029 - lua-prepend-path
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +02001030 - mworker-max-reloads
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +02001031 - nbthread
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001032 - node
Amaury Denoyelle0f50cb92021-03-26 18:50:33 +01001033 - numa-cpu-mapping
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001034 - pidfile
Willy Tarreau119e50e2020-05-22 13:53:29 +02001035 - pp2-never-send-local
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001036 - presetenv
1037 - resetenv
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001038 - uid
1039 - ulimit-n
1040 - user
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +02001041 - set-dumpable
Willy Tarreau13d2ba22021-03-26 11:38:08 +01001042 - set-var
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001043 - setenv
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02001044 - stats
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001045 - ssl-default-bind-ciphers
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001046 - ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites
Jerome Magninb203ff62020-04-03 15:28:22 +02001047 - ssl-default-bind-curves
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001048 - ssl-default-bind-options
1049 - ssl-default-server-ciphers
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001050 - ssl-default-server-ciphersuites
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001051 - ssl-default-server-options
1052 - ssl-dh-param-file
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +01001053 - ssl-server-verify
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +02001054 - ssl-skip-self-issued-ca
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001055 - unix-bind
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001056 - unsetenv
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001057 - 51degrees-data-file
1058 - 51degrees-property-name-list
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +02001059 - 51degrees-property-separator
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001060 - 51degrees-cache-size
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001061 - wurfl-data-file
1062 - wurfl-information-list
1063 - wurfl-information-list-separator
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001064 - wurfl-cache-size
William Dauchy0fec3ab2019-10-27 20:08:11 +01001065 - strict-limits
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01001066
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001067 * Performance tuning
William Dauchy0a8824f2019-10-27 20:08:09 +01001068 - busy-polling
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +02001069 - max-spread-checks
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001070 - maxconn
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +02001071 - maxconnrate
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001072 - maxcomprate
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +01001073 - maxcompcpuusage
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001074 - maxpipes
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +02001075 - maxsessrate
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02001076 - maxsslconn
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +02001077 - maxsslrate
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001078 - maxzlibmem
Willy Tarreauc4e56dc2022-03-08 10:41:40 +01001079 - no-memory-trimming
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001080 - noepoll
1081 - nokqueue
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +00001082 - noevports
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001083 - nopoll
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001084 - nosplice
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001085 - nogetaddrinfo
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +00001086 - noreuseport
Willy Tarreau75c62c22018-11-22 11:02:09 +01001087 - profiling.tasks
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02001088 - spread-checks
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02001089 - server-state-base
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +02001090 - server-state-file
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00001091 - ssl-engine
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00001092 - ssl-mode-async
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001093 - tune.buffers.limit
1094 - tune.buffers.reserve
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001095 - tune.bufsize
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +01001096 - tune.comp.maxlevel
Willy Tarreaubc52bec2020-06-18 08:58:47 +02001097 - tune.fd.edge-triggered
Willy Tarreaufe20e5b2017-07-27 11:42:14 +02001098 - tune.h2.header-table-size
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02001099 - tune.h2.initial-window-size
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +02001100 - tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01001101 - tune.http.cookielen
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02001102 - tune.http.logurilen
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02001103 - tune.http.maxhdr
Willy Tarreau76cc6992020-07-01 18:49:24 +02001104 - tune.idle-pool.shared
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001105 - tune.idletimer
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001106 - tune.lua.forced-yield
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +01001107 - tune.lua.maxmem
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001108 - tune.lua.session-timeout
1109 - tune.lua.task-timeout
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02001110 - tune.lua.service-timeout
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01001111 - tune.maxaccept
1112 - tune.maxpollevents
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001113 - tune.maxrewrite
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02001114 - tune.pattern.cache-size
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +02001115 - tune.pipesize
Willy Tarreaua8e2d972020-07-01 18:27:16 +02001116 - tune.pool-high-fd-ratio
1117 - tune.pool-low-fd-ratio
Amaury Denoyelle97e84c62022-04-19 18:26:55 +02001118 - tune.quic.conn-buf-limit
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001119 - tune.rcvbuf.client
1120 - tune.rcvbuf.server
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01001121 - tune.recv_enough
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02001122 - tune.runqueue-depth
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +02001123 - tune.sched.low-latency
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001124 - tune.sndbuf.client
1125 - tune.sndbuf.server
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01001126 - tune.ssl.cachesize
Thomas Prückl10243932022-04-27 13:04:54 +02001127 - tune.ssl.force-private-cache
1128 - tune.ssl.hard-maxrecord
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +02001129 - tune.ssl.keylog
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01001130 - tune.ssl.lifetime
1131 - tune.ssl.maxrecord
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02001132 - tune.ssl.default-dh-param
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +02001133 - tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size
Marcin Deranek310a2602021-07-13 19:04:24 +02001134 - tune.ssl.capture-buffer-size
1135 - tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size (deprecated)
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001136 - tune.vars.global-max-size
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01001137 - tune.vars.proc-max-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001138 - tune.vars.reqres-max-size
1139 - tune.vars.sess-max-size
1140 - tune.vars.txn-max-size
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001141 - tune.zlib.memlevel
1142 - tune.zlib.windowsize
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01001143
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001144 * Debugging
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001145 - quiet
Willy Tarreau3eb10b82020-04-15 16:42:39 +02001146 - zero-warning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001147
1148
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011493.1. Process management and security
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001150------------------------------------
1151
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +02001152ca-base <dir>
1153 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL CA certificates and CRLs from when a
Emmanuel Hocdet842e94e2019-12-16 16:39:17 +01001154 relative path is used with "ca-file", "ca-verify-file" or "crl-file"
1155 directives. Absolute locations specified in "ca-file", "ca-verify-file" and
1156 "crl-file" prevail and ignore "ca-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +02001157
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001158chroot <jail dir>
1159 Changes current directory to <jail dir> and performs a chroot() there before
1160 dropping privileges. This increases the security level in case an unknown
1161 vulnerability would be exploited, since it would make it very hard for the
1162 attacker to exploit the system. This only works when the process is started
1163 with superuser privileges. It is important to ensure that <jail_dir> is both
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001164 empty and non-writable to anyone.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01001165
Frédéric Lécaille372508c2022-05-06 08:53:16 +02001166cluster-secret <secret>
1167 Define an ASCII string secret shared between several nodes belonging to the
1168 same cluster. It could be used for different usages. It is at least used to
1169 derive stateless reset tokens for all the QUIC connections instantiated by
1170 this process. If you do not set this parameter, the stateless reset QUIC
1171 feature will be silently disabled.
1172
Remi Tricot-Le Bretonb5d968d2022-04-08 18:04:18 +02001173close-spread-time <time>
1174 Define a time window during which idle connections and active connections
1175 closing is spread in case of soft-stop. After a SIGUSR1 is received and the
1176 grace period is over (if any), the idle connections will all be closed at
1177 once if this option is not set, and active HTTP or HTTP2 connections will be
1178 ended after the next request is received, either by appending a "Connection:
1179 close" line to the HTTP response, or by sending a GOAWAY frame in case of
1180 HTTP2. When this option is set, connection closing will be spread over this
1181 set <time>.
Remi Tricot-Le Breton4d7fdc62022-04-26 15:17:18 +02001182 If the close-spread-time is set to "infinite", active connection closing
1183 during a soft-stop will be disabled. The "Connection: close" header will not
1184 be added to HTTP responses (or GOAWAY for HTTP2) anymore and idle connections
1185 will only be closed once their timeout is reached (based on the various
1186 timeouts set in the configuration).
Remi Tricot-Le Bretonb5d968d2022-04-08 18:04:18 +02001187
1188 Arguments :
1189 <time> is a time window (by default in milliseconds) during which
Remi Tricot-Le Breton4d7fdc62022-04-26 15:17:18 +02001190 connection closing will be spread during a soft-stop operation, or
1191 "infinite" if active connection closing should be disabled.
Remi Tricot-Le Bretonb5d968d2022-04-08 18:04:18 +02001192
1193 It is recommended to set this setting to a value lower than the one used in
1194 the "hard-stop-after" option if this one is used, so that all connections
1195 have a chance to gracefully close before the process stops.
1196
Remi Tricot-Le Breton4d7fdc62022-04-26 15:17:18 +02001197 See also: grace, hard-stop-after, idle-close-on-response
Remi Tricot-Le Bretonb5d968d2022-04-08 18:04:18 +02001198
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001199cpu-map [auto:]<process-set>[/<thread-set>] <cpu-set>...
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +02001200 On some operating systems, it is possible to bind a process or a thread to a
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001201 specific CPU set. This means that the process or the thread will never run on
1202 other CPUs. The "cpu-map" directive specifies CPU sets for process or thread
1203 sets. The first argument is a process set, eventually followed by a thread
1204 set. These sets have the format
1205
1206 all | odd | even | number[-[number]]
1207
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +02001208 <number> must be a number between 1 and 32 or 64, depending on the machine's
1209 word size. Any process IDs above 1 and any thread IDs above nbthread are
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001210 ignored. It is possible to specify a range with two such number delimited by
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +02001211 a dash ('-'). It also is possible to specify all thraeds at once using
Christopher Faulet1dcb9cb2017-11-22 10:24:40 +01001212 "all", only odd numbers using "odd" or even numbers using "even", just like
1213 with the "bind-process" directive. The second and forthcoming arguments are
Amaury Denoyelle982fb532021-04-21 18:39:58 +02001214 CPU sets. Each CPU set is either a unique number starting at 0 for the first
1215 CPU or a range with two such numbers delimited by a dash ('-'). Outside of
1216 Linux and BSDs, there may be a limitation on the maximum CPU index to either
1217 31 or 63. Multiple CPU numbers or ranges may be specified, and the processes
1218 or threads will be allowed to bind to all of them. Obviously, multiple
1219 "cpu-map" directives may be specified. Each "cpu-map" directive will replace
1220 the previous ones when they overlap. A thread will be bound on the
1221 intersection of its mapping and the one of the process on which it is
1222 attached. If the intersection is null, no specific binding will be set for
1223 the thread.
Willy Tarreaufc6c0322012-11-16 16:12:27 +01001224
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01001225 Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can be omitted. In such
1226 case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum value, 32 or 64 depending
1227 on the machine's word size.
1228
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +01001229 The prefix "auto:" can be added before the process set to let HAProxy
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +02001230 automatically bind a process or a thread to a CPU by incrementing threads and
1231 CPU sets. To be valid, both sets must have the same size. No matter the
1232 declaration order of the CPU sets, it will be bound from the lowest to the
1233 highest bound. Having both a process and a thread range with the "auto:"
1234 prefix is not supported. Only one range is supported, the other one must be
1235 a fixed number.
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +01001236
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +02001237 Note that process ranges are supported for historical reasons. Nowadays, a
1238 lone number designates a process and must be 1, and specifying a thread range
1239 or number requires to prepend "1/" in front of it. Finally, "1" is strictly
1240 equivalent to "1/all" and designates all threads on the process.
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001241
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +02001242 Examples:
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001243 cpu-map 1/all 0-3 # bind all threads of the first process on the
1244 # first 4 CPUs
1245
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +02001246 cpu-map 1/1- 0- # will be replaced by "cpu-map 1/1-64 0-63"
1247 # or "cpu-map 1/1-32 0-31" depending on the machine's
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001248 # word size.
1249
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001250 # all these lines bind the thread 1 to the cpu 0, the thread 2 to cpu 1
1251 # and so on.
1252 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0-3
1253 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0-1 2-3
1254 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 3 2 1 0
1255
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +02001256 # bind each thread to exactly one CPU using all/odd/even keyword
1257 cpu-map auto:1/all 0-63
1258 cpu-map auto:1/even 0-31
1259 cpu-map auto:1/odd 32-63
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +01001260
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +02001261 # invalid cpu-map because thread and CPU sets have different sizes.
1262 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0 # invalid
1263 cpu-map auto:1/1 0-3 # invalid
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001264
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +02001265crt-base <dir>
1266 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL certificates from when a relative
William Dauchy238ea3b2020-01-11 13:09:12 +01001267 path is used with "crtfile" or "crt" directives. Absolute locations specified
1268 prevail and ignore "crt-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +02001269
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001270daemon
1271 Makes the process fork into background. This is the recommended mode of
1272 operation. It is equivalent to the command line "-D" argument. It can be
Lukas Tribusf46bf952017-11-21 12:39:34 +01001273 disabled by the command line "-db" argument. This option is ignored in
1274 systemd mode.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001275
Willy Tarreau8a022d52021-04-27 20:29:11 +02001276default-path { current | config | parent | origin <path> }
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001277 By default HAProxy loads all files designated by a relative path from the
Willy Tarreau8a022d52021-04-27 20:29:11 +02001278 location the process is started in. In some circumstances it might be
1279 desirable to force all relative paths to start from a different location
1280 just as if the process was started from such locations. This is what this
1281 directive is made for. Technically it will perform a temporary chdir() to
1282 the designated location while processing each configuration file, and will
1283 return to the original directory after processing each file. It takes an
1284 argument indicating the policy to use when loading files whose path does
1285 not start with a slash ('/'):
1286 - "current" indicates that all relative files are to be loaded from the
1287 directory the process is started in ; this is the default.
1288
1289 - "config" indicates that all relative files should be loaded from the
1290 directory containing the configuration file. More specifically, if the
1291 configuration file contains a slash ('/'), the longest part up to the
1292 last slash is used as the directory to change to, otherwise the current
1293 directory is used. This mode is convenient to bundle maps, errorfiles,
1294 certificates and Lua scripts together as relocatable packages. When
1295 multiple configuration files are loaded, the directory is updated for
1296 each of them.
1297
1298 - "parent" indicates that all relative files should be loaded from the
1299 parent of the directory containing the configuration file. More
1300 specifically, if the configuration file contains a slash ('/'), ".."
1301 is appended to the longest part up to the last slash is used as the
1302 directory to change to, otherwise the directory is "..". This mode is
1303 convenient to bundle maps, errorfiles, certificates and Lua scripts
1304 together as relocatable packages, but where each part is located in a
1305 different subdirectory (e.g. "config/", "certs/", "maps/", ...).
1306
1307 - "origin" indicates that all relative files should be loaded from the
1308 designated (mandatory) path. This may be used to ease management of
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001309 different HAProxy instances running in parallel on a system, where each
Willy Tarreau8a022d52021-04-27 20:29:11 +02001310 instance uses a different prefix but where the rest of the sections are
1311 made easily relocatable.
1312
1313 Each "default-path" directive instantly replaces any previous one and will
1314 possibly result in switching to a different directory. While this should
1315 always result in the desired behavior, it is really not a good practice to
1316 use multiple default-path directives, and if used, the policy ought to remain
1317 consistent across all configuration files.
1318
1319 Warning: some configuration elements such as maps or certificates are
1320 uniquely identified by their configured path. By using a relocatable layout,
1321 it becomes possible for several of them to end up with the same unique name,
1322 making it difficult to update them at run time, especially when multiple
1323 configuration files are loaded from different directories. It is essential to
1324 observe a strict collision-free file naming scheme before adopting relative
1325 paths. A robust approach could consist in prefixing all files names with
1326 their respective site name, or in doing so at the directory level.
1327
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +02001328deviceatlas-json-file <path>
1329 Sets the path of the DeviceAtlas JSON data file to be loaded by the API.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001330 The path must be a valid JSON data file and accessible by HAProxy process.
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +02001331
1332deviceatlas-log-level <value>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001333 Sets the level of information returned by the API. This directive is
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +02001334 optional and set to 0 by default if not set.
1335
1336deviceatlas-separator <char>
1337 Sets the character separator for the API properties results. This directive
1338 is optional and set to | by default if not set.
1339
Cyril Bonté0306c4a2015-10-26 22:37:38 +01001340deviceatlas-properties-cookie <name>
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02001341 Sets the client cookie's name used for the detection if the DeviceAtlas
1342 Client-side component was used during the request. This directive is optional
1343 and set to DAPROPS by default if not set.
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +01001344
Amaury Denoyelled2e53cd2021-05-06 16:21:39 +02001345expose-experimental-directives
1346 This statement must appear before using directives tagged as experimental or
1347 the config file will be rejected.
1348
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09001349external-check
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +01001350 Allows the use of an external agent to perform health checks. This is
1351 disabled by default as a security precaution, and even when enabled, checks
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +01001352 may still fail unless "insecure-fork-wanted" is enabled as well. If the
1353 program launched makes use of a setuid executable (it should really not),
1354 you may also need to set "insecure-setuid-wanted" in the global section.
1355 See "option external-check", and "insecure-fork-wanted", and
1356 "insecure-setuid-wanted".
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09001357
Willy Tarreau2df1fbf2022-04-25 18:02:03 +02001358fd-hard-limit <number>
1359 Sets an upper bound to the maximum number of file descriptors that the
1360 process will use, regardless of system limits. While "ulimit-n" and "maxconn"
1361 may be used to enforce a value, when they are not set, the process will be
1362 limited to the hard limit of the RLIMIT_NOFILE setting as reported by
1363 "ulimit -n -H". But some modern operating systems are now allowing extremely
1364 large values here (in the order of 1 billion), which will consume way too
1365 much RAM for regular usage. The fd-hard-limit setting is provided to enforce
1366 a possibly lower bound to this limit. This means that it will always respect
1367 the system-imposed limits when they are below <number> but the specified
1368 value will be used if system-imposed limits are higher. In the example below,
1369 no other setting is specified and the maxconn value will automatically adapt
1370 to the lower of "fd-hard-limit" and the system-imposed limit:
1371
1372 global
1373 # use as many FDs as possible but no more than 50000
1374 fd-hard-limit 50000
1375
1376 See also: ulimit-n, maxconn
1377
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001378gid <number>
Thayne McCombscdbcca92021-01-07 21:24:41 -07001379 Changes the process's group ID to <number>. It is recommended that the group
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001380 ID is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
1381 be started with a user belonging to this group, or with superuser privileges.
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001382 Note that if HAProxy is started from a user having supplementary groups, it
Michael Schererab012dd2013-01-12 18:35:19 +01001383 will only be able to drop these groups if started with superuser privileges.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001384 See also "group" and "uid".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01001385
Willy Tarreau10080712021-09-07 10:49:45 +02001386grace <time>
1387 Defines a delay between SIGUSR1 and real soft-stop.
1388
1389 Arguments :
1390 <time> is an extra delay (by default in milliseconds) after receipt of the
1391 SIGUSR1 signal that will be waited for before proceeding with the
1392 soft-stop operation.
1393
1394 This is used for compatibility with legacy environments where the haproxy
1395 process needs to be stopped but some external components need to detect the
1396 status before listeners are unbound. The principle is that the internal
1397 "stopping" variable (which is reported by the "stopping" sample fetch
1398 function) will be turned to true, but listeners will continue to accept
1399 connections undisturbed, until the delay expires, after what the regular
1400 soft-stop will proceed. This must not be used with processes that are
1401 reloaded, or this will prevent the old process from unbinding, and may
1402 prevent the new one from starting, or simply cause trouble.
1403
1404 Example:
1405
1406 global
1407 grace 10s
1408
1409 # Returns 200 OK until stopping is set via SIGUSR1
1410 frontend ext-check
1411 bind :9999
1412 monitor-uri /ext-check
1413 monitor fail if { stopping }
1414
1415 Please note that a more flexible and durable approach would instead consist
1416 for an orchestration system in setting a global variable from the CLI, use
1417 that variable to respond to external checks, then after a delay send the
1418 SIGUSR1 signal.
1419
1420 Example:
1421
1422 # Returns 200 OK until proc.stopping is set to non-zero. May be done
1423 # from HTTP using set-var(proc.stopping) or from the CLI using:
1424 # > set var proc.stopping int(1)
1425 frontend ext-check
1426 bind :9999
1427 monitor-uri /ext-check
1428 monitor fail if { var(proc.stopping) -m int gt 0 }
1429
1430 See also: hard-stop-after, monitor
1431
Willy Tarreau11770ce2019-12-03 08:29:22 +01001432group <group name>
1433 Similar to "gid" but uses the GID of group name <group name> from /etc/group.
1434 See also "gid" and "user".
1435
Cyril Bonté203ec5a2017-03-23 22:44:13 +01001436hard-stop-after <time>
1437 Defines the maximum time allowed to perform a clean soft-stop.
1438
1439 Arguments :
1440 <time> is the maximum time (by default in milliseconds) for which the
1441 instance will remain alive when a soft-stop is received via the
1442 SIGUSR1 signal.
1443
1444 This may be used to ensure that the instance will quit even if connections
1445 remain opened during a soft-stop (for example with long timeouts for a proxy
1446 in tcp mode). It applies both in TCP and HTTP mode.
1447
1448 Example:
1449 global
1450 hard-stop-after 30s
1451
Willy Tarreau10080712021-09-07 10:49:45 +02001452 See also: grace
1453
Christopher Faulet0f9c0f52022-05-13 09:20:13 +02001454h1-accept-payload-with-any-method
1455 Does not reject HTTP/1.0 GET/HEAD/DELETE requests with a payload.
1456
1457 While It is explicitly allowed in HTTP/1.1, HTTP/1.0 is not clear on this
1458 point and some old servers don't expect any payload and never look for body
1459 length (via Content-Length or Transfer-Encoding headers). It means that some
1460 intermediaries may properly handle the payload for HTTP/1.0 GET/HEAD/DELETE
1461 requests, while some others may totally ignore it. That may lead to security
1462 issues because a request smuggling attack is possible. Thus, by default,
1463 HAProxy rejects HTTP/1.0 GET/HEAD/DELETE requests with a payload.
1464
1465 However, it may be an issue with some old clients. In this case, this global
1466 option may be set.
1467
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02001468h1-case-adjust <from> <to>
1469 Defines the case adjustment to apply, when enabled, to the header name
1470 <from>, to change it to <to> before sending it to HTTP/1 clients or
1471 servers. <from> must be in lower case, and <from> and <to> must not differ
1472 except for their case. It may be repeated if several header names need to be
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05001473 adjusted. Duplicate entries are not allowed. If a lot of header names have to
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02001474 be adjusted, it might be more convenient to use "h1-case-adjust-file".
1475 Please note that no transformation will be applied unless "option
1476 h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" or "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server" is
1477 specified in a proxy.
1478
1479 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
1480 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
1481 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
1482 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
1483 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
1484 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
1485 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
1486
1487 Applications which fail to properly process requests or responses may require
1488 to temporarily use such workarounds to adjust header names sent to them for
1489 the time it takes the application to be fixed. Please note that an
1490 application which requires such workarounds might be vulnerable to content
1491 smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
1492
1493 Example:
1494 global
1495 h1-case-adjust content-length Content-Length
1496
1497 See "h1-case-adjust-file", "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" and
1498 "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server".
1499
1500h1-case-adjust-file <hdrs-file>
1501 Defines a file containing a list of key/value pairs used to adjust the case
1502 of some header names before sending them to HTTP/1 clients or servers. The
1503 file <hdrs-file> must contain 2 header names per line. The first one must be
1504 in lower case and both must not differ except for their case. Lines which
1505 start with '#' are ignored, just like empty lines. Leading and trailing tabs
1506 and spaces are stripped. Duplicate entries are not allowed. Please note that
1507 no transformation will be applied unless "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client"
1508 or "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server" is specified in a proxy.
1509
1510 If this directive is repeated, only the last one will be processed. It is an
1511 alternative to the directive "h1-case-adjust" if a lot of header names need
1512 to be adjusted. Please read the risks associated with using this.
1513
1514 See "h1-case-adjust", "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" and
1515 "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server".
1516
William Lallemandde1803f2022-05-04 18:14:25 +02001517httpclient.ssl.ca-file <cafile>
1518 This option defines the ca-file which should be used to verify the server
1519 certificate. It takes the same parameters as the "ca-file" option on the
1520 server line.
1521
1522 By default and when this option is not used, the value is
1523 "@system-ca" which tries to load the CA of the system. If it fails the SSL
1524 will be disabled for the httpclient.
1525
1526 However, when this option is explicitly enabled it will trigger a
1527 configuration error if it fails.
1528
1529httpclient.ssl.verify [none|required]
1530 Works the same way as the verify option on server lines. If specified to 'none',
1531 servers certificates are not verified. Default option is "required".
1532
1533 By default and when this option is not used, the value is
1534 "required". If it fails the SSL will be disabled for the httpclient.
1535
1536 However, when this option is explicitly enabled it will trigger a
1537 configuration error if it fails.
1538
1539httpclient.resolvers.id <resolvers id>
1540 This option defines the resolvers section with which the httpclient will try
1541 to resolve.
1542
1543 Default option is the "default" resolvers ID. By default, if this option is
1544 not used, it will simply disable the resolving if the section is not found.
1545
1546 However, when this option is explicitly enabled it will trigger a
1547 configuration error if it fails to load.
1548
1549httpclient.resolvers.prefer <ipv4|ipv6>
1550 This option allows to chose which family of IP you want when resolving,
1551 which is convenient when IPv6 is not available on your network. Default
1552 option is "ipv6".
1553
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +01001554insecure-fork-wanted
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001555 By default HAProxy tries hard to prevent any thread and process creation
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +01001556 after it starts. Doing so is particularly important when using Lua files of
1557 uncertain origin, and when experimenting with development versions which may
1558 still contain bugs whose exploitability is uncertain. And generally speaking
1559 it's good hygiene to make sure that no unexpected background activity can be
1560 triggered by traffic. But this prevents external checks from working, and may
1561 break some very specific Lua scripts which actively rely on the ability to
1562 fork. This option is there to disable this protection. Note that it is a bad
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001563 idea to disable it, as a vulnerability in a library or within HAProxy itself
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +01001564 will be easier to exploit once disabled. In addition, forking from Lua or
1565 anywhere else is not reliable as the forked process may randomly embed a lock
1566 set by another thread and never manage to finish an operation. As such it is
1567 highly recommended that this option is never used and that any workload
1568 requiring such a fork be reconsidered and moved to a safer solution (such as
1569 agents instead of external checks). This option supports the "no" prefix to
1570 disable it.
1571
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +01001572insecure-setuid-wanted
1573 HAProxy doesn't need to call executables at run time (except when using
1574 external checks which are strongly recommended against), and is even expected
1575 to isolate itself into an empty chroot. As such, there basically is no valid
1576 reason to allow a setuid executable to be called without the user being fully
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001577 aware of the risks. In a situation where HAProxy would need to call external
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +01001578 checks and/or disable chroot, exploiting a vulnerability in a library or in
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001579 HAProxy itself could lead to the execution of an external program. On Linux
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +01001580 it is possible to lock the process so that any setuid bit present on such an
1581 executable is ignored. This significantly reduces the risk of privilege
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001582 escalation in such a situation. This is what HAProxy does by default. In case
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +01001583 this causes a problem to an external check (for example one which would need
1584 the "ping" command), then it is possible to disable this protection by
1585 explicitly adding this directive in the global section. If enabled, it is
1586 possible to turn it back off by prefixing it with the "no" keyword.
1587
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +01001588issuers-chain-path <dir>
1589 Assigns a directory to load certificate chain for issuer completion. All
1590 files must be in PEM format. For certificates loaded with "crt" or "crt-list",
1591 if certificate chain is not included in PEM (also commonly known as
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001592 intermediate certificate), HAProxy will complete chain if the issuer of the
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +01001593 certificate corresponds to the first certificate of the chain loaded with
1594 "issuers-chain-path".
1595 A "crt" file with PrivateKey+Certificate+IntermediateCA2+IntermediateCA1
1596 could be replaced with PrivateKey+Certificate. HAProxy will complete the
1597 chain if a file with IntermediateCA2+IntermediateCA1 is present in
1598 "issuers-chain-path" directory. All other certificates with the same issuer
1599 will share the chain in memory.
1600
Amaury Denoyellebefeae82021-07-09 17:14:30 +02001601h2-workaround-bogus-websocket-clients
1602 This disables the announcement of the support for h2 websockets to clients.
1603 This can be use to overcome clients which have issues when implementing the
1604 relatively fresh RFC8441, such as Firefox 88. To allow clients to
1605 automatically downgrade to http/1.1 for the websocket tunnel, specify h2
1606 support on the bind line using "alpn" without an explicit "proto" keyword. If
1607 this statement was previously activated, this can be disabled by prefixing
1608 the keyword with "no'.
1609
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +02001610localpeer <name>
1611 Sets the local instance's peer name. It will be ignored if the "-L"
1612 command line argument is specified or if used after "peers" section
1613 definitions. In such cases, a warning message will be emitted during
1614 the configuration parsing.
1615
1616 This option will also set the HAPROXY_LOCALPEER environment variable.
1617 See also "-L" in the management guide and "peers" section below.
1618
Jan Wagner3e678602020-12-17 22:22:32 +01001619log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<sample_size>]
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02001620 <facility> [max level [min level]]
Cyril Bonté3e954872018-03-20 23:30:27 +01001621 Adds a global syslog server. Several global servers can be defined. They
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001622 will receive logs for starts and exits, as well as all logs from proxies
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001623 configured with "log global".
1624
1625 <address> can be one of:
1626
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01001627 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon and a UDP port. If
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001628 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
1629 port).
1630
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01001631 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon and optionally a UDP port. If
1632 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
1633 port).
1634
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01001635 - A filesystem path to a datagram UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001636 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible inside
1637 the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is appropriately
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001638 writable).
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001639
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01001640 - A file descriptor number in the form "fd@<number>", which may point
1641 to a pipe, terminal, or socket. In this case unbuffered logs are used
1642 and one writev() call per log is performed. This is a bit expensive
1643 but acceptable for most workloads. Messages sent this way will not be
1644 truncated but may be dropped, in which case the DroppedLogs counter
1645 will be incremented. The writev() call is atomic even on pipes for
1646 messages up to PIPE_BUF size, which POSIX recommends to be at least
1647 512 and which is 4096 bytes on most modern operating systems. Any
1648 larger message may be interleaved with messages from other processes.
1649 Exceptionally for debugging purposes the file descriptor may also be
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001650 directed to a file, but doing so will significantly slow HAProxy down
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01001651 as non-blocking calls will be ignored. Also there will be no way to
1652 purge nor rotate this file without restarting the process. Note that
1653 the configured syslog format is preserved, so the output is suitable
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01001654 for use with a TCP syslog server. See also the "short" and "raw"
1655 format below.
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01001656
1657 - "stdout" / "stderr", which are respectively aliases for "fd@1" and
1658 "fd@2", see above.
1659
Willy Tarreauc046d162019-08-30 15:24:59 +02001660 - A ring buffer in the form "ring@<name>", which will correspond to an
1661 in-memory ring buffer accessible over the CLI using the "show events"
1662 command, which will also list existing rings and their sizes. Such
1663 buffers are lost on reload or restart but when used as a complement
1664 this can help troubleshooting by having the logs instantly available.
1665
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02001666 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
1667 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01001668
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02001669 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this value
1670 will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that syslog
1671 servers act differently on log line length. All servers support the
1672 default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop larger lines
1673 while others do log them. If a server supports long lines, it may
1674 make sense to set this value here in order to avoid truncating long
1675 lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines, it is preferable to
1676 truncate them before sending them. Accepted values are 80 to 65535
1677 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is generally fine for all
1678 standard usages. Some specific cases of long captures or
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001679 JSON-formatted logs may require larger values. You may also need to
1680 increase "tune.http.logurilen" if your request URIs are truncated.
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02001681
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02001682 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
1683 one of the following :
1684
Emeric Brun0237c4e2020-11-27 16:24:34 +01001685 local Analog to rfc3164 syslog message format except that hostname
1686 field is stripped. This is the default.
1687 Note: option "log-send-hostname" switches the default to
1688 rfc3164.
1689
1690 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format.
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02001691 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
1692
1693 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
1694 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
1695
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02001696 priority A message containing only a level plus syslog facility between
1697 angle brackets such as '<63>', followed by the text. The PID,
1698 date, time, process name and system name are omitted. This is
1699 designed to be used with a local log server.
1700
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01001701 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
1702 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
1703 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
1704 local log server. This format is compatible with what the systemd
1705 logger consumes.
1706
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02001707 timed A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
1708 '<3>', followed by ISO date and by the text. The PID, process
1709 name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
1710 used with a local log server.
1711
1712 iso A message containing only the ISO date, followed by the text.
1713 The PID, process name and system name are omitted. This is
1714 designed to be used with a local log server.
1715
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01001716 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
1717 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
1718 used in containers or during development, where the severity only
1719 depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr).
1720
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02001721 <ranges> A list of comma-separated ranges to identify the logs to sample.
1722 This is used to balance the load of the logs to send to the log
1723 server. The limits of the ranges cannot be null. They are numbered
1724 from 1. The size or period (in number of logs) of the sample must be
1725 set with <sample_size> parameter.
1726
1727 <sample_size>
1728 The size of the sample in number of logs to consider when balancing
1729 their logging loads. It is used to balance the load of the logs to
1730 send to the syslog server. This size must be greater or equal to the
1731 maximum of the high limits of the ranges.
1732 (see also <ranges> parameter).
1733
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001734 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001735
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01001736 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
1737 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
1738 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
1739
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01001740 Note that the facility is ignored for the "short" and "raw"
1741 formats, but still required as a positional field. It is
1742 recommended to use "daemon" in this case to make it clear that
1743 it's only supposed to be used locally.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001744
1745 An optional level can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By default,
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02001746 all messages are sent. If a maximum level is specified, only messages with a
1747 severity at least as important as this level will be sent. An optional minimum
1748 level can be specified. If it is set, logs emitted with a more severe level
1749 than this one will be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending
1750 "emerg" messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
1751 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001752
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001753 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001754
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +01001755log-send-hostname [<string>]
1756 Sets the hostname field in the syslog header. If optional "string" parameter
1757 is set the header is set to the string contents, otherwise uses the hostname
1758 of the system. Generally used if one is not relaying logs through an
1759 intermediate syslog server or for simply customizing the hostname printed in
1760 the logs.
1761
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +00001762log-tag <string>
1763 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
1764 program name as launched from the command line, which usually is "haproxy".
1765 Sometimes it can be useful to differentiate between multiple processes
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01001766 running on the same host. See also the per-proxy "log-tag" directive.
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +00001767
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001768lua-load <file>
Thierry Fournier59f11be2020-11-29 00:37:41 +01001769 This global directive loads and executes a Lua file in the shared context
1770 that is visible to all threads. Any variable set in such a context is visible
1771 from any thread. This is the easiest and recommended way to load Lua programs
1772 but it will not scale well if a lot of Lua calls are performed, as only one
1773 thread may be running on the global state at a time. A program loaded this
1774 way will always see 0 in the "core.thread" variable. This directive can be
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001775 used multiple times.
1776
Thierry Fournier59f11be2020-11-29 00:37:41 +01001777lua-load-per-thread <file>
1778 This global directive loads and executes a Lua file into each started thread.
1779 Any global variable has a thread-local visibility so that each thread could
1780 see a different value. As such it is strongly recommended not to use global
1781 variables in programs loaded this way. An independent copy is loaded and
1782 initialized for each thread, everything is done sequentially and in the
1783 thread's numeric order from 1 to nbthread. If some operations need to be
1784 performed only once, the program should check the "core.thread" variable to
1785 figure what thread is being initialized. Programs loaded this way will run
1786 concurrently on all threads and will be highly scalable. This is the
1787 recommended way to load simple functions that register sample-fetches,
1788 converters, actions or services once it is certain the program doesn't depend
1789 on global variables. For the sake of simplicity, the directive is available
1790 even if only one thread is used and even if threads are disabled (in which
1791 case it will be equivalent to lua-load). This directive can be used multiple
1792 times.
1793
Tim Duesterhusdd74b5f2020-01-12 13:55:40 +01001794lua-prepend-path <string> [<type>]
1795 Prepends the given string followed by a semicolon to Lua's package.<type>
1796 variable.
1797 <type> must either be "path" or "cpath". If <type> is not given it defaults
1798 to "path".
1799
1800 Lua's paths are semicolon delimited lists of patterns that specify how the
1801 `require` function attempts to find the source file of a library. Question
1802 marks (?) within a pattern will be replaced by module name. The path is
1803 evaluated left to right. This implies that paths that are prepended later
1804 will be checked earlier.
1805
1806 As an example by specifying the following path:
1807
1808 lua-prepend-path /usr/share/haproxy-lua/?/init.lua
1809 lua-prepend-path /usr/share/haproxy-lua/?.lua
1810
1811 When `require "example"` is being called Lua will first attempt to load the
1812 /usr/share/haproxy-lua/example.lua script, if that does not exist the
1813 /usr/share/haproxy-lua/example/init.lua will be attempted and the default
1814 paths if that does not exist either.
1815
1816 See https://www.lua.org/pil/8.1.html for the details within the Lua
1817 documentation.
1818
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001819master-worker [no-exit-on-failure]
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001820 Master-worker mode. It is equivalent to the command line "-W" argument.
1821 This mode will launch a "master" which will monitor the "workers". Using
1822 this mode, you can reload HAProxy directly by sending a SIGUSR2 signal to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001823 the master. The master-worker mode is compatible either with the foreground
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +02001824 or daemon mode.
1825
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001826 By default, if a worker exits with a bad return code, in the case of a
1827 segfault for example, all workers will be killed, and the master will leave.
1828 It is convenient to combine this behavior with Restart=on-failure in a
1829 systemd unit file in order to relaunch the whole process. If you don't want
1830 this behavior, you must use the keyword "no-exit-on-failure".
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001831
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001832 See also "-W" in the management guide.
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001833
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +02001834mworker-max-reloads <number>
1835 In master-worker mode, this option limits the number of time a worker can
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001836 survive to a reload. If the worker did not leave after a reload, once its
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +02001837 number of reloads is greater than this number, the worker will receive a
1838 SIGTERM. This option helps to keep under control the number of workers.
1839 See also "show proc" in the Management Guide.
1840
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +02001841nbthread <number>
1842 This setting is only available when support for threads was built in. It
Willy Tarreaub63dbb72021-06-11 16:50:29 +02001843 makes HAProxy run on <number> threads. "nbthread" also works when HAProxy is
1844 started in foreground. On some platforms supporting CPU affinity, the default
1845 "nbthread" value is automatically set to the number of CPUs the process is
1846 bound to upon startup. This means that the thread count can easily be
1847 adjusted from the calling process using commands like "taskset" or "cpuset".
1848 Otherwise, this value defaults to 1. The default value is reported in the
1849 output of "haproxy -vv".
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +02001850
Amaury Denoyelle0f50cb92021-03-26 18:50:33 +01001851numa-cpu-mapping
Amaury Denoyelleb09f4472021-12-15 09:48:39 +01001852 If running on a NUMA-aware platform, HAProxy inspects on startup the CPU
1853 topology of the machine. If a multi-socket machine is detected, the affinity
1854 is automatically calculated to run on the CPUs of a single node. This is done
1855 in order to not suffer from the performance penalties caused by the
1856 inter-socket bus latency. However, if the applied binding is non optimal on a
1857 particular architecture, it can be disabled with the statement 'no
1858 numa-cpu-mapping'. This automatic binding is also not applied if a nbthread
1859 statement is present in the configuration, or the affinity of the process is
1860 already specified, for example via the 'cpu-map' directive or the taskset
1861 utility.
Amaury Denoyelle0f50cb92021-03-26 18:50:33 +01001862
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001863pidfile <pidfile>
MIZUTA Takeshic32f3942020-08-26 13:46:19 +09001864 Writes PIDs of all daemons into file <pidfile> when daemon mode or writes PID
1865 of master process into file <pidfile> when master-worker mode. This option is
1866 equivalent to the "-p" command line argument. The file must be accessible to
1867 the user starting the process. See also "daemon" and "master-worker".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001868
Willy Tarreau119e50e2020-05-22 13:53:29 +02001869pp2-never-send-local
1870 A bug in the PROXY protocol v2 implementation was present in HAProxy up to
1871 version 2.1, causing it to emit a PROXY command instead of a LOCAL command
1872 for health checks. This is particularly minor but confuses some servers'
1873 logs. Sadly, the bug was discovered very late and revealed that some servers
1874 which possibly only tested their PROXY protocol implementation against
1875 HAProxy fail to properly handle the LOCAL command, and permanently remain in
1876 the "down" state when HAProxy checks them. When this happens, it is possible
1877 to enable this global option to revert to the older (bogus) behavior for the
1878 time it takes to contact the affected components' vendors and get them fixed.
1879 This option is disabled by default and acts on all servers having the
1880 "send-proxy-v2" statement.
1881
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001882presetenv <name> <value>
1883 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
1884 is NOT overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line
1885 in the configuration file sees the new value. See also "setenv", "resetenv",
1886 and "unsetenv".
1887
1888resetenv [<name> ...]
1889 Removes all environment variables except the ones specified in argument. It
1890 allows to use a clean controlled environment before setting new values with
1891 setenv or unsetenv. Please note that some internal functions may make use of
1892 some environment variables, such as time manipulation functions, but also
1893 OpenSSL or even external checks. This must be used with extreme care and only
1894 after complete validation. The changes immediately take effect so that the
1895 next line in the configuration file sees the new environment. See also
1896 "setenv", "presetenv", and "unsetenv".
1897
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01001898stats bind-process [ all | odd | even | <process_num>[-[process_num>]] ] ...
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +02001899 Deprecated. Before threads were supported, this was used to force some stats
1900 instances on certain processes only. The default and only accepted value is
1901 "1" (along with "all" and "odd" which alias it). Do not use this setting.
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +02001902
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02001903server-state-base <directory>
1904 Specifies the directory prefix to be prepended in front of all servers state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001905 file names which do not start with a '/'. See also "server-state-file",
1906 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name".
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +02001907
1908server-state-file <file>
1909 Specifies the path to the file containing state of servers. If the path starts
1910 with a slash ('/'), it is considered absolute, otherwise it is considered
1911 relative to the directory specified using "server-state-base" (if set) or to
1912 the current directory. Before reloading HAProxy, it is possible to save the
1913 servers' current state using the stats command "show servers state". The
1914 output of this command must be written in the file pointed by <file>. When
1915 starting up, before handling traffic, HAProxy will read, load and apply state
1916 for each server found in the file and available in its current running
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001917 configuration. See also "server-state-base" and "show servers state",
1918 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name"
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02001919
Willy Tarreau13d2ba22021-03-26 11:38:08 +01001920set-var <var-name> <expr>
1921 Sets the process-wide variable '<var-name>' to the result of the evaluation
1922 of the sample expression <expr>. The variable '<var-name>' may only be a
1923 process-wide variable (using the 'proc.' prefix). It works exactly like the
1924 'set-var' action in TCP or HTTP rules except that the expression is evaluated
1925 at configuration parsing time and that the variable is instantly set. The
1926 sample fetch functions and converters permitted in the expression are only
Willy Tarreau753d4db2021-09-03 09:02:47 +02001927 those using internal data, typically 'int(value)' or 'str(value)'. It is
Willy Tarreau13d2ba22021-03-26 11:38:08 +01001928 possible to reference previously allocated variables as well. These variables
1929 will then be readable (and modifiable) from the regular rule sets.
1930
1931 Example:
1932 global
1933 set-var proc.current_state str(primary)
1934 set-var proc.prio int(100)
1935 set-var proc.threshold int(200),sub(proc.prio)
1936
Willy Tarreau753d4db2021-09-03 09:02:47 +02001937set-var-fmt <var-name> <fmt>
1938 Sets the process-wide variable '<var-name>' to the string resulting from the
1939 evaluation of the log-format <fmt>. The variable '<var-name>' may only be a
1940 process-wide variable (using the 'proc.' prefix). It works exactly like the
1941 'set-var-fmt' action in TCP or HTTP rules except that the expression is
1942 evaluated at configuration parsing time and that the variable is instantly
1943 set. The sample fetch functions and converters permitted in the expression
1944 are only those using internal data, typically 'int(value)' or 'str(value)'.
1945 It is possible to reference previously allocated variables as well. These
1946 variables will then be readable (and modifiable) from the regular rule sets.
1947 Please see section 8.2.4 for details on the log-format syntax.
1948
1949 Example:
1950 global
1951 set-var-fmt proc.current_state "primary"
1952 set-var-fmt proc.bootid "%pid|%t"
1953
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001954setenv <name> <value>
1955 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
1956 is overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line in
1957 the configuration file sees the new value. See also "presetenv", "resetenv",
1958 and "unsetenv".
1959
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +02001960set-dumpable
1961 This option is better left disabled by default and enabled only upon a
William Dauchyec730982019-10-27 20:08:10 +01001962 developer's request. If it has been enabled, it may still be forcibly
1963 disabled by prefixing it with the "no" keyword. It has no impact on
1964 performance nor stability but will try hard to re-enable core dumps that were
1965 possibly disabled by file size limitations (ulimit -f), core size limitations
1966 (ulimit -c), or "dumpability" of a process after changing its UID/GID (such
1967 as /proc/sys/fs/suid_dumpable on Linux). Core dumps might still be limited by
1968 the current directory's permissions (check what directory the file is started
1969 from), the chroot directory's permission (it may be needed to temporarily
1970 disable the chroot directive or to move it to a dedicated writable location),
1971 or any other system-specific constraint. For example, some Linux flavours are
1972 notorious for replacing the default core file with a path to an executable
1973 not even installed on the system (check /proc/sys/kernel/core_pattern). Often,
1974 simply writing "core", "core.%p" or "/var/log/core/core.%p" addresses the
1975 issue. When trying to enable this option waiting for a rare issue to
1976 re-appear, it's often a good idea to first try to obtain such a dump by
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001977 issuing, for example, "kill -11" to the "haproxy" process and verify that it
William Dauchyec730982019-10-27 20:08:10 +01001978 leaves a core where expected when dying.
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +02001979
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001980ssl-default-bind-ciphers <ciphers>
1981 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1982 the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite")
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +00001983 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2 for all
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001984 "bind" lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of the string
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001985 is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
1986 information and recommendations see e.g.
1987 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
1988 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
1989 cipher configuration, please check the "ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites" keyword.
1990 Please check the "bind" keyword for more information.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001991
1992ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
1993 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
1994 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the default string
1995 describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are negotiated
1996 during the TLSv1.3 handshake for all "bind" lines which do not explicitly define
1997 theirs. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001998 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the section "ciphersuites". For
1999 cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the
2000 "ssl-default-bind-ciphers" keyword. Please check the "bind" keyword for more
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02002001 information.
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01002002
Jerome Magninb203ff62020-04-03 15:28:22 +02002003ssl-default-bind-curves <curves>
2004 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
2005 the default string describing the list of elliptic curves algorithms ("curve
2006 suite") that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with ECDHE. The format
2007 of the string is a colon-delimited list of curve name.
2008 Please check the "bind" keyword for more information.
2009
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01002010ssl-default-bind-options [<option>]...
2011 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
2012 default ssl-options to force on all "bind" lines. Please check the "bind"
2013 keyword to see available options.
2014
2015 Example:
2016 global
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +02002017 ssl-default-bind-options ssl-min-ver TLSv1.0 no-tls-tickets
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01002018
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01002019ssl-default-server-ciphers <ciphers>
2020 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
2021 sets the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +00002022 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2 with the server,
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02002023 for all "server" lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00002024 the string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
2025 information and recommendations see e.g.
2026 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
2027 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/).
2028 For TLSv1.3 cipher configuration, please check the
2029 "ssl-default-server-ciphersuites" keyword. Please check the "server" keyword
2030 for more information.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02002031
2032ssl-default-server-ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
2033 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
2034 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the default
2035 string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are negotiated during
2036 the TLSv1.3 handshake with the server, for all "server" lines which do not
2037 explicitly define theirs. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00002038 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the section "ciphersuites". For
2039 cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the
2040 "ssl-default-server-ciphers" keyword. Please check the "server" keyword for
2041 more information.
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01002042
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01002043ssl-default-server-options [<option>]...
2044 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
2045 default ssl-options to force on all "server" lines. Please check the "server"
2046 keyword to see available options.
2047
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02002048ssl-dh-param-file <file>
2049 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
2050 the default DH parameters that are used during the SSL/TLS handshake when
2051 ephemeral Diffie-Hellman (DHE) key exchange is used, for all "bind" lines
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002052 which do not explicitly define theirs. It will be overridden by custom DH
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02002053 parameters found in a bind certificate file if any. If custom DH parameters
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02002054 are not specified either by using ssl-dh-param-file or by setting them
Remi Tricot-Le Breton1d6338e2022-04-12 11:31:55 +02002055 directly in the certificate file, DHE ciphers will not be used, unless
2056 tune.ssl.default-dh-param is set. In this latter case, pre-defined DH
2057 parameters of the specified size will be used. Custom parameters are known to
2058 be more secure and therefore their use is recommended.
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02002059 Custom DH parameters may be generated by using the OpenSSL command
2060 "openssl dhparam <size>", where size should be at least 2048, as 1024-bit DH
2061 parameters should not be considered secure anymore.
2062
William Lallemand8e8581e2020-10-20 17:36:46 +02002063ssl-load-extra-del-ext
2064 This setting allows to configure the way HAProxy does the lookup for the
2065 extra SSL files. By default HAProxy adds a new extension to the filename.
William Lallemand089c1382020-10-23 17:35:12 +02002066 (ex: with "foobar.crt" load "foobar.crt.key"). With this option enabled,
William Lallemand8e8581e2020-10-20 17:36:46 +02002067 HAProxy removes the extension before adding the new one (ex: with
William Lallemand089c1382020-10-23 17:35:12 +02002068 "foobar.crt" load "foobar.key").
2069
2070 Your crt file must have a ".crt" extension for this option to work.
William Lallemand8e8581e2020-10-20 17:36:46 +02002071
2072 This option is not compatible with bundle extensions (.ecdsa, .rsa. .dsa)
2073 and won't try to remove them.
2074
2075 This option is disabled by default. See also "ssl-load-extra-files".
2076
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +01002077ssl-load-extra-files <none|all|bundle|sctl|ocsp|issuer|key>*
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01002078 This setting alters the way HAProxy will look for unspecified files during
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +02002079 the loading of the SSL certificates. This option applies to certificates
2080 associated to "bind" lines as well as "server" lines but some of the extra
2081 files will not have any functional impact for "server" line certificates.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01002082
2083 By default, HAProxy discovers automatically a lot of files not specified in
2084 the configuration, and you may want to disable this behavior if you want to
2085 optimize the startup time.
2086
2087 "none": Only load the files specified in the configuration. Don't try to load
2088 a certificate bundle if the file does not exist. In the case of a directory,
2089 it won't try to bundle the certificates if they have the same basename.
2090
2091 "all": This is the default behavior, it will try to load everything,
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +01002092 bundles, sctl, ocsp, issuer, key.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01002093
2094 "bundle": When a file specified in the configuration does not exist, HAProxy
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +02002095 will try to load a "cert bundle". Certificate bundles are only managed on the
2096 frontend side and will not work for backend certificates.
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +02002097
2098 Starting from HAProxy 2.3, the bundles are not loaded in the same OpenSSL
2099 certificate store, instead it will loads each certificate in a separate
2100 store which is equivalent to declaring multiple "crt". OpenSSL 1.1.1 is
2101 required to achieve this. Which means that bundles are now used only for
2102 backward compatibility and are not mandatory anymore to do an hybrid RSA/ECC
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +02002103 bind configuration.
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +02002104
2105 To associate these PEM files into a "cert bundle" that is recognized by
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002106 HAProxy, they must be named in the following way: All PEM files that are to
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +02002107 be bundled must have the same base name, with a suffix indicating the key
2108 type. Currently, three suffixes are supported: rsa, dsa and ecdsa. For
2109 example, if www.example.com has two PEM files, an RSA file and an ECDSA
2110 file, they must be named: "example.pem.rsa" and "example.pem.ecdsa". The
2111 first part of the filename is arbitrary; only the suffix matters. To load
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002112 this bundle into HAProxy, specify the base name only:
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +02002113
2114 Example : bind :8443 ssl crt example.pem
2115
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002116 Note that the suffix is not given to HAProxy; this tells HAProxy to look for
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +02002117 a cert bundle.
2118
2119 HAProxy will load all PEM files in the bundle as if they were configured
2120 separately in several "crt".
2121
2122 The bundle loading does not have an impact anymore on the directory loading
2123 since files are loading separately.
2124
2125 On the CLI, bundles are seen as separate files, and the bundle extension is
2126 required to commit them.
2127
William Dauchy57dd6f12020-10-06 15:22:37 +02002128 OCSP files (.ocsp), issuer files (.issuer), Certificate Transparency (.sctl)
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +02002129 as well as private keys (.key) are supported with multi-cert bundling.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01002130
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +02002131 "sctl": Try to load "<basename>.sctl" for each crt keyword. If provided for
2132 a backend certificate, it will be loaded but will not have any functional
2133 impact.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01002134
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +02002135 "ocsp": Try to load "<basename>.ocsp" for each crt keyword. If provided for
2136 a backend certificate, it will be loaded but will not have any functional
2137 impact.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01002138
2139 "issuer": Try to load "<basename>.issuer" if the issuer of the OCSP file is
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +02002140 not provided in the PEM file. If provided for a backend certificate, it will
2141 be loaded but will not have any functional impact.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01002142
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +01002143 "key": If the private key was not provided by the PEM file, try to load a
2144 file "<basename>.key" containing a private key.
2145
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01002146 The default behavior is "all".
2147
2148 Example:
2149 ssl-load-extra-files bundle sctl
2150 ssl-load-extra-files sctl ocsp issuer
2151 ssl-load-extra-files none
2152
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +02002153 See also: "crt", section 5.1 about bind options and section 5.2 about server
2154 options.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01002155
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +01002156ssl-server-verify [none|required]
2157 The default behavior for SSL verify on servers side. If specified to 'none',
2158 servers certificates are not verified. The default is 'required' except if
2159 forced using cmdline option '-dV'.
2160
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +02002161ssl-skip-self-issued-ca
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04002162 Self issued CA, aka x509 root CA, is the anchor for chain validation: as a
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +02002163 server is useless to send it, client must have it. Standard configuration
2164 need to not include such CA in PEM file. This option allows you to keep such
2165 CA in PEM file without sending it to the client. Use case is to provide
2166 issuer for ocsp without the need for '.issuer' file and be able to share it
2167 with 'issuers-chain-path'. This concerns all certificates without intermediate
2168 certificates. It's useless for BoringSSL, .issuer is ignored because ocsp
William Lallemand9a1d8392020-08-10 17:28:23 +02002169 bits does not need it. Requires at least OpenSSL 1.0.2.
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +02002170
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02002171stats socket [<address:port>|<path>] [param*]
2172 Binds a UNIX socket to <path> or a TCPv4/v6 address to <address:port>.
2173 Connections to this socket will return various statistics outputs and even
2174 allow some commands to be issued to change some runtime settings. Please
Willy Tarreau1af20c72017-06-23 16:01:14 +02002175 consult section 9.3 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide for more
Kevin Decherf949c7202015-10-13 23:26:44 +02002176 details.
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +02002177
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02002178 All parameters supported by "bind" lines are supported, for instance to
2179 restrict access to some users or their access rights. Please consult
2180 section 5.1 for more information.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02002181
2182stats timeout <timeout, in milliseconds>
2183 The default timeout on the stats socket is set to 10 seconds. It is possible
2184 to change this value with "stats timeout". The value must be passed in
Willy Tarreaubefdff12007-12-02 22:27:38 +01002185 milliseconds, or be suffixed by a time unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02002186
2187stats maxconn <connections>
2188 By default, the stats socket is limited to 10 concurrent connections. It is
2189 possible to change this value with "stats maxconn".
2190
Willy Tarreaud04bc3a2021-09-27 13:55:10 +02002191thread-group <group> [<thread-range>...]
2192 This setting is only available when support for threads was built in. It
2193 enumerates the list of threads that will compose thread group <group>.
2194 Thread numbers and group numbers start at 1. Thread ranges are defined either
2195 using a single thread number at once, or by specifying the lower and upper
2196 bounds delimited by a dash '-' (e.g. "1-16"). Unassigned threads will be
2197 automatically assigned to unassigned thread groups, and thread groups
2198 defined with this directive will never receive more threads than those
2199 defined. Defining the same group multiple times overrides previous
2200 definitions with the new one. See also "nbthread" and "thread-groups".
2201
Willy Tarreauc33b9692021-09-22 12:07:23 +02002202thread-groups <number>
2203 This setting is only available when support for threads was built in. It
2204 makes HAProxy split its threads into <number> independent groups. At the
2205 moment, the limit is 1 and is also the default value. See also "nbthread".
2206
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002207uid <number>
Thayne McCombscdbcca92021-01-07 21:24:41 -07002208 Changes the process's user ID to <number>. It is recommended that the user ID
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002209 is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
2210 be started with superuser privileges in order to be able to switch to another
2211 one. See also "gid" and "user".
2212
2213ulimit-n <number>
2214 Sets the maximum number of per-process file-descriptors to <number>. By
2215 default, it is automatically computed, so it is recommended not to use this
Willy Tarreau2df1fbf2022-04-25 18:02:03 +02002216 option. If the intent is only to limit the number of file descriptors, better
2217 use "fd-hard-limit" instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002218
Amaury Denoyelle414a6122021-08-06 10:25:32 +02002219 Note that the dynamic servers are not taken into account in this automatic
2220 resource calculation. If using a large number of them, it may be needed to
2221 manually specify this value.
2222
Willy Tarreau2df1fbf2022-04-25 18:02:03 +02002223 See also: fd-hard-limit, maxconn
2224
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002225unix-bind [ prefix <prefix> ] [ mode <mode> ] [ user <user> ] [ uid <uid> ]
2226 [ group <group> ] [ gid <gid> ]
2227
2228 Fixes common settings to UNIX listening sockets declared in "bind" statements.
2229 This is mainly used to simplify declaration of those UNIX sockets and reduce
2230 the risk of errors, since those settings are most commonly required but are
2231 also process-specific. The <prefix> setting can be used to force all socket
2232 path to be relative to that directory. This might be needed to access another
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002233 component's chroot. Note that those paths are resolved before HAProxy chroots
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002234 itself, so they are absolute. The <mode>, <user>, <uid>, <group> and <gid>
2235 all have the same meaning as their homonyms used by the "bind" statement. If
2236 both are specified, the "bind" statement has priority, meaning that the
2237 "unix-bind" settings may be seen as process-wide default settings.
2238
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01002239unsetenv [<name> ...]
2240 Removes environment variables specified in arguments. This can be useful to
2241 hide some sensitive information that are occasionally inherited from the
2242 user's environment during some operations. Variables which did not exist are
2243 silently ignored so that after the operation, it is certain that none of
2244 these variables remain. The changes immediately take effect so that the next
2245 line in the configuration file will not see these variables. See also
2246 "setenv", "presetenv", and "resetenv".
2247
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002248user <user name>
2249 Similar to "uid" but uses the UID of user name <user name> from /etc/passwd.
2250 See also "uid" and "group".
2251
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02002252node <name>
2253 Only letters, digits, hyphen and underscore are allowed, like in DNS names.
2254
2255 This statement is useful in HA configurations where two or more processes or
2256 servers share the same IP address. By setting a different node-name on all
2257 nodes, it becomes easy to immediately spot what server is handling the
2258 traffic.
2259
2260description <text>
2261 Add a text that describes the instance.
2262
2263 Please note that it is required to escape certain characters (# for example)
2264 and this text is inserted into a html page so you should avoid using
2265 "<" and ">" characters.
2266
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100226751degrees-data-file <file path>
2268 The path of the 51Degrees data file to provide device detection services. The
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002269 file should be unzipped and accessible by HAProxy with relevant permissions.
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01002270
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002271 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01002272 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
2273
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +0000227451degrees-property-name-list [<string> ...]
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01002275 A list of 51Degrees property names to be load from the dataset. A full list
2276 of names is available on the 51Degrees website:
2277 https://51degrees.com/resources/property-dictionary
2278
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002279 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01002280 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
2281
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +0200228251degrees-property-separator <char>
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01002283 A char that will be appended to every property value in a response header
2284 containing 51Degrees results. If not set that will be set as ','.
2285
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002286 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02002287 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
2288
228951degrees-cache-size <number>
2290 Sets the size of the 51Degrees converter cache to <number> entries. This
2291 is an LRU cache which reminds previous device detections and their results.
2292 By default, this cache is disabled.
2293
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002294 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01002295 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
2296
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002297wurfl-data-file <file path>
2298 The path of the WURFL data file to provide device detection services. The
2299 file should be accessible by HAProxy with relevant permissions.
2300
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002301 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been compiled
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002302 with USE_WURFL=1.
2303
2304wurfl-information-list [<capability>]*
2305 A space-delimited list of WURFL capabilities, virtual capabilities, property
2306 names we plan to use in injected headers. A full list of capability and
2307 virtual capability names is available on the Scientiamobile website :
2308
2309 https://www.scientiamobile.com/wurflCapability
2310
2311 Valid WURFL properties are:
2312 - wurfl_id Contains the device ID of the matched device.
2313
2314 - wurfl_root_id Contains the device root ID of the matched
2315 device.
2316
2317 - wurfl_isdevroot Tells if the matched device is a root device.
2318 Possible values are "TRUE" or "FALSE".
2319
2320 - wurfl_useragent The original useragent coming with this
2321 particular web request.
2322
2323 - wurfl_api_version Contains a string representing the currently
2324 used Libwurfl API version.
2325
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002326 - wurfl_info A string containing information on the parsed
2327 wurfl.xml and its full path.
2328
2329 - wurfl_last_load_time Contains the UNIX timestamp of the last time
2330 WURFL has been loaded successfully.
2331
2332 - wurfl_normalized_useragent The normalized useragent.
2333
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002334 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been compiled
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002335 with USE_WURFL=1.
2336
2337wurfl-information-list-separator <char>
2338 A char that will be used to separate values in a response header containing
2339 WURFL results. If not set that a comma (',') will be used by default.
2340
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002341 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been compiled
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002342 with USE_WURFL=1.
2343
2344wurfl-patch-file [<file path>]
2345 A list of WURFL patch file paths. Note that patches are loaded during startup
2346 thus before the chroot.
2347
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002348 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been compiled
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002349 with USE_WURFL=1.
2350
paulborilebad132c2019-04-18 11:57:04 +02002351wurfl-cache-size <size>
2352 Sets the WURFL Useragent cache size. For faster lookups, already processed user
2353 agents are kept in a LRU cache :
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002354 - "0" : no cache is used.
paulborilebad132c2019-04-18 11:57:04 +02002355 - <size> : size of lru cache in elements.
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002356
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002357 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been compiled
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002358 with USE_WURFL=1.
2359
William Dauchy0fec3ab2019-10-27 20:08:11 +01002360strict-limits
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002361 Makes process fail at startup when a setrlimit fails. HAProxy tries to set the
William Dauchya5194602020-03-28 19:29:58 +01002362 best setrlimit according to what has been calculated. If it fails, it will
2363 emit a warning. This option is here to guarantee an explicit failure of
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002364 HAProxy when those limits fail. It is enabled by default. It may still be
William Dauchya5194602020-03-28 19:29:58 +01002365 forcibly disabled by prefixing it with the "no" keyword.
William Dauchy0fec3ab2019-10-27 20:08:11 +01002366
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020023673.2. Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002368-----------------------
2369
Willy Tarreaubeb859a2018-11-22 18:07:59 +01002370busy-polling
2371 In some situations, especially when dealing with low latency on processors
2372 supporting a variable frequency or when running inside virtual machines, each
2373 time the process waits for an I/O using the poller, the processor goes back
2374 to sleep or is offered to another VM for a long time, and it causes
2375 excessively high latencies. This option provides a solution preventing the
2376 processor from sleeping by always using a null timeout on the pollers. This
2377 results in a significant latency reduction (30 to 100 microseconds observed)
2378 at the expense of a risk to overheat the processor. It may even be used with
2379 threads, in which case improperly bound threads may heavily conflict,
2380 resulting in a worse performance and high values for the CPU stolen fields
2381 in "show info" output, indicating which threads are misconfigured. It is
2382 important not to let the process run on the same processor as the network
2383 interrupts when this option is used. It is also better to avoid using it on
2384 multiple CPU threads sharing the same core. This option is disabled by
2385 default. If it has been enabled, it may still be forcibly disabled by
2386 prefixing it with the "no" keyword. It is ignored by the "select" and
2387 "poll" pollers.
2388
William Dauchy3894d972019-12-28 15:36:02 +01002389 This option is automatically disabled on old processes in the context of
2390 seamless reload; it avoids too much cpu conflicts when multiple processes
2391 stay around for some time waiting for the end of their current connections.
2392
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +02002393max-spread-checks <delay in milliseconds>
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002394 By default, HAProxy tries to spread the start of health checks across the
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +02002395 smallest health check interval of all the servers in a farm. The principle is
2396 to avoid hammering services running on the same server. But when using large
2397 check intervals (10 seconds or more), the last servers in the farm take some
2398 time before starting to be tested, which can be a problem. This parameter is
2399 used to enforce an upper bound on delay between the first and the last check,
2400 even if the servers' check intervals are larger. When servers run with
2401 shorter intervals, their intervals will be respected though.
2402
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002403maxconn <number>
2404 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent connections to <number>. It
2405 is equivalent to the command-line argument "-n". Proxies will stop accepting
2406 connections when this limit is reached. The "ulimit-n" parameter is
Willy Tarreau8274e102014-06-19 15:31:25 +02002407 automatically adjusted according to this value. See also "ulimit-n". Note:
2408 the "select" poller cannot reliably use more than 1024 file descriptors on
2409 some platforms. If your platform only supports select and reports "select
2410 FAILED" on startup, you need to reduce maxconn until it works (slightly
Willy Tarreaub28f3442019-03-04 08:13:43 +01002411 below 500 in general). If this value is not set, it will automatically be
2412 calculated based on the current file descriptors limit reported by the
2413 "ulimit -n" command, possibly reduced to a lower value if a memory limit
2414 is enforced, based on the buffer size, memory allocated to compression, SSL
2415 cache size, and use or not of SSL and the associated maxsslconn (which can
Willy Tarreau2df1fbf2022-04-25 18:02:03 +02002416 also be automatic). In any case, the fd-hard-limit applies if set.
2417
2418 See also: fd-hard-limit, ulimit-n
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002419
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +02002420maxconnrate <number>
2421 Sets the maximum per-process number of connections per second to <number>.
2422 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
2423 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
2424 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
2425 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
2426 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
2427 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
2428 fairness.
2429
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01002430maxcomprate <number>
2431 Sets the maximum per-process input compression rate to <number> kilobytes
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002432 per second. For each session, if the maximum is reached, the compression
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01002433 level will be decreased during the session. If the maximum is reached at the
2434 beginning of a session, the session will not compress at all. If the maximum
2435 is not reached, the compression level will be increased up to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002436 tune.comp.maxlevel. A value of zero means there is no limit, this is the
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01002437 default value.
2438
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +01002439maxcompcpuusage <number>
2440 Sets the maximum CPU usage HAProxy can reach before stopping the compression
2441 for new requests or decreasing the compression level of current requests.
2442 It works like 'maxcomprate' but measures CPU usage instead of incoming data
Willy Tarreaub63dbb72021-06-11 16:50:29 +02002443 bandwidth. The value is expressed in percent of the CPU used by HAProxy. A
2444 value of 100 disable the limit. The default value is 100. Setting a lower
2445 value will prevent the compression work from slowing the whole process down
2446 and from introducing high latencies.
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +01002447
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01002448maxpipes <number>
2449 Sets the maximum per-process number of pipes to <number>. Currently, pipes
2450 are only used by kernel-based tcp splicing. Since a pipe contains two file
2451 descriptors, the "ulimit-n" value will be increased accordingly. The default
2452 value is maxconn/4, which seems to be more than enough for most heavy usages.
2453 The splice code dynamically allocates and releases pipes, and can fall back
2454 to standard copy, so setting this value too low may only impact performance.
2455
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +02002456maxsessrate <number>
2457 Sets the maximum per-process number of sessions per second to <number>.
2458 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
2459 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
2460 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
2461 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
2462 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
2463 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
2464 fairness.
2465
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02002466maxsslconn <number>
2467 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent SSL connections to
2468 <number>. By default there is no SSL-specific limit, which means that the
2469 global maxconn setting will apply to all connections. Setting this limit
2470 avoids having openssl use too much memory and crash when malloc returns NULL
2471 (since it unfortunately does not reliably check for such conditions). Note
2472 that the limit applies both to incoming and outgoing connections, so one
2473 connection which is deciphered then ciphered accounts for 2 SSL connections.
Willy Tarreaud0256482015-01-15 21:45:22 +01002474 If this value is not set, but a memory limit is enforced, this value will be
2475 automatically computed based on the memory limit, maxconn, the buffer size,
2476 memory allocated to compression, SSL cache size, and use of SSL in either
2477 frontends, backends or both. If neither maxconn nor maxsslconn are specified
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002478 when there is a memory limit, HAProxy will automatically adjust these values
Willy Tarreaud0256482015-01-15 21:45:22 +01002479 so that 100% of the connections can be made over SSL with no risk, and will
2480 consider the sides where it is enabled (frontend, backend, both).
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02002481
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +02002482maxsslrate <number>
2483 Sets the maximum per-process number of SSL sessions per second to <number>.
2484 SSL listeners will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It
2485 can be used to limit the global SSL CPU usage regardless of each frontend
2486 capacity. It is important to note that this can only be used as a service
2487 protection measure, as there will not necessarily be a fair share between
2488 frontends when the limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each
2489 frontend to some value close to its expected share. It is also important to
2490 note that the sessions are accounted before they enter the SSL stack and not
2491 after, which also protects the stack against bad handshakes. Also, lowering
2492 tune.maxaccept can improve fairness.
2493
William Lallemand9d5f5482012-11-07 16:12:57 +01002494maxzlibmem <number>
2495 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by the zlib.
2496 When the maximum amount is reached, future sessions will not compress as long
2497 as RAM is unavailable. When sets to 0, there is no limit.
William Lallemande3a7d992012-11-20 11:25:20 +01002498 The default value is 0. The value is available in bytes on the UNIX socket
2499 with "show info" on the line "MaxZlibMemUsage", the memory used by zlib is
2500 "ZlibMemUsage" in bytes.
2501
Willy Tarreauc4e56dc2022-03-08 10:41:40 +01002502no-memory-trimming
2503 Disables memory trimming ("malloc_trim") at a few moments where attempts are
2504 made to reclaim lots of memory (on memory shortage or on reload). Trimming
2505 memory forces the system's allocator to scan all unused areas and to release
2506 them. This is generally seen as nice action to leave more available memory to
2507 a new process while the old one is unlikely to make significant use of it.
2508 But some systems dealing with tens to hundreds of thousands of concurrent
2509 connections may experience a lot of memory fragmentation, that may render
2510 this release operation extremely long. During this time, no more traffic
2511 passes through the process, new connections are not accepted anymore, some
2512 health checks may even fail, and the watchdog may even trigger and kill the
2513 unresponsive process, leaving a huge core dump. If this ever happens, then it
2514 is suggested to use this option to disable trimming and stop trying to be
2515 nice with the new process. Note that advanced memory allocators usually do
2516 not suffer from such a problem.
2517
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002518noepoll
2519 Disables the use of the "epoll" event polling system on Linux. It is
2520 equivalent to the command-line argument "-de". The next polling system
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +01002521 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002522
2523nokqueue
2524 Disables the use of the "kqueue" event polling system on BSD. It is
2525 equivalent to the command-line argument "-dk". The next polling system
2526 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
2527
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +00002528noevports
2529 Disables the use of the event ports event polling system on SunOS systems
2530 derived from Solaris 10 and later. It is equivalent to the command-line
2531 argument "-dv". The next polling system used will generally be "poll". See
2532 also "nopoll".
2533
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002534nopoll
2535 Disables the use of the "poll" event polling system. It is equivalent to the
2536 command-line argument "-dp". The next polling system used will be "select".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002537 It should never be needed to disable "poll" since it's available on all
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +00002538 platforms supported by HAProxy. See also "nokqueue", "noepoll" and
2539 "noevports".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002540
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01002541nosplice
2542 Disables the use of kernel tcp splicing between sockets on Linux. It is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002543 equivalent to the command line argument "-dS". Data will then be copied
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01002544 using conventional and more portable recv/send calls. Kernel tcp splicing is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002545 limited to some very recent instances of kernel 2.6. Most versions between
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01002546 2.6.25 and 2.6.28 are buggy and will forward corrupted data, so they must not
2547 be used. This option makes it easier to globally disable kernel splicing in
2548 case of doubt. See also "option splice-auto", "option splice-request" and
2549 "option splice-response".
2550
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002551nogetaddrinfo
2552 Disables the use of getaddrinfo(3) for name resolving. It is equivalent to
2553 the command line argument "-dG". Deprecated gethostbyname(3) will be used.
2554
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +00002555noreuseport
2556 Disables the use of SO_REUSEPORT - see socket(7). It is equivalent to the
2557 command line argument "-dR".
2558
Willy Tarreauca3afc22021-05-05 18:33:19 +02002559profiling.memory { on | off }
2560 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') per-function memory profiling. This will
2561 keep usage statistics of malloc/calloc/realloc/free calls anywhere in the
2562 process (including libraries) which will be reported on the CLI using the
2563 "show profiling" command. This is essentially meant to be used when an
2564 abnormal memory usage is observed that cannot be explained by the pools and
2565 other info are required. The performance hit will typically be around 1%,
2566 maybe a bit more on highly threaded machines, so it is normally suitable for
2567 use in production. The same may be achieved at run time on the CLI using the
2568 "set profiling memory" command, please consult the management manual.
2569
Willy Tarreaud2d33482019-04-25 17:09:07 +02002570profiling.tasks { auto | on | off }
2571 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') per-task CPU profiling. When set to 'auto'
2572 the profiling automatically turns on a thread when it starts to suffer from
2573 an average latency of 1000 microseconds or higher as reported in the
2574 "avg_loop_us" activity field, and automatically turns off when the latency
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002575 returns below 990 microseconds (this value is an average over the last 1024
Willy Tarreaud2d33482019-04-25 17:09:07 +02002576 loops so it does not vary quickly and tends to significantly smooth short
2577 spikes). It may also spontaneously trigger from time to time on overloaded
2578 systems, containers, or virtual machines, or when the system swaps (which
2579 must absolutely never happen on a load balancer).
2580
2581 CPU profiling per task can be very convenient to report where the time is
2582 spent and which requests have what effect on which other request. Enabling
2583 it will typically affect the overall's performance by less than 1%, thus it
2584 is recommended to leave it to the default 'auto' value so that it only
2585 operates when a problem is identified. This feature requires a system
Willy Tarreau75c62c22018-11-22 11:02:09 +01002586 supporting the clock_gettime(2) syscall with clock identifiers
2587 CLOCK_MONOTONIC and CLOCK_THREAD_CPUTIME_ID, otherwise the reported time will
2588 be zero. This option may be changed at run time using "set profiling" on the
2589 CLI.
2590
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02002591spread-checks <0..50, in percent>
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09002592 Sometimes it is desirable to avoid sending agent and health checks to
2593 servers at exact intervals, for instance when many logical servers are
2594 located on the same physical server. With the help of this parameter, it
2595 becomes possible to add some randomness in the check interval between 0
2596 and +/- 50%. A value between 2 and 5 seems to show good results. The
2597 default value remains at 0.
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02002598
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002599ssl-engine <name> [algo <comma-separated list of algorithms>]
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00002600 Sets the OpenSSL engine to <name>. List of valid values for <name> may be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002601 obtained using the command "openssl engine". This statement may be used
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00002602 multiple times, it will simply enable multiple crypto engines. Referencing an
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002603 unsupported engine will prevent HAProxy from starting. Note that many engines
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00002604 will lead to lower HTTPS performance than pure software with recent
2605 processors. The optional command "algo" sets the default algorithms an ENGINE
2606 will supply using the OPENSSL function ENGINE_set_default_string(). A value
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002607 of "ALL" uses the engine for all cryptographic operations. If no list of
2608 algo is specified then the value of "ALL" is used. A comma-separated list
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00002609 of different algorithms may be specified, including: RSA, DSA, DH, EC, RAND,
2610 CIPHERS, DIGESTS, PKEY, PKEY_CRYPTO, PKEY_ASN1. This is the same format that
2611 openssl configuration file uses:
2612 https://www.openssl.org/docs/man1.0.2/apps/config.html
2613
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00002614ssl-mode-async
2615 Adds SSL_MODE_ASYNC mode to the SSL context. This enables asynchronous TLS
Emeric Brun3854e012017-05-17 20:42:48 +02002616 I/O operations if asynchronous capable SSL engines are used. The current
Emeric Brunb5e42a82017-06-06 12:35:14 +00002617 implementation supports a maximum of 32 engines. The Openssl ASYNC API
2618 doesn't support moving read/write buffers and is not compliant with
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002619 HAProxy's buffer management. So the asynchronous mode is disabled on
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002620 read/write operations (it is only enabled during initial and renegotiation
Emeric Brunb5e42a82017-06-06 12:35:14 +00002621 handshakes).
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00002622
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01002623tune.buffers.limit <number>
2624 Sets a hard limit on the number of buffers which may be allocated per process.
2625 The default value is zero which means unlimited. The minimum non-zero value
2626 will always be greater than "tune.buffers.reserve" and should ideally always
2627 be about twice as large. Forcing this value can be particularly useful to
2628 limit the amount of memory a process may take, while retaining a sane
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002629 behavior. When this limit is reached, sessions which need a buffer wait for
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01002630 another one to be released by another session. Since buffers are dynamically
2631 allocated and released, the waiting time is very short and not perceptible
2632 provided that limits remain reasonable. In fact sometimes reducing the limit
2633 may even increase performance by increasing the CPU cache's efficiency. Tests
2634 have shown good results on average HTTP traffic with a limit to 1/10 of the
2635 expected global maxconn setting, which also significantly reduces memory
2636 usage. The memory savings come from the fact that a number of connections
2637 will not allocate 2*tune.bufsize. It is best not to touch this value unless
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002638 advised to do so by an HAProxy core developer.
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01002639
Willy Tarreau1058ae72014-12-23 22:40:40 +01002640tune.buffers.reserve <number>
2641 Sets the number of buffers which are pre-allocated and reserved for use only
2642 during memory shortage conditions resulting in failed memory allocations. The
2643 minimum value is 2 and is also the default. There is no reason a user would
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002644 want to change this value, it's mostly aimed at HAProxy core developers.
Willy Tarreau1058ae72014-12-23 22:40:40 +01002645
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02002646tune.bufsize <number>
2647 Sets the buffer size to this size (in bytes). Lower values allow more
2648 sessions to coexist in the same amount of RAM, and higher values allow some
2649 applications with very large cookies to work. The default value is 16384 and
2650 can be changed at build time. It is strongly recommended not to change this
2651 from the default value, as very low values will break some services such as
2652 statistics, and values larger than default size will increase memory usage,
2653 possibly causing the system to run out of memory. At least the global maxconn
Willy Tarreau45a66cc2017-11-24 11:28:00 +01002654 parameter should be decreased by the same factor as this one is increased. In
2655 addition, use of HTTP/2 mandates that this value must be 16384 or more. If an
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002656 HTTP request is larger than (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite), HAProxy will
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +04002657 return HTTP 400 (Bad Request) error. Similarly if an HTTP response is larger
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002658 than this size, HAProxy will return HTTP 502 (Bad Gateway). Note that the
Willy Tarreauc77d3642018-12-12 06:19:42 +01002659 value set using this parameter will automatically be rounded up to the next
2660 multiple of 8 on 32-bit machines and 16 on 64-bit machines.
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02002661
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +01002662tune.comp.maxlevel <number>
2663 Sets the maximum compression level. The compression level affects CPU
2664 usage during compression. This value affects CPU usage during compression.
2665 Each session using compression initializes the compression algorithm with
2666 this value. The default value is 1.
2667
Willy Tarreauc299e1e2019-02-27 11:35:12 +01002668tune.fail-alloc
Willy Tarreauf4b79c42022-02-23 15:20:53 +01002669 If compiled with DEBUG_FAIL_ALLOC or started with "-dMfail", gives the
2670 percentage of chances an allocation attempt fails. Must be between 0 (no
2671 failure) and 100 (no success). This is useful to debug and make sure memory
2672 failures are handled gracefully.
Willy Tarreauc299e1e2019-02-27 11:35:12 +01002673
Willy Tarreaubc52bec2020-06-18 08:58:47 +02002674tune.fd.edge-triggered { on | off } [ EXPERIMENTAL ]
2675 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the edge-triggered polling mode for FDs
2676 that support it. This is currently only support with epoll. It may noticeably
2677 reduce the number of epoll_ctl() calls and slightly improve performance in
2678 certain scenarios. This is still experimental, it may result in frozen
2679 connections if bugs are still present, and is disabled by default.
2680
Willy Tarreaufe20e5b2017-07-27 11:42:14 +02002681tune.h2.header-table-size <number>
2682 Sets the HTTP/2 dynamic header table size. It defaults to 4096 bytes and
2683 cannot be larger than 65536 bytes. A larger value may help certain clients
2684 send more compact requests, depending on their capabilities. This amount of
2685 memory is consumed for each HTTP/2 connection. It is recommended not to
2686 change it.
2687
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02002688tune.h2.initial-window-size <number>
2689 Sets the HTTP/2 initial window size, which is the number of bytes the client
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002690 can upload before waiting for an acknowledgment from HAProxy. This setting
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002691 only affects payload contents (i.e. the body of POST requests), not headers.
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02002692 The default value is 65535, which roughly allows up to 5 Mbps of upload
2693 bandwidth per client over a network showing a 100 ms ping time, or 500 Mbps
2694 over a 1-ms local network. It can make sense to increase this value to allow
2695 faster uploads, or to reduce it to increase fairness when dealing with many
2696 clients. It doesn't affect resource usage.
2697
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +02002698tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams <number>
2699 Sets the HTTP/2 maximum number of concurrent streams per connection (ie the
2700 number of outstanding requests on a single connection). The default value is
2701 100. A larger one may slightly improve page load time for complex sites when
2702 visited over high latency networks, but increases the amount of resources a
2703 single client may allocate. A value of zero disables the limit so a single
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002704 client may create as many streams as allocatable by HAProxy. It is highly
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +02002705 recommended not to change this value.
2706
Willy Tarreaua24b35c2019-02-21 13:24:36 +01002707tune.h2.max-frame-size <number>
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002708 Sets the HTTP/2 maximum frame size that HAProxy announces it is willing to
Willy Tarreaua24b35c2019-02-21 13:24:36 +01002709 receive to its peers. The default value is the largest between 16384 and the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002710 buffer size (tune.bufsize). In any case, HAProxy will not announce support
Willy Tarreaua24b35c2019-02-21 13:24:36 +01002711 for frame sizes larger than buffers. The main purpose of this setting is to
2712 allow to limit the maximum frame size setting when using large buffers. Too
2713 large frame sizes might have performance impact or cause some peers to
2714 misbehave. It is highly recommended not to change this value.
2715
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01002716tune.http.cookielen <number>
2717 Sets the maximum length of captured cookies. This is the maximum value that
2718 the "capture cookie xxx len yyy" will be allowed to take, and any upper value
2719 will automatically be truncated to this one. It is important not to set too
2720 high a value because all cookie captures still allocate this size whatever
2721 their configured value (they share a same pool). This value is per request
2722 per response, so the memory allocated is twice this value per connection.
2723 When not specified, the limit is set to 63 characters. It is recommended not
2724 to change this value.
2725
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02002726tune.http.logurilen <number>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002727 Sets the maximum length of request URI in logs. This prevents truncating long
2728 request URIs with valuable query strings in log lines. This is not related
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02002729 to syslog limits. If you increase this limit, you may also increase the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002730 'log ... len yyy' parameter. Your syslog daemon may also need specific
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02002731 configuration directives too.
2732 The default value is 1024.
2733
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02002734tune.http.maxhdr <number>
2735 Sets the maximum number of headers in a request. When a request comes with a
2736 number of headers greater than this value (including the first line), it is
2737 rejected with a "400 Bad Request" status code. Similarly, too large responses
2738 are blocked with "502 Bad Gateway". The default value is 101, which is enough
2739 for all usages, considering that the widely deployed Apache server uses the
2740 same limit. It can be useful to push this limit further to temporarily allow
Christopher Faulet50174f32017-06-21 16:31:35 +02002741 a buggy application to work by the time it gets fixed. The accepted range is
2742 1..32767. Keep in mind that each new header consumes 32bits of memory for
2743 each session, so don't push this limit too high.
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02002744
Willy Tarreau76cc6992020-07-01 18:49:24 +02002745tune.idle-pool.shared { on | off }
2746 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') sharing of idle connection pools between
2747 threads for a same server. The default is to share them between threads in
2748 order to minimize the number of persistent connections to a server, and to
2749 optimize the connection reuse rate. But to help with debugging or when
2750 suspecting a bug in HAProxy around connection reuse, it can be convenient to
2751 forcefully disable this idle pool sharing between multiple threads, and force
Willy Tarreau0784db82021-02-19 11:45:22 +01002752 this option to "off". The default is on. It is strongly recommended against
2753 disabling this option without setting a conservative value on "pool-low-conn"
2754 for all servers relying on connection reuse to achieve a high performance
2755 level, otherwise connections might be closed very often as the thread count
2756 increases.
Willy Tarreau76cc6992020-07-01 18:49:24 +02002757
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01002758tune.idletimer <timeout>
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002759 Sets the duration after which HAProxy will consider that an empty buffer is
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01002760 probably associated with an idle stream. This is used to optimally adjust
2761 some packet sizes while forwarding large and small data alternatively. The
2762 decision to use splice() or to send large buffers in SSL is modulated by this
2763 parameter. The value is in milliseconds between 0 and 65535. A value of zero
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002764 means that HAProxy will not try to detect idle streams. The default is 1000,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002765 which seems to correctly detect end user pauses (e.g. read a page before
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002766 clicking). There should be no reason for changing this value. Please check
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01002767 tune.ssl.maxrecord below.
2768
Willy Tarreau7ac908b2019-02-27 12:02:18 +01002769tune.listener.multi-queue { on | off }
2770 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the listener's multi-queue accept which
2771 spreads the incoming traffic to all threads a "bind" line is allowed to run
2772 on instead of taking them for itself. This provides a smoother traffic
2773 distribution and scales much better, especially in environments where threads
2774 may be unevenly loaded due to external activity (network interrupts colliding
2775 with one thread for example). This option is enabled by default, but it may
2776 be forcefully disabled for troubleshooting or for situations where it is
2777 estimated that the operating system already provides a good enough
2778 distribution and connections are extremely short-lived.
2779
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002780tune.lua.forced-yield <number>
2781 This directive forces the Lua engine to execute a yield each <number> of
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01002782 instructions executed. This permits interrupting a long script and allows the
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002783 HAProxy scheduler to process other tasks like accepting connections or
2784 forwarding traffic. The default value is 10000 instructions. If HAProxy often
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002785 executes some Lua code but more responsiveness is required, this value can be
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002786 lowered. If the Lua code is quite long and its result is absolutely required
2787 to process the data, the <number> can be increased.
2788
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +01002789tune.lua.maxmem
2790 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by Lua. By
2791 default it is zero which means unlimited. It is important to set a limit to
2792 ensure that a bug in a script will not result in the system running out of
2793 memory.
2794
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002795tune.lua.session-timeout <timeout>
2796 This is the execution timeout for the Lua sessions. This is useful for
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02002797 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
2798 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002799 not taken in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002800
2801tune.lua.task-timeout <timeout>
2802 Purpose is the same as "tune.lua.session-timeout", but this timeout is
2803 dedicated to the tasks. By default, this timeout isn't set because a task may
2804 remain alive during of the lifetime of HAProxy. For example, a task used to
2805 check servers.
2806
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02002807tune.lua.service-timeout <timeout>
2808 This is the execution timeout for the Lua services. This is useful for
2809 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
2810 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002811 not taken in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02002812
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01002813tune.maxaccept <number>
Willy Tarreau16a21472012-11-19 12:39:59 +01002814 Sets the maximum number of consecutive connections a process may accept in a
2815 row before switching to other work. In single process mode, higher numbers
Willy Tarreau66161322021-02-19 15:50:27 +01002816 used to give better performance at high connection rates, though this is not
2817 the case anymore with the multi-queue. This value applies individually to
2818 each listener, so that the number of processes a listener is bound to is
2819 taken into account. This value defaults to 4 which showed best results. If a
2820 significantly higher value was inherited from an ancient config, it might be
2821 worth removing it as it will both increase performance and lower response
2822 time. In multi-process mode, it is divided by twice the number of processes
2823 the listener is bound to. Setting this value to -1 completely disables the
2824 limitation. It should normally not be needed to tweak this value.
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01002825
2826tune.maxpollevents <number>
2827 Sets the maximum amount of events that can be processed at once in a call to
2828 the polling system. The default value is adapted to the operating system. It
2829 has been noticed that reducing it below 200 tends to slightly decrease
2830 latency at the expense of network bandwidth, and increasing it above 200
2831 tends to trade latency for slightly increased bandwidth.
2832
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02002833tune.maxrewrite <number>
2834 Sets the reserved buffer space to this size in bytes. The reserved space is
2835 used for header rewriting or appending. The first reads on sockets will never
2836 fill more than bufsize-maxrewrite. Historically it has defaulted to half of
2837 bufsize, though that does not make much sense since there are rarely large
2838 numbers of headers to add. Setting it too high prevents processing of large
2839 requests or responses. Setting it too low prevents addition of new headers
2840 to already large requests or to POST requests. It is generally wise to set it
2841 to about 1024. It is automatically readjusted to half of bufsize if it is
2842 larger than that. This means you don't have to worry about it when changing
2843 bufsize.
2844
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02002845tune.pattern.cache-size <number>
2846 Sets the size of the pattern lookup cache to <number> entries. This is an LRU
2847 cache which reminds previous lookups and their results. It is used by ACLs
2848 and maps on slow pattern lookups, namely the ones using the "sub", "reg",
2849 "dir", "dom", "end", "bin" match methods as well as the case-insensitive
2850 strings. It applies to pattern expressions which means that it will be able
2851 to memorize the result of a lookup among all the patterns specified on a
2852 configuration line (including all those loaded from files). It automatically
2853 invalidates entries which are updated using HTTP actions or on the CLI. The
2854 default cache size is set to 10000 entries, which limits its footprint to
Willy Tarreau403bfbb2019-10-23 06:59:31 +02002855 about 5 MB per process/thread on 32-bit systems and 8 MB per process/thread
2856 on 64-bit systems, as caches are thread/process local. There is a very low
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02002857 risk of collision in this cache, which is in the order of the size of the
2858 cache divided by 2^64. Typically, at 10000 requests per second with the
2859 default cache size of 10000 entries, there's 1% chance that a brute force
2860 attack could cause a single collision after 60 years, or 0.1% after 6 years.
2861 This is considered much lower than the risk of a memory corruption caused by
2862 aging components. If this is not acceptable, the cache can be disabled by
2863 setting this parameter to 0.
2864
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +02002865tune.pipesize <number>
2866 Sets the kernel pipe buffer size to this size (in bytes). By default, pipes
2867 are the default size for the system. But sometimes when using TCP splicing,
2868 it can improve performance to increase pipe sizes, especially if it is
2869 suspected that pipes are not filled and that many calls to splice() are
2870 performed. This has an impact on the kernel's memory footprint, so this must
2871 not be changed if impacts are not understood.
2872
Olivier Houchard88698d92019-04-16 19:07:22 +02002873tune.pool-high-fd-ratio <number>
2874 This setting sets the max number of file descriptors (in percentage) used by
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002875 HAProxy globally against the maximum number of file descriptors HAProxy can
Olivier Houchard88698d92019-04-16 19:07:22 +02002876 use before we start killing idle connections when we can't reuse a connection
2877 and we have to create a new one. The default is 25 (one quarter of the file
2878 descriptor will mean that roughly half of the maximum front connections can
2879 keep an idle connection behind, anything beyond this probably doesn't make
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002880 much sense in the general case when targeting connection reuse).
Olivier Houchard88698d92019-04-16 19:07:22 +02002881
Willy Tarreau83ca3052020-07-01 18:30:16 +02002882tune.pool-low-fd-ratio <number>
2883 This setting sets the max number of file descriptors (in percentage) used by
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002884 HAProxy globally against the maximum number of file descriptors HAProxy can
Willy Tarreau83ca3052020-07-01 18:30:16 +02002885 use before we stop putting connection into the idle pool for reuse. The
2886 default is 20.
2887
Amaury Denoyelle97e84c62022-04-19 18:26:55 +02002888tune.quic.conn-buf-limit <number>
2889 Warning: QUIC support in HAProxy is currently experimental. Configuration may
2890 change without deprecation in the future.
2891
2892 This settings defines the maximum number of buffers allocated for a QUIC
2893 connection on data emission. By default, it is set to 30. QUIC buffers are
2894 drained on ACK reception. This setting has a direct impact on the throughput
2895 and memory consumption and can be adjusted according to an estimated round
2896 time-trip.
2897
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002898tune.rcvbuf.client <number>
2899tune.rcvbuf.server <number>
2900 Forces the kernel socket receive buffer size on the client or the server side
2901 to the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
2902 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002903 the kernel auto-tune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002904 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (e.g. 4096) in
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002905 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
2906 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
2907
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01002908tune.recv_enough <number>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002909 HAProxy uses some hints to detect that a short read indicates the end of the
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01002910 socket buffers. One of them is that a read returns more than <recv_enough>
2911 bytes, which defaults to 10136 (7 segments of 1448 each). This default value
2912 may be changed by this setting to better deal with workloads involving lots
2913 of short messages such as telnet or SSH sessions.
2914
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02002915tune.runqueue-depth <number>
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002916 Sets the maximum amount of task that can be processed at once when running
Willy Tarreau060a7612021-03-10 11:06:26 +01002917 tasks. The default value depends on the number of threads but sits between 35
2918 and 280, which tend to show the highest request rates and lowest latencies.
2919 Increasing it may incur latency when dealing with I/Os, making it too small
2920 can incur extra overhead. Higher thread counts benefit from lower values.
2921 When experimenting with much larger values, it may be useful to also enable
2922 tune.sched.low-latency and possibly tune.fd.edge-triggered to limit the
2923 maximum latency to the lowest possible.
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +02002924
2925tune.sched.low-latency { on | off }
2926 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the low-latency task scheduler. By default
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002927 HAProxy processes tasks from several classes one class at a time as this is
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +02002928 the most efficient. But when running with large values of tune.runqueue-depth
2929 this can have a measurable effect on request or connection latency. When this
2930 low-latency setting is enabled, tasks of lower priority classes will always
2931 be executed before other ones if they exist. This will permit to lower the
2932 maximum latency experienced by new requests or connections in the middle of
2933 massive traffic, at the expense of a higher impact on this large traffic.
2934 For regular usage it is better to leave this off. The default value is off.
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02002935
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002936tune.sndbuf.client <number>
2937tune.sndbuf.server <number>
2938 Forces the kernel socket send buffer size on the client or the server side to
2939 the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
2940 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002941 the kernel auto-tune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002942 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (e.g. 4096) in
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002943 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
2944 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
2945 Another use case is to prevent write timeouts with extremely slow clients due
2946 to the kernel waiting for a large part of the buffer to be read before
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002947 notifying HAProxy again.
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002948
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01002949tune.ssl.cachesize <number>
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01002950 Sets the size of the global SSL session cache, in a number of blocks. A block
William Dauchy9a4bbfe2021-02-12 15:58:46 +01002951 is large enough to contain an encoded session without peer certificate. An
2952 encoded session with peer certificate is stored in multiple blocks depending
2953 on the size of the peer certificate. A block uses approximately 200 bytes of
2954 memory (based on `sizeof(struct sh_ssl_sess_hdr) + SHSESS_BLOCK_MIN_SIZE`
2955 calculation used for `shctx_init` function). The default value may be forced
2956 at build time, otherwise defaults to 20000. When the cache is full, the most
2957 idle entries are purged and reassigned. Higher values reduce the occurrence
2958 of such a purge, hence the number of CPU-intensive SSL handshakes by ensuring
2959 that all users keep their session as long as possible. All entries are
Willy Tarreaub63dbb72021-06-11 16:50:29 +02002960 pre-allocated upon startup. Setting this value to 0 disables the SSL session
2961 cache.
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01002962
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02002963tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Lukas Tribus27935782018-10-01 02:00:16 +02002964 This option disables SSL session cache sharing between all processes. It
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02002965 should normally not be used since it will force many renegotiations due to
2966 clients hitting a random process. But it may be required on some operating
2967 systems where none of the SSL cache synchronization method may be used. In
2968 this case, adding a first layer of hash-based load balancing before the SSL
2969 layer might limit the impact of the lack of session sharing.
2970
Thomas Prückl10243932022-04-27 13:04:54 +02002971tune.ssl.hard-maxrecord <number>
2972 Sets the maximum amount of bytes passed to SSL_write() at any time. Default
2973 value 0 means there is no limit. In contrast to tune.ssl.maxrecord this
2974 settings will not be adjusted dynamically. Smaller records may decrease
2975 throughput, but may be required when dealing with low-footprint clients.
2976
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +02002977tune.ssl.keylog { on | off }
2978 This option activates the logging of the TLS keys. It should be used with
2979 care as it will consume more memory per SSL session and could decrease
2980 performances. This is disabled by default.
2981
2982 These sample fetches should be used to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE that is
2983 required to decipher traffic with wireshark.
2984
2985 https://developer.mozilla.org/en-US/docs/Mozilla/Projects/NSS/Key_Log_Format
2986
2987 The SSLKEYLOG is a series of lines which are formatted this way:
2988
2989 <Label> <space> <ClientRandom> <space> <Secret>
2990
2991 The ClientRandom is provided by the %[ssl_fc_client_random,hex] sample
2992 fetch, the secret and the Label could be find in the array below. You need
2993 to generate a SSLKEYLOGFILE with all the labels in this array.
2994
2995 The following sample fetches are hexadecimal strings and does not need to be
2996 converted.
2997
2998 SSLKEYLOGFILE Label | Sample fetches for the Secrets
2999 --------------------------------|-----------------------------------------
3000 CLIENT_EARLY_TRAFFIC_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_client_early_traffic_secret]
3001 CLIENT_HANDSHAKE_TRAFFIC_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_client_handshake_traffic_secret]
3002 SERVER_HANDSHAKE_TRAFFIC_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_server_handshake_traffic_secret]
3003 CLIENT_TRAFFIC_SECRET_0 | %[ssl_fc_client_traffic_secret_0]
3004 SERVER_TRAFFIC_SECRET_0 | %[ssl_fc_server_traffic_secret_0]
William Lallemandd742b6c2020-07-07 10:14:56 +02003005 EXPORTER_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_exporter_secret]
3006 EARLY_EXPORTER_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_early_exporter_secret]
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +02003007
3008 This is only available with OpenSSL 1.1.1, and useful with TLS1.3 session.
3009
3010 If you want to generate the content of a SSLKEYLOGFILE with TLS < 1.3, you
3011 only need this line:
3012
3013 "CLIENT_RANDOM %[ssl_fc_client_random,hex] %[ssl_fc_session_key,hex]"
3014
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01003015tune.ssl.lifetime <timeout>
3016 Sets how long a cached SSL session may remain valid. This time is expressed
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03003017 in seconds and defaults to 300 (5 min). It is important to understand that it
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01003018 does not guarantee that sessions will last that long, because if the cache is
3019 full, the longest idle sessions will be purged despite their configured
3020 lifetime. The real usefulness of this setting is to prevent sessions from
3021 being used for too long.
3022
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01003023tune.ssl.maxrecord <number>
Thomas Prückl10243932022-04-27 13:04:54 +02003024 Sets the maximum amount of bytes passed to SSL_write() at the beginning of
3025 the data transfer. Default value 0 means there is no limit. Over SSL/TLS,
3026 the client can decipher the data only once it has received a full record.
3027 With large records, it means that clients might have to download up to 16kB
3028 of data before starting to process them. Limiting the value can improve page
3029 load times on browsers located over high latency or low bandwidth networks.
3030 It is suggested to find optimal values which fit into 1 or 2 TCP segments
3031 (generally 1448 bytes over Ethernet with TCP timestamps enabled, or 1460 when
3032 timestamps are disabled), keeping in mind that SSL/TLS add some overhead.
3033 Typical values of 1419 and 2859 gave good results during tests. Use
3034 "strace -e trace=write" to find the best value. HAProxy will automatically
3035 switch to this setting after an idle stream has been detected (see
3036 tune.idletimer above). See also tune.ssl.hard-maxrecord.
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01003037
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02003038tune.ssl.default-dh-param <number>
3039 Sets the maximum size of the Diffie-Hellman parameters used for generating
3040 the ephemeral/temporary Diffie-Hellman key in case of DHE key exchange. The
3041 final size will try to match the size of the server's RSA (or DSA) key (e.g,
3042 a 2048 bits temporary DH key for a 2048 bits RSA key), but will not exceed
Remi Tricot-Le Breton1d6338e2022-04-12 11:31:55 +02003043 this maximum value. Only 1024 or higher values are allowed. Higher values
3044 will increase the CPU load, and values greater than 1024 bits are not
3045 supported by Java 7 and earlier clients. This value is not used if static
3046 Diffie-Hellman parameters are supplied either directly in the certificate
3047 file or by using the ssl-dh-param-file parameter.
3048 If there is neither a default-dh-param nor a ssl-dh-param-file defined, and
3049 if the server's PEM file of a given frontend does not specify its own DH
3050 parameters, then DHE ciphers will be unavailable for this frontend.
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02003051
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +02003052tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size <number>
3053 Sets the size of the cache used to store generated certificates to <number>
3054 entries. This is a LRU cache. Because generating a SSL certificate
3055 dynamically is expensive, they are cached. The default cache size is set to
3056 1000 entries.
3057
Marcin Deranek310a2602021-07-13 19:04:24 +02003058tune.ssl.capture-buffer-size <number>
3059tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size <number> (deprecated)
Marcin Deranek769fd2e2021-07-12 14:16:55 +02003060 Sets the maximum size of the buffer used for capturing client hello cipher
3061 list, extensions list, elliptic curves list and elliptic curve point
3062 formats. If the value is 0 (default value) the capture is disabled,
3063 otherwise a buffer is allocated for each SSL/TLS connection.
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +01003064
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02003065tune.vars.global-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01003066tune.vars.proc-max-size <size>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02003067tune.vars.reqres-max-size <size>
3068tune.vars.sess-max-size <size>
3069tune.vars.txn-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01003070 These five tunes help to manage the maximum amount of memory used by the
3071 variables system. "global" limits the overall amount of memory available for
3072 all scopes. "proc" limits the memory for the process scope, "sess" limits the
3073 memory for the session scope, "txn" for the transaction scope, and "reqres"
3074 limits the memory for each request or response processing.
3075 Memory accounting is hierarchical, meaning more coarse grained limits include
3076 the finer grained ones: "proc" includes "sess", "sess" includes "txn", and
3077 "txn" includes "reqres".
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02003078
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01003079 For example, when "tune.vars.sess-max-size" is limited to 100,
3080 "tune.vars.txn-max-size" and "tune.vars.reqres-max-size" cannot exceed
3081 100 either. If we create a variable "txn.var" that contains 100 bytes,
3082 all available space is consumed.
3083 Notice that exceeding the limits at runtime will not result in an error
3084 message, but values might be cut off or corrupted. So make sure to accurately
3085 plan for the amount of space needed to store all your variables.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02003086
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01003087tune.zlib.memlevel <number>
3088 Sets the memLevel parameter in zlib initialization for each session. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03003089 defines how much memory should be allocated for the internal compression
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01003090 state. A value of 1 uses minimum memory but is slow and reduces compression
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003091 ratio, a value of 9 uses maximum memory for optimal speed. Can be a value
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01003092 between 1 and 9. The default value is 8.
3093
3094tune.zlib.windowsize <number>
3095 Sets the window size (the size of the history buffer) as a parameter of the
3096 zlib initialization for each session. Larger values of this parameter result
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003097 in better compression at the expense of memory usage. Can be a value between
3098 8 and 15. The default value is 15.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003099
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020031003.3. Debugging
3101--------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003102
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003103quiet
3104 Do not display any message during startup. It is equivalent to the command-
3105 line argument "-q".
3106
Willy Tarreau3eb10b82020-04-15 16:42:39 +02003107zero-warning
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003108 When this option is set, HAProxy will refuse to start if any warning was
Willy Tarreau3eb10b82020-04-15 16:42:39 +02003109 emitted while processing the configuration. It is highly recommended to set
3110 this option on configurations that are not changed often, as it helps detect
3111 subtle mistakes and keep the configuration clean and forward-compatible. Note
3112 that "haproxy -c" will also report errors in such a case. This option is
3113 equivalent to command line argument "-dW".
3114
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003115
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010031163.4. Userlists
3117--------------
3118It is possible to control access to frontend/backend/listen sections or to
3119http stats by allowing only authenticated and authorized users. To do this,
3120it is required to create at least one userlist and to define users.
3121
3122userlist <listname>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01003123 Creates new userlist with name <listname>. Many independent userlists can be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003124 used to store authentication & authorization data for independent customers.
3125
3126group <groupname> [users <user>,<user>,(...)]
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01003127 Adds group <groupname> to the current userlist. It is also possible to
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003128 attach users to this group by using a comma separated list of names
3129 proceeded by "users" keyword.
3130
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01003131user <username> [password|insecure-password <password>]
3132 [groups <group>,<group>,(...)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003133 Adds user <username> to the current userlist. Both secure (encrypted) and
3134 insecure (unencrypted) passwords can be used. Encrypted passwords are
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01003135 evaluated using the crypt(3) function, so depending on the system's
3136 capabilities, different algorithms are supported. For example, modern Glibc
3137 based Linux systems support MD5, SHA-256, SHA-512, and, of course, the
3138 classic DES-based method of encrypting passwords.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003139
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01003140 Attention: Be aware that using encrypted passwords might cause significantly
3141 increased CPU usage, depending on the number of requests, and the algorithm
3142 used. For any of the hashed variants, the password for each request must
3143 be processed through the chosen algorithm, before it can be compared to the
3144 value specified in the config file. Most current algorithms are deliberately
3145 designed to be expensive to compute to achieve resistance against brute
3146 force attacks. They do not simply salt/hash the clear text password once,
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003147 but thousands of times. This can quickly become a major factor in HAProxy's
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01003148 overall CPU consumption!
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003149
3150 Example:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01003151 userlist L1
3152 group G1 users tiger,scott
3153 group G2 users xdb,scott
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003154
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01003155 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx9za9667qe4(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91
3156 user scott insecure-password elgato
3157 user xdb insecure-password hello
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003158
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01003159 userlist L2
3160 group G1
3161 group G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003162
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01003163 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91 groups G1
3164 user scott insecure-password elgato groups G1,G2
3165 user xdb insecure-password hello groups G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003166
3167 Please note that both lists are functionally identical.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003168
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003169
31703.5. Peers
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003171----------
Emeric Brun94900952015-06-11 18:25:54 +02003172It is possible to propagate entries of any data-types in stick-tables between
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003173several HAProxy instances over TCP connections in a multi-master fashion. Each
Emeric Brun94900952015-06-11 18:25:54 +02003174instance pushes its local updates and insertions to remote peers. The pushed
Willy Tarreaudb2ab822021-10-08 17:53:12 +02003175values overwrite remote ones without aggregation. As an exception, the data
3176type "conn_cur" is never learned from peers, as it is supposed to reflect local
3177values. Earlier versions used to synchronize it and to cause negative values in
3178active-active setups, and always-growing values upon reloads or active-passive
3179switches because the local value would reflect more connections than locally
3180present. This information, however, is pushed so that monitoring systems can
3181watch it.
3182
3183Interrupted exchanges are automatically detected and recovered from the last
3184known point. In addition, during a soft restart, the old process connects to
3185the new one using such a TCP connection to push all its entries before the new
3186process tries to connect to other peers. That ensures very fast replication
3187during a reload, it typically takes a fraction of a second even for large
3188tables.
3189
Emeric Brun94900952015-06-11 18:25:54 +02003190Note that Server IDs are used to identify servers remotely, so it is important
3191that configurations look similar or at least that the same IDs are forced on
3192each server on all participants.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003193
3194peers <peersect>
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003195 Creates a new peer list with name <peersect>. It is an independent section,
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003196 which is referenced by one or more stick-tables.
3197
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01003198bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
3199 Defines the binding parameters of the local peer of this "peers" section.
3200 Such lines are not supported with "peer" line in the same "peers" section.
3201
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02003202disabled
3203 Disables a peers section. It disables both listening and any synchronization
3204 related to this section. This is provided to disable synchronization of stick
3205 tables without having to comment out all "peers" references.
3206
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01003207default-bind [param*]
3208 Defines the binding parameters for the local peer, excepted its address.
3209
3210default-server [param*]
3211 Change default options for a server in a "peers" section.
3212
3213 Arguments:
3214 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
3215 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
3216 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
3217 details.
3218
3219
3220 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
3221
Emeric Brun620761f2021-09-29 10:29:52 +02003222enabled
3223 This re-enables a peers section which was previously disabled via the
3224 "disabled" keyword.
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02003225
Jan Wagner3e678602020-12-17 22:22:32 +01003226log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<sample_size>]
Frédéric Lécailleb6f759b2019-11-05 09:57:45 +01003227 <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
3228 "peers" sections support the same "log" keyword as for the proxies to
3229 log information about the "peers" listener. See "log" option for proxies for
3230 more details.
3231
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01003232peer <peername> <ip>:<port> [param*]
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003233 Defines a peer inside a peers section.
3234 If <peername> is set to the local peer name (by default hostname, or forced
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +02003235 using "-L" command line option or "localpeer" global configuration setting),
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003236 HAProxy will listen for incoming remote peer connection on <ip>:<port>.
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +02003237 Otherwise, <ip>:<port> defines where to connect to in order to join the
3238 remote peer, and <peername> is used at the protocol level to identify and
3239 validate the remote peer on the server side.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003240
3241 During a soft restart, local peer <ip>:<port> is used by the old instance to
3242 connect the new one and initiate a complete replication (teaching process).
3243
3244 It is strongly recommended to have the exact same peers declaration on all
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +02003245 peers and to only rely on the "-L" command line argument or the "localpeer"
3246 global configuration setting to change the local peer name. This makes it
3247 easier to maintain coherent configuration files across all peers.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003248
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02003249 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
3250 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01003251
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01003252 Note: "peer" keyword may transparently be replaced by "server" keyword (see
3253 "server" keyword explanation below).
3254
3255server <peername> [<ip>:<port>] [param*]
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02003256 As previously mentioned, "peer" keyword may be replaced by "server" keyword
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01003257 with a support for all "server" parameters found in 5.2 paragraph.
3258 If the underlying peer is local, <ip>:<port> parameters must not be present.
Aleksandar Lazic332258a2022-03-30 00:11:40 +02003259 These parameters must be provided on a "bind" line (see "bind" keyword
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01003260 of this "peers" section).
3261 Some of these parameters are irrelevant for "peers" sections.
3262
3263
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003264 Example:
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01003265 # The old way.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003266 peers mypeers
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01003267 peer haproxy1 192.168.0.1:1024
3268 peer haproxy2 192.168.0.2:1024
3269 peer haproxy3 10.2.0.1:1024
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003270
3271 backend mybackend
3272 mode tcp
3273 balance roundrobin
3274 stick-table type ip size 20k peers mypeers
3275 stick on src
3276
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01003277 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
3278 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003279
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01003280 Example:
3281 peers mypeers
3282 bind 127.0.0.11:10001 ssl crt mycerts/pem
3283 default-server ssl verify none
3284 server hostA 127.0.0.10:10000
3285 server hostB #local peer
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003286
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01003287
3288table <tablename> type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
3289 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [store <data_type>]*
3290
3291 Configure a stickiness table for the current section. This line is parsed
3292 exactly the same way as the "stick-table" keyword in others section, except
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05003293 for the "peers" argument which is not required here and with an additional
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01003294 mandatory first parameter to designate the stick-table. Contrary to others
3295 sections, there may be several "table" lines in "peers" sections (see also
3296 "stick-table" keyword).
3297
3298 Also be aware of the fact that "peers" sections have their own stick-table
3299 namespaces to avoid collisions between stick-table names identical in
3300 different "peers" section. This is internally handled prepending the "peers"
3301 sections names to the name of the stick-tables followed by a '/' character.
3302 If somewhere else in the configuration file you have to refer to such
3303 stick-tables declared in "peers" sections you must use the prefixed version
3304 of the stick-table name as follows:
3305
3306 peers mypeers
3307 peer A ...
3308 peer B ...
3309 table t1 ...
3310
3311 frontend fe1
3312 tcp-request content track-sc0 src table mypeers/t1
3313
3314 This is also this prefixed version of the stick-table names which must be
3315 used to refer to stick-tables through the CLI.
3316
3317 About "peers" protocol, as only "peers" belonging to the same section may
3318 communicate with each others, there is no need to do such a distinction.
3319 Several "peers" sections may declare stick-tables with the same name.
3320 This is shorter version of the stick-table name which is sent over the network.
3321 There is only a '/' character as prefix to avoid stick-table name collisions between
3322 stick-tables declared as backends and stick-table declared in "peers" sections
3323 as follows in this weird but supported configuration:
3324
3325 peers mypeers
3326 peer A ...
3327 peer B ...
3328 table t1 type string size 10m store gpc0
3329
3330 backend t1
3331 stick-table type string size 10m store gpc0 peers mypeers
3332
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04003333 Here "t1" table declared in "mypeers" section has "mypeers/t1" as global name.
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01003334 "t1" table declared as a backend as "t1" as global name. But at peer protocol
3335 level the former table is named "/t1", the latter is again named "t1".
3336
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +090033373.6. Mailers
3338------------
3339It is possible to send email alerts when the state of servers changes.
3340If configured email alerts are sent to each mailer that is configured
3341in a mailers section. Email is sent to mailers using SMTP.
3342
Pieter Baauw386a1272015-08-16 15:26:24 +02003343mailers <mailersect>
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003344 Creates a new mailer list with the name <mailersect>. It is an
3345 independent section which is referenced by one or more proxies.
3346
3347mailer <mailername> <ip>:<port>
3348 Defines a mailer inside a mailers section.
3349
3350 Example:
3351 mailers mymailers
3352 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
3353 mailer smtp2 192.168.0.2:587
3354
3355 backend mybackend
3356 mode tcp
3357 balance roundrobin
3358
3359 email-alert mailers mymailers
3360 email-alert from test1@horms.org
3361 email-alert to test2@horms.org
3362
3363 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
3364 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
3365
Pieter Baauw235fcfc2016-02-13 15:33:40 +01003366timeout mail <time>
3367 Defines the time available for a mail/connection to be made and send to
3368 the mail-server. If not defined the default value is 10 seconds. To allow
3369 for at least two SYN-ACK packets to be send during initial TCP handshake it
3370 is advised to keep this value above 4 seconds.
3371
3372 Example:
3373 mailers mymailers
3374 timeout mail 20s
3375 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003376
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +020033773.7. Programs
3378-------------
3379In master-worker mode, it is possible to launch external binaries with the
3380master, these processes are called programs. These programs are launched and
3381managed the same way as the workers.
3382
3383During a reload of HAProxy, those processes are dealing with the same
3384sequence as a worker:
3385
3386 - the master is re-executed
3387 - the master sends a SIGUSR1 signal to the program
3388 - if "option start-on-reload" is not disabled, the master launches a new
3389 instance of the program
3390
3391During a stop, or restart, a SIGTERM is sent to the programs.
3392
3393program <name>
3394 This is a new program section, this section will create an instance <name>
3395 which is visible in "show proc" on the master CLI. (See "9.4. Master CLI" in
3396 the management guide).
3397
3398command <command> [arguments*]
3399 Define the command to start with optional arguments. The command is looked
3400 up in the current PATH if it does not include an absolute path. This is a
3401 mandatory option of the program section. Arguments containing spaces must
3402 be enclosed in quotes or double quotes or be prefixed by a backslash.
3403
Andrew Heberle97236962019-07-12 11:50:26 +08003404user <user name>
3405 Changes the executed command user ID to the <user name> from /etc/passwd.
3406 See also "group".
3407
3408group <group name>
3409 Changes the executed command group ID to the <group name> from /etc/group.
3410 See also "user".
3411
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +02003412option start-on-reload
3413no option start-on-reload
3414 Start (or not) a new instance of the program upon a reload of the master.
3415 The default is to start a new instance. This option may only be used in a
3416 program section.
3417
3418
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +010034193.8. HTTP-errors
3420----------------
3421
3422It is possible to globally declare several groups of HTTP errors, to be
3423imported afterwards in any proxy section. Same group may be referenced at
3424several places and can be fully or partially imported.
3425
3426http-errors <name>
3427 Create a new http-errors group with the name <name>. It is an independent
3428 section that may be referenced by one or more proxies using its name.
3429
3430errorfile <code> <file>
3431 Associate a file contents to an HTTP error code
3432
3433 Arguments :
3434 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02003435 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01003436 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504.
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01003437
3438 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
3439 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
3440 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
3441 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
3442 before any chroot is performed.
3443
3444 Please referrers to "errorfile" keyword in section 4 for details.
3445
3446 Example:
3447 http-errors website-1
3448 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site1/400.http
3449 errorfile 404 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site1/404.http
3450 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
3451
3452 http-errors website-2
3453 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site2/400.http
3454 errorfile 404 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site2/404.http
3455 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
3456
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +020034573.9. Rings
3458----------
3459
3460It is possible to globally declare ring-buffers, to be used as target for log
3461servers or traces.
3462
3463ring <ringname>
3464 Creates a new ring-buffer with name <ringname>.
3465
3466description <text>
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04003467 The description is an optional description string of the ring. It will
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003468 appear on CLI. By default, <name> is reused to fill this field.
3469
3470format <format>
3471 Format used to store events into the ring buffer.
3472
3473 Arguments:
3474 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
3475 one of the following :
3476
3477 iso A message containing only the ISO date, followed by the text.
3478 The PID, process name and system name are omitted. This is
3479 designed to be used with a local log server.
3480
Emeric Brun0237c4e2020-11-27 16:24:34 +01003481 local Analog to rfc3164 syslog message format except that hostname
3482 field is stripped. This is the default.
3483 Note: option "log-send-hostname" switches the default to
3484 rfc3164.
3485
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003486 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
3487 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
3488 used in containers or during development, where the severity
3489 only depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr). This
3490 is the default.
3491
Emeric Brun0237c4e2020-11-27 16:24:34 +01003492 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format.
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003493 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
3494
3495 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
3496 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
3497
3498 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
3499 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
3500 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
3501 local log server. This format is compatible with what the systemd
3502 logger consumes.
3503
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02003504 priority A message containing only a level plus syslog facility between angle
3505 brackets such as '<63>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time,
3506 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used
3507 with a local log server.
3508
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003509 timed A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
3510 '<3>', followed by ISO date and by the text. The PID, process
3511 name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
3512 used with a local log server.
3513
3514maxlen <length>
3515 The maximum length of an event message stored into the ring,
3516 including formatted header. If an event message is longer than
3517 <length>, it will be truncated to this length.
3518
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02003519server <name> <address> [param*]
3520 Used to configure a syslog tcp server to forward messages from ring buffer.
3521 This supports for all "server" parameters found in 5.2 paragraph. Some of
3522 these parameters are irrelevant for "ring" sections. Important point: there
3523 is little reason to add more than one server to a ring, because all servers
3524 will receive the exact same copy of the ring contents, and as such the ring
3525 will progress at the speed of the slowest server. If one server does not
3526 respond, it will prevent old messages from being purged and may block new
3527 messages from being inserted into the ring. The proper way to send messages
3528 to multiple servers is to use one distinct ring per log server, not to
Emeric Brun97556472020-05-30 01:42:45 +02003529 attach multiple servers to the same ring. Note that specific server directive
3530 "log-proto" is used to set the protocol used to send messages.
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02003531
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003532size <size>
3533 This is the optional size in bytes for the ring-buffer. Default value is
3534 set to BUFSIZE.
3535
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02003536timeout connect <timeout>
3537 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
3538
3539 Arguments :
3540 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
3541 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
3542 as explained at the top of this document.
3543
3544timeout server <timeout>
3545 Set the maximum time for pending data staying into output buffer.
3546
3547 Arguments :
3548 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
3549 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
3550 as explained at the top of this document.
3551
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003552 Example:
3553 global
3554 log ring@myring local7
3555
3556 ring myring
3557 description "My local buffer"
3558 format rfc3164
3559 maxlen 1200
3560 size 32764
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02003561 timeout connect 5s
3562 timeout server 10s
Emeric Brun97556472020-05-30 01:42:45 +02003563 server mysyslogsrv 127.0.0.1:6514 log-proto octet-count
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003564
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +020035653.10. Log forwarding
3566-------------------
3567
3568It is possible to declare one or multiple log forwarding section,
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003569HAProxy will forward all received log messages to a log servers list.
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003570
3571log-forward <name>
3572 Creates a new log forwarder proxy identified as <name>.
3573
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02003574backlog <conns>
3575 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
3576 on connections accept.
3577
3578bind <addr> [param*]
3579 Used to configure a stream log listener to receive messages to forward.
Emeric Brunda46c1c2020-10-08 08:39:02 +02003580 This supports the "bind" parameters found in 5.1 paragraph including
3581 those about ssl but some statements such as "alpn" may be irrelevant for
3582 syslog protocol over TCP.
3583 Those listeners support both "Octet Counting" and "Non-Transparent-Framing"
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02003584 modes as defined in rfc-6587.
3585
Willy Tarreau76aaa7f2020-09-16 15:07:22 +02003586dgram-bind <addr> [param*]
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02003587 Used to configure a datagram log listener to receive messages to forward.
3588 Addresses must be in IPv4 or IPv6 form,followed by a port. This supports
3589 for some of the "bind" parameters found in 5.1 paragraph among which
3590 "interface", "namespace" or "transparent", the other ones being
Willy Tarreau26ff5da2020-09-16 15:22:19 +02003591 silently ignored as irrelevant for UDP/syslog case.
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003592
3593log global
Jan Wagner3e678602020-12-17 22:22:32 +01003594log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<sample_size>]
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003595 <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
3596 Used to configure target log servers. See more details on proxies
3597 documentation.
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003598 If no format specified, HAProxy tries to keep the incoming log format.
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003599 Configured facility is ignored, except if incoming message does not
3600 present a facility but one is mandatory on the outgoing format.
3601 If there is no timestamp available in the input format, but the field
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003602 exists in output format, HAProxy will use the local date.
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003603
3604 Example:
3605 global
3606 log stderr format iso local7
3607
3608 ring myring
3609 description "My local buffer"
3610 format rfc5424
3611 maxlen 1200
3612 size 32764
3613 timeout connect 5s
3614 timeout server 10s
3615 # syslog tcp server
3616 server mysyslogsrv 127.0.0.1:514 log-proto octet-count
3617
3618 log-forward sylog-loadb
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02003619 dgram-bind 127.0.0.1:1514
3620 bind 127.0.0.1:1514
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003621 # all messages on stderr
3622 log global
3623 # all messages on local tcp syslog server
3624 log ring@myring local0
3625 # load balance messages on 4 udp syslog servers
3626 log 127.0.0.1:10001 sample 1:4 local0
3627 log 127.0.0.1:10002 sample 2:4 local0
3628 log 127.0.0.1:10003 sample 3:4 local0
3629 log 127.0.0.1:10004 sample 4:4 local0
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01003630
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02003631maxconn <conns>
3632 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a log forwarder.
3633 10 is the default.
3634
3635timeout client <timeout>
3636 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
3637
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020036384. Proxies
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003639----------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003640
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003641Proxy configuration can be located in a set of sections :
Willy Tarreau7c0b4d82021-02-12 14:58:08 +01003642 - defaults [<name>] [ from <defaults_name> ]
3643 - frontend <name> [ from <defaults_name> ]
3644 - backend <name> [ from <defaults_name> ]
3645 - listen <name> [ from <defaults_name> ]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003646
3647A "frontend" section describes a set of listening sockets accepting client
3648connections.
3649
3650A "backend" section describes a set of servers to which the proxy will connect
3651to forward incoming connections.
3652
3653A "listen" section defines a complete proxy with its frontend and backend
3654parts combined in one section. It is generally useful for TCP-only traffic.
3655
Willy Tarreau7c0b4d82021-02-12 14:58:08 +01003656A "defaults" section resets all settings to the documented ones and presets new
3657ones for use by subsequent sections. All of "frontend", "backend" and "listen"
3658sections always take their initial settings from a defaults section, by default
3659the latest one that appears before the newly created section. It is possible to
3660explicitly designate a specific "defaults" section to load the initial settings
3661from by indicating its name on the section line after the optional keyword
3662"from". While "defaults" section do not impose a name, this use is encouraged
3663for better readability. It is also the only way to designate a specific section
3664to use instead of the default previous one. Since "defaults" section names are
3665optional, by default a very permissive check is applied on their name and these
3666are even permitted to overlap. However if a "defaults" section is referenced by
3667any other section, its name must comply with the syntax imposed on all proxy
3668names, and this name must be unique among the defaults sections. Please note
3669that regardless of what is currently permitted, it is recommended to avoid
3670duplicate section names in general and to respect the same syntax as for proxy
Christopher Fauletb4054202021-10-12 18:57:43 +02003671names. This rule might be enforced in a future version. In addition, a warning
3672is emitted if a defaults section is explicitly used by a proxy while it is also
3673implicitly used by another one because it is the last one defined. It is highly
3674encouraged to not mix both usages by always using explicit references or by
3675adding a last common defaults section reserved for all implicit uses.
Willy Tarreau7c0b4d82021-02-12 14:58:08 +01003676
3677Note that it is even possible for a defaults section to take its initial
3678settings from another one, and as such, inherit settings across multiple levels
3679of defaults sections. This can be convenient to establish certain configuration
3680profiles to carry groups of default settings (e.g. TCP vs HTTP or short vs long
3681timeouts) but can quickly become confusing to follow.
3682
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003683All proxy names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits,
3684'-' (dash), '_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are
3685case-sensitive, which means that "www" and "WWW" are two different proxies.
3686
3687Historically, all proxy names could overlap, it just caused troubles in the
3688logs. Since the introduction of content switching, it is mandatory that two
3689proxies with overlapping capabilities (frontend/backend) have different names.
3690However, it is still permitted that a frontend and a backend share the same
3691name, as this configuration seems to be commonly encountered.
3692
3693Right now, two major proxy modes are supported : "tcp", also known as layer 4,
3694and "http", also known as layer 7. In layer 4 mode, HAProxy simply forwards
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003695bidirectional traffic between two sides. In layer 7 mode, HAProxy analyzes the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003696protocol, and can interact with it by allowing, blocking, switching, adding,
3697modifying, or removing arbitrary contents in requests or responses, based on
3698arbitrary criteria.
3699
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003700In HTTP mode, the processing applied to requests and responses flowing over
3701a connection depends in the combination of the frontend's HTTP options and
Julien Pivotto21ad3152019-12-10 13:11:17 +01003702the backend's. HAProxy supports 3 connection modes :
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003703
3704 - KAL : keep alive ("option http-keep-alive") which is the default mode : all
3705 requests and responses are processed, and connections remain open but idle
3706 between responses and new requests.
3707
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003708 - SCL: server close ("option http-server-close") : the server-facing
3709 connection is closed after the end of the response is received, but the
3710 client-facing connection remains open.
3711
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02003712 - CLO: close ("option httpclose"): the connection is closed after the end of
3713 the response and "Connection: close" appended in both directions.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003714
3715The effective mode that will be applied to a connection passing through a
3716frontend and a backend can be determined by both proxy modes according to the
3717following matrix, but in short, the modes are symmetric, keep-alive is the
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02003718weakest option and close is the strongest.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003719
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02003720 Backend mode
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003721
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02003722 | KAL | SCL | CLO
3723 ----+-----+-----+----
3724 KAL | KAL | SCL | CLO
3725 ----+-----+-----+----
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02003726 mode SCL | SCL | SCL | CLO
3727 ----+-----+-----+----
3728 CLO | CLO | CLO | CLO
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003729
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01003730It is possible to chain a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. It is pointless if
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003731only HTTP traffic is handled. But it may be used to handle several protocols
3732within the same frontend. In this case, the client's connection is first handled
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01003733as a raw tcp connection before being upgraded to HTTP. Before the upgrade, the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003734content processings are performend on raw data. Once upgraded, data is parsed
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01003735and stored using an internal representation called HTX and it is no longer
3736possible to rely on raw representation. There is no way to go back.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003737
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01003738There are two kind of upgrades, in-place upgrades and destructive upgrades. The
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003739first ones involves a TCP to HTTP/1 upgrade. In HTTP/1, the request
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01003740processings are serialized, thus the applicative stream can be preserved. The
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003741second one involves a TCP to HTTP/2 upgrade. Because it is a multiplexed
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01003742protocol, the applicative stream cannot be associated to any HTTP/2 stream and
3743is destroyed. New applicative streams are then created when HAProxy receives
3744new HTTP/2 streams at the lower level, in the H2 multiplexer. It is important
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003745to understand this difference because that drastically changes the way to
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01003746process data. When an HTTP/1 upgrade is performed, the content processings
3747already performed on raw data are neither lost nor reexecuted while for an
3748HTTP/2 upgrade, applicative streams are distinct and all frontend rules are
3749evaluated systematically on each one. And as said, the first stream, the TCP
3750one, is destroyed, but only after the frontend rules were evaluated.
3751
3752There is another importnat point to understand when HTTP processings are
3753performed from a TCP proxy. While HAProxy is able to parse HTTP/1 in-fly from
3754tcp-request content rules, it is not possible for HTTP/2. Only the HTTP/2
3755preface can be parsed. This is a huge limitation regarding the HTTP content
3756analysis in TCP. Concretely it is only possible to know if received data are
3757HTTP. For instance, it is not possible to choose a backend based on the Host
3758header value while it is trivial in HTTP/1. Hopefully, there is a solution to
3759mitigate this drawback.
3760
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003761There are two ways to perform an HTTP upgrade. The first one, the historical
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01003762method, is to select an HTTP backend. The upgrade happens when the backend is
3763set. Thus, for in-place upgrades, only the backend configuration is considered
3764in the HTTP data processing. For destructive upgrades, the applicative stream
3765is destroyed, thus its processing is stopped. With this method, possibilities
3766to choose a backend with an HTTP/2 connection are really limited, as mentioned
3767above, and a bit useless because the stream is destroyed. The second method is
3768to upgrade during the tcp-request content rules evaluation, thanks to the
3769"switch-mode http" action. In this case, the upgrade is performed in the
3770frontend context and it is possible to define HTTP directives in this
3771frontend. For in-place upgrades, it offers all the power of the HTTP analysis
3772as soon as possible. It is not that far from an HTTP frontend. For destructive
3773upgrades, it does not change anything except it is useless to choose a backend
3774on limited information. It is of course the recommended method. Thus, testing
3775the request protocol from the tcp-request content rules to perform an HTTP
3776upgrade is enough. All the remaining HTTP manipulation may be moved to the
3777frontend http-request ruleset. But keep in mind that tcp-request content rules
3778remains evaluated on each streams, that can't be changed.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003779
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020037804.1. Proxy keywords matrix
3781--------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003782
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003783The following list of keywords is supported. Most of them may only be used in a
3784limited set of section types. Some of them are marked as "deprecated" because
3785they are inherited from an old syntax which may be confusing or functionally
3786limited, and there are new recommended keywords to replace them. Keywords
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003787marked with "(*)" can be optionally inverted using the "no" prefix, e.g. "no
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003788option contstats". This makes sense when the option has been enabled by default
Willy Tarreau3842f002009-06-14 11:39:52 +02003789and must be disabled for a specific instance. Such options may also be prefixed
3790with "default" in order to restore default settings regardless of what has been
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +02003791specified in a previous "defaults" section. Keywords supported in defaults
3792sections marked with "(!)" are only supported in named defaults sections, not
3793anonymous ones.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003794
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003795
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003796 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
3797------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +02003798acl X (!) X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003799backlog X X X -
3800balance X - X X
3801bind - X X -
3802bind-process X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003803capture cookie - X X -
3804capture request header - X X -
3805capture response header - X X -
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09003806clitcpka-cnt X X X -
3807clitcpka-idle X X X -
3808clitcpka-intvl X X X -
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02003809compression X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003810cookie X - X X
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02003811declare capture - X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003812default-server X - X X
3813default_backend X X X -
3814description - X X X
3815disabled X X X X
3816dispatch - - X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003817email-alert from X X X X
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003818email-alert level X X X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003819email-alert mailers X X X X
3820email-alert myhostname X X X X
3821email-alert to X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003822enabled X X X X
3823errorfile X X X X
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01003824errorfiles X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003825errorloc X X X X
3826errorloc302 X X X X
3827-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
3828errorloc303 X X X X
Remi Tricot-Le Bretonfe21fe72021-08-31 12:08:52 +02003829error-log-format X X X -
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01003830force-persist - - X X
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003831filter - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003832fullconn X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003833hash-type X - X X
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +02003834http-after-response X (!) X X X
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02003835http-check comment X - X X
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02003836http-check connect X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003837http-check disable-on-404 X - X X
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02003838http-check expect X - X X
Peter Gervai8912ae62020-06-11 18:26:36 +02003839http-check send X - X X
Willy Tarreau7ab6aff2010-10-12 06:30:16 +02003840http-check send-state X - X X
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02003841http-check set-var X - X X
3842http-check unset-var X - X X
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02003843http-error X X X X
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +02003844http-request X (!) X X X
3845http-response X (!) X X X
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02003846http-reuse X - X X
Baptiste Assmann2c42ef52013-10-09 21:57:02 +02003847http-send-name-header - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003848id - X X X
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01003849ignore-persist - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02003850load-server-state-from-file X - X X
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02003851log (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01003852log-format X X X -
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02003853log-format-sd X X X -
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01003854log-tag X X X X
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02003855max-keep-alive-queue X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003856maxconn X X X -
3857mode X X X X
3858monitor fail - X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003859monitor-uri X X X -
3860option abortonclose (*) X - X X
3861option accept-invalid-http-request (*) X X X -
3862option accept-invalid-http-response (*) X - X X
3863option allbackups (*) X - X X
3864option checkcache (*) X - X X
3865option clitcpka (*) X X X -
3866option contstats (*) X X X -
Christopher Faulet89aed322020-06-02 17:33:56 +02003867option disable-h2-upgrade (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003868option dontlog-normal (*) X X X -
3869option dontlognull (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003870-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
3871option forwardfor X X X X
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02003872option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client (*) X X X -
3873option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02003874option http-buffer-request (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau82649f92015-05-01 22:40:51 +02003875option http-ignore-probes (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01003876option http-keep-alive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02003877option http-no-delay (*) X X X X
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02003878option http-pretend-keepalive (*) X - X X
Christopher Faulet18c13d32022-05-16 11:43:10 +02003879option http-restrict-req-hdr-names X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003880option http-server-close (*) X X X X
3881option http-use-proxy-header (*) X X X -
3882option httpchk X - X X
3883option httpclose (*) X X X X
Freddy Spierenburge88b7732019-03-25 14:35:17 +01003884option httplog X X X -
Remi Tricot-Le Breton98b930d2021-07-29 09:45:52 +02003885option httpslog X X X -
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003886option independent-streams (*) X X X X
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02003887option ldap-check X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09003888option external-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003889option log-health-checks (*) X - X X
3890option log-separate-errors (*) X X X -
3891option logasap (*) X X X -
3892option mysql-check X - X X
3893option nolinger (*) X X X X
3894option originalto X X X X
3895option persist (*) X - X X
Baptiste Assmann809e22a2015-10-12 20:22:55 +02003896option pgsql-check X - X X
3897option prefer-last-server (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003898option redispatch (*) X - X X
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02003899option redis-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003900option smtpchk X - X X
3901option socket-stats (*) X X X -
3902option splice-auto (*) X X X X
3903option splice-request (*) X X X X
3904option splice-response (*) X X X X
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +01003905option spop-check - - - X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003906option srvtcpka (*) X - X X
3907option ssl-hello-chk X - X X
3908-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01003909option tcp-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003910option tcp-smart-accept (*) X X X -
3911option tcp-smart-connect (*) X - X X
3912option tcpka X X X X
3913option tcplog X X X X
3914option transparent (*) X - X X
William Dauchya9dd9012022-01-05 22:53:24 +01003915option idle-close-on-response (*) X X X -
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09003916external-check command X - X X
3917external-check path X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003918persist rdp-cookie X - X X
3919rate-limit sessions X X X -
3920redirect - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003921-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003922retries X - X X
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02003923retry-on X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003924server - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02003925server-state-file-name X - X X
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +02003926server-template - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003927source X - X X
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09003928srvtcpka-cnt X - X X
3929srvtcpka-idle X - X X
3930srvtcpka-intvl X - X X
Baptiste Assmann5a549212015-10-12 20:30:24 +02003931stats admin - X X X
3932stats auth X X X X
3933stats enable X X X X
3934stats hide-version X X X X
3935stats http-request - X X X
3936stats realm X X X X
3937stats refresh X X X X
3938stats scope X X X X
3939stats show-desc X X X X
3940stats show-legends X X X X
3941stats show-node X X X X
3942stats uri X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003943-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
3944stick match - - X X
3945stick on - - X X
3946stick store-request - - X X
Willy Tarreaud8dc99f2011-07-01 11:33:25 +02003947stick store-response - - X X
Adam Spiers68af3c12017-04-06 16:31:39 +01003948stick-table - X X X
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02003949tcp-check comment X - X X
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +02003950tcp-check connect X - X X
3951tcp-check expect X - X X
3952tcp-check send X - X X
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +02003953tcp-check send-lf X - X X
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +02003954tcp-check send-binary X - X X
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +02003955tcp-check send-binary-lf X - X X
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +02003956tcp-check set-var X - X X
3957tcp-check unset-var X - X X
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +02003958tcp-request connection X (!) X X -
3959tcp-request content X (!) X X X
3960tcp-request inspect-delay X (!) X X X
3961tcp-request session X (!) X X -
3962tcp-response content X (!) - X X
3963tcp-response inspect-delay X (!) - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003964timeout check X - X X
3965timeout client X X X -
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02003966timeout client-fin X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003967timeout connect X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003968timeout http-keep-alive X X X X
3969timeout http-request X X X X
3970timeout queue X - X X
3971timeout server X - X X
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02003972timeout server-fin X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003973timeout tarpit X X X X
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02003974timeout tunnel X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003975transparent (deprecated) X - X X
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01003976unique-id-format X X X -
3977unique-id-header X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003978use_backend - X X -
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +02003979use-fcgi-app - - X X
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02003980use-server - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003981------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
3982 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003983
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003984
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020039854.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
3986---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003987
3988This section provides a description of each keyword and its usage.
3989
3990
3991acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
3992 Declare or complete an access list.
3993 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +02003994 yes(!) | yes | yes | yes
3995
3996 This directive is only available from named defaults sections, not anonymous
3997 ones. ACLs defined in a defaults section are not visible from other sections
3998 using it.
3999
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004000 Example:
4001 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
4002 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
4003 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
4004
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004005 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004006
4007
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01004008backlog <conns>
4009 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
4010 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4011 yes | yes | yes | no
4012 Arguments :
4013 <conns> is the number of pending connections. Depending on the operating
4014 system, it may represent the number of already acknowledged
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02004015 connections, of non-acknowledged ones, or both.
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01004016
4017 In order to protect against SYN flood attacks, one solution is to increase
4018 the system's SYN backlog size. Depending on the system, sometimes it is just
4019 tunable via a system parameter, sometimes it is not adjustable at all, and
4020 sometimes the system relies on hints given by the application at the time of
4021 the listen() syscall. By default, HAProxy passes the frontend's maxconn value
4022 to the listen() syscall. On systems which can make use of this value, it can
4023 sometimes be useful to be able to specify a different value, hence this
4024 backlog parameter.
4025
4026 On Linux 2.4, the parameter is ignored by the system. On Linux 2.6, it is
4027 used as a hint and the system accepts up to the smallest greater power of
4028 two, and never more than some limits (usually 32768).
4029
4030 See also : "maxconn" and the target operating system's tuning guide.
4031
4032
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004033balance <algorithm> [ <arguments> ]
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02004034balance url_param <param> [check_post]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004035 Define the load balancing algorithm to be used in a backend.
4036 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4037 yes | no | yes | yes
4038 Arguments :
4039 <algorithm> is the algorithm used to select a server when doing load
4040 balancing. This only applies when no persistence information
4041 is available, or when a connection is redispatched to another
4042 server. <algorithm> may be one of the following :
4043
4044 roundrobin Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
4045 This is the smoothest and fairest algorithm when the server's
4046 processing time remains equally distributed. This algorithm
4047 is dynamic, which means that server weights may be adjusted
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02004048 on the fly for slow starts for instance. It is limited by
Godbacha34bdc02013-07-22 07:44:53 +08004049 design to 4095 active servers per backend. Note that in some
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02004050 large farms, when a server becomes up after having been down
4051 for a very short time, it may sometimes take a few hundreds
4052 requests for it to be re-integrated into the farm and start
4053 receiving traffic. This is normal, though very rare. It is
4054 indicated here in case you would have the chance to observe
4055 it, so that you don't worry.
4056
4057 static-rr Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
4058 This algorithm is as similar to roundrobin except that it is
4059 static, which means that changing a server's weight on the
4060 fly will have no effect. On the other hand, it has no design
4061 limitation on the number of servers, and when a server goes
4062 up, it is always immediately reintroduced into the farm, once
4063 the full map is recomputed. It also uses slightly less CPU to
4064 run (around -1%).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004065
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01004066 leastconn The server with the lowest number of connections receives the
4067 connection. Round-robin is performed within groups of servers
4068 of the same load to ensure that all servers will be used. Use
4069 of this algorithm is recommended where very long sessions are
4070 expected, such as LDAP, SQL, TSE, etc... but is not very well
4071 suited for protocols using short sessions such as HTTP. This
4072 algorithm is dynamic, which means that server weights may be
Willy Tarreau8c855f62020-10-22 17:41:45 +02004073 adjusted on the fly for slow starts for instance. It will
4074 also consider the number of queued connections in addition to
4075 the established ones in order to minimize queuing.
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01004076
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01004077 first The first server with available connection slots receives the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03004078 connection. The servers are chosen from the lowest numeric
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01004079 identifier to the highest (see server parameter "id"), which
4080 defaults to the server's position in the farm. Once a server
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02004081 reaches its maxconn value, the next server is used. It does
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01004082 not make sense to use this algorithm without setting maxconn.
4083 The purpose of this algorithm is to always use the smallest
4084 number of servers so that extra servers can be powered off
4085 during non-intensive hours. This algorithm ignores the server
4086 weight, and brings more benefit to long session such as RDP
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02004087 or IMAP than HTTP, though it can be useful there too. In
4088 order to use this algorithm efficiently, it is recommended
4089 that a cloud controller regularly checks server usage to turn
4090 them off when unused, and regularly checks backend queue to
4091 turn new servers on when the queue inflates. Alternatively,
4092 using "http-check send-state" may inform servers on the load.
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01004093
Willy Tarreau7c9a0fe2022-04-25 10:25:34 +02004094 hash Takes a regular sample expression in argument. The expression
4095 is evaluated for each request and hashed according to the
4096 configured hash-type. The result of the hash is divided by
4097 the total weight of the running servers to designate which
4098 server will receive the request. This can be used in place of
4099 "source", "uri", "hdr()", "url_param()", "rdp-cookie" to make
4100 use of a converter, refine the evaluation, or be used to
4101 extract data from local variables for example. When the data
4102 is not available, round robin will apply. This algorithm is
4103 static by default, which means that changing a server's
4104 weight on the fly will have no effect, but this can be
4105 changed using "hash-type".
4106
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004107 source The source IP address is hashed and divided by the total
4108 weight of the running servers to designate which server will
4109 receive the request. This ensures that the same client IP
4110 address will always reach the same server as long as no
4111 server goes down or up. If the hash result changes due to the
4112 number of running servers changing, many clients will be
4113 directed to a different server. This algorithm is generally
4114 used in TCP mode where no cookie may be inserted. It may also
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004115 be used on the Internet to provide a best-effort stickiness
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004116 to clients which refuse session cookies. This algorithm is
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004117 static by default, which means that changing a server's
4118 weight on the fly will have no effect, but this can be
Willy Tarreau7c9a0fe2022-04-25 10:25:34 +02004119 changed using "hash-type". See also the "hash" option above.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004120
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01004121 uri This algorithm hashes either the left part of the URI (before
4122 the question mark) or the whole URI (if the "whole" parameter
4123 is present) and divides the hash value by the total weight of
4124 the running servers. The result designates which server will
4125 receive the request. This ensures that the same URI will
4126 always be directed to the same server as long as no server
4127 goes up or down. This is used with proxy caches and
4128 anti-virus proxies in order to maximize the cache hit rate.
4129 Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP backend.
4130 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
4131 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
4132 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004133
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01004134 This algorithm supports two optional parameters "len" and
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02004135 "depth", both followed by a positive integer number. These
4136 options may be helpful when it is needed to balance servers
4137 based on the beginning of the URI only. The "len" parameter
4138 indicates that the algorithm should only consider that many
4139 characters at the beginning of the URI to compute the hash.
4140 Note that having "len" set to 1 rarely makes sense since most
4141 URIs start with a leading "/".
4142
4143 The "depth" parameter indicates the maximum directory depth
4144 to be used to compute the hash. One level is counted for each
4145 slash in the request. If both parameters are specified, the
4146 evaluation stops when either is reached.
4147
Willy Tarreau57a37412020-09-23 08:56:29 +02004148 A "path-only" parameter indicates that the hashing key starts
4149 at the first '/' of the path. This can be used to ignore the
4150 authority part of absolute URIs, and to make sure that HTTP/1
Willy Tarreau7c9a0fe2022-04-25 10:25:34 +02004151 and HTTP/2 URIs will provide the same hash. See also the
4152 "hash" option above.
Willy Tarreau57a37412020-09-23 08:56:29 +02004153
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004154 url_param The URL parameter specified in argument will be looked up in
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02004155 the query string of each HTTP GET request.
4156
4157 If the modifier "check_post" is used, then an HTTP POST
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02004158 request entity will be searched for the parameter argument,
4159 when it is not found in a query string after a question mark
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02004160 ('?') in the URL. The message body will only start to be
4161 analyzed once either the advertised amount of data has been
4162 received or the request buffer is full. In the unlikely event
4163 that chunked encoding is used, only the first chunk is
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02004164 scanned. Parameter values separated by a chunk boundary, may
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02004165 be randomly balanced if at all. This keyword used to support
4166 an optional <max_wait> parameter which is now ignored.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02004167
4168 If the parameter is found followed by an equal sign ('=') and
4169 a value, then the value is hashed and divided by the total
4170 weight of the running servers. The result designates which
4171 server will receive the request.
4172
4173 This is used to track user identifiers in requests and ensure
4174 that a same user ID will always be sent to the same server as
4175 long as no server goes up or down. If no value is found or if
4176 the parameter is not found, then a round robin algorithm is
4177 applied. Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004178 backend. This algorithm is static by default, which means
4179 that changing a server's weight on the fly will have no
Willy Tarreau7c9a0fe2022-04-25 10:25:34 +02004180 effect, but this can be changed using "hash-type". See also
4181 the "hash" option above.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004182
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02004183 hdr(<name>) The HTTP header <name> will be looked up in each HTTP
4184 request. Just as with the equivalent ACL 'hdr()' function,
4185 the header name in parenthesis is not case sensitive. If the
4186 header is absent or if it does not contain any value, the
4187 roundrobin algorithm is applied instead.
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01004188
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004189 An optional 'use_domain_only' parameter is available, for
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01004190 reducing the hash algorithm to the main domain part with some
4191 specific headers such as 'Host'. For instance, in the Host
4192 value "haproxy.1wt.eu", only "1wt" will be considered.
4193
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004194 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
4195 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
Willy Tarreau7c9a0fe2022-04-25 10:25:34 +02004196 but this can be changed using "hash-type". See also the
4197 "hash" option above.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004198
Willy Tarreau21c741a2019-01-14 18:14:27 +01004199 random
4200 random(<draws>)
4201 A random number will be used as the key for the consistent
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02004202 hashing function. This means that the servers' weights are
4203 respected, dynamic weight changes immediately take effect, as
4204 well as new server additions. Random load balancing can be
4205 useful with large farms or when servers are frequently added
Willy Tarreau21c741a2019-01-14 18:14:27 +01004206 or removed as it may avoid the hammering effect that could
4207 result from roundrobin or leastconn in this situation. The
4208 hash-balance-factor directive can be used to further improve
4209 fairness of the load balancing, especially in situations
4210 where servers show highly variable response times. When an
4211 argument <draws> is present, it must be an integer value one
4212 or greater, indicating the number of draws before selecting
4213 the least loaded of these servers. It was indeed demonstrated
4214 that picking the least loaded of two servers is enough to
4215 significantly improve the fairness of the algorithm, by
4216 always avoiding to pick the most loaded server within a farm
4217 and getting rid of any bias that could be induced by the
4218 unfair distribution of the consistent list. Higher values N
4219 will take away N-1 of the highest loaded servers at the
4220 expense of performance. With very high values, the algorithm
4221 will converge towards the leastconn's result but much slower.
4222 The default value is 2, which generally shows very good
4223 distribution and performance. This algorithm is also known as
4224 the Power of Two Random Choices and is described here :
4225 http://www.eecs.harvard.edu/~michaelm/postscripts/handbook2001.pdf
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02004226
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02004227 rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02004228 rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02004229 The RDP cookie <name> (or "mstshash" if omitted) will be
4230 looked up and hashed for each incoming TCP request. Just as
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +01004231 with the equivalent ACL 'req.rdp_cookie()' function, the name
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02004232 is not case-sensitive. This mechanism is useful as a degraded
4233 persistence mode, as it makes it possible to always send the
4234 same user (or the same session ID) to the same server. If the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004235 cookie is not found, the normal roundrobin algorithm is
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02004236 used instead.
4237
4238 Note that for this to work, the frontend must ensure that an
4239 RDP cookie is already present in the request buffer. For this
4240 you must use 'tcp-request content accept' rule combined with
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +01004241 a 'req.rdp_cookie_cnt' ACL.
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02004242
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004243 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
4244 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
Willy Tarreau7c9a0fe2022-04-25 10:25:34 +02004245 but this can be changed using "hash-type". See also the
4246 "hash" option above.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004247
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004248 <arguments> is an optional list of arguments which may be needed by some
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02004249 algorithms. Right now, only "url_param" and "uri" support an
4250 optional argument.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02004251
Willy Tarreau3cd9af22009-03-15 14:06:41 +01004252 The load balancing algorithm of a backend is set to roundrobin when no other
4253 algorithm, mode nor option have been set. The algorithm may only be set once
4254 for each backend.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004255
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02004256 With authentication schemes that require the same connection like NTLM, URI
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05004257 based algorithms must not be used, as they would cause subsequent requests
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02004258 to be routed to different backend servers, breaking the invalid assumptions
4259 NTLM relies on.
4260
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004261 Examples :
4262 balance roundrobin
4263 balance url_param userid
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02004264 balance url_param session_id check_post 64
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01004265 balance hdr(User-Agent)
4266 balance hdr(host)
4267 balance hdr(Host) use_domain_only
Willy Tarreau7c9a0fe2022-04-25 10:25:34 +02004268 balance hash req.cookie(clientid)
4269 balance hash var(req.client_id)
4270 balance hash req.hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1),ipmask(24)
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02004271
4272 Note: the following caveats and limitations on using the "check_post"
4273 extension with "url_param" must be considered :
4274
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004275 - all POST requests are eligible for consideration, because there is no way
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02004276 to determine if the parameters will be found in the body or entity which
4277 may contain binary data. Therefore another method may be required to
4278 restrict consideration of POST requests that have no URL parameters in
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02004279 the body. (see acl http_end)
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02004280
4281 - using a <max_wait> value larger than the request buffer size does not
4282 make sense and is useless. The buffer size is set at build time, and
4283 defaults to 16 kB.
4284
4285 - Content-Encoding is not supported, the parameter search will probably
4286 fail; and load balancing will fall back to Round Robin.
4287
4288 - Expect: 100-continue is not supported, load balancing will fall back to
4289 Round Robin.
4290
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00004291 - Transfer-Encoding (RFC7230 3.3.1) is only supported in the first chunk.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02004292 If the entire parameter value is not present in the first chunk, the
4293 selection of server is undefined (actually, defined by how little
4294 actually appeared in the first chunk).
4295
4296 - This feature does not support generation of a 100, 411 or 501 response.
4297
4298 - In some cases, requesting "check_post" MAY attempt to scan the entire
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004299 contents of a message body. Scanning normally terminates when linear
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02004300 white space or control characters are found, indicating the end of what
4301 might be a URL parameter list. This is probably not a concern with SGML
4302 type message bodies.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004303
Willy Tarreau25241232021-07-18 19:18:56 +02004304 See also : "dispatch", "cookie", "transparent", "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004305
4306
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02004307bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
4308bind /<path> [, ...] [param*]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004309 Define one or several listening addresses and/or ports in a frontend.
4310 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4311 no | yes | yes | no
4312 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01004313 <address> is optional and can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6
4314 address, or '*'. It designates the address the frontend will
4315 listen on. If unset, all IPv4 addresses of the system will be
4316 listened on. The same will apply for '*' or the system's
David du Colombier9c938da2011-03-17 10:40:27 +01004317 special address "0.0.0.0". The IPv6 equivalent is '::'.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01004318 Optionally, an address family prefix may be used before the
4319 address to force the family regardless of the address format,
4320 which can be useful to specify a path to a unix socket with
4321 no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
4322 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
4323 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
Emeric Brun3835c0d2020-07-07 09:46:09 +02004324 - 'udp@' -> address is resolved as IPv4 or IPv6 and
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02004325 protocol UDP is used. Currently those listeners are
4326 supported only in log-forward sections.
Emeric Brun3835c0d2020-07-07 09:46:09 +02004327 - 'udp4@' -> address is always IPv4 and protocol UDP
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02004328 is used. Currently those listeners are supported
4329 only in log-forward sections.
Emeric Brun3835c0d2020-07-07 09:46:09 +02004330 - 'udp6@' -> address is always IPv6 and protocol UDP
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02004331 is used. Currently those listeners are supported
4332 only in log-forward sections.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01004333 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreau70f72e02014-07-08 00:37:50 +02004334 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only).
Willy Tarreau40aa0702013-03-10 23:51:38 +01004335 - 'fd@<n>' -> use file descriptor <n> inherited from the
4336 parent. The fd must be bound and may or may not already
4337 be listening.
William Lallemand2fe7dd02018-09-11 16:51:29 +02004338 - 'sockpair@<n>'-> like fd@ but you must use the fd of a
4339 connected unix socket or of a socketpair. The bind waits
4340 to receive a FD over the unix socket and uses it as if it
4341 was the FD of an accept(). Should be used carefully.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02004342 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
4343 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
4344 variables.
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01004345
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01004346 <port_range> is either a unique TCP port, or a port range for which the
4347 proxy will accept connections for the IP address specified
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01004348 above. The port is mandatory for TCP listeners. Note that in
4349 the case of an IPv6 address, the port is always the number
4350 after the last colon (':'). A range can either be :
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01004351 - a numerical port (ex: '80')
4352 - a dash-delimited ports range explicitly stating the lower
4353 and upper bounds (ex: '2000-2100') which are included in
4354 the range.
4355
4356 Particular care must be taken against port ranges, because
4357 every <address:port> couple consumes one socket (= a file
4358 descriptor), so it's easy to consume lots of descriptors
4359 with a simple range, and to run out of sockets. Also, each
4360 <address:port> couple must be used only once among all
4361 instances running on a same system. Please note that binding
4362 to ports lower than 1024 generally require particular
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004363 privileges to start the program, which are independent of
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01004364 the 'uid' parameter.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004365
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01004366 <path> is a UNIX socket path beginning with a slash ('/'). This is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004367 alternative to the TCP listening port. HAProxy will then
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01004368 receive UNIX connections on the socket located at this place.
4369 The path must begin with a slash and by default is absolute.
4370 It can be relative to the prefix defined by "unix-bind" in
4371 the global section. Note that the total length of the prefix
4372 followed by the socket path cannot exceed some system limits
4373 for UNIX sockets, which commonly are set to 107 characters.
4374
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02004375 <param*> is a list of parameters common to all sockets declared on the
4376 same line. These numerous parameters depend on OS and build
4377 options and have a complete section dedicated to them. Please
4378 refer to section 5 to for more details.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02004379
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004380 It is possible to specify a list of address:port combinations delimited by
4381 commas. The frontend will then listen on all of these addresses. There is no
4382 fixed limit to the number of addresses and ports which can be listened on in
4383 a frontend, as well as there is no limit to the number of "bind" statements
4384 in a frontend.
4385
4386 Example :
4387 listen http_proxy
4388 bind :80,:443
4389 bind 10.0.0.1:10080,10.0.0.1:10443
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01004390 bind /var/run/ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004391
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02004392 listen http_https_proxy
4393 bind :80
Cyril Bonté0d44fc62012-10-09 22:45:33 +02004394 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02004395
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01004396 listen http_https_proxy_explicit
4397 bind ipv6@:80
4398 bind ipv4@public_ssl:443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
4399 bind unix@ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
4400
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01004401 listen external_bind_app1
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02004402 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01004403
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +02004404 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
4405 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
4406 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
4407 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
4408 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
4409
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01004410 See also : "source", "option forwardfor", "unix-bind" and the PROXY protocol
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02004411 documentation, and section 5 about bind options.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004412
4413
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01004414bind-process [ all | odd | even | <process_num>[-[<process_num>]] ] ...
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01004415 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4416 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01004417
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +02004418 Deprecated. Before threads were supported, this was used to force some
4419 frontends on certain processes only, or to adjust backends so that they
4420 could match the frontends that used them. The default and only accepted
4421 value is "1" (along with "all" and "odd" which alias it). Do not use this
4422 setting. Threads can still be bound per-socket using the "process" bind
4423 keyword.
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01004424
Willy Tarreaub63dbb72021-06-11 16:50:29 +02004425 See also : "process" in section 5.1.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01004426
4427
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004428capture cookie <name> len <length>
4429 Capture and log a cookie in the request and in the response.
4430 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4431 no | yes | yes | no
4432 Arguments :
4433 <name> is the beginning of the name of the cookie to capture. In order
4434 to match the exact name, simply suffix the name with an equal
4435 sign ('='). The full name will appear in the logs, which is
4436 useful with application servers which adjust both the cookie name
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004437 and value (e.g. ASPSESSIONXXX).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004438
4439 <length> is the maximum number of characters to report in the logs, which
4440 include the cookie name, the equal sign and the value, all in the
4441 standard "name=value" form. The string will be truncated on the
4442 right if it exceeds <length>.
4443
4444 Only the first cookie is captured. Both the "cookie" request headers and the
4445 "set-cookie" response headers are monitored. This is particularly useful to
4446 check for application bugs causing session crossing or stealing between
4447 users, because generally the user's cookies can only change on a login page.
4448
4449 When the cookie was not presented by the client, the associated log column
4450 will report "-". When a request does not cause a cookie to be assigned by the
4451 server, a "-" is reported in the response column.
4452
4453 The capture is performed in the frontend only because it is necessary that
4454 the log format does not change for a given frontend depending on the
4455 backends. This may change in the future. Note that there can be only one
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01004456 "capture cookie" statement in a frontend. The maximum capture length is set
4457 by the global "tune.http.cookielen" setting and defaults to 63 characters. It
4458 is not possible to specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004459
4460 Example:
4461 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
4462
4463 See also : "capture request header", "capture response header" as well as
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004464 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004465
4466
4467capture request header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01004468 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified request header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004469 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4470 no | yes | yes | no
4471 Arguments :
4472 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004473 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004474 appear in the requests, with the first letter of each word in
4475 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
4476 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
4477
4478 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
4479 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
4480 it exceeds <length>.
4481
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01004482 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004483 value will be added to the logs between braces ('{}'). If multiple headers
4484 are captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar ('|') and will appear
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01004485 in the same order they were declared in the configuration. Non-existent
4486 headers will be logged just as an empty string. Common uses for request
4487 header captures include the "Host" field in virtual hosting environments, the
4488 "Content-length" when uploads are supported, "User-agent" to quickly
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004489 differentiate between real users and robots, and "X-Forwarded-For" in proxied
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01004490 environments to find where the request came from.
4491
4492 Note that when capturing headers such as "User-agent", some spaces may be
4493 logged, making the log analysis more difficult. Thus be careful about what
4494 you log if you know your log parser is not smart enough to rely on the
4495 braces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004496
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01004497 There is no limit to the number of captured request headers nor to their
4498 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
4499 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
4500 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
4501 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004502
4503 Example:
4504 capture request header Host len 15
4505 capture request header X-Forwarded-For len 15
Cyril Bontéd1b0f7c2015-10-26 22:37:39 +01004506 capture request header Referer len 15
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004507
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004508 See also : "capture cookie", "capture response header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004509 about logging.
4510
4511
4512capture response header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01004513 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified response header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004514 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4515 no | yes | yes | no
4516 Arguments :
4517 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004518 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004519 appear in the response, with the first letter of each word in
4520 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
4521 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
4522
4523 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
4524 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
4525 it exceeds <length>.
4526
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01004527 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004528 result will be added to the logs between braces ('{}') after the captured
4529 request headers. If multiple headers are captured, they will be delimited by
4530 a vertical bar ('|') and will appear in the same order they were declared in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01004531 the configuration. Non-existent headers will be logged just as an empty
4532 string. Common uses for response header captures include the "Content-length"
4533 header which indicates how many bytes are expected to be returned, the
4534 "Location" header to track redirections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004535
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01004536 There is no limit to the number of captured response headers nor to their
4537 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
4538 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
4539 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
4540 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004541
4542 Example:
4543 capture response header Content-length len 9
4544 capture response header Location len 15
4545
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004546 See also : "capture cookie", "capture request header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004547 about logging.
4548
4549
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09004550clitcpka-cnt <count>
4551 Sets the maximum number of keepalive probes TCP should send before dropping
4552 the connection on the client side.
4553 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4554 yes | yes | yes | no
4555 Arguments :
4556 <count> is the maximum number of keepalive probes.
4557
4558 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPCNT. If this keyword
4559 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_probes) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +02004560 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
4561 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09004562
4563 See also : "option clitcpka", "clitcpka-idle", "clitcpka-intvl".
4564
4565
4566clitcpka-idle <timeout>
4567 Sets the time the connection needs to remain idle before TCP starts sending
4568 keepalive probes, if enabled the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the
4569 client side.
4570 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4571 yes | yes | yes | no
4572 Arguments :
4573 <timeout> is the time the connection needs to remain idle before TCP starts
4574 sending keepalive probes. It is specified in seconds by default,
4575 but can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the
4576 unit, as explained at the top of this document.
4577
4578 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPIDLE. If this keyword
4579 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_time) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +02004580 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
4581 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09004582
4583 See also : "option clitcpka", "clitcpka-cnt", "clitcpka-intvl".
4584
4585
4586clitcpka-intvl <timeout>
4587 Sets the time between individual keepalive probes on the client side.
4588 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4589 yes | yes | yes | no
4590 Arguments :
4591 <timeout> is the time between individual keepalive probes. It is specified
4592 in seconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number
4593 is suffixed by the unit, as explained at the top of this
4594 document.
4595
4596 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPINTVL. If this keyword
4597 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_intvl) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +02004598 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
4599 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09004600
4601 See also : "option clitcpka", "clitcpka-cnt", "clitcpka-idle".
4602
4603
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004604compression algo <algorithm> ...
4605compression type <mime type> ...
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02004606 Enable HTTP compression.
4607 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4608 yes | yes | yes | yes
4609 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004610 algo is followed by the list of supported compression algorithms.
4611 type is followed by the list of MIME types that will be compressed.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004612
4613 The currently supported algorithms are :
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01004614 identity this is mostly for debugging, and it was useful for developing
4615 the compression feature. Identity does not apply any change on
4616 data.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004617
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01004618 gzip applies gzip compression. This setting is only available when
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01004619 support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01004620
4621 deflate same as "gzip", but with deflate algorithm and zlib format.
4622 Note that this algorithm has ambiguous support on many
4623 browsers and no support at all from recent ones. It is
4624 strongly recommended not to use it for anything else than
4625 experimentation. This setting is only available when support
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01004626 for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004627
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01004628 raw-deflate same as "deflate" without the zlib wrapper, and used as an
4629 alternative when the browser wants "deflate". All major
4630 browsers understand it and despite violating the standards,
4631 it is known to work better than "deflate", at least on MSIE
4632 and some versions of Safari. Do not use it in conjunction
4633 with "deflate", use either one or the other since both react
4634 to the same Accept-Encoding token. This setting is only
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01004635 available when support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004636
Dmitry Sivachenko87c208b2012-11-22 20:03:26 +04004637 Compression will be activated depending on the Accept-Encoding request
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004638 header. With identity, it does not take care of that header.
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04004639 If backend servers support HTTP compression, these directives
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004640 will be no-op: HAProxy will see the compressed response and will not
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04004641 compress again. If backend servers do not support HTTP compression and
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004642 there is Accept-Encoding header in request, HAProxy will compress the
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04004643 matching response.
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02004644
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01004645 Compression is disabled when:
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01004646 * the request does not advertise a supported compression algorithm in the
4647 "Accept-Encoding" header
Julien Pivottoff80c822021-03-29 12:41:40 +02004648 * the response message is not HTTP/1.1 or above
Tim Duesterhusbb48c9a2019-01-30 23:46:04 +01004649 * HTTP status code is not one of 200, 201, 202, or 203
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01004650 * response contain neither a "Content-Length" header nor a
4651 "Transfer-Encoding" whose last value is "chunked"
4652 * response contains a "Content-Type" header whose first value starts with
4653 "multipart"
4654 * the response contains the "no-transform" value in the "Cache-control"
4655 header
4656 * User-Agent matches "Mozilla/4" unless it is MSIE 6 with XP SP2, or MSIE 7
4657 and later
4658 * The response contains a "Content-Encoding" header, indicating that the
4659 response is already compressed (see compression offload)
Tim Duesterhusbb48c9a2019-01-30 23:46:04 +01004660 * The response contains an invalid "ETag" header or multiple ETag headers
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01004661
Tim Duesterhusb229f012019-01-29 16:38:56 +01004662 Note: The compression does not emit the Warning header.
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01004663
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02004664 Examples :
4665 compression algo gzip
4666 compression type text/html text/plain
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004667
Christopher Faulet44d34bf2021-11-05 12:06:14 +01004668 See also : "compression offload"
4669
4670compression offload
4671 Makes HAProxy work as a compression offloader only.
4672 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4673 no | yes | yes | yes
4674
4675 The "offload" setting makes HAProxy remove the Accept-Encoding header to
4676 prevent backend servers from compressing responses. It is strongly
4677 recommended not to do this because this means that all the compression work
4678 will be done on the single point where HAProxy is located. However in some
4679 deployment scenarios, HAProxy may be installed in front of a buggy gateway
4680 with broken HTTP compression implementation which can't be turned off.
4681 In that case HAProxy can be used to prevent that gateway from emitting
4682 invalid payloads. In this case, simply removing the header in the
4683 configuration does not work because it applies before the header is parsed,
4684 so that prevents HAProxy from compressing. The "offload" setting should
4685 then be used for such scenarios.
4686
4687 If this setting is used in a defaults section, a warning is emitted and the
4688 option is ignored.
4689
4690 See also : "compression type", "compression algo"
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02004691
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02004692cookie <name> [ rewrite | insert | prefix ] [ indirect ] [ nocache ]
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02004693 [ postonly ] [ preserve ] [ httponly ] [ secure ]
4694 [ domain <domain> ]* [ maxidle <idle> ] [ maxlife <life> ]
Christopher Faulet2f533902020-01-21 11:06:48 +01004695 [ dynamic ] [ attr <value> ]*
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004696 Enable cookie-based persistence in a backend.
4697 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4698 yes | no | yes | yes
4699 Arguments :
4700 <name> is the name of the cookie which will be monitored, modified or
4701 inserted in order to bring persistence. This cookie is sent to
4702 the client via a "Set-Cookie" header in the response, and is
4703 brought back by the client in a "Cookie" header in all requests.
4704 Special care should be taken to choose a name which does not
4705 conflict with any likely application cookie. Also, if the same
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004706 backends are subject to be used by the same clients (e.g.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004707 HTTP/HTTPS), care should be taken to use different cookie names
4708 between all backends if persistence between them is not desired.
4709
4710 rewrite This keyword indicates that the cookie will be provided by the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004711 server and that HAProxy will have to modify its value to set the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004712 server's identifier in it. This mode is handy when the management
4713 of complex combinations of "Set-cookie" and "Cache-control"
4714 headers is left to the application. The application can then
4715 decide whether or not it is appropriate to emit a persistence
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01004716 cookie. Since all responses should be monitored, this mode
4717 doesn't work in HTTP tunnel mode. Unless the application
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004718 behavior is very complex and/or broken, it is advised not to
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01004719 start with this mode for new deployments. This keyword is
4720 incompatible with "insert" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004721
4722 insert This keyword indicates that the persistence cookie will have to
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004723 be inserted by HAProxy in server responses if the client did not
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004724
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02004725 already have a cookie that would have permitted it to access this
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004726 server. When used without the "preserve" option, if the server
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02004727 emits a cookie with the same name, it will be removed before
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004728 processing. For this reason, this mode can be used to upgrade
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004729 existing configurations running in the "rewrite" mode. The cookie
4730 will only be a session cookie and will not be stored on the
4731 client's disk. By default, unless the "indirect" option is added,
4732 the server will see the cookies emitted by the client. Due to
4733 caching effects, it is generally wise to add the "nocache" or
4734 "postonly" keywords (see below). The "insert" keyword is not
4735 compatible with "rewrite" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004736
4737 prefix This keyword indicates that instead of relying on a dedicated
4738 cookie for the persistence, an existing one will be completed.
4739 This may be needed in some specific environments where the client
4740 does not support more than one single cookie and the application
4741 already needs it. In this case, whenever the server sets a cookie
4742 named <name>, it will be prefixed with the server's identifier
4743 and a delimiter. The prefix will be removed from all client
4744 requests so that the server still finds the cookie it emitted.
4745 Since all requests and responses are subject to being modified,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01004746 this mode doesn't work with tunnel mode. The "prefix" keyword is
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02004747 not compatible with "rewrite" and "insert". Note: it is highly
4748 recommended not to use "indirect" with "prefix", otherwise server
4749 cookie updates would not be sent to clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004750
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02004751 indirect When this option is specified, no cookie will be emitted to a
4752 client which already has a valid one for the server which has
4753 processed the request. If the server sets such a cookie itself,
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004754 it will be removed, unless the "preserve" option is also set. In
4755 "insert" mode, this will additionally remove cookies from the
4756 requests transmitted to the server, making the persistence
4757 mechanism totally transparent from an application point of view.
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02004758 Note: it is highly recommended not to use "indirect" with
4759 "prefix", otherwise server cookie updates would not be sent to
4760 clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004761
4762 nocache This option is recommended in conjunction with the insert mode
4763 when there is a cache between the client and HAProxy, as it
4764 ensures that a cacheable response will be tagged non-cacheable if
4765 a cookie needs to be inserted. This is important because if all
4766 persistence cookies are added on a cacheable home page for
4767 instance, then all customers will then fetch the page from an
4768 outer cache and will all share the same persistence cookie,
4769 leading to one server receiving much more traffic than others.
4770 See also the "insert" and "postonly" options.
4771
4772 postonly This option ensures that cookie insertion will only be performed
4773 on responses to POST requests. It is an alternative to the
4774 "nocache" option, because POST responses are not cacheable, so
4775 this ensures that the persistence cookie will never get cached.
4776 Since most sites do not need any sort of persistence before the
4777 first POST which generally is a login request, this is a very
4778 efficient method to optimize caching without risking to find a
4779 persistence cookie in the cache.
4780 See also the "insert" and "nocache" options.
4781
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004782 preserve This option may only be used with "insert" and/or "indirect". It
4783 allows the server to emit the persistence cookie itself. In this
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004784 case, if a cookie is found in the response, HAProxy will leave it
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004785 untouched. This is useful in order to end persistence after a
4786 logout request for instance. For this, the server just has to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004787 emit a cookie with an invalid value (e.g. empty) or with a date in
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004788 the past. By combining this mechanism with the "disable-on-404"
4789 check option, it is possible to perform a completely graceful
4790 shutdown because users will definitely leave the server after
4791 they logout.
4792
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004793 httponly This option tells HAProxy to add an "HttpOnly" cookie attribute
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02004794 when a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a
4795 user agent doesn't share the cookie with non-HTTP components.
4796 Please check RFC6265 for more information on this attribute.
4797
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004798 secure This option tells HAProxy to add a "Secure" cookie attribute when
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02004799 a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a user agent
4800 never emits this cookie over non-secure channels, which means
4801 that a cookie learned with this flag will be presented only over
4802 SSL/TLS connections. Please check RFC6265 for more information on
4803 this attribute.
4804
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02004805 domain This option allows to specify the domain at which a cookie is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004806 inserted. It requires exactly one parameter: a valid domain
Willy Tarreau68a897b2009-12-03 23:28:34 +01004807 name. If the domain begins with a dot, the browser is allowed to
4808 use it for any host ending with that name. It is also possible to
4809 specify several domain names by invoking this option multiple
4810 times. Some browsers might have small limits on the number of
4811 domains, so be careful when doing that. For the record, sending
4812 10 domains to MSIE 6 or Firefox 2 works as expected.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02004813
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02004814 maxidle This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some idle
4815 time. It only works with insert-mode cookies. When a cookie is
4816 sent to the client, the date this cookie was emitted is sent too.
4817 Upon further presentations of this cookie, if the date is older
4818 than the delay indicated by the parameter (in seconds), it will
4819 be ignored. Otherwise, it will be refreshed if needed when the
4820 response is sent to the client. This is particularly useful to
4821 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004822 too long on the same server (e.g. after a farm size change). When
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02004823 this option is set and a cookie has no date, it is always
4824 accepted, but gets refreshed in the response. This maintains the
4825 ability for admins to access their sites. Cookies that have a
4826 date in the future further than 24 hours are ignored. Doing so
4827 lets admins fix timezone issues without risking kicking users off
4828 the site.
4829
4830 maxlife This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some life
4831 time, whether they're in use or not. It only works with insert
4832 mode cookies. When a cookie is first sent to the client, the date
4833 this cookie was emitted is sent too. Upon further presentations
4834 of this cookie, if the date is older than the delay indicated by
4835 the parameter (in seconds), it will be ignored. If the cookie in
4836 the request has no date, it is accepted and a date will be set.
4837 Cookies that have a date in the future further than 24 hours are
4838 ignored. Doing so lets admins fix timezone issues without risking
4839 kicking users off the site. Contrary to maxidle, this value is
4840 not refreshed, only the first visit date counts. Both maxidle and
4841 maxlife may be used at the time. This is particularly useful to
4842 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004843 too long on the same server (e.g. after a farm size change). This
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02004844 is stronger than the maxidle method in that it forces a
4845 redispatch after some absolute delay.
4846
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01004847 dynamic Activate dynamic cookies. When used, a session cookie is
4848 dynamically created for each server, based on the IP and port
4849 of the server, and a secret key, specified in the
4850 "dynamic-cookie-key" backend directive.
4851 The cookie will be regenerated each time the IP address change,
4852 and is only generated for IPv4/IPv6.
4853
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004854 attr This option tells HAProxy to add an extra attribute when a
Christopher Faulet2f533902020-01-21 11:06:48 +01004855 cookie is inserted. The attribute value can contain any
4856 characters except control ones or ";". This option may be
4857 repeated.
4858
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004859 There can be only one persistence cookie per HTTP backend, and it can be
4860 declared in a defaults section. The value of the cookie will be the value
4861 indicated after the "cookie" keyword in a "server" statement. If no cookie
4862 is declared for a given server, the cookie is not set.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02004863
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004864 Examples :
4865 cookie JSESSIONID prefix
4866 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
4867 cookie SRV insert postonly indirect
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02004868 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache maxidle 30m maxlife 8h
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004869
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02004870 See also : "balance source", "capture cookie", "server" and "ignore-persist".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004871
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01004872
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02004873declare capture [ request | response ] len <length>
4874 Declares a capture slot.
4875 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4876 no | yes | yes | no
4877 Arguments:
4878 <length> is the length allowed for the capture.
4879
4880 This declaration is only available in the frontend or listen section, but the
4881 reserved slot can be used in the backends. The "request" keyword allocates a
4882 capture slot for use in the request, and "response" allocates a capture slot
4883 for use in the response.
4884
4885 See also: "capture-req", "capture-res" (sample converters),
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +02004886 "capture.req.hdr", "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches),
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02004887 "http-request capture" and "http-response capture".
4888
4889
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01004890default-server [param*]
4891 Change default options for a server in a backend
4892 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4893 yes | no | yes | yes
4894 Arguments:
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01004895 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
4896 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
4897 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
4898 details.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01004899
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01004900 Example :
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01004901 default-server inter 1000 weight 13
4902
4903 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004904
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01004905
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004906default_backend <backend>
4907 Specify the backend to use when no "use_backend" rule has been matched.
4908 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4909 yes | yes | yes | no
4910 Arguments :
4911 <backend> is the name of the backend to use.
4912
4913 When doing content-switching between frontend and backends using the
4914 "use_backend" keyword, it is often useful to indicate which backend will be
4915 used when no rule has matched. It generally is the dynamic backend which
4916 will catch all undetermined requests.
4917
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004918 Example :
4919
4920 use_backend dynamic if url_dyn
4921 use_backend static if url_css url_img extension_img
4922 default_backend dynamic
4923
Willy Tarreau98d04852015-05-26 12:18:29 +02004924 See also : "use_backend"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004925
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004926
Baptiste Assmann27f51342013-10-09 06:51:49 +02004927description <string>
4928 Describe a listen, frontend or backend.
4929 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4930 no | yes | yes | yes
4931 Arguments : string
4932
4933 Allows to add a sentence to describe the related object in the HAProxy HTML
4934 stats page. The description will be printed on the right of the object name
4935 it describes.
4936 No need to backslash spaces in the <string> arguments.
4937
4938
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004939disabled
4940 Disable a proxy, frontend or backend.
4941 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4942 yes | yes | yes | yes
4943 Arguments : none
4944
4945 The "disabled" keyword is used to disable an instance, mainly in order to
4946 liberate a listening port or to temporarily disable a service. The instance
4947 will still be created and its configuration will be checked, but it will be
4948 created in the "stopped" state and will appear as such in the statistics. It
4949 will not receive any traffic nor will it send any health-checks or logs. It
4950 is possible to disable many instances at once by adding the "disabled"
4951 keyword in a "defaults" section.
4952
4953 See also : "enabled"
4954
4955
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02004956dispatch <address>:<port>
4957 Set a default server address
4958 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4959 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02004960 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02004961
4962 <address> is the IPv4 address of the default server. Alternatively, a
4963 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
4964 during start-up.
4965
4966 <ports> is a mandatory port specification. All connections will be sent
4967 to this port, and it is not permitted to use port offsets as is
4968 possible with normal servers.
4969
Willy Tarreau787aed52011-04-15 06:45:37 +02004970 The "dispatch" keyword designates a default server for use when no other
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02004971 server can take the connection. In the past it was used to forward non
4972 persistent connections to an auxiliary load balancer. Due to its simple
4973 syntax, it has also been used for simple TCP relays. It is recommended not to
4974 use it for more clarity, and to use the "server" directive instead.
4975
4976 See also : "server"
4977
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01004978
4979dynamic-cookie-key <string>
4980 Set the dynamic cookie secret key for a backend.
4981 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4982 yes | no | yes | yes
4983 Arguments : The secret key to be used.
4984
4985 When dynamic cookies are enabled (see the "dynamic" directive for cookie),
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004986 a dynamic cookie is created for each server (unless one is explicitly
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01004987 specified on the "server" line), using a hash of the IP address of the
4988 server, the TCP port, and the secret key.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004989 That way, we can ensure session persistence across multiple load-balancers,
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01004990 even if servers are dynamically added or removed.
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02004991
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004992enabled
4993 Enable a proxy, frontend or backend.
4994 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4995 yes | yes | yes | yes
4996 Arguments : none
4997
4998 The "enabled" keyword is used to explicitly enable an instance, when the
4999 defaults has been set to "disabled". This is very rarely used.
5000
5001 See also : "disabled"
5002
5003
5004errorfile <code> <file>
5005 Return a file contents instead of errors generated by HAProxy
5006 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5007 yes | yes | yes | yes
5008 Arguments :
5009 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02005010 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01005011 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005012
5013 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01005014 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005015 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01005016 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
5017 before any chroot is performed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005018
5019 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
5020 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
5021 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
5022
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02005023 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
5024
Christopher Faulet70170672020-05-18 17:42:48 +02005025 The files are parsed when HAProxy starts and must be valid according to the
5026 HTTP specification. They should not exceed the configured buffer size
5027 (BUFSIZE), which generally is 16 kB, otherwise an internal error will be
5028 returned. It is also wise not to put any reference to local contents
5029 (e.g. images) in order to avoid loops between the client and HAProxy when all
5030 servers are down, causing an error to be returned instead of an
5031 image. Finally, The response cannot exceed (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite)
5032 so that "http-after-response" rules still have room to operate (see
5033 "tune.maxrewrite").
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01005034
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005035 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
5036 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
5037 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running. A
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005038 simple method for developing those files consists in associating them to the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005039 403 status code and interrogating a blocked URL.
5040
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02005041 See also : "http-error", "errorloc", "errorloc302", "errorloc303"
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005042
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01005043 Example :
5044 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/400badreq.http
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01005045 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01005046 errorfile 403 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/403forbid.http
5047 errorfile 503 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/503sorry.http
5048
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005049
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01005050errorfiles <name> [<code> ...]
5051 Import, fully or partially, the error files defined in the <name> http-errors
5052 section.
5053 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5054 yes | yes | yes | yes
5055 Arguments :
5056 <name> is the name of an existing http-errors section.
5057
5058 <code> is a HTTP status code. Several status code may be listed.
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02005059 Currently, HAProxy is capable of generating codes 200, 400, 401,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01005060 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503,
5061 and 504.
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01005062
5063 Errors defined in the http-errors section with the name <name> are imported
5064 in the current proxy. If no status code is specified, all error files of the
5065 http-errors section are imported. Otherwise, only error files associated to
5066 the listed status code are imported. Those error files override the already
5067 defined custom errors for the proxy. And they may be overridden by following
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005068 ones. Functionally, it is exactly the same as declaring all error files by
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01005069 hand using "errorfile" directives.
5070
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02005071 See also : "http-error", "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302" ,
5072 "errorloc303" and section 3.8 about http-errors.
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01005073
5074 Example :
5075 errorfiles generic
5076 errorfiles site-1 403 404
5077
5078
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005079errorloc <code> <url>
5080errorloc302 <code> <url>
5081 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
5082 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5083 yes | yes | yes | yes
5084 Arguments :
5085 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02005086 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01005087 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005088
5089 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
5090 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
5091 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
5092 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005093 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (e.g. 500).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005094
5095 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
5096 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
5097 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
5098
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02005099 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
5100
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005101 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 302 status code, which tells the
5102 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP method. This can be
5103 quite problematic in case of non-GET methods such as POST, because the URL
5104 sent to the client might not be allowed for something other than GET. To
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01005105 work around this problem, please use "errorloc303" which send the HTTP 303
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005106 status code, indicating to the client that the URL must be fetched with a GET
5107 request.
5108
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02005109 See also : "http-error", "errorfile", "errorloc303"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005110
5111
5112errorloc303 <code> <url>
5113 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
5114 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5115 yes | yes | yes | yes
5116 Arguments :
5117 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02005118 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01005119 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005120
5121 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
5122 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
5123 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
5124 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005125 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (e.g. 500).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005126
5127 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
5128 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
5129 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
5130
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02005131 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
5132
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005133 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 303 status code, which tells the
5134 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP GET method. This
5135 solves the usual problems associated with "errorloc" and the 302 code. It is
5136 possible that some very old browsers designed before HTTP/1.1 do not support
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01005137 it, but no such problem has been reported till now.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005138
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02005139 See also : "http-error", "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005140
5141
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09005142email-alert from <emailaddr>
5143 Declare the from email address to be used in both the envelope and header
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005144 of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent from.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09005145 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5146 yes | yes | yes | yes
5147
5148 Arguments :
5149
5150 <emailaddr> is the from email address to use when sending email alerts
5151
5152 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
5153 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
5154
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09005155 See also : "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02005156 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to", section 3.6 about
5157 mailers.
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09005158
5159
5160email-alert level <level>
5161 Declare the maximum log level of messages for which email alerts will be
5162 sent. This acts as a filter on the sending of email alerts.
5163 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5164 yes | yes | yes | yes
5165
5166 Arguments :
5167
5168 <level> One of the 8 syslog levels:
5169 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
5170 The above syslog levels are ordered from lowest to highest.
5171
5172 By default level is alert
5173
5174 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
5175 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
5176 for the proxy.
5177
Simon Horman1421e212015-04-30 13:10:35 +09005178 Alerts are sent when :
5179
5180 * An un-paused server is marked as down and <level> is alert or lower
5181 * A paused server is marked as down and <level> is notice or lower
5182 * A server is marked as up or enters the drain state and <level>
5183 is notice or lower
5184 * "option log-health-checks" is enabled, <level> is info or lower,
5185 and a health check status update occurs
5186
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09005187 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers",
5188 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09005189 section 3.6 about mailers.
5190
5191
5192email-alert mailers <mailersect>
5193 Declare the mailers to be used when sending email alerts
5194 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5195 yes | yes | yes | yes
5196
5197 Arguments :
5198
5199 <mailersect> is the name of the mailers section to send email alerts.
5200
5201 Also requires "email-alert from" and "email-alert to" to be set
5202 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
5203
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09005204 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert myhostname",
5205 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09005206
5207
5208email-alert myhostname <hostname>
5209 Declare the to hostname address to be used when communicating with
5210 mailers.
5211 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5212 yes | yes | yes | yes
5213
5214 Arguments :
5215
Baptiste Assmann738bad92015-12-21 15:27:53 +01005216 <hostname> is the hostname to use when communicating with mailers
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09005217
5218 By default the systems hostname is used.
5219
5220 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
5221 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
5222 for the proxy.
5223
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09005224 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
5225 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09005226
5227
5228email-alert to <emailaddr>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005229 Declare both the recipient address in the envelope and to address in the
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09005230 header of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent to.
5231 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5232 yes | yes | yes | yes
5233
5234 Arguments :
5235
5236 <emailaddr> is the to email address to use when sending email alerts
5237
5238 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
5239 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
5240
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09005241 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09005242 "email-alert myhostname", section 3.6 about mailers.
5243
5244
Remi Tricot-Le Bretonfe21fe72021-08-31 12:08:52 +02005245error-log-format <string>
5246 Specifies the log format string to use in case of connection error on the frontend side.
5247 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5248 yes | yes | yes | no
5249
5250 This directive specifies the log format string that will be used for logs
5251 containing information related to errors, timeouts, retries redispatches or
5252 HTTP status code 5xx. This format will in short be used for every log line
5253 that would be concerned by the "log-separate-errors" option, including
Willy Tarreauec5c1102021-11-06 09:18:33 +01005254 connection errors described in section 8.2.5.
5255
Remi Tricot-Le Bretonfe21fe72021-08-31 12:08:52 +02005256 If the directive is used in a defaults section, all subsequent frontends will
5257 use the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4 which covers the log format
5258 string in depth.
5259
5260 "error-log-format" directive overrides previous "error-log-format"
5261 directives.
5262
5263
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01005264force-persist { if | unless } <condition>
5265 Declare a condition to force persistence on down servers
5266 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01005267 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01005268
5269 By default, requests are not dispatched to down servers. It is possible to
5270 force this using "option persist", but it is unconditional and redispatches
5271 to a valid server if "option redispatch" is set. That leaves with very little
5272 possibilities to force some requests to reach a server which is artificially
5273 marked down for maintenance operations.
5274
5275 The "force-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
5276 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore the down status of
5277 a server and still try to connect to it. That makes it possible to start a
5278 server, still replying an error to the health checks, and run a specially
5279 configured browser to test the service. Among the handy methods, one could
5280 use a specific source IP address, or a specific cookie. The cookie also has
5281 the advantage that it can easily be added/removed on the browser from a test
5282 page. Once the service is validated, it is then possible to open the service
5283 to the world by returning a valid response to health checks.
5284
5285 The forced persistence is enabled when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
5286 "unless" condition is met. The final redispatch is always disabled when this
5287 is used.
5288
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005289 See also : "option redispatch", "ignore-persist", "persist",
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02005290 and section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01005291
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02005292
5293filter <name> [param*]
5294 Add the filter <name> in the filter list attached to the proxy.
5295 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5296 no | yes | yes | yes
5297 Arguments :
5298 <name> is the name of the filter. Officially supported filters are
5299 referenced in section 9.
5300
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01005301 <param*> is a list of parameters accepted by the filter <name>. The
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02005302 parsing of these parameters are the responsibility of the
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01005303 filter. Please refer to the documentation of the corresponding
5304 filter (section 9) for all details on the supported parameters.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02005305
5306 Multiple occurrences of the filter line can be used for the same proxy. The
5307 same filter can be referenced many times if needed.
5308
5309 Example:
5310 listen
5311 bind *:80
5312
5313 filter trace name BEFORE-HTTP-COMP
5314 filter compression
5315 filter trace name AFTER-HTTP-COMP
5316
5317 compression algo gzip
5318 compression offload
5319
5320 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
5321
5322 See also : section 9.
5323
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01005324
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005325fullconn <conns>
5326 Specify at what backend load the servers will reach their maxconn
5327 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5328 yes | no | yes | yes
5329 Arguments :
5330 <conns> is the number of connections on the backend which will make the
5331 servers use the maximal number of connections.
5332
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005333 When a server has a "maxconn" parameter specified, it means that its number
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005334 of concurrent connections will never go higher. Additionally, if it has a
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005335 "minconn" parameter, it indicates a dynamic limit following the backend's
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005336 load. The server will then always accept at least <minconn> connections,
5337 never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on the ramp between both
5338 values when the backend has less than <conns> concurrent connections. This
5339 makes it possible to limit the load on the servers during normal loads, but
5340 push it further for important loads without overloading the servers during
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005341 exceptional loads.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005342
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04005343 Since it's hard to get this value right, HAProxy automatically sets it to
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02005344 10% of the sum of the maxconns of all frontends that may branch to this
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01005345 backend (based on "use_backend" and "default_backend" rules). That way it's
5346 safe to leave it unset. However, "use_backend" involving dynamic names are
5347 not counted since there is no way to know if they could match or not.
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02005348
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005349 Example :
5350 # The servers will accept between 100 and 1000 concurrent connections each
5351 # and the maximum of 1000 will be reached when the backend reaches 10000
5352 # connections.
5353 backend dynamic
5354 fullconn 10000
5355 server srv1 dyn1:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
5356 server srv2 dyn2:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
5357
5358 See also : "maxconn", "server"
5359
5360
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04005361hash-balance-factor <factor>
5362 Specify the balancing factor for bounded-load consistent hashing
5363 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5364 yes | no | no | yes
5365 Arguments :
5366 <factor> is the control for the maximum number of concurrent requests to
5367 send to a server, expressed as a percentage of the average number
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +01005368 of concurrent requests across all of the active servers.
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04005369
5370 Specifying a "hash-balance-factor" for a server with "hash-type consistent"
5371 enables an algorithm that prevents any one server from getting too many
5372 requests at once, even if some hash buckets receive many more requests than
5373 others. Setting <factor> to 0 (the default) disables the feature. Otherwise,
5374 <factor> is a percentage greater than 100. For example, if <factor> is 150,
5375 then no server will be allowed to have a load more than 1.5 times the average.
5376 If server weights are used, they will be respected.
5377
5378 If the first-choice server is disqualified, the algorithm will choose another
5379 server based on the request hash, until a server with additional capacity is
5380 found. A higher <factor> allows more imbalance between the servers, while a
5381 lower <factor> means that more servers will be checked on average, affecting
5382 performance. Reasonable values are from 125 to 200.
5383
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02005384 This setting is also used by "balance random" which internally relies on the
5385 consistent hashing mechanism.
5386
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04005387 See also : "balance" and "hash-type".
5388
5389
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05005390hash-type <method> <function> <modifier>
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02005391 Specify a method to use for mapping hashes to servers
5392 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5393 yes | no | yes | yes
5394 Arguments :
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005395 <method> is the method used to select a server from the hash computed by
5396 the <function> :
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02005397
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005398 map-based the hash table is a static array containing all alive servers.
5399 The hashes will be very smooth, will consider weights, but
5400 will be static in that weight changes while a server is up
5401 will be ignored. This means that there will be no slow start.
5402 Also, since a server is selected by its position in the array,
5403 most mappings are changed when the server count changes. This
5404 means that when a server goes up or down, or when a server is
5405 added to a farm, most connections will be redistributed to
5406 different servers. This can be inconvenient with caches for
5407 instance.
Willy Tarreau798a39c2010-11-24 15:04:29 +01005408
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005409 consistent the hash table is a tree filled with many occurrences of each
5410 server. The hash key is looked up in the tree and the closest
5411 server is chosen. This hash is dynamic, it supports changing
5412 weights while the servers are up, so it is compatible with the
5413 slow start feature. It has the advantage that when a server
5414 goes up or down, only its associations are moved. When a
5415 server is added to the farm, only a few part of the mappings
5416 are redistributed, making it an ideal method for caches.
5417 However, due to its principle, the distribution will never be
5418 very smooth and it may sometimes be necessary to adjust a
5419 server's weight or its ID to get a more balanced distribution.
5420 In order to get the same distribution on multiple load
5421 balancers, it is important that all servers have the exact
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05005422 same IDs. Note: consistent hash uses sdbm and avalanche if no
5423 hash function is specified.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005424
5425 <function> is the hash function to be used :
5426
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005427 sdbm this function was created initially for sdbm (a public-domain
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005428 reimplementation of ndbm) database library. It was found to do
5429 well in scrambling bits, causing better distribution of the keys
5430 and fewer splits. It also happens to be a good general hashing
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05005431 function with good distribution, unless the total server weight
5432 is a multiple of 64, in which case applying the avalanche
5433 modifier may help.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005434
5435 djb2 this function was first proposed by Dan Bernstein many years ago
5436 on comp.lang.c. Studies have shown that for certain workload this
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05005437 function provides a better distribution than sdbm. It generally
5438 works well with text-based inputs though it can perform extremely
5439 poorly with numeric-only input or when the total server weight is
5440 a multiple of 33, unless the avalanche modifier is also used.
5441
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04005442 wt6 this function was designed for HAProxy while testing other
Willy Tarreaua0f42712013-11-14 14:30:35 +01005443 functions in the past. It is not as smooth as the other ones, but
5444 is much less sensible to the input data set or to the number of
5445 servers. It can make sense as an alternative to sdbm+avalanche or
5446 djb2+avalanche for consistent hashing or when hashing on numeric
5447 data such as a source IP address or a visitor identifier in a URL
5448 parameter.
5449
Willy Tarreau324f07f2015-01-20 19:44:50 +01005450 crc32 this is the most common CRC32 implementation as used in Ethernet,
5451 gzip, PNG, etc. It is slower than the other ones but may provide
5452 a better distribution or less predictable results especially when
5453 used on strings.
5454
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05005455 <modifier> indicates an optional method applied after hashing the key :
5456
5457 avalanche This directive indicates that the result from the hash
5458 function above should not be used in its raw form but that
5459 a 4-byte full avalanche hash must be applied first. The
5460 purpose of this step is to mix the resulting bits from the
5461 previous hash in order to avoid any undesired effect when
5462 the input contains some limited values or when the number of
5463 servers is a multiple of one of the hash's components (64
5464 for SDBM, 33 for DJB2). Enabling avalanche tends to make the
5465 result less predictable, but it's also not as smooth as when
5466 using the original function. Some testing might be needed
5467 with some workloads. This hash is one of the many proposed
5468 by Bob Jenkins.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02005469
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005470 The default hash type is "map-based" and is recommended for most usages. The
5471 default function is "sdbm", the selection of a function should be based on
5472 the range of the values being hashed.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02005473
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04005474 See also : "balance", "hash-balance-factor", "server"
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02005475
5476
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005477http-after-response <action> <options...> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5478 Access control for all Layer 7 responses (server, applet/service and internal
5479 ones).
5480
5481 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +02005482 yes(!) | yes | yes | yes
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005483
5484 The http-after-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer
5485 7 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they
5486 are met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
5487 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
5488 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
5489 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
5490
5491 Unlike http-response rules, these ones are applied on all responses, the
5492 server ones but also to all responses generated by HAProxy. These rules are
5493 evaluated at the end of the responses analysis, before the data forwarding.
5494
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02005495 The first keyword is the rule's action. Several types of actions are
5496 supported:
5497 - add-header <name> <fmt>
5498 - allow
Christopher Fauletba8f0632021-12-06 08:43:22 +01005499 - capture <sample> id <id>
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02005500 - del-header <name> [ -m <meth> ]
5501 - replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
5502 - replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
5503 - set-header <name> <fmt>
5504 - set-status <status> [reason <str>]
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +01005505 - set-var(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <expr>
5506 - set-var-fmt(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <fmt>
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02005507 - strict-mode { on | off }
5508 - unset-var(<var-name>)
5509
5510 The supported actions are described below.
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005511
5512 There is no limit to the number of http-after-response statements per
5513 instance.
5514
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +02005515 This directive is only available from named defaults sections, not anonymous
5516 ones. Rules defined in the defaults section are evaluated before ones in the
5517 associated proxy section. To avoid ambiguities, in this case the same
5518 defaults section cannot be used by proxies with the frontend capability and
5519 by proxies with the backend capability. It means a listen section cannot use
5520 a defaults section defining such rules.
5521
Christopher Fauletd5ac6de2020-12-02 08:40:14 +01005522 Note: Errors emitted in early stage of the request parsing are handled by the
5523 multiplexer at a lower level, before any http analysis. Thus no
5524 http-after-response ruleset is evaluated on these errors.
5525
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005526 Example:
5527 http-after-response set-header Strict-Transport-Security "max-age=31536000"
5528 http-after-response set-header Cache-Control "no-store,no-cache,private"
5529 http-after-response set-header Pragma "no-cache"
5530
5531http-after-response add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5532
5533 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and whose
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02005534 value is defined by <fmt>. Please refer to "http-request add-header" for a
5535 complete description.
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005536
Christopher Fauletba8f0632021-12-06 08:43:22 +01005537http-after-response capture <sample> id <id> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5538
5539 This captures sample expression <sample> from the response buffer, and
5540 converts it to a string. Please refer to "http-response capture" for a
5541 complete description.
5542
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005543http-after-response allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5544
5545 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response pass the check.
Christopher Faulet27025602021-11-09 17:58:12 +01005546 No further "http-after-response" rules are evaluated for the current section.
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005547
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00005548http-after-response del-header <name> [ -m <meth> ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005549
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02005550 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>. Please
5551 refer to "http-request del-header" for a complete description.
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005552
5553http-after-response replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
5554 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5555
5556 This works like "http-response replace-header".
5557
5558 Example:
5559 http-after-response replace-header Set-Cookie (C=[^;]*);(.*) \1;ip=%bi;\2
5560
5561 # applied to:
5562 Set-Cookie: C=1; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
5563
5564 # outputs:
5565 Set-Cookie: C=1;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
5566
5567 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20.
5568
5569http-after-response replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
5570 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5571
5572 This works like "http-response replace-value".
5573
5574 Example:
5575 http-after-response replace-value Cache-control ^public$ private
5576
5577 # applied to:
5578 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, public
5579
5580 # outputs:
5581 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, private
5582
5583http-after-response set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5584
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02005585 This does the same as "http-after-response add-header" except that the header
5586 name is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
5587 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
5588 external users.
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005589
5590http-after-response set-status <status> [reason <str>]
5591 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5592
5593 This replaces the response status code with <status> which must be an integer
Ilya Shipitsina4d09e72021-11-20 23:11:12 +05005594 between 100 and 999. Please refer to "http-response set-status" for a complete
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02005595 description.
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005596
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +01005597http-after-response set-var(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5598http-after-response set-var-fmt(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau9a621ae2021-09-02 21:00:38 +02005599
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02005600 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
5601 inline. Please refer to "http-request set-var" and "http-request set-var-fmt"
5602 for a complete description.
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005603
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02005604http-after-response strict-mode { on | off } [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005605
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02005606 This enables or disables the strict rewriting mode for following
5607 rules. Please refer to "http-request strict-mode" for a complete description.
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005608
5609http-after-response unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5610
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02005611 This is used to unset a variable. See "http-request set-var" for details
5612 about <var-name>.
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005613
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005614
5615http-check comment <string>
5616 Defines a comment for the following the http-check rule, reported in logs if
5617 it fails.
5618 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5619 yes | no | yes | yes
5620
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005621 Arguments :
5622 <string> is the comment message to add in logs if the following http-check
5623 rule fails.
5624
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005625 It only works for connect, send and expect rules. It is useful to make
5626 user-friendly error reporting.
5627
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005628 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check connect", "http-check send" and
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005629 "http-check expect".
5630
5631
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005632http-check connect [default] [port <expr>] [addr <ip>] [send-proxy]
5633 [via-socks4] [ssl] [sni <sni>] [alpn <alpn>] [linger]
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +02005634 [proto <name>] [comment <msg>]
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005635 Opens a new connection to perform an HTTP health check
5636 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5637 yes | no | yes | yes
5638
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005639 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005640 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
5641
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005642 default Use default options of the server line to do the health
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005643 checks. The server options are used only if not redefined.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005644
5645 port <expr> if not set, check port or server port is used.
5646 It tells HAProxy where to open the connection to.
5647 <port> must be a valid TCP port source integer, from 1 to
5648 65535 or an sample-fetch expression.
5649
5650 addr <ip> defines the IP address to do the health check.
5651
5652 send-proxy send a PROXY protocol string
5653
5654 via-socks4 enables outgoing health checks using upstream socks4 proxy.
5655
5656 ssl opens a ciphered connection
5657
5658 sni <sni> specifies the SNI to use to do health checks over SSL.
5659
5660 alpn <alpn> defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol
5661 list consists in a comma-delimited list of protocol names,
5662 for instance: "h2,http/1.1". If it is not set, the server ALPN
5663 is used.
5664
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +02005665 proto <name> forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for this connection.
5666 It must be an HTTP mux protocol and it must be usable on the
5667 backend side. The list of available protocols is reported in
5668 haproxy -vv.
5669
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005670 linger cleanly close the connection instead of using a single RST.
5671
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005672 Just like tcp-check health checks, it is possible to configure the connection
5673 to use to perform HTTP health check. This directive should also be used to
5674 describe a scenario involving several request/response exchanges, possibly on
5675 different ports or with different servers.
5676
5677 When there are no TCP port configured on the server line neither server port
5678 directive, then the first step of the http-check sequence must be to specify
5679 the port with a "http-check connect".
5680
5681 In an http-check ruleset a 'connect' is required, it is also mandatory to start
5682 the ruleset with a 'connect' rule. Purpose is to ensure admin know what they
5683 do.
5684
5685 When a connect must start the ruleset, if may still be preceded by set-var,
5686 unset-var or comment rules.
5687
5688 Examples :
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005689 # check HTTP and HTTPs services on a server.
5690 # first open port 80 thanks to server line port directive, then
5691 # tcp-check opens port 443, ciphered and run a request on it:
5692 option httpchk
5693
5694 http-check connect
Christopher Fauleta5c14ef2020-04-29 14:19:13 +02005695 http-check send meth GET uri / ver HTTP/1.1 hdr host haproxy.1wt.eu
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02005696 http-check expect status 200-399
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005697 http-check connect port 443 ssl sni haproxy.1wt.eu
Christopher Fauleta5c14ef2020-04-29 14:19:13 +02005698 http-check send meth GET uri / ver HTTP/1.1 hdr host haproxy.1wt.eu
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02005699 http-check expect status 200-399
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005700
5701 server www 10.0.0.1 check port 80
5702
5703 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check send", "http-check expect"
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005704
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005705
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005706http-check disable-on-404
5707 Enable a maintenance mode upon HTTP/404 response to health-checks
5708 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005709 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005710 Arguments : none
5711
5712 When this option is set, a server which returns an HTTP code 404 will be
5713 excluded from further load-balancing, but will still receive persistent
5714 connections. This provides a very convenient method for Web administrators
5715 to perform a graceful shutdown of their servers. It is also important to note
5716 that a server which is detected as failed while it was in this mode will not
5717 generate an alert, just a notice. If the server responds 2xx or 3xx again, it
5718 will immediately be reinserted into the farm. The status on the stats page
5719 reports "NOLB" for a server in this mode. It is important to note that this
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005720 option only works in conjunction with the "httpchk" option. If this option
5721 is used with "http-check expect", then it has precedence over it so that 404
Christopher Fauletfa8b89a2020-11-20 18:54:13 +01005722 responses will still be considered as soft-stop. Note also that a stopped
5723 server will stay stopped even if it replies 404s. This option is only
5724 evaluated for running servers.
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005725
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005726 See also : "option httpchk" and "http-check expect".
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005727
5728
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005729http-check expect [min-recv <int>] [comment <msg>]
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005730 [ok-status <st>] [error-status <st>] [tout-status <st>]
5731 [on-success <fmt>] [on-error <fmt>] [status-code <expr>]
5732 [!] <match> <pattern>
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005733 Make HTTP health checks consider response contents or specific status codes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005734 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau1ee51a62011-08-19 20:04:17 +02005735 yes | no | yes | yes
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005736
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005737 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005738 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
5739
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005740 min-recv is optional and can define the minimum amount of data required to
5741 evaluate the current expect rule. If the number of received bytes
5742 is under this limit, the check will wait for more data. This
5743 option can be used to resolve some ambiguous matching rules or to
5744 avoid executing costly regex matches on content known to be still
5745 incomplete. If an exact string is used, the minimum between the
5746 string length and this parameter is used. This parameter is
5747 ignored if it is set to -1. If the expect rule does not match,
5748 the check will wait for more data. If set to 0, the evaluation
5749 result is always conclusive.
5750
5751 ok-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
5752 the expect rule is successfully evaluated and if it is
5753 the last rule in the tcp-check ruleset. "L7OK", "L7OKC",
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +02005754 "L6OK" and "L4OK" are supported :
5755 - L7OK : check passed on layer 7
Christopher Faulet83662b52020-11-20 17:47:47 +01005756 - L7OKC : check conditionally passed on layer 7, set
5757 server to NOLB state.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +02005758 - L6OK : check passed on layer 6
5759 - L4OK : check passed on layer 4
5760 By default "L7OK" is used.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005761
5762 error-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
5763 an error occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Faulet83662b52020-11-20 17:47:47 +01005764 "L7OKC", "L7RSP", "L7STS", "L6RSP" and "L4CON" are
5765 supported :
5766 - L7OKC : check conditionally passed on layer 7, set
5767 server to NOLB state.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +02005768 - L7RSP : layer 7 invalid response - protocol error
5769 - L7STS : layer 7 response error, for example HTTP 5xx
5770 - L6RSP : layer 6 invalid response - protocol error
5771 - L4CON : layer 1-4 connection problem
5772 By default "L7RSP" is used.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005773
5774 tout-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
5775 a timeout occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +02005776 "L7TOUT", "L6TOUT", and "L4TOUT" are supported :
5777 - L7TOUT : layer 7 (HTTP/SMTP) timeout
5778 - L6TOUT : layer 6 (SSL) timeout
5779 - L4TOUT : layer 1-4 timeout
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005780 By default "L7TOUT" is used.
5781
5782 on-success <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
5783 informational message reported in logs if the expect
5784 rule is successfully evaluated and if it is the last rule
5785 in the tcp-check ruleset. <fmt> is a log-format string.
5786
5787 on-error <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
5788 informational message reported in logs if an error
5789 occurred during the expect rule evaluation. <fmt> is a
5790 log-format string.
5791
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005792 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
Christopher Fauletb5594262020-05-05 20:23:13 +02005793 response. The keyword may be one of "status", "rstatus", "hdr",
5794 "fhdr", "string", or "rstring". The keyword may be preceded by an
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005795 exclamation mark ("!") to negate the match. Spaces are allowed
5796 between the exclamation mark and the keyword. See below for more
5797 details on the supported keywords.
5798
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02005799 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string, a regular
5800 expression or a more complex pattern with several arguments. If
5801 the string pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped with the
5802 usual backslash ('\').
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005803
5804 By default, "option httpchk" considers that response statuses 2xx and 3xx
5805 are valid, and that others are invalid. When "http-check expect" is used,
5806 it defines what is considered valid or invalid. Only one "http-check"
5807 statement is supported in a backend. If a server fails to respond or times
5808 out, the check obviously fails. The available matches are :
5809
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02005810 status <codes> : test the status codes found parsing <codes> string. it
5811 must be a comma-separated list of status codes or range
5812 codes. A health check response will be considered as
5813 valid if the response's status code matches any status
5814 code or is inside any range of the list. If the "status"
5815 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
5816 considered invalid if the status code matches.
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005817
5818 rstatus <regex> : test a regular expression for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005819 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005820 response's status code matches the expression. If the
5821 "rstatus" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
5822 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
5823 This is mostly used to check for multiple codes.
5824
Christopher Fauletb5594262020-05-05 20:23:13 +02005825 hdr { name | name-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <name>
5826 [ { value | value-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <value> :
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02005827 test the specified header pattern on the HTTP response
5828 headers. The name pattern is mandatory but the value
5829 pattern is optional. If not specified, only the header
5830 presence is verified. <meth> is the matching method,
5831 applied on the header name or the header value. Supported
5832 matching methods are "str" (exact match), "beg" (prefix
5833 match), "end" (suffix match), "sub" (substring match) or
5834 "reg" (regex match). If not specified, exact matching
Christopher Fauletb5594262020-05-05 20:23:13 +02005835 method is used. If the "name-lf" parameter is used,
5836 <name> is evaluated as a log-format string. If "value-lf"
5837 parameter is used, <value> is evaluated as a log-format
5838 string. These parameters cannot be used with the regex
5839 matching method. Finally, the header value is considered
5840 as comma-separated list. Note that matchings are case
5841 insensitive on the header names.
5842
5843 fhdr { name | name-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <name>
5844 [ { value | value-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <value> :
5845 test the specified full header pattern on the HTTP
5846 response headers. It does exactly the same than "hdr"
5847 keyword, except the full header value is tested, commas
5848 are not considered as delimiters.
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02005849
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005850 string <string> : test the exact string match in the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005851 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005852 response's body contains this exact string. If the
5853 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
5854 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
5855 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory word at
5856 the end of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005857 specific error appears on the check page (e.g. a stack
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005858 trace).
5859
5860 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005861 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005862 response's body matches this expression. If the "rstring"
5863 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
5864 considered invalid if the body matches the expression.
5865 This can be used to look for a mandatory word at the end
5866 of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a specific
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005867 error appears on the check page (e.g. a stack trace).
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005868
Christopher Fauletaaab0832020-05-05 15:54:22 +02005869 string-lf <fmt> : test a log-format string match in the HTTP response body.
5870 A health check response will be considered valid if the
5871 response's body contains the string resulting of the
5872 evaluation of <fmt>, which follows the log-format rules.
5873 If prefixed with "!", then the response will be
5874 considered invalid if the body contains the string.
5875
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005876 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +01005877 defined by the global "tune.bufsize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005878 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
5879 "string" or "rstring". If a large response is absolutely required, it is
5880 possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
5881 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
5882 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
5883 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources.
5884
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005885 In an http-check ruleset, the last expect rule may be implicit. If no expect
5886 rule is specified after the last "http-check send", an implicit expect rule
5887 is defined to match on 2xx or 3xx status codes. It means this rule is also
5888 defined if there is no "http-check" rule at all, when only "option httpchk"
5889 is set.
Cyril Bonté32602d22015-01-30 00:07:07 +01005890
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005891 Last, if "http-check expect" is combined with "http-check disable-on-404",
5892 then this last one has precedence when the server responds with 404.
5893
5894 Examples :
5895 # only accept status 200 as valid
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02005896 http-check expect status 200,201,300-310
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005897
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02005898 # be sure a sessid coookie is set
5899 http-check expect header name "set-cookie" value -m beg "sessid="
5900
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005901 # consider SQL errors as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01005902 http-check expect ! string SQL\ Error
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005903
5904 # consider status 5xx only as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01005905 http-check expect ! rstatus ^5
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005906
5907 # check that we have a correct hexadecimal tag before /html
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03005908 http-check expect rstring <!--tag:[0-9a-f]*--></html>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005909
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005910 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check connect", "http-check disable-on-404"
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005911 and "http-check send".
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005912
5913
Christopher Faulet7c95f5f2020-05-06 15:06:34 +02005914http-check send [meth <method>] [{ uri <uri> | uri-lf <fmt> }>] [ver <version>]
Christopher Faulet574e7bd2020-05-06 15:38:58 +02005915 [hdr <name> <fmt>]* [{ body <string> | body-lf <fmt> }]
5916 [comment <msg>]
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005917 Add a possible list of headers and/or a body to the request sent during HTTP
5918 health checks.
5919 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5920 yes | no | yes | yes
5921 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005922 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
5923
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005924 meth <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not
5925 set, the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires
5926 low server processing and is easy to filter out from the
5927 logs. Any method may be used, though it is not recommended
5928 to invent non-standard ones.
5929
Christopher Faulet7c95f5f2020-05-06 15:06:34 +02005930 uri <uri> is optional and set the URI referenced in the HTTP requests
5931 to the string <uri>. It defaults to "/" which is accessible
5932 by default on almost any server, but may be changed to any
5933 other URI. Query strings are permitted.
5934
5935 uri-lf <fmt> is optional and set the URI referenced in the HTTP requests
5936 using the log-format string <fmt>. It defaults to "/" which
5937 is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
5938 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005939
Christopher Faulet907701b2020-04-28 09:37:00 +02005940 ver <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005941 "HTTP/1.0" but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005942 1.0, so turning it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005943 the Host field is mandatory in HTTP/1.1, use "hdr" argument
5944 to add it.
5945
5946 hdr <name> <fmt> adds the HTTP header field whose name is specified in
5947 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt>, which follows
5948 to the log-format rules.
5949
5950 body <string> add the body defined by <string> to the request sent during
5951 HTTP health checks. If defined, the "Content-Length" header
5952 is thus automatically added to the request.
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005953
Christopher Faulet574e7bd2020-05-06 15:38:58 +02005954 body-lf <fmt> add the body defined by the log-format string <fmt> to the
5955 request sent during HTTP health checks. If defined, the
5956 "Content-Length" header is thus automatically added to the
5957 request.
5958
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005959 In addition to the request line defined by the "option httpchk" directive,
5960 this one is the valid way to add some headers and optionally a body to the
5961 request sent during HTTP health checks. If a body is defined, the associate
Christopher Faulet9df910c2020-04-29 14:20:47 +02005962 "Content-Length" header is automatically added. Thus, this header or
5963 "Transfer-encoding" header should not be present in the request provided by
5964 "http-check send". If so, it will be ignored. The old trick consisting to add
5965 headers after the version string on the "option httpchk" line is now
Amaury Denoyelle6d975f02020-12-22 14:08:52 +01005966 deprecated.
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005967
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005968 Also "http-check send" doesn't support HTTP keep-alive. Keep in mind that it
Amaury Denoyelle6d975f02020-12-22 14:08:52 +01005969 will automatically append a "Connection: close" header, unless a Connection
5970 header has already already been configured via a hdr entry.
Christopher Faulet9df910c2020-04-29 14:20:47 +02005971
5972 Note that the Host header and the request authority, when both defined, are
5973 automatically synchronized. It means when the HTTP request is sent, when a
5974 Host is inserted in the request, the request authority is accordingly
5975 updated. Thus, don't be surprised if the Host header value overwrites the
5976 configured request authority.
5977
5978 Note also for now, no Host header is automatically added in HTTP/1.1 or above
5979 requests. You should add it explicitly.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005980
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005981 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check send-state" and "http-check expect".
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005982
5983
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01005984http-check send-state
5985 Enable emission of a state header with HTTP health checks
5986 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5987 yes | no | yes | yes
5988 Arguments : none
5989
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04005990 When this option is set, HAProxy will systematically send a special header
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01005991 "X-Haproxy-Server-State" with a list of parameters indicating to each server
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04005992 how they are seen by HAProxy. This can be used for instance when a server is
5993 manipulated without access to HAProxy and the operator needs to know whether
5994 HAProxy still sees it up or not, or if the server is the last one in a farm.
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01005995
5996 The header is composed of fields delimited by semi-colons, the first of which
5997 is a word ("UP", "DOWN", "NOLB"), possibly followed by a number of valid
5998 checks on the total number before transition, just as appears in the stats
5999 interface. Next headers are in the form "<variable>=<value>", indicating in
6000 no specific order some values available in the stats interface :
Joseph Lynch514061c2015-01-15 17:52:59 -08006001 - a variable "address", containing the address of the backend server.
6002 This corresponds to the <address> field in the server declaration. For
6003 unix domain sockets, it will read "unix".
6004
6005 - a variable "port", containing the port of the backend server. This
6006 corresponds to the <port> field in the server declaration. For unix
6007 domain sockets, it will read "unix".
6008
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01006009 - a variable "name", containing the name of the backend followed by a slash
6010 ("/") then the name of the server. This can be used when a server is
6011 checked in multiple backends.
6012
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04006013 - a variable "node" containing the name of the HAProxy node, as set in the
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01006014 global "node" variable, otherwise the system's hostname if unspecified.
6015
6016 - a variable "weight" indicating the weight of the server, a slash ("/")
6017 and the total weight of the farm (just counting usable servers). This
6018 helps to know if other servers are available to handle the load when this
6019 one fails.
6020
6021 - a variable "scur" indicating the current number of concurrent connections
6022 on the server, followed by a slash ("/") then the total number of
6023 connections on all servers of the same backend.
6024
6025 - a variable "qcur" indicating the current number of requests in the
6026 server's queue.
6027
6028 Example of a header received by the application server :
6029 >>> X-Haproxy-Server-State: UP 2/3; name=bck/srv2; node=lb1; weight=1/2; \
6030 scur=13/22; qcur=0
6031
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02006032 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404" and
6033 "http-check send".
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01006034
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006035
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +01006036http-check set-var(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <expr>
6037http-check set-var-fmt(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <fmt>
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006038 This operation sets the content of a variable. The variable is declared inline.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006039 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6040 yes | no | yes | yes
6041
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02006042 Arguments :
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006043 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
6044 scope. The scopes allowed for http-check are:
6045 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
6046 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
6047 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
6048 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
6049 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
6050 and '-'.
6051
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +01006052 <cond> A set of conditions that must all be true for the variable to
6053 actually be set (such as "ifnotempty", "ifgt" ...). See the
Ilya Shipitsin5e87bcf2021-12-25 11:45:52 +05006054 set-var converter's description for a full list of possible
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +01006055 conditions.
6056
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006057 <expr> Is a sample-fetch expression potentially followed by converters.
6058
Willy Tarreau9a621ae2021-09-02 21:00:38 +02006059 <fmt> This is the value expressed using log-format rules (see Custom
6060 Log Format in section 8.2.4).
6061
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02006062 Examples :
6063 http-check set-var(check.port) int(1234)
Willy Tarreau9a621ae2021-09-02 21:00:38 +02006064 http-check set-var-fmt(check.port) "name=%H"
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006065
6066
6067http-check unset-var(<var-name>)
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006068 Free a reference to a variable within its scope.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006069 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6070 yes | no | yes | yes
6071
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02006072 Arguments :
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006073 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
6074 scope. The scopes allowed for http-check are:
6075 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
6076 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
6077 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
6078 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
6079 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
6080 and '-'.
6081
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02006082 Examples :
6083 http-check unset-var(check.port)
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006084
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006085
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02006086http-error status <code> [content-type <type>]
6087 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
6088 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
6089 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
6090 Defines a custom error message to use instead of errors generated by HAProxy.
6091 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6092 yes | yes | yes | yes
6093 Arguments :
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05006094 status <code> is the HTTP status code. It must be specified.
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02006095 Currently, HAProxy is capable of generating codes
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02006096 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410, 413, 425,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01006097 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504.
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02006098
6099 content-type <type> is the response content type, for instance
6100 "text/plain". This parameter is ignored and should be
6101 omitted when an errorfile is configured or when the
6102 payload is empty. Otherwise, it must be defined.
6103
6104 default-errorfiles Reset the previously defined error message for current
6105 proxy for the status <code>. If used on a backend, the
6106 frontend error message is used, if defined. If used on
6107 a frontend, the default error message is used.
6108
6109 errorfile <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response.
6110 It is recommended to follow the common practice of
6111 appending ".http" to the filename so that people do
6112 not confuse the response with HTML error pages, and to
6113 use absolute paths, since files are read before any
6114 chroot is performed.
6115
6116 errorfiles <name> designates the http-errors section to use to import
6117 the error message with the status code <code>. If no
6118 such message is found, the proxy's error messages are
6119 considered.
6120
6121 file <file> specifies the file to use as response payload. If the
6122 file is not empty, its content-type must be set as
6123 argument to "content-type", otherwise, any
6124 "content-type" argument is ignored. <file> is
6125 considered as a raw string.
6126
6127 string <str> specifies the raw string to use as response payload.
6128 The content-type must always be set as argument to
6129 "content-type".
6130
6131 lf-file <file> specifies the file to use as response payload. If the
6132 file is not empty, its content-type must be set as
6133 argument to "content-type", otherwise, any
6134 "content-type" argument is ignored. <file> is
6135 evaluated as a log-format string.
6136
6137 lf-string <str> specifies the log-format string to use as response
6138 payload. The content-type must always be set as
6139 argument to "content-type".
6140
6141 hdr <name> <fmt> adds to the response the HTTP header field whose name
6142 is specified in <name> and whose value is defined by
6143 <fmt>, which follows to the log-format rules.
6144 This parameter is ignored if an errorfile is used.
6145
6146 This directive may be used instead of "errorfile", to define a custom error
6147 message. As "errorfile" directive, it is used for errors detected and
6148 returned by HAProxy. If an errorfile is defined, it is parsed when HAProxy
6149 starts and must be valid according to the HTTP standards. The generated
6150 response must not exceed the configured buffer size (BUFFSIZE), otherwise an
6151 internal error will be returned. Finally, if you consider to use some
6152 http-after-response rules to rewrite these errors, the reserved buffer space
6153 should be available (see "tune.maxrewrite").
6154
6155 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
6156 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
6157 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running.
6158
Christopher Fauletd5ac6de2020-12-02 08:40:14 +01006159 Note: 400/408/500 errors emitted in early stage of the request parsing are
6160 handled by the multiplexer at a lower level. No custom formatting is
6161 supported at this level. Thus only static error messages, defined with
6162 "errorfile" directive, are supported. However, this limitation only
6163 exists during the request headers parsing or between two transactions.
6164
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02006165 See also : "errorfile", "errorfiles", "errorloc", "errorloc302",
6166 "errorloc303" and section 3.8 about http-errors.
6167
6168
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006169http-request <action> [options...] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01006170 Access control for Layer 7 requests
6171
6172 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +02006173 yes(!) | yes | yes | yes
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01006174
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01006175 The http-request statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
6176 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
6177 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
6178 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
6179 if the condition is true.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01006180
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02006181 The first keyword is the rule's action. Several types of actions are
6182 supported:
6183 - add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt>
6184 - add-header <name> <fmt>
6185 - allow
6186 - auth [realm <realm>]
6187 - cache-use <name>
6188 - capture <sample> [ len <length> | id <id> ]
6189 - del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt>
6190 - del-header <name> [ -m <meth> ]
6191 - del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt>
6192 - deny [ { status | deny_status } <code>] ...
6193 - disable-l7-retry
6194 - do-resolve(<var>,<resolvers>,[ipv4,ipv6]) <expr>
6195 - early-hint <name> <fmt>
6196 - normalize-uri <normalizer>
6197 - redirect <rule>
6198 - reject
6199 - replace-header <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
6200 - replace-path <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
6201 - replace-pathq <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
6202 - replace-uri <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
6203 - replace-value <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
6204 - return [status <code>] [content-type <type>] ...
6205 - sc-inc-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>)
6206 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
6207 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
6208 - sc-set-gpt(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
6209 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
6210 - set-dst <expr>
6211 - set-dst-port <expr>
6212 - set-header <name> <fmt>
6213 - set-log-level <level>
6214 - set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
6215 - set-mark <mark>
6216 - set-method <fmt>
6217 - set-nice <nice>
6218 - set-path <fmt>
6219 - set-pathq <fmt>
6220 - set-priority-class <expr>
6221 - set-priority-offset <expr>
6222 - set-query <fmt>
6223 - set-src <expr>
6224 - set-src-port <expr>
6225 - set-timeout { server | tunnel } { <timeout> | <expr> }
6226 - set-tos <tos>
6227 - set-uri <fmt>
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +01006228 - set-var(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <expr>
6229 - set-var-fmt(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <fmt>
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02006230 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
6231 - silent-drop
6232 - strict-mode { on | off }
6233 - tarpit [ { status | deny_status } <code>] ...
6234 - track-sc0 <key> [table <table>]
6235 - track-sc1 <key> [table <table>]
6236 - track-sc2 <key> [table <table>]
6237 - unset-var(<var-name>)
6238 - use-service <service-name>
6239 - wait-for-body time <time> [ at-least <bytes> ]
6240 - wait-for-handshake
6241 - cache-use <name>
6242
6243 The supported actions are described below.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01006244
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006245 There is no limit to the number of http-request statements per instance.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01006246
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +02006247 This directive is only available from named defaults sections, not anonymous
6248 ones. Rules defined in the defaults section are evaluated before ones in the
6249 associated proxy section. To avoid ambiguities, in this case the same
6250 defaults section cannot be used by proxies with the frontend capability and
6251 by proxies with the backend capability. It means a listen section cannot use
6252 a defaults section defining such rules.
6253
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006254 Example:
6255 acl nagios src 192.168.129.3
6256 acl local_net src 192.168.0.0/16
6257 acl auth_ok http_auth(L1)
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01006258
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006259 http-request allow if nagios
6260 http-request allow if local_net auth_ok
6261 http-request auth realm Gimme if local_net auth_ok
6262 http-request deny
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01006263
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006264 Example:
6265 acl key req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key) -m found
6266 acl add path /addacl
6267 acl del path /delacl
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01006268
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006269 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01006270
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006271 http-request add-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key add
6272 http-request del-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key del
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02006273
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006274 Example:
6275 acl value req.hdr(X-Value) -m found
6276 acl setmap path /setmap
6277 acl delmap path /delmap
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006278
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006279 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006280
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006281 http-request set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[req.hdr(X-Value)] if setmap value
6282 http-request del-map(map.lst) %[src] if delmap
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006283
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006284 See also : "stats http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
6285 about ACL usage.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006286
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006287http-request add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006288
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006289 This is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
6290 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
6291 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
6292 log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It performs a lookup
6293 in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values. This
6294 lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
6295 It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the stats socket, but can
6296 be triggered by an HTTP request.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006297
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006298http-request add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006299
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006300 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and
6301 whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see
6302 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly useful to pass
6303 connection-specific information to the server (e.g. the client's SSL
6304 certificate), or to combine several headers into one. This rule is not
6305 final, so it is possible to add other similar rules. Note that header
6306 addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse the resulting
6307 header from a previous rule.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006308
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006309http-request allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006310
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006311 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the request pass the check.
Christopher Faulet27025602021-11-09 17:58:12 +01006312 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated for the current section.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006313
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006314http-request auth [realm <realm>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006315
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006316 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately responds with an
6317 HTTP 401 or 407 error code to invite the user to present a valid user name
6318 and password. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated. An optional
6319 "realm" parameter is supported, it sets the authentication realm that is
6320 returned with the response (typically the application's name).
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006321
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02006322 The corresponding proxy's error message is used. It may be customized using
6323 an "errorfile" or an "http-error" directive. For 401 responses, all
6324 occurrences of the WWW-Authenticate header are removed and replaced by a new
6325 one with a basic authentication challenge for realm "<realm>". For 407
6326 responses, the same is done on the Proxy-Authenticate header. If the error
6327 message must not be altered, consider to use "http-request return" rule
6328 instead.
6329
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006330 Example:
6331 acl auth_ok http_auth_group(L1) G1
6332 http-request auth unless auth_ok
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006333
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +02006334http-request cache-use <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006335
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02006336 See section 6.2 about cache setup.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01006337
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006338http-request capture <sample> [ len <length> | id <id> ]
6339 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01006340
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006341 This captures sample expression <sample> from the request buffer, and
6342 converts it to a string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is
6343 stored into the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next
6344 to some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs,
6345 and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it
6346 into headers or anything. The length should be limited given that this size
6347 will be allocated for each capture during the whole session life.
6348 Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture request header" for
6349 more information.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01006350
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006351 If the keyword "id" is used instead of "len", the action tries to store the
6352 captured string in a previously declared capture slot. This is useful to run
6353 captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a previous directive
Baptiste Assmann19a69b32020-01-16 14:34:22 +01006354 "http-request capture" or with the "declare capture" keyword.
6355
6356 When using this action in a backend, double check that the relevant
6357 frontend(s) have the required capture slots otherwise, this rule will be
6358 ignored at run time. This can't be detected at configuration parsing time
6359 due to HAProxy's ability to dynamically resolve backend name at runtime.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01006360
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006361http-request del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01006362
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006363 This is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
6364 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
6365 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
6366 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
6367 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but can
6368 be triggered by an HTTP request.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01006369
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00006370http-request del-header <name> [ -m <meth> ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02006371
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00006372 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>. <meth>
6373 is the matching method, applied on the header name. Supported matching methods
6374 are "str" (exact match), "beg" (prefix match), "end" (suffix match), "sub"
6375 (substring match) and "reg" (regex match). If not specified, exact matching
6376 method is used.
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02006377
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006378http-request del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02006379
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006380 This is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
6381 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
6382 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
6383 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
6384 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
6385 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02006386
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006387http-request deny [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6388http-request deny [ { status | deny_status } <code>] [content-type <type>]
6389 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
6390 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
6391 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
6392 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04006393
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006394 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects the request.
6395 By default an HTTP 403 error is returned. But the response may be customized
6396 using same syntax than "http-request return" rules. Thus, see "http-request
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05006397 return" for details. For compatibility purpose, when no argument is defined,
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006398 or only "deny_status", the argument "default-errorfiles" is implied. It means
6399 "http-request deny [deny_status <status>]" is an alias of
6400 "http-request deny [status <status>] default-errorfiles".
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006401 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006402 See also "http-request return".
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04006403
Olivier Houchard602bf7d2019-05-10 13:59:15 +02006404http-request disable-l7-retry [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6405 This disables any attempt to retry the request if it fails for any other
6406 reason than a connection failure. This can be useful for example to make
6407 sure POST requests aren't retried on failure.
6408
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02006409http-request do-resolve(<var>,<resolvers>,[ipv4,ipv6]) <expr>
6410 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +01006411
6412 This action performs a DNS resolution of the output of <expr> and stores
6413 the result in the variable <var>. It uses the DNS resolvers section
6414 pointed by <resolvers>.
6415 It is possible to choose a resolution preference using the optional
6416 arguments 'ipv4' or 'ipv6'.
6417 When performing the DNS resolution, the client side connection is on
6418 pause waiting till the end of the resolution.
6419 If an IP address can be found, it is stored into <var>. If any kind of
6420 error occurs, then <var> is not set.
6421 One can use this action to discover a server IP address at run time and
6422 based on information found in the request (IE a Host header).
6423 If this action is used to find the server's IP address (using the
6424 "set-dst" action), then the server IP address in the backend must be set
6425 to 0.0.0.0.
6426
6427 Example:
6428 resolvers mydns
6429 nameserver local 127.0.0.53:53
6430 nameserver google 8.8.8.8:53
6431 timeout retry 1s
6432 hold valid 10s
6433 hold nx 3s
6434 hold other 3s
6435 hold obsolete 0s
6436 accepted_payload_size 8192
6437
6438 frontend fe
6439 bind 10.42.0.1:80
6440 http-request do-resolve(txn.myip,mydns,ipv4) hdr(Host),lower
6441 http-request capture var(txn.myip) len 40
6442
6443 # return 503 when the variable is not set,
6444 # which mean DNS resolution error
6445 use_backend b_503 unless { var(txn.myip) -m found }
6446
6447 default_backend be
6448
6449 backend b_503
6450 # dummy backend used to return 503.
6451 # one can use the errorfile directive to send a nice
6452 # 503 error page to end users
6453
6454 backend be
6455 # rule to prevent HAProxy from reconnecting to services
6456 # on the local network (forged DNS name used to scan the network)
6457 http-request deny if { var(txn.myip) -m ip 127.0.0.0/8 10.0.0.0/8 }
6458 http-request set-dst var(txn.myip)
6459 server clear 0.0.0.0:0
6460
6461 NOTE: Don't forget to set the "protection" rules to ensure HAProxy won't
6462 be used to scan the network or worst won't loop over itself...
6463
Frédéric Lécaille06f5b642018-11-12 11:01:10 +01006464http-request early-hint <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6465
6466 This is used to build an HTTP 103 Early Hints response prior to any other one.
6467 This appends an HTTP header field to this response whose name is specified in
6468 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules
6469 (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly useful to pass
Frédéric Lécaille3aac1062018-11-13 09:42:13 +01006470 to the client some Link headers to preload resources required to render the
6471 HTML documents.
Frédéric Lécaille06f5b642018-11-12 11:01:10 +01006472
6473 See RFC 8297 for more information.
6474
Tim Duesterhusd371e992021-04-15 21:45:58 +02006475http-request normalize-uri <normalizer> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhusdec1c362021-05-10 17:28:26 +02006476http-request normalize-uri fragment-encode [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhusc9e05ab2021-05-10 17:28:25 +02006477http-request normalize-uri fragment-strip [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02006478http-request normalize-uri path-merge-slashes [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Maximilian Maderff3bb8b2021-04-21 00:22:50 +02006479http-request normalize-uri path-strip-dot [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02006480http-request normalize-uri path-strip-dotdot [ full ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhus2e4a18e2021-04-21 21:20:36 +02006481http-request normalize-uri percent-decode-unreserved [ strict ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02006482http-request normalize-uri percent-to-uppercase [ strict ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6483http-request normalize-uri query-sort-by-name [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhusd371e992021-04-15 21:45:58 +02006484
Tim Duesterhusb918a4a2021-04-16 23:52:29 +02006485 Performs normalization of the request's URI.
6486
Tim Duesterhus2963fd32021-04-17 00:24:56 +02006487 URI normalization in HAProxy 2.4 is currently available as an experimental
Amaury Denoyellea9e639a2021-05-06 15:50:12 +02006488 technical preview. As such, it requires the global directive
6489 'expose-experimental-directives' first to be able to invoke it. You should be
6490 prepared that the behavior of normalizers might change to fix possible
6491 issues, possibly breaking proper request processing in your infrastructure.
Tim Duesterhus2963fd32021-04-17 00:24:56 +02006492
Tim Duesterhusb918a4a2021-04-16 23:52:29 +02006493 Each normalizer handles a single type of normalization to allow for a
6494 fine-grained selection of the level of normalization that is appropriate for
6495 the supported backend.
6496
6497 As an example the "path-strip-dotdot" normalizer might be useful for a static
6498 fileserver that directly maps the requested URI to the path within the local
6499 filesystem. However it might break routing of an API that expects a specific
6500 number of segments in the path.
6501
Tim Duesterhus2e4a18e2021-04-21 21:20:36 +02006502 It is important to note that some normalizers might result in unsafe
6503 transformations for broken URIs. It might also be possible that a combination
6504 of normalizers that are safe by themselves results in unsafe transformations
6505 when improperly combined.
6506
6507 As an example the "percent-decode-unreserved" normalizer might result in
6508 unexpected results when a broken URI includes bare percent characters. One
6509 such a broken URI is "/%%36%36" which would be decoded to "/%66" which in
6510 turn is equivalent to "/f". By specifying the "strict" option requests to
6511 such a broken URI would safely be rejected.
6512
Tim Duesterhusb918a4a2021-04-16 23:52:29 +02006513 The following normalizers are available:
Tim Duesterhusd371e992021-04-15 21:45:58 +02006514
Tim Duesterhusdec1c362021-05-10 17:28:26 +02006515 - fragment-encode: Encodes "#" as "%23".
6516
6517 The "fragment-strip" normalizer should be preferred, unless it is known
6518 that broken clients do not correctly encode '#' within the path component.
6519
6520 Example:
6521 - /#foo -> /%23foo
6522
Tim Duesterhusc9e05ab2021-05-10 17:28:25 +02006523 - fragment-strip: Removes the URI's "fragment" component.
6524
6525 According to RFC 3986#3.5 the "fragment" component of an URI should not
6526 be sent, but handled by the User Agent after retrieving a resource.
6527
6528 This normalizer should be applied first to ensure that the fragment is
6529 not interpreted as part of the request's path component.
6530
6531 Example:
6532 - /#foo -> /
6533
Tim Duesterhusd6d33de2021-04-21 21:20:35 +02006534 - path-strip-dot: Removes "/./" segments within the "path" component
6535 (RFC 3986#6.2.2.3).
Maximilian Maderff3bb8b2021-04-21 00:22:50 +02006536
Tim Duesterhus2e4a18e2021-04-21 21:20:36 +02006537 Segments including percent encoded dots ("%2E") will not be detected. Use
6538 the "percent-decode-unreserved" normalizer first if this is undesired.
6539
Tim Duesterhus7a95f412021-04-21 21:20:33 +02006540 Example:
6541 - /. -> /
6542 - /./bar/ -> /bar/
6543 - /a/./a -> /a/a
6544 - /.well-known/ -> /.well-known/ (no change)
Maximilian Maderff3bb8b2021-04-21 00:22:50 +02006545
Tim Duesterhusd6d33de2021-04-21 21:20:35 +02006546 - path-strip-dotdot: Normalizes "/../" segments within the "path" component
6547 (RFC 3986#6.2.2.3).
6548
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02006549 This merges segments that attempt to access the parent directory with
Tim Duesterhus2e4a18e2021-04-21 21:20:36 +02006550 their preceding segment.
6551
6552 Empty segments do not receive special treatment. Use the "merge-slashes"
6553 normalizer first if this is undesired.
6554
6555 Segments including percent encoded dots ("%2E") will not be detected. Use
6556 the "percent-decode-unreserved" normalizer first if this is undesired.
Tim Duesterhus9982fc22021-04-15 21:45:59 +02006557
6558 Example:
6559 - /foo/../ -> /
6560 - /foo/../bar/ -> /bar/
6561 - /foo/bar/../ -> /foo/
6562 - /../bar/ -> /../bar/
Tim Duesterhus560e1a62021-04-15 21:46:00 +02006563 - /bar/../../ -> /../
Tim Duesterhus9982fc22021-04-15 21:45:59 +02006564 - /foo//../ -> /foo/
Tim Duesterhus2e4a18e2021-04-21 21:20:36 +02006565 - /foo/%2E%2E/ -> /foo/%2E%2E/
Tim Duesterhus9982fc22021-04-15 21:45:59 +02006566
Tim Duesterhus560e1a62021-04-15 21:46:00 +02006567 If the "full" option is specified then "../" at the beginning will be
6568 removed as well:
6569
6570 Example:
6571 - /../bar/ -> /bar/
6572 - /bar/../../ -> /
6573
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02006574 - path-merge-slashes: Merges adjacent slashes within the "path" component
6575 into a single slash.
Tim Duesterhusd371e992021-04-15 21:45:58 +02006576
6577 Example:
6578 - // -> /
6579 - /foo//bar -> /foo/bar
6580
Tim Duesterhus2e4a18e2021-04-21 21:20:36 +02006581 - percent-decode-unreserved: Decodes unreserved percent encoded characters to
6582 their representation as a regular character (RFC 3986#6.2.2.2).
6583
6584 The set of unreserved characters includes all letters, all digits, "-",
6585 ".", "_", and "~".
6586
6587 Example:
6588 - /%61dmin -> /admin
6589 - /foo%3Fbar=baz -> /foo%3Fbar=baz (no change)
6590 - /%%36%36 -> /%66 (unsafe)
6591 - /%ZZ -> /%ZZ
6592
6593 If the "strict" option is specified then invalid sequences will result
6594 in a HTTP 400 Bad Request being returned.
6595
6596 Example:
6597 - /%%36%36 -> HTTP 400
6598 - /%ZZ -> HTTP 400
6599
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02006600 - percent-to-uppercase: Uppercases letters within percent-encoded sequences
Tim Duesterhusc315efd2021-04-21 21:20:34 +02006601 (RFC 3986#6.2.2.1).
Tim Duesterhusa4071932021-04-15 21:46:02 +02006602
6603 Example:
6604 - /%6f -> /%6F
6605 - /%zz -> /%zz
6606
6607 If the "strict" option is specified then invalid sequences will result
6608 in a HTTP 400 Bad Request being returned.
6609
6610 Example:
6611 - /%zz -> HTTP 400
6612
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02006613 - query-sort-by-name: Sorts the query string parameters by parameter name.
Tim Duesterhusd7b89be2021-04-15 21:46:01 +02006614 Parameters are assumed to be delimited by '&'. Shorter names sort before
6615 longer names and identical parameter names maintain their relative order.
6616
6617 Example:
6618 - /?c=3&a=1&b=2 -> /?a=1&b=2&c=3
6619 - /?aaa=3&a=1&aa=2 -> /?a=1&aa=2&aaa=3
6620 - /?a=3&b=4&a=1&b=5&a=2 -> /?a=3&a=1&a=2&b=4&b=5
6621
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006622http-request redirect <rule> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006623
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006624 This performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule. This is exactly
6625 the same as the "redirect" statement except that it inserts a redirect rule
6626 which can be processed in the middle of other "http-request" rules and that
6627 these rules use the "log-format" strings. See the "redirect" keyword for the
6628 rule's syntax.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006629
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006630http-request reject [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006631
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006632 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately closes the connection
6633 without sending any response. It acts similarly to the
6634 "tcp-request content reject" rules. It can be useful to force an immediate
6635 connection closure on HTTP/2 connections.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006636
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006637http-request replace-header <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
6638 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02006639
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05006640 This matches the value of all occurrences of header field <name> against
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006641 <match-regex>. Matching is performed case-sensitively. Matching values are
6642 completely replaced by <replace-fmt>. Format characters are allowed in
6643 <replace-fmt> and work like <fmt> arguments in "http-request add-header".
6644 Standard back-references using the backslash ('\') followed by a number are
6645 supported.
Thierry FOURNIER82bf70d2015-05-26 17:58:29 +02006646
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006647 This action acts on whole header lines, regardless of the number of values
6648 they may contain. Thus it is well-suited to process headers naturally
6649 containing commas in their value, such as If-Modified-Since. Headers that
6650 contain a comma-separated list of values, such as Accept, should be processed
6651 using "http-request replace-value".
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01006652
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006653 Example:
6654 http-request replace-header Cookie foo=([^;]*);(.*) foo=\1;ip=%bi;\2
6655
6656 # applied to:
6657 Cookie: foo=foobar; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
6658
6659 # outputs:
6660 Cookie: foo=foobar;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
6661
6662 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02006663
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006664 http-request replace-header User-Agent curl foo
6665
6666 # applied to:
6667 User-Agent: curl/7.47.0
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02006668
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006669 # outputs:
6670 User-Agent: foo
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02006671
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01006672http-request replace-path <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
6673 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6674
6675 This works like "replace-header" except that it works on the request's path
6676 component instead of a header. The path component starts at the first '/'
Christopher Faulet82c83322020-09-02 14:16:59 +02006677 after an optional scheme+authority and ends before the question mark. Thus,
6678 the replacement does not modify the scheme, the authority and the
6679 query-string.
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01006680
6681 It is worth noting that regular expressions may be more expensive to evaluate
6682 than certain ACLs, so rare replacements may benefit from a condition to avoid
6683 performing the evaluation at all if it does not match.
6684
6685 Example:
6686 # prefix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /foo/bar?q=1 :
6687 http-request replace-path (.*) /foo\1
6688
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01006689 # strip /foo : turn /foo/bar?q=1 into /bar?q=1
6690 http-request replace-path /foo/(.*) /\1
6691 # or more efficient if only some requests match :
6692 http-request replace-path /foo/(.*) /\1 if { url_beg /foo/ }
6693
Christopher Faulet312294f2020-09-02 17:17:44 +02006694http-request replace-pathq <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
6695 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6696
6697 This does the same as "http-request replace-path" except that the path
6698 contains the query-string if any is present. Thus, the path and the
6699 query-string are replaced.
6700
6701 Example:
6702 # suffix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /bar/foo?q=1 :
6703 http-request replace-pathq ([^?]*)(\?(.*))? \1/foo\2
6704
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02006705http-request replace-uri <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
6706 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6707
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006708 This works like "replace-header" except that it works on the request's URI part
6709 instead of a header. The URI part may contain an optional scheme, authority or
6710 query string. These are considered to be part of the value that is matched
6711 against.
6712
6713 It is worth noting that regular expressions may be more expensive to evaluate
6714 than certain ACLs, so rare replacements may benefit from a condition to avoid
6715 performing the evaluation at all if it does not match.
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02006716
Willy Tarreau62b59132019-12-17 06:51:20 +01006717 IMPORTANT NOTE: historically in HTTP/1.x, the vast majority of requests sent
6718 by browsers use the "origin form", which differs from the "absolute form" in
6719 that they do not contain a scheme nor authority in the URI portion. Mostly
6720 only requests sent to proxies, those forged by hand and some emitted by
6721 certain applications use the absolute form. As such, "replace-uri" usually
6722 works fine most of the time in HTTP/1.x with rules starting with a "/". But
6723 with HTTP/2, clients are encouraged to send absolute URIs only, which look
6724 like the ones HTTP/1 clients use to talk to proxies. Such partial replace-uri
6725 rules may then fail in HTTP/2 when they work in HTTP/1. Either the rules need
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01006726 to be adapted to optionally match a scheme and authority, or replace-path
6727 should be used.
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02006728
Willy Tarreau62b59132019-12-17 06:51:20 +01006729 Example:
6730 # rewrite all "http" absolute requests to "https":
6731 http-request replace-uri ^http://(.*) https://\1
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02006732
Willy Tarreau62b59132019-12-17 06:51:20 +01006733 # prefix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /foo/bar?q=1 :
6734 http-request replace-uri ([^/:]*://[^/]*)?(.*) \1/foo\2
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02006735
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006736http-request replace-value <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
6737 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02006738
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006739 This works like "replace-header" except that it matches the regex against
6740 every comma-delimited value of the header field <name> instead of the
6741 entire header. This is suited for all headers which are allowed to carry
6742 more than one value. An example could be the Accept header.
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02006743
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006744 Example:
6745 http-request replace-value X-Forwarded-For ^192\.168\.(.*)$ 172.16.\1
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02006746
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006747 # applied to:
6748 X-Forwarded-For: 192.168.10.1, 192.168.13.24, 10.0.0.37
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02006749
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006750 # outputs:
6751 X-Forwarded-For: 172.16.10.1, 172.16.13.24, 10.0.0.37
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01006752
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006753http-request return [status <code>] [content-type <type>]
6754 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
6755 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01006756 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006757 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6758
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05006759 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately returns a response. The
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006760 default status code used for the response is 200. It can be optionally
6761 specified as an arguments to "status". The response content-type may also be
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04006762 specified as an argument to "content-type". Finally the response itself may
Sébastien Grossab877122020-10-08 10:06:03 +02006763 be defined. It can be a full HTTP response specifying the errorfile to use,
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05006764 or the response payload specifying the file or the string to use. These rules
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006765 are followed to create the response :
6766
6767 * If neither the errorfile nor the payload to use is defined, a dummy
6768 response is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It can be
6769 any code in the range [200, 599]. The "content-type" argument, if any, is
6770 ignored.
6771
6772 * If "default-errorfiles" argument is set, the proxy's errorfiles are
6773 considered. If the "status" argument is defined, it must be one of the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04006774 status code handled by HAProxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 413,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01006775 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type" argument, if
6776 any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006777
6778 * If a specific errorfile is defined, with an "errorfile" argument, the
6779 corresponding file, containing a full HTTP response, is returned. Only the
6780 "status" argument is considered. It must be one of the status code handled
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04006781 by HAProxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 501,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01006782 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type" argument, if any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006783
6784 * If an http-errors section is defined, with an "errorfiles" argument, the
6785 corresponding file in the specified http-errors section, containing a full
6786 HTTP response, is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04006787 must be one of the status code handled by HAProxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01006788 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type"
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02006789 argument, if any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006790
6791 * If a "file" or a "lf-file" argument is specified, the file's content is
6792 used as the response payload. If the file is not empty, its content-type
6793 must be set as argument to "content-type". Otherwise, any "content-type"
6794 argument is ignored. With a "lf-file" argument, the file's content is
6795 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "file" argument, it is considered
6796 as a raw content.
6797
6798 * If a "string" or "lf-string" argument is specified, the defined string is
6799 used as the response payload. The content-type must always be set as
6800 argument to "content-type". With a "lf-string" argument, the string is
6801 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "string" argument, it is
6802 considered as a raw string.
6803
Sébastien Grossab877122020-10-08 10:06:03 +02006804 When the response is not based on an errorfile, it is possible to append HTTP
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01006805 header fields to the response using "hdr" arguments. Otherwise, all "hdr"
6806 arguments are ignored. For each one, the header name is specified in <name>
6807 and its value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules.
6808
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006809 Note that the generated response must be smaller than a buffer. And to avoid
6810 any warning, when an errorfile or a raw file is loaded, the buffer space
Sébastien Grossab877122020-10-08 10:06:03 +02006811 reserved for the headers rewriting should also be free.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006812
6813 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
6814
6815 Example:
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04006816 http-request return errorfile /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/200.http \
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006817 if { path /ping }
6818
6819 http-request return content-type image/x-icon file /var/www/favicon.ico \
6820 if { path /favicon.ico }
6821
6822 http-request return status 403 content-type text/plain \
6823 lf-string "Access denied. IP %[src] is blacklisted." \
6824 if { src -f /etc/haproxy/blacklist.lst }
6825
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +02006826http-request sc-inc-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6827
6828 This actions increments the General Purpose Counter at the index <idx>
6829 of the array associated to the sticky counter designated by <sc-id>.
6830 If an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation
6831 continues. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99 and <sc-id> is an integer
6832 between 0 and 2. It also silently fails if the there is no GPC stored
6833 at this index.
6834 This action applies only to the 'gpc' and 'gpc_rate' array data_types (and
6835 not to the legacy 'gpc0', 'gpc1', 'gpc0_rate' nor 'gpc1_rate' data_types).
6836
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006837http-request sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6838http-request sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006839
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006840 This actions increments the GPC0 or GPC1 counter according with the sticky
6841 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails
6842 and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006843
Emeric Brun877b0b52021-06-30 18:57:49 +02006844http-request sc-set-gpt(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
6845 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6846 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT at the index <idx> of the array
6847 associated to the sticky counter designated by <sc-id> at the value of
6848 <int>/<expr>. The expected result is a boolean.
6849 If an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation
6850 continues. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99 and <sc-id> is an integer
6851 between 0 and 2. It also silently fails if the there is no GPT stored
6852 at this index.
6853 This action applies only to the 'gpt' array data_type (and not to the
6854 legacy 'gpt0' data-type).
6855
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01006856http-request sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
6857 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006858
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01006859 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter
6860 designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The expected result is a
6861 boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions
6862 evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006863
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02006864http-request send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
6865 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6866
6867 This action is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. To do so,
6868 the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as well as the SPOE
6869 group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an existing SPOE
6870 filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line, the SPOE
6871 agent name must be used.
6872
6873 Arguments:
6874 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
6875
6876 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine
6877 configuration.
6878
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006879http-request set-dst <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006880
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006881 This is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
6882 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites destination IP,
6883 but provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask the IP for
6884 privacy. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use '0.0.0.0:0' as a
6885 server address in the backend.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01006886
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006887 Arguments:
6888 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
6889 by some converters.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01006890
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006891 Example:
6892 http-request set-dst hdr(x-dst)
6893 http-request set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01006894
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006895 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as the
6896 address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02006897
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006898http-request set-dst-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02006899
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006900 This is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
6901 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use '0.0.0.0:0'
6902 as a server address in the backend.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02006903
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006904 Arguments:
6905 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
6906 followed by some converters.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02006907
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006908 Example:
6909 http-request set-dst-port hdr(x-port)
6910 http-request set-dst-port int(4000)
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02006911
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006912 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
6913 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
6914 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02006915
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006916http-request set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02006917
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006918 This does the same as "http-request add-header" except that the header name
6919 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
6920 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
6921 external users. Note that the new value is computed before the removal so it
6922 is possible to concatenate a value to an existing header.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02006923
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006924 Example:
6925 http-request set-header X-Haproxy-Current-Date %T
6926 http-request set-header X-SSL %[ssl_fc]
6927 http-request set-header X-SSL-Session_ID %[ssl_fc_session_id,hex]
6928 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-Verify %[ssl_c_verify]
6929 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-DN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn]
6930 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-CN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn(cn)]
6931 http-request set-header X-SSL-Issuer %{+Q}[ssl_c_i_dn]
6932 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotBefore %{+Q}[ssl_c_notbefore]
6933 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotAfter %{+Q}[ssl_c_notafter]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02006934
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006935http-request set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02006936
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006937 This is used to change the log level of the current request when a certain
6938 condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels (see the "log"
6939 keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables logging for this
6940 request. This rule is not final so the last matching rule wins. This rule
6941 can be useful to disable health checks coming from another equipment.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006942
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006943http-request set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
6944 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006945
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006946 This is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
6947 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
6948 passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>, which follows
6949 log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>, which follows
6950 log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry.
6951 It performs a lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
6952 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
6953 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the
6954 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006955
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006956http-request set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006957
David Carlierf7f53af2021-06-26 12:04:36 +01006958 This is used to set the Netfilter/IPFW MARK on all packets sent to the client
6959 to the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This value is an
6960 unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter/ipfw and by the
6961 routing table or monitoring the packets through DTrace. It can be expressed
6962 both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x").
6963 This can be useful to force certain packets to take a different route (for
6964 example a cheaper network path for bulk downloads). This works on Linux
David Carlierbae4cb22021-07-03 10:15:15 +01006965 kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires admin privileges, as well on FreeBSD
6966 and OpenBSD.
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02006967
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006968http-request set-method <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006969
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006970 This rewrites the request method with the result of the evaluation of format
6971 string <fmt>. There should be very few valid reasons for having to do so as
6972 this is more likely to break something than to fix it.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006973
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006974http-request set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006975
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006976 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed. It only
6977 has effect against the other requests being processed at the same time.
6978 The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the "bind"
6979 line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the nicest
6980 the request will be. Lower values will make the request more important than
6981 other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of some requests, or
6982 lower the priority of non-important requests. Using this setting without
6983 prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006984
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006985http-request set-path <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02006986
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006987 This rewrites the request path with the result of the evaluation of format
6988 string <fmt>. The query string, if any, is left intact. If a scheme and
6989 authority is found before the path, they are left intact as well. If the
6990 request doesn't have a path ("*"), this one is replaced with the format.
6991 This can be used to prepend a directory component in front of a path for
6992 example. See also "http-request set-query" and "http-request set-uri".
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02006993
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006994 Example :
6995 # prepend the host name before the path
6996 http-request set-path /%[hdr(host)]%[path]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02006997
Christopher Faulet312294f2020-09-02 17:17:44 +02006998http-request set-pathq <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6999
7000 This does the same as "http-request set-path" except that the query-string is
7001 also rewritten. It may be used to remove the query-string, including the
7002 question mark (it is not possible using "http-request set-query").
7003
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007004http-request set-priority-class <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Olivier Houchardccaa7de2017-10-02 11:51:03 +02007005
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007006 This is used to set the queue priority class of the current request.
7007 The value must be a sample expression which converts to an integer in the
7008 range -2047..2047. Results outside this range will be truncated.
7009 The priority class determines the order in which queued requests are
7010 processed. Lower values have higher priority.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02007011
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007012http-request set-priority-offset <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02007013
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007014 This is used to set the queue priority timestamp offset of the current
7015 request. The value must be a sample expression which converts to an integer
7016 in the range -524287..524287. Results outside this range will be truncated.
7017 When a request is queued, it is ordered first by the priority class, then by
7018 the current timestamp adjusted by the given offset in milliseconds. Lower
7019 values have higher priority.
7020 Note that the resulting timestamp is is only tracked with enough precision
7021 for 524,287ms (8m44s287ms). If the request is queued long enough to where the
7022 adjusted timestamp exceeds this value, it will be misidentified as highest
7023 priority. Thus it is important to set "timeout queue" to a value, where when
7024 combined with the offset, does not exceed this limit.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02007025
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007026http-request set-query <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01007027
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007028 This rewrites the request's query string which appears after the first
7029 question mark ("?") with the result of the evaluation of format string <fmt>.
7030 The part prior to the question mark is left intact. If the request doesn't
7031 contain a question mark and the new value is not empty, then one is added at
7032 the end of the URI, followed by the new value. If a question mark was
7033 present, it will never be removed even if the value is empty. This can be
7034 used to add or remove parameters from the query string.
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007035
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007036 See also "http-request set-query" and "http-request set-uri".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01007037
7038 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007039 # replace "%3D" with "=" in the query string
7040 http-request set-query %[query,regsub(%3D,=,g)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01007041
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007042http-request set-src <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7043 This is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
7044 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites source IP, but
7045 provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask source IP for
Olivier Doucet56e31202020-04-21 09:32:56 +02007046 privacy. All subsequent calls to "src" fetch will return this value
7047 (see example).
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007048
7049 Arguments :
7050 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
7051 by some converters.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01007052
Olivier Doucet56e31202020-04-21 09:32:56 +02007053 See also "option forwardfor".
7054
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01007055 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007056 http-request set-src hdr(x-forwarded-for)
7057 http-request set-src src,ipmask(24)
7058
Olivier Doucet56e31202020-04-21 09:32:56 +02007059 # After the masking this will track connections
7060 # based on the IP address with the last byte zeroed out.
7061 http-request track-sc0 src
7062
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007063 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
7064 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
7065
7066http-request set-src-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7067
7068 This is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
7069 expression.
7070
7071 Arguments:
7072 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
7073 by some converters.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01007074
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01007075 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007076 http-request set-src-port hdr(x-port)
7077 http-request set-src-port int(4000)
7078
7079 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long as
7080 the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source address to
7081 IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
7082
Alex59c53352021-04-27 12:57:07 +02007083http-request set-timeout { server | tunnel } { <timeout> | <expr> }
Amaury Denoyelle8d228232020-12-10 13:43:54 +01007084 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7085
7086 This action overrides the specified "server" or "tunnel" timeout for the
7087 current stream only. The timeout can be specified in millisecond or with any
7088 other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit as explained at the top of
7089 this document. It is also possible to write an expression which must returns
7090 a number interpreted as a timeout in millisecond.
7091
7092 Note that the server/tunnel timeouts are only relevant on the backend side
7093 and thus this rule is only available for the proxies with backend
7094 capabilities. Also the timeout value must be non-null to obtain the expected
7095 results.
7096
7097 Example:
Alex59c53352021-04-27 12:57:07 +02007098 http-request set-timeout tunnel 5s
7099 http-request set-timeout server req.hdr(host),map_int(host.lst)
Amaury Denoyelle8d228232020-12-10 13:43:54 +01007100
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007101http-request set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7102
7103 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
7104 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this. This value
7105 represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be expressed both in
7106 decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note that only the 6 higher
7107 bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower bits are always 0. This can
7108 be used to adjust some routing behavior on border routers based on some
7109 information from the request.
7110
7111 See RFC 2474, 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
7112
7113http-request set-uri <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7114
7115 This rewrites the request URI with the result of the evaluation of format
7116 string <fmt>. The scheme, authority, path and query string are all replaced
7117 at once. This can be used to rewrite hosts in front of proxies, or to
7118 perform complex modifications to the URI such as moving parts between the
7119 path and the query string.
7120 See also "http-request set-path" and "http-request set-query".
7121
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +01007122http-request set-var(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7123http-request set-var-fmt(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007124
7125 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
7126 inline.
7127
7128 Arguments:
7129 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
7130 scope. The scopes allowed are:
7131 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
7132 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
7133 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
7134 (request and response)
7135 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
7136 processing
7137 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
7138 processing
7139 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
7140 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9'
7141 and '_'.
7142
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +01007143 <cond> A set of conditions that must all be true for the variable to
7144 actually be set (such as "ifnotempty", "ifgt" ...). See the
Ilya Shipitsin5e87bcf2021-12-25 11:45:52 +05007145 set-var converter's description for a full list of possible
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +01007146 conditions.
7147
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007148 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
7149 followed by some converters.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01007150
Willy Tarreau9a621ae2021-09-02 21:00:38 +02007151 <fmt> This is the value expressed using log-format rules (see Custom
7152 Log Format in section 8.2.4).
7153
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007154 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007155 http-request set-var(req.my_var) req.fhdr(user-agent),lower
Willy Tarreau9a621ae2021-09-02 21:00:38 +02007156 http-request set-var-fmt(txn.from) %[src]:%[src_port]
7157
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007158http-request silent-drop [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7159
7160 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
7161 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
7162 client from being notified. The effect it then that the client still sees an
7163 established connection while there's none on HAProxy. The purpose is to
7164 achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit" except that it doesn't use any local
7165 resource at all on the machine running HAProxy. It can resist much higher
7166 loads than "tarpit", and slow down stronger attackers. It is important to
7167 understand the impact of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed
7168 between the client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also
7169 keep the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
7170 action.
7171 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR socket
7172 option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other systems, the
7173 socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't pass the first
7174 router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do not use it unless
7175 you fully understand how it works.
7176
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02007177http-request strict-mode { on | off } [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01007178
7179 This enables or disables the strict rewriting mode for following rules. It
7180 does not affect rules declared before it and it is only applicable on rules
7181 performing a rewrite on the requests. When the strict mode is enabled, any
7182 rewrite failure triggers an internal error. Otherwise, such errors are
7183 silently ignored. The purpose of the strict rewriting mode is to make some
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05007184 rewrites optional while others must be performed to continue the request
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01007185 processing.
7186
Christopher Faulet1aea50e2020-01-17 16:03:53 +01007187 By default, the strict rewriting mode is enabled. Its value is also reset
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01007188 when a ruleset evaluation ends. So, for instance, if you change the mode on
7189 the frontend, the default mode is restored when HAProxy starts the backend
7190 rules evaluation.
7191
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02007192http-request tarpit [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7193http-request tarpit [ { status | deny_status } <code>] [content-type <type>]
7194 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
7195 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
7196 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
7197 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007198
7199 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately blocks the request
7200 without responding for a delay specified by "timeout tarpit" or
7201 "timeout connect" if the former is not set. After that delay, if the client
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02007202 is still connected, a response is returned so that the client does not
7203 suspect it has been tarpitted. Logs will report the flags "PT". The goal of
7204 the tarpit rule is to slow down robots during an attack when they're limited
7205 on the number of concurrent requests. It can be very efficient against very
7206 dumb robots, and will significantly reduce the load on firewalls compared to
7207 a "deny" rule. But when facing "correctly" developed robots, it can make
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007208 things worse by forcing HAProxy and the front firewall to support insane
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02007209 number of concurrent connections. By default an HTTP error 500 is returned.
7210 But the response may be customized using same syntax than
7211 "http-request return" rules. Thus, see "http-request return" for details.
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05007212 For compatibility purpose, when no argument is defined, or only "deny_status",
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02007213 the argument "default-errorfiles" is implied. It means
7214 "http-request tarpit [deny_status <status>]" is an alias of
7215 "http-request tarpit [status <status>] default-errorfiles".
7216 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
7217 See also "http-request return" and "http-request silent-drop".
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007218
7219http-request track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7220http-request track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7221http-request track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7222
7223 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current request. These rules do
7224 not stop evaluation and do not change default action. The number of counters
7225 that may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection is set in
7226 MAX_SESS_STKCTR at build time (reported in haproxy -vv) which defaults to 3,
Matteo Contrini1857b8c2020-10-16 17:35:54 +02007227 so the track-sc number is between 0 and (MAX_SESS_STKCTR-1). The first
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007228 "track-sc0" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the specified
7229 table as the first set. The first "track-sc1" rule executed enables tracking
7230 of the counters of the specified table as the second set. The first
7231 "track-sc2" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the specified
7232 table as the third set. It is a recommended practice to use the first set of
7233 counters for the per-frontend counters and the second set for the per-backend
7234 ones. But this is just a guideline, all may be used everywhere.
7235
7236 Arguments :
7237 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described in
7238 section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming request or
7239 connection will be analyzed, extracted, combined, and used to
7240 select which table entry to update the counters.
7241
7242 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one, which
7243 is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All the counters
7244 for the matches and updates for the key will then be performed in
7245 that table until the session ends.
7246
7247 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table and if
7248 it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to that entry
7249 is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's counters are updated
7250 as often as possible, every time the session's counters are updated, and also
7251 systematically when the session ends. Counters are only updated for events
7252 that happen after the tracking has been started. As an exception, connection
7253 counters and request counters are systematically updated so that they reflect
7254 useful information.
7255
7256 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is counted
7257 for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not expire during
7258 that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance advantage over just
7259 checking the keys, because only one table lookup is performed for all ACL
7260 checks that make use of it.
7261
7262http-request unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7263
7264 This is used to unset a variable. See above for details about <var-name>.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007265
7266 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007267 http-request unset-var(req.my_var)
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007268
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +01007269http-request use-service <service-name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7270
7271 This directive executes the configured HTTP service to reply to the request
7272 and stops the evaluation of the rules. An HTTP service may choose to reply by
7273 sending any valid HTTP response or it may immediately close the connection
7274 without sending any response. Outside natives services, for instance the
7275 Prometheus exporter, it is possible to write your own services in Lua. No
7276 further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
7277
7278 Arguments :
7279 <service-name> is mandatory. It is the service to call
7280
7281 Example:
7282 http-request use-service prometheus-exporter if { path /metrics }
7283
Christopher Faulet021a8e42021-03-29 10:46:38 +02007284http-request wait-for-body time <time> [ at-least <bytes> ]
7285 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7286
7287 This will delay the processing of the request waiting for the payload for at
7288 most <time> milliseconds. if "at-least" argument is specified, HAProxy stops
7289 to wait the payload when the first <bytes> bytes are received. 0 means no
7290 limit, it is the default value. Regardless the "at-least" argument value,
7291 HAProxy stops to wait if the whole payload is received or if the request
7292 buffer is full. This action may be used as a replacement to "option
7293 http-buffer-request".
7294
7295 Arguments :
7296
7297 <time> is mandatory. It is the maximum time to wait for the body. It
7298 follows the HAProxy time format and is expressed in milliseconds.
7299
7300 <bytes> is optional. It is the minimum payload size to receive to stop to
Ilya Shipitsinb2be9a12021-04-24 13:25:42 +05007301 wait. It follows the HAProxy size format and is expressed in
Christopher Faulet021a8e42021-03-29 10:46:38 +02007302 bytes.
7303
7304 Example:
7305 http-request wait-for-body time 1s at-least 1k if METH_POST
7306
7307 See also : "option http-buffer-request"
7308
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007309http-request wait-for-handshake [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007310
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007311 This will delay the processing of the request until the SSL handshake
7312 happened. This is mostly useful to delay processing early data until we're
7313 sure they are valid.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007314
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01007315
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007316http-response <action> <options...> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02007317 Access control for Layer 7 responses
7318
7319 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +02007320 yes(!) | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02007321
7322 The http-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
7323 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
7324 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
7325 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
7326 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
7327 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
7328
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02007329 The first keyword is the rule's action. Several types of actions are
7330 supported:
7331 - add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt>
7332 - add-header <name> <fmt>
7333 - allow
7334 - cache-store <name>
7335 - capture <sample> id <id>
7336 - del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt>
7337 - del-header <name> [ -m <meth> ]
7338 - del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt>
7339 - deny [ { status | deny_status } <code>] ...
7340 - redirect <rule>
7341 - replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
7342 - replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
7343 - return [status <code>] [content-type <type>] ...
7344 - sc-inc-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>)
7345 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
7346 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
7347 - sc-set-gpt(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
7348 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
7349 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
7350 - set-header <name> <fmt>
7351 - set-log-level <level>
7352 - set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
7353 - set-mark <mark>
7354 - set-nice <nice>
7355 - set-status <status> [reason <str>]
7356 - set-tos <tos>
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +01007357 - set-var(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <expr>
7358 - set-var-fmt(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <fmt>
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02007359 - silent-drop
7360 - strict-mode { on | off }
7361 - track-sc0 <key> [table <table>]
7362 - track-sc1 <key> [table <table>]
7363 - track-sc2 <key> [table <table>]
7364 - unset-var(<var-name>)
7365 - wait-for-body time <time> [ at-least <bytes> ]
7366
7367 The supported actions are described below.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02007368
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007369 There is no limit to the number of http-response statements per instance.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02007370
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +02007371 This directive is only available from named defaults sections, not anonymous
7372 ones. Rules defined in the defaults section are evaluated before ones in the
7373 associated proxy section. To avoid ambiguities, in this case the same
7374 defaults section cannot be used by proxies with the frontend capability and
7375 by proxies with the backend capability. It means a listen section cannot use
7376 a defaults section defining such rules.
7377
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007378 Example:
7379 acl key_acl res.hdr(X-Acl-Key) -m found
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02007380
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007381 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007382
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007383 http-response add-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
7384 http-response del-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007385
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007386 Example:
7387 acl value res.hdr(X-Value) -m found
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007388
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007389 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007390
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007391 http-response set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[res.hdr(X-Value)] if value
7392 http-response del-map(map.lst) %[src] if ! value
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007393
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007394 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
7395 ACL usage.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007396
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007397http-response add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007398
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02007399 This is used to add a new entry into an ACL. Please refer to "http-request
7400 add-acl" for a complete description.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007401
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007402http-response add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007403
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007404 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and whose
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02007405 value is defined by <fmt>. Please refer to "http-request add-header" for a
7406 complete description.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007407
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007408http-response allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007409
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007410 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response pass the check.
7411 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated for the current section.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007412
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +02007413http-response cache-store <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007414
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02007415 See section 6.2 about cache setup.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007416
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007417http-response capture <sample> id <id> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007418
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007419 This captures sample expression <sample> from the response buffer, and
7420 converts it to a string. The resulting string is stored into the next request
7421 "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to some captured HTTP
7422 headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs, and it will be
7423 possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it into headers or
7424 anything. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and
7425 "capture response header" for more information.
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02007426
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007427 The keyword "id" is the id of the capture slot which is used for storing the
7428 string. The capture slot must be defined in an associated frontend.
7429 This is useful to run captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a
7430 previous directive "http-response capture" or with the "declare capture"
7431 keyword.
Baptiste Assmann19a69b32020-01-16 14:34:22 +01007432
7433 When using this action in a backend, double check that the relevant
7434 frontend(s) have the required capture slots otherwise, this rule will be
7435 ignored at run time. This can't be detected at configuration parsing time
7436 due to HAProxy's ability to dynamically resolve backend name at runtime.
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02007437
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007438http-response del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02007439
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02007440 This is used to delete an entry from an ACL. Please refer to "http-request
7441 del-acl" for a complete description.
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02007442
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00007443http-response del-header <name> [ -m <meth> ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02007444
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02007445 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>. Please
7446 refer to "http-request del-header" for a complete description.
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02007447
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007448http-response del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02007449
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02007450 This is used to delete an entry from a MAP. Please refer to "http-request
7451 del-map" for a complete description.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007452
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02007453http-response deny [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7454http-response deny [ { status | deny_status } <code>] [content-type <type>]
7455 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
7456 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
7457 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
7458 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007459
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02007460 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects the response.
7461 By default an HTTP 502 error is returned. But the response may be customized
7462 using same syntax than "http-response return" rules. Thus, see
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05007463 "http-response return" for details. For compatibility purpose, when no
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02007464 argument is defined, or only "deny_status", the argument "default-errorfiles"
7465 is implied. It means "http-response deny [deny_status <status>]" is an alias
7466 of "http-response deny [status <status>] default-errorfiles".
Christopher Faulet040c8cd2020-01-13 16:43:45 +01007467 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated.
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02007468 See also "http-response return".
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007469
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007470http-response redirect <rule> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007471
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007472 This performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule.
7473 This supports a format string similarly to "http-request redirect" rules,
7474 with the exception that only the "location" type of redirect is possible on
7475 the response. See the "redirect" keyword for the rule's syntax. When a
7476 redirect rule is applied during a response, connections to the server are
7477 closed so that no data can be forwarded from the server to the client.
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02007478
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007479http-response replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
7480 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02007481
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01007482 This works like "http-request replace-header" except that it works on the
7483 server's response instead of the client's request.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01007484
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007485 Example:
7486 http-response replace-header Set-Cookie (C=[^;]*);(.*) \1;ip=%bi;\2
Willy Tarreau51d861a2015-05-22 17:30:48 +02007487
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007488 # applied to:
7489 Set-Cookie: C=1; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02007490
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007491 # outputs:
7492 Set-Cookie: C=1;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02007493
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007494 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02007495
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007496http-response replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
7497 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02007498
Tim Duesterhus6bd909b2020-01-17 15:53:18 +01007499 This works like "http-request replace-value" except that it works on the
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01007500 server's response instead of the client's request.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02007501
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007502 Example:
7503 http-response replace-value Cache-control ^public$ private
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01007504
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007505 # applied to:
7506 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, public
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01007507
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007508 # outputs:
7509 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, private
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01007510
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007511http-response return [status <code>] [content-type <type>]
7512 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
7513 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01007514 [ hdr <name> <value> ]*
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007515 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7516
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02007517 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately returns a
7518 response. Please refer to "http-request return" for a complete
7519 description. No further "http-response" rules are evaluated.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007520
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +02007521http-response sc-inc-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007522http-response sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7523http-response sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Ruoshan Huange4edc6b2016-07-14 15:07:45 +08007524
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02007525 These actions increment the General Purppose Counters according to the sticky
7526 counter designated by <sc-id>. Please refer to "http-request sc-inc-gpc",
7527 "http-request sc-inc-gpc0" and "http-request sc-inc-gpc1" for a complete
7528 description.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02007529
Emeric Brun877b0b52021-06-30 18:57:49 +02007530http-response sc-set-gpt(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02007531 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01007532http-response sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
7533 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02007534http-response sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
7535 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02007536
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02007537 These actions set the 32-bit unsigned General Purpose Tags according to the
7538 sticky counter designated by <sc-id>. Please refer to "http-request
7539 sc-inc-gpt" and "http-request sc-inc-gpt0" for a complete description.
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01007540
Christopher Faulet24e7f352021-08-12 09:32:07 +02007541http-response send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
7542 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02007543
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02007544 This action is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. Please
7545 refer to "http-request send-spoe-group" for a complete description.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02007546
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007547http-response set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02007548
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02007549 This does the same as "http-response add-header" except that the header name
7550 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
7551 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
7552 external users.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02007553
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007554http-response set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7555
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02007556 This is used to change the log level of the current response. Please refer to
7557 "http-request set-log-level" for a complete description.
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007558
7559http-response set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
7560
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02007561 This is used to add a new entry into a MAP. Please refer to "http-request
7562 set-map" for a complete description.
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007563
7564http-response set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7565
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02007566 This action is used to set the Netfilter/IPFW MARK in all packets sent to the
7567 client to the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. Please
7568 refer to "http-request set-mark" for a complete description.
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007569
7570http-response set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7571
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02007572 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed. Please
7573 refer to "http-request set-nice" for a complete description.
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007574
7575http-response set-status <status> [reason <str>]
7576 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7577
7578 This replaces the response status code with <status> which must be an integer
7579 between 100 and 999. Optionally, a custom reason text can be provided defined
7580 by <str>, or the default reason for the specified code will be used as a
7581 fallback.
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007582
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007583 Example:
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007584 # return "431 Request Header Fields Too Large"
7585 http-response set-status 431
7586 # return "503 Slow Down", custom reason
7587 http-response set-status 503 reason "Slow Down".
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007588
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007589http-response set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007590
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007591 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02007592 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this. Please refer to
7593 "http-request set-tos" for a complete description.
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007594
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +01007595http-response set-var(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7596http-response set-var-fmt(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007597
7598 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02007599 inline. Please refer to "http-request set-var" and "http-request set-var-fmt"
7600 for a complete description.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007601
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007602http-response silent-drop [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007603
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007604 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
7605 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02007606 client from being notified. Please refer to "http-request silent-drop" for a
7607 complete description.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007608
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02007609http-response strict-mode { on | off } [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01007610
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02007611 This enables or disables the strict rewriting mode for following
7612 rules. Please refer to "http-request strict-mode" for a complete description.
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01007613
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007614http-response track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7615http-response track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7616http-response track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02007617
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02007618 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. Please
7619 refer to "http-request track-sc0", "http-request track-sc1" and "http-request
7620 track-sc2" for a complete description.
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007621
7622http-response unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7623
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02007624 This is used to unset a variable. See "http-request set-var" for details
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007625 about <var-name>.
7626
Christopher Faulet021a8e42021-03-29 10:46:38 +02007627http-response wait-for-body time <time> [ at-least <bytes> ]
7628 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7629
7630 This will delay the processing of the response waiting for the payload for at
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02007631 most <time> milliseconds. Please refer to "http-request wait-for-body" for a
7632 complete description.
Christopher Faulet021a8e42021-03-29 10:46:38 +02007633
Baptiste Assmann5ecb77f2013-10-06 23:24:13 +02007634
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007635http-reuse { never | safe | aggressive | always }
7636 Declare how idle HTTP connections may be shared between requests
7637
7638 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7639 yes | no | yes | yes
7640
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007641 By default, a connection established between HAProxy and the backend server
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01007642 which is considered safe for reuse is moved back to the server's idle
7643 connections pool so that any other request can make use of it. This is the
7644 "safe" strategy below.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007645
7646 The argument indicates the desired connection reuse strategy :
7647
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01007648 - "never" : idle connections are never shared between sessions. This mode
7649 may be enforced to cancel a different strategy inherited from
7650 a defaults section or for troubleshooting. For example, if an
7651 old bogus application considers that multiple requests over
7652 the same connection come from the same client and it is not
7653 possible to fix the application, it may be desirable to
7654 disable connection sharing in a single backend. An example of
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007655 such an application could be an old HAProxy using cookie
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01007656 insertion in tunnel mode and not checking any request past the
7657 first one.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007658
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01007659 - "safe" : this is the default and the recommended strategy. The first
7660 request of a session is always sent over its own connection,
7661 and only subsequent requests may be dispatched over other
7662 existing connections. This ensures that in case the server
7663 closes the connection when the request is being sent, the
7664 browser can decide to silently retry it. Since it is exactly
7665 equivalent to regular keep-alive, there should be no side
Amaury Denoyelle27179652020-10-14 18:17:12 +02007666 effects. There is also a special handling for the connections
7667 using protocols subject to Head-of-line blocking (backend with
7668 h2 or fcgi). In this case, when at least one stream is
7669 processed, the used connection is reserved to handle streams
7670 of the same session. When no more streams are processed, the
7671 connection is released and can be reused.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007672
7673 - "aggressive" : this mode may be useful in webservices environments where
7674 all servers are not necessarily known and where it would be
7675 appreciable to deliver most first requests over existing
7676 connections. In this case, first requests are only delivered
7677 over existing connections that have been reused at least once,
7678 proving that the server correctly supports connection reuse.
7679 It should only be used when it's sure that the client can
7680 retry a failed request once in a while and where the benefit
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02007681 of aggressive connection reuse significantly outweighs the
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007682 downsides of rare connection failures.
7683
7684 - "always" : this mode is only recommended when the path to the server is
7685 known for never breaking existing connections quickly after
7686 releasing them. It allows the first request of a session to be
7687 sent to an existing connection. This can provide a significant
7688 performance increase over the "safe" strategy when the backend
7689 is a cache farm, since such components tend to show a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007690 consistent behavior and will benefit from the connection
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007691 sharing. It is recommended that the "http-keep-alive" timeout
7692 remains low in this mode so that no dead connections remain
7693 usable. In most cases, this will lead to the same performance
7694 gains as "aggressive" but with more risks. It should only be
7695 used when it improves the situation over "aggressive".
7696
7697 When http connection sharing is enabled, a great care is taken to respect the
Amaury Denoyelled773a4e2021-01-29 15:18:49 +01007698 connection properties and compatibility. Indeed, some properties are specific
7699 and it is not possibly to reuse it blindly. Those are the SSL SNI, source
7700 and destination address and proxy protocol block. A connection is reused only
7701 if it shares the same set of properties with the request.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007702
Amaury Denoyelled773a4e2021-01-29 15:18:49 +01007703 Also note that connections with certain bogus authentication schemes (relying
7704 on the connection) like NTLM are marked private and never shared.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007705
Lukas Tribuse8adfeb2019-11-06 11:50:25 +01007706 A connection pool is involved and configurable with "pool-max-conn".
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007707
7708 Note: connection reuse improves the accuracy of the "server maxconn" setting,
7709 because almost no new connection will be established while idle connections
7710 remain available. This is particularly true with the "always" strategy.
7711
7712 See also : "option http-keep-alive", "server maxconn"
7713
7714
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007715http-send-name-header [<header>]
7716 Add the server name to a request. Use the header string given by <header>
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007717 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7718 yes | no | yes | yes
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007719 Arguments :
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007720 <header> The header string to use to send the server name
7721
Willy Tarreau81bef7e2019-10-07 14:58:02 +02007722 The "http-send-name-header" statement causes the header field named <header>
7723 to be set to the name of the target server at the moment the request is about
7724 to be sent on the wire. Any existing occurrences of this header are removed.
7725 Upon retries and redispatches, the header field is updated to always reflect
7726 the server being attempted to connect to. Given that this header is modified
7727 very late in the connection setup, it may have unexpected effects on already
7728 modified headers. For example using it with transport-level header such as
7729 connection, content-length, transfer-encoding and so on will likely result in
7730 invalid requests being sent to the server. Additionally it has been reported
7731 that this directive is currently being used as a way to overwrite the Host
7732 header field in outgoing requests; while this trick has been known to work
7733 as a side effect of the feature for some time, it is not officially supported
7734 and might possibly not work anymore in a future version depending on the
7735 technical difficulties this feature induces. A long-term solution instead
7736 consists in fixing the application which required this trick so that it binds
7737 to the correct host name.
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007738
7739 See also : "server"
7740
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01007741id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02007742 Set a persistent ID to a proxy.
7743 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7744 no | yes | yes | yes
7745 Arguments : none
7746
7747 Set a persistent ID for the proxy. This ID must be unique and positive.
7748 An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first assigned
7749 value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01007750
7751
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02007752ignore-persist { if | unless } <condition>
7753 Declare a condition to ignore persistence
7754 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01007755 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02007756
7757 By default, when cookie persistence is enabled, every requests containing
7758 the cookie are unconditionally persistent (assuming the target server is up
7759 and running).
7760
7761 The "ignore-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
7762 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore persistence.
7763 This is sometimes useful to load balance requests for static files, which
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007764 often don't require persistence. This can also be used to fully disable
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02007765 persistence for a specific User-Agent (for example, some web crawler bots).
7766
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02007767 The persistence is ignored when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
7768 "unless" condition is met.
7769
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03007770 Example:
7771 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
7772 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
7773 ignore-persist if url_static
7774
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02007775 See also : "force-persist", "cookie", and section 7 about ACL usage.
7776
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007777load-server-state-from-file { global | local | none }
7778 Allow seamless reload of HAProxy
7779 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7780 yes | no | yes | yes
7781
7782 This directive points HAProxy to a file where server state from previous
7783 running process has been saved. That way, when starting up, before handling
7784 traffic, the new process can apply old states to servers exactly has if no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007785 reload occurred. The purpose of the "load-server-state-from-file" directive is
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007786 to tell HAProxy which file to use. For now, only 2 arguments to either prevent
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007787 loading state or load states from a file containing all backends and servers.
7788 The state file can be generated by running the command "show servers state"
7789 over the stats socket and redirect output.
7790
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007791 The format of the file is versioned and is very specific. To understand it,
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007792 please read the documentation of the "show servers state" command (chapter
Willy Tarreau1af20c72017-06-23 16:01:14 +02007793 9.3 of Management Guide).
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007794
7795 Arguments:
7796 global load the content of the file pointed by the global directive
7797 named "server-state-file".
7798
7799 local load the content of the file pointed by the directive
7800 "server-state-file-name" if set. If not set, then the backend
7801 name is used as a file name.
7802
7803 none don't load any stat for this backend
7804
7805 Notes:
Willy Tarreaue5a60682016-11-09 14:54:53 +01007806 - server's IP address is preserved across reloads by default, but the
7807 order can be changed thanks to the server's "init-addr" setting. This
7808 means that an IP address change performed on the CLI at run time will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007809 be preserved, and that any change to the local resolver (e.g. /etc/hosts)
Willy Tarreaue5a60682016-11-09 14:54:53 +01007810 will possibly not have any effect if the state file is in use.
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007811
7812 - server's weight is applied from previous running process unless it has
7813 has changed between previous and new configuration files.
7814
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007815 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007816
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007817 global
7818 stats socket /tmp/socket
7819 server-state-file /tmp/server_state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007820
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007821 defaults
7822 load-server-state-from-file global
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007823
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007824 backend bk
7825 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
7826 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007827
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007828
7829 Then one can run :
7830
7831 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state" > /tmp/server_state
7832
7833 Content of the file /tmp/server_state would be like this:
7834
7835 1
7836 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
7837 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
7838 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
7839
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007840 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007841
7842 global
7843 stats socket /tmp/socket
7844 server-state-base /etc/haproxy/states
7845
7846 defaults
7847 load-server-state-from-file local
7848
7849 backend bk
7850 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
7851 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
7852
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007853
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007854 Then one can run :
7855
7856 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state bk" > /etc/haproxy/states/bk
7857
7858 Content of the file /etc/haproxy/states/bk would be like this:
7859
7860 1
7861 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
7862 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
7863 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
7864
7865 See also: "server-state-file", "server-state-file-name", and
7866 "show servers state"
7867
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02007868
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007869log global
Jan Wagner3e678602020-12-17 22:22:32 +01007870log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<sample_size>]
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02007871 <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02007872no log
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007873 Enable per-instance logging of events and traffic.
7874 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7875 yes | yes | yes | yes
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02007876
7877 Prefix :
7878 no should be used when the logger list must be flushed. For example,
7879 if you don't want to inherit from the default logger list. This
7880 prefix does not allow arguments.
7881
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007882 Arguments :
7883 global should be used when the instance's logging parameters are the
7884 same as the global ones. This is the most common usage. "global"
7885 replaces <address>, <facility> and <level> with those of the log
7886 entries found in the "global" section. Only one "log global"
7887 statement may be used per instance, and this form takes no other
7888 parameter.
7889
7890 <address> indicates where to send the logs. It takes the same format as
7891 for the "global" section's logs, and can be one of :
7892
7893 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon (':') and a UDP
7894 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
7895 standard syslog port).
7896
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01007897 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon (':') and optionally a UDP
7898 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
7899 standard syslog port).
7900
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007901 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
7902 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible
7903 inside the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007904 appropriately writable).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007905
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01007906 - A file descriptor number in the form "fd@<number>", which may
7907 point to a pipe, terminal, or socket. In this case unbuffered
7908 logs are used and one writev() call per log is performed. This
7909 is a bit expensive but acceptable for most workloads. Messages
7910 sent this way will not be truncated but may be dropped, in
7911 which case the DroppedLogs counter will be incremented. The
7912 writev() call is atomic even on pipes for messages up to
7913 PIPE_BUF size, which POSIX recommends to be at least 512 and
7914 which is 4096 bytes on most modern operating systems. Any
7915 larger message may be interleaved with messages from other
7916 processes. Exceptionally for debugging purposes the file
7917 descriptor may also be directed to a file, but doing so will
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007918 significantly slow HAProxy down as non-blocking calls will be
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01007919 ignored. Also there will be no way to purge nor rotate this
7920 file without restarting the process. Note that the configured
7921 syslog format is preserved, so the output is suitable for use
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01007922 with a TCP syslog server. See also the "short" and "raw"
7923 formats below.
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01007924
7925 - "stdout" / "stderr", which are respectively aliases for "fd@1"
7926 and "fd@2", see above.
7927
Willy Tarreauc046d162019-08-30 15:24:59 +02007928 - A ring buffer in the form "ring@<name>", which will correspond
7929 to an in-memory ring buffer accessible over the CLI using the
7930 "show events" command, which will also list existing rings and
7931 their sizes. Such buffers are lost on reload or restart but
7932 when used as a complement this can help troubleshooting by
7933 having the logs instantly available.
7934
Emeric Brun94aab062021-04-02 10:41:36 +02007935 - An explicit stream address prefix such as "tcp@","tcp6@",
7936 "tcp4@" or "uxst@" will allocate an implicit ring buffer with
7937 a stream forward server targeting the given address.
7938
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01007939 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
7940 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01007941
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02007942 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this
7943 value will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that
7944 syslog servers act differently on log line length. All servers
7945 support the default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop
7946 larger lines while others do log them. If a server supports long
7947 lines, it may make sense to set this value here in order to avoid
7948 truncating long lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines,
7949 it is preferable to truncate them before sending them. Accepted
7950 values are 80 to 65535 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is
7951 generally fine for all standard usages. Some specific cases of
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007952 long captures or JSON-formatted logs may require larger values.
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02007953
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02007954 <ranges> A list of comma-separated ranges to identify the logs to sample.
7955 This is used to balance the load of the logs to send to the log
7956 server. The limits of the ranges cannot be null. They are numbered
7957 from 1. The size or period (in number of logs) of the sample must
7958 be set with <sample_size> parameter.
7959
7960 <sample_size>
7961 The size of the sample in number of logs to consider when balancing
7962 their logging loads. It is used to balance the load of the logs to
7963 send to the syslog server. This size must be greater or equal to the
7964 maximum of the high limits of the ranges.
7965 (see also <ranges> parameter).
7966
Willy Tarreauadb345d2018-11-12 07:56:13 +01007967 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
7968 one of the following :
7969
Emeric Brun0237c4e2020-11-27 16:24:34 +01007970 local Analog to rfc3164 syslog message format except that hostname
7971 field is stripped. This is the default.
7972 Note: option "log-send-hostname" switches the default to
7973 rfc3164.
7974
7975 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format.
Willy Tarreauadb345d2018-11-12 07:56:13 +01007976 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
7977
7978 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
7979 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
7980
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02007981 priority A message containing only a level plus syslog facility between
7982 angle brackets such as '<63>', followed by the text. The PID,
7983 date, time, process name and system name are omitted. This is
7984 designed to be used with a local log server.
7985
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01007986 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
7987 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
7988 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
7989 local log server. This format is compatible with what the
7990 systemd logger consumes.
7991
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02007992 timed A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
7993 '<3>', followed by ISO date and by the text. The PID, process
7994 name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
7995 used with a local log server.
7996
7997 iso A message containing only the ISO date, followed by the text.
7998 The PID, process name and system name are omitted. This is
7999 designed to be used with a local log server.
8000
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01008001 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
8002 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to
8003 be used in containers or during development, where the severity
8004 only depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr).
8005
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008006 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
8007
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01008008 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
8009 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
8010 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
8011
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01008012 Note that the facility is ignored for the "short" and "raw"
8013 formats, but still required as a positional field. It is
8014 recommended to use "daemon" in this case to make it clear that
8015 it's only supposed to be used locally.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008016
8017 <level> is optional and can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By
8018 default, all messages are sent. If a level is specified, only
8019 messages with a severity at least as important as this level
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02008020 will be sent. An optional minimum level can be specified. If it
8021 is set, logs emitted with a more severe level than this one will
8022 be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending "emerg"
8023 messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
8024 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008025
8026 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
8027
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02008028 It is important to keep in mind that it is the frontend which decides what to
8029 log from a connection, and that in case of content switching, the log entries
8030 from the backend will be ignored. Connections are logged at level "info".
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008031
8032 However, backend log declaration define how and where servers status changes
8033 will be logged. Level "notice" will be used to indicate a server going up,
8034 "warning" will be used for termination signals and definitive service
8035 termination, and "alert" will be used for when a server goes down.
8036
8037 Note : According to RFC3164, messages are truncated to 1024 bytes before
8038 being emitted.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008039
8040 Example :
8041 log global
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01008042 log stdout format short daemon # send log to systemd
8043 log stdout format raw daemon # send everything to stdout
8044 log stderr format raw daemon notice # send important events to stderr
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02008045 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice # only send important events
Emeric Brun94aab062021-04-02 10:41:36 +02008046 log tcp@127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice notice # same but limit output
8047 # level and send in tcp
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02008048 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01008049
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008050
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01008051log-format <string>
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01008052 Specifies the log format string to use for traffic logs
8053 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8054 yes | yes | yes | no
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01008055
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01008056 This directive specifies the log format string that will be used for all logs
8057 resulting from traffic passing through the frontend using this line. If the
8058 directive is used in a defaults section, all subsequent frontends will use
8059 the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4 which covers the log format
8060 string in depth.
Remi Tricot-Le Bretonfe21fe72021-08-31 12:08:52 +02008061 A specific log-format used only in case of connection error can also be
8062 defined, see the "error-log-format" option.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01008063
Remi Tricot-Le Breton98b930d2021-07-29 09:45:52 +02008064 "log-format" directive overrides previous "option tcplog", "log-format",
8065 "option httplog" and "option httpslog" directives.
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02008066
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02008067log-format-sd <string>
8068 Specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string
8069 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8070 yes | yes | yes | no
8071
8072 This directive specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string that
8073 will be used for all logs resulting from traffic passing through the frontend
8074 using this line. If the directive is used in a defaults section, all
8075 subsequent frontends will use the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4
8076 which covers the log format string in depth.
8077
8078 See https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3 for more information
8079 about the RFC5424 structured-data part.
8080
8081 Note : This log format string will be used only for loggers that have set
8082 log format to "rfc5424".
8083
8084 Example :
8085 log-format-sd [exampleSDID@1234\ bytes=\"%B\"\ status=\"%ST\"]
8086
8087
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01008088log-tag <string>
8089 Specifies the log tag to use for all outgoing logs
8090 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8091 yes | yes | yes | yes
8092
8093 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
8094 log-tag set in the global section, otherwise the program name as launched
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008095 from the command line, which usually is "HAProxy". Sometimes it can be useful
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01008096 to differentiate between multiple processes running on the same host, or to
8097 differentiate customer instances running in the same process. In the backend,
8098 logs about servers up/down will use this tag. As a hint, it can be convenient
8099 to set a log-tag related to a hosted customer in a defaults section then put
8100 all the frontends and backends for that customer, then start another customer
8101 in a new defaults section. See also the global "log-tag" directive.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008102
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02008103max-keep-alive-queue <value>
8104 Set the maximum server queue size for maintaining keep-alive connections
8105 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8106 yes | no | yes | yes
8107
8108 HTTP keep-alive tries to reuse the same server connection whenever possible,
8109 but sometimes it can be counter-productive, for example if a server has a lot
8110 of connections while other ones are idle. This is especially true for static
8111 servers.
8112
8113 The purpose of this setting is to set a threshold on the number of queued
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008114 connections at which HAProxy stops trying to reuse the same server and prefers
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02008115 to find another one. The default value, -1, means there is no limit. A value
8116 of zero means that keep-alive requests will never be queued. For very close
8117 servers which can be reached with a low latency and which are not sensible to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008118 breaking keep-alive, a low value is recommended (e.g. local static server can
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02008119 use a value of 10 or less). For remote servers suffering from a high latency,
8120 higher values might be needed to cover for the latency and/or the cost of
8121 picking a different server.
8122
8123 Note that this has no impact on responses which are maintained to the same
8124 server consecutively to a 401 response. They will still go to the same server
8125 even if they have to be queued.
8126
8127 See also : "option http-server-close", "option prefer-last-server", server
8128 "maxconn" and cookie persistence.
8129
Olivier Houcharda4d4fdf2018-12-14 19:27:06 +01008130max-session-srv-conns <nb>
8131 Set the maximum number of outgoing connections we can keep idling for a given
8132 client session. The default is 5 (it precisely equals MAX_SRV_LIST which is
8133 defined at build time).
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02008134
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008135maxconn <conns>
8136 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a frontend
8137 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8138 yes | yes | yes | no
8139 Arguments :
8140 <conns> is the maximum number of concurrent connections the frontend will
8141 accept to serve. Excess connections will be queued by the system
8142 in the socket's listen queue and will be served once a connection
8143 closes.
8144
8145 If the system supports it, it can be useful on big sites to raise this limit
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008146 very high so that HAProxy manages connection queues, instead of leaving the
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008147 clients with unanswered connection attempts. This value should not exceed the
8148 global maxconn. Also, keep in mind that a connection contains two buffers
Baptiste Assmann79fb45d2016-03-06 23:34:31 +01008149 of tune.bufsize (16kB by default) each, as well as some other data resulting
8150 in about 33 kB of RAM being consumed per established connection. That means
8151 that a medium system equipped with 1GB of RAM can withstand around
8152 20000-25000 concurrent connections if properly tuned.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008153
8154 Also, when <conns> is set to large values, it is possible that the servers
8155 are not sized to accept such loads, and for this reason it is generally wise
8156 to assign them some reasonable connection limits.
8157
Willy Tarreauc8d5b952019-02-27 17:25:52 +01008158 When this value is set to zero, which is the default, the global "maxconn"
8159 value is used.
Vincent Bernat6341be52012-06-27 17:18:30 +02008160
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008161 See also : "server", global section's "maxconn", "fullconn"
8162
8163
Willy Tarreau77e0dae2020-10-14 15:44:27 +02008164mode { tcp|http }
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008165 Set the running mode or protocol of the instance
8166 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8167 yes | yes | yes | yes
8168 Arguments :
8169 tcp The instance will work in pure TCP mode. A full-duplex connection
8170 will be established between clients and servers, and no layer 7
8171 examination will be performed. This is the default mode. It
8172 should be used for SSL, SSH, SMTP, ...
8173
8174 http The instance will work in HTTP mode. The client request will be
8175 analyzed in depth before connecting to any server. Any request
8176 which is not RFC-compliant will be rejected. Layer 7 filtering,
8177 processing and switching will be possible. This is the mode which
8178 brings HAProxy most of its value.
8179
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008180 When doing content switching, it is mandatory that the frontend and the
8181 backend are in the same mode (generally HTTP), otherwise the configuration
8182 will be refused.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008183
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008184 Example :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008185 defaults http_instances
8186 mode http
8187
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008188
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01008189monitor fail { if | unless } <condition>
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008190 Add a condition to report a failure to a monitor HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008191 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8192 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008193 Arguments :
8194 if <cond> the monitor request will fail if the condition is satisfied,
8195 and will succeed otherwise. The condition should describe a
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008196 combined test which must induce a failure if all conditions
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008197 are met, for instance a low number of servers both in a
8198 backend and its backup.
8199
8200 unless <cond> the monitor request will succeed only if the condition is
8201 satisfied, and will fail otherwise. Such a condition may be
8202 based on a test on the presence of a minimum number of active
8203 servers in a list of backends.
8204
8205 This statement adds a condition which can force the response to a monitor
8206 request to report a failure. By default, when an external component queries
8207 the URI dedicated to monitoring, a 200 response is returned. When one of the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008208 conditions above is met, HAProxy will return 503 instead of 200. This is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008209 very useful to report a site failure to an external component which may base
8210 routing advertisements between multiple sites on the availability reported by
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008211 HAProxy. In this case, one would rely on an ACL involving the "nbsrv"
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02008212 criterion. Note that "monitor fail" only works in HTTP mode. Both status
8213 messages may be tweaked using "errorfile" or "errorloc" if needed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008214
8215 Example:
8216 frontend www
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008217 mode http
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008218 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
8219 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
8220 monitor-uri /site_alive
8221 monitor fail if site_dead
8222
Willy Tarreau9e9919d2020-10-14 15:55:23 +02008223 See also : "monitor-uri", "errorfile", "errorloc"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008224
8225
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008226monitor-uri <uri>
8227 Intercept a URI used by external components' monitor requests
8228 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8229 yes | yes | yes | no
8230 Arguments :
8231 <uri> is the exact URI which we want to intercept to return HAProxy's
8232 health status instead of forwarding the request.
8233
8234 When an HTTP request referencing <uri> will be received on a frontend,
8235 HAProxy will not forward it nor log it, but instead will return either
8236 "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" or "HTTP/1.0 503 Service unavailable", depending on failure
8237 conditions defined with "monitor fail". This is normally enough for any
8238 front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and running without
8239 forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that the HTTP method, the
8240 version and all headers are ignored, but the request must at least be valid
8241 at the HTTP level. This keyword may only be used with an HTTP-mode frontend.
8242
Willy Tarreau721d8e02017-12-01 18:25:08 +01008243 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after the request is parsed
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02008244 and even before any "http-request". The only rulesets applied before are the
8245 tcp-request ones. They cannot be logged either, and it is the intended
8246 purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to an upper component,
8247 nothing more. However, it is possible to add any number of conditions using
8248 "monitor fail" and ACLs so that the result can be adjusted to whatever check
8249 can be imagined (most often the number of available servers in a backend).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008250
Christopher Faulet6072beb2020-02-18 15:34:58 +01008251 Note: if <uri> starts by a slash ('/'), the matching is performed against the
8252 request's path instead of the request's uri. It is a workaround to let
8253 the HTTP/2 requests match the monitor-uri. Indeed, in HTTP/2, clients
8254 are encouraged to send absolute URIs only.
8255
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008256 Example :
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008257 # Use /haproxy_test to report HAProxy's status
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008258 frontend www
8259 mode http
8260 monitor-uri /haproxy_test
8261
Willy Tarreau9e9919d2020-10-14 15:55:23 +02008262 See also : "monitor fail"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008263
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008264
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008265option abortonclose
8266no option abortonclose
8267 Enable or disable early dropping of aborted requests pending in queues.
8268 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8269 yes | no | yes | yes
8270 Arguments : none
8271
8272 In presence of very high loads, the servers will take some time to respond.
8273 The per-instance connection queue will inflate, and the response time will
8274 increase respective to the size of the queue times the average per-session
8275 response time. When clients will wait for more than a few seconds, they will
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01008276 often hit the "STOP" button on their browser, leaving a useless request in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008277 the queue, and slowing down other users, and the servers as well, because the
8278 request will eventually be served, then aborted at the first error
8279 encountered while delivering the response.
8280
8281 As there is no way to distinguish between a full STOP and a simple output
8282 close on the client side, HTTP agents should be conservative and consider
8283 that the client might only have closed its output channel while waiting for
8284 the response. However, this introduces risks of congestion when lots of users
8285 do the same, and is completely useless nowadays because probably no client at
8286 all will close the session while waiting for the response. Some HTTP agents
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008287 support this behavior (Squid, Apache, HAProxy), and others do not (TUX, most
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008288 hardware-based load balancers). So the probability for a closed input channel
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01008289 to represent a user hitting the "STOP" button is close to 100%, and the risk
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008290 of being the single component to break rare but valid traffic is extremely
8291 low, which adds to the temptation to be able to abort a session early while
8292 still not served and not pollute the servers.
8293
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008294 In HAProxy, the user can choose the desired behavior using the option
8295 "abortonclose". By default (without the option) the behavior is HTTP
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008296 compliant and aborted requests will be served. But when the option is
8297 specified, a session with an incoming channel closed will be aborted while
8298 it is still possible, either pending in the queue for a connection slot, or
8299 during the connection establishment if the server has not yet acknowledged
8300 the connection request. This considerably reduces the queue size and the load
8301 on saturated servers when users are tempted to click on STOP, which in turn
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008302 reduces the response time for other users.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008303
8304 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8305 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8306
8307 See also : "timeout queue" and server's "maxconn" and "maxqueue" parameters
8308
8309
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008310option accept-invalid-http-request
8311no option accept-invalid-http-request
8312 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP request parsing
8313 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8314 yes | yes | yes | no
8315 Arguments : none
8316
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02008317 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008318 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008319 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behavior as such
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008320 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
8321 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
8322 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
8323 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
8324 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01008325 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. Similarly, the
8326 list of characters allowed to appear in a URI is well defined by RFC3986, and
8327 chars 0-31, 32 (space), 34 ('"'), 60 ('<'), 62 ('>'), 92 ('\'), 94 ('^'), 96
8328 ('`'), 123 ('{'), 124 ('|'), 125 ('}'), 127 (delete) and anything above are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008329 not allowed at all. HAProxy always blocks a number of them (0..32, 127). The
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02008330 remaining ones are blocked by default unless this option is enabled. This
Willy Tarreau13317662015-05-01 13:47:08 +02008331 option also relaxes the test on the HTTP version, it allows HTTP/0.9 requests
8332 to pass through (no version specified) and multiple digits for both the major
8333 and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008334
8335 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
8336 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
8337 been confirmed.
8338
8339 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
8340 requests, but the complete request will be captured in order to permit later
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01008341 analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket. Similarly,
8342 requests containing invalid chars in the URI part will be logged. Doing this
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008343 also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
8344
8345 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8346 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8347
8348 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-response" and "show errors" on the
8349 stats socket.
8350
8351
8352option accept-invalid-http-response
8353no option accept-invalid-http-response
8354 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP response parsing
8355 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8356 yes | no | yes | yes
8357 Arguments : none
8358
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02008359 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008360 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008361 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behavior as such
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008362 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
8363 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
8364 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
8365 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
8366 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02008367 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. This option also
8368 relaxes the test on the HTTP version format, it allows multiple digits for
8369 both the major and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008370
8371 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
8372 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
8373 been confirmed.
8374
8375 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
8376 responses, but the complete response will be captured in order to permit
8377 later analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket.
8378 Doing this also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
8379
8380 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8381 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8382
8383 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-request" and "show errors" on the
8384 stats socket.
8385
8386
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008387option allbackups
8388no option allbackups
8389 Use either all backup servers at a time or only the first one
8390 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8391 yes | no | yes | yes
8392 Arguments : none
8393
8394 By default, the first operational backup server gets all traffic when normal
8395 servers are all down. Sometimes, it may be preferred to use multiple backups
8396 at once, because one will not be enough. When "option allbackups" is enabled,
8397 the load balancing will be performed among all backup servers when all normal
8398 ones are unavailable. The same load balancing algorithm will be used and the
8399 servers' weights will be respected. Thus, there will not be any priority
8400 order between the backup servers anymore.
8401
8402 This option is mostly used with static server farms dedicated to return a
8403 "sorry" page when an application is completely offline.
8404
8405 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8406 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8407
8408
8409option checkcache
8410no option checkcache
Godbach7056a352013-12-11 20:01:07 +08008411 Analyze all server responses and block responses with cacheable cookies
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008412 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8413 yes | no | yes | yes
8414 Arguments : none
8415
8416 Some high-level frameworks set application cookies everywhere and do not
8417 always let enough control to the developer to manage how the responses should
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008418 be cached. When a session cookie is returned on a cacheable object, there is a
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008419 high risk of session crossing or stealing between users traversing the same
8420 caches. In some situations, it is better to block the response than to let
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02008421 some sensitive session information go in the wild.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008422
8423 The option "checkcache" enables deep inspection of all server responses for
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008424 strict compliance with HTTP specification in terms of cacheability. It
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01008425 carefully checks "Cache-control", "Pragma" and "Set-cookie" headers in server
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008426 response to check if there's a risk of caching a cookie on a client-side
8427 proxy. When this option is enabled, the only responses which can be delivered
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01008428 to the client are :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008429 - all those without "Set-Cookie" header;
Willy Tarreauc55ddce2017-12-21 11:41:38 +01008430 - all those with a return code other than 200, 203, 204, 206, 300, 301,
8431 404, 405, 410, 414, 501, provided that the server has not set a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008432 "Cache-control: public" header field;
Willy Tarreau24ea0bc2017-12-21 11:32:55 +01008433 - all those that result from a request using a method other than GET, HEAD,
8434 OPTIONS, TRACE, provided that the server has not set a 'Cache-Control:
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008435 public' header field;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008436 - those with a 'Pragma: no-cache' header
8437 - those with a 'Cache-control: private' header
8438 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-store' header
8439 - those with a 'Cache-control: max-age=0' header
8440 - those with a 'Cache-control: s-maxage=0' header
8441 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache' header
8442 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie"' header
8443 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie,' header
8444 (allowing other fields after set-cookie)
8445
8446 If a response doesn't respect these requirements, then it will be blocked
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02008447 just as if it was from an "http-response deny" rule, with an "HTTP 502 bad
8448 gateway". The session state shows "PH--" meaning that the proxy blocked the
8449 response during headers processing. Additionally, an alert will be sent in
8450 the logs so that admins are informed that there's something to be fixed.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008451
8452 Due to the high impact on the application, the application should be tested
8453 in depth with the option enabled before going to production. It is also a
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01008454 good practice to always activate it during tests, even if it is not used in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008455 production, as it will report potentially dangerous application behaviors.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008456
8457 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8458 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8459
8460
8461option clitcpka
8462no option clitcpka
8463 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the client side
8464 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8465 yes | yes | yes | no
8466 Arguments : none
8467
8468 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
8469 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008470 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008471 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
8472
8473 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
8474 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
8475 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
8476 operating system and its tuning parameters.
8477
8478 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
8479 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
8480 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
8481 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
8482 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
8483
8484 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
8485
8486 Using option "clitcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
8487 client side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
8488 noticed between HAProxy and a client.
8489
8490 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8491 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8492
8493 See also : "option srvtcpka", "option tcpka"
8494
8495
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008496option contstats
8497 Enable continuous traffic statistics updates
8498 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8499 yes | yes | yes | no
8500 Arguments : none
8501
8502 By default, counters used for statistics calculation are incremented
8503 only when a session finishes. It works quite well when serving small
8504 objects, but with big ones (for example large images or archives) or
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008505 with A/V streaming, a graph generated from HAProxy counters looks like
Willy Tarreaudef0d222016-11-08 22:03:00 +01008506 a hedgehog. With this option enabled counters get incremented frequently
8507 along the session, typically every 5 seconds, which is often enough to
8508 produce clean graphs. Recounting touches a hotpath directly so it is not
8509 not enabled by default, as it can cause a lot of wakeups for very large
8510 session counts and cause a small performance drop.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008511
Christopher Faulet89aed322020-06-02 17:33:56 +02008512option disable-h2-upgrade
8513no option disable-h2-upgrade
8514 Enable or disable the implicit HTTP/2 upgrade from an HTTP/1.x client
8515 connection.
8516 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8517 yes | yes | yes | no
8518 Arguments : none
8519
8520 By default, HAProxy is able to implicitly upgrade an HTTP/1.x client
8521 connection to an HTTP/2 connection if the first request it receives from a
8522 given HTTP connection matches the HTTP/2 connection preface (i.e. the string
8523 "PRI * HTTP/2.0\r\n\r\nSM\r\n\r\n"). This way, it is possible to support
Christopher Faulet982e17d2021-03-26 14:44:18 +01008524 HTTP/1.x and HTTP/2 clients on a non-SSL connections. This option must be
8525 used to disable the implicit upgrade. Note this implicit upgrade is only
8526 supported for HTTP proxies, thus this option too. Note also it is possible to
8527 force the HTTP/2 on clear connections by specifying "proto h2" on the bind
8528 line. Finally, this option is applied on all bind lines. To disable implicit
8529 HTTP/2 upgrades for a specific bind line, it is possible to use "proto h1".
Christopher Faulet89aed322020-06-02 17:33:56 +02008530
8531 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8532 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008533
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02008534option dontlog-normal
8535no option dontlog-normal
8536 Enable or disable logging of normal, successful connections
8537 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8538 yes | yes | yes | no
8539 Arguments : none
8540
8541 There are large sites dealing with several thousand connections per second
8542 and for which logging is a major pain. Some of them are even forced to turn
8543 logs off and cannot debug production issues. Setting this option ensures that
8544 normal connections, those which experience no error, no timeout, no retry nor
8545 redispatch, will not be logged. This leaves disk space for anomalies. In HTTP
8546 mode, the response status code is checked and return codes 5xx will still be
8547 logged.
8548
8549 It is strongly discouraged to use this option as most of the time, the key to
8550 complex issues is in the normal logs which will not be logged here. If you
8551 need to separate logs, see the "log-separate-errors" option instead.
8552
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008553 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "log-separate-errors" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02008554 logging.
8555
8556
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008557option dontlognull
8558no option dontlognull
8559 Enable or disable logging of null connections
8560 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8561 yes | yes | yes | no
8562 Arguments : none
8563
8564 In certain environments, there are components which will regularly connect to
8565 various systems to ensure that they are still alive. It can be the case from
8566 another load balancer as well as from monitoring systems. By default, even a
8567 simple port probe or scan will produce a log. If those connections pollute
8568 the logs too much, it is possible to enable option "dontlognull" to indicate
8569 that a connection on which no data has been transferred will not be logged,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02008570 which typically corresponds to those probes. Note that errors will still be
8571 returned to the client and accounted for in the stats. If this is not what is
8572 desired, option http-ignore-probes can be used instead.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008573
8574 It is generally recommended not to use this option in uncontrolled
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008575 environments (e.g. internet), otherwise scans and other malicious activities
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008576 would not be logged.
8577
8578 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8579 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8580
Willy Tarreau9e9919d2020-10-14 15:55:23 +02008581 See also : "log", "http-ignore-probes", "monitor-uri", and
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02008582 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008583
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008584
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02008585option forwardfor [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ] [ if-none ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008586 Enable insertion of the X-Forwarded-For header to requests sent to servers
8587 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8588 yes | yes | yes | yes
8589 Arguments :
8590 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
8591 matching <network>
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02008592 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Forwarded-For"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008593 header name.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008594
8595 Since HAProxy works in reverse-proxy mode, the servers see its IP address as
8596 their client address. This is sometimes annoying when the client's IP address
8597 is expected in server logs. To solve this problem, the well-known HTTP header
8598 "X-Forwarded-For" may be added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server.
8599 This header contains a value representing the client's IP address. Since this
8600 header is always appended at the end of the existing header list, the server
8601 must be configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. See
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02008602 the server's manual to find how to enable use of this standard header. Note
8603 that only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
8604 possible that the client has already brought one.
8605
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008606 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02008607 the default "X-Forwarded-For". This can be useful where you might already
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008608 have a "X-Forwarded-For" header from a different application (e.g. stunnel),
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008609 and you need preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008610 "X-Forwarded-For" header and requires different one (e.g. Zeus Web Servers
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02008611 require "X-Cluster-Client-IP").
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008612
8613 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
8614 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
8615 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
8616 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
8617 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
8618 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
Christopher Faulet5d1def62021-02-26 09:19:15 +01008619 private networks or 127.0.0.1. IPv4 and IPv6 are both supported.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008620
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02008621 Alternatively, the keyword "if-none" states that the header will only be
8622 added if it is not present. This should only be used in perfectly trusted
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008623 environment, as this might cause a security issue if headers reaching HAProxy
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02008624 are under the control of the end-user.
8625
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008626 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02008627 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
8628 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02008629 both are defined. In the case of the "if-none" argument, if at least one of
8630 the frontend or the backend does not specify it, it wants the addition to be
8631 mandatory, so it wins.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008632
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02008633 Example :
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008634 # Public HTTP address also used by stunnel on the same machine
8635 frontend www
8636 mode http
8637 option forwardfor except 127.0.0.1 # stunnel already adds the header
8638
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02008639 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client
8640 backend www
8641 mode http
8642 option forwardfor header X-Client
8643
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02008644 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008645 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008646
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008647
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02008648option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client
8649no option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client
8650 Enable or disable the case adjustment of HTTP/1 headers sent to bogus clients
8651 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8652 yes | yes | yes | no
8653 Arguments : none
8654
8655 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
8656 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
8657 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
8658 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
8659 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
8660 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
8661 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
8662
8663 When HAProxy receives an HTTP/1 response, its header names are converted to
8664 lower case and manipulated and sent this way to the clients. If a client is
8665 known to violate the HTTP standards and to fail to process a response coming
8666 from HAProxy, it is possible to transform the lower case header names to a
8667 different format when the response is formatted and sent to the client, by
8668 enabling this option and specifying the list of headers to be reformatted
8669 using the global directives "h1-case-adjust" or "h1-case-adjust-file". This
8670 must only be a temporary workaround for the time it takes the client to be
8671 fixed, because clients which require such workarounds might be vulnerable to
8672 content smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
8673
8674 Please note that this option will not affect standards-compliant clients.
8675
8676 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8677 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8678
8679 See also: "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server", "h1-case-adjust",
8680 "h1-case-adjust-file".
8681
8682
8683option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server
8684no option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server
8685 Enable or disable the case adjustment of HTTP/1 headers sent to bogus servers
8686 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8687 yes | no | yes | yes
8688 Arguments : none
8689
8690 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
8691 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
8692 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
8693 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
8694 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
8695 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
8696 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
8697
8698 When HAProxy receives an HTTP/1 request, its header names are converted to
8699 lower case and manipulated and sent this way to the servers. If a server is
8700 known to violate the HTTP standards and to fail to process a request coming
8701 from HAProxy, it is possible to transform the lower case header names to a
8702 different format when the request is formatted and sent to the server, by
8703 enabling this option and specifying the list of headers to be reformatted
8704 using the global directives "h1-case-adjust" or "h1-case-adjust-file". This
8705 must only be a temporary workaround for the time it takes the server to be
8706 fixed, because servers which require such workarounds might be vulnerable to
8707 content smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
8708
8709 Please note that this option will not affect standards-compliant servers.
8710
8711 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8712 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8713
8714 See also: "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client", "h1-case-adjust",
8715 "h1-case-adjust-file".
8716
8717
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02008718option http-buffer-request
8719no option http-buffer-request
8720 Enable or disable waiting for whole HTTP request body before proceeding
8721 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8722 yes | yes | yes | yes
8723 Arguments : none
8724
8725 It is sometimes desirable to wait for the body of an HTTP request before
8726 taking a decision. This is what is being done by "balance url_param" for
8727 example. The first use case is to buffer requests from slow clients before
8728 connecting to the server. Another use case consists in taking the routing
8729 decision based on the request body's contents. This option placed in a
8730 frontend or backend forces the HTTP processing to wait until either the whole
Christopher Faulet6db8a2e2019-11-19 16:27:25 +01008731 body is received or the request buffer is full. It can have undesired side
8732 effects with some applications abusing HTTP by expecting unbuffered
8733 transmissions between the frontend and the backend, so this should definitely
8734 not be used by default.
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02008735
Christopher Faulet021a8e42021-03-29 10:46:38 +02008736 See also : "option http-no-delay", "timeout http-request",
8737 "http-request wait-for-body"
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02008738
8739
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02008740option http-ignore-probes
8741no option http-ignore-probes
8742 Enable or disable logging of null connections and request timeouts
8743 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8744 yes | yes | yes | no
8745 Arguments : none
8746
8747 Recently some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature
8748 consisting in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites
8749 just in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
8750 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408 Request
8751 Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when the browser
8752 decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log and feed the error
8753 counters. There was already "option dontlognull" but it's insufficient in
8754 this case. Instead, this option does the following things :
8755 - prevent any 400/408 message from being sent to the client if nothing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008756 was received over a connection before it was closed;
8757 - prevent any log from being emitted in this situation;
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02008758 - prevent any error counter from being incremented
8759
8760 That way the empty connection is silently ignored. Note that it is better
8761 not to use this unless it is clear that it is needed, because it will hide
8762 real problems. The most common reason for not receiving a request and seeing
8763 a 408 is due to an MTU inconsistency between the client and an intermediary
8764 element such as a VPN, which blocks too large packets. These issues are
8765 generally seen with POST requests as well as GET with large cookies. The logs
8766 are often the only way to detect them.
8767
8768 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8769 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8770
8771 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "errorfile", and section 8 about logging.
8772
8773
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008774option http-keep-alive
8775no option http-keep-alive
8776 Enable or disable HTTP keep-alive from client to server
8777 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8778 yes | yes | yes | yes
8779 Arguments : none
8780
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01008781 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
8782 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008783 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
8784 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02008785 as "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose". This option allows to
8786 set back the keep-alive mode, which can be useful when another mode was used
8787 in a defaults section.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01008788
8789 Setting "option http-keep-alive" enables HTTP keep-alive mode on the client-
8790 and server- sides. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008791 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side at the expense
8792 of maintaining idle connections to the servers. In general, it is possible
8793 with this option to achieve approximately twice the request rate that the
8794 "http-server-close" option achieves on small objects. There are mainly two
8795 situations where this option may be useful :
8796
8797 - when the server is non-HTTP compliant and authenticates the connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008798 instead of requests (e.g. NTLM authentication)
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008799
8800 - when the cost of establishing the connection to the server is significant
8801 compared to the cost of retrieving the associated object from the server.
8802
8803 This last case can happen when the server is a fast static server of cache.
8804 In this case, the server will need to be properly tuned to support high enough
8805 connection counts because connections will last until the client sends another
8806 request.
8807
8808 If the client request has to go to another backend or another server due to
8809 content switching or the load balancing algorithm, the idle connection will
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01008810 immediately be closed and a new one re-opened. Option "prefer-last-server" is
8811 available to try optimize server selection so that if the server currently
8812 attached to an idle connection is usable, it will be used.
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008813
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008814 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
8815 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
8816 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
8817 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
8818 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
8819 not set.
8820
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02008821 This option disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose" or "option
8822 http-server-close". When backend and frontend options differ, all of these 4
8823 options have precedence over "option http-keep-alive".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008824
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008825 See also : "option httpclose",, "option http-server-close",
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01008826 "option prefer-last-server", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +01008827 and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008828
8829
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02008830option http-no-delay
8831no option http-no-delay
8832 Instruct the system to favor low interactive delays over performance in HTTP
8833 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8834 yes | yes | yes | yes
8835 Arguments : none
8836
8837 In HTTP, each payload is unidirectional and has no notion of interactivity.
8838 Any agent is expected to queue data somewhat for a reasonably low delay.
8839 There are some very rare server-to-server applications that abuse the HTTP
8840 protocol and expect the payload phase to be highly interactive, with many
8841 interleaved data chunks in both directions within a single request. This is
8842 absolutely not supported by the HTTP specification and will not work across
8843 most proxies or servers. When such applications attempt to do this through
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008844 HAProxy, it works but they will experience high delays due to the network
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02008845 optimizations which favor performance by instructing the system to wait for
8846 enough data to be available in order to only send full packets. Typical
8847 delays are around 200 ms per round trip. Note that this only happens with
8848 abnormal uses. Normal uses such as CONNECT requests nor WebSockets are not
8849 affected.
8850
8851 When "option http-no-delay" is present in either the frontend or the backend
8852 used by a connection, all such optimizations will be disabled in order to
8853 make the exchanges as fast as possible. Of course this offers no guarantee on
8854 the functionality, as it may break at any other place. But if it works via
8855 HAProxy, it will work as fast as possible. This option should never be used
8856 by default, and should never be used at all unless such a buggy application
8857 is discovered. The impact of using this option is an increase of bandwidth
8858 usage and CPU usage, which may significantly lower performance in high
8859 latency environments.
8860
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02008861 See also : "option http-buffer-request"
8862
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02008863
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008864option http-pretend-keepalive
8865no option http-pretend-keepalive
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008866 Define whether HAProxy will announce keepalive to the server or not
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008867 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02008868 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008869 Arguments : none
8870
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008871 When running with "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose", HAProxy
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008872 adds a "Connection: close" header to the request forwarded to the server.
8873 Unfortunately, when some servers see this header, they automatically refrain
8874 from using the chunked encoding for responses of unknown length, while this
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008875 is totally unrelated. The immediate effect is that this prevents HAProxy from
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008876 maintaining the client connection alive. A second effect is that a client or
8877 a cache could receive an incomplete response without being aware of it, and
8878 consider the response complete.
8879
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008880 By setting "option http-pretend-keepalive", HAProxy will make the server
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008881 believe it will keep the connection alive. The server will then not fall back
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008882 to the abnormal undesired above. When HAProxy gets the whole response, it
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008883 will close the connection with the server just as it would do with the
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008884 "option httpclose". That way the client gets a normal response and the
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008885 connection is correctly closed on the server side.
8886
8887 It is recommended not to enable this option by default, because most servers
8888 will more efficiently close the connection themselves after the last packet,
8889 and release its buffers slightly earlier. Also, the added packet on the
8890 network could slightly reduce the overall peak performance. However it is
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008891 worth noting that when this option is enabled, HAProxy will have slightly
8892 less work to do. So if HAProxy is the bottleneck on the whole architecture,
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008893 enabling this option might save a few CPU cycles.
8894
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02008895 This option may be set in backend and listen sections. Using it in a frontend
8896 section will be ignored and a warning will be reported during startup. It is
8897 a backend related option, so there is no real reason to set it on a
8898 frontend. This option may be combined with "option httpclose", which will
8899 cause keepalive to be announced to the server and close to be announced to
8900 the client. This practice is discouraged though.
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008901
8902 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8903 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8904
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008905 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close", and
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008906 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008907
Christopher Faulet18c13d32022-05-16 11:43:10 +02008908option http-restrict-req-hdr-names { preserve | delete | reject }
8909 Set HAProxy policy about HTTP request header names containing characters
8910 outside the "[a-zA-Z0-9-]" charset
8911 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8912 yes | yes | yes | yes
8913 Arguments :
8914 preserve disable the filtering. It is the default mode for HTTP proxies
8915 with no FastCGI application configured.
8916
8917 delete remove request headers with a name containing a character
8918 outside the "[a-zA-Z0-9-]" charset. It is the default mode for
8919 HTTP backends with a configured FastCGI application.
8920
8921 reject reject the request with a 403-Forbidden response if it contains a
8922 header name with a character outside the "[a-zA-Z0-9-]" charset.
8923
8924 This option may be used to restrict the request header names to alphanumeric
8925 and hyphen characters ([A-Za-z0-9-]). This may be mandatory to interoperate
8926 with non-HTTP compliant servers that fail to handle some characters in header
8927 names. It may also be mandatory for FastCGI applications because all
8928 non-alphanumeric characters in header names are replaced by an underscore
8929 ('_'). Thus, it is easily possible to mix up header names and bypass some
8930 rules. For instance, "X-Forwarded-For" and "X_Forwarded-For" headers are both
8931 converted to "HTTP_X_FORWARDED_FOR" in FastCGI.
8932
8933 Note this option is evaluated per proxy and after the http-request rules
8934 evaluation.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008935
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01008936option http-server-close
8937no option http-server-close
8938 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing on the server side
8939 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8940 yes | yes | yes | yes
8941 Arguments : none
8942
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01008943 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
8944 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
8945 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
8946 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02008947 as "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose". Setting "option
8948 http-server-close" enables HTTP connection-close mode on the server side
8949 while keeping the ability to support HTTP keep-alive and pipelining on the
8950 client side. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
8951 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side to save server
8952 resources, similarly to "option httpclose". It also permits non-keepalive
8953 capable servers to be served in keep-alive mode to the clients if they
8954 conform to the requirements of RFC7230. Please note that some servers do not
8955 always conform to those requirements when they see "Connection: close" in the
8956 request. The effect will be that keep-alive will never be used. A workaround
8957 consists in enabling "option http-pretend-keepalive".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01008958
8959 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
8960 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
8961 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
8962 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01008963 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
8964 not set.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01008965
8966 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
8967 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02008968 It disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose" or "option
8969 http-keep-alive". Please check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how this option
8970 combines with others when frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01008971
8972 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8973 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8974
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008975 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
8976 "option http-keep-alive", and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01008977
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008978option http-use-proxy-header
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01008979no option http-use-proxy-header
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008980 Make use of non-standard Proxy-Connection header instead of Connection
8981 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8982 yes | yes | yes | no
8983 Arguments : none
8984
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00008985 While RFC7230 explicitly states that HTTP/1.1 agents must use the
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008986 Connection header to indicate their wish of persistent or non-persistent
8987 connections, both browsers and proxies ignore this header for proxied
8988 connections and make use of the undocumented, non-standard Proxy-Connection
8989 header instead. The issue begins when trying to put a load balancer between
8990 browsers and such proxies, because there will be a difference between what
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008991 HAProxy understands and what the client and the proxy agree on.
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008992
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008993 By setting this option in a frontend, HAProxy can automatically switch to use
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008994 that non-standard header if it sees proxied requests. A proxied request is
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01008995 defined here as one where the URI begins with neither a '/' nor a '*'. This
8996 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode. Note that this option can only be
8997 specified in a frontend and will affect the request along its whole life.
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008998
Willy Tarreau844a7e72010-01-31 21:46:18 +01008999 Also, when this option is set, a request which requires authentication will
9000 automatically switch to use proxy authentication headers if it is itself a
9001 proxied request. That makes it possible to check or enforce authentication in
9002 front of an existing proxy.
9003
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01009004 This option should normally never be used, except in front of a proxy.
9005
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02009006 See also : "option httpclose", and "option http-server-close".
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01009007
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009008option httpchk
9009option httpchk <uri>
9010option httpchk <method> <uri>
9011option httpchk <method> <uri> <version>
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02009012 Enables HTTP protocol to check on the servers health
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009013 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9014 yes | no | yes | yes
9015 Arguments :
9016 <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not set,
9017 the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires low server
9018 processing and is easy to filter out from the logs. Any method
9019 may be used, though it is not recommended to invent non-standard
9020 ones.
9021
9022 <uri> is the URI referenced in the HTTP requests. It defaults to " / "
9023 which is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
9024 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
9025
9026 <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to "HTTP/1.0"
9027 but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP 1.0, so turning
9028 it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that the Host field is
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02009029 mandatory in HTTP/1.1, use "http-check send" directive to add it.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009030
9031 By default, server health checks only consist in trying to establish a TCP
9032 connection. When "option httpchk" is specified, a complete HTTP request is
9033 sent once the TCP connection is established, and responses 2xx and 3xx are
9034 considered valid, while all other ones indicate a server failure, including
9035 the lack of any response.
9036
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02009037 Combined with "http-check" directives, it is possible to customize the
9038 request sent during the HTTP health checks or the matching rules on the
9039 response. It is also possible to configure a send/expect sequence, just like
9040 with the directive "tcp-check" for TCP health checks.
9041
9042 The server configuration is used by default to open connections to perform
9043 HTTP health checks. By it is also possible to overwrite server parameters
9044 using "http-check connect" rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009045
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02009046 "httpchk" option does not necessarily require an HTTP backend, it also works
9047 with plain TCP backends. This is particularly useful to check simple scripts
Christopher Faulet14cd3162020-04-16 14:50:06 +02009048 bound to some dedicated ports using the inetd daemon. However, it will always
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04009049 internally relies on an HTX multiplexer. Thus, it means the request
Christopher Faulet14cd3162020-04-16 14:50:06 +02009050 formatting and the response parsing will be strict.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009051
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02009052 Note : For a while, there was no way to add headers or body in the request
9053 used for HTTP health checks. So a workaround was to hide it at the end
9054 of the version string with a "\r\n" after the version. It is now
9055 deprecated. The directive "http-check send" must be used instead.
9056
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009057 Examples :
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02009058 # Relay HTTPS traffic to Apache instance and check service availability
9059 # using HTTP request "OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1" on port 80.
9060 backend https_relay
9061 mode tcp
9062 option httpchk OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1
9063 http-check send hdr Host www
9064 server apache1 192.168.1.1:443 check port 80
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009065
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +09009066 See also : "option ssl-hello-chk", "option smtpchk", "option mysql-check",
9067 "option pgsql-check", "http-check" and the "check", "port" and
9068 "inter" server options.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009069
9070
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009071option httpclose
9072no option httpclose
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02009073 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009074 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9075 yes | yes | yes | yes
9076 Arguments : none
9077
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01009078 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
9079 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
9080 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
9081 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02009082 as "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose".
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01009083
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02009084 If "option httpclose" is set, HAProxy will close connections with the server
9085 and the client as soon as the request and the response are received. It will
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05009086 also check if a "Connection: close" header is already set in each direction,
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02009087 and will add one if missing. Any "Connection" header different from "close"
9088 will also be removed.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009089
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02009090 This option may also be combined with "option http-pretend-keepalive", which
9091 will disable sending of the "Connection: close" header, but will still cause
9092 the connection to be closed once the whole response is received.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009093
9094 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
9095 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02009096 It disables and replaces any previous "option http-server-close" or "option
9097 http-keep-alive". Please check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how this option
9098 combines with others when frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009099
9100 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9101 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9102
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02009103 See also : "option http-server-close" and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009104
9105
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02009106option httplog [ clf ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009107 Enable logging of HTTP request, session state and timers
9108 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Tim Duesterhus9ad9f352018-02-05 20:52:27 +01009109 yes | yes | yes | no
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02009110 Arguments :
9111 clf if the "clf" argument is added, then the output format will be
9112 the CLF format instead of HAProxy's default HTTP format. You can
9113 use this when you need to feed HAProxy's logs through a specific
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009114 log analyzer which only support the CLF format and which is not
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02009115 extensible.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009116
9117 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
9118 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
9119 "option httplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including,
9120 but not limited to, the HTTP request, the connection timers, the session
9121 status, the connections numbers, the captured headers and cookies, the
9122 frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source address and
9123 ports.
9124
PiBa-NLbd556bf2014-12-11 21:31:54 +01009125 Specifying only "option httplog" will automatically clear the 'clf' mode
9126 if it was set by default.
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02009127
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02009128 "option httplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
9129
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009130 See also : section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009131
Remi Tricot-Le Breton98b930d2021-07-29 09:45:52 +02009132option httpslog
9133 Enable logging of HTTPS request, session state and timers
9134 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9135 yes | yes | yes | no
9136
9137 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
9138 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
9139 "option httpslog", each log line turns into a much richer format including,
9140 but not limited to, the HTTP request, the connection timers, the session
9141 status, the connections numbers, the captured headers and cookies, the
9142 frontend, backend and server name, the SSL certificate verification and SSL
9143 handshake statuses, and of course the source address and ports.
9144
9145 "option httpslog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
9146
9147 See also : section 8 about logging.
9148
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009149
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009150option independent-streams
9151no option independent-streams
9152 Enable or disable independent timeout processing for both directions
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02009153 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9154 yes | yes | yes | yes
9155 Arguments : none
9156
9157 By default, when data is sent over a socket, both the write timeout and the
9158 read timeout for that socket are refreshed, because we consider that there is
9159 activity on that socket, and we have no other means of guessing if we should
9160 receive data or not.
9161
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009162 While this default behavior is desirable for almost all applications, there
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02009163 exists a situation where it is desirable to disable it, and only refresh the
9164 read timeout if there are incoming data. This happens on sessions with large
9165 timeouts and low amounts of exchanged data such as telnet session. If the
9166 server suddenly disappears, the output data accumulates in the system's
9167 socket buffers, both timeouts are correctly refreshed, and there is no way
9168 to know the server does not receive them, so we don't timeout. However, when
9169 the underlying protocol always echoes sent data, it would be enough by itself
9170 to detect the issue using the read timeout. Note that this problem does not
9171 happen with more verbose protocols because data won't accumulate long in the
9172 socket buffers.
9173
9174 When this option is set on the frontend, it will disable read timeout updates
9175 on data sent to the client. There probably is little use of this case. When
9176 the option is set on the backend, it will disable read timeout updates on
9177 data sent to the server. Doing so will typically break large HTTP posts from
9178 slow lines, so use it with caution.
9179
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02009180 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server" and "timeout tunnel"
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02009181
9182
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02009183option ldap-check
9184 Use LDAPv3 health checks for server testing
9185 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9186 yes | no | yes | yes
9187 Arguments : none
9188
9189 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks LDAPv3 instead of just
9190 testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set, an
9191 LDAPv3 anonymous simple bind message is sent to the server, and the response
9192 is analyzed to find an LDAPv3 bind response message.
9193
9194 The server is considered valid only when the LDAP response contains success
9195 resultCode (http://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc4511#section-4.1.9).
9196
9197 Logging of bind requests is server dependent see your documentation how to
9198 configure it.
9199
9200 Example :
9201 option ldap-check
9202
9203 See also : "option httpchk"
9204
9205
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09009206option external-check
9207 Use external processes for server health checks
9208 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9209 yes | no | yes | yes
9210
9211 It is possible to test the health of a server using an external command.
9212 This is achieved by running the executable set using "external-check
9213 command".
9214
9215 Requires the "external-check" global to be set.
9216
9217 See also : "external-check", "external-check command", "external-check path"
9218
9219
William Dauchya9dd9012022-01-05 22:53:24 +01009220option idle-close-on-response
9221no option idle-close-on-response
9222 Avoid closing idle frontend connections if a soft stop is in progress
9223 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9224 yes | yes | yes | no
9225 Arguments : none
9226
9227 By default, idle connections will be closed during a soft stop. In some
9228 environments, a client talking to the proxy may have prepared some idle
9229 connections in order to send requests later. If there is no proper retry on
9230 write errors, this can result in errors while haproxy is reloading. Even
9231 though a proper implementation should retry on connection/write errors, this
9232 option was introduced to support backwards compatibility with haproxy prior
9233 to version 2.4. Indeed before v2.4, haproxy used to wait for a last request
9234 and response to add a "connection: close" header before closing, thus
9235 notifying the client that the connection would not be reusable.
9236
9237 In a real life example, this behavior was seen in AWS using the ALB in front
9238 of a haproxy. The end result was ALB sending 502 during haproxy reloads.
9239
9240 Users are warned that using this option may increase the number of old
9241 processes if connections remain idle for too long. Adjusting the client
9242 timeouts and/or the "hard-stop-after" parameter accordingly might be
9243 needed in case of frequent reloads.
9244
9245 See also: "timeout client", "timeout client-fin", "timeout http-request",
9246 "hard-stop-after"
9247
9248
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02009249option log-health-checks
9250no option log-health-checks
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02009251 Enable or disable logging of health checks status updates
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02009252 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9253 yes | no | yes | yes
9254 Arguments : none
9255
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02009256 By default, failed health check are logged if server is UP and successful
9257 health checks are logged if server is DOWN, so the amount of additional
9258 information is limited.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02009259
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02009260 When this option is enabled, any change of the health check status or to
9261 the server's health will be logged, so that it becomes possible to know
9262 that a server was failing occasional checks before crashing, or exactly when
9263 it failed to respond a valid HTTP status, then when the port started to
9264 reject connections, then when the server stopped responding at all.
9265
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009266 Note that status changes not caused by health checks (e.g. enable/disable on
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02009267 the CLI) are intentionally not logged by this option.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02009268
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02009269 See also: "option httpchk", "option ldap-check", "option mysql-check",
9270 "option pgsql-check", "option redis-check", "option smtpchk",
9271 "option tcp-check", "log" and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02009272
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02009273
9274option log-separate-errors
9275no option log-separate-errors
9276 Change log level for non-completely successful connections
9277 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9278 yes | yes | yes | no
9279 Arguments : none
9280
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009281 Sometimes looking for errors in logs is not easy. This option makes HAProxy
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02009282 raise the level of logs containing potentially interesting information such
9283 as errors, timeouts, retries, redispatches, or HTTP status codes 5xx. The
9284 level changes from "info" to "err". This makes it possible to log them
9285 separately to a different file with most syslog daemons. Be careful not to
9286 remove them from the original file, otherwise you would lose ordering which
9287 provides very important information.
9288
9289 Using this option, large sites dealing with several thousand connections per
9290 second may log normal traffic to a rotating buffer and only archive smaller
9291 error logs.
9292
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009293 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "dontlog-normal" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02009294 logging.
9295
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009296
9297option logasap
9298no option logasap
Jerome Magnin95fb57b2020-04-23 19:01:17 +02009299 Enable or disable early logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009300 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9301 yes | yes | yes | no
9302 Arguments : none
9303
Jerome Magnin95fb57b2020-04-23 19:01:17 +02009304 By default, logs are emitted when all the log format variables and sample
9305 fetches used in the definition of the log-format string return a value, or
9306 when the session is terminated. This allows the built in log-format strings
9307 to account for the transfer time, or the number of bytes in log messages.
9308
9309 When handling long lived connections such as large file transfers or RDP,
9310 it may take a while for the request or connection to appear in the logs.
9311 Using "option logasap", the log message is created as soon as the server
9312 connection is established in mode tcp, or as soon as the server sends the
9313 complete headers in mode http. Missing information in the logs will be the
Ilya Shipitsin4329a9a2020-05-05 21:17:10 +05009314 total number of bytes which will only indicate the amount of data transferred
Jerome Magnin95fb57b2020-04-23 19:01:17 +02009315 before the message was created and the total time which will not take the
9316 remainder of the connection life or transfer time into account. For the case
9317 of HTTP, it is good practice to capture the Content-Length response header
9318 so that the logs at least indicate how many bytes are expected to be
Ilya Shipitsin4329a9a2020-05-05 21:17:10 +05009319 transferred.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009320
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009321 Examples :
9322 listen http_proxy 0.0.0.0:80
9323 mode http
9324 option httplog
9325 option logasap
9326 log 192.168.2.200 local3
9327
9328 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
9329 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
9330 static/srv1 9/10/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/1/1/1/0 1/0 \
9331 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
9332
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009333 See also : "option httplog", "capture response header", and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009334 logging.
9335
9336
Christopher Faulet62f79fe2020-05-18 18:13:03 +02009337option mysql-check [ user <username> [ { post-41 | pre-41 } ] ]
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02009338 Use MySQL health checks for server testing
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01009339 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9340 yes | no | yes | yes
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02009341 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009342 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to MySQL
9343 server.
Christopher Faulet62f79fe2020-05-18 18:13:03 +02009344 post-41 Send post v4.1 client compatible checks (the default)
9345 pre-41 Send pre v4.1 client compatible checks
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02009346
9347 If you specify a username, the check consists of sending two MySQL packet,
9348 one Client Authentication packet, and one QUIT packet, to correctly close
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009349 MySQL session. We then parse the MySQL Handshake Initialization packet and/or
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02009350 Error packet. It is a basic but useful test which does not produce error nor
Daniel Blackd3e7dc42021-07-01 12:09:32 +10009351 aborted connect on the server. However, it requires an unlocked authorised
9352 user without a password. To create a basic limited user in MySQL with
9353 optional resource limits:
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02009354
Daniel Blackd3e7dc42021-07-01 12:09:32 +10009355 CREATE USER '<username>'@'<ip_of_haproxy|network_of_haproxy/netmask>'
9356 /*!50701 WITH MAX_QUERIES_PER_HOUR 1 MAX_UPDATES_PER_HOUR 0 */
9357 /*M!100201 MAX_STATEMENT_TIME 0.0001 */;
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02009358
9359 If you don't specify a username (it is deprecated and not recommended), the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009360 check only consists in parsing the Mysql Handshake Initialization packet or
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02009361 Error packet, we don't send anything in this mode. It was reported that it
9362 can generate lockout if check is too frequent and/or if there is not enough
9363 traffic. In fact, you need in this case to check MySQL "max_connect_errors"
9364 value as if a connection is established successfully within fewer than MySQL
9365 "max_connect_errors" attempts after a previous connection was interrupted,
9366 the error count for the host is cleared to zero. If HAProxy's server get
9367 blocked, the "FLUSH HOSTS" statement is the only way to unblock it.
9368
9369 Remember that this does not check database presence nor database consistency.
9370 To do this, you can use an external check with xinetd for example.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01009371
Hervé COMMOWICK212f7782011-06-10 14:05:59 +02009372 The check requires MySQL >=3.22, for older version, please use TCP check.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01009373
9374 Most often, an incoming MySQL server needs to see the client's IP address for
9375 various purposes, including IP privilege matching and connection logging.
9376 When possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
9377 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02009378 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in, and the MySQL
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009379 server to route the client via the machine hosting HAProxy.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01009380
9381 See also: "option httpchk"
9382
9383
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009384option nolinger
9385no option nolinger
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009386 Enable or disable immediate session resource cleaning after close
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009387 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9388 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009389 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009390
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009391 When clients or servers abort connections in a dirty way (e.g. they are
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009392 physically disconnected), the session timeouts triggers and the session is
9393 closed. But it will remain in FIN_WAIT1 state for some time in the system,
9394 using some resources and possibly limiting the ability to establish newer
9395 connections.
9396
9397 When this happens, it is possible to activate "option nolinger" which forces
9398 the system to immediately remove any socket's pending data on close. Thus,
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +02009399 a TCP RST is emitted, any pending data are truncated, and the session is
9400 instantly purged from the system's tables. The generally visible effect for
9401 a client is that responses are truncated if the close happens with a last
9402 block of data (e.g. on a redirect or error response). On the server side,
9403 it may help release the source ports immediately when forwarding a client
9404 aborts in tunnels. In both cases, TCP resets are emitted and given that
9405 the session is instantly destroyed, there will be no retransmit. On a lossy
9406 network this can increase problems, especially when there is a firewall on
9407 the lossy side, because the firewall might see and process the reset (hence
9408 purge its session) and block any further traffic for this session,, including
9409 retransmits from the other side. So if the other side doesn't receive it,
9410 it will never receive any RST again, and the firewall might log many blocked
9411 packets.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009412
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +02009413 For all these reasons, it is strongly recommended NOT to use this option,
9414 unless absolutely needed as a last resort. In most situations, using the
9415 "client-fin" or "server-fin" timeouts achieves similar results with a more
9416 reliable behavior. On Linux it's also possible to use the "tcp-ut" bind or
9417 server setting.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009418
9419 This option may be used both on frontends and backends, depending on the side
9420 where it is required. Use it on the frontend for clients, and on the backend
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +02009421 for servers. While this option is technically supported in "defaults"
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +05009422 sections, it must really not be used there as it risks to accidentally
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +02009423 propagate to sections that must no use it and to cause problems there.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009424
9425 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9426 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9427
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +02009428 See also: "timeout client-fin", "timeout server-fin", "tcp-ut" bind or server
9429 keywords.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009430
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009431option originalto [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ]
9432 Enable insertion of the X-Original-To header to requests sent to servers
9433 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9434 yes | yes | yes | yes
9435 Arguments :
9436 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
9437 matching <network>
9438 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Original-To"
9439 header name.
9440
9441 Since HAProxy can work in transparent mode, every request from a client can
9442 be redirected to the proxy and HAProxy itself can proxy every request to a
9443 complex SQUID environment and the destination host from SO_ORIGINAL_DST will
9444 be lost. This is annoying when you want access rules based on destination ip
9445 addresses. To solve this problem, a new HTTP header "X-Original-To" may be
9446 added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server. This header contains a
9447 value representing the original destination IP address. Since this must be
9448 configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. Note that
9449 only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
9450 possible that the client has already brought one.
9451
9452 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
9453 the default "X-Original-To". This can be useful where you might already
9454 have a "X-Original-To" header from a different application, and you need
9455 preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the "X-Original-To"
9456 header and requires different one.
9457
9458 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
9459 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
9460 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
Amaury Denoyellef8b42922021-03-04 18:41:14 +01009461 header for a known destination address or network by adding the "except"
9462 keyword followed by the network address. In this case, any destination IP
9463 matching the network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common
9464 uses are with private networks or 127.0.0.1. IPv4 and IPv6 are both
9465 supported.
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009466
9467 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
9468 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
9469 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
9470 both are defined.
9471
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009472 Examples :
9473 # Original Destination address
9474 frontend www
9475 mode http
9476 option originalto except 127.0.0.1
9477
9478 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client-Dst
9479 backend www
9480 mode http
9481 option originalto header X-Client-Dst
9482
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02009483 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close".
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009484
9485
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009486option persist
9487no option persist
9488 Enable or disable forced persistence on down servers
9489 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9490 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009491 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009492
9493 When an HTTP request reaches a backend with a cookie which references a dead
9494 server, by default it is redispatched to another server. It is possible to
9495 force the request to be sent to the dead server first using "option persist"
9496 if absolutely needed. A common use case is when servers are under extreme
9497 load and spend their time flapping. In this case, the users would still be
9498 directed to the server they opened the session on, in the hope they would be
9499 correctly served. It is recommended to use "option redispatch" in conjunction
9500 with this option so that in the event it would not be possible to connect to
9501 the server at all (server definitely dead), the client would finally be
9502 redirected to another valid server.
9503
9504 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9505 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9506
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01009507 See also : "option redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009508
9509
Willy Tarreau0c122822013-12-15 18:49:01 +01009510option pgsql-check [ user <username> ]
9511 Use PostgreSQL health checks for server testing
9512 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9513 yes | no | yes | yes
9514 Arguments :
9515 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to
9516 PostgreSQL server.
9517
9518 The check sends a PostgreSQL StartupMessage and waits for either
9519 Authentication request or ErrorResponse message. It is a basic but useful
9520 test which does not produce error nor aborted connect on the server.
9521 This check is identical with the "mysql-check".
9522
9523 See also: "option httpchk"
9524
9525
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01009526option prefer-last-server
9527no option prefer-last-server
9528 Allow multiple load balanced requests to remain on the same server
9529 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9530 yes | no | yes | yes
9531 Arguments : none
9532
9533 When the load balancing algorithm in use is not deterministic, and a previous
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009534 request was sent to a server to which HAProxy still holds a connection, it is
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01009535 sometimes desirable that subsequent requests on a same session go to the same
9536 server as much as possible. Note that this is different from persistence, as
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009537 we only indicate a preference which HAProxy tries to apply without any form
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01009538 of warranty. The real use is for keep-alive connections sent to servers. When
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009539 this option is used, HAProxy will try to reuse the same connection that is
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01009540 attached to the server instead of rebalancing to another server, causing a
9541 close of the connection. This can make sense for static file servers. It does
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01009542 not make much sense to use this in combination with hashing algorithms. Note,
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009543 HAProxy already automatically tries to stick to a server which sends a 401 or
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02009544 to a proxy which sends a 407 (authentication required), when the load
9545 balancing algorithm is not deterministic. This is mandatory for use with the
9546 broken NTLM authentication challenge, and significantly helps in
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01009547 troubleshooting some faulty applications. Option prefer-last-server might be
9548 desirable in these environments as well, to avoid redistributing the traffic
9549 after every other response.
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01009550
9551 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9552 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9553
9554 See also: "option http-keep-alive"
9555
9556
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009557option redispatch
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07009558option redispatch <interval>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009559no option redispatch
9560 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
9561 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9562 yes | no | yes | yes
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07009563 Arguments :
9564 <interval> The optional integer value that controls how often redispatches
9565 occur when retrying connections. Positive value P indicates a
9566 redispatch is desired on every Pth retry, and negative value
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009567 N indicate a redispatch is desired on the Nth retry prior to the
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07009568 last retry. For example, the default of -1 preserves the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009569 historical behavior of redispatching on the last retry, a
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07009570 positive value of 1 would indicate a redispatch on every retry,
9571 and a positive value of 3 would indicate a redispatch on every
9572 third retry. You can disable redispatches with a value of 0.
9573
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009574
9575 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
9576 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
9577 be able to access the service anymore.
9578
Willy Tarreau59884a62019-01-02 14:48:31 +01009579 Specifying "option redispatch" will allow the proxy to break cookie or
9580 consistent hash based persistence and redistribute them to a working server.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009581
Olivier Carrère6e6f59b2020-04-15 11:30:18 +02009582 Active servers are selected from a subset of the list of available
9583 servers. Active servers that are not down or in maintenance (i.e., whose
9584 health is not checked or that have been checked as "up"), are selected in the
9585 following order:
9586
9587 1. Any active, non-backup server, if any, or,
9588
9589 2. If the "allbackups" option is not set, the first backup server in the
9590 list, or
9591
9592 3. If the "allbackups" option is set, any backup server.
9593
9594 When a retry occurs, HAProxy tries to select another server than the last
9595 one. The new server is selected from the current list of servers.
9596
9597 Sometimes, if the list is updated between retries (e.g., if numerous retries
9598 occur and last longer than the time needed to check that a server is down,
9599 remove it from the list and fall back on the list of backup servers),
9600 connections may be redirected to a backup server, though.
9601
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07009602 It also allows to retry connections to another server in case of multiple
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009603 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
9604 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009605
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009606 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9607 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9608
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02009609 See also : "retries", "force-persist"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009610
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009611
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02009612option redis-check
9613 Use redis health checks for server testing
9614 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9615 yes | no | yes | yes
9616 Arguments : none
9617
9618 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks REDIS protocol instead
9619 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
9620 a PING redis command is sent to the server, and the response is analyzed to
9621 find the "+PONG" response message.
9622
9623 Example :
9624 option redis-check
9625
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03009626 See also : "option httpchk", "option tcp-check", "tcp-check expect"
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02009627
9628
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009629option smtpchk
9630option smtpchk <hello> <domain>
9631 Use SMTP health checks for server testing
9632 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9633 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009634 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009635 <hello> is an optional argument. It is the "hello" command to use. It can
Lukas Tribus27935782018-10-01 02:00:16 +02009636 be either "HELO" (for SMTP) or "EHLO" (for ESMTP). All other
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009637 values will be turned into the default command ("HELO").
9638
9639 <domain> is the domain name to present to the server. It may only be
9640 specified (and is mandatory) if the hello command has been
9641 specified. By default, "localhost" is used.
9642
9643 When "option smtpchk" is set, the health checks will consist in TCP
9644 connections followed by an SMTP command. By default, this command is
9645 "HELO localhost". The server's return code is analyzed and only return codes
9646 starting with a "2" will be considered as valid. All other responses,
9647 including a lack of response will constitute an error and will indicate a
9648 dead server.
9649
9650 This test is meant to be used with SMTP servers or relays. Depending on the
9651 request, it is possible that some servers do not log each connection attempt,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009652 so you may want to experiment to improve the behavior. Using telnet on port
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009653 25 is often easier than adjusting the configuration.
9654
9655 Most often, an incoming SMTP server needs to see the client's IP address for
9656 various purposes, including spam filtering, anti-spoofing and logging. When
9657 possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
9658 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02009659 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009660
9661 Example :
9662 option smtpchk HELO mydomain.org
9663
9664 See also : "option httpchk", "source"
9665
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009666
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +02009667option socket-stats
9668no option socket-stats
9669
9670 Enable or disable collecting & providing separate statistics for each socket.
9671 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9672 yes | yes | yes | no
9673
9674 Arguments : none
9675
9676
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01009677option splice-auto
9678no option splice-auto
9679 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets in both directions
9680 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9681 yes | yes | yes | yes
9682 Arguments : none
9683
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009684 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, HAProxy
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01009685 will automatically evaluate the opportunity to use kernel tcp splicing to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009686 forward data between the client and the server, in either direction. HAProxy
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01009687 uses heuristics to estimate if kernel splicing might improve performance or
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009688 not. Both directions are handled independently. Note that the heuristics used
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01009689 are not much aggressive in order to limit excessive use of splicing. This
9690 option requires splicing to be enabled at compile time, and may be globally
9691 disabled with the global option "nosplice". Since splice uses pipes, using it
9692 requires that there are enough spare pipes.
9693
9694 Important note: kernel-based TCP splicing is a Linux-specific feature which
9695 first appeared in kernel 2.6.25. It offers kernel-based acceleration to
9696 transfer data between sockets without copying these data to user-space, thus
9697 providing noticeable performance gains and CPU cycles savings. Since many
9698 early implementations are buggy, corrupt data and/or are inefficient, this
9699 feature is not enabled by default, and it should be used with extreme care.
9700 While it is not possible to detect the correctness of an implementation,
9701 2.6.29 is the first version offering a properly working implementation. In
9702 case of doubt, splicing may be globally disabled using the global "nosplice"
9703 keyword.
9704
9705 Example :
9706 option splice-auto
9707
9708 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9709 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9710
9711 See also : "option splice-request", "option splice-response", and global
9712 options "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
9713
9714
9715option splice-request
9716no option splice-request
9717 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for requests
9718 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9719 yes | yes | yes | yes
9720 Arguments : none
9721
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009722 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, HAProxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009723 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01009724 the client to the server. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
9725 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
9726 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
9727 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
9728
9729 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
9730
9731 Example :
9732 option splice-request
9733
9734 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9735 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9736
9737 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-response", and global options
9738 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
9739
9740
9741option splice-response
9742no option splice-response
9743 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for responses
9744 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9745 yes | yes | yes | yes
9746 Arguments : none
9747
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009748 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, HAProxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009749 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01009750 the server to the client. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
9751 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
9752 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
9753 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
9754
9755 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
9756
9757 Example :
9758 option splice-response
9759
9760 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9761 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9762
9763 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-request", and global options
9764 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
9765
9766
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +01009767option spop-check
9768 Use SPOP health checks for server testing
9769 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9770 no | no | no | yes
9771 Arguments : none
9772
9773 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks SPOP protocol instead
9774 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
9775 a HELLO handshake is performed between HAProxy and the server, and the
9776 response is analyzed to check no error is reported.
9777
9778 Example :
9779 option spop-check
9780
9781 See also : "option httpchk"
9782
9783
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009784option srvtcpka
9785no option srvtcpka
9786 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the server side
9787 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9788 yes | no | yes | yes
9789 Arguments : none
9790
9791 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
9792 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009793 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009794 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
9795
9796 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
9797 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
9798 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
9799 operating system and its tuning parameters.
9800
9801 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
9802 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
9803 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
9804 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
9805 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
9806
9807 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
9808
9809 Using option "srvtcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
9810 server side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
9811 noticed between HAProxy and a server.
9812
9813 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9814 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9815
9816 See also : "option clitcpka", "option tcpka"
9817
9818
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009819option ssl-hello-chk
9820 Use SSLv3 client hello health checks for server testing
9821 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9822 yes | no | yes | yes
9823 Arguments : none
9824
9825 When some SSL-based protocols are relayed in TCP mode through HAProxy, it is
9826 possible to test that the server correctly talks SSL instead of just testing
9827 that it accepts the TCP connection. When "option ssl-hello-chk" is set, pure
9828 SSLv3 client hello messages are sent once the connection is established to
9829 the server, and the response is analyzed to find an SSL server hello message.
9830 The server is considered valid only when the response contains this server
9831 hello message.
9832
9833 All servers tested till there correctly reply to SSLv3 client hello messages,
9834 and most servers tested do not even log the requests containing only hello
9835 messages, which is appreciable.
9836
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009837 Note that this check works even when SSL support was not built into HAProxy
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02009838 because it forges the SSL message. When SSL support is available, it is best
9839 to use native SSL health checks instead of this one.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009840
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02009841 See also: "option httpchk", "check-ssl"
9842
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009843
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009844option tcp-check
9845 Perform health checks using tcp-check send/expect sequences
9846 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9847 yes | no | yes | yes
9848
9849 This health check method is intended to be combined with "tcp-check" command
9850 lists in order to support send/expect types of health check sequences.
9851
9852 TCP checks currently support 4 modes of operations :
9853 - no "tcp-check" directive : the health check only consists in a connection
9854 attempt, which remains the default mode.
9855
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009856 - "tcp-check send" or "tcp-check send-binary" only is mentioned : this is
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009857 used to send a string along with a connection opening. With some
9858 protocols, it helps sending a "QUIT" message for example that prevents
9859 the server from logging a connection error for each health check. The
9860 check result will still be based on the ability to open the connection
9861 only.
9862
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009863 - "tcp-check expect" only is mentioned : this is used to test a banner.
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009864 The connection is opened and HAProxy waits for the server to present some
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009865 contents which must validate some rules. The check result will be based
9866 on the matching between the contents and the rules. This is suited for
9867 POP, IMAP, SMTP, FTP, SSH, TELNET.
9868
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009869 - both "tcp-check send" and "tcp-check expect" are mentioned : this is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009870 used to test a hello-type protocol. HAProxy sends a message, the server
9871 responds and its response is analyzed. the check result will be based on
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009872 the matching between the response contents and the rules. This is often
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009873 suited for protocols which require a binding or a request/response model.
9874 LDAP, MySQL, Redis and SSL are example of such protocols, though they
9875 already all have their dedicated checks with a deeper understanding of
9876 the respective protocols.
9877 In this mode, many questions may be sent and many answers may be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009878 analyzed.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009879
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02009880 A fifth mode can be used to insert comments in different steps of the script.
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009881
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02009882 For each tcp-check rule you create, you can add a "comment" directive,
9883 followed by a string. This string will be reported in the log and stderr in
9884 debug mode. It is useful to make user-friendly error reporting. The
9885 "comment" is of course optional.
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009886
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02009887 During the execution of a health check, a variable scope is made available to
9888 store data samples, using the "tcp-check set-var" operation. Freeing those
9889 variable is possible using "tcp-check unset-var".
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +01009890
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009891
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009892 Examples :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009893 # perform a POP check (analyze only server's banner)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009894 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009895 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready comment POP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009896
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009897 # perform an IMAP check (analyze only server's banner)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009898 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009899 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready comment IMAP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009900
9901 # look for the redis master server after ensuring it speaks well
9902 # redis protocol, then it exits properly.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009903 # (send a command then analyze the response 3 times)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009904 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009905 tcp-check comment PING\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009906 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +02009907 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009908 tcp-check comment role\ check
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009909 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
9910 tcp-check expect string role:master
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009911 tcp-check comment QUIT\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009912 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
9913 tcp-check expect string +OK
9914
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009915 forge a HTTP request, then analyze the response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009916 (send many headers before analyzing)
9917 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009918 tcp-check comment forge\ and\ send\ HTTP\ request
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009919 tcp-check send HEAD\ /\ HTTP/1.1\r\n
9920 tcp-check send Host:\ www.mydomain.com\r\n
9921 tcp-check send User-Agent:\ HAProxy\ tcpcheck\r\n
9922 tcp-check send \r\n
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009923 tcp-check expect rstring HTTP/1\..\ (2..|3..) comment check\ HTTP\ response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009924
9925
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02009926 See also : "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect" and "tcp-check send".
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009927
9928
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02009929option tcp-smart-accept
9930no option tcp-smart-accept
9931 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the accept sequence
9932 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9933 yes | yes | yes | no
9934 Arguments : none
9935
9936 When an HTTP connection request comes in, the system acknowledges it on
9937 behalf of HAProxy, then the client immediately sends its request, and the
9938 system acknowledges it too while it is notifying HAProxy about the new
9939 connection. HAProxy then reads the request and responds. This means that we
9940 have one TCP ACK sent by the system for nothing, because the request could
9941 very well be acknowledged by HAProxy when it sends its response.
9942
9943 For this reason, in HTTP mode, HAProxy automatically asks the system to avoid
9944 sending this useless ACK on platforms which support it (currently at least
9945 Linux). It must not cause any problem, because the system will send it anyway
9946 after 40 ms if the response takes more time than expected to come.
9947
9948 During complex network debugging sessions, it may be desirable to disable
9949 this optimization because delayed ACKs can make troubleshooting more complex
9950 when trying to identify where packets are delayed. It is then possible to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009951 fall back to normal behavior by specifying "no option tcp-smart-accept".
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02009952
9953 It is also possible to force it for non-HTTP proxies by simply specifying
9954 "option tcp-smart-accept". For instance, it can make sense with some services
9955 such as SMTP where the server speaks first.
9956
9957 It is recommended to avoid forcing this option in a defaults section. In case
9958 of doubt, consider setting it back to automatic values by prepending the
9959 "default" keyword before it, or disabling it using the "no" keyword.
9960
Willy Tarreaud88edf22009-06-14 15:48:17 +02009961 See also : "option tcp-smart-connect"
9962
9963
9964option tcp-smart-connect
9965no option tcp-smart-connect
9966 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the connect sequence
9967 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9968 yes | no | yes | yes
9969 Arguments : none
9970
9971 On certain systems (at least Linux), HAProxy can ask the kernel not to
9972 immediately send an empty ACK upon a connection request, but to directly
9973 send the buffer request instead. This saves one packet on the network and
9974 thus boosts performance. It can also be useful for some servers, because they
9975 immediately get the request along with the incoming connection.
9976
9977 This feature is enabled when "option tcp-smart-connect" is set in a backend.
9978 It is not enabled by default because it makes network troubleshooting more
9979 complex.
9980
9981 It only makes sense to enable it with protocols where the client speaks first
9982 such as HTTP. In other situations, if there is no data to send in place of
9983 the ACK, a normal ACK is sent.
9984
9985 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9986 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9987
9988 See also : "option tcp-smart-accept"
9989
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02009990
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009991option tcpka
9992 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on both sides
9993 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9994 yes | yes | yes | yes
9995 Arguments : none
9996
9997 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
9998 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009999 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +010010000 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
10001
10002 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
10003 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
10004 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
10005 operating system and its tuning parameters.
10006
10007 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
10008 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
10009 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
10010 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
10011 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
10012
10013 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
10014
10015 Using option "tcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on both
10016 the client and server sides of a connection. Note that this is meaningful
10017 only in "defaults" or "listen" sections. If this option is used in a
10018 frontend, only the client side will get keep-alives, and if this option is
10019 used in a backend, only the server side will get keep-alives. For this
10020 reason, it is strongly recommended to explicitly use "option clitcpka" and
10021 "option srvtcpka" when the configuration is split between frontends and
10022 backends.
10023
10024 See also : "option clitcpka", "option srvtcpka"
10025
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010026
10027option tcplog
10028 Enable advanced logging of TCP connections with session state and timers
10029 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Tim Duesterhus9ad9f352018-02-05 20:52:27 +010010030 yes | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010031 Arguments : none
10032
10033 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
10034 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
10035 "option tcplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including, but
10036 not limited to, the connection timers, the session status, the connections
10037 numbers, the frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source
10038 address and ports. This option is useful for pure TCP proxies in order to
10039 find which of the client or server disconnects or times out. For normal HTTP
10040 proxies, it's better to use "option httplog" which is even more complete.
10041
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +020010042 "option tcplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
10043
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010044 See also : "option httplog", and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010045
10046
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010047option transparent
10048no option transparent
10049 Enable client-side transparent proxying
10050 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +010010051 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010052 Arguments : none
10053
10054 This option was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer 3
10055 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
10056 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
10057 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
10058 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
10059 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
10060 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
10061 appropriate server.
10062
10063 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
10064 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
10065
Willy Tarreaua1146052011-03-01 09:51:54 +010010066 See also: the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword, and the
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010067 "transparent" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010068
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +010010069
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +090010070external-check command <command>
10071 Executable to run when performing an external-check
10072 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10073 yes | no | yes | yes
10074
10075 Arguments :
10076 <command> is the external command to run
10077
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +090010078 The arguments passed to the to the command are:
10079
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +010010080 <proxy_address> <proxy_port> <server_address> <server_port>
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +090010081
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +010010082 The <proxy_address> and <proxy_port> are derived from the first listener
10083 that is either IPv4, IPv6 or a UNIX socket. In the case of a UNIX socket
10084 listener the proxy_address will be the path of the socket and the
10085 <proxy_port> will be the string "NOT_USED". In a backend section, it's not
10086 possible to determine a listener, and both <proxy_address> and <proxy_port>
10087 will have the string value "NOT_USED".
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +090010088
Cyril Bonté72cda2a2014-12-27 22:28:39 +010010089 Some values are also provided through environment variables.
10090
10091 Environment variables :
10092 HAPROXY_PROXY_ADDR The first bind address if available (or empty if not
10093 applicable, for example in a "backend" section).
10094
10095 HAPROXY_PROXY_ID The backend id.
10096
10097 HAPROXY_PROXY_NAME The backend name.
10098
10099 HAPROXY_PROXY_PORT The first bind port if available (or empty if not
10100 applicable, for example in a "backend" section or
10101 for a UNIX socket).
10102
10103 HAPROXY_SERVER_ADDR The server address.
10104
10105 HAPROXY_SERVER_CURCONN The current number of connections on the server.
10106
10107 HAPROXY_SERVER_ID The server id.
10108
10109 HAPROXY_SERVER_MAXCONN The server max connections.
10110
10111 HAPROXY_SERVER_NAME The server name.
10112
10113 HAPROXY_SERVER_PORT The server port if available (or empty for a UNIX
10114 socket).
10115
Willy Tarreau973cf902022-05-13 15:58:35 +020010116 HAPROXY_SERVER_SSL "0" when SSL is not used, "1" when it is used
10117
10118 HAPROXY_SERVER_PROTO The protocol used by this server, which can be one
10119 of "cli" (the haproxy CLI), "syslog" (syslog TCP
10120 server), "peers" (peers TCP server), "h1" (HTTP/1.x
10121 server), "h2" (HTTP/2 server), or "tcp" (any other
10122 TCP server).
10123
Cyril Bonté72cda2a2014-12-27 22:28:39 +010010124 PATH The PATH environment variable used when executing
10125 the command may be set using "external-check path".
10126
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +020010127 See also "2.3. Environment variables" for other variables.
10128
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +090010129 If the command executed and exits with a zero status then the check is
10130 considered to have passed, otherwise the check is considered to have
10131 failed.
10132
10133 Example :
10134 external-check command /bin/true
10135
10136 See also : "external-check", "option external-check", "external-check path"
10137
10138
10139external-check path <path>
10140 The value of the PATH environment variable used when running an external-check
10141 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10142 yes | no | yes | yes
10143
10144 Arguments :
10145 <path> is the path used when executing external command to run
10146
10147 The default path is "".
10148
10149 Example :
10150 external-check path "/usr/bin:/bin"
10151
10152 See also : "external-check", "option external-check",
10153 "external-check command"
10154
10155
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +020010156persist rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +020010157persist rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +020010158 Enable RDP cookie-based persistence
10159 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10160 yes | no | yes | yes
10161 Arguments :
10162 <name> is the optional name of the RDP cookie to check. If omitted, the
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +020010163 default cookie name "msts" will be used. There currently is no
10164 valid reason to change this name.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +020010165
10166 This statement enables persistence based on an RDP cookie. The RDP cookie
10167 contains all information required to find the server in the list of known
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010168 servers. So when this option is set in the backend, the request is analyzed
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +020010169 and if an RDP cookie is found, it is decoded. If it matches a known server
10170 which is still UP (or if "option persist" is set), then the connection is
10171 forwarded to this server.
10172
10173 Note that this only makes sense in a TCP backend, but for this to work, the
10174 frontend must have waited long enough to ensure that an RDP cookie is present
10175 in the request buffer. This is the same requirement as with the "rdp-cookie"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010176 load-balancing method. Thus it is highly recommended to put all statements in
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +020010177 a single "listen" section.
10178
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +020010179 Also, it is important to understand that the terminal server will emit this
10180 RDP cookie only if it is configured for "token redirection mode", which means
10181 that the "IP address redirection" option is disabled.
10182
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +020010183 Example :
10184 listen tse-farm
10185 bind :3389
10186 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
10187 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
10188 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
10189 # apply RDP cookie persistence
10190 persist rdp-cookie
10191 # if server is unknown, let's balance on the same cookie.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020010192 # alternatively, "balance leastconn" may be useful too.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +020010193 balance rdp-cookie
10194 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
10195 server srv2 1.1.1.2:3389
10196
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010010197 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "tcp-request" and the "req.rdp_cookie" ACL.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +020010198
10199
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +010010200rate-limit sessions <rate>
10201 Set a limit on the number of new sessions accepted per second on a frontend
10202 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10203 yes | yes | yes | no
10204 Arguments :
10205 <rate> The <rate> parameter is an integer designating the maximum number
10206 of new sessions per second to accept on the frontend.
10207
10208 When the frontend reaches the specified number of new sessions per second, it
10209 stops accepting new connections until the rate drops below the limit again.
10210 During this time, the pending sessions will be kept in the socket's backlog
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040010211 (in system buffers) and HAProxy will not even be aware that sessions are
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +010010212 pending. When applying very low limit on a highly loaded service, it may make
10213 sense to increase the socket's backlog using the "backlog" keyword.
10214
10215 This feature is particularly efficient at blocking connection-based attacks
10216 or service abuse on fragile servers. Since the session rate is measured every
10217 millisecond, it is extremely accurate. Also, the limit applies immediately,
10218 no delay is needed at all to detect the threshold.
10219
10220 Example : limit the connection rate on SMTP to 10 per second max
10221 listen smtp
10222 mode tcp
10223 bind :25
10224 rate-limit sessions 10
Panagiotis Panagiotopoulos7282d8e2016-02-11 16:37:15 +020010225 server smtp1 127.0.0.1:1025
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +010010226
Willy Tarreaua17c2d92011-07-25 08:16:20 +020010227 Note : when the maximum rate is reached, the frontend's status is not changed
10228 but its sockets appear as "WAITING" in the statistics if the
10229 "socket-stats" option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +010010230
10231 See also : the "backlog" keyword and the "fe_sess_rate" ACL criterion.
10232
10233
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +020010234redirect location <loc> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
10235redirect prefix <pfx> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
10236redirect scheme <sch> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +020010237 Return an HTTP redirection if/unless a condition is matched
10238 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10239 no | yes | yes | yes
10240
10241 If/unless the condition is matched, the HTTP request will lead to a redirect
Willy Tarreauf285f542010-01-03 20:03:03 +010010242 response. If no condition is specified, the redirect applies unconditionally.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +020010243
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010010244 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +020010245 <loc> With "redirect location", the exact value in <loc> is placed into
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +010010246 the HTTP "Location" header. When used in an "http-request" rule,
10247 <loc> value follows the log-format rules and can include some
10248 dynamic values (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +020010249
10250 <pfx> With "redirect prefix", the "Location" header is built from the
10251 concatenation of <pfx> and the complete URI path, including the
10252 query string, unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see
10253 below). As a special case, if <pfx> equals exactly "/", then
10254 nothing is inserted before the original URI. It allows one to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +010010255 redirect to the same URL (for instance, to insert a cookie). When
10256 used in an "http-request" rule, <pfx> value follows the log-format
10257 rules and can include some dynamic values (see Custom Log Format
10258 in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +020010259
10260 <sch> With "redirect scheme", then the "Location" header is built by
10261 concatenating <sch> with "://" then the first occurrence of the
10262 "Host" header, and then the URI path, including the query string
10263 unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see below). If no
10264 path is found or if the path is "*", then "/" is used instead. If
10265 no "Host" header is found, then an empty host component will be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010266 returned, which most recent browsers interpret as redirecting to
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +020010267 the same host. This directive is mostly used to redirect HTTP to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +010010268 HTTPS. When used in an "http-request" rule, <sch> value follows
10269 the log-format rules and can include some dynamic values (see
10270 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010010271
10272 <code> The code is optional. It indicates which type of HTTP redirection
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +010010273 is desired. Only codes 301, 302, 303, 307 and 308 are supported,
10274 with 302 used by default if no code is specified. 301 means
10275 "Moved permanently", and a browser may cache the Location. 302
Baptiste Assmannea849c02015-08-03 11:42:50 +020010276 means "Moved temporarily" and means that the browser should not
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +010010277 cache the redirection. 303 is equivalent to 302 except that the
10278 browser will fetch the location with a GET method. 307 is just
10279 like 302 but makes it clear that the same method must be reused.
10280 Likewise, 308 replaces 301 if the same method must be used.
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010010281
10282 <option> There are several options which can be specified to adjust the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010283 expected behavior of a redirection :
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010010284
10285 - "drop-query"
10286 When this keyword is used in a prefix-based redirection, then the
10287 location will be set without any possible query-string, which is useful
10288 for directing users to a non-secure page for instance. It has no effect
10289 with a location-type redirect.
10290
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +010010291 - "append-slash"
10292 This keyword may be used in conjunction with "drop-query" to redirect
10293 users who use a URL not ending with a '/' to the same one with the '/'.
10294 It can be useful to ensure that search engines will only see one URL.
10295 For this, a return code 301 is preferred.
10296
Willy Tarreaubc1223b2021-09-02 16:54:33 +020010297 - "ignore-empty"
10298 This keyword only has effect when a location is produced using a log
10299 format expression (i.e. when used in http-request or http-response).
10300 It indicates that if the result of the expression is empty, the rule
10301 should silently be skipped. The main use is to allow mass-redirects
10302 of known paths using a simple map.
10303
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010010304 - "set-cookie NAME[=value]"
10305 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "=value")
10306 to the response. This is sometimes used to indicate that a user has
10307 been seen, for instance to protect against some types of DoS. No other
10308 cookie option is added, so the cookie will be a session cookie. Note
10309 that for a browser, a sole cookie name without an equal sign is
10310 different from a cookie with an equal sign.
10311
10312 - "clear-cookie NAME[=]"
10313 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "="), but
10314 with the "Max-Age" attribute set to zero. This will tell the browser to
10315 delete this cookie. It is useful for instance on logout pages. It is
10316 important to note that clearing the cookie "NAME" will not remove a
10317 cookie set with "NAME=value". You have to clear the cookie "NAME=" for
10318 that, because the browser makes the difference.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +020010319
10320 Example: move the login URL only to HTTPS.
10321 acl clear dst_port 80
10322 acl secure dst_port 8080
10323 acl login_page url_beg /login
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010010324 acl logout url_beg /logout
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +010010325 acl uid_given url_reg /login?userid=[^&]+
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010010326 acl cookie_set hdr_sub(cookie) SEEN=1
10327
10328 redirect prefix https://mysite.com set-cookie SEEN=1 if !cookie_set
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +010010329 redirect prefix https://mysite.com if login_page !secure
10330 redirect prefix http://mysite.com drop-query if login_page !uid_given
10331 redirect location http://mysite.com/ if !login_page secure
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010010332 redirect location / clear-cookie USERID= if logout
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +020010333
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +010010334 Example: send redirects for request for articles without a '/'.
10335 acl missing_slash path_reg ^/article/[^/]*$
10336 redirect code 301 prefix / drop-query append-slash if missing_slash
10337
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040010338 Example: redirect all HTTP traffic to HTTPS when SSL is handled by HAProxy.
David BERARDe7153042012-11-03 00:11:31 +010010339 redirect scheme https if !{ ssl_fc }
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +020010340
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +010010341 Example: append 'www.' prefix in front of all hosts not having it
Coen Rosdorff596659b2016-04-11 11:33:49 +020010342 http-request redirect code 301 location \
10343 http://www.%[hdr(host)]%[capture.req.uri] \
10344 unless { hdr_beg(host) -i www }
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +010010345
Willy Tarreaubc1223b2021-09-02 16:54:33 +020010346 Example: permanently redirect only old URLs to new ones
10347 http-request redirect code 301 location \
10348 %[path,map_str(old-blog-articles.map)] ignore-empty
10349
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010350 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +020010351
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +010010352
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +020010353retries <value>
10354 Set the number of retries to perform on a server after a connection failure
10355 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10356 yes | no | yes | yes
10357 Arguments :
10358 <value> is the number of times a connection attempt should be retried on
10359 a server when a connection either is refused or times out. The
10360 default value is 3.
10361
10362 It is important to understand that this value applies to the number of
10363 connection attempts, not full requests. When a connection has effectively
10364 been established to a server, there will be no more retry.
10365
10366 In order to avoid immediate reconnections to a server which is restarting,
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -070010367 a turn-around timer of min("timeout connect", one second) is applied before
10368 a retry occurs.
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +020010369
10370 When "option redispatch" is set, the last retry may be performed on another
10371 server even if a cookie references a different server.
10372
10373 See also : "option redispatch"
10374
10375
Lukas Tribusde160082021-12-08 11:33:01 +010010376retry-on [space-delimited list of keywords]
Jerome Magnin5ce3c142020-05-13 20:09:57 +020010377 Specify when to attempt to automatically retry a failed request.
10378 This setting is only valid when "mode" is set to http and is silently ignored
10379 otherwise.
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +020010380 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10381 yes | no | yes | yes
10382 Arguments :
Lukas Tribusde160082021-12-08 11:33:01 +010010383 <keywords> is a space-delimited list of keywords or HTTP status codes, each
10384 representing a type of failure event on which an attempt to
10385 retry the request is desired. Please read the notes at the
10386 bottom before changing this setting. The following keywords are
10387 supported :
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +020010388
10389 none never retry
10390
10391 conn-failure retry when the connection or the SSL handshake failed
10392 and the request could not be sent. This is the default.
10393
10394 empty-response retry when the server connection was closed after part
10395 of the request was sent, and nothing was received from
10396 the server. This type of failure may be caused by the
10397 request timeout on the server side, poor network
10398 condition, or a server crash or restart while
10399 processing the request.
10400
Olivier Houcharde3249a92019-05-03 23:01:47 +020010401 junk-response retry when the server returned something not looking
10402 like a complete HTTP response. This includes partial
10403 responses headers as well as non-HTTP contents. It
10404 usually is a bad idea to retry on such events, which
10405 may be caused a configuration issue (wrong server port)
10406 or by the request being harmful to the server (buffer
10407 overflow attack for example).
10408
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +020010409 response-timeout the server timeout stroke while waiting for the server
10410 to respond to the request. This may be caused by poor
10411 network condition, the reuse of an idle connection
10412 which has expired on the path, or by the request being
10413 extremely expensive to process. It generally is a bad
10414 idea to retry on such events on servers dealing with
10415 heavy database processing (full scans, etc) as it may
10416 amplify denial of service attacks.
10417
Olivier Houchard865d8392019-05-03 22:46:27 +020010418 0rtt-rejected retry requests which were sent over early data and were
10419 rejected by the server. These requests are generally
10420 considered to be safe to retry.
10421
Julien Pivotto2de240a2020-11-12 11:14:05 +010010422 <status> any HTTP status code among "401" (Unauthorized), "403"
10423 (Forbidden), "404" (Not Found), "408" (Request Timeout),
10424 "425" (Too Early), "500" (Server Error), "501" (Not
10425 Implemented), "502" (Bad Gateway), "503" (Service
10426 Unavailable), "504" (Gateway Timeout).
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +020010427
Olivier Houchardddf0e032019-05-10 18:05:40 +020010428 all-retryable-errors
10429 retry request for any error that are considered
10430 retryable. This currently activates "conn-failure",
10431 "empty-response", "junk-response", "response-timeout",
10432 "0rtt-rejected", "500", "502", "503", and "504".
10433
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +020010434 Using this directive replaces any previous settings with the new ones; it is
10435 not cumulative.
10436
10437 Please note that using anything other than "none" and "conn-failure" requires
10438 to allocate a buffer and copy the whole request into it, so it has memory and
10439 performance impacts. Requests not fitting in a single buffer will never be
10440 retried (see the global tune.bufsize setting).
10441
10442 You have to make sure the application has a replay protection mechanism built
10443 in such as a unique transaction IDs passed in requests, or that replaying the
10444 same request has no consequence, or it is very dangerous to use any retry-on
10445 value beside "conn-failure" and "none". Static file servers and caches are
10446 generally considered safe against any type of retry. Using a status code can
10447 be useful to quickly leave a server showing an abnormal behavior (out of
10448 memory, file system issues, etc), but in this case it may be a good idea to
10449 immediately redispatch the connection to another server (please see "option
10450 redispatch" for this). Last, it is important to understand that most causes
10451 of failures are the requests themselves and that retrying a request causing a
10452 server to misbehave will often make the situation even worse for this server,
10453 or for the whole service in case of redispatch.
10454
10455 Unless you know exactly how the application deals with replayed requests, you
10456 should not use this directive.
10457
10458 The default is "conn-failure".
10459
Lukas Tribusde160082021-12-08 11:33:01 +010010460 Example:
10461 retry-on 503 504
10462
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +020010463 See also: "retries", "option redispatch", "tune.bufsize"
10464
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +010010465server <name> <address>[:[port]] [param*]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010466 Declare a server in a backend
10467 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10468 no | no | yes | yes
10469 Arguments :
10470 <name> is the internal name assigned to this server. This name will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010471 appear in logs and alerts. If "http-send-name-header" is
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -050010472 set, it will be added to the request header sent to the server.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010473
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +010010474 <address> is the IPv4 or IPv6 address of the server. Alternatively, a
10475 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
10476 during start-up. Address "0.0.0.0" or "*" has a special meaning.
10477 It indicates that the connection will be forwarded to the same IP
Willy Tarreaud669a4f2010-07-13 14:49:50 +020010478 address as the one from the client connection. This is useful in
10479 transparent proxy architectures where the client's connection is
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040010480 intercepted and HAProxy must forward to the original destination
Willy Tarreaud669a4f2010-07-13 14:49:50 +020010481 address. This is more or less what the "transparent" keyword does
10482 except that with a server it's possible to limit concurrency and
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +010010483 to report statistics. Optionally, an address family prefix may be
10484 used before the address to force the family regardless of the
10485 address format, which can be useful to specify a path to a unix
10486 socket with no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
10487 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
10488 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
10489 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +020010490 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
William Lallemand2fe7dd02018-09-11 16:51:29 +020010491 - 'sockpair@' -> address is the FD of a connected unix
10492 socket or of a socketpair. During a connection, the
10493 backend creates a pair of connected sockets, and passes
10494 one of them over the FD. The bind part will use the
10495 received socket as the client FD. Should be used
10496 carefully.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +020010497 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
10498 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010010499 variables. The "init-addr" setting can be used to modify the way
10500 IP addresses should be resolved upon startup.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010501
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010502 <port> is an optional port specification. If set, all connections will
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010503 be sent to this port. If unset, the same port the client
10504 connected to will be used. The port may also be prefixed by a "+"
10505 or a "-". In this case, the server's port will be determined by
10506 adding this value to the client's port.
10507
10508 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "server" keywords
10509 accepts an important number of options and has a complete section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010510 dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more details.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010511
10512 Examples :
10513 server first 10.1.1.1:1080 cookie first check inter 1000
10514 server second 10.1.1.2:1080 cookie second check inter 1000
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +010010515 server transp ipv4@
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +020010516 server backup "${SRV_BACKUP}:1080" backup
10517 server www1_dc1 "${LAN_DC1}.101:80"
10518 server www1_dc2 "${LAN_DC2}.101:80"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010519
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +020010520 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
10521 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
10522 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
10523 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
10524 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
10525
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -050010526 See also: "default-server", "http-send-name-header" and section 5 about
10527 server options
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010528
Christopher Faulet583b6de2021-02-12 09:27:10 +010010529server-state-file-name [ { use-backend-name | <file> } ]
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +020010530 Set the server state file to read, load and apply to servers available in
Christopher Faulet583b6de2021-02-12 09:27:10 +010010531 this backend.
10532 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10533 no | no | yes | yes
10534
10535 It only applies when the directive "load-server-state-from-file" is set to
10536 "local". When <file> is not provided, if "use-backend-name" is used or if
10537 this directive is not set, then backend name is used. If <file> starts with a
10538 slash '/', then it is considered as an absolute path. Otherwise, <file> is
10539 concatenated to the global directive "server-state-base".
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +020010540
10541 Example: the minimal configuration below would make HAProxy look for the
10542 state server file '/etc/haproxy/states/bk':
10543
10544 global
10545 server-state-file-base /etc/haproxy/states
10546
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010010547 backend bk
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +020010548 load-server-state-from-file
10549
Christopher Faulet583b6de2021-02-12 09:27:10 +010010550 See also: "server-state-base", "load-server-state-from-file", and
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +020010551 "show servers state"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010552
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +020010553server-template <prefix> <num | range> <fqdn>[:<port>] [params*]
10554 Set a template to initialize servers with shared parameters.
10555 The names of these servers are built from <prefix> and <num | range> parameters.
10556 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10557 no | no | yes | yes
10558
10559 Arguments:
10560 <prefix> A prefix for the server names to be built.
10561
10562 <num | range>
10563 If <num> is provided, this template initializes <num> servers
10564 with 1 up to <num> as server name suffixes. A range of numbers
10565 <num_low>-<num_high> may also be used to use <num_low> up to
10566 <num_high> as server name suffixes.
10567
10568 <fqdn> A FQDN for all the servers this template initializes.
10569
10570 <port> Same meaning as "server" <port> argument (see "server" keyword).
10571
10572 <params*>
10573 Remaining server parameters among all those supported by "server"
10574 keyword.
10575
10576 Examples:
10577 # Initializes 3 servers with srv1, srv2 and srv3 as names,
10578 # google.com as FQDN, and health-check enabled.
10579 server-template srv 1-3 google.com:80 check
10580
10581 # or
10582 server-template srv 3 google.com:80 check
10583
10584 # would be equivalent to:
10585 server srv1 google.com:80 check
10586 server srv2 google.com:80 check
10587 server srv3 google.com:80 check
10588
10589
10590
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010591source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020010592source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +010010593source <addr>[:<port>] [interface <name>]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010594 Set the source address for outgoing connections
10595 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10596 yes | no | yes | yes
10597 Arguments :
10598 <addr> is the IPv4 address HAProxy will bind to before connecting to a
10599 server. This address is also used as a source for health checks.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +010010600
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010601 The default value of 0.0.0.0 means that the system will select
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +010010602 the most appropriate address to reach its destination. Optionally
10603 an address family prefix may be used before the address to force
10604 the family regardless of the address format, which can be useful
10605 to specify a path to a unix socket with no slash ('/'). Currently
10606 supported prefixes are :
10607 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
10608 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
10609 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +020010610 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020010611 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
10612 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010613
10614 <port> is an optional port. It is normally not needed but may be useful
10615 in some very specific contexts. The default value of zero means
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020010616 the system will select a free port. Note that port ranges are not
10617 supported in the backend. If you want to force port ranges, you
10618 have to specify them on each "server" line.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010619
10620 <addr2> is the IP address to present to the server when connections are
10621 forwarded in full transparent proxy mode. This is currently only
10622 supported on some patched Linux kernels. When this address is
10623 specified, clients connecting to the server will be presented
10624 with this address, while health checks will still use the address
10625 <addr>.
10626
10627 <port2> is the optional port to present to the server when connections
10628 are forwarded in full transparent proxy mode (see <addr2> above).
10629 The default value of zero means the system will select a free
10630 port.
10631
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020010632 <hdr> is the name of a HTTP header in which to fetch the IP to bind to.
10633 This is the name of a comma-separated header list which can
10634 contain multiple IP addresses. By default, the last occurrence is
10635 used. This is designed to work with the X-Forwarded-For header
Baptiste Assmannea3e73b2013-02-02 23:47:49 +010010636 and to automatically bind to the client's IP address as seen
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020010637 by previous proxy, typically Stunnel. In order to use another
10638 occurrence from the last one, please see the <occ> parameter
10639 below. When the header (or occurrence) is not found, no binding
10640 is performed so that the proxy's default IP address is used. Also
10641 keep in mind that the header name is case insensitive, as for any
10642 HTTP header.
10643
10644 <occ> is the occurrence number of a value to be used in a multi-value
10645 header. This is to be used in conjunction with "hdr_ip(<hdr>)",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040010646 in order to specify which occurrence to use for the source IP
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020010647 address. Positive values indicate a position from the first
10648 occurrence, 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
10649 positions relative to the last one, -1 being the last one. This
10650 is helpful for situations where an X-Forwarded-For header is set
10651 at the entry point of an infrastructure and must be used several
10652 proxy layers away. When this value is not specified, -1 is
10653 assumed. Passing a zero here disables the feature.
10654
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +010010655 <name> is an optional interface name to which to bind to for outgoing
10656 traffic. On systems supporting this features (currently, only
10657 Linux), this allows one to bind all traffic to the server to
10658 this interface even if it is not the one the system would select
10659 based on routing tables. This should be used with extreme care.
10660 Note that using this option requires root privileges.
10661
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010662 The "source" keyword is useful in complex environments where a specific
10663 address only is allowed to connect to the servers. It may be needed when a
10664 private address must be used through a public gateway for instance, and it is
10665 known that the system cannot determine the adequate source address by itself.
10666
10667 An extension which is available on certain patched Linux kernels may be used
10668 through the "usesrc" optional keyword. It makes it possible to connect to the
10669 servers with an IP address which does not belong to the system itself. This
10670 is called "full transparent proxy mode". For this to work, the destination
10671 servers have to route their traffic back to this address through the machine
10672 running HAProxy, and IP forwarding must generally be enabled on this machine.
10673
10674 In this "full transparent proxy" mode, it is possible to force a specific IP
10675 address to be presented to the servers. This is not much used in fact. A more
10676 common use is to tell HAProxy to present the client's IP address. For this,
10677 there are two methods :
10678
10679 - present the client's IP and port addresses. This is the most transparent
10680 mode, but it can cause problems when IP connection tracking is enabled on
10681 the machine, because a same connection may be seen twice with different
10682 states. However, this solution presents the huge advantage of not
10683 limiting the system to the 64k outgoing address+port couples, because all
10684 of the client ranges may be used.
10685
10686 - present only the client's IP address and select a spare port. This
10687 solution is still quite elegant but slightly less transparent (downstream
10688 firewalls logs will not match upstream's). It also presents the downside
10689 of limiting the number of concurrent connections to the usual 64k ports.
10690 However, since the upstream and downstream ports are different, local IP
10691 connection tracking on the machine will not be upset by the reuse of the
10692 same session.
10693
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010694 This option sets the default source for all servers in the backend. It may
10695 also be specified in a "defaults" section. Finer source address specification
10696 is possible at the server level using the "source" server option. Refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010697 section 5 for more information.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010698
Baptiste Assmann91bd3372015-07-17 21:59:42 +020010699 In order to work, "usesrc" requires root privileges.
10700
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010701 Examples :
10702 backend private
10703 # Connect to the servers using our 192.168.1.200 source address
10704 source 192.168.1.200
10705
10706 backend transparent_ssl1
10707 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address
10708 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
10709
10710 backend transparent_ssl2
10711 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address and port
10712 # not recommended if IP conntrack is present on the local machine.
10713 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc client
10714
10715 backend transparent_ssl3
10716 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address. It
10717 # is more conntrack-friendly.
10718 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
10719
10720 backend transparent_smtp
10721 # Connect to the SMTP farm from the client's source address/port
10722 # with Tproxy version 4.
10723 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc clientip
10724
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020010725 backend transparent_http
10726 # Connect to the servers using the client's IP as seen by previous
10727 # proxy.
10728 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
10729
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010730 See also : the "source" server option in section 5, the Tproxy patches for
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010731 the Linux kernel on www.balabit.com, the "bind" keyword.
10732
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010733
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +090010734srvtcpka-cnt <count>
10735 Sets the maximum number of keepalive probes TCP should send before dropping
10736 the connection on the server side.
10737 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10738 yes | no | yes | yes
10739 Arguments :
10740 <count> is the maximum number of keepalive probes.
10741
10742 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPCNT. If this keyword
10743 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_probes) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +020010744 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
10745 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +090010746
10747 See also : "option srvtcpka", "srvtcpka-idle", "srvtcpka-intvl".
10748
10749
10750srvtcpka-idle <timeout>
10751 Sets the time the connection needs to remain idle before TCP starts sending
10752 keepalive probes, if enabled the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the
10753 server side.
10754 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10755 yes | no | yes | yes
10756 Arguments :
10757 <timeout> is the time the connection needs to remain idle before TCP starts
10758 sending keepalive probes. It is specified in seconds by default,
10759 but can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the
10760 unit, as explained at the top of this document.
10761
10762 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPIDLE. If this keyword
10763 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_time) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +020010764 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
10765 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +090010766
10767 See also : "option srvtcpka", "srvtcpka-cnt", "srvtcpka-intvl".
10768
10769
10770srvtcpka-intvl <timeout>
10771 Sets the time between individual keepalive probes on the server side.
10772 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10773 yes | no | yes | yes
10774 Arguments :
10775 <timeout> is the time between individual keepalive probes. It is specified
10776 in seconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number
10777 is suffixed by the unit, as explained at the top of this
10778 document.
10779
10780 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPINTVL. If this keyword
10781 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_intvl) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +020010782 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
10783 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +090010784
10785 See also : "option srvtcpka", "srvtcpka-cnt", "srvtcpka-idle".
10786
10787
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +020010788stats admin { if | unless } <cond>
10789 Enable statistics admin level if/unless a condition is matched
10790 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010791 no | yes | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +020010792
10793 This statement enables the statistics admin level if/unless a condition is
10794 matched.
10795
10796 The admin level allows to enable/disable servers from the web interface. By
10797 default, statistics page is read-only for security reasons.
10798
Cyril Bonté23b39d92011-02-10 22:54:44 +010010799 Currently, the POST request is limited to the buffer size minus the reserved
10800 buffer space, which means that if the list of servers is too long, the
10801 request won't be processed. It is recommended to alter few servers at a
10802 time.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +020010803
10804 Example :
10805 # statistics admin level only for localhost
10806 backend stats_localhost
10807 stats enable
10808 stats admin if LOCALHOST
10809
10810 Example :
10811 # statistics admin level always enabled because of the authentication
10812 backend stats_auth
10813 stats enable
10814 stats auth admin:AdMiN123
10815 stats admin if TRUE
10816
10817 Example :
10818 # statistics admin level depends on the authenticated user
10819 userlist stats-auth
10820 group admin users admin
10821 user admin insecure-password AdMiN123
10822 group readonly users haproxy
10823 user haproxy insecure-password haproxy
10824
10825 backend stats_auth
10826 stats enable
10827 acl AUTH http_auth(stats-auth)
10828 acl AUTH_ADMIN http_auth_group(stats-auth) admin
10829 stats http-request auth unless AUTH
10830 stats admin if AUTH_ADMIN
10831
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +020010832 See also : "stats enable", "stats auth", "stats http-request", section 3.4
10833 about userlists and section 7 about ACL usage.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +020010834
10835
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010836stats auth <user>:<passwd>
10837 Enable statistics with authentication and grant access to an account
10838 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010839 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010840 Arguments :
10841 <user> is a user name to grant access to
10842
10843 <passwd> is the cleartext password associated to this user
10844
10845 This statement enables statistics with default settings, and restricts access
10846 to declared users only. It may be repeated as many times as necessary to
10847 allow as many users as desired. When a user tries to access the statistics
10848 without a valid account, a "401 Forbidden" response will be returned so that
10849 the browser asks the user to provide a valid user and password. The real
10850 which will be returned to the browser is configurable using "stats realm".
10851
10852 Since the authentication method is HTTP Basic Authentication, the passwords
10853 circulate in cleartext on the network. Thus, it was decided that the
10854 configuration file would also use cleartext passwords to remind the users
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +020010855 that those ones should not be sensitive and not shared with any other account.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010856
10857 It is also possible to reduce the scope of the proxies which appear in the
10858 report using "stats scope".
10859
10860 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10861 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10862 unobvious parameters.
10863
10864 Example :
10865 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10866 backend public_www
10867 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
10868 stats enable
10869 stats hide-version
10870 stats scope .
10871 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010872 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010873 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10874 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
10875
10876 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10877 backend private_monitoring
10878 stats enable
10879 stats uri /admin?stats
10880 stats refresh 5s
10881
10882 See also : "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats scope", "stats uri"
10883
10884
10885stats enable
10886 Enable statistics reporting with default settings
10887 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010888 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010889 Arguments : none
10890
10891 This statement enables statistics reporting with default settings defined
10892 at build time. Unless stated otherwise, these settings are used :
10893 - stats uri : /haproxy?stats
10894 - stats realm : "HAProxy Statistics"
10895 - stats auth : no authentication
10896 - stats scope : no restriction
10897
10898 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10899 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10900 unobvious parameters.
10901
10902 Example :
10903 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10904 backend public_www
10905 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
10906 stats enable
10907 stats hide-version
10908 stats scope .
10909 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010910 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010911 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10912 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
10913
10914 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10915 backend private_monitoring
10916 stats enable
10917 stats uri /admin?stats
10918 stats refresh 5s
10919
10920 See also : "stats auth", "stats realm", "stats uri"
10921
10922
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010923stats hide-version
10924 Enable statistics and hide HAProxy version reporting
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020010925 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010926 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010927 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020010928
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010929 By default, the stats page reports some useful status information along with
10930 the statistics. Among them is HAProxy's version. However, it is generally
10931 considered dangerous to report precise version to anyone, as it can help them
10932 target known weaknesses with specific attacks. The "stats hide-version"
10933 statement removes the version from the statistics report. This is recommended
10934 for public sites or any site with a weak login/password.
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020010935
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +020010936 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10937 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10938 unobvious parameters.
10939
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010940 Example :
10941 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10942 backend public_www
10943 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +020010944 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010945 stats hide-version
10946 stats scope .
10947 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010948 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010949 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10950 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020010951
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020010952 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10953 backend private_monitoring
10954 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010955 stats uri /admin?stats
10956 stats refresh 5s
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki15514c22010-01-04 16:03:09 +010010957
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010958 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020010959
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +010010960
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +020010961stats http-request { allow | deny | auth [realm <realm>] }
10962 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
10963 Access control for statistics
10964
10965 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10966 no | no | yes | yes
10967
10968 As "http-request", these set of options allow to fine control access to
10969 statistics. Each option may be followed by if/unless and acl.
10970 First option with matched condition (or option without condition) is final.
10971 For "deny" a 403 error will be returned, for "allow" normal processing is
10972 performed, for "auth" a 401/407 error code is returned so the client
10973 should be asked to enter a username and password.
10974
10975 There is no fixed limit to the number of http-request statements per
10976 instance.
10977
10978 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
10979 about ACL usage.
10980
10981
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010982stats realm <realm>
10983 Enable statistics and set authentication realm
10984 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010985 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010986 Arguments :
10987 <realm> is the name of the HTTP Basic Authentication realm reported to
10988 the browser. The browser uses it to display it in the pop-up
10989 inviting the user to enter a valid username and password.
10990
10991 The realm is read as a single word, so any spaces in it should be escaped
10992 using a backslash ('\').
10993
10994 This statement is useful only in conjunction with "stats auth" since it is
10995 only related to authentication.
10996
10997 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10998 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10999 unobvious parameters.
11000
11001 Example :
11002 # public access (limited to this backend only)
11003 backend public_www
11004 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
11005 stats enable
11006 stats hide-version
11007 stats scope .
11008 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011009 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011010 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
11011 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
11012
11013 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
11014 backend private_monitoring
11015 stats enable
11016 stats uri /admin?stats
11017 stats refresh 5s
11018
11019 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats uri"
11020
11021
11022stats refresh <delay>
11023 Enable statistics with automatic refresh
11024 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020011025 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011026 Arguments :
11027 <delay> is the suggested refresh delay, specified in seconds, which will
11028 be returned to the browser consulting the report page. While the
11029 browser is free to apply any delay, it will generally respect it
11030 and refresh the page this every seconds. The refresh interval may
11031 be specified in any other non-default time unit, by suffixing the
11032 unit after the value, as explained at the top of this document.
11033
11034 This statement is useful on monitoring displays with a permanent page
11035 reporting the load balancer's activity. When set, the HTML report page will
11036 include a link "refresh"/"stop refresh" so that the user can select whether
Jackie Tapia749f74c2020-07-22 18:59:40 -050011037 they want automatic refresh of the page or not.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011038
11039 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
11040 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
11041 unobvious parameters.
11042
11043 Example :
11044 # public access (limited to this backend only)
11045 backend public_www
11046 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
11047 stats enable
11048 stats hide-version
11049 stats scope .
11050 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011051 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011052 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
11053 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
11054
11055 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
11056 backend private_monitoring
11057 stats enable
11058 stats uri /admin?stats
11059 stats refresh 5s
11060
11061 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
11062
11063
11064stats scope { <name> | "." }
11065 Enable statistics and limit access scope
11066 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020011067 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011068 Arguments :
11069 <name> is the name of a listen, frontend or backend section to be
11070 reported. The special name "." (a single dot) designates the
11071 section in which the statement appears.
11072
11073 When this statement is specified, only the sections enumerated with this
11074 statement will appear in the report. All other ones will be hidden. This
11075 statement may appear as many times as needed if multiple sections need to be
11076 reported. Please note that the name checking is performed as simple string
11077 comparisons, and that it is never checked that a give section name really
11078 exists.
11079
11080 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
11081 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
11082 unobvious parameters.
11083
11084 Example :
11085 # public access (limited to this backend only)
11086 backend public_www
11087 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
11088 stats enable
11089 stats hide-version
11090 stats scope .
11091 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011092 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011093 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
11094 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
11095
11096 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
11097 backend private_monitoring
11098 stats enable
11099 stats uri /admin?stats
11100 stats refresh 5s
11101
11102 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
11103
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011104
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011105stats show-desc [ <desc> ]
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011106 Enable reporting of a description on the statistics page.
11107 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020011108 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011109
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011110 <desc> is an optional description to be reported. If unspecified, the
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011111 description from global section is automatically used instead.
11112
11113 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
11114 customers, where node or description should be different for each customer.
11115
11116 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
11117 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011118 unobvious parameters. By default description is not shown.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011119
11120 Example :
11121 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
11122 backend private_monitoring
11123 stats enable
11124 stats show-desc Master node for Europe, Asia, Africa
11125 stats uri /admin?stats
11126 stats refresh 5s
11127
11128 See also: "show-node", "stats enable", "stats uri" and "description" in
11129 global section.
11130
11131
11132stats show-legends
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020011133 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page
11134 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11135 yes | yes | yes | yes
11136 Arguments : none
11137
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011138 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page :
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011139 - cap: capabilities (proxy)
11140 - mode: one of tcp, http or health (proxy)
11141 - id: SNMP ID (proxy, socket, server)
11142 - IP (socket, server)
11143 - cookie (backend, server)
11144
11145 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
11146 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011147 unobvious parameters. Default behavior is not to show this information.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011148
11149 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
11150
11151
Amaury Denoyelle0b70a8a2020-10-05 11:49:45 +020011152stats show-modules
11153 Enable display of extra statistics module on the statistics page
11154 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11155 yes | yes | yes | yes
11156 Arguments : none
11157
11158 New columns are added at the end of the line containing the extra statistics
11159 values as a tooltip.
11160
11161 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
11162 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
11163 unobvious parameters. Default behavior is not to show this information.
11164
11165 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
11166
11167
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011168stats show-node [ <name> ]
11169 Enable reporting of a host name on the statistics page.
11170 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020011171 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011172 Arguments:
11173 <name> is an optional name to be reported. If unspecified, the
11174 node name from global section is automatically used instead.
11175
11176 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
11177 customers, where node or description might be different on a stats page
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011178 provided for each customer. Default behavior is not to show host name.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011179
11180 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
11181 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
11182 unobvious parameters.
11183
11184 Example:
11185 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
11186 backend private_monitoring
11187 stats enable
11188 stats show-node Europe-1
11189 stats uri /admin?stats
11190 stats refresh 5s
11191
11192 See also: "show-desc", "stats enable", "stats uri", and "node" in global
11193 section.
11194
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011195
11196stats uri <prefix>
11197 Enable statistics and define the URI prefix to access them
11198 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020011199 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011200 Arguments :
11201 <prefix> is the prefix of any URI which will be redirected to stats. This
11202 prefix may contain a question mark ('?') to indicate part of a
11203 query string.
11204
11205 The statistics URI is intercepted on the relayed traffic, so it appears as a
11206 page within the normal application. It is strongly advised to ensure that the
11207 selected URI will never appear in the application, otherwise it will never be
11208 possible to reach it in the application.
11209
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040011210 The default URI compiled in HAProxy is "/haproxy?stats", but this may be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011211 changed at build time, so it's better to always explicitly specify it here.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011212 It is generally a good idea to include a question mark in the URI so that
11213 intermediate proxies refrain from caching the results. Also, since any string
11214 beginning with the prefix will be accepted as a stats request, the question
11215 mark helps ensuring that no valid URI will begin with the same words.
11216
11217 It is sometimes very convenient to use "/" as the URI prefix, and put that
11218 statement in a "listen" instance of its own. That makes it easy to dedicate
11219 an address or a port to statistics only.
11220
11221 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
11222 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
11223 unobvious parameters.
11224
11225 Example :
11226 # public access (limited to this backend only)
11227 backend public_www
11228 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
11229 stats enable
11230 stats hide-version
11231 stats scope .
11232 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011233 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011234 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
11235 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
11236
11237 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
11238 backend private_monitoring
11239 stats enable
11240 stats uri /admin?stats
11241 stats refresh 5s
11242
11243 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm"
11244
11245
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011246stick match <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <cond>]
11247 Define a request pattern matching condition to stick a user to a server
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011248 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011249 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011250
11251 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020011252 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011253 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011254 will be analyzed in the hope to find a matching entry in a
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011255 stickiness table. This rule is mandatory.
11256
11257 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
11258 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
11259 the "stick-table" statement.
11260
11261 <cond> is an optional matching condition. It makes it possible to match
11262 on a certain criterion only when other conditions are met (or
11263 not met). For instance, it could be used to match on a source IP
11264 address except when a request passes through a known proxy, in
11265 which case we'd match on a header containing that IP address.
11266
11267 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
11268 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick match" statement
11269 describes a rule to extract the stickiness criterion from an incoming request
11270 or connection. See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and
11271 transformation rules.
11272
11273 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
11274 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
11275 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
11276 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
11277 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
11278 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
11279 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
11280
11281 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick match" statement
11282 will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. See section 7 for
11283 ACL based conditions.
11284
11285 There is no limit on the number of "stick match" statements. The first that
11286 applies and matches will cause the request to be directed to the same server
11287 as was used for the request which created the entry. That way, multiple
11288 matches can be used as fallbacks.
11289
11290 The stick rules are checked after the persistence cookies, so they will not
11291 affect stickiness if a cookie has already been used to select a server. That
11292 way, it becomes very easy to insert cookies and match on IP addresses in
11293 order to maintain stickiness between HTTP and HTTPS.
11294
11295 Example :
11296 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
11297 # last 30 minutes
11298 backend pop
11299 mode tcp
11300 balance roundrobin
11301 stick store-request src
11302 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
11303 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
11304 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
11305
11306 backend smtp
11307 mode tcp
11308 balance roundrobin
11309 stick match src table pop
11310 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
11311 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
11312
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +020011313 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", and section 7 about ACLs and samples
11314 fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011315
11316
11317stick on <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
11318 Define a request pattern to associate a user to a server
11319 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11320 no | no | yes | yes
11321
11322 Note : This form is exactly equivalent to "stick match" followed by
11323 "stick store-request", all with the same arguments. Please refer
11324 to both keywords for details. It is only provided as a convenience
11325 for writing more maintainable configurations.
11326
11327 Examples :
11328 # The following form ...
Willy Tarreauec579d82010-02-26 19:15:04 +010011329 stick on src table pop if !localhost
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011330
11331 # ...is strictly equivalent to this one :
11332 stick match src table pop if !localhost
11333 stick store-request src table pop if !localhost
11334
11335
11336 # Use cookie persistence for HTTP, and stick on source address for HTTPS as
11337 # well as HTTP without cookie. Share the same table between both accesses.
11338 backend http
11339 mode http
11340 balance roundrobin
11341 stick on src table https
11342 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
11343 server s1 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s1
11344 server s2 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s2
11345
11346 backend https
11347 mode tcp
11348 balance roundrobin
11349 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
11350 stick on src
11351 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
11352 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
11353
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +020011354 See also : "stick match", "stick store-request".
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011355
11356
11357stick store-request <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
11358 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
11359 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11360 no | no | yes | yes
11361
11362 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020011363 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011364 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011365 will be analyzed, extracted and stored in the table once a
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011366 server is selected.
11367
11368 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
11369 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
11370 the "stick-table" statement.
11371
11372 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
11373 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
11374 For instance, it could be used to store the source IP address
11375 except when the request passes through a known proxy, in which
11376 case we'd store a converted form of a header containing that IP
11377 address.
11378
11379 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
11380 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-request" statement
11381 describes a rule to decide what to extract from the request and when to do
11382 it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further requests to
11383 match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the extracted part must
11384 make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further request. Storing a
11385 client's IP address for instance often makes sense. Storing an ID found in a
11386 URL parameter also makes sense. Storing a source port will almost never make
11387 any sense because it will be randomly matched. See section 7 for a complete
11388 list of possible patterns and transformation rules.
11389
11390 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
11391 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
11392 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
11393 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
11394 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
11395 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
11396 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
11397
11398 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-request"
11399 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
11400 condition will be evaluated while parsing the request, so any criteria can be
11401 used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
11402
11403 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-request" statements, but
11404 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
11405 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
11406 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
11407 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
11408 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +010011409 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-request rules with
11410 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
11411 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
11412 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
11413 request rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
11414 not be evaluated.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011415
11416 The "store-request" rules are evaluated once the server connection has been
11417 established, so that the table will contain the real server that processed
11418 the request.
11419
11420 Example :
11421 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
11422 # last 30 minutes
11423 backend pop
11424 mode tcp
11425 balance roundrobin
11426 stick store-request src
11427 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
11428 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
11429 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
11430
11431 backend smtp
11432 mode tcp
11433 balance roundrobin
11434 stick match src table pop
11435 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
11436 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
11437
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +020011438 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", about ACLs and sample fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011439
11440
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020011441stick-table type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
Thayne McCombs92149f92020-11-20 01:28:26 -070011442 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [peers <peersect>] [srvkey <srvkey>]
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +020011443 [store <data_type>]*
Godbach64cef792013-12-04 16:08:22 +080011444 Configure the stickiness table for the current section
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011445 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +020011446 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011447
11448 Arguments :
11449 ip a table declared with "type ip" will only store IPv4 addresses.
11450 This form is very compact (about 50 bytes per entry) and allows
11451 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
11452 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
11453
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +010011454 ipv6 a table declared with "type ipv6" will only store IPv6 addresses.
11455 This form is very compact (about 60 bytes per entry) and allows
11456 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
11457 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
11458
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011459 integer a table declared with "type integer" will store 32bit integers
11460 which can represent a client identifier found in a request for
11461 instance.
11462
11463 string a table declared with "type string" will store substrings of up
11464 to <len> characters. If the string provided by the pattern
11465 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
11466 being stored. During matching, at most <len> characters will be
11467 compared between the string in the table and the extracted
11468 pattern. When not specified, the string is automatically limited
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020011469 to 32 characters.
11470
11471 binary a table declared with "type binary" will store binary blocks
11472 of <len> bytes. If the block provided by the pattern
11473 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020011474 being stored. If the block provided by the sample expression
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020011475 is shorter than <len>, it will be padded by 0. When not
11476 specified, the block is automatically limited to 32 bytes.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011477
11478 <length> is the maximum number of characters that will be stored in a
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020011479 "string" type table (See type "string" above). Or the number
11480 of bytes of the block in "binary" type table. Be careful when
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011481 changing this parameter as memory usage will proportionally
11482 increase.
11483
11484 <size> is the maximum number of entries that can fit in the table. This
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010011485 value directly impacts memory usage. Count approximately
11486 50 bytes per entry, plus the size of a string if any. The size
11487 supports suffixes "k", "m", "g" for 2^10, 2^20 and 2^30 factors.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011488
11489 [nopurge] indicates that we refuse to purge older entries when the table
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040011490 is full. When not specified and the table is full when HAProxy
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011491 wants to store an entry in it, it will flush a few of the oldest
11492 entries in order to release some space for the new ones. This is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011493 most often the desired behavior. In some specific cases, it
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011494 be desirable to refuse new entries instead of purging the older
11495 ones. That may be the case when the amount of data to store is
11496 far above the hardware limits and we prefer not to offer access
11497 to new clients than to reject the ones already connected. When
11498 using this parameter, be sure to properly set the "expire"
11499 parameter (see below).
11500
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +020011501 <peersect> is the name of the peers section to use for replication. Entries
11502 which associate keys to server IDs are kept synchronized with
11503 the remote peers declared in this section. All entries are also
11504 automatically learned from the local peer (old process) during a
11505 soft restart.
11506
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011507 <expire> defines the maximum duration of an entry in the table since it
11508 was last created, refreshed or matched. The expiration delay is
11509 defined using the standard time format, similarly as the various
11510 timeouts. The maximum duration is slightly above 24 days. See
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +010011511 section 2.5 for more information. If this delay is not specified,
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020011512 the session won't automatically expire, but older entries will
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011513 be removed once full. Be sure not to use the "nopurge" parameter
11514 if not expiration delay is specified.
11515
Thayne McCombs92149f92020-11-20 01:28:26 -070011516 <srvkey> specifies how each server is identified for the purposes of the
11517 stick table. The valid values are "name" and "addr". If "name" is
11518 given, then <name> argument for the server (may be generated by
11519 a template). If "addr" is given, then the server is identified
11520 by its current network address, including the port. "addr" is
11521 especially useful if you are using service discovery to generate
11522 the addresses for servers with peered stick-tables and want
11523 to consistently use the same host across peers for a stickiness
11524 token.
11525
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +020011526 <data_type> is used to store additional information in the stick-table. This
11527 may be used by ACLs in order to control various criteria related
11528 to the activity of the client matching the stick-table. For each
11529 item specified here, the size of each entry will be inflated so
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011530 that the additional data can fit. Several data types may be
11531 stored with an entry. Multiple data types may be specified after
11532 the "store" keyword, as a comma-separated list. Alternatively,
11533 it is possible to repeat the "store" keyword followed by one or
11534 several data types. Except for the "server_id" type which is
11535 automatically detected and enabled, all data types must be
11536 explicitly declared to be stored. If an ACL references a data
11537 type which is not stored, the ACL will simply not match. Some
11538 data types require an argument which must be passed just after
11539 the type between parenthesis. See below for the supported data
11540 types and their arguments.
11541
11542 The data types that can be stored with an entry are the following :
11543 - server_id : this is an integer which holds the numeric ID of the server a
11544 request was assigned to. It is used by the "stick match", "stick store",
11545 and "stick on" rules. It is automatically enabled when referenced.
11546
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020011547 - gpc(<nb>) : General Purpose Counters Array of <nb> elements. This is an
11548 array of positive 32-bit integers which may be used to count anything.
11549 Most of the time they will be used as a incremental counters on some
11550 entries, for instance to note that a limit is reached and trigger some
11551 actions. This array is limited to a maximum of 100 elements:
11552 gpc0 to gpc99, to ensure that the build of a peer update
11553 message can fit into the buffer. Users should take in consideration
11554 that a large amount of counters will increase the data size and the
11555 traffic load using peers protocol since all data/counters are pushed
11556 each time any of them is updated.
Emeric Brun726783d2021-06-30 19:06:43 +020011557 This data_type will exclude the usage of the legacy data_types 'gpc0'
11558 and 'gpc1' on the same table. Using the 'gpc' array data_type, all 'gpc0'
11559 and 'gpc1' related fetches and actions will apply to the two first
11560 elements of this array.
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020011561
11562 - gpc_rate(<nb>,<period>) : Array of increment rates of General Purpose
11563 Counters over a period. Those elements are positive 32-bit integers which
11564 may be used for anything. Just like <gpc>, the count events, but instead
11565 of keeping a cumulative number, they maintain the rate at which the
11566 counter is incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the
11567 frequency of occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific
11568 URL). This array is limited to a maximum of 100 elements: gpc0 to gpc99,
11569 to ensure that the build of a peer update message can fit into the
11570 buffer. Users should take in consideration that a large amount of
11571 counters will increase the data size and the traffic load using peers
11572 protocol since all data/counters are pushed each time any of them is
11573 updated.
Emeric Brun726783d2021-06-30 19:06:43 +020011574 This data_type will exclude the usage of the legacy data_types
11575 'gpc0_rate' and 'gpc1_rate' on the same table. Using the 'gpc_rate'
11576 array data_type, all 'gpc0' and 'gpc1' related fetches and actions
11577 will apply to the two first elements of this array.
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020011578
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011579 - gpc0 : first General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
11580 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
11581 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011582 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011583
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020011584 - gpc0_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
11585 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
11586 for anything. Just like <gpc0>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011587 a cumulative number, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020011588 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011589 occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific URL).
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020011590
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010011591 - gpc1 : second General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
11592 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
11593 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
11594 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches.
11595
11596 - gpc1_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
11597 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
11598 for anything. Just like <gpc1>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
11599 a cumulative number, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
11600 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
11601 occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific URL).
11602
Emeric Brun877b0b52021-06-30 18:57:49 +020011603 - gpt(<nb>) : General Purpose Tags Array of <nb> elements. This is an array
11604 of positive 32-bit integers which may be used for anything.
11605 Most of the time they will be used to put a special tags on some entries,
11606 for instance to note that a specific behavior was detected and must be
11607 known for future matches. This array is limited to a maximum of 100
11608 elements: gpt0 to gpt99, to ensure that the build of a peer update
11609 message can fit into the buffer. Users should take in consideration
11610 that a large amount of counters will increase the data size and the
11611 traffic load using peers protocol since all data/counters are pushed
11612 each time any of them is updated.
Emeric Brunf7ab0bf2021-06-30 18:58:22 +020011613 This data_type will exclude the usage of the legacy data_type 'gpt0'
11614 on the same table. Using the 'gpt' array data_type, all 'gpt0' related
11615 fetches and actions will apply to the first element of this array.
Emeric Brun877b0b52021-06-30 18:57:49 +020011616
Emeric Brun1a6b7252021-07-01 18:34:48 +020011617 - gpt0 : first General Purpose Tag. It is a positive 32-bit integer
11618 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
11619 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
11620 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches
11621
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011622 - conn_cnt : Connection Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
11623 the absolute number of connections received from clients which matched
11624 this entry. It does not mean the connections were accepted, just that
11625 they were received.
11626
11627 - conn_cur : Current Connections. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
11628 stores the concurrent connection counts for the entry. It is incremented
11629 once an incoming connection matches the entry, and decremented once the
11630 connection leaves. That way it is possible to know at any time the exact
11631 number of concurrent connections for an entry.
11632
11633 - conn_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
11634 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
11635 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
11636 incoming connection rate over that period, in connections per period. The
11637 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
11638
11639 - sess_cnt : Session Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
11640 the absolute number of sessions received from clients which matched this
11641 entry. A session is a connection that was accepted by the layer 4 rules.
11642
11643 - sess_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
11644 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
11645 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
11646 incoming session rate over that period, in sessions per period. The
11647 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
11648
11649 - http_req_cnt : HTTP request Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
11650 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests received from clients which
11651 matched this entry. It does not matter whether they are valid requests or
11652 not. Note that this is different from sessions when keep-alive is used on
11653 the client side.
11654
11655 - http_req_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
11656 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
11657 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
11658 HTTP request rate over that period, in requests per period. The result is
11659 an integer which can be matched using ACLs. It does not matter whether
11660 they are valid requests or not. Note that this is different from sessions
11661 when keep-alive is used on the client side.
11662
11663 - http_err_cnt : HTTP Error Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
11664 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests errors induced by clients
11665 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
11666 requests, as well as on denied or tarpitted requests, and on failed
11667 authentications. If the server responds with 4xx, then the request is
11668 also counted as an error since it's an error triggered by the client
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011669 (e.g. vulnerability scan).
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011670
11671 - http_err_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
11672 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
11673 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
11674 HTTP request error rate over that period, in requests per period (see
11675 http_err_cnt above for what is accounted as an error). The result is an
11676 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
11677
Willy Tarreau826f3ab2021-02-10 12:07:15 +010011678 - http_fail_cnt : HTTP Failure Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
11679 counts the absolute number of HTTP response failures induced by servers
11680 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
11681 responses, as well as any 5xx response other than 501 or 505. It aims at
11682 being used combined with path or URI to detect service failures.
11683
11684 - http_fail_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
11685 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
11686 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
11687 HTTP response failure rate over that period, in requests per period (see
11688 http_fail_cnt above for what is accounted as a failure). The result is an
11689 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
11690
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011691 - bytes_in_cnt : client to server byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011692 integer which counts the cumulative number of bytes received from clients
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011693 which matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be
11694 used to limit abuse of upload features on photo or video servers.
11695
11696 - bytes_in_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
11697 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
11698 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
11699 incoming bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
11700 to detect users which upload too much and too fast. Warning: with large
11701 uploads, it is possible that the amount of uploaded data will be counted
11702 once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average transfer speed
11703 instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be smoothed with
11704 "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of byte_in_cnt is
11705 recommended for better fairness.
11706
11707 - bytes_out_cnt : server to client byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011708 integer which counts the cumulative number of bytes sent to clients which
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011709 matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be used
11710 to limit abuse of bots sucking the whole site.
11711
11712 - bytes_out_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
11713 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
11714 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
11715 outgoing bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
11716 to detect users which download too much and too fast. Warning: with large
11717 transfers, it is possible that the amount of transferred data will be
11718 counted once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average
11719 transfer speed instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be
11720 smoothed with "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of
11721 byte_out_cnt is recommended for better fairness.
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +020011722
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +020011723 There is only one stick-table per proxy. At the moment of writing this doc,
11724 it does not seem useful to have multiple tables per proxy. If this happens
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011725 to be required, simply create a dummy backend with a stick-table in it and
11726 reference it.
11727
11728 It is important to understand that stickiness based on learning information
11729 has some limitations, including the fact that all learned associations are
Baptiste Assmann123ff042016-03-06 23:29:28 +010011730 lost upon restart unless peers are properly configured to transfer such
11731 information upon restart (recommended). In general it can be good as a
11732 complement but not always as an exclusive stickiness.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011733
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011734 Last, memory requirements may be important when storing many data types.
11735 Indeed, storing all indicators above at once in each entry requires 116 bytes
11736 per entry, or 116 MB for a 1-million entries table. This is definitely not
11737 something that can be ignored.
11738
11739 Example:
11740 # Keep track of counters of up to 1 million IP addresses over 5 minutes
11741 # and store a general purpose counter and the average connection rate
11742 # computed over a sliding window of 30 seconds.
11743 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0,conn_rate(30s)
11744
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +010011745 See also : "stick match", "stick on", "stick store-request", section 2.5
David du Colombiera13d1b92011-03-17 10:40:22 +010011746 about time format and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011747
11748
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011749stick store-response <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
Baptiste Assmann2f2d2ec2016-03-06 23:27:24 +010011750 Define a response pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011751 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11752 no | no | yes | yes
11753
11754 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020011755 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011756 describes what elements of the response or connection will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011757 be analyzed, extracted and stored in the table once a
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011758 server is selected.
11759
11760 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
11761 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
11762 the "stick-table" statement.
11763
11764 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
11765 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
11766 For instance, it could be used to store the SSL session ID only
11767 when the response is a SSL server hello.
11768
11769 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
11770 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-response"
11771 statement describes a rule to decide what to extract from the response and
11772 when to do it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further
11773 requests to match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the
11774 extracted part must make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011775 request. Storing an ID found in a header of a response makes sense.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011776 See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and transformation
11777 rules.
11778
11779 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
11780 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
11781 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
11782 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
11783 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
11784 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
11785 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
11786
11787 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-response"
11788 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
11789 condition will be evaluated while parsing the response, so any criteria can
11790 be used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
11791
11792 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-response" statements, but
11793 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
11794 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
11795 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
11796 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
11797 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +010011798 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-response rules with
11799 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
11800 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
11801 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
11802 response rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
11803 not be evaluated. However, even if a store-request rule references a table, a
11804 store-response rule may also use the same table. This means that each table
11805 may learn exactly one element from the request and one element from the
11806 response at once.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011807
11808 The table will contain the real server that processed the request.
11809
11810 Example :
11811 # Learn SSL session ID from both request and response and create affinity.
11812 backend https
11813 mode tcp
11814 balance roundrobin
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020011815 # maximum SSL session ID length is 32 bytes.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011816 stick-table type binary len 32 size 30k expire 30m
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011817
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010011818 acl clienthello req.ssl_hello_type 1
11819 acl serverhello rep.ssl_hello_type 2
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011820
11821 # use tcp content accepts to detects ssl client and server hello.
11822 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
11823 tcp-request content accept if clienthello
11824
11825 # no timeout on response inspect delay by default.
11826 tcp-response content accept if serverhello
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011827
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011828 # SSL session ID (SSLID) may be present on a client or server hello.
11829 # Its length is coded on 1 byte at offset 43 and its value starts
11830 # at offset 44.
11831
11832 # Match and learn on request if client hello.
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010011833 stick on req.payload_lv(43,1) if clienthello
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011834
11835 # Learn on response if server hello.
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010011836 stick store-response resp.payload_lv(43,1) if serverhello
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020011837
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011838 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
11839 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
11840
11841 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", and section 7 about ACLs and pattern
11842 extraction.
11843
11844
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011845tcp-check comment <string>
11846 Defines a comment for the following the tcp-check rule, reported in logs if
11847 it fails.
11848 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11849 yes | no | yes | yes
11850
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011851 Arguments :
11852 <string> is the comment message to add in logs if the following tcp-check
11853 rule fails.
11854
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011855 It only works for connect, send and expect rules. It is useful to make
11856 user-friendly error reporting.
11857
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011858 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check send" and
11859 "tcp-check expect".
11860
11861
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011862tcp-check connect [default] [port <expr>] [addr <ip>] [send-proxy] [via-socks4]
11863 [ssl] [sni <sni>] [alpn <alpn>] [linger]
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020011864 [proto <name>] [comment <msg>]
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011865 Opens a new connection
11866 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020011867 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011868
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011869 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011870 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
11871
Christopher Faulet4dce5922020-03-30 13:54:42 +020011872 default Use default options of the server line to do the health
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040011873 checks. The server options are used only if not redefined.
Christopher Faulet4dce5922020-03-30 13:54:42 +020011874
Christopher Fauletb7d30092020-03-30 15:19:03 +020011875 port <expr> if not set, check port or server port is used.
Christopher Faulet5c288742020-03-31 08:15:58 +020011876 It tells HAProxy where to open the connection to.
11877 <port> must be a valid TCP port source integer, from 1 to
Christopher Fauletb7d30092020-03-30 15:19:03 +020011878 65535 or an sample-fetch expression.
Christopher Faulet5c288742020-03-31 08:15:58 +020011879
11880 addr <ip> defines the IP address to do the health check.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011881
11882 send-proxy send a PROXY protocol string
11883
Christopher Faulet085426a2020-03-30 13:07:02 +020011884 via-socks4 enables outgoing health checks using upstream socks4 proxy.
11885
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011886 ssl opens a ciphered connection
11887
Christopher Faulet79b31d42020-03-30 13:00:05 +020011888 sni <sni> specifies the SNI to use to do health checks over SSL.
11889
Christopher Faulet98572322020-03-30 13:16:44 +020011890 alpn <alpn> defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol
11891 list consists in a comma-delimited list of protocol names,
11892 for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
11893 If it is not set, the server ALPN is used.
11894
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020011895 proto <name> forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for this connection.
11896 It must be a TCP mux protocol and it must be usable on the
11897 backend side. The list of available protocols is reported in
11898 haproxy -vv.
11899
Christopher Faulet5c288742020-03-31 08:15:58 +020011900 linger cleanly close the connection instead of using a single RST.
Gaetan Rivetf8ba6772020-02-07 15:37:17 +010011901
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011902 When an application lies on more than a single TCP port or when HAProxy
11903 load-balance many services in a single backend, it makes sense to probe all
11904 the services individually before considering a server as operational.
11905
11906 When there are no TCP port configured on the server line neither server port
11907 directive, then the 'tcp-check connect port <port>' must be the first step
11908 of the sequence.
11909
11910 In a tcp-check ruleset a 'connect' is required, it is also mandatory to start
11911 the ruleset with a 'connect' rule. Purpose is to ensure admin know what they
11912 do.
11913
11914 When a connect must start the ruleset, if may still be preceded by set-var,
11915 unset-var or comment rules.
11916
11917 Examples :
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011918 # check HTTP and HTTPs services on a server.
11919 # first open port 80 thanks to server line port directive, then
11920 # tcp-check opens port 443, ciphered and run a request on it:
11921 option tcp-check
11922 tcp-check connect
11923 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
11924 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
11925 tcp-check send \r\n
11926 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
11927 tcp-check connect port 443 ssl
11928 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
11929 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
11930 tcp-check send \r\n
11931 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
11932 server www 10.0.0.1 check port 80
11933
11934 # check both POP and IMAP from a single server:
11935 option tcp-check
Gaetan Rivetf8ba6772020-02-07 15:37:17 +010011936 tcp-check connect port 110 linger
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011937 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
11938 tcp-check connect port 143
11939 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
11940 server mail 10.0.0.1 check
11941
11942 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check send", "tcp-check expect"
11943
11944
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011945tcp-check expect [min-recv <int>] [comment <msg>]
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020011946 [ok-status <st>] [error-status <st>] [tout-status <st>]
Christopher Faulet98cc57c2020-04-01 20:52:31 +020011947 [on-success <fmt>] [on-error <fmt>] [status-code <expr>]
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020011948 [!] <match> <pattern>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011949 Specify data to be collected and analyzed during a generic health check
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011950 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020011951 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011952
11953 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011954 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
11955
Gaetan Rivet1afd8262020-02-07 15:37:17 +010011956 min-recv is optional and can define the minimum amount of data required to
11957 evaluate the current expect rule. If the number of received bytes
11958 is under this limit, the check will wait for more data. This
11959 option can be used to resolve some ambiguous matching rules or to
11960 avoid executing costly regex matches on content known to be still
11961 incomplete. If an exact string (string or binary) is used, the
11962 minimum between the string length and this parameter is used.
11963 This parameter is ignored if it is set to -1. If the expect rule
11964 does not match, the check will wait for more data. If set to 0,
11965 the evaluation result is always conclusive.
11966
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011967 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
Gaetan Rivetefab6c62020-02-07 15:37:17 +010011968 response. The keyword may be one of "string", "rstring", "binary" or
11969 "rbinary".
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011970 The keyword may be preceded by an exclamation mark ("!") to negate
11971 the match. Spaces are allowed between the exclamation mark and the
11972 keyword. See below for more details on the supported keywords.
11973
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020011974 ok-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
11975 the expect rule is successfully evaluated and if it is
11976 the last rule in the tcp-check ruleset. "L7OK", "L7OKC",
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +020011977 "L6OK" and "L4OK" are supported :
11978 - L7OK : check passed on layer 7
Christopher Faulet83662b52020-11-20 17:47:47 +010011979 - L7OKC : check conditionally passed on layer 7, set
11980 server to NOLB state.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +020011981 - L6OK : check passed on layer 6
11982 - L4OK : check passed on layer 4
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020011983 By default "L7OK" is used.
11984
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020011985 error-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
11986 an error occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Faulet83662b52020-11-20 17:47:47 +010011987 "L7OKC", "L7RSP", "L7STS", "L6RSP" and "L4CON" are
11988 supported :
11989 - L7OKC : check conditionally passed on layer 7, set
11990 server to NOLB state.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +020011991 - L7RSP : layer 7 invalid response - protocol error
11992 - L7STS : layer 7 response error, for example HTTP 5xx
11993 - L6RSP : layer 6 invalid response - protocol error
11994 - L4CON : layer 1-4 connection problem
11995 By default "L7RSP" is used.
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020011996
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020011997 tout-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020011998 a timeout occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +020011999 "L7TOUT", "L6TOUT", and "L4TOUT" are supported :
12000 - L7TOUT : layer 7 (HTTP/SMTP) timeout
12001 - L6TOUT : layer 6 (SSL) timeout
12002 - L4TOUT : layer 1-4 timeout
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020012003 By default "L7TOUT" is used.
12004
Christopher Fauletbe52b4d2020-04-01 16:30:22 +020012005 on-success <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
12006 informational message reported in logs if the expect
12007 rule is successfully evaluated and if it is the last rule
12008 in the tcp-check ruleset. <fmt> is a log-format string.
12009
12010 on-error <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
12011 informational message reported in logs if an error
12012 occurred during the expect rule evaluation. <fmt> is a
12013 log-format string.
12014
Christopher Faulet98cc57c2020-04-01 20:52:31 +020012015 status-code <expr> is optional and can be used to set the check status code
12016 reported in logs, on success or on error. <expr> is a
12017 standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
12018 followed by some converters.
12019
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020012020 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
12021 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
12022 with the usual backslash ('\').
12023 If the match is set to binary, then the pattern must be passed as
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012024 a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number. Each sequence of
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020012025 two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal digits may be
12026 used upper or lower case.
12027
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020012028 The available matches are intentionally similar to their http-check cousins :
12029
12030 string <string> : test the exact string matches in the response buffer.
12031 A health check response will be considered valid if the
12032 response's buffer contains this exact string. If the
12033 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
12034 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
12035 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory pattern
12036 in a protocol response, or to detect a failure when a
12037 specific error appears in a protocol banner.
12038
12039 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer.
12040 A health check response will be considered valid if the
12041 response's buffer matches this expression. If the
12042 "rstring" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
12043 will be considered invalid if the body matches the
12044 expression.
12045
Christopher Fauletaaab0832020-05-05 15:54:22 +020012046 string-lf <fmt> : test a log-format string match in the response's buffer.
12047 A health check response will be considered valid if the
12048 response's buffer contains the string resulting of the
12049 evaluation of <fmt>, which follows the log-format rules.
12050 If prefixed with "!", then the response will be
12051 considered invalid if the buffer contains the string.
12052
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020012053 binary <hexstring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches
12054 in the response buffer. A health check response will
12055 be considered valid if the response's buffer contains
12056 this exact hexadecimal string.
12057 Purpose is to match data on binary protocols.
12058
Gaetan Rivetefab6c62020-02-07 15:37:17 +010012059 rbinary <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer, like
12060 "rstring". However, the response buffer is transformed
12061 into its hexadecimal form, including NUL-bytes. This
12062 allows using all regex engines to match any binary
12063 content. The hexadecimal transformation takes twice the
12064 size of the original response. As such, the expected
12065 pattern should work on at-most half the response buffer
12066 size.
12067
Christopher Fauletaaab0832020-05-05 15:54:22 +020012068 binary-lf <hexfmt> : test a log-format string in its hexadecimal form
12069 match in the response's buffer. A health check response
12070 will be considered valid if the response's buffer
12071 contains the hexadecimal string resulting of the
12072 evaluation of <fmt>, which follows the log-format
12073 rules. If prefixed with "!", then the response will be
12074 considered invalid if the buffer contains the
12075 hexadecimal string. The hexadecimal string is converted
12076 in a binary string before matching the response's
12077 buffer.
12078
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020012079 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +010012080 defined by the global "tune.bufsize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020012081 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
12082 "string", "rstring" or binary. If a large response is absolutely required, it
12083 is possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
12084 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
12085 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
12086 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources. Also, in its
12087 current state, the check will not find any string nor regex past a null
12088 character in the response. Similarly it is not possible to request matching
12089 the null character.
12090
12091 Examples :
12092 # perform a POP check
12093 option tcp-check
12094 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
12095
12096 # perform an IMAP check
12097 option tcp-check
12098 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
12099
12100 # look for the redis master server
12101 option tcp-check
12102 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +020012103 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020012104 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
12105 tcp-check expect string role:master
12106 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
12107 tcp-check expect string +OK
12108
12109
12110 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check send",
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +010012111 "tcp-check send-binary", "http-check expect", tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020012112
12113
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020012114tcp-check send <data> [comment <msg>]
12115tcp-check send-lf <fmt> [comment <msg>]
12116 Specify a string or a log-format string to be sent as a question during a
12117 generic health check
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020012118 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020012119 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020012120
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020012121 Arguments :
12122 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
12123
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020012124 <data> is the string that will be sent during a generic health
12125 check session.
Christopher Faulet16fff672020-04-30 07:50:54 +020012126
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020012127 <fmt> is the log-format string that will be sent, once evaluated,
12128 during a generic health check session.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020012129
12130 Examples :
12131 # look for the redis master server
12132 option tcp-check
12133 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
12134 tcp-check expect string role:master
12135
12136 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +010012137 "tcp-check send-binary", tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020012138
12139
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020012140tcp-check send-binary <hexstring> [comment <msg>]
12141tcp-check send-binary-lf <hexfmt> [comment <msg>]
12142 Specify an hex digits string or an hex digits log-format string to be sent as
12143 a binary question during a raw tcp health check
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020012144 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020012145 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020012146
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020012147 Arguments :
12148 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020012149
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020012150 <hexstring> is the hexadecimal string that will be send, once converted
12151 to binary, during a generic health check session.
Christopher Faulet16fff672020-04-30 07:50:54 +020012152
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020012153 <hexfmt> is the hexadecimal log-format string that will be send, once
12154 evaluated and converted to binary, during a generic health
12155 check session.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020012156
12157 Examples :
12158 # redis check in binary
12159 option tcp-check
12160 tcp-check send-binary 50494e470d0a # PING\r\n
12161 tcp-check expect binary 2b504F4e47 # +PONG
12162
12163
12164 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +010012165 "tcp-check send", tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020012166
12167
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +010012168tcp-check set-var(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <expr>
12169tcp-check set-var-fmt(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <fmt>
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010012170 This operation sets the content of a variable. The variable is declared inline.
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010012171 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020012172 yes | no | yes | yes
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010012173
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020012174 Arguments :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010012175 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
12176 scope. The scopes allowed for tcp-check are:
12177 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
12178 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
12179 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
12180 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
12181 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
12182 and '-'.
12183
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +010012184 <cond> A set of conditions that must all be true for the variable to
12185 actually be set (such as "ifnotempty", "ifgt" ...). See the
Ilya Shipitsin5e87bcf2021-12-25 11:45:52 +050012186 set-var converter's description for a full list of possible
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +010012187 conditions.
12188
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010012189 <expr> Is a sample-fetch expression potentially followed by converters.
12190
Willy Tarreau9a621ae2021-09-02 21:00:38 +020012191 <fmt> This is the value expressed using log-format rules (see Custom
12192 Log Format in section 8.2.4).
12193
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020012194 Examples :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010012195 tcp-check set-var(check.port) int(1234)
Willy Tarreau9a621ae2021-09-02 21:00:38 +020012196 tcp-check set-var-fmt(check.name) "%H"
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010012197
12198
12199tcp-check unset-var(<var-name>)
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010012200 Free a reference to a variable within its scope.
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010012201 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020012202 yes | no | yes | yes
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010012203
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020012204 Arguments :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010012205 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
12206 scope. The scopes allowed for tcp-check are:
12207 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
12208 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
12209 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
12210 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
12211 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
12212 and '-'.
12213
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020012214 Examples :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010012215 tcp-check unset-var(check.port)
12216
12217
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012218tcp-request connection <action> <options...> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012219 Perform an action on an incoming connection depending on a layer 4 condition
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +020012220 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +020012221 yes(!) | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012222 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020012223 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
12224 below.
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +020012225
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012226 <condition> is a standard layer4-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012227
12228 Immediately after acceptance of a new incoming connection, it is possible to
12229 evaluate some conditions to decide whether this connection must be accepted
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012230 or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions cannot make use of
12231 any data contents because the connection has not been read from yet, and the
12232 buffers are not yet allocated. This is used to selectively and very quickly
12233 accept or drop connections from various sources with a very low overhead. If
12234 some contents need to be inspected in order to take the decision, the
12235 "tcp-request content" statements must be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012236
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012237 The "tcp-request connection" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
12238 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
12239 accept the incoming connection. There is no specific limit to the number of
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012240 rules which may be inserted. Any rule may optionally be followed by an
12241 ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated if the condition
12242 is true.
12243
12244 The first keyword is the rule's action. Several types of actions are
12245 supported:
12246 - accept
12247 - expect-netscaler-cip layer4
12248 - expect-proxy layer4
12249 - reject
12250 - sc-inc-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>)
12251 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
12252 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
12253 - sc-set-gpt(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
12254 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
12255 - set-dst <expr>
12256 - set-dst-port <expr>
12257 - set-mark <mark>
12258 - set-src <expr>
12259 - set-src-port <expr>
12260 - set-tos <tos>
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +010012261 - set-var(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <expr>
12262 - set-var-fmt(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <fmt>
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012263 - silent-drop
12264 - track-sc0 <key> [table <table>]
12265 - track-sc1 <key> [table <table>]
12266 - track-sc2 <key> [table <table>]
Jaroslaw Rzeszótkoc8637032021-11-02 16:56:05 +010012267 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012268
12269 The supported actions are described below.
12270
12271 There is no limit to the number of "tcp-request connection" statements per
12272 instance.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012273
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +020012274 This directive is only available from named defaults sections, not anonymous
12275 ones. Rules defined in the defaults section are evaluated before ones in the
12276 associated proxy section. To avoid ambiguities, in this case the same
12277 defaults section cannot be used by proxies with the frontend capability and
12278 by proxies with the backend capability. It means a listen section cannot use
12279 a defaults section defining such rules.
12280
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012281 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
12282 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
12283 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020012284
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012285 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
12286 connection without counting them, and track accepted connections.
12287 This results in connection rate being capped from abusive sources.
Christopher Faulet469c06c2021-06-25 15:11:35 +020012288
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012289 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
12290 tcp-request connection reject if { src_conn_rate gt 10 }
12291 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020012292
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012293 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, count all other
12294 connections and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
12295 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020012296
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012297 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
12298 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
12299 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_conn_rate gt 10 }
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020012300
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012301 Example: enable the PROXY protocol for traffic coming from all known proxies.
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020012302
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012303 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020012304
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012305 See section 7 about ACL usage.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020012306
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012307 See also : "tcp-request session", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020012308
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012309tcp-request connection accept [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020012310
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012311 This is used to accept the connection. No further "tcp-request connection"
12312 rules are evaluated.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020012313
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012314tcp-request connection expect-netscaler-cip layer4
12315 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020012316
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012317 This configures the client-facing connection to receive a NetScaler Client IP
12318 insertion protocol header before any byte is read from the socket. This is
12319 equivalent to having the "accept-netscaler-cip" keyword on the "bind" line,
12320 except that using the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol to be accepted only
12321 for certain IP address ranges using an ACL. This is convenient when multiple
12322 layers of load balancers are passed through by traffic coming from public
12323 hosts.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020012324
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012325tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020012326
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012327 This configures the client-facing connection to receive a PROXY protocol
12328 header before any byte is read from the socket. This is equivalent to having
12329 the "accept-proxy" keyword on the "bind" line, except that using the TCP rule
12330 allows the PROXY protocol to be accepted only for certain IP address ranges
12331 using an ACL. This is convenient when multiple layers of load balancers are
12332 passed through by traffic coming from public hosts.
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020012333
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012334tcp-request connection reject [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020012335
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012336 This is used to reject the connection. No further "tcp-request connection"
12337 rules are evaluated. Rejected connections do not even become a session, which
12338 is why they are accounted separately for in the stats, as "denied
12339 connections". They are not considered for the session rate-limit and are not
12340 logged either. The reason is that these rules should only be used to filter
12341 extremely high connection rates such as the ones encountered during a massive
12342 DDoS attack. Under these extreme conditions, the simple action of logging
12343 each event would make the system collapse and would considerably lower the
12344 filtering capacity. If logging is absolutely desired, then "tcp-request
12345 content" rules should be used instead, as "tcp-request session" rules will
12346 not log either.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020012347
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012348tcp-request connection sc-inc-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12349tcp-request connection sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12350tcp-request connection sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020012351
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012352 These actions increment the General Purppose Counters according to the sticky
12353 counter designated by <sc-id>. Please refer to "http-request sc-inc-gpc",
12354 "http-request sc-inc-gpc0" and "http-request sc-inc-gpc1" for a complete
12355 description.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020012356
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012357tcp-request connection sc-set-gpt(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
12358 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12359tcp-request connection sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
12360 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020012361
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012362 These actions set the 32-bit unsigned General Purpose Tags according to the
12363 sticky counter designated by <sc-id>. Please refer to "http-request
12364 sc-inc-gpt" and "http-request sc-inc-gpt0" for a complete description.
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020012365
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012366tcp-request connection set-dst <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12367tcp-request connection set-dst-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet469c06c2021-06-25 15:11:35 +020012368
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012369 These actions are used to set the destination IP/Port address to the value of
12370 specified expression. Please refer to "http-request set-dst" and
12371 "http-request set-dst-port" for a complete description.
Christopher Faulet469c06c2021-06-25 15:11:35 +020012372
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012373tcp-request connection set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020012374
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012375 This action is used to set the Netfilter/IPFW MARK in all packets sent to the
12376 client to the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. Please
12377 refer to "http-request set-mark" for a complete description.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012378
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012379tcp-request connection set-src <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12380tcp-request connection set-src-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012381
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012382 These actions are used to set the source IP/Port address to the value of
12383 specified expression. Please refer to "http-request set-src" and
12384 "http-request set-src-port" for a complete description.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012385
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012386tcp-request connection set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012387
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012388 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
12389 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this. Please refer to
12390 "http-request set-tos" for a complete description.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012391
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +010012392tcp-request connection set-var(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12393tcp-request connection set-var-fmt(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Jaroslaw Rzeszótkoc8637032021-11-02 16:56:05 +010012394
12395 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
12396 inline. "tcp-request connection" can set variables in the "proc" and "sess"
12397 scopes. Please refer to "http-request set-var" and "http-request set-var-fmt"
12398 for a complete description.
12399
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012400tcp-request connection silent-drop [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020012401
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012402 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
12403 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
12404 client from being notified. Please refer to "http-request silent-drop" for a
12405 complete description.
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020012406
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012407tcp-request connection track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12408tcp-request connection track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12409tcp-request connection track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012410
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012411 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. Please
12412 refer to "http-request track-sc0", "http-request track-sc1" and "http-request
12413 track-sc2" for a complete description.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012414
Jaroslaw Rzeszótkoc8637032021-11-02 16:56:05 +010012415tcp-request connection unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12416
12417 This is used to unset a variable. Please refer to "http-request set-var" for
12418 details about variables.
12419
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012420
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012421tcp-request content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
12422 Perform an action on a new session depending on a layer 4-7 condition
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012423 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +020012424 yes(!) | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012425 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020012426 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
12427 below.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012428
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012429 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012430
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012431 A request's contents can be analyzed at an early stage of request processing
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012432 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
12433 evaluated every time the request contents are updated, until either an
Christopher Fauletae863c62021-03-15 12:03:44 +010012434 "accept", a "reject" or a "switch-mode" rule matches, or the TCP request
12435 inspection delay expires with no matching rule.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012436
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012437 The first difference between these rules and "tcp-request connection" rules
12438 is that "tcp-request content" rules can make use of contents to take a
12439 decision. Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or
12440 validity. The second difference is that content-based rules can be used in
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010012441 both frontends and backends. In case of HTTP keep-alive with the client, all
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040012442 tcp-request content rules are evaluated again, so HAProxy keeps a record of
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010012443 what sticky counters were assigned by a "tcp-request connection" versus a
12444 "tcp-request content" rule, and flushes all the content-related ones after
12445 processing an HTTP request, so that they may be evaluated again by the rules
12446 being evaluated again for the next request. This is of particular importance
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012447 when the rule tracks some L7 information or when it is conditioned by an
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010012448 L7-based ACL, since tracking may change between requests.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012449
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012450 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
12451 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
12452 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
12453 inserted.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012454
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012455 The first keyword is the rule's action. Several types of actions are
12456 supported:
12457 - accept
12458 - capture <sample> len <length>
12459 - do-resolve(<var>,<resolvers>,[ipv4,ipv6]) <expr>
12460 - reject
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020012461 - sc-inc-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>)
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020012462 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010012463 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
Emeric Brun877b0b52021-06-30 18:57:49 +020012464 - sc-set-gpt(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010012465 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012466 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
Baptiste Assmanne1afd4f2019-04-18 16:21:13 +020012467 - set-dst <expr>
12468 - set-dst-port <expr>
Christopher Faulet551a6412021-06-25 14:35:29 +020012469 - set-log-level <level>
Christopher Faulet469c06c2021-06-25 15:11:35 +020012470 - set-mark <mark>
Christopher Faulet1da374a2021-06-25 14:46:02 +020012471 - set-nice <nice>
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012472 - set-priority-class <expr>
12473 - set-priority-offset <expr>
Christopher Faulet1e83b702021-06-23 12:07:21 +020012474 - set-src <expr>
12475 - set-src-port <expr>
Christopher Faulet469c06c2021-06-25 15:11:35 +020012476 - set-tos <tos>
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +010012477 - set-var(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <expr>
12478 - set-var-fmt(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <fmt>
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012479 - silent-drop
Christopher Fauletae863c62021-03-15 12:03:44 +010012480 - switch-mode http [ proto <name> ]
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012481 - track-sc0 <key> [table <table>]
12482 - track-sc1 <key> [table <table>]
12483 - track-sc2 <key> [table <table>]
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010012484 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +010012485 - use-service <service-name>
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012486
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012487 The supported actions are described below.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012488
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010012489 While there is nothing mandatory about it, it is recommended to use the
12490 track-sc0 in "tcp-request connection" rules, track-sc1 for "tcp-request
12491 content" rules in the frontend, and track-sc2 for "tcp-request content"
12492 rules in the backend, because that makes the configuration more readable
12493 and easier to troubleshoot, but this is just a guideline and all counters
12494 may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012495
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012496 This directive is only available from named defaults sections, not anonymous
12497 ones. Rules defined in the defaults section are evaluated before ones in the
12498 associated proxy section. To avoid ambiguities, in this case the same
12499 defaults section cannot be used by proxies with the frontend capability and
12500 by proxies with the backend capability. It means a listen section cannot use
12501 a defaults section defining such rules.
12502
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012503 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012504 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
12505 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012506
Christopher Faulet2079a4a2020-10-02 11:48:57 +020012507 Note also that it is recommended to use a "tcp-request session" rule to track
12508 information that does *not* depend on Layer 7 contents, especially for HTTP
12509 frontends. Some HTTP processing are performed at the session level and may
12510 lead to an early rejection of the requests. Thus, the tracking at the content
12511 level may be disturbed in such case. A warning is emitted during startup to
12512 prevent, as far as possible, such unreliable usage.
12513
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012514 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-request content"
Christopher Faulet7ea509e2020-10-02 11:38:46 +020012515 rules from a TCP proxy, since HTTP-specific ACL matches are able to
12516 preliminarily parse the contents of a buffer before extracting the required
12517 data. If the buffered contents do not parse as a valid HTTP message, then the
12518 ACL does not match. The parser which is involved there is exactly the same
12519 as for all other HTTP processing, so there is no risk of parsing something
12520 differently. In an HTTP frontend or an HTTP backend, it is guaranteed that
12521 HTTP contents will always be immediately present when the rule is evaluated
12522 first because the HTTP parsing is performed in the early stages of the
12523 connection processing, at the session level. But for such proxies, using
12524 "http-request" rules is much more natural and recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012525
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010012526 Tracking layer7 information is also possible provided that the information
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020012527 are present when the rule is processed. The rule processing engine is able to
12528 wait until the inspect delay expires when the data to be tracked is not yet
12529 available.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010012530
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +010012531 Example:
12532 tcp-request content use-service lua.deny { src -f /etc/haproxy/blacklist.lst }
12533
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012534 Example:
12535
12536 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
Willy Tarreau9a621ae2021-09-02 21:00:38 +020012537 tcp-request content set-var-fmt(sess.from) %[src]:%[src_port]
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010012538 tcp-request content unset-var(sess.my_var2)
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012539
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012540 Example:
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012541 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
Christopher Fauletae863c62021-03-15 12:03:44 +010012542 # and reject everything else. (Only works for HTTP/1 connections)
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012543 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
12544 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +020012545 tcp-request content accept if is_host_com
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012546 tcp-request content reject
12547
Christopher Fauletae863c62021-03-15 12:03:44 +010012548 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
12549 # and reject everything else. (works for HTTP/1 and HTTP/2 connections)
12550 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
12551 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
12552 tcp-request switch-mode http if HTTP
12553 tcp-request reject # non-HTTP traffic is implicit here
12554 ...
12555 http-request reject unless is_host_com
12556
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012557 Example:
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012558 # reject SMTP connection if client speaks first
12559 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010012560 acl content_present req.len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012561 tcp-request content reject if content_present
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012562
12563 # Forward HTTPS connection only if client speaks
12564 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010012565 acl content_present req.len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012566 tcp-request content accept if content_present
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012567 tcp-request content reject
12568
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010012569 Example:
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030012570 # Track the last IP(stick-table type string) from X-Forwarded-For
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010012571 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020012572 tcp-request content track-sc0 hdr(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030012573 # Or track the last IP(stick-table type ip|ipv6) from X-Forwarded-For
12574 tcp-request content track-sc0 req.hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010012575
12576 Example:
12577 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
12578 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020012579 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010012580
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012581 Example: track per-frontend and per-backend counters, block abusers at the
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030012582 frontend when the backend detects abuse(and marks gpc0).
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012583
12584 frontend http
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012585 # Use General Purpose Counter 0 in SC0 as a global abuse counter
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012586 # protecting all our sites
12587 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012588 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
12589 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_get_gpc0 gt 0 }
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012590 ...
12591 use_backend http_dynamic if { path_end .php }
12592
12593 backend http_dynamic
12594 # if a source makes too fast requests to this dynamic site (tracked
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012595 # by SC1), block it globally in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012596 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store http_req_rate(10s)
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012597 acl click_too_fast sc1_http_req_rate gt 10
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030012598 acl mark_as_abuser sc0_inc_gpc0(http) gt 0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012599 tcp-request content track-sc1 src
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012600 tcp-request content reject if click_too_fast mark_as_abuser
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012601
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012602 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012603
Jarno Huuskonen95b012b2017-04-06 13:59:14 +030012604 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request session",
12605 "tcp-request inspect-delay", and "http-request".
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012606
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012607tcp-request content accept [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12608
12609 This is used to accept the connection. No further "tcp-request content"
Christopher Faulet27025602021-11-09 17:58:12 +010012610 rules are evaluated for the current section.
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012611
12612tcp-request content capture <sample> len <length>
12613 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12614
12615 This captures sample expression <sample> from the request buffer, and
12616 converts it to a string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is
12617 stored into the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next
12618 to some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs,
12619 and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it
12620 into headers or anything. The length should be limited given that this size
12621 will be allocated for each capture during the whole session life. Please
12622 check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture request header" for more
12623 information.
12624
12625tcp-request content do-resolve(<var>,<resolvers>,[ipv4,ipv6]) <expr>
12626
12627 This action performs a DNS resolution of the output of <expr> and stores the
12628 result in the variable <var>. Please refer to "http-request do-resolve" for a
12629 complete description.
12630
12631tcp-request content reject [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12632
12633 This is used to reject the connection. No further "tcp-request content" rules
12634 are evaluated.
12635
12636tcp-request content sc-inc-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12637tcp-request content sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12638tcp-request content sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12639
12640 These actions increment the General Purppose Counters according to the sticky
12641 counter designated by <sc-id>. Please refer to "http-request sc-inc-gpc",
12642 "http-request sc-inc-gpc0" and "http-request sc-inc-gpc1" for a complete
12643 description.
12644
12645tcp-request content sc-set-gpt(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
12646 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12647tcp-request content sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
12648 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12649
12650 These actions set the 32-bit unsigned General Purpose Tags according to the
12651 sticky counter designated by <sc-id>. Please refer to "http-request
12652 sc-inc-gpt" and "http-request sc-inc-gpt0" for a complete description.
12653
12654tcp-request content send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
12655 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12656
12657 Thaction is is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. Please
12658 refer to "http-request send-spoe-group" for a complete description.
12659
12660tcp-request content set-dst <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12661tcp-request content set-dst-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12662
12663 These actions are used to set the destination IP/Port address to the value of
12664 specified expression. Please refer to "http-request set-dst" and
12665 "http-request set-dst-port" for a complete description.
12666
12667tcp-request content set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12668
12669 This action is used to set the log level of the current session. Please refer
12670 to "http-request set-log-level". for a complete description.
12671
12672tcp-request content set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12673
12674 This action is used to set the Netfilter/IPFW MARK in all packets sent to the
12675 client to the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. Please
12676 refer to "http-request set-mark" for a complete description.
12677
12678tcp-request content set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12679
12680 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed. Please
12681 refer to "http-request set-nice" for a complete description.
12682
12683tcp-request content set-priority-class <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12684
12685 This is used to set the queue priority class of the current request. Please
12686 refer to "http-request set-priority-class" for a complete description.
12687
12688tcp-request content set-priority-offset <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12689
12690 This is used to set the queue priority timestamp offset of the current
12691 request. Please refer to "http-request set-priority-offset" for a complete
12692 description.
12693
Christopher Faulet1e83b702021-06-23 12:07:21 +020012694tcp-request content set-src <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12695tcp-request content set-src-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12696
12697 These actions are used to set the source IP/Port address to the value of
12698 specified expression. Please refer to "http-request set-src" and
12699 "http-request set-src-port" for a complete description.
12700
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012701tcp-request content set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12702
12703 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
12704 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this. Please refer to
12705 "http-request set-tos" for a complete description.
12706
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +010012707tcp-request content set-var(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12708tcp-request content set-var-fmt(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012709
12710 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
12711 inline. Please refer to "http-request set-var" and "http-request set-var-fmt"
12712 for a complete description.
12713
12714tcp-request content silent-drop [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12715
12716 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
12717 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
12718 client from being notified. Please refer to "http-request silent-drop" for a
12719 complete description.
12720
12721tcp-request content switch-mode http [ proto <name> ]
12722 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12723
12724 This action is used to perform a connection upgrade. Only HTTP upgrades are
12725 supported for now. The protocol may optionally be specified. This action is
12726 only available for a proxy with the frontend capability. The connection
12727 upgrade is immediately performed, following "tcp-request content" rules are
12728 not evaluated. This upgrade method should be preferred to the implicit one
12729 consisting to rely on the backend mode. When used, it is possible to set HTTP
12730 directives in a frontend without any warning. These directives will be
12731 conditionally evaluated if the HTTP upgrade is performed. However, an HTTP
12732 backend must still be selected. It remains unsupported to route an HTTP
12733 connection (upgraded or not) to a TCP server.
12734
12735 See section 4 about Proxies for more details on HTTP upgrades.
12736
12737tcp-request content track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12738tcp-request content track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12739tcp-request content track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12740
12741 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. Please
12742 refer to "http-request track-sc0", "http-request track-sc1" and "http-request
12743 track-sc2" for a complete description.
12744
12745tcp-request content unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12746
12747 This is used to unset a variable. Please refer to "http-request set-var" for
12748 details about variables.
12749
Aleksandar Lazic332258a2022-03-30 00:11:40 +020012750tcp-request content use-service <service-name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012751
12752 This action is used to executes a TCP service which will reply to the request
12753 and stop the evaluation of the rules. This service may choose to reply by
12754 sending any valid response or it may immediately close the connection without
12755 sending anything. Outside natives services, it is possible to write your own
12756 services in Lua. No further "tcp-request content" rules are evaluated.
12757
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012758
12759tcp-request inspect-delay <timeout>
12760 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for data during content inspection
12761 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +020012762 yes(!) | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012763 Arguments :
12764 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12765 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12766 as explained at the top of this document.
12767
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040012768 People using HAProxy primarily as a TCP relay are often worried about the
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012769 risk of passing any type of protocol to a server without any analysis. In
12770 order to be able to analyze the request contents, we must first withhold
12771 the data then analyze them. This statement simply enables withholding of
12772 data for at most the specified amount of time.
12773
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +020012774 TCP content inspection applies very early when a connection reaches a
12775 frontend, then very early when the connection is forwarded to a backend. This
12776 means that a connection may experience a first delay in the frontend and a
12777 second delay in the backend if both have tcp-request rules.
12778
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040012779 Note that when performing content inspection, HAProxy will evaluate the whole
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012780 rules for every new chunk which gets in, taking into account the fact that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012781 those data are partial. If no rule matches before the aforementioned delay,
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012782 a last check is performed upon expiration, this time considering that the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040012783 contents are definitive. If no delay is set, HAProxy will not wait at all
Willy Tarreaud869b242009-03-15 14:43:58 +010012784 and will immediately apply a verdict based on the available information.
12785 Obviously this is unlikely to be very useful and might even be racy, so such
12786 setups are not recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012787
12788 As soon as a rule matches, the request is released and continues as usual. If
12789 the timeout is reached and no rule matches, the default policy will be to let
12790 it pass through unaffected.
12791
12792 For most protocols, it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients
12793 send the full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to
12794 cover TCP retransmits but that's all. For some protocols, it may make sense
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012795 to use large values, for instance to ensure that the client never talks
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012796 before the server (e.g. SMTP), or to wait for a client to talk before passing
12797 data to the server (e.g. SSL). Note that the client timeout must cover at
Willy Tarreaub824b002010-09-29 16:36:16 +020012798 least the inspection delay, otherwise it will expire first. If the client
12799 closes the connection or if the buffer is full, the delay immediately expires
12800 since the contents will not be able to change anymore.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012801
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +020012802 This directive is only available from named defaults sections, not anonymous
12803 ones. Proxies inherit this value from their defaults section.
12804
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020012805 See also : "tcp-request content accept", "tcp-request content reject",
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012806 "timeout client".
12807
12808
Christopher Faulet2468c212021-10-13 22:00:39 +020012809tcp-request session <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
12810 Perform an action on a validated session depending on a layer 5 condition
12811 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +020012812 yes(!) | yes | yes | no
Christopher Faulet2468c212021-10-13 22:00:39 +020012813 Arguments :
12814 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
12815 below.
12816
12817 <condition> is a standard layer5-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
12818
12819 Once a session is validated, (i.e. after all handshakes have been completed),
12820 it is possible to evaluate some conditions to decide whether this session
12821 must be accepted or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions
12822 cannot make use of any data contents because no buffers are allocated yet and
Anubhave09efaa2021-10-14 22:28:25 +053012823 the processing cannot wait at this stage. The main use case is to copy some
Christopher Faulet2468c212021-10-13 22:00:39 +020012824 early information into variables (since variables are accessible in the
12825 session), or to keep track of some information collected after the handshake,
12826 such as SSL-level elements (SNI, ciphers, client cert's CN) or information
12827 from the PROXY protocol header (e.g. track a source forwarded this way). The
12828 extracted information can thus be copied to a variable or tracked using
12829 "track-sc" rules. Of course it is also possible to decide to accept/reject as
12830 with other rulesets. Most operations performed here could also be performed
12831 in "tcp-request content" rules, except that in HTTP these rules are evaluated
12832 for each new request, and that might not always be acceptable. For example a
12833 rule might increment a counter on each evaluation. It would also be possible
12834 that a country is resolved by geolocation from the source IP address,
12835 assigned to a session-wide variable, then the source address rewritten from
12836 an HTTP header for all requests. If some contents need to be inspected in
12837 order to take the decision, the "tcp-request content" statements must be used
12838 instead.
12839
12840 The "tcp-request session" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
12841 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
12842 accept the incoming session. There is no specific limit to the number of
12843 rules which may be inserted.
12844
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012845 The first keyword is the rule's action. Several types of actions are
12846 supported:
12847 - accept
12848 - reject
Christopher Faulet2468c212021-10-13 22:00:39 +020012849 - sc-inc-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>)
12850 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
12851 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
12852 - sc-set-gpt(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
12853 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Christopher Faulet2468c212021-10-13 22:00:39 +020012854 - set-dst <expr>
12855 - set-dst-port <expr>
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012856 - set-mark <mark>
Christopher Faulet2468c212021-10-13 22:00:39 +020012857 - set-src <expr>
12858 - set-src-port <expr>
12859 - set-tos <tos>
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +010012860 - set-var(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <expr>
12861 - set-var-fmt(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <fmt>
Christopher Faulet2468c212021-10-13 22:00:39 +020012862 - silent-drop
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012863 - track-sc0 <key> [table <table>]
12864 - track-sc1 <key> [table <table>]
12865 - track-sc2 <key> [table <table>]
12866 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Christopher Faulet2468c212021-10-13 22:00:39 +020012867
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012868 The supported actions are described below.
12869
12870 This directive is only available from named defaults sections, not anonymous
12871 ones. Rules defined in the defaults section are evaluated before ones in the
12872 associated proxy section. To avoid ambiguities, in this case the same
12873 defaults section cannot be used by proxies with the frontend capability and
12874 by proxies with the backend capability. It means a listen section cannot use
12875 a defaults section defining such rules.
Christopher Faulet2468c212021-10-13 22:00:39 +020012876
12877 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
12878 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
12879 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
12880
12881 Example: track the original source address by default, or the one advertised
12882 in the PROXY protocol header for connection coming from the local
12883 proxies. The first connection-level rule enables receipt of the
12884 PROXY protocol for these ones, the second rule tracks whatever
12885 address we decide to keep after optional decoding.
12886
12887 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
12888 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
12889
12890 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
12891 sessions without counting them, and track accepted sessions.
12892 This results in session rate being capped from abusive sources.
12893
12894 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
12895 tcp-request session reject if { src_sess_rate gt 10 }
12896 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
12897
12898 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, count all other
12899 sessions and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
12900 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
12901
12902 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
12903 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
12904 tcp-request session reject if { sc0_sess_rate gt 10 }
12905
12906 See section 7 about ACL usage.
12907
12908 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
12909
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012910tcp-request session accept [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12911
12912 This is used to accept the connection. No further "tcp-request session"
12913 rules are evaluated.
12914
12915tcp-request session reject [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12916
12917 This is used to reject the connection. No further "tcp-request session" rules
12918 are evaluated.
12919
12920tcp-request session sc-inc-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12921tcp-request session sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12922tcp-request session sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12923
12924 These actions increment the General Purppose Counters according to the sticky
12925 counter designated by <sc-id>. Please refer to "http-request sc-inc-gpc",
12926 "http-request sc-inc-gpc0" and "http-request sc-inc-gpc1" for a complete
12927 description.
12928
12929tcp-request session sc-set-gpt(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
12930 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12931tcp-request session sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
12932 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12933
12934 These actions set the 32-bit unsigned General Purpose Tags according to the
12935 sticky counter designated by <sc-id>. Please refer to "tcp-request connection
12936 sc-inc-gpt" and "tcp-request connection sc-inc-gpt0" for a complete
12937 description.
12938
12939tcp-request session set-dst <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12940tcp-request session set-dst-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12941
12942 These actions are used to set the destination IP/Port address to the value of
12943 specified expression. Please refer to "http-request set-dst" and
12944 "http-request set-dst-port" for a complete description.
12945
12946tcp-request session set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12947
12948 This action is used to set the Netfilter/IPFW MARK in all packets sent to the
12949 client to the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. Please
12950 refer to "http-request set-mark" for a complete description.
12951
12952tcp-request session set-src <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12953tcp-request session set-src-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12954
12955 These actions are used to set the source IP/Port address to the value of
12956 specified expression. Please refer to "http-request set-src" and
12957 "http-request set-src-port" for a complete description.
12958
12959tcp-request session set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12960
12961 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
12962 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this. Please refer to
12963 "http-request set-tos" for a complete description.
12964
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +010012965tcp-request session set-var(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12966tcp-request session set-var-fmt(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012967
12968 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
12969 inline. Please refer to "http-request set-var" and "http-request set-var-fmt"
12970 for a complete description.
12971
12972tcp-request session silent-drop [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12973
12974 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
12975 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
12976 client from being notified. Please refer to "http-request silent-drop" for a
12977 complete description.
12978
12979tcp-request session track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12980tcp-request session track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12981tcp-request session track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12982
12983 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. Please
12984 refer to "http-request track-sc0", "http-request track-sc1" and "http-request
12985 track-sc2" for a complete description.
12986
12987tcp-request session unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12988
12989 This is used to unset a variable. Please refer to "http-request set-var" for
12990 details about variables.
12991
Christopher Faulet2468c212021-10-13 22:00:39 +020012992
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012993tcp-response content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
12994 Perform an action on a session response depending on a layer 4-7 condition
12995 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +020012996 yes(!) | no | yes | yes
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012997 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020012998 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
12999 below.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020013000
13001 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
13002
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013003 Response contents can be analyzed at an early stage of response processing
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020013004 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
13005 evaluated every time the response contents are updated, until either an
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020013006 "accept", "close" or a "reject" rule matches, or a TCP response inspection
13007 delay is set and expires with no matching rule.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020013008
13009 Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or validity.
13010
13011 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
13012 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
13013 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
13014 inserted.
13015
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013016 The first keyword is the rule's action. Several types of actions are
13017 supported:
13018 - accept
13019 - close
13020 - reject
13021 - sc-inc-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>)
13022 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
13023 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
13024 - sc-set-gpt(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
13025 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
13026 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
13027 - set-log-level <level>
13028 - set-mark <mark>
13029 - set-nice <nice>
13030 - set-tos <tos>
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +010013031 - set-var(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <expr>
13032 - set-var-fmt(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <fmt>
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013033 - silent-drop
13034 - unset-var(<var-name>)
13035
13036 The supported actions are described below.
13037
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +020013038 This directive is only available from named defaults sections, not anonymous
13039 ones. Rules defined in the defaults section are evaluated before ones in the
13040 associated proxy section. To avoid ambiguities, in this case the same
13041 defaults section cannot be used by proxies with the frontend capability and
13042 by proxies with the backend capability. It means a listen section cannot use
13043 a defaults section defining such rules.
13044
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013045 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
13046 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
13047 for changing the default action to a reject.
13048
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020013049 Several types of actions are supported :
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020013050
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013051 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-response
13052 content" rules, but then it is important to ensure that a full response has
13053 been buffered, otherwise no contents will match. In order to achieve this,
13054 the best solution involves detecting the HTTP protocol during the inspection
13055 period.
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020013056
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013057 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020013058
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013059 See also : "tcp-request content", "tcp-response inspect-delay"
Christopher Faulet551a6412021-06-25 14:35:29 +020013060
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013061tcp-response content accept [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet469c06c2021-06-25 15:11:35 +020013062
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013063 This is used to accept the response. No further "tcp-response content" rules
13064 are evaluated.
Christopher Faulet1da374a2021-06-25 14:46:02 +020013065
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013066tcp-response content close [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet469c06c2021-06-25 15:11:35 +020013067
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013068 This is used to immediately closes the connection with the server. No further
13069 "tcp-response content" rules are evaluated. The main purpose of this action
13070 is to force a connection to be finished between a client and a server after
13071 an exchange when the application protocol expects some long time outs to
13072 elapse first. The goal is to eliminate idle connections which take
13073 significant resources on servers with certain protocols.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020013074
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013075tcp-response content reject [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau9a621ae2021-09-02 21:00:38 +020013076
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013077 This is used to reject the response. No further "tcp-response content" rules
13078 are evaluated.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010013079
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013080tcp-response content sc-inc-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13081tcp-response content sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13082tcp-response content sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020013083
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013084 These actions increment the General Purppose Counters according to the sticky
13085 counter designated by <sc-id>. Please refer to "http-request sc-inc-gpc",
13086 "http-request sc-inc-gpc0" and "http-request sc-inc-gpc1" for a complete
13087 description.
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020013088
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013089tcp-response content sc-set-gpt(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
13090 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13091tcp-resposne content sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
13092 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010013093
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013094 These actions set the 32-bit unsigned General Purpose Tags according to the
13095 sticky counter designated by <sc-id>. Please refer to "http-request
13096 sc-inc-gpt" and "http-request sc-inc-gpt0" for a complete description.
Emeric Brun877b0b52021-06-30 18:57:49 +020013097
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013098tcp-response content send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
13099 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020013100
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013101 Thaction is is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. Please
13102 refer to "http-request send-spoe-group" for a complete description.
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020013103
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013104tcp-response content set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020013105
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013106 This action is used to set the log level of the current session. Please refer
13107 to "http-request set-log-level". for a complete description.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020013108
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013109tcp-response content set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020013110
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013111 This action is used to set the Netfilter/IPFW MARK in all packets sent to the
13112 client to the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. Please
13113 refer to "http-request set-mark" for a complete description.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020013114
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013115tcp-response content set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020013116
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013117 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed. Please
13118 refer to "http-request set-nice" for a complete description.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020013119
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013120tcp-response content set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau9a621ae2021-09-02 21:00:38 +020013121
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013122 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
13123 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this. Please refer to
13124 "http-request set-tos" for a complete description.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010013125
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +010013126tcp-response content set-var(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13127tcp-response content set-var-fmt(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020013128
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013129 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
13130 inline. Please refer to "http-request set-var" and "http-request set-var-fmt"
13131 for a complete description.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020013132
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013133tcp-response content silent-drop [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020013134
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013135 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
13136 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
13137 client from being notified. Please refer to "http-request silent-drop" for a
13138 complete description.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020013139
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013140tcp-response content unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020013141
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013142 This is used to unset a variable. Please refer to "http-request set-var" for
13143 details about variables.
13144
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020013145
13146tcp-response inspect-delay <timeout>
13147 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a response during content inspection
13148 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +020013149 yes(!) | no | yes | yes
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020013150 Arguments :
13151 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
13152 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
13153 as explained at the top of this document.
13154
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013155 This directive is only available from named defaults sections, not anonymous
13156 ones. Proxies inherit this value from their defaults section.
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +020013157
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020013158 See also : "tcp-response content", "tcp-request inspect-delay".
13159
13160
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010013161timeout check <timeout>
13162 Set additional check timeout, but only after a connection has been already
13163 established.
13164
13165 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13166 yes | no | yes | yes
13167 Arguments:
13168 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
13169 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
13170 as explained at the top of this document.
13171
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040013172 If set, HAProxy uses min("timeout connect", "inter") as a connect timeout
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010013173 for check and "timeout check" as an additional read timeout. The "min" is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013174 used so that people running with *very* long "timeout connect" (e.g. those
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010013175 who needed this due to the queue or tarpit) do not slow down their checks.
Willy Tarreaud7550a22010-02-10 05:10:19 +010013176 (Please also note that there is no valid reason to have such long connect
13177 timeouts, because "timeout queue" and "timeout tarpit" can always be used to
13178 avoid that).
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010013179
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040013180 If "timeout check" is not set HAProxy uses "inter" for complete check
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010013181 timeout (connect + read) exactly like all <1.3.15 version.
13182
13183 In most cases check request is much simpler and faster to handle than normal
13184 requests and people may want to kick out laggy servers so this timeout should
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010013185 be smaller than "timeout server".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010013186
13187 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
13188 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
13189 forget about it.
13190
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +020013191 This directive is only available from named defaults sections, not anonymous
13192 ones. Proxies inherit this value from their defaults section.
13193
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010013194 See also: "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout server",
13195 "timeout tarpit".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010013196
13197
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013198timeout client <timeout>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013199 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
13200 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13201 yes | yes | yes | no
13202 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013203 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013204 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
13205 as explained at the top of this document.
13206
13207 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
13208 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
13209 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
Baptiste Assmann2e1941e2016-03-06 23:24:12 +010013210 response while it is reading data sent by the server. That said, for the
13211 first phase, it is preferable to set the "timeout http-request" to better
13212 protect HAProxy from Slowloris like attacks. The value is specified in
13213 milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013214 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
13215 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
13216 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010013217 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013218 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013219 (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). If some long-lived sessions are mixed with short-lived
13220 sessions (e.g. WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering "timeout tunnel",
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020013221 which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for tunnels, as well as
13222 "timeout client-fin" for half-closed connections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013223
13224 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
13225 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
13226 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
13227 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013228 during startup because it may result in accumulation of expired sessions in
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013229 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
13230
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020013231 See also : "timeout server", "timeout tunnel", "timeout http-request".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013232
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013233
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020013234timeout client-fin <timeout>
13235 Set the inactivity timeout on the client side for half-closed connections.
13236 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13237 yes | yes | yes | no
13238 Arguments :
13239 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
13240 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
13241 as explained at the top of this document.
13242
13243 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
13244 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
13245 from "timeout client" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
13246 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
13247 FIN_WAIT state for too long when clients do not disconnect cleanly. This
13248 problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
13249 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
Willy Tarreau599391a2017-11-24 10:16:00 +010013250 down in one direction. It is applied to idle HTTP/2 connections once a GOAWAY
13251 frame was sent, often indicating an expectation that the connection quickly
13252 ends.
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020013253
13254 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
13255 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
13256 will use the other timeouts (timeout.client or timeout.tunnel).
13257
13258 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server-fin", and "timeout tunnel".
13259
13260
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013261timeout connect <timeout>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013262 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
13263 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13264 yes | no | yes | yes
13265 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013266 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013267 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
13268 as explained at the top of this document.
13269
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040013270 If the server is located on the same LAN as HAProxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010013271 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010013272 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013273 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010013274 connect timeout also presets both queue and tarpit timeouts to the same value
13275 if these have not been specified.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013276
13277 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
13278 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
13279 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
13280 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013281 during startup because it may result in accumulation of failed sessions in
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013282 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
13283
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020013284 See also: "timeout check", "timeout queue", "timeout server", "timeout tarpit".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013285
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013286
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010013287timeout http-keep-alive <timeout>
13288 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a new HTTP request to appear
13289 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13290 yes | yes | yes | yes
13291 Arguments :
13292 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
13293 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
13294 as explained at the top of this document.
13295
13296 By default, the time to wait for a new request in case of keep-alive is set
13297 by "timeout http-request". However this is not always convenient because some
13298 people want very short keep-alive timeouts in order to release connections
13299 faster, and others prefer to have larger ones but still have short timeouts
13300 once the request has started to present itself.
13301
13302 The "http-keep-alive" timeout covers these needs. It will define how long to
13303 wait for a new HTTP request to start coming after a response was sent. Once
13304 the first byte of request has been seen, the "http-request" timeout is used
13305 to wait for the complete request to come. Note that empty lines prior to a
13306 new request do not refresh the timeout and are not counted as a new request.
13307
13308 There is also another difference between the two timeouts : when a connection
13309 expires during timeout http-keep-alive, no error is returned, the connection
13310 just closes. If the connection expires in "http-request" while waiting for a
13311 connection to complete, a HTTP 408 error is returned.
13312
13313 In general it is optimal to set this value to a few tens to hundreds of
13314 milliseconds, to allow users to fetch all objects of a page at once but
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013315 without waiting for further clicks. Also, if set to a very small value (e.g.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010013316 1 millisecond) it will probably only accept pipelined requests but not the
13317 non-pipelined ones. It may be a nice trade-off for very large sites running
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020013318 with tens to hundreds of thousands of clients.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010013319
13320 If this parameter is not set, the "http-request" timeout applies, and if both
13321 are not set, "timeout client" still applies at the lower level. It should be
13322 set in the frontend to take effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in
13323 which case the HTTP backend's timeout will be used.
13324
13325 See also : "timeout http-request", "timeout client".
13326
13327
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010013328timeout http-request <timeout>
13329 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a complete HTTP request
13330 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +020013331 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010013332 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013333 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010013334 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
13335 as explained at the top of this document.
13336
13337 In order to offer DoS protection, it may be required to lower the maximum
13338 accepted time to receive a complete HTTP request without affecting the client
13339 timeout. This helps protecting against established connections on which
13340 nothing is sent. The client timeout cannot offer a good protection against
13341 this abuse because it is an inactivity timeout, which means that if the
13342 attacker sends one character every now and then, the timeout will not
13343 trigger. With the HTTP request timeout, no matter what speed the client
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020013344 types, the request will be aborted if it does not complete in time. When the
13345 timeout expires, an HTTP 408 response is sent to the client to inform it
13346 about the problem, and the connection is closed. The logs will report
13347 termination codes "cR". Some recent browsers are having problems with this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013348 standard, well-documented behavior, so it might be needed to hide the 408
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020013349 code using "option http-ignore-probes" or "errorfile 408 /dev/null". See
13350 more details in the explanations of the "cR" termination code in section 8.5.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010013351
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +010013352 By default, this timeout only applies to the header part of the request,
13353 and not to any data. As soon as the empty line is received, this timeout is
13354 not used anymore. When combined with "option http-buffer-request", this
13355 timeout also applies to the body of the request..
13356 It is used again on keep-alive connections to wait for a second
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010013357 request if "timeout http-keep-alive" is not set.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010013358
13359 Generally it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients send the
13360 full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to cover TCP
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013361 retransmits but that's all. Setting it to very low values (e.g. 50 ms) will
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010013362 generally work on local networks as long as there are no packet losses. This
13363 will prevent people from sending bare HTTP requests using telnet.
13364
13365 If this parameter is not set, the client timeout still applies between each
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +020013366 chunk of the incoming request. It should be set in the frontend to take
13367 effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in which case the HTTP backend's
13368 timeout will be used.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010013369
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020013370 See also : "errorfile", "http-ignore-probes", "timeout http-keep-alive", and
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +010013371 "timeout client", "option http-buffer-request".
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010013372
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013373
13374timeout queue <timeout>
13375 Set the maximum time to wait in the queue for a connection slot to be free
13376 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13377 yes | no | yes | yes
13378 Arguments :
13379 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
13380 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
13381 as explained at the top of this document.
13382
13383 When a server's maxconn is reached, connections are left pending in a queue
13384 which may be server-specific or global to the backend. In order not to wait
13385 indefinitely, a timeout is applied to requests pending in the queue. If the
13386 timeout is reached, it is considered that the request will almost never be
13387 served, so it is dropped and a 503 error is returned to the client.
13388
13389 The "timeout queue" statement allows to fix the maximum time for a request to
13390 be left pending in a queue. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's
13391 connection timeout ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility
13392 with older versions with no "timeout queue" parameter.
13393
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020013394 See also : "timeout connect".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013395
13396
13397timeout server <timeout>
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013398 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
13399 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13400 yes | no | yes | yes
13401 Arguments :
13402 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
13403 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
13404 as explained at the top of this document.
13405
13406 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
13407 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
13408 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
13409 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
13410 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
13411 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
13412 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
13413
13414 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
13415 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
13416 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
13417 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
13418 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010013419 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013420 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013421 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum). If some long-lived sessions are mixed
13422 with short-lived sessions (e.g. WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020013423 "timeout tunnel", which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for
13424 tunnels.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013425
13426 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
13427 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
13428 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
13429 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013430 during startup because it may result in accumulation of expired sessions in
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013431 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
13432
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020013433 See also : "timeout client" and "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013434
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020013435
13436timeout server-fin <timeout>
13437 Set the inactivity timeout on the server side for half-closed connections.
13438 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13439 yes | no | yes | yes
13440 Arguments :
13441 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
13442 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
13443 as explained at the top of this document.
13444
13445 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
13446 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
13447 from "timeout server" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
13448 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
13449 FIN_WAIT state for too long when a remote server does not disconnect cleanly.
13450 This problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
13451 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
13452 down in one direction. This setting was provided for completeness, but in most
13453 situations, it should not be needed.
13454
13455 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
13456 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
13457 will use the other timeouts (timeout.server or timeout.tunnel).
13458
13459 See also : "timeout client-fin", "timeout server", and "timeout tunnel".
13460
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013461
13462timeout tarpit <timeout>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010013463 Set the duration for which tarpitted connections will be maintained
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013464 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13465 yes | yes | yes | yes
13466 Arguments :
13467 <timeout> is the tarpit duration specified in milliseconds by default, but
13468 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
13469 as explained at the top of this document.
13470
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020013471 When a connection is tarpitted using "http-request tarpit", it is maintained
13472 open with no activity for a certain amount of time, then closed. "timeout
13473 tarpit" defines how long it will be maintained open.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013474
13475 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
13476 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
13477 document. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's connection timeout
13478 ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility with older versions
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010013479 with no "timeout tarpit" parameter.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013480
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020013481 See also : "timeout connect".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013482
13483
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020013484timeout tunnel <timeout>
13485 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client and server side for tunnels.
13486 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13487 yes | no | yes | yes
13488 Arguments :
13489 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
13490 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
13491 as explained at the top of this document.
13492
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040013493 The tunnel timeout applies when a bidirectional connection is established
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020013494 between a client and a server, and the connection remains inactive in both
13495 directions. This timeout supersedes both the client and server timeouts once
13496 the connection becomes a tunnel. In TCP, this timeout is used as soon as no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013497 analyzer remains attached to either connection (e.g. tcp content rules are
13498 accepted). In HTTP, this timeout is used when a connection is upgraded (e.g.
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020013499 when switching to the WebSocket protocol, or forwarding a CONNECT request
13500 to a proxy), or after the first response when no keepalive/close option is
13501 specified.
13502
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020013503 Since this timeout is usually used in conjunction with long-lived connections,
13504 it usually is a good idea to also set "timeout client-fin" to handle the
13505 situation where a client suddenly disappears from the net and does not
13506 acknowledge a close, or sends a shutdown and does not acknowledge pending
13507 data anymore. This can happen in lossy networks where firewalls are present,
13508 and is detected by the presence of large amounts of sessions in a FIN_WAIT
13509 state.
13510
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020013511 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
13512 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
13513 document. Whatever the expected normal idle time, it is a good practice to
13514 cover at least one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013515 are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020013516
13517 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
13518 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
13519 forget about it.
13520
13521 Example :
13522 defaults http
13523 option http-server-close
13524 timeout connect 5s
13525 timeout client 30s
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020013526 timeout client-fin 30s
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020013527 timeout server 30s
13528 timeout tunnel 1h # timeout to use with WebSocket and CONNECT
13529
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020013530 See also : "timeout client", "timeout client-fin", "timeout server".
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020013531
13532
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013533transparent (deprecated)
13534 Enable client-side transparent proxying
13535 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +010013536 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013537 Arguments : none
13538
13539 This keyword was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer
13540 3 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
13541 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
13542 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
13543 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
13544 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
13545 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
13546 appropriate server.
13547
13548 The "transparent" keyword is deprecated, use "option transparent" instead.
13549
13550 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
13551 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
13552
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013553 See also: "option transparent"
13554
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013555unique-id-format <string>
13556 Generate a unique ID for each request.
13557 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13558 yes | yes | yes | no
13559 Arguments :
13560 <string> is a log-format string.
13561
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020013562 This keyword creates a ID for each request using the custom log format. A
13563 unique ID is useful to trace a request passing through many components of
13564 a complex infrastructure. The newly created ID may also be logged using the
13565 %ID tag the log-format string.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013566
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020013567 The format should be composed from elements that are guaranteed to be
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040013568 unique when combined together. For instance, if multiple HAProxy instances
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020013569 are involved, it might be important to include the node name. It is often
13570 needed to log the incoming connection's source and destination addresses
13571 and ports. Note that since multiple requests may be performed over the same
13572 connection, including a request counter may help differentiate them.
13573 Similarly, a timestamp may protect against a rollover of the counter.
13574 Logging the process ID will avoid collisions after a service restart.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013575
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020013576 It is recommended to use hexadecimal notation for many fields since it
13577 makes them more compact and saves space in logs.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013578
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020013579 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013580
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050013581 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013582
13583 will generate:
13584
13585 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
13586
13587 See also: "unique-id-header"
13588
13589unique-id-header <name>
13590 Add a unique ID header in the HTTP request.
13591 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13592 yes | yes | yes | no
13593 Arguments :
13594 <name> is the name of the header.
13595
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020013596 Add a unique-id header in the HTTP request sent to the server, using the
13597 unique-id-format. It can't work if the unique-id-format doesn't exist.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013598
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020013599 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013600
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050013601 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013602 unique-id-header X-Unique-ID
13603
13604 will generate:
13605
13606 X-Unique-ID: 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
13607
13608 See also: "unique-id-format"
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013609
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020013610use_backend <backend> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020013611 Switch to a specific backend if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013612 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13613 no | yes | yes | no
13614 Arguments :
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010013615 <backend> is the name of a valid backend or "listen" section, or a
13616 "log-format" string resolving to a backend name.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013617
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020013618 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7. If
13619 it is omitted, the rule is unconditionally applied.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013620
13621 When doing content-switching, connections arrive on a frontend and are then
13622 dispatched to various backends depending on a number of conditions. The
13623 relation between the conditions and the backends is described with the
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020013624 "use_backend" keyword. While it is normally used with HTTP processing, it can
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013625 also be used in pure TCP, either without content using stateless ACLs (e.g.
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020013626 source address validation) or combined with a "tcp-request" rule to wait for
13627 some payload.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013628
13629 There may be as many "use_backend" rules as desired. All of these rules are
13630 evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which matches will
13631 assign the backend.
13632
13633 In the first form, the backend will be used if the condition is met. In the
13634 second form, the backend will be used if the condition is not met. If no
13635 condition is valid, the backend defined with "default_backend" will be used.
13636 If no default backend is defined, either the servers in the same section are
13637 used (in case of a "listen" section) or, in case of a frontend, no server is
13638 used and a 503 service unavailable response is returned.
13639
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020013640 Note that it is possible to switch from a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. In
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010013641 this case, either the frontend has already checked that the protocol is HTTP,
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020013642 and backend processing will immediately follow, or the backend will wait for
13643 a complete HTTP request to get in. This feature is useful when a frontend
13644 must decode several protocols on a unique port, one of them being HTTP.
13645
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010013646 When <backend> is a simple name, it is resolved at configuration time, and an
13647 error is reported if the specified backend does not exist. If <backend> is
13648 a log-format string instead, no check may be done at configuration time, so
13649 the backend name is resolved dynamically at run time. If the resulting
13650 backend name does not correspond to any valid backend, no other rule is
13651 evaluated, and the default_backend directive is applied instead. Note that
13652 when using dynamic backend names, it is highly recommended to use a prefix
13653 that no other backend uses in order to ensure that an unauthorized backend
13654 cannot be forced from the request.
13655
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013656 It is worth mentioning that "use_backend" rules with an explicit name are
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010013657 used to detect the association between frontends and backends to compute the
13658 backend's "fullconn" setting. This cannot be done for dynamic names.
13659
13660 See also: "default_backend", "tcp-request", "fullconn", "log-format", and
13661 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010013662
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020013663use-fcgi-app <name>
13664 Defines the FastCGI application to use for the backend.
13665 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13666 no | no | yes | yes
13667 Arguments :
13668 <name> is the name of the FastCGI application to use.
13669
13670 See section 10.1 about FastCGI application setup for details.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010013671
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020013672use-server <server> if <condition>
13673use-server <server> unless <condition>
13674 Only use a specific server if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
13675 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13676 no | no | yes | yes
13677 Arguments :
Jerome Magnin824186b2020-03-29 09:37:12 +020013678 <server> is the name of a valid server in the same backend section
13679 or a "log-format" string resolving to a server name.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020013680
13681 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7.
13682
13683 By default, connections which arrive to a backend are load-balanced across
13684 the available servers according to the configured algorithm, unless a
13685 persistence mechanism such as a cookie is used and found in the request.
13686
13687 Sometimes it is desirable to forward a particular request to a specific
13688 server without having to declare a dedicated backend for this server. This
13689 can be achieved using the "use-server" rules. These rules are evaluated after
13690 the "redirect" rules and before evaluating cookies, and they have precedence
13691 on them. There may be as many "use-server" rules as desired. All of these
13692 rules are evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which
13693 matches will assign the server.
13694
13695 If a rule designates a server which is down, and "option persist" is not used
13696 and no force-persist rule was validated, it is ignored and evaluation goes on
13697 with the next rules until one matches.
13698
13699 In the first form, the server will be used if the condition is met. In the
13700 second form, the server will be used if the condition is not met. If no
13701 condition is valid, the processing continues and the server will be assigned
13702 according to other persistence mechanisms.
13703
13704 Note that even if a rule is matched, cookie processing is still performed but
13705 does not assign the server. This allows prefixed cookies to have their prefix
13706 stripped.
13707
13708 The "use-server" statement works both in HTTP and TCP mode. This makes it
13709 suitable for use with content-based inspection. For instance, a server could
Lukas Tribusa267b5d2020-07-19 00:25:06 +020013710 be selected in a farm according to the TLS SNI field when using protocols with
Alex5c866202021-06-05 13:23:08 +020013711 implicit TLS (also see "req.ssl_sni"). And if these servers have their weight
Lukas Tribusa267b5d2020-07-19 00:25:06 +020013712 set to zero, they will not be used for other traffic.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020013713
13714 Example :
13715 # intercept incoming TLS requests based on the SNI field
Alex5c866202021-06-05 13:23:08 +020013716 use-server www if { req.ssl_sni -i www.example.com }
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020013717 server www 192.168.0.1:443 weight 0
Alex5c866202021-06-05 13:23:08 +020013718 use-server mail if { req.ssl_sni -i mail.example.com }
Lukas Tribusa267b5d2020-07-19 00:25:06 +020013719 server mail 192.168.0.1:465 weight 0
Alex5c866202021-06-05 13:23:08 +020013720 use-server imap if { req.ssl_sni -i imap.example.com }
Lukas Tribus98a3e3f2017-03-26 12:55:35 +000013721 server imap 192.168.0.1:993 weight 0
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020013722 # all the rest is forwarded to this server
13723 server default 192.168.0.2:443 check
13724
Jerome Magnin824186b2020-03-29 09:37:12 +020013725 When <server> is a simple name, it is checked against existing servers in the
13726 configuration and an error is reported if the specified server does not exist.
13727 If it is a log-format, no check is performed when parsing the configuration,
13728 and if we can't resolve a valid server name at runtime but the use-server rule
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +050013729 was conditioned by an ACL returning true, no other use-server rule is applied
Jerome Magnin824186b2020-03-29 09:37:12 +020013730 and we fall back to load balancing.
13731
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013732 See also: "use_backend", section 5 about server and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020013733
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013734
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100137355. Bind and server options
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013736--------------------------
13737
13738The "bind", "server" and "default-server" keywords support a number of settings
13739depending on some build options and on the system HAProxy was built on. These
13740settings generally each consist in one word sometimes followed by a value,
13741written on the same line as the "bind" or "server" line. All these options are
13742described in this section.
13743
13744
137455.1. Bind options
13746-----------------
13747
13748The "bind" keyword supports a certain number of settings which are all passed
13749as arguments on the same line. The order in which those arguments appear makes
13750no importance, provided that they appear after the bind address. All of these
13751parameters are optional. Some of them consist in a single words (booleans),
13752while other ones expect a value after them. In this case, the value must be
13753provided immediately after the setting name.
13754
13755The currently supported settings are the following ones.
13756
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010013757accept-netscaler-cip <magic number>
13758 Enforces the use of the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol over any
13759 connection accepted by any of the TCP sockets declared on the same line. The
13760 NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol dictates the layer 3/4 addresses of
13761 the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is used, with the
13762 only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will only see the
13763 real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses indicated in the
13764 protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real address will still
13765 be used. This keyword combined with support from external components can be
13766 used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the X-Forwarded-For
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +010013767 mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always usable. See also
13768 "tcp-request connection expect-netscaler-cip" for a finer-grained setting of
13769 which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010013770
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013771accept-proxy
13772 Enforces the use of the PROXY protocol over any connection accepted by any of
Willy Tarreau77992672014-06-14 11:06:17 +020013773 the sockets declared on the same line. Versions 1 and 2 of the PROXY protocol
13774 are supported and correctly detected. The PROXY protocol dictates the layer
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013775 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is
13776 used, with the only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will
13777 only see the real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses
13778 indicated in the protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013779 address will still be used. This keyword combined with support from external
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013780 components can be used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the
13781 X-Forwarded-For mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020013782 usable. See also "tcp-request connection expect-proxy" for a finer-grained
13783 setting of which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013784
Olivier Houchardc2aae742017-09-22 18:26:28 +020013785allow-0rtt
Bertrand Jacquina25282b2018-08-14 00:56:13 +010013786 Allow receiving early data when using TLSv1.3. This is disabled by default,
Olivier Houchard69752962019-01-08 15:35:32 +010013787 due to security considerations. Because it is vulnerable to replay attacks,
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013788 you should only allow if for requests that are safe to replay, i.e. requests
Olivier Houchard69752962019-01-08 15:35:32 +010013789 that are idempotent. You can use the "wait-for-handshake" action for any
13790 request that wouldn't be safe with early data.
Olivier Houchardc2aae742017-09-22 18:26:28 +020013791
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020013792alpn <protocols>
13793 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
13794 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
13795 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013796 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020013797 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010013798 initial NPN extension. ALPN is required to enable HTTP/2 on an HTTP frontend.
13799 Versions of OpenSSL prior to 1.0.2 didn't support ALPN and only supposed the
13800 now obsolete NPN extension. At the time of writing this, most browsers still
13801 support both ALPN and NPN for HTTP/2 so a fallback to NPN may still work for
13802 a while. But ALPN must be used whenever possible. If both HTTP/2 and HTTP/1.1
13803 are expected to be supported, both versions can be advertised, in order of
13804 preference, like below :
13805
13806 bind :443 ssl crt pub.pem alpn h2,http/1.1
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020013807
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013808backlog <backlog>
Willy Tarreaue2711c72019-02-27 15:39:41 +010013809 Sets the socket's backlog to this value. If unspecified or 0, the frontend's
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013810 backlog is used instead, which generally defaults to the maxconn value.
13811
Emmanuel Hocdete7f2b732017-01-09 16:15:54 +010013812curves <curves>
13813 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
13814 the string describing the list of elliptic curves algorithms ("curve suite")
13815 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with ECDHE. The format of the
13816 string is a colon-delimited list of curve name.
13817 Example: "X25519:P-256" (without quote)
13818 When "curves" is set, "ecdhe" parameter is ignored.
13819
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020013820ecdhe <named curve>
13821 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
Emeric Brun6924ef82013-03-06 14:08:53 +010013822 the named curve (RFC 4492) used to generate ECDH ephemeral keys. By default,
13823 used named curve is prime256v1.
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020013824
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020013825ca-file <cafile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020013826 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13827 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
William Lallemand34107802022-04-01 23:49:11 +020013828 client's certificate. It is possible to load a directory containing multiple
13829 CAs, in this case HAProxy will try to load every ".pem", ".crt", ".cer", and
William Lallemande4b93eb2022-05-09 09:29:00 +020013830 .crl" available in the directory, files starting with a dot are ignored.
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020013831
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020013832ca-ignore-err [all|<errorID>,...]
13833 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
13834 Sets a comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth > 0.
13835 If set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an
13836 error is ignored.
13837
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020013838ca-sign-file <cafile>
13839 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13840 designates a PEM file containing both the CA certificate and the CA private
13841 key used to create and sign server's certificates. This is a mandatory
13842 setting when the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
13843 'generate-certificates' for details.
13844
Bertrand Jacquind4d0a232016-11-13 16:37:12 +000013845ca-sign-pass <passphrase>
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020013846 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It is
13847 the CA private key passphrase. This setting is optional and used only when
13848 the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
13849 'generate-certificates' for details.
13850
Emmanuel Hocdet842e94e2019-12-16 16:39:17 +010013851ca-verify-file <cafile>
13852 This setting designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to
13853 verify client's certificate. It designates CA certificates which must not be
13854 included in CA names sent in server hello message. Typically, "ca-file" must
13855 be defined with intermediate certificates, and "ca-verify-file" with
13856 certificates to ending the chain, like root CA.
13857
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013858ciphers <ciphers>
13859 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
13860 the string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +000013861 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2. The format of the
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000013862 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020013863 information and recommendations see e.g.
13864 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
13865 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
13866 cipher configuration, please check the "ciphersuites" keyword.
13867
13868ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
13869 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
13870 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the string describing
13871 the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are negotiated during the
13872 TLSv1.3 handshake. The format of the string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000013873 OpenSSL man pages under the "ciphersuites" section. For cipher configuration
13874 for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the "ciphers" keyword.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013875
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020013876crl-file <crlfile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020013877 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13878 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
Remi Tricot-Le Breton02bd6842021-05-04 12:22:34 +020013879 to verify client's certificate. You need to provide a certificate revocation
13880 list for every certificate of your certificate authority chain.
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020013881
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013882crt <cert>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013883 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13884 designates a PEM file containing both the required certificates and any
13885 associated private keys. This file can be built by concatenating multiple
13886 PEM files into one (e.g. cat cert.pem key.pem > combined.pem). If your CA
13887 requires an intermediate certificate, this can also be concatenated into this
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +010013888 file. Intermediate certificate can also be shared in a directory via
13889 "issuers-chain-path" directive.
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013890
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +010013891 If the file does not contain a private key, HAProxy will try to load
13892 the key at the same path suffixed by a ".key".
13893
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013894 If the OpenSSL used supports Diffie-Hellman, parameters present in this file
13895 are loaded.
13896
13897 If a directory name is used instead of a PEM file, then all files found in
William Lallemand3f25ae32020-02-24 16:30:12 +010013898 that directory will be loaded in alphabetic order unless their name ends
William Lallemand589570d2022-05-09 10:30:51 +020013899 with '.key', '.issuer', '.ocsp' or '.sctl' (reserved extensions). Files
13900 starting with a dot are also ignored. This directive may be specified multiple
13901 times in order to load certificates from multiple files or directories. The
13902 certificates will be presented to clients who provide a valid TLS Server Name
13903 Indication field matching one of their CN or alt subjects. Wildcards are
13904 supported, where a wildcard character '*' is used instead of the first
13905 hostname component (e.g. *.example.org matches www.example.org but not
13906 www.sub.example.org).
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013907
13908 If no SNI is provided by the client or if the SSL library does not support
13909 TLS extensions, or if the client provides an SNI hostname which does not
13910 match any certificate, then the first loaded certificate will be presented.
13911 This means that when loading certificates from a directory, it is highly
Cyril Bonté3180f7b2015-01-25 00:16:08 +010013912 recommended to load the default one first as a file or to ensure that it will
13913 always be the first one in the directory.
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013914
Emeric Brune032bfa2012-09-28 13:01:45 +020013915 Note that the same cert may be loaded multiple times without side effects.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013916
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013917 Some CAs (such as GoDaddy) offer a drop down list of server types that do not
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013918 include HAProxy when obtaining a certificate. If this happens be sure to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013919 choose a web server that the CA believes requires an intermediate CA (for
13920 GoDaddy, selection Apache Tomcat will get the correct bundle, but many
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013921 others, e.g. nginx, result in a wrong bundle that will not work for some
13922 clients).
13923
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040013924 For each PEM file, HAProxy checks for the presence of file at the same path
Emeric Brun4147b2e2014-06-16 18:36:30 +020013925 suffixed by ".ocsp". If such file is found, support for the TLS Certificate
13926 Status Request extension (also known as "OCSP stapling") is automatically
13927 enabled. The content of this file is optional. If not empty, it must contain
13928 a valid OCSP Response in DER format. In order to be valid an OCSP Response
13929 must comply with the following rules: it has to indicate a good status,
13930 it has to be a single response for the certificate of the PEM file, and it
13931 has to be valid at the moment of addition. If these rules are not respected
13932 the OCSP Response is ignored and a warning is emitted. In order to identify
13933 which certificate an OCSP Response applies to, the issuer's certificate is
13934 necessary. If the issuer's certificate is not found in the PEM file, it will
13935 be loaded from a file at the same path as the PEM file suffixed by ".issuer"
13936 if it exists otherwise it will fail with an error.
13937
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040013938 For each PEM file, HAProxy also checks for the presence of file at the same
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010013939 path suffixed by ".sctl". If such file is found, support for Certificate
13940 Transparency (RFC6962) TLS extension is enabled. The file must contain a
13941 valid Signed Certificate Timestamp List, as described in RFC. File is parsed
13942 to check basic syntax, but no signatures are verified.
13943
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050013944 There are cases where it is desirable to support multiple key types, e.g. RSA
13945 and ECDSA in the cipher suites offered to the clients. This allows clients
13946 that support EC certificates to be able to use EC ciphers, while
13947 simultaneously supporting older, RSA only clients.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050013948
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +020013949 To achieve this, OpenSSL 1.1.1 is required, you can configure this behavior
13950 by providing one crt entry per certificate type, or by configuring a "cert
13951 bundle" like it was required before HAProxy 1.8. See "ssl-load-extra-files".
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050013952
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020013953crt-ignore-err <errors>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013954 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. Sets a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013955 comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth == 0. If
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013956 set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an error
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013957 is ignored.
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020013958
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010013959crt-list <file>
13960 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010013961 designates a list of PEM file with an optional ssl configuration and a SNI
13962 filter per certificate, with the following format for each line :
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010013963
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010013964 <crtfile> [\[<sslbindconf> ...\]] [[!]<snifilter> ...]
13965
William Lallemand5d036392020-06-30 16:11:36 +020013966 sslbindconf supports "allow-0rtt", "alpn", "ca-file", "ca-verify-file",
13967 "ciphers", "ciphersuites", "crl-file", "curves", "ecdhe", "no-ca-names",
13968 "npn", "verify" configuration. With BoringSSL and Openssl >= 1.1.1
13969 "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" are also supported. It overrides the
13970 configuration set in bind line for the certificate.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010013971
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +020013972 Wildcards are supported in the SNI filter. Negative filter are also supported,
Joao Moraise51fab02020-11-21 07:42:20 -030013973 useful in combination with a wildcard filter to exclude a particular SNI, or
13974 after the first certificate to exclude a pattern from its CN or Subject Alt
13975 Name (SAN). The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a valid
13976 TLS Server Name Indication field matching one of the SNI filters. If no SNI
13977 filter is specified, the CN and SAN are used. This directive may be specified
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +020013978 multiple times. See the "crt" option for more information. The default
13979 certificate is still needed to meet OpenSSL expectations. If it is not used,
13980 the 'strict-sni' option may be used.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010013981
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +020013982 Multi-cert bundling (see "ssl-load-extra-files") is supported with crt-list,
13983 as long as only the base name is given in the crt-list. SNI filter will do
13984 the same work on all bundled certificates.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050013985
William Lallemand7c26ed72020-06-03 17:34:48 +020013986 Empty lines as well as lines beginning with a hash ('#') will be ignored.
13987
Joao Moraisaa8fcc42020-11-24 08:24:30 -030013988 The first declared certificate of a bind line is used as the default
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040013989 certificate, either from crt or crt-list option, which HAProxy should use in
Joao Moraisaa8fcc42020-11-24 08:24:30 -030013990 the TLS handshake if no other certificate matches. This certificate will also
13991 be used if the provided SNI matches its CN or SAN, even if a matching SNI
13992 filter is found on any crt-list. The SNI filter !* can be used after the first
13993 declared certificate to not include its CN and SAN in the SNI tree, so it will
13994 never match except if no other certificate matches. This way the first
13995 declared certificate act as a fallback.
Joao Moraise51fab02020-11-21 07:42:20 -030013996
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010013997 crt-list file example:
Joao Moraise51fab02020-11-21 07:42:20 -030013998 cert1.pem !*
William Lallemand7c26ed72020-06-03 17:34:48 +020013999 # comment
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010014000 cert2.pem [alpn h2,http/1.1]
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010014001 certW.pem *.domain.tld !secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010014002 certS.pem [curves X25519:P-256 ciphers ECDHE-ECDSA-AES256-GCM-SHA384] secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010014003
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020014004defer-accept
14005 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
14006 states that a connection will only be accepted once some data arrive on it,
14007 or at worst after the first retransmit. This should be used only on protocols
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014008 for which the client talks first (e.g. HTTP). It can slightly improve
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020014009 performance by ensuring that most of the request is already available when
14010 the connection is accepted. On the other hand, it will not be able to detect
14011 connections which don't talk. It is important to note that this option is
14012 broken in all kernels up to 2.6.31, as the connection is never accepted until
14013 the client talks. This can cause issues with front firewalls which would see
14014 an established connection while the proxy will only see it in SYN_RECV. This
14015 option is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones.
14016
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020014017expose-fd listeners
14018 This option is only usable with the stats socket. It gives your stats socket
14019 the capability to pass listeners FD to another HAProxy process.
William Lallemand2be557f2021-11-24 18:45:37 +010014020 In master-worker mode, this is not required anymore, the listeners will be
14021 passed using the internal socketpairs between the master and the workers.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014022 See also "-x" in the management guide.
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020014023
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020014024force-sslv3
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014025 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020014026 this listener. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014027 for high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014028 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020014029
14030force-tlsv10
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014031 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014032 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014033 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020014034
14035force-tlsv11
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014036 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014037 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014038 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020014039
14040force-tlsv12
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014041 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014042 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014043 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020014044
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020014045force-tlsv13
14046 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
14047 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014048 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020014049
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020014050generate-certificates
14051 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
14052 enables the dynamic SSL certificates generation. A CA certificate and its
14053 private key are necessary (see 'ca-sign-file'). When HAProxy is configured as
14054 a transparent forward proxy, SSL requests generate errors because of a common
14055 name mismatch on the certificate presented to the client. With this option
14056 enabled, HAProxy will try to forge a certificate using the SNI hostname
14057 indicated by the client. This is done only if no certificate matches the SNI
14058 hostname (see 'crt-list'). If an error occurs, the default certificate is
14059 used, else the 'strict-sni' option is set.
14060 It can also be used when HAProxy is configured as a reverse proxy to ease the
14061 deployment of an architecture with many backends.
14062
14063 Creating a SSL certificate is an expensive operation, so a LRU cache is used
14064 to store forged certificates (see 'tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size'). It
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014065 increases the HAProxy's memory footprint to reduce latency when the same
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020014066 certificate is used many times.
14067
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020014068gid <gid>
14069 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system gid. It can also
14070 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
14071 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "group"
14072 setting except that the group ID is used instead of its name. This setting is
14073 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
14074
14075group <group>
14076 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system group. It can
14077 also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note
14078 that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the
14079 "gid" setting except that the group name is used instead of its gid. This
14080 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
14081
14082id <id>
14083 Fixes the socket ID. By default, socket IDs are automatically assigned, but
14084 sometimes it is more convenient to fix them to ease monitoring. This value
14085 must be strictly positive and unique within the listener/frontend. This
14086 option can only be used when defining only a single socket.
14087
14088interface <interface>
Lukas Tribusfce2e962013-02-12 22:13:19 +010014089 Restricts the socket to a specific interface. When specified, only packets
14090 received from that particular interface are processed by the socket. This is
14091 currently only supported on Linux. The interface must be a primary system
14092 interface, not an aliased interface. It is also possible to bind multiple
14093 frontends to the same address if they are bound to different interfaces. Note
14094 that binding to a network interface requires root privileges. This parameter
Jérôme Magnin61275192018-02-07 11:39:58 +010014095 is only compatible with TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets. When specified, return traffic
14096 uses the same interface as inbound traffic, and its associated routing table,
14097 even if there are explicit routes through different interfaces configured.
14098 This can prove useful to address asymmetric routing issues when the same
14099 client IP addresses need to be able to reach frontends hosted on different
14100 interfaces.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020014101
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020014102level <level>
14103 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to restrict the nature of
14104 the commands that can be issued on the socket. It is ignored by other
14105 sockets. <level> can be one of :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014106 - "user" is the least privileged level; only non-sensitive stats can be
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020014107 read, and no change is allowed. It would make sense on systems where it
14108 is not easy to restrict access to the socket.
14109 - "operator" is the default level and fits most common uses. All data can
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014110 be read, and only non-sensitive changes are permitted (e.g. clear max
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020014111 counters).
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014112 - "admin" should be used with care, as everything is permitted (e.g. clear
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020014113 all counters).
14114
Andjelko Iharosc4df59e2017-07-20 11:59:48 +020014115severity-output <format>
14116 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to configure severity
14117 level output prepended to informational feedback messages. Severity
14118 level of messages can range between 0 and 7, conforming to syslog
14119 rfc5424. Valid and successful socket commands requesting data
14120 (i.e. "show map", "get acl foo" etc.) will never have a severity level
14121 prepended. It is ignored by other sockets. <format> can be one of :
14122 - "none" (default) no severity level is prepended to feedback messages.
14123 - "number" severity level is prepended as a number.
14124 - "string" severity level is prepended as a string following the
14125 rfc5424 convention.
14126
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020014127maxconn <maxconn>
14128 Limits the sockets to this number of concurrent connections. Extraneous
14129 connections will remain in the system's backlog until a connection is
14130 released. If unspecified, the limit will be the same as the frontend's
14131 maxconn. Note that in case of port ranges or multiple addresses, the same
14132 value will be applied to each socket. This setting enables different
14133 limitations on expensive sockets, for instance SSL entries which may easily
14134 eat all memory.
14135
14136mode <mode>
14137 Sets the octal mode used to define access permissions on the UNIX socket. It
14138 can also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement.
14139 Note that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is ignored by non
14140 UNIX sockets.
14141
14142mss <maxseg>
14143 Sets the TCP Maximum Segment Size (MSS) value to be advertised on incoming
14144 connections. This can be used to force a lower MSS for certain specific
14145 ports, for instance for connections passing through a VPN. Note that this
14146 relies on a kernel feature which is theoretically supported under Linux but
14147 was buggy in all versions prior to 2.6.28. It may or may not work on other
14148 operating systems. It may also not change the advertised value but change the
14149 effective size of outgoing segments. The commonly advertised value for TCPv4
14150 over Ethernet networks is 1460 = 1500(MTU) - 40(IP+TCP). If this value is
14151 positive, it will be used as the advertised MSS. If it is negative, it will
14152 indicate by how much to reduce the incoming connection's advertised MSS for
14153 outgoing segments. This parameter is only compatible with TCP v4/v6 sockets.
14154
14155name <name>
14156 Sets an optional name for these sockets, which will be reported on the stats
14157 page.
14158
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020014159namespace <name>
14160 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
14161 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a listener to
14162 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
14163 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
14164
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020014165nice <nice>
14166 Sets the 'niceness' of connections initiated from the socket. Value must be
14167 in the range -1024..1024 inclusive, and defaults to zero. Positive values
14168 means that such connections are more friendly to others and easily offer
14169 their place in the scheduler. On the opposite, negative values mean that
14170 connections want to run with a higher priority than others. The difference
14171 only happens under high loads when the system is close to saturation.
14172 Negative values are appropriate for low-latency or administration services,
14173 and high values are generally recommended for CPU intensive tasks such as SSL
14174 processing or bulk transfers which are less sensible to latency. For example,
14175 it may make sense to use a positive value for an SMTP socket and a negative
14176 one for an RDP socket.
14177
Emmanuel Hocdet174dfe52017-07-28 15:01:05 +020014178no-ca-names
14179 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
14180 prevents from send CA names in server hello message when ca-file is used.
Emmanuel Hocdet842e94e2019-12-16 16:39:17 +010014181 Use "ca-verify-file" instead of "ca-file" with "no-ca-names".
Emmanuel Hocdet174dfe52017-07-28 15:01:05 +020014182
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020014183no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020014184 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014185 disables support for SSLv3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener when
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020014186 SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and cannot
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014187 be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also available on
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014188 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver" and
14189 "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020014190
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020014191no-tls-tickets
14192 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
14193 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
14194 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014195 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage. This option is also
14196 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Lukas Tribusbdb386d2020-03-10 00:56:09 +010014197 The TLS ticket mechanism is only used up to TLS 1.2.
14198 Forward Secrecy is compromised with TLS tickets, unless ticket keys
14199 are periodically rotated (via reload or by using "tls-ticket-keys").
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020014200
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020014201no-tlsv10
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020014202 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014203 disables support for TLSv1.0 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020014204 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014205 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014206 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
14207 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020014208
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020014209no-tlsv11
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020014210 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014211 disables support for TLSv1.1 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020014212 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014213 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014214 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
14215 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020014216
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020014217no-tlsv12
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020014218 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014219 disables support for TLSv1.2 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020014220 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014221 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014222 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
14223 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020014224
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020014225no-tlsv13
14226 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
14227 disables support for TLSv1.3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
14228 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
14229 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014230 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
14231 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020014232
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020014233npn <protocols>
14234 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
14235 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
14236 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014237 This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020014238 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010014239 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword), though this one is
14240 only available starting with OpenSSL 1.0.2. If HTTP/2 is desired on an older
14241 version of OpenSSL, NPN might still be used as most clients still support it
14242 at the time of writing this. It is possible to enable both NPN and ALPN
14243 though it probably doesn't make any sense out of testing.
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020014244
Lukas Tribus53ae85c2017-05-04 15:45:40 +000014245prefer-client-ciphers
14246 Use the client's preference when selecting the cipher suite, by default
14247 the server's preference is enforced. This option is also available on
14248 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Lukas Tribus926594f2018-05-18 17:55:57 +020014249 Note that with OpenSSL >= 1.1.1 ChaCha20-Poly1305 is reprioritized anyway
14250 (without setting this option), if a ChaCha20-Poly1305 cipher is at the top of
14251 the client cipher list.
Lukas Tribus53ae85c2017-05-04 15:45:40 +000014252
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010014253process <process-set>[/<thread-set>]
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +020014254 This restricts the list of threads on which this listener is allowed to run.
14255 It does not enforce any of them but eliminates those which do not match. Note
14256 that only process number 1 is permitted. If a thread set is specified, it
14257 limits the threads allowed to process incoming connections for this listener.
14258 For the unlikely case where several ranges are needed, this directive may be
14259 repeated. <process-set> and <thread-set> must use the format
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010014260
14261 all | odd | even | number[-[number]]
14262
Willy Tarreauc8cac042021-09-21 14:31:29 +020014263 Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can be omitted. In such a
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +020014264 case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum value. The main purpose is
14265 to have multiple bind lines sharing the same IP:port but not the same thread
14266 in a listener, so that the system can distribute the incoming connections
14267 into multiple queues, bypassing haproxy's internal queue load balancing.
14268 Currently Linux 3.9 and above is known for supporting this.
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +020014269
Willy Tarreauc8cac042021-09-21 14:31:29 +020014270 This directive is deprecated in favor of the more suited "thread" directive
14271 below, and will be removed in 2.7.
14272
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020014273proto <name>
14274 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the incoming connections. It
14275 must be compatible with the mode of the frontend (TCP or HTTP). It must also
14276 be usable on the frontend side. The list of available protocols is reported
Christopher Faulet982e17d2021-03-26 14:44:18 +010014277 in haproxy -vv. The protocols properties are reported : the mode (TCP/HTTP),
14278 the side (FE/BE), the mux name and its flags.
14279
Christopher Fauleta97cced2022-04-12 18:04:10 +020014280 Some protocols are subject to the head-of-line blocking on server side
14281 (flag=HOL_RISK). Finally some protocols don't support upgrades (flag=NO_UPG).
14282 The HTX compatibility is also reported (flag=HTX).
Christopher Faulet982e17d2021-03-26 14:44:18 +010014283
14284 Here are the protocols that may be used as argument to a "proto" directive on
14285 a bind line :
14286
Christopher Fauleta97cced2022-04-12 18:04:10 +020014287 h2 : mode=HTTP side=FE|BE mux=H2 flags=HTX|HOL_RISK|NO_UPG
Christopher Faulet982e17d2021-03-26 14:44:18 +010014288 h1 : mode=HTTP side=FE|BE mux=H1 flags=HTX|NO_UPG
14289 none : mode=TCP side=FE|BE mux=PASS flags=NO_UPG
14290
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040014291 Idea behind this option is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020014292 protocol for all connections instantiated from this listening socket. For
Joseph Herlant71b4b152018-11-13 16:55:16 -080014293 instance, it is possible to force the http/2 on clear TCP by specifying "proto
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020014294 h2" on the bind line.
14295
Willy Tarreau6dfbef42021-10-12 15:23:03 +020014296shards <number> | by-thread
14297 In multi-threaded mode, on operating systems supporting multiple listeners on
14298 the same IP:port, this will automatically create this number of multiple
14299 identical listeners for the same line, all bound to a fair share of the number
14300 of the threads attached to this listener. This can sometimes be useful when
14301 using very large thread counts where the in-kernel locking on a single socket
14302 starts to cause a significant overhead. In this case the incoming traffic is
14303 distributed over multiple sockets and the contention is reduced. Note that
14304 doing this can easily increase the CPU usage by making more threads work a
14305 little bit.
14306
14307 If the number of shards is higher than the number of available threads, it
14308 will automatically be trimmed to the number of threads (i.e. one shard per
14309 thread). The special "by-thread" value also creates as many shards as there
14310 are threads on the "bind" line. Since the system will evenly distribute the
14311 incoming traffic between all these shards, it is important that this number
14312 is an integral divisor of the number of threads.
14313
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020014314ssl
14315 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014316 enables SSL deciphering on connections instantiated from this listener. A
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020014317 certificate is necessary (see "crt" above). All contents in the buffers will
14318 appear in clear text, so that ACLs and HTTP processing will only have access
Emmanuel Hocdetbd695fe2017-05-15 15:53:41 +020014319 to deciphered contents. SSLv3 is disabled per default, use "ssl-min-ver SSLv3"
14320 to enable it.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020014321
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014322ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
14323 This option enforces use of <version> or lower on SSL connections instantiated
William Lallemand50df1cb2020-06-02 10:52:24 +020014324 from this listener. Using this setting without "ssl-min-ver" can be
14325 ambiguous because the default ssl-min-ver value could change in future HAProxy
14326 versions. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014327 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
14328
14329ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
William Lallemand50df1cb2020-06-02 10:52:24 +020014330 This option enforces use of <version> or upper on SSL connections
14331 instantiated from this listener. The default value is "TLSv1.2". This option
14332 is also available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
14333 See also "ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014334
Emmanuel Hocdet65623372013-01-24 17:17:15 +010014335strict-sni
14336 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. The
14337 SSL/TLS negotiation is allow only if the client provided an SNI which match
14338 a certificate. The default certificate is not used.
14339 See the "crt" option for more information.
14340
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010014341tcp-ut <delay>
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010014342 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all incoming connections instantiated from this
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010014343 listening socket. This option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040014344 allows HAProxy to configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014345 receiving an acknowledgment for the configured delay. This is especially
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010014346 useful on long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as
14347 remote terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server
14348 timeouts must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is
14349 important to detect that the client has disappeared in order to release all
14350 resources associated with its connection (and the server's session). The
14351 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works
14352 for regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
14353
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020014354tfo
Lukas Tribus0defb902013-02-13 23:35:39 +010014355 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on Linux kernels >= 3.7. It
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020014356 enables TCP Fast Open on the listening socket, which means that clients which
14357 support this feature will be able to send a request and receive a response
14358 during the 3-way handshake starting from second connection, thus saving one
14359 round-trip after the first connection. This only makes sense with protocols
14360 that use high connection rates and where each round trip matters. This can
14361 possibly cause issues with many firewalls which do not accept data on SYN
14362 packets, so this option should only be enabled once well tested. This option
Lukas Tribus0999f762013-04-02 16:43:24 +020014363 is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones. You may
14364 need to build HAProxy with USE_TFO=1 if your libc doesn't define
14365 TCP_FASTOPEN.
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020014366
Willy Tarreaud57b9ff2021-09-29 18:50:31 +020014367thread [<thread-group>/]<thread-set>
Willy Tarreauc8cac042021-09-21 14:31:29 +020014368 This restricts the list of threads on which this listener is allowed to run.
14369 It does not enforce any of them but eliminates those which do not match. It
14370 limits the threads allowed to process incoming connections for this listener.
Willy Tarreaud57b9ff2021-09-29 18:50:31 +020014371
14372 There are two numbering schemes. By default, thread numbers are absolute in
14373 the process, comprised between 1 and the value specified in global.nbthread.
14374 When thread groups are enabled, the number of a single desired thread group
14375 (starting at 1) may be specified before a slash ('/') before the thread
14376 range. In this case, the thread numbers in the range are relative to the
14377 thread group instead, and start at 1 for each thread group. Absolute and
14378 relative thread numbers may be used interchangeably but they must not be
14379 mixed on a single "bind" line, as those not set will be resolved at the end
14380 of the parsing.
14381
Willy Tarreauc8cac042021-09-21 14:31:29 +020014382 For the unlikely case where several ranges are needed, this directive may be
Willy Tarreaud57b9ff2021-09-29 18:50:31 +020014383 repeated. It is not permitted to use different thread groups even when using
14384 multiple directives. The <thread-set> specification must use the format:
Willy Tarreauc8cac042021-09-21 14:31:29 +020014385
14386 all | odd | even | number[-[number]]
14387
14388 Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can be omitted. In such a
14389 case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum value. The main purpose is
14390 to have multiple bind lines sharing the same IP:port but not the same thread
14391 in a listener, so that the system can distribute the incoming connections
14392 into multiple queues, bypassing haproxy's internal queue load balancing.
14393 Currently Linux 3.9 and above is known for supporting this.
14394
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010014395tls-ticket-keys <keyfile>
14396 Sets the TLS ticket keys file to load the keys from. The keys need to be 48
Emeric Brun9e754772019-01-10 17:51:55 +010014397 or 80 bytes long, depending if aes128 or aes256 is used, encoded with base64
14398 with one line per key (ex. openssl rand 80 | openssl base64 -A | xargs echo).
14399 The first key determines the key length used for next keys: you can't mix
14400 aes128 and aes256 keys. Number of keys is specified by the TLS_TICKETS_NO
14401 build option (default 3) and at least as many keys need to be present in
14402 the file. Last TLS_TICKETS_NO keys will be used for decryption and the
14403 penultimate one for encryption. This enables easy key rotation by just
14404 appending new key to the file and reloading the process. Keys must be
14405 periodically rotated (ex. every 12h) or Perfect Forward Secrecy is
14406 compromised. It is also a good idea to keep the keys off any permanent
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010014407 storage such as hard drives (hint: use tmpfs and don't swap those files).
14408 Lifetime hint can be changed using tune.ssl.timeout.
14409
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020014410transparent
14411 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
14412 indicates that the addresses will be bound even if they do not belong to the
14413 local machine, and that packets targeting any of these addresses will be
14414 intercepted just as if the addresses were locally configured. This normally
14415 requires that IP forwarding is enabled. Caution! do not use this with the
14416 default address '*', as it would redirect any traffic for the specified port.
14417 This keyword is available only when HAProxy is built with USE_LINUX_TPROXY=1.
14418 This parameter is only compatible with TCPv4 and TCPv6 sockets, depending on
14419 kernel version. Some distribution kernels include backports of the feature,
14420 so check for support with your vendor.
14421
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010014422v4v6
14423 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
14424 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to both IPv4
14425 and IPv6 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes necessary
14426 on systems which bind to IPv6 only by default. It has no effect on non-IPv6
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014427 sockets, and is overridden by the "v6only" option.
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010014428
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010014429v6only
14430 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
14431 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to IPv6 only
14432 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes preferred to doing it
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010014433 system-wide as it is per-listener. It has no effect on non-IPv6 sockets and
14434 has precedence over the "v4v6" option.
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010014435
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020014436uid <uid>
14437 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system uid. It can also
14438 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
14439 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "user"
14440 setting except that the user numeric ID is used instead of its name. This
14441 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
14442
14443user <user>
14444 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system user. It can also
14445 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
14446 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "uid"
14447 setting except that the user name is used instead of its uid. This setting is
14448 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
14449
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020014450verify [none|optional|required]
14451 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
14452 to 'none', client certificate is not requested. This is the default. In other
14453 cases, a client certificate is requested. If the client does not provide a
14454 certificate after the request and if 'verify' is set to 'required', then the
14455 handshake is aborted, while it would have succeeded if set to 'optional'. The
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020014456 certificate provided by the client is always verified using CAs from
14457 'ca-file' and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. On verify failure the handshake
14458 is aborted, regardless of the 'verify' option, unless the error code exactly
14459 matches one of those listed with 'ca-ignore-err' or 'crt-ignore-err'.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020014460
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +0200144615.2. Server and default-server options
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +010014462------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014463
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010014464The "server" and "default-server" keywords support a certain number of settings
14465which are all passed as arguments on the server line. The order in which those
14466arguments appear does not count, and they are all optional. Some of those
14467settings are single words (booleans) while others expect one or several values
14468after them. In this case, the values must immediately follow the setting name.
14469Except default-server, all those settings must be specified after the server's
14470address if they are used:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014471
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014472 server <name> <address>[:port] [settings ...]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010014473 default-server [settings ...]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014474
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014475Note that all these settings are supported both by "server" and "default-server"
14476keywords, except "id" which is only supported by "server".
14477
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014478The currently supported settings are the following ones.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014479
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020014480addr <ipv4|ipv6>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014481 Using the "addr" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different IP address
Baptiste Assmann13f83532016-03-06 23:14:36 +010014482 to send health-checks or to probe the agent-check. On some servers, it may be
14483 desirable to dedicate an IP address to specific component able to perform
14484 complex tests which are more suitable to health-checks than the application.
14485 This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not set. See also the
14486 "port" parameter.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014487
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014488agent-check
14489 Enable an auxiliary agent check which is run independently of a regular
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014490 health check. An agent health check is performed by making a TCP connection
Willy Tarreau7a0139e2018-12-16 08:42:56 +010014491 to the port set by the "agent-port" parameter and reading an ASCII string
14492 terminated by the first '\r' or '\n' met. The string is made of a series of
14493 words delimited by spaces, tabs or commas in any order, each consisting of :
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014494
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014495 - An ASCII representation of a positive integer percentage, e.g. "75%".
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014496 Values in this format will set the weight proportional to the initial
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040014497 weight of a server as configured when HAProxy starts. Note that a zero
Willy Tarreauc5af3a62014-10-07 15:27:33 +020014498 weight is reported on the stats page as "DRAIN" since it has the same
14499 effect on the server (it's removed from the LB farm).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014500
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014501 - The string "maxconn:" followed by an integer (no space between). Values
14502 in this format will set the maxconn of a server. The maximum number of
14503 connections advertised needs to be multiplied by the number of load
14504 balancers and different backends that use this health check to get the
14505 total number of connections the server might receive. Example: maxconn:30
Nenad Merdanovic174dd372016-04-24 23:10:06 +020014506
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014507 - The word "ready". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014508 READY mode, thus canceling any DRAIN or MAINT state
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014509
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014510 - The word "drain". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
14511 DRAIN mode, thus it will not accept any new connections other than those
14512 that are accepted via persistence.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014513
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014514 - The word "maint". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
14515 MAINT mode, thus it will not accept any new connections at all, and health
14516 checks will be stopped.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014517
William Dauchyf8e795c2020-09-26 13:35:51 +020014518 - The words "down", "fail", or "stopped", optionally followed by a
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014519 description string after a sharp ('#'). All of these mark the server's
14520 operating state as DOWN, but since the word itself is reported on the stats
14521 page, the difference allows an administrator to know if the situation was
14522 expected or not : the service may intentionally be stopped, may appear up
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014523 but fail some validity tests, or may be seen as down (e.g. missing process,
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014524 or port not responding).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014525
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014526 - The word "up" sets back the server's operating state as UP if health checks
14527 also report that the service is accessible.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014528
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014529 Parameters which are not advertised by the agent are not changed. For
14530 example, an agent might be designed to monitor CPU usage and only report a
14531 relative weight and never interact with the operating status. Similarly, an
14532 agent could be designed as an end-user interface with 3 radio buttons
14533 allowing an administrator to change only the administrative state. However,
14534 it is important to consider that only the agent may revert its own actions,
14535 so if a server is set to DRAIN mode or to DOWN state using the agent, the
14536 agent must implement the other equivalent actions to bring the service into
14537 operations again.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014538
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090014539 Failure to connect to the agent is not considered an error as connectivity
14540 is tested by the regular health check which is enabled by the "check"
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014541 parameter. Warning though, it is not a good idea to stop an agent after it
14542 reports "down", since only an agent reporting "up" will be able to turn the
14543 server up again. Note that the CLI on the Unix stats socket is also able to
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +010014544 force an agent's result in order to work around a bogus agent if needed.
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090014545
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014546 Requires the "agent-port" parameter to be set. See also the "agent-inter"
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014547 and "no-agent-check" parameters.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014548
James Brown55f9ff12015-10-21 18:19:05 -070014549agent-send <string>
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040014550 If this option is specified, HAProxy will send the given string (verbatim)
James Brown55f9ff12015-10-21 18:19:05 -070014551 to the agent server upon connection. You could, for example, encode
14552 the backend name into this string, which would enable your agent to send
14553 different responses based on the backend. Make sure to include a '\n' if
14554 you want to terminate your request with a newline.
14555
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014556agent-inter <delay>
14557 The "agent-inter" parameter sets the interval between two agent checks
14558 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
14559
14560 Just as with every other time-based parameter, it may be entered in any
14561 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "agent-inter"
14562 parameter also serves as a timeout for agent checks "timeout check" is
14563 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
14564 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
14565 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
14566 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
14567 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
14568 of backends use the same servers.
14569
14570 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-port" parameters.
14571
Misiek768d8602017-01-09 09:52:43 +010014572agent-addr <addr>
14573 The "agent-addr" parameter sets address for agent check.
14574
14575 You can offload agent-check to another target, so you can make single place
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040014576 managing status and weights of servers defined in HAProxy in case you can't
Misiek768d8602017-01-09 09:52:43 +010014577 make self-aware and self-managing services. You can specify both IP or
14578 hostname, it will be resolved.
14579
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014580agent-port <port>
14581 The "agent-port" parameter sets the TCP port used for agent checks.
14582
14583 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-inter" parameters.
14584
Olivier Houchard8cb2d2e2019-05-06 18:58:48 +020014585allow-0rtt
14586 Allow sending early data to the server when using TLS 1.3.
Olivier Houchard22c9b442019-05-06 19:01:04 +020014587 Note that early data will be sent only if the client used early data, or
14588 if the backend uses "retry-on" with the "0rtt-rejected" keyword.
Olivier Houchard8cb2d2e2019-05-06 18:58:48 +020014589
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010014590alpn <protocols>
14591 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
14592 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
14593 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014594 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010014595 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
14596 initial NPN extension. ALPN is required to connect to HTTP/2 servers.
14597 Versions of OpenSSL prior to 1.0.2 didn't support ALPN and only supposed the
14598 now obsolete NPN extension.
14599 If both HTTP/2 and HTTP/1.1 are expected to be supported, both versions can
14600 be advertised, in order of preference, like below :
14601
14602 server 127.0.0.1:443 ssl crt pub.pem alpn h2,http/1.1
14603
Amaury Denoyellef9d59572021-10-18 14:40:29 +020014604 See also "ws" to use an alternative ALPN for websocket streams.
14605
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014606backup
14607 When "backup" is present on a server line, the server is only used in load
14608 balancing when all other non-backup servers are unavailable. Requests coming
14609 with a persistence cookie referencing the server will always be served
14610 though. By default, only the first operational backup server is used, unless
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014611 the "allbackups" option is set in the backend. See also the "no-backup" and
14612 "allbackups" options.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014613
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020014614ca-file <cafile>
14615 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
14616 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
William Lallemand34107802022-04-01 23:49:11 +020014617 server's certificate. It is possible to load a directory containing multiple
14618 CAs, in this case HAProxy will try to load every ".pem", ".crt", ".cer", and
William Lallemande4b93eb2022-05-09 09:29:00 +020014619 .crl" available in the directory, files starting with a dot are ignored.
William Lallemand34107802022-04-01 23:49:11 +020014620
14621 In order to use the trusted CAs of your system, the "@system-ca" parameter
14622 could be used in place of the cafile. The location of this directory could be
14623 overwritten by setting the SSL_CERT_DIR environment variable.
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020014624
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014625check
Jerome Magnin90702bc2020-04-26 14:23:04 +020014626 This option enables health checks on a server:
14627 - when not set, no health checking is performed, and the server is always
14628 considered available.
14629 - when set and no other check method is configured, the server is considered
14630 available when a connection can be established at the highest configured
14631 transport layer. This means TCP by default, or SSL/TLS when "ssl" or
14632 "check-ssl" are set, both possibly combined with connection prefixes such
14633 as a PROXY protocol header when "send-proxy" or "check-send-proxy" are
Amaury Denoyelle7d098be2022-03-09 14:20:10 +010014634 set. This behavior is slightly different for dynamic servers, read the
14635 following paragraphs for more details.
Jerome Magnin90702bc2020-04-26 14:23:04 +020014636 - when set and an application-level health check is defined, the
14637 application-level exchanges are performed on top of the configured
14638 transport layer and the server is considered available if all of the
14639 exchanges succeed.
14640
14641 By default, health checks are performed on the same address and port as
14642 configured on the server, using the same encapsulation parameters (SSL/TLS,
14643 proxy-protocol header, etc... ). It is possible to change the destination
14644 address using "addr" and the port using "port". When done, it is assumed the
14645 server isn't checked on the service port, and configured encapsulation
Ilya Shipitsin4329a9a2020-05-05 21:17:10 +050014646 parameters are not reused. One must explicitly set "check-send-proxy" to send
Jerome Magnin90702bc2020-04-26 14:23:04 +020014647 connection headers, "check-ssl" to use SSL/TLS.
14648
Amaury Denoyelle7d098be2022-03-09 14:20:10 +010014649 Note that the implicit configuration of ssl and PROXY protocol is not
14650 performed for dynamic servers. In this case, it is required to explicitely
14651 use "check-ssl" and "check-send-proxy" when wanted, even if the check port is
14652 not overridden.
14653
Jerome Magnin90702bc2020-04-26 14:23:04 +020014654 When "sni" or "alpn" are set on the server line, their value is not used for
14655 health checks and one must use "check-sni" or "check-alpn".
14656
14657 The default source address for health check traffic is the same as the one
14658 defined in the backend. It can be changed with the "source" keyword.
14659
14660 The interval between checks can be set using the "inter" keyword, and the
14661 "rise" and "fall" keywords can be used to define how many successful or
14662 failed health checks are required to flag a server available or not
14663 available.
14664
14665 Optional application-level health checks can be configured with "option
14666 httpchk", "option mysql-check" "option smtpchk", "option pgsql-check",
14667 "option ldap-check", or "option redis-check".
14668
14669 Example:
14670 # simple tcp check
14671 backend foo
14672 server s1 192.168.0.1:80 check
14673 # this does a tcp connect + tls handshake
14674 backend foo
14675 server s1 192.168.0.1:443 ssl check
14676 # simple tcp check is enough for check success
14677 backend foo
14678 option tcp-check
14679 tcp-check connect
14680 server s1 192.168.0.1:443 ssl check
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014681
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +020014682check-send-proxy
14683 This option forces emission of a PROXY protocol line with outgoing health
14684 checks, regardless of whether the server uses send-proxy or not for the
14685 normal traffic. By default, the PROXY protocol is enabled for health checks
14686 if it is already enabled for normal traffic and if no "port" nor "addr"
14687 directive is present. However, if such a directive is present, the
14688 "check-send-proxy" option needs to be used to force the use of the
14689 protocol. See also the "send-proxy" option for more information.
14690
Olivier Houchard92150142018-12-21 19:47:01 +010014691check-alpn <protocols>
14692 Defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol list consists in
14693 a comma-delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0"
14694 (without quotes). If it is not set, the server ALPN is used.
14695
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020014696check-proto <name>
14697 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the server's health-check
14698 connections. It must be compatible with the health-check type (TCP or
14699 HTTP). It must also be usable on the backend side. The list of available
Christopher Faulet982e17d2021-03-26 14:44:18 +010014700 protocols is reported in haproxy -vv. The protocols properties are
14701 reported : the mode (TCP/HTTP), the side (FE/BE), the mux name and its flags.
14702
Christopher Fauleta97cced2022-04-12 18:04:10 +020014703 Some protocols are subject to the head-of-line blocking on server side
14704 (flag=HOL_RISK). Finally some protocols don't support upgrades (flag=NO_UPG).
14705 The HTX compatibility is also reported (flag=HTX).
Christopher Faulet982e17d2021-03-26 14:44:18 +010014706
14707 Here are the protocols that may be used as argument to a "check-proto"
14708 directive on a server line:
14709
Christopher Fauleta97cced2022-04-12 18:04:10 +020014710 h2 : mode=HTTP side=FE|BE mux=H2 flags=HTX|HOL_RISK|NO_UPG
Christopher Faulet982e17d2021-03-26 14:44:18 +010014711 fcgi : mode=HTTP side=BE mux=FCGI flags=HTX|HOL_RISK|NO_UPG
14712 h1 : mode=HTTP side=FE|BE mux=H1 flags=HTX|NO_UPG
14713 none : mode=TCP side=FE|BE mux=PASS flags=NO_UPG
14714
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040014715 Idea behind this option is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020014716 protocol for health-check connections established to this server.
14717 If not defined, the server one will be used, if set.
14718
Jérôme Magninae9bb762018-12-09 16:08:26 +010014719check-sni <sni>
Olivier Houchard9130a962017-10-17 17:33:43 +020014720 This option allows you to specify the SNI to be used when doing health checks
Jérôme Magninae9bb762018-12-09 16:08:26 +010014721 over SSL. It is only possible to use a string to set <sni>. If you want to
14722 set a SNI for proxied traffic, see "sni".
Olivier Houchard9130a962017-10-17 17:33:43 +020014723
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020014724check-ssl
14725 This option forces encryption of all health checks over SSL, regardless of
14726 whether the server uses SSL or not for the normal traffic. This is generally
14727 used when an explicit "port" or "addr" directive is specified and SSL health
14728 checks are not inherited. It is important to understand that this option
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014729 inserts an SSL transport layer below the checks, so that a simple TCP connect
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020014730 check becomes an SSL connect, which replaces the old ssl-hello-chk. The most
14731 common use is to send HTTPS checks by combining "httpchk" with SSL checks.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014732 All SSL settings are common to health checks and traffic (e.g. ciphers).
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014733 See the "ssl" option for more information and "no-check-ssl" to disable
14734 this option.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020014735
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080014736check-via-socks4
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014737 This option enables outgoing health checks using upstream socks4 proxy. By
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080014738 default, the health checks won't go through socks tunnel even it was enabled
14739 for normal traffic.
14740
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020014741ciphers <ciphers>
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020014742 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. This
14743 option sets the string describing the list of cipher algorithms that is
14744 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server. The format of the
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000014745 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
14746 information and recommendations see e.g.
14747 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
14748 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
14749 cipher configuration, please check the "ciphersuites" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020014750
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020014751ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
14752 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
14753 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. This option sets the string
14754 describing the list of cipher algorithms that is negotiated during the TLS
14755 1.3 handshake with the server. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000014756 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the "ciphersuites" section.
14757 For cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the "ciphers"
14758 keyword.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020014759
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014760cookie <value>
14761 The "cookie" parameter sets the cookie value assigned to the server to
14762 <value>. This value will be checked in incoming requests, and the first
14763 operational server possessing the same value will be selected. In return, in
14764 cookie insertion or rewrite modes, this value will be assigned to the cookie
14765 sent to the client. There is nothing wrong in having several servers sharing
14766 the same cookie value, and it is in fact somewhat common between normal and
14767 backup servers. See also the "cookie" keyword in backend section.
14768
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020014769crl-file <crlfile>
14770 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
14771 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
14772 to verify server's certificate.
14773
Emeric Bruna7aa3092012-10-26 12:58:00 +020014774crt <cert>
14775 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
14776 It designates a PEM file from which to load both a certificate and the
14777 associated private key. This file can be built by concatenating both PEM
14778 files into one. This certificate will be sent if the server send a client
14779 certificate request.
14780
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +020014781 If the file does not contain a private key, HAProxy will try to load the key
14782 at the same path suffixed by a ".key" (provided the "ssl-load-extra-files"
14783 option is set accordingly).
14784
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020014785disabled
14786 The "disabled" keyword starts the server in the "disabled" state. That means
14787 that it is marked down in maintenance mode, and no connection other than the
14788 ones allowed by persist mode will reach it. It is very well suited to setup
14789 new servers, because normal traffic will never reach them, while it is still
14790 possible to test the service by making use of the force-persist mechanism.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014791 See also "enabled" setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020014792
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014793enabled
14794 This option may be used as 'server' setting to reset any 'disabled'
14795 setting which would have been inherited from 'default-server' directive as
14796 default value.
14797 It may also be used as 'default-server' setting to reset any previous
14798 'default-server' 'disabled' setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020014799
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014800error-limit <count>
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +010014801 If health observing is enabled, the "error-limit" parameter specifies the
14802 number of consecutive errors that triggers event selected by the "on-error"
14803 option. By default it is set to 10 consecutive errors.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010014804
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014805 See also the "check", "error-limit" and "on-error".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010014806
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014807fall <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014808 The "fall" parameter states that a server will be considered as dead after
14809 <count> consecutive unsuccessful health checks. This value defaults to 3 if
14810 unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "rise" parameters.
14811
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014812force-sslv3
14813 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
14814 the server. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts for
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014815 high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014816 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014817
14818force-tlsv10
14819 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014820 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014821 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014822
14823force-tlsv11
14824 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014825 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014826 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014827
14828force-tlsv12
14829 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014830 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014831 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014832
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020014833force-tlsv13
14834 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
14835 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014836 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020014837
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014838id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +020014839 Set a persistent ID for the server. This ID must be positive and unique for
14840 the proxy. An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first
14841 assigned value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014842
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010014843init-addr {last | libc | none | <ip>},[...]*
14844 Indicate in what order the server's address should be resolved upon startup
14845 if it uses an FQDN. Attempts are made to resolve the address by applying in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014846 turn each of the methods mentioned in the comma-delimited list. The first
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010014847 method which succeeds is used. If the end of the list is reached without
14848 finding a working method, an error is thrown. Method "last" suggests to pick
14849 the address which appears in the state file (see "server-state-file"). Method
14850 "libc" uses the libc's internal resolver (gethostbyname() or getaddrinfo()
14851 depending on the operating system and build options). Method "none"
14852 specifically indicates that the server should start without any valid IP
14853 address in a down state. It can be useful to ignore some DNS issues upon
14854 startup, waiting for the situation to get fixed later. Finally, an IP address
14855 (IPv4 or IPv6) may be provided. It can be the currently known address of the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014856 server (e.g. filled by a configuration generator), or the address of a dummy
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010014857 server used to catch old sessions and present them with a decent error
14858 message for example. When the "first" load balancing algorithm is used, this
14859 IP address could point to a fake server used to trigger the creation of new
14860 instances on the fly. This option defaults to "last,libc" indicating that the
14861 previous address found in the state file (if any) is used first, otherwise
14862 the libc's resolver is used. This ensures continued compatibility with the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014863 historic behavior.
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010014864
14865 Example:
14866 defaults
14867 # never fail on address resolution
14868 default-server init-addr last,libc,none
14869
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014870inter <delay>
14871fastinter <delay>
14872downinter <delay>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014873 The "inter" parameter sets the interval between two consecutive health checks
14874 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
14875 It is also possible to use "fastinter" and "downinter" to optimize delays
14876 between checks depending on the server state :
14877
Pieter Baauw44fc9df2015-09-17 21:30:46 +020014878 Server state | Interval used
14879 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
14880 UP 100% (non-transitional) | "inter"
14881 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
14882 Transitionally UP (going down "fall"), | "fastinter" if set,
14883 Transitionally DOWN (going up "rise"), | "inter" otherwise.
14884 or yet unchecked. |
14885 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
14886 DOWN 100% (non-transitional) | "downinter" if set,
14887 | "inter" otherwise.
14888 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010014889
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014890 Just as with every other time-based parameter, they can be entered in any
14891 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "inter" parameter also
14892 serves as a timeout for health checks sent to servers if "timeout check" is
14893 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014894 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
14895 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
14896 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
14897 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
14898 of backends use the same servers.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014899
Emeric Brun97556472020-05-30 01:42:45 +020014900log-proto <logproto>
14901 The "log-proto" specifies the protocol used to forward event messages to
14902 a server configured in a ring section. Possible values are "legacy"
14903 and "octet-count" corresponding respectively to "Non-transparent-framing"
14904 and "Octet counting" in rfc6587. "legacy" is the default.
14905
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014906maxconn <maxconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014907 The "maxconn" parameter specifies the maximal number of concurrent
14908 connections that will be sent to this server. If the number of incoming
Tim Duesterhuscefbbd92019-11-27 22:35:27 +010014909 concurrent connections goes higher than this value, they will be queued,
14910 waiting for a slot to be released. This parameter is very important as it can
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014911 save fragile servers from going down under extreme loads. If a "minconn"
14912 parameter is specified, the limit becomes dynamic. The default value is "0"
14913 which means unlimited. See also the "minconn" and "maxqueue" parameters, and
14914 the backend's "fullconn" keyword.
14915
Tim Duesterhuscefbbd92019-11-27 22:35:27 +010014916 In HTTP mode this parameter limits the number of concurrent requests instead
14917 of the number of connections. Multiple requests might be multiplexed over a
14918 single TCP connection to the server. As an example if you specify a maxconn
14919 of 50 you might see between 1 and 50 actual server connections, but no more
14920 than 50 concurrent requests.
14921
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014922maxqueue <maxqueue>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014923 The "maxqueue" parameter specifies the maximal number of connections which
14924 will wait in the queue for this server. If this limit is reached, next
14925 requests will be redispatched to other servers instead of indefinitely
14926 waiting to be served. This will break persistence but may allow people to
Willy Tarreau8ae8c482020-10-22 17:19:07 +020014927 quickly re-log in when the server they try to connect to is dying. Some load
14928 balancing algorithms such as leastconn take this into account and accept to
14929 add requests into a server's queue up to this value if it is explicitly set
14930 to a value greater than zero, which often allows to better smooth the load
14931 when dealing with single-digit maxconn values. The default value is "0" which
14932 means the queue is unlimited. See also the "maxconn" and "minconn" parameters
14933 and "balance leastconn".
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014934
Willy Tarreau9c538e02019-01-23 10:21:49 +010014935max-reuse <count>
14936 The "max-reuse" argument indicates the HTTP connection processors that they
14937 should not reuse a server connection more than this number of times to send
14938 new requests. Permitted values are -1 (the default), which disables this
14939 limit, or any positive value. Value zero will effectively disable keep-alive.
14940 This is only used to work around certain server bugs which cause them to leak
14941 resources over time. The argument is not necessarily respected by the lower
14942 layers as there might be technical limitations making it impossible to
14943 enforce. At least HTTP/2 connections to servers will respect it.
14944
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014945minconn <minconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014946 When the "minconn" parameter is set, the maxconn limit becomes a dynamic
14947 limit following the backend's load. The server will always accept at least
14948 <minconn> connections, never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on
14949 the ramp between both values when the backend has less than <fullconn>
14950 concurrent connections. This makes it possible to limit the load on the
14951 server during normal loads, but push it further for important loads without
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010014952 overloading the server during exceptional loads. See also the "maxconn"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014953 and "maxqueue" parameters, as well as the "fullconn" backend keyword.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010014954
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020014955namespace <name>
14956 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
14957 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a server to
14958 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
14959 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
14960
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014961no-agent-check
14962 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "agent-check"
14963 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14964 default value.
14965 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14966 "default-server" "agent-check" setting.
14967
14968no-backup
14969 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "backup"
14970 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14971 default value.
14972 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14973 "default-server" "backup" setting.
14974
14975no-check
14976 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check"
14977 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14978 default value.
14979 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14980 "default-server" "check" setting.
14981
14982no-check-ssl
14983 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check-ssl"
14984 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14985 default value.
14986 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14987 "default-server" "check-ssl" setting.
14988
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014989no-send-proxy
14990 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy"
14991 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14992 default value.
14993 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14994 "default-server" "send-proxy" setting.
14995
14996no-send-proxy-v2
14997 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2"
14998 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14999 default value.
15000 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
15001 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2" setting.
15002
15003no-send-proxy-v2-ssl
15004 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl"
15005 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
15006 default value.
15007 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
15008 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl" setting.
15009
15010no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
15011 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn"
15012 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
15013 default value.
15014 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
15015 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" setting.
15016
15017no-ssl
15018 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "ssl"
15019 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
15020 default value.
15021 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
15022 "default-server" "ssl" setting.
15023
William Dauchyf6370442020-11-14 19:25:33 +010015024 Note that using `default-server ssl` setting and `no-ssl` on server will
15025 however init SSL connection, so it can be later be enabled through the
15026 runtime API: see `set server` commands in management doc.
15027
Willy Tarreau2a3fb1c2015-02-05 16:47:07 +010015028no-ssl-reuse
15029 This option disables SSL session reuse when SSL is used to communicate with
15030 the server. It will force the server to perform a full handshake for every
15031 new connection. It's probably only useful for benchmarking, troubleshooting,
15032 and for paranoid users.
15033
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020015034no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020015035 This option disables support for SSLv3 when SSL is used to communicate with
15036 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020015037 using any configuration option. Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020015038
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020015039 Supported in default-server: No
15040
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020015041no-tls-tickets
15042 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
15043 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
15044 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010015045 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage for servers. This option
15046 is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Lukas Tribusbdb386d2020-03-10 00:56:09 +010015047 The TLS ticket mechanism is only used up to TLS 1.2.
15048 Forward Secrecy is compromised with TLS tickets, unless ticket keys
15049 are periodically rotated (via reload or by using "tls-ticket-keys").
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010015050 See also "tls-tickets".
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020015051
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020015052no-tlsv10
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020015053 This option disables support for TLSv1.0 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020015054 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
15055 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010015056 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
15057 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020015058 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020015059
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020015060 Supported in default-server: No
15061
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020015062no-tlsv11
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020015063 This option disables support for TLSv1.1 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020015064 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
15065 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010015066 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
15067 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020015068 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020015069
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020015070 Supported in default-server: No
15071
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020015072no-tlsv12
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020015073 This option disables support for TLSv1.2 when SSL is used to communicate with
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020015074 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
15075 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010015076 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
15077 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020015078 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020015079
15080 Supported in default-server: No
15081
15082no-tlsv13
15083 This option disables support for TLSv1.3 when SSL is used to communicate with
15084 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
15085 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
15086 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
15087 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020015088 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020015089
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020015090 Supported in default-server: No
15091
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010015092no-verifyhost
15093 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "verifyhost"
15094 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
15095 default value.
15096 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
15097 "default-server" "verifyhost" setting.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020015098
Frédéric Lécaille1b9423d2019-07-04 14:19:06 +020015099no-tfo
15100 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "tfo"
15101 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
15102 default value.
15103 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
15104 "default-server" "tfo" setting.
15105
Simon Hormanfa461682011-06-25 09:39:49 +090015106non-stick
15107 Never add connections allocated to this sever to a stick-table.
15108 This may be used in conjunction with backup to ensure that
15109 stick-table persistence is disabled for backup servers.
15110
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010015111npn <protocols>
15112 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
15113 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
15114 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050015115 This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010015116 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
15117 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword), though this one is
15118 only available starting with OpenSSL 1.0.2.
15119
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010015120observe <mode>
15121 This option enables health adjusting based on observing communication with
15122 the server. By default this functionality is disabled and enabling it also
15123 requires to enable health checks. There are two supported modes: "layer4" and
15124 "layer7". In layer4 mode, only successful/unsuccessful tcp connections are
15125 significant. In layer7, which is only allowed for http proxies, responses
15126 received from server are verified, like valid/wrong http code, unparsable
Willy Tarreau150d1462012-03-10 08:19:02 +010015127 headers, a timeout, etc. Valid status codes include 100 to 499, 501 and 505.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010015128
15129 See also the "check", "on-error" and "error-limit".
15130
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010015131on-error <mode>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010015132 Select what should happen when enough consecutive errors are detected.
15133 Currently, four modes are available:
15134 - fastinter: force fastinter
15135 - fail-check: simulate a failed check, also forces fastinter (default)
15136 - sudden-death: simulate a pre-fatal failed health check, one more failed
15137 check will mark a server down, forces fastinter
15138 - mark-down: mark the server immediately down and force fastinter
15139
15140 See also the "check", "observe" and "error-limit".
15141
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090015142on-marked-down <action>
15143 Modify what occurs when a server is marked down.
15144 Currently one action is available:
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070015145 - shutdown-sessions: Shutdown peer sessions. When this setting is enabled,
15146 all connections to the server are immediately terminated when the server
15147 goes down. It might be used if the health check detects more complex cases
15148 than a simple connection status, and long timeouts would cause the service
15149 to remain unresponsive for too long a time. For instance, a health check
15150 might detect that a database is stuck and that there's no chance to reuse
15151 existing connections anymore. Connections killed this way are logged with
15152 a 'D' termination code (for "Down").
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090015153
15154 Actions are disabled by default
15155
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070015156on-marked-up <action>
15157 Modify what occurs when a server is marked up.
15158 Currently one action is available:
15159 - shutdown-backup-sessions: Shutdown sessions on all backup servers. This is
15160 done only if the server is not in backup state and if it is not disabled
15161 (it must have an effective weight > 0). This can be used sometimes to force
15162 an active server to take all the traffic back after recovery when dealing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015163 with long sessions (e.g. LDAP, SQL, ...). Doing this can cause more trouble
15164 than it tries to solve (e.g. incomplete transactions), so use this feature
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070015165 with extreme care. Sessions killed because a server comes up are logged
15166 with an 'U' termination code (for "Up").
15167
15168 Actions are disabled by default
15169
Willy Tarreau2f3f4d32020-07-01 07:43:51 +020015170pool-low-conn <max>
15171 Set a low threshold on the number of idling connections for a server, below
15172 which a thread will not try to steal a connection from another thread. This
15173 can be useful to improve CPU usage patterns in scenarios involving many very
15174 fast servers, in order to ensure all threads will keep a few idle connections
15175 all the time instead of letting them accumulate over one thread and migrating
15176 them from thread to thread. Typical values of twice the number of threads
15177 seem to show very good performance already with sub-millisecond response
15178 times. The default is zero, indicating that any idle connection can be used
15179 at any time. It is the recommended setting for normal use. This only applies
15180 to connections that can be shared according to the same principles as those
Willy Tarreau0784db82021-02-19 11:45:22 +010015181 applying to "http-reuse". In case connection sharing between threads would
15182 be disabled via "tune.idle-pool.shared", it can become very important to use
15183 this setting to make sure each thread always has a few connections, or the
15184 connection reuse rate will decrease as thread count increases.
Willy Tarreau2f3f4d32020-07-01 07:43:51 +020015185
Olivier Houchard006e3102018-12-10 18:30:32 +010015186pool-max-conn <max>
15187 Set the maximum number of idling connections for a server. -1 means unlimited
15188 connections, 0 means no idle connections. The default is -1. When idle
15189 connections are enabled, orphaned idle connections which do not belong to any
15190 client session anymore are moved to a dedicated pool so that they remain
15191 usable by future clients. This only applies to connections that can be shared
15192 according to the same principles as those applying to "http-reuse".
15193
Olivier Houchardb7b3faa2018-12-14 18:15:36 +010015194pool-purge-delay <delay>
15195 Sets the delay to start purging idle connections. Each <delay> interval, half
Olivier Houcharda56eebf2019-03-19 16:44:02 +010015196 of the idle connections are closed. 0 means we don't keep any idle connection.
Willy Tarreaufb553652019-06-04 14:06:31 +020015197 The default is 5s.
Olivier Houchardb7b3faa2018-12-14 18:15:36 +010015198
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010015199port <port>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015200 Using the "port" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different port to
William Dauchy4858fb22021-02-03 22:30:09 +010015201 send health-checks or to probe the agent-check. On some servers, it may be
15202 desirable to dedicate a port to a specific component able to perform complex
15203 tests which are more suitable to health-checks than the application. It is
15204 common to run a simple script in inetd for instance. This parameter is
15205 ignored if the "check" parameter is not set. See also the "addr" parameter.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015206
Christopher Faulet8ed0a3e2018-04-10 14:45:45 +020015207proto <name>
Christopher Faulet8ed0a3e2018-04-10 14:45:45 +020015208 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the outgoing connections to this
15209 server. It must be compatible with the mode of the backend (TCP or HTTP). It
15210 must also be usable on the backend side. The list of available protocols is
Christopher Faulet982e17d2021-03-26 14:44:18 +010015211 reported in haproxy -vv.The protocols properties are reported : the mode
15212 (TCP/HTTP), the side (FE/BE), the mux name and its flags.
15213
Christopher Fauleta97cced2022-04-12 18:04:10 +020015214 Some protocols are subject to the head-of-line blocking on server side
15215 (flag=HOL_RISK). Finally some protocols don't support upgrades (flag=NO_UPG).
15216 The HTX compatibility is also reported (flag=HTX).
Christopher Faulet982e17d2021-03-26 14:44:18 +010015217
15218 Here are the protocols that may be used as argument to a "proto" directive on
15219 a server line :
15220
Christopher Fauleta97cced2022-04-12 18:04:10 +020015221 h2 : mode=HTTP side=FE|BE mux=H2 flags=HTX|HOL_RISK|NO_UPG
Christopher Faulet982e17d2021-03-26 14:44:18 +010015222 fcgi : mode=HTTP side=BE mux=FCGI flags=HTX|HOL_RISK|NO_UPG
15223 h1 : mode=HTTP side=FE|BE mux=H1 flags=HTX|NO_UPG
15224 none : mode=TCP side=FE|BE mux=PASS flags=NO_UPG
15225
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040015226 Idea behind this option is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
Christopher Faulet8ed0a3e2018-04-10 14:45:45 +020015227 protocol for all connections established to this server.
15228
Amaury Denoyellef9d59572021-10-18 14:40:29 +020015229 See also "ws" to use an alternative protocol for websocket streams.
15230
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015231redir <prefix>
15232 The "redir" parameter enables the redirection mode for all GET and HEAD
15233 requests addressing this server. This means that instead of having HAProxy
15234 forward the request to the server, it will send an "HTTP 302" response with
15235 the "Location" header composed of this prefix immediately followed by the
15236 requested URI beginning at the leading '/' of the path component. That means
15237 that no trailing slash should be used after <prefix>. All invalid requests
15238 will be rejected, and all non-GET or HEAD requests will be normally served by
15239 the server. Note that since the response is completely forged, no header
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010015240 mangling nor cookie insertion is possible in the response. However, cookies in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015241 requests are still analyzed, making this solution completely usable to direct
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015242 users to a remote location in case of local disaster. Main use consists in
15243 increasing bandwidth for static servers by having the clients directly
15244 connect to them. Note: never use a relative location here, it would cause a
15245 loop between the client and HAProxy!
15246
15247 Example : server srv1 192.168.1.1:80 redir http://image1.mydomain.com check
15248
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010015249rise <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015250 The "rise" parameter states that a server will be considered as operational
15251 after <count> consecutive successful health checks. This value defaults to 2
15252 if unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "fall" parameters.
15253
Baptiste Assmann8e2d9432018-06-22 15:04:43 +020015254resolve-opts <option>,<option>,...
15255 Comma separated list of options to apply to DNS resolution linked to this
15256 server.
15257
15258 Available options:
15259
15260 * allow-dup-ip
15261 By default, HAProxy prevents IP address duplication in a backend when DNS
15262 resolution at runtime is in operation.
15263 That said, for some cases, it makes sense that two servers (in the same
15264 backend, being resolved by the same FQDN) have the same IP address.
15265 For such case, simply enable this option.
15266 This is the opposite of prevent-dup-ip.
15267
Daniel Corbettf8716912019-11-17 09:48:56 -050015268 * ignore-weight
15269 Ignore any weight that is set within an SRV record. This is useful when
15270 you would like to control the weights using an alternate method, such as
15271 using an "agent-check" or through the runtime api.
15272
Baptiste Assmann8e2d9432018-06-22 15:04:43 +020015273 * prevent-dup-ip
15274 Ensure HAProxy's default behavior is enforced on a server: prevent re-using
15275 an IP address already set to a server in the same backend and sharing the
15276 same fqdn.
15277 This is the opposite of allow-dup-ip.
15278
15279 Example:
15280 backend b_myapp
15281 default-server init-addr none resolvers dns
15282 server s1 myapp.example.com:80 check resolve-opts allow-dup-ip
15283 server s2 myapp.example.com:81 check resolve-opts allow-dup-ip
15284
15285 With the option allow-dup-ip set:
15286 * if the nameserver returns a single IP address, then both servers will use
15287 it
15288 * If the nameserver returns 2 IP addresses, then each server will pick up a
15289 different address
15290
15291 Default value: not set
15292
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015293resolve-prefer <family>
15294 When DNS resolution is enabled for a server and multiple IP addresses from
15295 different families are returned, HAProxy will prefer using an IP address
15296 from the family mentioned in the "resolve-prefer" parameter.
15297 Available families: "ipv4" and "ipv6"
15298
Baptiste Assmannc4aabae2015-08-04 22:43:06 +020015299 Default value: ipv6
15300
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020015301 Example:
15302
15303 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-prefer ipv6
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015304
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010015305resolve-net <network>[,<network[,...]]
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050015306 This option prioritizes the choice of an ip address matching a network. This is
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010015307 useful with clouds to prefer a local ip. In some cases, a cloud high
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010015308 availability service can be announced with many ip addresses on many
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015309 different datacenters. The latency between datacenter is not negligible, so
15310 this patch permits to prefer a local datacenter. If no address matches the
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010015311 configured network, another address is selected.
15312
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020015313 Example:
15314
15315 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-net 10.0.0.0/8
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010015316
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015317resolvers <id>
15318 Points to an existing "resolvers" section to resolve current server's
15319 hostname.
15320
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020015321 Example:
15322
15323 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 check resolvers mydns
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015324
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020015325 See also section 5.3
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015326
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010015327send-proxy
15328 The "send-proxy" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol over any
15329 connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs the other
15330 end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so that it can
15331 know the client's address or the public address it accessed to, whatever the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010015332 upper layer protocol. For connections accepted by an "accept-proxy" or
15333 "accept-netscaler-cip" listener, the advertised address will be used. Only
15334 TCPv4 and TCPv6 address families are supported. Other families such as
15335 Unix sockets, will report an UNKNOWN family. Servers using this option can
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040015336 fully be chained to another instance of HAProxy listening with an
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010015337 "accept-proxy" setting. This setting must not be used if the server isn't
15338 aware of the protocol. When health checks are sent to the server, the PROXY
15339 protocol is automatically used when this option is set, unless there is an
15340 explicit "port" or "addr" directive, in which case an explicit
15341 "check-send-proxy" directive would also be needed to use the PROXY protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010015342 See also the "no-send-proxy" option of this section and "accept-proxy" and
15343 "accept-netscaler-cip" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010015344
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040015345send-proxy-v2
15346 The "send-proxy-v2" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version 2
15347 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
15348 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
15349 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
Emmanuel Hocdet404d9782017-10-24 10:55:14 +020015350 whatever the upper layer protocol. It also send ALPN information if an alpn
15351 have been negotiated. This setting must not be used if the server isn't aware
15352 of this version of the protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2" option of
15353 this section and send-proxy" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040015354
Emmanuel Hocdetf643b802018-02-01 15:20:32 +010015355proxy-v2-options <option>[,<option>]*
Tim Duesterhuscf6e0c82020-03-13 12:34:24 +010015356 The "proxy-v2-options" parameter add options to send in PROXY protocol
15357 version 2 when "send-proxy-v2" is used. Options available are:
15358
15359 - ssl : See also "send-proxy-v2-ssl".
15360 - cert-cn : See also "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn".
15361 - ssl-cipher: Name of the used cipher.
15362 - cert-sig : Signature algorithm of the used certificate.
15363 - cert-key : Key algorithm of the used certificate
15364 - authority : Host name value passed by the client (only SNI from a TLS
15365 connection is supported).
15366 - crc32c : Checksum of the PROXYv2 header.
15367 - unique-id : Send a unique ID generated using the frontend's
15368 "unique-id-format" within the PROXYv2 header.
15369 This unique-id is primarily meant for "mode tcp". It can
15370 lead to unexpected results in "mode http", because the
15371 generated unique ID is also used for the first HTTP request
15372 within a Keep-Alive connection.
Emmanuel Hocdetf643b802018-02-01 15:20:32 +010015373
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040015374send-proxy-v2-ssl
15375 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
15376 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
15377 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
15378 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
15379 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
15380 of the PROXY protocol is added to the PROXY protocol header. This setting
15381 must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010015382 See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl" option of this section and the
15383 "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040015384
15385send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
15386 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
15387 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
15388 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
15389 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
15390 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
15391 of the PROXY protocol, along along with the Common Name from the subject of
15392 the client certificate (if any), is added to the PROXY protocol header. This
15393 setting must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015394 protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" option of this section and
15395 the "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040015396
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010015397slowstart <start_time_in_ms>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015398 The "slowstart" parameter for a server accepts a value in milliseconds which
15399 indicates after how long a server which has just come back up will run at
15400 full speed. Just as with every other time-based parameter, it can be entered
15401 in any other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The speed grows
15402 linearly from 0 to 100% during this time. The limitation applies to two
15403 parameters :
15404
15405 - maxconn: the number of connections accepted by the server will grow from 1
15406 to 100% of the usual dynamic limit defined by (minconn,maxconn,fullconn).
15407
15408 - weight: when the backend uses a dynamic weighted algorithm, the weight
15409 grows linearly from 1 to 100%. In this case, the weight is updated at every
15410 health-check. For this reason, it is important that the "inter" parameter
15411 is smaller than the "slowstart", in order to maximize the number of steps.
15412
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040015413 The slowstart never applies when HAProxy starts, otherwise it would cause
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015414 trouble to running servers. It only applies when a server has been previously
15415 seen as failed.
15416
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020015417sni <expression>
15418 The "sni" parameter evaluates the sample fetch expression, converts it to a
15419 string and uses the result as the host name sent in the SNI TLS extension to
15420 the server. A typical use case is to send the SNI received from the client in
15421 a bridged HTTPS scenario, using the "ssl_fc_sni" sample fetch for the
Willy Tarreau2ab88672017-07-05 18:23:03 +020015422 expression, though alternatives such as req.hdr(host) can also make sense. If
15423 "verify required" is set (which is the recommended setting), the resulting
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020015424 name will also be matched against the server certificate's names. See the
Jérôme Magninb36a6d22018-12-09 16:03:40 +010015425 "verify" directive for more details. If you want to set a SNI for health
15426 checks, see the "check-sni" directive for more details.
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020015427
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020015428source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020015429source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020015430source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [interface <name>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015431 The "source" parameter sets the source address which will be used when
15432 connecting to the server. It follows the exact same parameters and principle
15433 as the backend "source" keyword, except that it only applies to the server
15434 referencing it. Please consult the "source" keyword for details.
15435
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020015436 Additionally, the "source" statement on a server line allows one to specify a
15437 source port range by indicating the lower and higher bounds delimited by a
15438 dash ('-'). Some operating systems might require a valid IP address when a
15439 source port range is specified. It is permitted to have the same IP/range for
15440 several servers. Doing so makes it possible to bypass the maximum of 64k
15441 total concurrent connections. The limit will then reach 64k connections per
15442 server.
15443
Lukas Tribus7d56c6d2016-09-13 09:51:15 +000015444 Since Linux 4.2/libc 2.23 IP_BIND_ADDRESS_NO_PORT is set for connections
15445 specifying the source address without port(s).
15446
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020015447ssl
Willy Tarreau44f65392013-06-25 07:56:20 +020015448 This option enables SSL ciphering on outgoing connections to the server. It
15449 is critical to verify server certificates using "verify" when using SSL to
15450 connect to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man in
15451 the-middle attacks rendering SSL useless. When this option is used, health
15452 checks are automatically sent in SSL too unless there is a "port" or an
15453 "addr" directive indicating the check should be sent to a different location.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010015454 See the "no-ssl" to disable "ssl" option and "check-ssl" option to force
15455 SSL health checks.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020015456
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020015457ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
15458 This option enforces use of <version> or lower when SSL is used to communicate
15459 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
15460 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
15461
15462ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
15463 This option enforces use of <version> or upper when SSL is used to communicate
15464 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
15465 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-max-ver".
15466
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010015467ssl-reuse
15468 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-ssl-reuse"
15469 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
15470 default value.
15471 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
15472 "default-server" "no-ssl-reuse" setting.
15473
15474stick
15475 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "non-stick"
15476 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
15477 default value.
15478 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
15479 "default-server" "non-stick" setting.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020015480
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080015481socks4 <addr>:<port>
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050015482 This option enables upstream socks4 tunnel for outgoing connections to the
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080015483 server. Using this option won't force the health check to go via socks4 by
15484 default. You will have to use the keyword "check-via-socks4" to enable it.
15485
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020015486tcp-ut <delay>
15487 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all outgoing connections to this server. This
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040015488 option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It allows HAProxy to
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020015489 configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not receiving an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015490 acknowledgment for the configured delay. This is especially useful on
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020015491 long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as remote
15492 terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server timeouts
15493 must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is important to
15494 detect that the server has disappeared in order to release all resources
15495 associated with its connection (and the client's session). One typical use
15496 case is also to force dead server connections to die when health checks are
15497 too slow or during a soft reload since health checks are then disabled. The
15498 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works for
15499 regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
15500
Willy Tarreau034c88c2017-01-23 23:36:45 +010015501tfo
15502 This option enables using TCP fast open when connecting to servers, on
15503 systems that support it (currently only the Linux kernel >= 4.11).
15504 See the "tfo" bind option for more information about TCP fast open.
15505 Please note that when using tfo, you should also use the "conn-failure",
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040015506 "empty-response" and "response-timeout" keywords for "retry-on", or HAProxy
Frédéric Lécaille1b9423d2019-07-04 14:19:06 +020015507 won't be able to retry the connection on failure. See also "no-tfo".
Willy Tarreau034c88c2017-01-23 23:36:45 +010015508
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015509track [<proxy>/]<server>
Willy Tarreau32091232014-05-16 13:52:00 +020015510 This option enables ability to set the current state of the server by tracking
15511 another one. It is possible to track a server which itself tracks another
15512 server, provided that at the end of the chain, a server has health checks
15513 enabled. If <proxy> is omitted the current one is used. If disable-on-404 is
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015514 used, it has to be enabled on both proxies.
15515
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010015516tls-tickets
15517 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-tls-tickets"
15518 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
15519 default value.
Lukas Tribusbdb386d2020-03-10 00:56:09 +010015520 The TLS ticket mechanism is only used up to TLS 1.2.
15521 Forward Secrecy is compromised with TLS tickets, unless ticket keys
15522 are periodically rotated (via reload or by using "tls-ticket-keys").
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010015523 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
Bjoern Jacke5ab7eb62020-02-13 14:16:16 +010015524 "default-server" "no-tls-tickets" setting.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010015525
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020015526verify [none|required]
15527 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +010015528 to 'none', server certificate is not verified. In the other case, The
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020015529 certificate provided by the server is verified using CAs from 'ca-file' and
15530 optional CRLs from 'crl-file' after having checked that the names provided in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015531 the certificate's subject and subjectAlternateNames attributes match either
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020015532 the name passed using the "sni" directive, or if not provided, the static
15533 host name passed using the "verifyhost" directive. When no name is found, the
15534 certificate's names are ignored. For this reason, without SNI it's important
15535 to use "verifyhost". On verification failure the handshake is aborted. It is
15536 critically important to verify server certificates when using SSL to connect
15537 to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man-in-the-middle
15538 attacks rendering SSL totally useless. Unless "ssl_server_verify" appears in
15539 the global section, "verify" is set to "required" by default.
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020015540
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070015541verifyhost <hostname>
15542 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in, and
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020015543 only takes effect if 'verify required' is also specified. This directive sets
15544 a default static hostname to check the server's certificate against when no
15545 SNI was used to connect to the server. If SNI is not used, this is the only
15546 way to enable hostname verification. This static hostname, when set, will
15547 also be used for health checks (which cannot provide an SNI value). If none
15548 of the hostnames in the certificate match the specified hostname, the
15549 handshake is aborted. The hostnames in the server-provided certificate may
15550 include wildcards. See also "verify", "sni" and "no-verifyhost" options.
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070015551
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010015552weight <weight>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015553 The "weight" parameter is used to adjust the server's weight relative to
15554 other servers. All servers will receive a load proportional to their weight
15555 relative to the sum of all weights, so the higher the weight, the higher the
Willy Tarreau6704d672009-06-15 10:56:05 +020015556 load. The default weight is 1, and the maximal value is 256. A value of 0
15557 means the server will not participate in load-balancing but will still accept
15558 persistent connections. If this parameter is used to distribute the load
15559 according to server's capacity, it is recommended to start with values which
15560 can both grow and shrink, for instance between 10 and 100 to leave enough
15561 room above and below for later adjustments.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015562
Amaury Denoyellef9d59572021-10-18 14:40:29 +020015563ws { auto | h1 | h2 }
15564 This option allows to configure the protocol used when relaying websocket
15565 streams. This is most notably useful when using an HTTP/2 backend without the
15566 support for H2 websockets through the RFC8441.
15567
15568 The default mode is "auto". This will reuse the same protocol as the main
15569 one. The only difference is when using ALPN. In this case, it can try to
15570 downgrade the ALPN to "http/1.1" only for websocket streams if the configured
15571 server ALPN contains it.
15572
15573 The value "h1" is used to force HTTP/1.1 for websockets streams, through ALPN
15574 if SSL ALPN is activated for the server. Similarly, "h2" can be used to
15575 force HTTP/2.0 websockets. Use this value with care : the server must support
15576 RFC8441 or an error will be reported by haproxy when relaying websockets.
15577
15578 Note that NPN is not taken into account as its usage has been deprecated in
15579 favor of the ALPN extension.
15580
15581 See also "alpn" and "proto".
15582
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015583
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200155845.3. Server IP address resolution using DNS
15585-------------------------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015586
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015587HAProxy allows using a host name on the server line to retrieve its IP address
15588using name servers. By default, HAProxy resolves the name when parsing the
Thayne McCombscdbcca92021-01-07 21:24:41 -070015589configuration file, at startup and cache the result for the process's life.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015590This is not sufficient in some cases, such as in Amazon where a server's IP
15591can change after a reboot or an ELB Virtual IP can change based on current
15592workload.
15593This chapter describes how HAProxy can be configured to process server's name
15594resolution at run time.
15595Whether run time server name resolution has been enable or not, HAProxy will
15596carry on doing the first resolution when parsing the configuration.
15597
15598
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200155995.3.1. Global overview
15600----------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015601
15602As we've seen in introduction, name resolution in HAProxy occurs at two
15603different steps of the process life:
15604
15605 1. when starting up, HAProxy parses the server line definition and matches a
15606 host name. It uses libc functions to get the host name resolved. This
15607 resolution relies on /etc/resolv.conf file.
15608
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015609 2. at run time, HAProxy performs periodically name resolutions for servers
15610 requiring DNS resolutions.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015611
15612A few other events can trigger a name resolution at run time:
15613 - when a server's health check ends up in a connection timeout: this may be
15614 because the server has a new IP address. So we need to trigger a name
15615 resolution to know this new IP.
15616
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015617When using resolvers, the server name can either be a hostname, or a SRV label.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015618HAProxy considers anything that starts with an underscore as a SRV label. If a
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015619SRV label is specified, then the corresponding SRV records will be retrieved
15620from the DNS server, and the provided hostnames will be used. The SRV label
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040015621will be checked periodically, and if any server are added or removed, HAProxy
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015622will automatically do the same.
Olivier Houchardecfa18d2017-08-07 17:30:03 +020015623
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015624A few things important to notice:
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050015625 - all the name servers are queried in the meantime. HAProxy will process the
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015626 first valid response.
15627
15628 - a resolution is considered as invalid (NX, timeout, refused), when all the
15629 servers return an error.
15630
15631
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200156325.3.2. The resolvers section
15633----------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015634
15635This section is dedicated to host information related to name resolution in
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015636HAProxy. There can be as many as resolvers section as needed. Each section can
15637contain many name servers.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015638
William Lallemandc33df2e2022-05-06 17:14:00 +020015639At startup, HAProxy tries to generate a resolvers section named "default", if
15640no section was named this way in the configuration. This section is used by
15641default by the httpclient and uses the parse-resolv-conf keyword. If HAProxy
15642failed to generate automatically this section, no error or warning are emitted.
15643
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015644When multiple name servers are configured in a resolvers section, then HAProxy
15645uses the first valid response. In case of invalid responses, only the last one
15646is treated. Purpose is to give the chance to a slow server to deliver a valid
15647answer after a fast faulty or outdated server.
15648
15649When each server returns a different error type, then only the last error is
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015650used by HAProxy. The following processing is applied on this error:
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015651
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015652 1. HAProxy retries the same DNS query with a new query type. The A queries are
15653 switch to AAAA or the opposite. SRV queries are not concerned here. Timeout
15654 errors are also excluded.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015655
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015656 2. When the fallback on the query type was done (or not applicable), HAProxy
15657 retries the original DNS query, with the preferred query type.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015658
Thierry Fournier55c40ea2021-12-15 19:03:52 +010015659 3. HAProxy retries previous steps <resolve_retries> times. If no valid
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015660 response is received after that, it stops the DNS resolution and reports
15661 the error.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015662
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015663For example, with 2 name servers configured in a resolvers section, the
15664following scenarios are possible:
15665
15666 - First response is valid and is applied directly, second response is
15667 ignored
15668
15669 - First response is invalid and second one is valid, then second response is
15670 applied
15671
15672 - First response is a NX domain and second one a truncated response, then
15673 HAProxy retries the query with a new type
15674
15675 - First response is a NX domain and second one is a timeout, then HAProxy
15676 retries the query with a new type
15677
15678 - Query timed out for both name servers, then HAProxy retries it with the
15679 same query type
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015680
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040015681As a DNS server may not answer all the IPs in one DNS request, HAProxy keeps
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020015682a cache of previous answers, an answer will be considered obsolete after
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015683<hold obsolete> seconds without the IP returned.
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020015684
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015685
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015686resolvers <resolvers id>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015687 Creates a new name server list labeled <resolvers id>
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015688
15689A resolvers section accept the following parameters:
15690
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020015691accepted_payload_size <nb>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015692 Defines the maximum payload size accepted by HAProxy and announced to all the
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015693 name servers configured in this resolvers section.
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020015694 <nb> is in bytes. If not set, HAProxy announces 512. (minimal value defined
15695 by RFC 6891)
15696
Emeric Brun4c751952021-03-08 16:41:29 +010015697 Note: the maximum allowed value is 65535. Recommended value for UDP is
15698 4096 and it is not recommended to exceed 8192 except if you are sure
15699 that your system and network can handle this (over 65507 makes no sense
15700 since is the maximum UDP payload size). If you are using only TCP
15701 nameservers to handle huge DNS responses, you should put this value
15702 to the max: 65535.
Baptiste Assmann9d8dbbc2017-08-18 23:35:08 +020015703
Emeric Brunc8f3e452021-04-07 16:04:54 +020015704nameserver <name> <address>[:port] [param*]
15705 Used to configure a nameserver. <name> of the nameserver should ne unique.
15706 By default the <address> is considered of type datagram. This means if an
15707 IPv4 or IPv6 is configured without special address prefixes (paragraph 11.)
15708 the UDP protocol will be used. If an stream protocol address prefix is used,
15709 the nameserver will be considered as a stream server (TCP for instance) and
15710 "server" parameters found in 5.2 paragraph which are relevant for DNS
15711 resolving will be considered. Note: currently, in TCP mode, 4 queries are
15712 pipelined on the same connections. A batch of idle connections are removed
15713 every 5 seconds. "maxconn" can be configured to limit the amount of those
Emeric Brun56fc5d92021-02-12 20:05:45 +010015714 concurrent connections and TLS should also usable if the server supports.
15715
Ben Draut44e609b2018-05-29 15:40:08 -060015716parse-resolv-conf
15717 Adds all nameservers found in /etc/resolv.conf to this resolvers nameservers
15718 list. Ordered as if each nameserver in /etc/resolv.conf was individually
15719 placed in the resolvers section in place of this directive.
15720
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015721hold <status> <period>
15722 Defines <period> during which the last name resolution should be kept based
15723 on last resolution <status>
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010015724 <status> : last name resolution status. Acceptable values are "nx",
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020015725 "other", "refused", "timeout", "valid", "obsolete".
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015726 <period> : interval between two successive name resolution when the last
15727 answer was in <status>. It follows the HAProxy time format.
15728 <period> is in milliseconds by default.
15729
Baptiste Assmann686408b2017-08-18 10:15:42 +020015730 Default value is 10s for "valid", 0s for "obsolete" and 30s for others.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015731
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015732resolve_retries <nb>
15733 Defines the number <nb> of queries to send to resolve a server name before
15734 giving up.
15735 Default value: 3
15736
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015737 A retry occurs on name server timeout or when the full sequence of DNS query
15738 type failover is over and we need to start up from the default ANY query
15739 type.
15740
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015741timeout <event> <time>
15742 Defines timeouts related to name resolution
15743 <event> : the event on which the <time> timeout period applies to.
15744 events available are:
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010015745 - resolve : default time to trigger name resolutions when no
15746 other time applied.
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015747 Default value: 1s
15748 - retry : time between two DNS queries, when no valid response
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010015749 have been received.
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015750 Default value: 1s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015751 <time> : time related to the event. It follows the HAProxy time format.
15752 <time> is expressed in milliseconds.
15753
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020015754 Example:
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015755
15756 resolvers mydns
15757 nameserver dns1 10.0.0.1:53
15758 nameserver dns2 10.0.0.2:53
Emeric Brunc8f3e452021-04-07 16:04:54 +020015759 nameserver dns3 tcp@10.0.0.3:53
Ben Draut44e609b2018-05-29 15:40:08 -060015760 parse-resolv-conf
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015761 resolve_retries 3
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015762 timeout resolve 1s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015763 timeout retry 1s
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010015764 hold other 30s
15765 hold refused 30s
15766 hold nx 30s
15767 hold timeout 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015768 hold valid 10s
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020015769 hold obsolete 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015770
15771
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200157726. Cache
15773---------
15774
15775HAProxy provides a cache, which was designed to perform cache on small objects
15776(favicon, css...). This is a minimalist low-maintenance cache which runs in
15777RAM.
15778
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +020015779The cache is based on a memory area shared between all threads, and split in 1kB
15780blocks.
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020015781
15782If an object is not used anymore, it can be deleted to store a new object
15783independently of its expiration date. The oldest objects are deleted first
15784when we try to allocate a new one.
15785
15786The cache uses a hash of the host header and the URI as the key.
15787
15788It's possible to view the status of a cache using the Unix socket command
15789"show cache" consult section 9.3 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide
15790for more details.
15791
15792When an object is delivered from the cache, the server name in the log is
15793replaced by "<CACHE>".
15794
15795
157966.1. Limitation
15797----------------
15798
15799The cache won't store and won't deliver objects in these cases:
15800
15801- If the response is not a 200
Remi Tricot-Le Breton4f730832020-11-26 15:51:50 +010015802- If the response contains a Vary header and either the process-vary option is
15803 disabled, or a currently unmanaged header is specified in the Vary value (only
15804 accept-encoding and referer are managed for now)
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020015805- If the Content-Length + the headers size is greater than "max-object-size"
15806- If the response is not cacheable
Remi Tricot-Le Bretond493bc82020-11-26 15:51:29 +010015807- If the response does not have an explicit expiration time (s-maxage or max-age
15808 Cache-Control directives or Expires header) or a validator (ETag or Last-Modified
15809 headers)
Remi Tricot-Le Breton5853c0c2020-12-10 17:58:43 +010015810- If the process-vary option is enabled and there are already max-secondary-entries
15811 entries with the same primary key as the current response
Remi Tricot-Le Breton6ca89162021-01-07 14:50:51 +010015812- If the process-vary option is enabled and the response has an unknown encoding (not
15813 mentioned in https://www.iana.org/assignments/http-parameters/http-parameters.xhtml)
15814 while varying on the accept-encoding client header
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020015815
15816- If the request is not a GET
15817- If the HTTP version of the request is smaller than 1.1
15818- If the request contains an Authorization header
15819
15820
158216.2. Setup
15822-----------
15823
15824To setup a cache, you must define a cache section and use it in a proxy with
15825the corresponding http-request and response actions.
15826
15827
158286.2.1. Cache section
15829---------------------
15830
15831cache <name>
15832 Declare a cache section, allocate a shared cache memory named <name>, the
15833 size of cache is mandatory.
15834
15835total-max-size <megabytes>
15836 Define the size in RAM of the cache in megabytes. This size is split in
15837 blocks of 1kB which are used by the cache entries. Its maximum value is 4095.
15838
15839max-object-size <bytes>
15840 Define the maximum size of the objects to be cached. Must not be greater than
15841 an half of "total-max-size". If not set, it equals to a 256th of the cache size.
15842 All objects with sizes larger than "max-object-size" will not be cached.
15843
15844max-age <seconds>
Remi Tricot-Le Breton5853c0c2020-12-10 17:58:43 +010015845 Define the maximum expiration duration. The expiration is set as the lowest
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020015846 value between the s-maxage or max-age (in this order) directive in the
15847 Cache-Control response header and this value. The default value is 60
15848 seconds, which means that you can't cache an object more than 60 seconds by
15849 default.
15850
Remi Tricot-Le Bretone6cc5b52020-12-23 18:13:53 +010015851process-vary <on/off>
15852 Enable or disable the processing of the Vary header. When disabled, a response
Remi Tricot-Le Breton754b2422020-11-16 15:56:10 +010015853 containing such a header will never be cached. When enabled, we need to calculate
15854 a preliminary hash for a subset of request headers on all the incoming requests
15855 (which might come with a cpu cost) which will be used to build a secondary key
Remi Tricot-Le Bretone6cc5b52020-12-23 18:13:53 +010015856 for a given request (see RFC 7234#4.1). The default value is off (disabled).
Remi Tricot-Le Breton754b2422020-11-16 15:56:10 +010015857
Remi Tricot-Le Breton5853c0c2020-12-10 17:58:43 +010015858max-secondary-entries <number>
15859 Define the maximum number of simultaneous secondary entries with the same primary
15860 key in the cache. This needs the vary support to be enabled. Its default value is 10
15861 and should be passed a strictly positive integer.
15862
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020015863
158646.2.2. Proxy section
15865---------------------
15866
15867http-request cache-use <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
15868 Try to deliver a cached object from the cache <name>. This directive is also
15869 mandatory to store the cache as it calculates the cache hash. If you want to
15870 use a condition for both storage and delivering that's a good idea to put it
15871 after this one.
15872
15873http-response cache-store <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
15874 Store an http-response within the cache. The storage of the response headers
15875 is done at this step, which means you can use others http-response actions
15876 to modify headers before or after the storage of the response. This action
15877 is responsible for the setup of the cache storage filter.
15878
15879
15880Example:
15881
15882 backend bck1
15883 mode http
15884
15885 http-request cache-use foobar
15886 http-response cache-store foobar
15887 server srv1 127.0.0.1:80
15888
15889 cache foobar
15890 total-max-size 4
15891 max-age 240
15892
15893
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200158947. Using ACLs and fetching samples
15895----------------------------------
15896
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015897HAProxy is capable of extracting data from request or response streams, from
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015898client or server information, from tables, environmental information etc...
15899The action of extracting such data is called fetching a sample. Once retrieved,
15900these samples may be used for various purposes such as a key to a stick-table,
15901but most common usages consist in matching them against predefined constant
15902data called patterns.
15903
15904
159057.1. ACL basics
15906---------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015907
15908The use of Access Control Lists (ACL) provides a flexible solution to perform
15909content switching and generally to take decisions based on content extracted
15910from the request, the response or any environmental status. The principle is
15911simple :
15912
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015913 - extract a data sample from a stream, table or the environment
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010015914 - optionally apply some format conversion to the extracted sample
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015915 - apply one or multiple pattern matching methods on this sample
15916 - perform actions only when a pattern matches the sample
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015917
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015918The actions generally consist in blocking a request, selecting a backend, or
15919adding a header.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015920
15921In order to define a test, the "acl" keyword is used. The syntax is :
15922
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015923 acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] [<value>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015924
15925This creates a new ACL <aclname> or completes an existing one with new tests.
15926Those tests apply to the portion of request/response specified in <criterion>
15927and may be adjusted with optional flags [flags]. Some criteria also support
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010015928an operator which may be specified before the set of values. Optionally some
15929conversion operators may be applied to the sample, and they will be specified
15930as a comma-delimited list of keywords just after the first keyword. The values
15931are of the type supported by the criterion, and are separated by spaces.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015932
15933ACL names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits, '-' (dash),
15934'_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are case-sensitive,
15935which means that "my_acl" and "My_Acl" are two different ACLs.
15936
15937There is no enforced limit to the number of ACLs. The unused ones do not affect
15938performance, they just consume a small amount of memory.
15939
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015940The criterion generally is the name of a sample fetch method, or one of its ACL
15941specific declinations. The default test method is implied by the output type of
15942this sample fetch method. The ACL declinations can describe alternate matching
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010015943methods of a same sample fetch method. The sample fetch methods are the only
15944ones supporting a conversion.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015945
15946Sample fetch methods return data which can be of the following types :
15947 - boolean
15948 - integer (signed or unsigned)
15949 - IPv4 or IPv6 address
15950 - string
15951 - data block
15952
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010015953Converters transform any of these data into any of these. For example, some
15954converters might convert a string to a lower-case string while other ones
15955would turn a string to an IPv4 address, or apply a netmask to an IP address.
15956The resulting sample is of the type of the last converter applied to the list,
15957which defaults to the type of the sample fetch method.
15958
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020015959Each sample or converter returns data of a specific type, specified with its
15960keyword in this documentation. When an ACL is declared using a standard sample
15961fetch method, certain types automatically involved a default matching method
15962which are summarized in the table below :
15963
15964 +---------------------+-----------------+
15965 | Sample or converter | Default |
15966 | output type | matching method |
15967 +---------------------+-----------------+
15968 | boolean | bool |
15969 +---------------------+-----------------+
15970 | integer | int |
15971 +---------------------+-----------------+
15972 | ip | ip |
15973 +---------------------+-----------------+
15974 | string | str |
15975 +---------------------+-----------------+
15976 | binary | none, use "-m" |
15977 +---------------------+-----------------+
15978
15979Note that in order to match a binary samples, it is mandatory to specify a
15980matching method, see below.
15981
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015982The ACL engine can match these types against patterns of the following types :
15983 - boolean
15984 - integer or integer range
15985 - IP address / network
15986 - string (exact, substring, suffix, prefix, subdir, domain)
15987 - regular expression
15988 - hex block
15989
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015990The following ACL flags are currently supported :
15991
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020015992 -i : ignore case during matching of all subsequent patterns.
15993 -f : load patterns from a file.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015994 -m : use a specific pattern matching method
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010015995 -n : forbid the DNS resolutions
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010015996 -M : load the file pointed by -f like a map file.
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010015997 -u : force the unique id of the ACL
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015998 -- : force end of flags. Useful when a string looks like one of the flags.
15999
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016000The "-f" flag is followed by the name of a file from which all lines will be
16001read as individual values. It is even possible to pass multiple "-f" arguments
16002if the patterns are to be loaded from multiple files. Empty lines as well as
16003lines beginning with a sharp ('#') will be ignored. All leading spaces and tabs
16004will be stripped. If it is absolutely necessary to insert a valid pattern
16005beginning with a sharp, just prefix it with a space so that it is not taken for
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040016006a comment. Depending on the data type and match method, HAProxy may load the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016007lines into a binary tree, allowing very fast lookups. This is true for IPv4 and
16008exact string matching. In this case, duplicates will automatically be removed.
16009
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010016010The "-M" flag allows an ACL to use a map file. If this flag is set, the file is
16011parsed as two column file. The first column contains the patterns used by the
16012ACL, and the second column contain the samples. The sample can be used later by
16013a map. This can be useful in some rare cases where an ACL would just be used to
16014check for the existence of a pattern in a map before a mapping is applied.
16015
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010016016The "-u" flag forces the unique id of the ACL. This unique id is used with the
16017socket interface to identify ACL and dynamically change its values. Note that a
16018file is always identified by its name even if an id is set.
16019
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016020Also, note that the "-i" flag applies to subsequent entries and not to entries
16021loaded from files preceding it. For instance :
16022
16023 acl valid-ua hdr(user-agent) -f exact-ua.lst -i -f generic-ua.lst test
16024
16025In this example, each line of "exact-ua.lst" will be exactly matched against
16026the "user-agent" header of the request. Then each line of "generic-ua" will be
16027case-insensitively matched. Then the word "test" will be insensitively matched
16028as well.
16029
16030The "-m" flag is used to select a specific pattern matching method on the input
16031sample. All ACL-specific criteria imply a pattern matching method and generally
16032do not need this flag. However, this flag is useful with generic sample fetch
16033methods to describe how they're going to be matched against the patterns. This
16034is required for sample fetches which return data type for which there is no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016035obvious matching method (e.g. string or binary). When "-m" is specified and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016036followed by a pattern matching method name, this method is used instead of the
16037default one for the criterion. This makes it possible to match contents in ways
16038that were not initially planned, or with sample fetch methods which return a
16039string. The matching method also affects the way the patterns are parsed.
16040
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010016041The "-n" flag forbids the dns resolutions. It is used with the load of ip files.
16042By default, if the parser cannot parse ip address it considers that the parsed
16043string is maybe a domain name and try dns resolution. The flag "-n" disable this
16044resolution. It is useful for detecting malformed ip lists. Note that if the DNS
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040016045server is not reachable, the HAProxy configuration parsing may last many minutes
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050016046waiting for the timeout. During this time no error messages are displayed. The
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010016047flag "-n" disable this behavior. Note also that during the runtime, this
16048function is disabled for the dynamic acl modifications.
16049
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016050There are some restrictions however. Not all methods can be used with all
16051sample fetch methods. Also, if "-m" is used in conjunction with "-f", it must
16052be placed first. The pattern matching method must be one of the following :
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020016053
16054 - "found" : only check if the requested sample could be found in the stream,
16055 but do not compare it against any pattern. It is recommended not
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016056 to pass any pattern to avoid confusion. This matching method is
16057 particularly useful to detect presence of certain contents such
16058 as headers, cookies, etc... even if they are empty and without
16059 comparing them to anything nor counting them.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020016060
16061 - "bool" : check the value as a boolean. It can only be applied to fetches
16062 which return a boolean or integer value, and takes no pattern.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016063 Value zero or false does not match, all other values do match.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020016064
16065 - "int" : match the value as an integer. It can be used with integer and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016066 boolean samples. Boolean false is integer 0, true is integer 1.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020016067
16068 - "ip" : match the value as an IPv4 or IPv6 address. It is compatible
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016069 with IP address samples only, so it is implied and never needed.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020016070
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016071 - "bin" : match the contents against a hexadecimal string representing a
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020016072 binary sequence. This may be used with binary or string samples.
16073
16074 - "len" : match the sample's length as an integer. This may be used with
16075 binary or string samples.
16076
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016077 - "str" : exact match : match the contents against a string. This may be
16078 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020016079
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016080 - "sub" : substring match : check that the contents contain at least one of
16081 the provided string patterns. This may be used with binary or
16082 string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020016083
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016084 - "reg" : regex match : match the contents against a list of regular
16085 expressions. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020016086
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016087 - "beg" : prefix match : check that the contents begin like the provided
16088 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020016089
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016090 - "end" : suffix match : check that the contents end like the provided
16091 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020016092
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016093 - "dir" : subdir match : check that a slash-delimited portion of the
16094 contents exactly matches one of the provided string patterns.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020016095 This may be used with binary or string samples.
16096
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016097 - "dom" : domain match : check that a dot-delimited portion of the contents
16098 exactly match one of the provided string patterns. This may be
16099 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020016100
16101For example, to quickly detect the presence of cookie "JSESSIONID" in an HTTP
16102request, it is possible to do :
16103
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010016104 acl jsess_present req.cook(JSESSIONID) -m found
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020016105
16106In order to apply a regular expression on the 500 first bytes of data in the
16107buffer, one would use the following acl :
16108
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010016109 acl script_tag req.payload(0,500) -m reg -i <script>
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020016110
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010016111On systems where the regex library is much slower when using "-i", it is
16112possible to convert the sample to lowercase before matching, like this :
16113
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010016114 acl script_tag req.payload(0,500),lower -m reg <script>
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010016115
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016116All ACL-specific criteria imply a default matching method. Most often, these
16117criteria are composed by concatenating the name of the original sample fetch
16118method and the matching method. For example, "hdr_beg" applies the "beg" match
16119to samples retrieved using the "hdr" fetch method. Since all ACL-specific
16120criteria rely on a sample fetch method, it is always possible instead to use
16121the original sample fetch method and the explicit matching method using "-m".
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020016122
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016123If an alternate match is specified using "-m" on an ACL-specific criterion,
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030016124the matching method is simply applied to the underlying sample fetch method.
16125For example, all ACLs below are exact equivalent :
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020016126
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016127 acl short_form hdr_beg(host) www.
16128 acl alternate1 hdr_beg(host) -m beg www.
16129 acl alternate2 hdr_dom(host) -m beg www.
16130 acl alternate3 hdr(host) -m beg www.
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020016131
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020016132
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020016133The table below summarizes the compatibility matrix between sample or converter
16134types and the pattern types to fetch against. It indicates for each compatible
16135combination the name of the matching method to be used, surrounded with angle
16136brackets ">" and "<" when the method is the default one and will work by
16137default without "-m".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010016138
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016139 +-------------------------------------------------+
16140 | Input sample type |
16141 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020016142 | pattern type | boolean | integer | ip | string | binary |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016143 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
16144 | none (presence only) | found | found | found | found | found |
16145 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020016146 | none (boolean value) |> bool <| bool | | bool | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016147 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020016148 | integer (value) | int |> int <| int | int | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016149 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010016150 | integer (length) | len | len | len | len | len |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016151 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020016152 | IP address | | |> ip <| ip | ip |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016153 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020016154 | exact string | str | str | str |> str <| str |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016155 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010016156 | prefix | beg | beg | beg | beg | beg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016157 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010016158 | suffix | end | end | end | end | end |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016159 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010016160 | substring | sub | sub | sub | sub | sub |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016161 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010016162 | subdir | dir | dir | dir | dir | dir |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016163 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010016164 | domain | dom | dom | dom | dom | dom |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016165 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010016166 | regex | reg | reg | reg | reg | reg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016167 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
16168 | hex block | | | | bin | bin |
16169 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016170
16171
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200161727.1.1. Matching booleans
16173------------------------
16174
16175In order to match a boolean, no value is needed and all values are ignored.
16176Boolean matching is used by default for all fetch methods of type "boolean".
16177When boolean matching is used, the fetched value is returned as-is, which means
16178that a boolean "true" will always match and a boolean "false" will never match.
16179
16180Boolean matching may also be enforced using "-m bool" on fetch methods which
16181return an integer value. Then, integer value 0 is converted to the boolean
16182"false" and all other values are converted to "true".
16183
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016184
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200161857.1.2. Matching integers
16186------------------------
16187
16188Integer matching applies by default to integer fetch methods. It can also be
16189enforced on boolean fetches using "-m int". In this case, "false" is converted
16190to the integer 0, and "true" is converted to the integer 1.
16191
16192Integer matching also supports integer ranges and operators. Note that integer
16193matching only applies to positive values. A range is a value expressed with a
16194lower and an upper bound separated with a colon, both of which may be omitted.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016195
16196For instance, "1024:65535" is a valid range to represent a range of
16197unprivileged ports, and "1024:" would also work. "0:1023" is a valid
16198representation of privileged ports, and ":1023" would also work.
16199
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020016200As a special case, some ACL functions support decimal numbers which are in fact
16201two integers separated by a dot. This is used with some version checks for
16202instance. All integer properties apply to those decimal numbers, including
16203ranges and operators.
16204
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016205For an easier usage, comparison operators are also supported. Note that using
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010016206operators with ranges does not make much sense and is strongly discouraged.
16207Similarly, it does not make much sense to perform order comparisons with a set
16208of values.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016209
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010016210Available operators for integer matching are :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016211
16212 eq : true if the tested value equals at least one value
16213 ge : true if the tested value is greater than or equal to at least one value
16214 gt : true if the tested value is greater than at least one value
16215 le : true if the tested value is less than or equal to at least one value
16216 lt : true if the tested value is less than at least one value
16217
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010016218For instance, the following ACL matches any negative Content-Length header :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016219
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010016220 acl negative-length req.hdr_val(content-length) lt 0
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016221
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020016222This one matches SSL versions between 3.0 and 3.1 (inclusive) :
16223
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010016224 acl sslv3 req.ssl_ver 3:3.1
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020016225
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016226
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200162277.1.3. Matching strings
16228-----------------------
16229
16230String matching applies to string or binary fetch methods, and exists in 6
16231different forms :
16232
16233 - exact match (-m str) : the extracted string must exactly match the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016234 patterns;
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016235
16236 - substring match (-m sub) : the patterns are looked up inside the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016237 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them is found inside;
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016238
16239 - prefix match (-m beg) : the patterns are compared with the beginning of
16240 the extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
16241
16242 - suffix match (-m end) : the patterns are compared with the end of the
16243 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
16244
Baptiste Assmann33db6002016-03-06 23:32:10 +010016245 - subdir match (-m dir) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016246 string, delimited with slashes ("/"), and the ACL matches if any of them
16247 matches.
16248
16249 - domain match (-m dom) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
16250 string, delimited with dots ("."), and the ACL matches if any of them
16251 matches.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016252
16253String matching applies to verbatim strings as they are passed, with the
16254exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it possible to escape some
16255characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is passed before the first
16256string, then the matching will be performed ignoring the case. In order
16257to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass the "--" flag
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010016258before the first string. Same applies of course to match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016259
Mathias Weiersmuellercb250fc2019-12-02 09:43:40 +010016260Do not use string matches for binary fetches which might contain null bytes
16261(0x00), as the comparison stops at the occurrence of the first null byte.
16262Instead, convert the binary fetch to a hex string with the hex converter first.
16263
16264Example:
16265 # matches if the string <tag> is present in the binary sample
16266 acl tag_found req.payload(0,0),hex -m sub 3C7461673E
16267
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016268
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200162697.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
16270---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016271
16272Just like with string matching, regex matching applies to verbatim strings as
16273they are passed, with the exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it
16274possible to escape some characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is
16275passed before the first regex, then the matching will be performed ignoring
16276the case. In order to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010016277the "--" flag before the first string. Same principle applies of course to
16278match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016279
16280
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200162817.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
16282-------------------------------------
16283
16284It is possible to match some extracted samples against a binary block which may
16285not safely be represented as a string. For this, the patterns must be passed as
16286a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number, when the match method is set
16287to binary. Each sequence of two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal
16288digits may be used upper or lower case.
16289
16290Example :
16291 # match "Hello\n" in the input stream (\x48 \x65 \x6c \x6c \x6f \x0a)
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010016292 acl hello req.payload(0,6) -m bin 48656c6c6f0a
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016293
16294
162957.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
16296---------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016297
16298IPv4 addresses values can be specified either as plain addresses or with a
16299netmask appended, in which case the IPv4 address matches whenever it is
16300within the network. Plain addresses may also be replaced with a resolvable
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010016301host name, but this practice is generally discouraged as it makes it more
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010016302difficult to read and debug configurations. If hostnames are used, you should
16303at least ensure that they are present in /etc/hosts so that the configuration
16304does not depend on any random DNS match at the moment the configuration is
16305parsed.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016306
Daniel Schnellereba56342016-04-13 00:26:52 +020016307The dotted IPv4 address notation is supported in both regular as well as the
16308abbreviated form with all-0-octets omitted:
16309
16310 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
16311 | Example 1 | Example 2 | Example 3 |
16312 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
16313 | 192.168.0.1 | 10.0.0.12 | 127.0.0.1 |
16314 | 192.168.1 | 10.12 | 127.1 |
16315 | 192.168.0.1/22 | 10.0.0.12/8 | 127.0.0.1/8 |
16316 | 192.168.1/22 | 10.12/8 | 127.1/8 |
16317 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
16318
16319Notice that this is different from RFC 4632 CIDR address notation in which
16320192.168.42/24 would be equivalent to 192.168.42.0/24.
16321
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020016322IPv6 may be entered in their usual form, with or without a netmask appended.
16323Only bit counts are accepted for IPv6 netmasks. In order to avoid any risk of
16324trouble with randomly resolved IP addresses, host names are never allowed in
16325IPv6 patterns.
16326
16327HAProxy is also able to match IPv4 addresses with IPv6 addresses in the
16328following situations :
16329 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies
16330 in IPv4 using the supplied mask if any.
16331 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv6, the match applies
16332 in IPv6 using the supplied mask if any.
16333 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies in IPv4
16334 using the pattern's mask if the IPv6 address matches with 2002:IPV4::,
16335 ::IPV4 or ::ffff:IPV4, otherwise it fails.
16336 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv6, the IPv4 address is first
16337 converted to IPv6 by prefixing ::ffff: in front of it, then the match is
16338 applied in IPv6 using the supplied IPv6 mask.
16339
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016340
163417.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
16342----------------------------------
16343
16344Some actions are only performed upon a valid condition. A condition is a
16345combination of ACLs with operators. 3 operators are supported :
16346
16347 - AND (implicit)
16348 - OR (explicit with the "or" keyword or the "||" operator)
16349 - Negation with the exclamation mark ("!")
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016350
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016351A condition is formed as a disjunctive form:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016352
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016353 [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln { or [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln } ...
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020016354
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016355Such conditions are generally used after an "if" or "unless" statement,
16356indicating when the condition will trigger the action.
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020016357
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016358For instance, to block HTTP requests to the "*" URL with methods other than
16359"OPTIONS", as well as POST requests without content-length, and GET or HEAD
16360requests with a content-length greater than 0, and finally every request which
16361is not either GET/HEAD/POST/OPTIONS !
16362
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010016363 acl missing_cl req.hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030016364 http-request deny if HTTP_URL_STAR !METH_OPTIONS || METH_POST missing_cl
16365 http-request deny if METH_GET HTTP_CONTENT
16366 http-request deny unless METH_GET or METH_POST or METH_OPTIONS
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016367
16368To select a different backend for requests to static contents on the "www" site
16369and to every request on the "img", "video", "download" and "ftp" hosts :
16370
16371 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
16372 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
16373 acl host_www hdr_beg(host) -i www
16374 acl host_static hdr_beg(host) -i img. video. download. ftp.
16375
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016376 # now use backend "static" for all static-only hosts, and for static URLs
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016377 # of host "www". Use backend "www" for the rest.
16378 use_backend static if host_static or host_www url_static
16379 use_backend www if host_www
16380
16381It is also possible to form rules using "anonymous ACLs". Those are unnamed ACL
16382expressions that are built on the fly without needing to be declared. They must
16383be enclosed between braces, with a space before and after each brace (because
16384the braces must be seen as independent words). Example :
16385
16386 The following rule :
16387
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010016388 acl missing_cl req.hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030016389 http-request deny if METH_POST missing_cl
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016390
16391 Can also be written that way :
16392
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010016393 http-request deny if METH_POST { req.hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0 }
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016394
16395It is generally not recommended to use this construct because it's a lot easier
16396to leave errors in the configuration when written that way. However, for very
16397simple rules matching only one source IP address for instance, it can make more
16398sense to use them than to declare ACLs with random names. Another example of
16399good use is the following :
16400
16401 With named ACLs :
16402
16403 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
16404 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
16405 monitor fail if site_dead
16406
16407 With anonymous ACLs :
16408
16409 monitor fail if { nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2 } || { nbsrv(static) lt 2 }
16410
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030016411See section 4.2 for detailed help on the "http-request deny" and "use_backend"
16412keywords.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016413
16414
164157.3. Fetching samples
16416---------------------
16417
16418Historically, sample fetch methods were only used to retrieve data to match
16419against patterns using ACLs. With the arrival of stick-tables, a new class of
16420sample fetch methods was created, most often sharing the same syntax as their
16421ACL counterpart. These sample fetch methods are also known as "fetches". As
16422of now, ACLs and fetches have converged. All ACL fetch methods have been made
16423available as fetch methods, and ACLs may use any sample fetch method as well.
16424
16425This section details all available sample fetch methods and their output type.
16426Some sample fetch methods have deprecated aliases that are used to maintain
16427compatibility with existing configurations. They are then explicitly marked as
16428deprecated and should not be used in new setups.
16429
16430The ACL derivatives are also indicated when available, with their respective
16431matching methods. These ones all have a well defined default pattern matching
16432method, so it is never necessary (though allowed) to pass the "-m" option to
16433indicate how the sample will be matched using ACLs.
16434
16435As indicated in the sample type versus matching compatibility matrix above,
16436when using a generic sample fetch method in an ACL, the "-m" option is
16437mandatory unless the sample type is one of boolean, integer, IPv4 or IPv6. When
16438the same keyword exists as an ACL keyword and as a standard fetch method, the
16439ACL engine will automatically pick the ACL-only one by default.
16440
16441Some of these keywords support one or multiple mandatory arguments, and one or
16442multiple optional arguments. These arguments are strongly typed and are checked
16443when the configuration is parsed so that there is no risk of running with an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016444incorrect argument (e.g. an unresolved backend name). Fetch function arguments
16445are passed between parenthesis and are delimited by commas. When an argument
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016446is optional, it will be indicated below between square brackets ('[ ]'). When
16447all arguments are optional, the parenthesis may be omitted.
16448
16449Thus, the syntax of a standard sample fetch method is one of the following :
16450 - name
16451 - name(arg1)
16452 - name(arg1,arg2)
16453
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016454
164557.3.1. Converters
16456-----------------
16457
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010016458Sample fetch methods may be combined with transformations to be applied on top
16459of the fetched sample (also called "converters"). These combinations form what
16460is called "sample expressions" and the result is a "sample". Initially this
16461was only supported by "stick on" and "stick store-request" directives but this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016462has now be extended to all places where samples may be used (ACLs, log-format,
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010016463unique-id-format, add-header, ...).
16464
16465These transformations are enumerated as a series of specific keywords after the
16466sample fetch method. These keywords may equally be appended immediately after
16467the fetch keyword's argument, delimited by a comma. These keywords can also
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016468support some arguments (e.g. a netmask) which must be passed in parenthesis.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010016469
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016470A certain category of converters are bitwise and arithmetic operators which
16471support performing basic operations on integers. Some bitwise operations are
16472supported (and, or, xor, cpl) and some arithmetic operations are supported
16473(add, sub, mul, div, mod, neg). Some comparators are provided (odd, even, not,
16474bool) which make it possible to report a match without having to write an ACL.
16475
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016476The currently available list of transformation keywords include :
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010016477
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001647851d.single(<prop>[,<prop>*])
16479 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
16480 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
16481 The device is identified using the User-Agent header passed to the
16482 converter. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
16483 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
16484
16485 Example :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016486 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request,
16487 # containing values for the three properties requested by using the
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +000016488 # User-Agent passed to the converter.
16489 frontend http-in
16490 bind *:8081
16491 default_backend servers
16492 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
16493 %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),51d.single(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
16494
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016495add(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016496 Adds <value> to the input value of type signed integer, and returns the
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016497 result as a signed integer. <value> can be a numeric value or a variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016498 name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The
16499 scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016500 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016501 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16502 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
16503 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
16504 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016505 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016506 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016507
Nikola Sale0dbf0382022-04-03 18:11:53 +020016508add_item(<delim>,[<var>][,<suff>]])
16509 Concatenates a minimum of 2 and up to 3 fields after the current sample which
16510 is then turned into a string. The first one, <delim>, is a constant string,
16511 that will be appended immediately after the existing sample if an existing
16512 sample is not empty and either the <var> or the <suff> is not empty. The
16513 second one, <var>, is a variable name. The variable will be looked up, its
16514 contents converted to a string, and it will be appended immediately after
16515 the <delim> part. If the variable is not found, nothing is appended. It is
16516 optional and may optionally be followed by a constant string <suff>, however
16517 if <var> is omitted, then <suff> is mandatory. This converter is similar to
16518 the concat converter and can be used to build new variables made of a
16519 succession of other variables but the main difference is that it does the
16520 checks if adding a delimiter makes sense as wouldn't be the case if e.g. the
16521 current sample is empty. That situation would require 2 separate rules using
16522 concat converter where the first rule would have to check if the current
16523 sample string is empty before adding a delimiter. If commas or closing
16524 parenthesis are needed as delimiters, they must be protected by quotes or
16525 backslashes, themselves protected so that they are not stripped by the first
16526 level parser. See examples below.
16527
16528 Example:
16529 http-request set-var(req.tagged) 'var(req.tagged),add_item(",",req.score1,"(site1)") if src,in_table(site1)'
16530 http-request set-var(req.tagged) 'var(req.tagged),add_item(",",req.score2,"(site2)") if src,in_table(site2)'
16531 http-request set-var(req.tagged) 'var(req.tagged),add_item(",",req.score3,"(site3)") if src,in_table(site3)'
16532 http-request set-header x-tagged %[var(req.tagged)]
16533
16534 http-request set-var(req.tagged) 'var(req.tagged),add_item(",",req.score1),add_item(",",req.score2)'
16535 http-request set-var(req.tagged) 'var(req.tagged),add_item(",",,(site1))' if src,in_table(site1)
16536
Nenad Merdanovicc31499d2019-03-23 11:00:32 +010016537aes_gcm_dec(<bits>,<nonce>,<key>,<aead_tag>)
16538 Decrypts the raw byte input using the AES128-GCM, AES192-GCM or
16539 AES256-GCM algorithm, depending on the <bits> parameter. All other parameters
16540 need to be base64 encoded and the returned result is in raw byte format.
16541 If the <aead_tag> validation fails, the converter doesn't return any data.
16542 The <nonce>, <key> and <aead_tag> can either be strings or variables. This
16543 converter requires at least OpenSSL 1.0.1.
16544
16545 Example:
16546 http-response set-header X-Decrypted-Text %[var(txn.enc),\
16547 aes_gcm_dec(128,txn.nonce,Zm9vb2Zvb29mb29wZm9vbw==,txn.aead_tag)]
16548
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016549and(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016550 Performs a bitwise "AND" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016551 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016552 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
16553 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016554 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016555 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16556 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
16557 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
16558 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016559 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016560 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016561
Holger Just1bfc24b2017-05-06 00:56:53 +020016562b64dec
16563 Converts (decodes) a base64 encoded input string to its binary
16564 representation. It performs the inverse operation of base64().
Moemen MHEDHBI92f7d432021-04-01 20:53:59 +020016565 For base64url("URL and Filename Safe Alphabet" (RFC 4648)) variant
16566 see "ub64dec".
Holger Just1bfc24b2017-05-06 00:56:53 +020016567
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020016568base64
16569 Converts a binary input sample to a base64 string. It is used to log or
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016570 transfer binary content in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g.
Moemen MHEDHBI92f7d432021-04-01 20:53:59 +020016571 an SSL ID can be copied in a header). For base64url("URL and Filename
16572 Safe Alphabet" (RFC 4648)) variant see "ub64enc".
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020016573
Marcin Deranek40ca09c2021-07-13 14:05:24 +020016574be2dec(<separator>,<chunk_size>,[<truncate>])
16575 Converts big-endian binary input sample to a string containing an unsigned
16576 integer number per <chunk_size> input bytes. <separator> is put every
16577 <chunk_size> binary input bytes if specified. <truncate> flag indicates
16578 whatever binary input is truncated at <chunk_size> boundaries. <chunk_size>
16579 maximum value is limited by the size of long long int (8 bytes).
16580
16581 Example:
16582 bin(01020304050607),be2dec(:,2) # 258:772:1286:7
16583 bin(01020304050607),be2dec(-,2,1) # 258-772-1286
16584 bin(01020304050607),be2dec(,2,1) # 2587721286
16585 bin(7f000001),be2dec(.,1) # 127.0.0.1
16586
Marcin Deranekda0264a2021-07-13 14:08:56 +020016587be2hex([<separator>],[<chunk_size>],[<truncate>])
16588 Converts big-endian binary input sample to a hex string containing two hex
16589 digits per input byte. It is used to log or transfer hex dumps of some
16590 binary input data in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g. an SSL ID
16591 can be copied in a header). <separator> is put every <chunk_size> binary
16592 input bytes if specified. <truncate> flag indicates whatever binary input is
16593 truncated at <chunk_size> boundaries.
16594
16595 Example:
16596 bin(01020304050607),be2hex # 01020304050607
16597 bin(01020304050607),be2hex(:,2) # 0102:0304:0506:07
16598 bin(01020304050607),be2hex(--,2,1) # 0102--0304--0506
16599 bin(0102030405060708),be2hex(,3,1) # 010203040506
16600
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016601bool
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016602 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016603 non-null, otherwise returns FALSE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016604 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (e.g. verify the
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016605 presence of a flag).
16606
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010016607bytes(<offset>[,<length>])
16608 Extracts some bytes from an input binary sample. The result is a binary
16609 sample starting at an offset (in bytes) of the original sample and
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010016610 optionally truncated at the given length.
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010016611
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010016612concat([<start>],[<var>],[<end>])
16613 Concatenates up to 3 fields after the current sample which is then turned to
16614 a string. The first one, <start>, is a constant string, that will be appended
16615 immediately after the existing sample. It may be omitted if not used. The
16616 second one, <var>, is a variable name. The variable will be looked up, its
16617 contents converted to a string, and it will be appended immediately after the
16618 <first> part. If the variable is not found, nothing is appended. It may be
16619 omitted as well. The third field, <end> is a constant string that will be
16620 appended after the variable. It may also be omitted. Together, these elements
16621 allow to concatenate variables with delimiters to an existing set of
16622 variables. This can be used to build new variables made of a succession of
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010016623 other variables, such as colon-delimited values. If commas or closing
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040016624 parenthesis are needed as delimiters, they must be protected by quotes or
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010016625 backslashes, themselves protected so that they are not stripped by the first
Willy Tarreau9a621ae2021-09-02 21:00:38 +020016626 level parser. This is often used to build composite variables from other
16627 ones, but sometimes using a format string with multiple fields may be more
16628 convenient. See examples below.
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010016629
16630 Example:
16631 tcp-request session set-var(sess.src) src
16632 tcp-request session set-var(sess.dn) ssl_c_s_dn
16633 tcp-request session set-var(txn.sig) str(),concat(<ip=,sess.ip,>),concat(<dn=,sess.dn,>)
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010016634 tcp-request session set-var(txn.ipport) "str(),concat('addr=(',sess.ip),concat(',',sess.port,')')"
Willy Tarreau9a621ae2021-09-02 21:00:38 +020016635 tcp-request session set-var-fmt(txn.ipport) "addr=(%[sess.ip],%[sess.port])" ## does the same
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010016636 http-request set-header x-hap-sig %[var(txn.sig)]
16637
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016638cpl
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016639 Takes the input value of type signed integer, applies a ones-complement
16640 (flips all bits) and returns the result as an signed integer.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016641
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010016642crc32([<avalanche>])
16643 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32
16644 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
16645 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
16646 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
16647 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
16648 provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32 to be
16649 computed on some input keys, so it follows the most common implementation as
16650 found in Ethernet, Gzip, PNG, etc... It is slower than the other algorithms
16651 but may provide a better or at least less predictable distribution. It must
16652 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010016653 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32c" and the "hash-type" directive.
16654
16655crc32c([<avalanche>])
16656 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32C
16657 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
16658 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
16659 converter uses the same functions as described in RFC4960, Appendix B [8].
16660 It is provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32C to be
16661 computed on some input keys. It is slower than the other algorithms and it must
16662 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
16663 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32" and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010016664
Christopher Fauletea159d62020-04-01 16:21:44 +020016665cut_crlf
16666 Cuts the string representation of the input sample on the first carriage
16667 return ('\r') or newline ('\n') character found. Only the string length is
16668 updated.
16669
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +010016670da-csv-conv(<prop>[,<prop>*])
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020016671 Asks the DeviceAtlas converter to identify the User Agent string passed on
16672 input, and to emit a string made of the concatenation of the properties
16673 enumerated in argument, delimited by the separator defined by the global
16674 keyword "deviceatlas-property-separator", or by default the pipe character
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040016675 ('|'). There's a limit of 12 different properties imposed by the HAProxy
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020016676 configuration language.
16677
16678 Example:
16679 frontend www
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020016680 bind *:8881
16681 default_backend servers
David Carlier840b0242016-03-16 10:09:55 +000016682 http-request set-header X-DeviceAtlas-Data %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),da-csv(primaryHardwareType,osName,osVersion,browserName,browserVersion,browserRenderingEngine)]
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020016683
Willy Tarreau0851fd52019-12-17 10:07:25 +010016684debug([<prefix][,<destination>])
16685 This converter is used as debug tool. It takes a capture of the input sample
16686 and sends it to event sink <destination>, which may designate a ring buffer
16687 such as "buf0", as well as "stdout", or "stderr". Available sinks may be
16688 checked at run time by issuing "show events" on the CLI. When not specified,
16689 the output will be "buf0", which may be consulted via the CLI's "show events"
16690 command. An optional prefix <prefix> may be passed to help distinguish
16691 outputs from multiple expressions. It will then appear before the colon in
16692 the output message. The input sample is passed as-is on the output, so that
16693 it is safe to insert the debug converter anywhere in a chain, even with non-
16694 printable sample types.
16695
16696 Example:
16697 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src,debug(track-sc)
Thierry FOURNIER9687c772015-05-07 15:46:29 +020016698
Patrick Gansterer8e366512020-04-22 16:47:57 +020016699digest(<algorithm>)
16700 Converts a binary input sample to a message digest. The result is a binary
16701 sample. The <algorithm> must be an OpenSSL message digest name (e.g. sha256).
16702
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040016703 Please note that this converter is only available when HAProxy has been
Patrick Gansterer8e366512020-04-22 16:47:57 +020016704 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
16705
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016706div(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016707 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
16708 result as an signed integer. If <value> is null, the largest unsigned
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016709 integer is returned (typically 2^63-1). <value> can be a numeric value or a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016710 variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
16711 scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016712 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016713 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16714 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
16715 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
16716 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016717 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016718 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016719
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020016720djb2([<avalanche>])
16721 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the DJB2
16722 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
16723 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
16724 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
16725 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
16726 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
16727 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010016728 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32c",
16729 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020016730
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016731even
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016732 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is even
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016733 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "not,and(1),bool".
16734
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020016735field(<index>,<delimiters>[,<count>])
16736 Extracts the substring at the given index counting from the beginning
16737 (positive index) or from the end (negative index) considering given delimiters
16738 from an input string. Indexes start at 1 or -1 and delimiters are a string
16739 formatted list of chars. Optionally you can specify <count> of fields to
16740 extract (default: 1). Value of 0 indicates extraction of all remaining
16741 fields.
16742
16743 Example :
16744 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(5,_) # f5
16745 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(2,_,0) # f2_f3__f5
16746 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(2,_,2) # f2_f3
16747 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(-2,_,3) # f2_f3_
16748 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(-3,_,0) # f1_f2_f3
Emeric Brunf399b0d2014-11-03 17:07:03 +010016749
Baptiste Assmanne138dda2020-10-22 15:39:03 +020016750fix_is_valid
16751 Parses a binary payload and performs sanity checks regarding FIX (Financial
16752 Information eXchange):
16753
16754 - checks that all tag IDs and values are not empty and the tags IDs are well
16755 numeric
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +050016756 - checks the BeginString tag is the first tag with a valid FIX version
Baptiste Assmanne138dda2020-10-22 15:39:03 +020016757 - checks the BodyLength tag is the second one with the right body length
Christopher Fauleted4bef72021-03-18 17:40:56 +010016758 - checks the MsgType tag is the third tag.
Baptiste Assmanne138dda2020-10-22 15:39:03 +020016759 - checks that last tag in the message is the CheckSum tag with a valid
16760 checksum
16761
16762 Due to current HAProxy design, only the first message sent by the client and
16763 the server can be parsed.
16764
16765 This converter returns a boolean, true if the payload contains a valid FIX
16766 message, false if not.
16767
16768 See also the fix_tag_value converter.
16769
16770 Example:
16771 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
16772 tcp-request content reject unless { req.payload(0,0),fix_is_valid }
16773
16774fix_tag_value(<tag>)
16775 Parses a FIX (Financial Information eXchange) message and extracts the value
16776 from the tag <tag>. <tag> can be a string or an integer pointing to the
16777 desired tag. Any integer value is accepted, but only the following strings
16778 are translated into their integer equivalent: BeginString, BodyLength,
Daniel Corbettbefef702021-03-09 23:00:34 -050016779 MsgType, SenderCompID, TargetCompID, CheckSum. More tag names can be easily
Baptiste Assmanne138dda2020-10-22 15:39:03 +020016780 added.
16781
16782 Due to current HAProxy design, only the first message sent by the client and
16783 the server can be parsed. No message validation is performed by this
16784 converter. It is highly recommended to validate the message first using
16785 fix_is_valid converter.
16786
16787 See also the fix_is_valid converter.
16788
16789 Example:
16790 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
16791 tcp-request content reject unless { req.payload(0,0),fix_is_valid }
16792 # MsgType tag ID is 35, so both lines below will return the same content
16793 tcp-request content set-var(txn.foo) req.payload(0,0),fix_tag_value(35)
16794 tcp-request content set-var(txn.bar) req.payload(0,0),fix_tag_value(MsgType)
16795
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016796hex
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016797 Converts a binary input sample to a hex string containing two hex digits per
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016798 input byte. It is used to log or transfer hex dumps of some binary input data
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016799 in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g. an SSL ID can be copied in a
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016800 header).
Thierry FOURNIER2f49d6d2014-03-12 15:01:52 +010016801
Dragan Dosen3f957b22017-10-24 09:27:34 +020016802hex2i
16803 Converts a hex string containing two hex digits per input byte to an
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050016804 integer. If the input value cannot be converted, then zero is returned.
Dragan Dosen3f957b22017-10-24 09:27:34 +020016805
Christopher Faulet4ccc12f2020-04-01 09:08:32 +020016806htonl
16807 Converts the input integer value to its 32-bit binary representation in the
16808 network byte order. Because sample fetches own signed 64-bit integer, when
16809 this converter is used, the input integer value is first casted to an
16810 unsigned 32-bit integer.
16811
Tim Duesterhusa3082092021-01-21 17:40:49 +010016812hmac(<algorithm>,<key>)
Patrick Gansterer8e366512020-04-22 16:47:57 +020016813 Converts a binary input sample to a message authentication code with the given
16814 key. The result is a binary sample. The <algorithm> must be one of the
16815 registered OpenSSL message digest names (e.g. sha256). The <key> parameter must
16816 be base64 encoded and can either be a string or a variable.
16817
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040016818 Please note that this converter is only available when HAProxy has been
Patrick Gansterer8e366512020-04-22 16:47:57 +020016819 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
16820
Cyril Bonté6bcd1822019-11-05 23:13:59 +010016821http_date([<offset],[<unit>])
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016822 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
16823 representing this date in a format suitable for use in HTTP header fields. If
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000016824 an offset value is specified, then it is added to the date before the
16825 conversion is operated. This is particularly useful to emit Date header fields,
16826 Expires values in responses when combined with a positive offset, or
16827 Last-Modified values when the offset is negative.
16828 If a unit value is specified, then consider the timestamp as either
16829 "s" for seconds (default behavior), "ms" for milliseconds, or "us" for
16830 microseconds since epoch. Offset is assumed to have the same unit as
16831 input timestamp.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016832
Tim Duesterhus3943e4f2020-09-11 14:25:23 +020016833iif(<true>,<false>)
16834 Returns the <true> string if the input value is true. Returns the <false>
16835 string otherwise.
16836
16837 Example:
Tim Duesterhus870713b2020-09-11 17:13:12 +020016838 http-request set-header x-forwarded-proto %[ssl_fc,iif(https,http)]
Tim Duesterhus3943e4f2020-09-11 14:25:23 +020016839
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016840in_table(<table>)
16841 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16842 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, a boolean false
16843 is returned. Otherwise a boolean true is returned. This can be used to verify
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016844 the presence of a certain key in a table tracking some elements (e.g. whether
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016845 or not a source IP address or an Authorization header was already seen).
16846
Tim Duesterhusa3082092021-01-21 17:40:49 +010016847ipmask(<mask4>,[<mask6>])
Tim Duesterhus1478aa72018-01-25 16:24:51 +010016848 Apply a mask to an IP address, and use the result for lookups and storage.
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020016849 This can be used to make all hosts within a certain mask to share the same
Tim Duesterhus1478aa72018-01-25 16:24:51 +010016850 table entries and as such use the same server. The mask4 can be passed in
16851 dotted form (e.g. 255.255.255.0) or in CIDR form (e.g. 24). The mask6 can
16852 be passed in quadruplet form (e.g. ffff:ffff::) or in CIDR form (e.g. 64).
16853 If no mask6 is given IPv6 addresses will fail to convert for backwards
16854 compatibility reasons.
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020016855
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020016856json([<input-code>])
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016857 Escapes the input string and produces an ASCII output string ready to use as a
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020016858 JSON string. The converter tries to decode the input string according to the
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020016859 <input-code> parameter. It can be "ascii", "utf8", "utf8s", "utf8p" or
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020016860 "utf8ps". The "ascii" decoder never fails. The "utf8" decoder detects 3 types
16861 of errors:
16862 - bad UTF-8 sequence (lone continuation byte, bad number of continuation
16863 bytes, ...)
16864 - invalid range (the decoded value is within a UTF-8 prohibited range),
16865 - code overlong (the value is encoded with more bytes than necessary).
16866
16867 The UTF-8 JSON encoding can produce a "too long value" error when the UTF-8
16868 character is greater than 0xffff because the JSON string escape specification
16869 only authorizes 4 hex digits for the value encoding. The UTF-8 decoder exists
16870 in 4 variants designated by a combination of two suffix letters : "p" for
16871 "permissive" and "s" for "silently ignore". The behaviors of the decoders
16872 are :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016873 - "ascii" : never fails;
16874 - "utf8" : fails on any detected errors;
16875 - "utf8s" : never fails, but removes characters corresponding to errors;
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020016876 - "utf8p" : accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but fails on any other
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016877 error;
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020016878 - "utf8ps" : never fails, accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but removes
16879 characters corresponding to the other errors.
16880
16881 This converter is particularly useful for building properly escaped JSON for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016882 logging to servers which consume JSON-formatted traffic logs.
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020016883
16884 Example:
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020016885 capture request header Host len 15
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020016886 capture request header user-agent len 150
16887 log-format '{"ip":"%[src]","user-agent":"%[capture.req.hdr(1),json(utf8s)]"}'
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020016888
16889 Input request from client 127.0.0.1:
16890 GET / HTTP/1.0
16891 User-Agent: Very "Ugly" UA 1/2
16892
16893 Output log:
16894 {"ip":"127.0.0.1","user-agent":"Very \"Ugly\" UA 1\/2"}
16895
Alex51c8ad42021-04-15 16:45:15 +020016896json_query(<json_path>,[<output_type>])
16897 The json_query converter supports the JSON types string, boolean and
16898 number. Floating point numbers will be returned as a string. By
16899 specifying the output_type 'int' the value will be converted to an
16900 Integer. If conversion is not possible the json_query converter fails.
16901
16902 <json_path> must be a valid JSON Path string as defined in
16903 https://datatracker.ietf.org/doc/draft-ietf-jsonpath-base/
16904
16905 Example:
16906 # get a integer value from the request body
16907 # "{"integer":4}" => 5
16908 http-request set-var(txn.pay_int) req.body,json_query('$.integer','int'),add(1)
16909
16910 # get a key with '.' in the name
16911 # {"my.key":"myvalue"} => myvalue
16912 http-request set-var(txn.pay_mykey) req.body,json_query('$.my\\.key')
16913
16914 # {"boolean-false":false} => 0
16915 http-request set-var(txn.pay_boolean_false) req.body,json_query('$.boolean-false')
16916
16917 # get the value of the key 'iss' from a JWT Bearer token
16918 http-request set-var(txn.token_payload) req.hdr(Authorization),word(2,.),ub64dec,json_query('$.iss')
16919
Remi Tricot-Le Breton0a72f5e2021-10-01 15:36:57 +020016920jwt_header_query([<json_path>],[<output_type>])
16921 When given a JSON Web Token (JWT) in input, either returns the decoded header
16922 part of the token (the first base64-url encoded part of the JWT) if no
16923 parameter is given, or performs a json_query on the decoded header part of
16924 the token. See "json_query" converter for details about the accepted
16925 json_path and output_type parameters.
16926
16927 Please note that this converter is only available when HAProxy has been
16928 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
16929
16930jwt_payload_query([<json_path>],[<output_type>])
16931 When given a JSON Web Token (JWT) in input, either returns the decoded
16932 payload part of the token (the second base64-url encoded part of the JWT) if
16933 no parameter is given, or performs a json_query on the decoded payload part
16934 of the token. See "json_query" converter for details about the accepted
16935 json_path and output_type parameters.
16936
16937 Please note that this converter is only available when HAProxy has been
16938 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
16939
Remi Tricot-Le Breton130e1422021-10-01 15:36:58 +020016940jwt_verify(<alg>,<key>)
16941 Performs a signature verification for the JSON Web Token (JWT) given in input
16942 by using the <alg> algorithm and the <key> parameter, which should either
Willy Tarreau0eba94e2021-10-15 11:48:42 +020016943 hold a secret or a path to a public certificate. Returns 1 in case of
Remi Tricot-Le Breton1c891bc2021-10-18 15:14:49 +020016944 verification success, 0 in case of verification error and a strictly negative
16945 value for any other error. Because of all those non-null error return values,
16946 the result of this converter should never be converted to a boolean. See
16947 below for a full list of the possible return values.
Willy Tarreau0eba94e2021-10-15 11:48:42 +020016948
Remi Tricot-Le Breton130e1422021-10-01 15:36:58 +020016949 For now, only JWS tokens using the Compact Serialization format can be
16950 processed (three dot-separated base64-url encoded strings). Among the
16951 accepted algorithms for a JWS (see section 3.1 of RFC7518), the PSXXX ones
16952 are not managed yet.
Willy Tarreau0eba94e2021-10-15 11:48:42 +020016953
Remi Tricot-Le Breton130e1422021-10-01 15:36:58 +020016954 If the used algorithm is of the HMAC family, <key> should be the secret used
16955 in the HMAC signature calculation. Otherwise, <key> should be the path to the
16956 public certificate that can be used to validate the token's signature. All
16957 the certificates that might be used to verify JWTs must be known during init
16958 in order to be added into a dedicated certificate cache so that no disk
16959 access is required during runtime. For this reason, any used certificate must
Ilya Shipitsina4d09e72021-11-20 23:11:12 +050016960 be mentioned explicitly at least once in a jwt_verify call. Passing an
Remi Tricot-Le Breton130e1422021-10-01 15:36:58 +020016961 intermediate variable as second parameter is then not advised.
16962
16963 This converter only verifies the signature of the token and does not perform
16964 a full JWT validation as specified in section 7.2 of RFC7519. We do not
16965 ensure that the header and payload contents are fully valid JSON's once
16966 decoded for instance, and no checks are performed regarding their respective
16967 contents.
16968
16969 The possible return values are the following :
16970
Willy Tarreau0eba94e2021-10-15 11:48:42 +020016971 +----+----------------------------------------------------------------------+
16972 | ID | message |
16973 +----+----------------------------------------------------------------------+
Remi Tricot-Le Breton1c891bc2021-10-18 15:14:49 +020016974 | 0 | "Verification failure" |
Ilya Shipitsina4d09e72021-11-20 23:11:12 +050016975 | 1 | "Verification success" |
Remi Tricot-Le Breton1c891bc2021-10-18 15:14:49 +020016976 | -1 | "Unknown algorithm (not mentioned in RFC7518)" |
16977 | -2 | "Unmanaged algorithm (PSXXX algorithm family)" |
16978 | -3 | "Invalid token" |
16979 | -4 | "Out of memory" |
16980 | -5 | "Unknown certificate" |
Willy Tarreau0eba94e2021-10-15 11:48:42 +020016981 +----+----------------------------------------------------------------------+
Remi Tricot-Le Breton130e1422021-10-01 15:36:58 +020016982
16983 Please note that this converter is only available when HAProxy has been
16984 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
16985
16986 Example:
16987 # Get a JWT from the authorization header, extract the "alg" field of its
16988 # JOSE header and use a public certificate to verify a signature
16989 http-request set-var(txn.bearer) http_auth_bearer
16990 http-request set-var(txn.jwt_alg) var(txn.bearer),jwt_header_query('$.alg')
16991 http-request deny unless { var(txn.jwt_alg) "RS256" }
16992 http-request deny unless { var(txn.bearer),jwt_verify(txn.jwt_alg,"/path/to/crt.pem") 1 }
16993
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016994language(<value>[,<default>])
16995 Returns the value with the highest q-factor from a list as extracted from the
16996 "accept-language" header using "req.fhdr". Values with no q-factor have a
16997 q-factor of 1. Values with a q-factor of 0 are dropped. Only values which
16998 belong to the list of semi-colon delimited <values> will be considered. The
16999 argument <value> syntax is "lang[;lang[;lang[;...]]]". If no value matches the
17000 given list and a default value is provided, it is returned. Note that language
17001 names may have a variant after a dash ('-'). If this variant is present in the
17002 list, it will be matched, but if it is not, only the base language is checked.
17003 The match is case-sensitive, and the output string is always one of those
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017004 provided in arguments. The ordering of arguments is meaningless, only the
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020017005 ordering of the values in the request counts, as the first value among
17006 multiple sharing the same q-factor is used.
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020017007
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020017008 Example :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020017009
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020017010 # this configuration switches to the backend matching a
17011 # given language based on the request :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020017012
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020017013 acl es req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str es
17014 acl fr req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str fr
17015 acl en req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str en
17016 use_backend spanish if es
17017 use_backend french if fr
17018 use_backend english if en
17019 default_backend choose_your_language
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020017020
Willy Tarreau60a2ee72017-12-15 07:13:48 +010017021length
Etienne Carriereed0d24e2017-12-13 13:41:34 +010017022 Get the length of the string. This can only be placed after a string
17023 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
17024 type. The result is of type integer.
17025
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020017026lower
17027 Convert a string sample to lower case. This can only be placed after a string
17028 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
17029 type. The result is of type string.
17030
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020017031ltime(<format>[,<offset>])
17032 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
17033 representing this date in local time using a format defined by the <format>
17034 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
17035 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
17036 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
17037 by your operating system. See also the utime converter.
17038
17039 Example :
17040
17041 # Emit two colons, one with the local time and another with ip:port
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017042 # e.g. 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020017043 log-format %[date,ltime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
17044
Christopher Faulet51fc9d12020-04-01 17:24:41 +020017045ltrim(<chars>)
17046 Skips any characters from <chars> from the beginning of the string
17047 representation of the input sample.
17048
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020017049map(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
17050map_<match_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
17051map_<match_type>_<output_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
17052 Search the input value from <map_file> using the <match_type> matching method,
17053 and return the associated value converted to the type <output_type>. If the
17054 input value cannot be found in the <map_file>, the converter returns the
17055 <default_value>. If the <default_value> is not set, the converter fails and
17056 acts as if no input value could be fetched. If the <match_type> is not set, it
17057 defaults to "str". Likewise, if the <output_type> is not set, it defaults to
17058 "str". For convenience, the "map" keyword is an alias for "map_str" and maps a
17059 string to another string.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010017060
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020017061 It is important to avoid overlapping between the keys : IP addresses and
17062 strings are stored in trees, so the first of the finest match will be used.
17063 Other keys are stored in lists, so the first matching occurrence will be used.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010017064
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010017065 The following array contains the list of all map functions available sorted by
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020017066 input type, match type and output type.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010017067
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020017068 input type | match method | output type str | output type int | output type ip
17069 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
17070 str | str | map_str | map_str_int | map_str_ip
17071 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Willy Tarreau787a4c02014-05-10 07:55:30 +020017072 str | beg | map_beg | map_beg_int | map_end_ip
17073 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020017074 str | sub | map_sub | map_sub_int | map_sub_ip
17075 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
17076 str | dir | map_dir | map_dir_int | map_dir_ip
17077 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
17078 str | dom | map_dom | map_dom_int | map_dom_ip
17079 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
17080 str | end | map_end | map_end_int | map_end_ip
17081 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Ruoshan Huang3c5e3742016-12-02 16:25:31 +080017082 str | reg | map_reg | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
17083 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
17084 str | reg | map_regm | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020017085 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
17086 int | int | map_int | map_int_int | map_int_ip
17087 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
17088 ip | ip | map_ip | map_ip_int | map_ip_ip
17089 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010017090
Thierry Fournier8feaa662016-02-10 22:55:20 +010017091 The special map called "map_regm" expect matching zone in the regular
17092 expression and modify the output replacing back reference (like "\1") by
17093 the corresponding match text.
17094
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020017095 The file contains one key + value per line. Lines which start with '#' are
17096 ignored, just like empty lines. Leading tabs and spaces are stripped. The key
17097 is then the first "word" (series of non-space/tabs characters), and the value
17098 is what follows this series of space/tab till the end of the line excluding
17099 trailing spaces/tabs.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010017100
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020017101 Example :
17102
17103 # this is a comment and is ignored
17104 2.22.246.0/23 United Kingdom \n
17105 <-><-----------><--><------------><---->
17106 | | | | `- trailing spaces ignored
17107 | | | `---------- value
17108 | | `-------------------- middle spaces ignored
17109 | `---------------------------- key
17110 `------------------------------------ leading spaces ignored
17111
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010017112mod(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020017113 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
17114 remainder as an signed integer. If <value> is null, then zero is returned.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020017115 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017116 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010017117 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017118 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
17119 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
17120 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
17121 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017122 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010017123 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010017124
Alexbf1bd5a2021-04-24 13:02:21 +020017125mqtt_field_value(<packettype>,<fieldname_or_property_ID>)
Baptiste Assmanne279ca62020-10-27 18:10:06 +010017126 Returns value of <fieldname> found in input MQTT payload of type
17127 <packettype>.
17128 <packettype> can be either a string (case insensitive matching) or a numeric
17129 value corresponding to the type of packet we're supposed to extract data
17130 from.
17131 Supported string and integers can be found here:
17132 https://docs.oasis-open.org/mqtt/mqtt/v3.1.1/os/mqtt-v3.1.1-os.html#_Toc398718021
17133 https://docs.oasis-open.org/mqtt/mqtt/v5.0/os/mqtt-v5.0-os.html#_Toc3901022
17134
17135 <fieldname> depends on <packettype> and can be any of the following below.
17136 (note that <fieldname> matching is case insensitive).
17137 <property id> can only be found in MQTT v5.0 streams. check this table:
17138 https://docs.oasis-open.org/mqtt/mqtt/v5.0/os/mqtt-v5.0-os.html#_Toc3901029
17139
17140 - CONNECT (or 1): flags, protocol_name, protocol_version, client_identifier,
17141 will_topic, will_payload, username, password, keepalive
17142 OR any property ID as a numeric value (for MQTT v5.0
17143 packets only):
17144 17: Session Expiry Interval
17145 33: Receive Maximum
17146 39: Maximum Packet Size
17147 34: Topic Alias Maximum
17148 25: Request Response Information
17149 23: Request Problem Information
17150 21: Authentication Method
17151 22: Authentication Data
17152 18: Will Delay Interval
17153 1: Payload Format Indicator
17154 2: Message Expiry Interval
17155 3: Content Type
17156 8: Response Topic
17157 9: Correlation Data
17158 Not supported yet:
17159 38: User Property
17160
17161 - CONNACK (or 2): flags, protocol_version, reason_code
17162 OR any property ID as a numeric value (for MQTT v5.0
17163 packets only):
17164 17: Session Expiry Interval
17165 33: Receive Maximum
17166 36: Maximum QoS
17167 37: Retain Available
17168 39: Maximum Packet Size
17169 18: Assigned Client Identifier
17170 34: Topic Alias Maximum
17171 31: Reason String
17172 40; Wildcard Subscription Available
17173 41: Subscription Identifiers Available
17174 42: Shared Subscription Available
17175 19: Server Keep Alive
17176 26: Response Information
17177 28: Server Reference
17178 21: Authentication Method
17179 22: Authentication Data
17180 Not supported yet:
17181 38: User Property
17182
17183 Due to current HAProxy design, only the first message sent by the client and
17184 the server can be parsed. Thus this converter can extract data only from
17185 CONNECT and CONNACK packet types. CONNECT is the first message sent by the
17186 client and CONNACK is the first response sent by the server.
17187
17188 Example:
17189
17190 acl data_in_buffer req.len ge 4
17191 tcp-request content set-var(txn.username) \
17192 req.payload(0,0),mqtt_field_value(connect,protocol_name) \
17193 if data_in_buffer
17194 # do the same as above
17195 tcp-request content set-var(txn.username) \
17196 req.payload(0,0),mqtt_field_value(1,protocol_name) \
17197 if data_in_buffer
17198
17199mqtt_is_valid
17200 Checks that the binary input is a valid MQTT packet. It returns a boolean.
17201
17202 Due to current HAProxy design, only the first message sent by the client and
17203 the server can be parsed. Thus this converter can extract data only from
17204 CONNECT and CONNACK packet types. CONNECT is the first message sent by the
17205 client and CONNACK is the first response sent by the server.
17206
Christopher Faulet140a3572022-03-22 09:41:11 +010017207 Only MQTT 3.1, 3.1.1 and 5.0 are supported.
17208
Baptiste Assmanne279ca62020-10-27 18:10:06 +010017209 Example:
17210
17211 acl data_in_buffer req.len ge 4
Daniel Corbettcc9d9b02021-05-13 10:46:07 -040017212 tcp-request content reject unless { req.payload(0,0),mqtt_is_valid }
Baptiste Assmanne279ca62020-10-27 18:10:06 +010017213
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010017214mul(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020017215 Multiplies the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns
Thierry FOURNIER00c005c2015-07-08 01:10:21 +020017216 the product as an signed integer. In case of overflow, the largest possible
17217 value for the sign is returned so that the operation doesn't wrap around.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020017218 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017219 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010017220 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017221 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
17222 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
17223 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
17224 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017225 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010017226 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010017227
Nenad Merdanovicb7e7c472017-03-12 21:56:55 +010017228nbsrv
17229 Takes an input value of type string, interprets it as a backend name and
17230 returns the number of usable servers in that backend. Can be used in places
17231 where we want to look up a backend from a dynamic name, like a result of a
17232 map lookup.
17233
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010017234neg
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020017235 Takes the input value of type signed integer, computes the opposite value,
17236 and returns the remainder as an signed integer. 0 is identity. This operator
17237 is provided for reversed subtracts : in order to subtract the input from a
17238 constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)".
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010017239
17240not
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020017241 Returns a boolean FALSE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010017242 non-null, otherwise returns TRUE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017243 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (e.g. verify the
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010017244 absence of a flag).
17245
17246odd
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020017247 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is odd
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010017248 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "and(1),bool".
17249
17250or(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020017251 Performs a bitwise "OR" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020017252 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017253 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
17254 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010017255 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017256 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
17257 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
17258 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
17259 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017260 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010017261 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010017262
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010017263protobuf(<field_number>,[<field_type>])
17264 This extracts the protocol buffers message field in raw mode of an input binary
17265 sample representation of a protocol buffer message with <field_number> as field
17266 number (dotted notation) if <field_type> is not present, or as an integer sample
17267 if this field is present (see also "ungrpc" below).
17268 The list of the authorized types is the following one: "int32", "int64", "uint32",
17269 "uint64", "sint32", "sint64", "bool", "enum" for the "varint" wire type 0
17270 "fixed64", "sfixed64", "double" for the 64bit wire type 1, "fixed32", "sfixed32",
17271 "float" for the wire type 5. Note that "string" is considered as a length-delimited
17272 type, so it does not require any <field_type> argument to be extracted.
17273 More information may be found here about the protocol buffers message field types:
17274 https://developers.google.com/protocol-buffers/docs/encoding
17275
Willy Tarreauc4dc3502015-01-23 20:39:28 +010017276regsub(<regex>,<subst>[,<flags>])
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010017277 Applies a regex-based substitution to the input string. It does the same
17278 operation as the well-known "sed" utility with "s/<regex>/<subst>/". By
17279 default it will replace in the input string the first occurrence of the
17280 largest part matching the regular expression <regex> with the substitution
17281 string <subst>. It is possible to replace all occurrences instead by adding
17282 the flag "g" in the third argument <flags>. It is also possible to make the
17283 regex case insensitive by adding the flag "i" in <flags>. Since <flags> is a
17284 string, it is made up from the concatenation of all desired flags. Thus if
17285 both "i" and "g" are desired, using "gi" or "ig" will have the same effect.
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010017286 The first use of this converter is to replace certain characters or sequence
17287 of characters with other ones.
17288
17289 It is highly recommended to enclose the regex part using protected quotes to
17290 improve clarity and never have a closing parenthesis from the regex mixed up
17291 with the parenthesis from the function. Just like in Bourne shell, the first
17292 level of quotes is processed when delimiting word groups on the line, a
17293 second level is usable for argument. It is recommended to use single quotes
17294 outside since these ones do not try to resolve backslashes nor dollar signs.
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010017295
Willy Tarreaucd0d2ed2020-02-14 17:33:06 +010017296 Examples:
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010017297
17298 # de-duplicate "/" in header "x-path".
17299 # input: x-path: /////a///b/c/xzxyz/
17300 # output: x-path: /a/b/c/xzxyz/
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010017301 http-request set-header x-path "%[hdr(x-path),regsub('/+','/','g')]"
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010017302
Willy Tarreaucd0d2ed2020-02-14 17:33:06 +010017303 # copy query string to x-query and drop all leading '?', ';' and '&'
17304 http-request set-header x-query "%[query,regsub([?;&]*,'')]"
17305
Jerome Magnin07e1e3c2020-02-16 19:20:19 +010017306 # capture groups and backreferences
17307 # both lines do the same.
Willy Tarreau465dc7d2020-10-08 18:05:56 +020017308 http-request redirect location %[url,'regsub("(foo|bar)([0-9]+)?","\2\1",i)']
Jerome Magnin07e1e3c2020-02-16 19:20:19 +010017309 http-request redirect location %[url,regsub(\"(foo|bar)([0-9]+)?\",\"\2\1\",i)]
17310
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020017311capture-req(<id>)
17312 Capture the string entry in the request slot <id> and returns the entry as
17313 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
17314
17315 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020017316 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
17317 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020017318
17319capture-res(<id>)
17320 Capture the string entry in the response slot <id> and returns the entry as
17321 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
17322
17323 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020017324 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
17325 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020017326
Christopher Faulet568415a2020-04-01 17:24:47 +020017327rtrim(<chars>)
17328 Skips any characters from <chars> from the end of the string representation
17329 of the input sample.
17330
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020017331sdbm([<avalanche>])
17332 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the SDBM
17333 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
17334 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
17335 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
17336 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
17337 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
17338 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010017339 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "wt6", "crc32c",
17340 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020017341
Tim Duesterhusf38175c2020-06-09 11:48:42 +020017342secure_memcmp(<var>)
17343 Compares the contents of <var> with the input value. Both values are treated
17344 as a binary string. Returns a boolean indicating whether both binary strings
17345 match.
17346
17347 If both binary strings have the same length then the comparison will be
17348 performed in constant time.
17349
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040017350 Please note that this converter is only available when HAProxy has been
Tim Duesterhusf38175c2020-06-09 11:48:42 +020017351 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
17352
17353 Example :
17354
17355 http-request set-var(txn.token) hdr(token)
17356 # Check whether the token sent by the client matches the secret token
17357 # value, without leaking the contents using a timing attack.
17358 acl token_given str(my_secret_token),secure_memcmp(txn.token)
17359
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +010017360set-var(<var>[,<cond> ...])
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017361 Sets a variable with the input content and returns the content on the output
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +010017362 as-is if all of the specified conditions are true (see below for a list of
17363 possible conditions). The variable keeps the value and the associated input
17364 type. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The
17365 scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010017366 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017367 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
17368 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020017369 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017370 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
17371 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020017372 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010017373 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020017374
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +010017375 You can pass at most four conditions to the converter among the following
17376 possible conditions :
17377 - "ifexists"/"ifnotexists":
17378 Checks if the variable already existed before the current set-var call.
17379 A variable is usually created through a successful set-var call.
17380 Note that variables of scope "proc" are created during configuration
17381 parsing so the "ifexists" condition will always be true for them.
17382 - "ifempty"/"ifnotempty":
17383 Checks if the input is empty or not.
17384 Scalar types are never empty so the ifempty condition will be false for
17385 them regardless of the input's contents (integers, booleans, IPs ...).
17386 - "ifset"/"ifnotset":
17387 Checks if the variable was previously set or not, or if unset-var was
17388 called on the variable.
17389 A variable that does not exist yet is considered as not set. A "proc"
17390 variable can exist while not being set since they are created during
17391 configuration parsing.
17392 - "ifgt"/"iflt":
17393 Checks if the content of the variable is "greater than" or "less than"
17394 the input. This check can only be performed if both the input and
17395 the variable are of type integer. Otherwise, the check is considered as
17396 true by default.
17397
Dragan Dosen6e5a9ca2017-10-24 09:18:23 +020017398sha1
Tim Duesterhusd4376302019-06-17 12:41:44 +020017399 Converts a binary input sample to a SHA-1 digest. The result is a binary
Dragan Dosen6e5a9ca2017-10-24 09:18:23 +020017400 sample with length of 20 bytes.
17401
Tim Duesterhusd4376302019-06-17 12:41:44 +020017402sha2([<bits>])
17403 Converts a binary input sample to a digest in the SHA-2 family. The result
17404 is a binary sample with length of <bits>/8 bytes.
17405
17406 Valid values for <bits> are 224, 256, 384, 512, each corresponding to
17407 SHA-<bits>. The default value is 256.
17408
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040017409 Please note that this converter is only available when HAProxy has been
Tim Duesterhusd4376302019-06-17 12:41:44 +020017410 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
17411
Nenad Merdanovic177adc92019-08-27 01:58:13 +020017412srv_queue
17413 Takes an input value of type string, either a server name or <backend>/<server>
17414 format and returns the number of queued sessions on that server. Can be used
17415 in places where we want to look up queued sessions from a dynamic name, like a
17416 cookie value (e.g. req.cook(SRVID),srv_queue) and then make a decision to break
17417 persistence or direct a request elsewhere.
17418
Tim Duesterhusca097c12018-04-27 21:18:45 +020017419strcmp(<var>)
17420 Compares the contents of <var> with the input value of type string. Returns
17421 the result as a signed integer compatible with strcmp(3): 0 if both strings
17422 are identical. A value less than 0 if the left string is lexicographically
17423 smaller than the right string or if the left string is shorter. A value greater
17424 than 0 otherwise (right string greater than left string or the right string is
17425 shorter).
17426
Tim Duesterhusf38175c2020-06-09 11:48:42 +020017427 See also the secure_memcmp converter if you need to compare two binary
17428 strings in constant time.
17429
Tim Duesterhusca097c12018-04-27 21:18:45 +020017430 Example :
17431
17432 http-request set-var(txn.host) hdr(host)
17433 # Check whether the client is attempting domain fronting.
17434 acl ssl_sni_http_host_match ssl_fc_sni,strcmp(txn.host) eq 0
17435
17436
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010017437sub(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020017438 Subtracts <value> from the input value of type signed integer, and returns
17439 the result as an signed integer. Note: in order to subtract the input from
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020017440 a constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)". <value> can be a numeric value
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017441 or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about
17442 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010017443 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017444 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
17445 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020017446 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017447 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
17448 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020017449 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010017450 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010017451
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020017452table_bytes_in_rate(<table>)
17453 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17454 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
17455 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average client-to-server
17456 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
17457 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
17458 sc_bytes_in_rate sample fetch keyword.
17459
17460
17461table_bytes_out_rate(<table>)
17462 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17463 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
17464 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average server-to-client
17465 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
17466 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
17467 sc_bytes_out_rate sample fetch keyword.
17468
17469table_conn_cnt(<table>)
17470 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17471 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017472 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of incoming
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020017473 connections associated with the input sample in the designated table. See
17474 also the sc_conn_cnt sample fetch keyword.
17475
17476table_conn_cur(<table>)
17477 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17478 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
17479 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
17480 tracked connections associated with the input sample in the designated table.
17481 See also the sc_conn_cur sample fetch keyword.
17482
17483table_conn_rate(<table>)
17484 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17485 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
17486 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming connection
17487 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
17488 sc_conn_rate sample fetch keyword.
17489
Emeric Brun877b0b52021-06-30 18:57:49 +020017490table_gpt(<idx>,<table>)
17491 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a lookup in
17492 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, boolean value zero
17493 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the general
17494 purpose tag at the index <idx> of the array associated to the input sample
17495 in the designated <table>. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99.
17496 If there is no GPT stored at this index, it also returns the boolean value 0.
17497 This applies only to the 'gpt' array data_type (and not on the legacy 'gpt0'
17498 data-type).
17499 See also the sc_get_gpt sample fetch keyword.
17500
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020017501table_gpt0(<table>)
17502 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17503 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, boolean value zero
17504 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
17505 general purpose tag associated with the input sample in the designated table.
17506 See also the sc_get_gpt0 sample fetch keyword.
17507
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020017508table_gpc(<idx>,<table>)
17509 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a lookup in
17510 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
17511 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the
17512 General Purpose Counter at the index <idx> of the array associated
17513 to the input sample in the designated <table>. <idx> is an integer
17514 between 0 and 99.
17515 If there is no GPC stored at this index, it also returns the boolean value 0.
17516 This applies only to the 'gpc' array data_type (and not to the legacy
17517 'gpc0' nor 'gpc1' data_types).
17518 See also the sc_get_gpc sample fetch keyword.
17519
17520table_gpc_rate(<idx>,<table>)
17521 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a lookup in
17522 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
17523 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the Global
17524 Purpose Counter at index <idx> of the array (associated to the input sample
17525 in the designated stick-table <table>) was incremented over the
17526 configured period. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99.
17527 If there is no gpc_rate stored at this index, it also returns the boolean
17528 value 0.
17529 This applies only to the 'gpc_rate' array data_type (and not to the
17530 legacy 'gpc0_rate' nor 'gpc1_rate' data_types).
17531 See also the sc_gpc_rate sample fetch keyword.
17532
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020017533table_gpc0(<table>)
17534 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17535 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
17536 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
17537 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
17538 table. See also the sc_get_gpc0 sample fetch keyword.
17539
17540table_gpc0_rate(<table>)
17541 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17542 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
17543 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc0
17544 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
17545 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc0_rate
17546 sample fetch keyword.
17547
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010017548table_gpc1(<table>)
17549 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17550 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
17551 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the second
17552 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
17553 table. See also the sc_get_gpc1 sample fetch keyword.
17554
17555table_gpc1_rate(<table>)
17556 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17557 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
17558 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc1
17559 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
17560 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc1_rate
17561 sample fetch keyword.
17562
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020017563table_http_err_cnt(<table>)
17564 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17565 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017566 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020017567 errors associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
17568 sc_http_err_cnt sample fetch keyword.
17569
17570table_http_err_rate(<table>)
17571 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17572 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
17573 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP errors associated with the
17574 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of errors over the
17575 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_err_rate sample fetch
17576 keyword.
17577
Willy Tarreau826f3ab2021-02-10 12:07:15 +010017578table_http_fail_cnt(<table>)
17579 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17580 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
17581 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
17582 failures associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also
17583 the sc_http_fail_cnt sample fetch keyword.
17584
17585table_http_fail_rate(<table>)
17586 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17587 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
17588 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP failures associated with the
17589 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of failures over the
17590 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_fail_rate sample fetch
17591 keyword.
17592
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020017593table_http_req_cnt(<table>)
17594 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17595 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017596 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020017597 requests associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also
17598 the sc_http_req_cnt sample fetch keyword.
17599
17600table_http_req_rate(<table>)
17601 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17602 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
17603 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP requests associated with the
17604 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of requests over the
17605 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_req_rate sample fetch
17606 keyword.
17607
17608table_kbytes_in(<table>)
17609 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17610 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017611 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of client-
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020017612 to-server data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
17613 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
17614 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_in sample fetch
17615 keyword.
17616
17617table_kbytes_out(<table>)
17618 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17619 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017620 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of server-
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020017621 to-client data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
17622 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
17623 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_out sample fetch
17624 keyword.
17625
17626table_server_id(<table>)
17627 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17628 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
17629 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the server ID associated with
17630 the input sample in the designated table. A server ID is associated to a
17631 sample by a "stick" rule when a connection to a server succeeds. A server ID
17632 zero means that no server is associated with this key.
17633
17634table_sess_cnt(<table>)
17635 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17636 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017637 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of incoming
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020017638 sessions associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that
17639 a session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
17640 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_cnt sample fetch
17641 keyword.
17642
17643table_sess_rate(<table>)
17644 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17645 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
17646 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming session
17647 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that a
17648 session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
17649 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_rate sample fetch
17650 keyword.
17651
17652table_trackers(<table>)
17653 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17654 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
17655 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
17656 connections tracking the same key as the input sample in the designated
17657 table. It differs from table_conn_cur in that it does not rely on any stored
17658 information but on the table's reference count (the "use" value which is
17659 returned by "show table" on the CLI). This may sometimes be more suited for
17660 layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a server how many concurrent
17661 connections there are from a given address for example. See also the
17662 sc_trackers sample fetch keyword.
17663
Moemen MHEDHBI92f7d432021-04-01 20:53:59 +020017664ub64dec
17665 This converter is the base64url variant of b64dec converter. base64url
17666 encoding is the "URL and Filename Safe Alphabet" variant of base64 encoding.
17667 It is also the encoding used in JWT (JSON Web Token) standard.
17668
17669 Example:
17670 # Decoding a JWT payload:
17671 http-request set-var(txn.token_payload) req.hdr(Authorization),word(2,.),ub64dec
17672
17673ub64enc
17674 This converter is the base64url variant of base64 converter.
17675
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020017676upper
17677 Convert a string sample to upper case. This can only be placed after a string
17678 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
17679 type. The result is of type string.
17680
Willy Tarreau62ba9ba2020-04-23 17:54:47 +020017681url_dec([<in_form>])
17682 Takes an url-encoded string provided as input and returns the decoded version
17683 as output. The input and the output are of type string. If the <in_form>
17684 argument is set to a non-zero integer value, the input string is assumed to
17685 be part of a form or query string and the '+' character will be turned into a
17686 space (' '). Otherwise this will only happen after a question mark indicating
17687 a query string ('?').
Thierry FOURNIER82ff3c92015-05-07 15:46:20 +020017688
William Dauchy888b0ae2021-01-06 23:39:50 +010017689url_enc([<enc_type>])
17690 Takes a string provided as input and returns the encoded version as output.
17691 The input and the output are of type string. By default the type of encoding
17692 is meant for `query` type. There is no other type supported for now but the
17693 optional argument is here for future changes.
17694
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010017695ungrpc(<field_number>,[<field_type>])
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010017696 This extracts the protocol buffers message field in raw mode of an input binary
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010017697 sample representation of a gRPC message with <field_number> as field number
17698 (dotted notation) if <field_type> is not present, or as an integer sample if this
17699 field is present.
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010017700 The list of the authorized types is the following one: "int32", "int64", "uint32",
17701 "uint64", "sint32", "sint64", "bool", "enum" for the "varint" wire type 0
17702 "fixed64", "sfixed64", "double" for the 64bit wire type 1, "fixed32", "sfixed32",
17703 "float" for the wire type 5. Note that "string" is considered as a length-delimited
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010017704 type, so it does not require any <field_type> argument to be extracted.
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010017705 More information may be found here about the protocol buffers message field types:
17706 https://developers.google.com/protocol-buffers/docs/encoding
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010017707
17708 Example:
17709 // with such a protocol buffer .proto file content adapted from
17710 // https://github.com/grpc/grpc/blob/master/examples/protos/route_guide.proto
17711
17712 message Point {
17713 int32 latitude = 1;
17714 int32 longitude = 2;
17715 }
17716
17717 message PPoint {
17718 Point point = 59;
17719 }
17720
17721 message Rectangle {
17722 // One corner of the rectangle.
17723 PPoint lo = 48;
17724 // The other corner of the rectangle.
17725 PPoint hi = 49;
17726 }
17727
Peter Gervaidf4c9d22020-06-11 18:05:11 +020017728 let's say a body request is made of a "Rectangle" object value (two PPoint
17729 protocol buffers messages), the four protocol buffers fields could be
17730 extracted with these "ungrpc" directives:
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010017731
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010017732 req.body,ungrpc(48.59.1,int32) # "latitude" of "lo" first PPoint
17733 req.body,ungrpc(48.59.2,int32) # "longitude" of "lo" first PPoint
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050017734 req.body,ungrpc(49.59.1,int32) # "latitude" of "hi" second PPoint
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010017735 req.body,ungrpc(49.59.2,int32) # "longitude" of "hi" second PPoint
17736
Peter Gervaidf4c9d22020-06-11 18:05:11 +020017737 We could also extract the intermediary 48.59 field as a binary sample as follows:
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010017738
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010017739 req.body,ungrpc(48.59)
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010017740
Peter Gervaidf4c9d22020-06-11 18:05:11 +020017741 As a gRPC message is always made of a gRPC header followed by protocol buffers
17742 messages, in the previous example the "latitude" of "lo" first PPoint
17743 could be extracted with these equivalent directives:
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010017744
17745 req.body,ungrpc(48.59),protobuf(1,int32)
17746 req.body,ungrpc(48),protobuf(59.1,int32)
17747 req.body,ungrpc(48),protobuf(59),protobuf(1,int32)
17748
Peter Gervaidf4c9d22020-06-11 18:05:11 +020017749 Note that the first convert must be "ungrpc", the remaining ones must be
17750 "protobuf" and only the last one may have or not a second argument to
17751 interpret the previous binary sample.
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010017752
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010017753
Tim Duesterhusef4e45c2021-01-21 17:40:50 +010017754unset-var(<var>)
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010017755 Unsets a variable if the input content is defined. The name of the variable
17756 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
17757 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
17758 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
17759 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
17760 response),
17761 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
17762 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
17763 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
17764 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
17765
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020017766utime(<format>[,<offset>])
17767 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
17768 representing this date in UTC time using a format defined by the <format>
17769 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
17770 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
17771 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
17772 by your operating system. See also the ltime converter.
17773
17774 Example :
17775
17776 # Emit two colons, one with the UTC time and another with ip:port
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017777 # e.g. 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020017778 log-format %[date,utime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
17779
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020017780word(<index>,<delimiters>[,<count>])
17781 Extracts the nth word counting from the beginning (positive index) or from
17782 the end (negative index) considering given delimiters from an input string.
17783 Indexes start at 1 or -1 and delimiters are a string formatted list of chars.
Jerome Magnin88209322020-01-28 13:33:44 +010017784 Delimiters at the beginning or end of the input string are ignored.
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020017785 Optionally you can specify <count> of words to extract (default: 1).
17786 Value of 0 indicates extraction of all remaining words.
17787
17788 Example :
17789 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(4,_) # f5
17790 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(2,_,0) # f2_f3__f5
17791 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(3,_,2) # f3__f5
17792 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(-2,_,3) # f1_f2_f3
17793 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(-3,_,0) # f1_f2
Jerome Magnin88209322020-01-28 13:33:44 +010017794 str(/f1/f2/f3/f4),word(1,/) # f1
Emeric Brunc9a0f6d2014-11-25 14:09:01 +010017795
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020017796wt6([<avalanche>])
17797 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the WT6
17798 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
17799 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
17800 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
17801 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
17802 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
17803 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010017804 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "sdbm", "crc32c",
17805 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020017806
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010017807xor(<value>)
17808 Performs a bitwise "XOR" (exclusive OR) between <value> and the input value
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020017809 of type signed integer, and returns the result as an signed integer.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020017810 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017811 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010017812 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017813 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
17814 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020017815 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017816 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
17817 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020017818 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010017819 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010017820
Dragan Dosen04bf0cc2020-12-22 21:44:33 +010017821xxh3([<seed>])
17822 Hashes a binary input sample into a signed 64-bit quantity using the XXH3
17823 64-bit variant of the XXhash hash function. This hash supports a seed which
17824 defaults to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument.
17825 This hash is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash
17826 URLs and/or URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics
17827 with a low collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not
17828 considered as cryptographically secure.
17829
Thierry FOURNIER01e09742016-12-26 11:46:11 +010017830xxh32([<seed>])
17831 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the 32-bit
17832 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
17833 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
17834 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
17835 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
17836 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
17837 as cryptographically secure.
17838
17839xxh64([<seed>])
17840 Hashes a binary input sample into a signed 64-bit quantity using the 64-bit
17841 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
17842 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
17843 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
17844 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
17845 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
17846 as cryptographically secure.
17847
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010017848
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200178497.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017850--------------------------------------------
17851
17852A first set of sample fetch methods applies to internal information which does
17853not even relate to any client information. These ones are sometimes used with
17854"monitor-fail" directives to report an internal status to external watchers.
17855The sample fetch methods described in this section are usable anywhere.
17856
17857always_false : boolean
17858 Always returns the boolean "false" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
17859 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
17860
17861always_true : boolean
17862 Always returns the boolean "true" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
17863 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
17864
17865avg_queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017866 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017867 divided by the number of active servers. The current backend is used if no
17868 backend is specified. This is very similar to "queue" except that the size of
17869 the farm is considered, in order to give a more accurate measurement of the
17870 time it may take for a new connection to be processed. The main usage is with
17871 ACL to return a sorry page to new users when it becomes certain they will get
17872 a degraded service, or to pass to the backend servers in a header so that
17873 they decide to work in degraded mode or to disable some functions to speed up
17874 the processing a bit. Note that in the event there would not be any active
17875 server anymore, twice the number of queued connections would be considered as
17876 the measured value. This is a fair estimate, as we expect one server to get
17877 back soon anyway, but we still prefer to send new traffic to another backend
17878 if in better shape. See also the "queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate"
17879 sample fetches.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki346f76d2010-01-12 21:59:30 +010017880
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017881be_conn([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020017882 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the backend,
17883 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no backend name is
17884 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
17885 backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the nominal one is full.
Patrick Hemmer4cdf3ab2018-06-14 17:10:27 -040017886 See also the "fe_conn", "queue", "be_conn_free", and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
17887
17888be_conn_free([<backend>]) : integer
17889 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of available connections
17890 across available servers in the backend. Queue slots are not included. Backup
17891 servers are also not included, unless all other servers are down. If no
17892 backend name is specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible
17893 to check another backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the
Patrick Hemmer155e93e2018-06-14 18:01:35 -040017894 nominal one is full. See also the "be_conn", "connslots", and "srv_conn_free"
17895 criteria.
Patrick Hemmer4cdf3ab2018-06-14 17:10:27 -040017896
17897 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0
17898 (meaning unlimited), then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which
17899 case the value returned will be -1.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017900
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017901be_sess_rate([<backend>]) : integer
17902 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
17903 backend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
17904 switch to an alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017905 high a session rate, or to limit abuse of service (e.g. prevent sucking of an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017906 online dictionary). It can also be useful to add this element to logs using a
17907 log-format directive.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017908
17909 Example :
17910 # Redirect to an error page if the dictionary is requested too often
17911 backend dynamic
17912 mode http
17913 acl being_scanned be_sess_rate gt 100
17914 redirect location /denied.html if being_scanned
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010017915
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017916bin(<hex>) : bin
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020017917 Returns a binary chain. The input is the hexadecimal representation
17918 of the string.
17919
17920bool(<bool>) : bool
17921 Returns a boolean value. <bool> can be 'true', 'false', '1' or '0'.
17922 'false' and '0' are the same. 'true' and '1' are the same.
17923
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017924connslots([<backend>]) : integer
17925 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connection slots
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017926 still available in the backend, by totaling the maximum amount of
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017927 connections on all servers and the maximum queue size. This is probably only
17928 used with ACLs.
Tait Clarridge7896d522012-12-05 21:39:31 -050017929
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080017930 The basic idea here is to be able to measure the number of connection "slots"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020017931 still available (connection + queue), so that anything beyond that (intended
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080017932 usage; see "use_backend" keyword) can be redirected to a different backend.
17933
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020017934 'connslots' = number of available server connection slots, + number of
17935 available server queue slots.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080017936
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020017937 Note that while "fe_conn" may be used, "connslots" comes in especially
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020017938 useful when you have a case of traffic going to one single ip, splitting into
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017939 multiple backends (perhaps using ACLs to do name-based load balancing) and
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020017940 you want to be able to differentiate between different backends, and their
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017941 available "connslots". Also, whereas "nbsrv" only measures servers that are
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017942 actually *down*, this fetch is more fine-grained and looks into the number of
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020017943 available connection slots as well. See also "queue" and "avg_queue".
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080017944
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020017945 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: at this point in time, the code does not take care
17946 of dynamic connections. Also, if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0,
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017947 then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which case the value returned
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020017948 will be -1.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080017949
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010017950cpu_calls : integer
17951 Returns the number of calls to the task processing the stream or current
17952 request since it was allocated. This number is reset for each new request on
17953 the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value should usually be
17954 low and stable (around 2 calls for a typically simple request) but may become
17955 high if some processing (compression, caching or analysis) is performed. This
17956 is purely for performance monitoring purposes.
17957
17958cpu_ns_avg : integer
17959 Returns the average number of nanoseconds spent in each call to the task
17960 processing the stream or current request. This number is reset for each new
17961 request on the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value
17962 indicates the overall cost of processing the request or the connection for
17963 each call. There is no good nor bad value but the time spent in a call
17964 automatically causes latency for other processing (see lat_ns_avg below),
17965 and may affect other connection's apparent response time. Certain operations
17966 like compression, complex regex matching or heavy Lua operations may directly
17967 affect this value, and having it in the logs will make it easier to spot the
17968 faulty processing that needs to be fixed to recover decent performance.
17969 Note: this value is exactly cpu_ns_tot divided by cpu_calls.
17970
17971cpu_ns_tot : integer
17972 Returns the total number of nanoseconds spent in each call to the task
17973 processing the stream or current request. This number is reset for each new
17974 request on the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value
17975 indicates the overall cost of processing the request or the connection for
17976 each call. There is no good nor bad value but the time spent in a call
17977 automatically causes latency for other processing (see lat_ns_avg below),
17978 induces CPU costs on the machine, and may affect other connection's apparent
17979 response time. Certain operations like compression, complex regex matching or
17980 heavy Lua operations may directly affect this value, and having it in the
17981 logs will make it easier to spot the faulty processing that needs to be fixed
17982 to recover decent performance. The value may be artificially high due to a
17983 high cpu_calls count, for example when processing many HTTP chunks, and for
17984 this reason it is often preferred to log cpu_ns_avg instead.
17985
Cyril Bonté6bcd1822019-11-05 23:13:59 +010017986date([<offset>],[<unit>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020017987 Returns the current date as the epoch (number of seconds since 01/01/1970).
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000017988
17989 If an offset value is specified, then it is added to the current date before
17990 returning the value. This is particularly useful to compute relative dates,
17991 as both positive and negative offsets are allowed.
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020017992 It is useful combined with the http_date converter.
17993
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000017994 <unit> is facultative, and can be set to "s" for seconds (default behavior),
17995 "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds.
17996 If unit is set, return value is an integer reflecting either seconds,
17997 milliseconds or microseconds since epoch, plus offset.
17998 It is useful when a time resolution of less than a second is needed.
17999
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020018000 Example :
18001
18002 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response
18003 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600),http_date]
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020018004
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000018005 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response, with
18006 # millisecond granularity
18007 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600000,ms),http_date(0,ms)]
18008
Etienne Carrierea792a0a2018-01-17 13:43:24 +010018009date_us : integer
18010 Return the microseconds part of the date (the "second" part is returned by
18011 date sample). This sample is coherent with the date sample as it is comes
18012 from the same timeval structure.
18013
Willy Tarreau595ec542013-06-12 21:34:28 +020018014env(<name>) : string
18015 Returns a string containing the value of environment variable <name>. As a
18016 reminder, environment variables are per-process and are sampled when the
18017 process starts. This can be useful to pass some information to a next hop
18018 server, or with ACLs to take specific action when the process is started a
18019 certain way.
18020
18021 Examples :
18022 # Pass the Via header to next hop with the local hostname in it
18023 http-request add-header Via 1.1\ %[env(HOSTNAME)]
18024
18025 # reject cookie-less requests when the STOP environment variable is set
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010018026 http-request deny if !{ req.cook(SESSIONID) -m found } { env(STOP) -m found }
Willy Tarreau595ec542013-06-12 21:34:28 +020018027
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018028fe_conn([<frontend>]) : integer
18029 Returns the number of currently established connections on the frontend,
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018030 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no frontend name is
18031 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018032 frontend. It can be used to return a sorry page before hard-blocking, or to
18033 use a specific backend to drain new requests when the farm is considered
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018034 full. This is mostly used with ACLs but can also be used to pass some
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018035 statistics to servers in HTTP headers. See also the "dst_conn", "be_conn",
18036 "fe_sess_rate" fetches.
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020018037
Nenad Merdanovicad9a7e92016-10-03 04:57:37 +020018038fe_req_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
18039 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of HTTP requests per
18040 second sent to a frontend. This number can differ from "fe_sess_rate" in
18041 situations where client-side keep-alive is enabled.
18042
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018043fe_sess_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
18044 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
18045 frontend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
18046 limit the incoming session rate to an acceptable range in order to prevent
18047 abuse of service at the earliest moment, for example when combined with other
18048 layer 4 ACLs in order to force the clients to wait a bit for the rate to go
18049 down below the limit. It can also be useful to add this element to logs using
18050 a log-format directive. See also the "rate-limit sessions" directive for use
18051 in frontends.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010018052
18053 Example :
18054 # This frontend limits incoming mails to 10/s with a max of 100
18055 # concurrent connections. We accept any connection below 10/s, and
18056 # force excess clients to wait for 100 ms. Since clients are limited to
18057 # 100 max, there cannot be more than 10 incoming mails per second.
18058 frontend mail
18059 bind :25
18060 mode tcp
18061 maxconn 100
18062 acl too_fast fe_sess_rate ge 10
18063 tcp-request inspect-delay 100ms
18064 tcp-request content accept if ! too_fast
18065 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010018066
Nenad Merdanovic807a6e72017-03-12 22:00:00 +010018067hostname : string
18068 Returns the system hostname.
18069
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020018070int(<integer>) : signed integer
18071 Returns a signed integer.
18072
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020018073ipv4(<ipv4>) : ipv4
18074 Returns an ipv4.
18075
18076ipv6(<ipv6>) : ipv6
18077 Returns an ipv6.
18078
Willy Tarreau0657b932022-03-09 17:33:05 +010018079last_rule_file: string
18080 This returns the name of the configuration file containing the last final
18081 rule that was matched during stream analysis. A final rule is one that
18082 terminates the evaluation of the rule set (like an "accept", "deny" or
18083 "redirect"). This works for TCP request and response rules acting on the
18084 "content" rulesets, and on HTTP rules from "http-request", "http-response"
18085 and "http-after-response" rule sets. The legacy "redirect" rulesets are not
18086 supported (such information is not stored there), and neither "tcp-request
18087 connection" nor "tcp-request session" rulesets are supported because the
18088 information is stored at the stream level and streams do not exist during
18089 these rules. The main purpose of this function is to be able to report in
18090 logs where was the rule that gave the final verdict, in order to help
18091 figure why a request was denied for example. See also "last_rule_line".
18092
18093last_rule_line: integer
18094 This returns the line number in the configuration file where is located the
18095 last final rule that was matched during stream analysis. A final rule is one
18096 that terminates the evaluation of the rule set (like an "accept", "deny" or
18097 "redirect"). This works for TCP request and response rules acting on the
18098 "content" rulesets, and on HTTP rules from "http-request", "http-response"
18099 and "http-after-response" rule sets. The legacy "redirect" rulesets are not
18100 supported (such information is not stored there), and neither "tcp-request
18101 connection" nor "tcp-request session" rulesets are supported because the
18102 information is stored at the stream level and streams do not exist during
18103 these rules. The main purpose of this function is to be able to report in
18104 logs where was the rule that gave the final verdict, in order to help
18105 figure why a request was denied for example. See also "last_rule_file".
18106
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010018107lat_ns_avg : integer
18108 Returns the average number of nanoseconds spent between the moment the task
18109 handling the stream is woken up and the moment it is effectively called. This
18110 number is reset for each new request on the same connections in case of HTTP
18111 keep-alive. This value indicates the overall latency inflicted to the current
18112 request by all other requests being processed in parallel, and is a direct
18113 indicator of perceived performance due to noisy neighbours. In order to keep
18114 the value low, it is possible to reduce the scheduler's run queue depth using
18115 "tune.runqueue-depth", to reduce the number of concurrent events processed at
18116 once using "tune.maxpollevents", to decrease the stream's nice value using
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +020018117 the "nice" option on the "bind" lines or in the frontend, to enable low
18118 latency scheduling using "tune.sched.low-latency", or to look for other heavy
18119 requests in logs (those exhibiting large values of "cpu_ns_avg"), whose
18120 processing needs to be adjusted or fixed. Compression of large buffers could
18121 be a culprit, like heavy regex or long lists of regex. Note: this value is
18122 exactly lat_ns_tot divided by cpu_calls.
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010018123
18124lat_ns_tot : integer
18125 Returns the total number of nanoseconds spent between the moment the task
18126 handling the stream is woken up and the moment it is effectively called. This
18127 number is reset for each new request on the same connections in case of HTTP
18128 keep-alive. This value indicates the overall latency inflicted to the current
18129 request by all other requests being processed in parallel, and is a direct
18130 indicator of perceived performance due to noisy neighbours. In order to keep
18131 the value low, it is possible to reduce the scheduler's run queue depth using
18132 "tune.runqueue-depth", to reduce the number of concurrent events processed at
18133 once using "tune.maxpollevents", to decrease the stream's nice value using
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +020018134 the "nice" option on the "bind" lines or in the frontend, to enable low
18135 latency scheduling using "tune.sched.low-latency", or to look for other heavy
18136 requests in logs (those exhibiting large values of "cpu_ns_avg"), whose
18137 processing needs to be adjusted or fixed. Compression of large buffers could
18138 be a culprit, like heavy regex or long lists of regex. Note: while it
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010018139 may intuitively seem that the total latency adds to a transfer time, it is
18140 almost never true because while a task waits for the CPU, network buffers
18141 continue to fill up and the next call will process more at once. The value
18142 may be artificially high due to a high cpu_calls count, for example when
18143 processing many HTTP chunks, and for this reason it is often preferred to log
18144 lat_ns_avg instead, which is a more relevant performance indicator.
18145
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020018146meth(<method>) : method
18147 Returns a method.
18148
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018149nbsrv([<backend>]) : integer
18150 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of usable servers of
18151 either the current backend or the named backend. This is mostly used with
18152 ACLs but can also be useful when added to logs. This is normally used to
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018153 switch to an alternate backend when the number of servers is too low to
18154 to handle some load. It is useful to report a failure when combined with
18155 "monitor fail".
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010018156
Patrick Hemmerfabb24f2018-08-13 14:07:57 -040018157prio_class : integer
18158 Returns the priority class of the current session for http mode or connection
18159 for tcp mode. The value will be that set by the last call to "http-request
18160 set-priority-class" or "tcp-request content set-priority-class".
18161
18162prio_offset : integer
18163 Returns the priority offset of the current session for http mode or
18164 connection for tcp mode. The value will be that set by the last call to
18165 "http-request set-priority-offset" or "tcp-request content
18166 set-priority-offset".
18167
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010018168proc : integer
Willy Tarreaub63dbb72021-06-11 16:50:29 +020018169 Always returns value 1 (historically it would return the calling process
18170 number).
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010018171
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018172queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018173 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend,
18174 including all the connections in server queues. If no backend name is
18175 specified, the current one is used, but it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018176 one. This is useful with ACLs or to pass statistics to backend servers. This
18177 can be used to take actions when queuing goes above a known level, generally
18178 indicating a surge of traffic or a massive slowdown on the servers. One
18179 possible action could be to reject new users but still accept old ones. See
18180 also the "avg_queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate" fetches.
18181
Willy Tarreau84310e22014-02-14 11:59:04 +010018182rand([<range>]) : integer
18183 Returns a random integer value within a range of <range> possible values,
18184 starting at zero. If the range is not specified, it defaults to 2^32, which
18185 gives numbers between 0 and 4294967295. It can be useful to pass some values
18186 needed to take some routing decisions for example, or just for debugging
18187 purposes. This random must not be used for security purposes.
18188
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018189srv_conn([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
18190 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
18191 connections on the designated server, possibly including the connection being
18192 evaluated. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the
18193 current backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when one server is
18194 full, or to inform the server about our view of the number of active
Patrick Hemmer155e93e2018-06-14 18:01:35 -040018195 connections with it. See also the "fe_conn", "be_conn", "queue", and
18196 "srv_conn_free" fetch methods.
18197
18198srv_conn_free([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
18199 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of available connections
18200 on the designated server, possibly including the connection being evaluated.
18201 The value does not include queue slots. If <backend> is omitted, then the
18202 server is looked up in the current backend. It can be used to use a specific
18203 farm when one server is full, or to inform the server about our view of the
18204 number of active connections with it. See also the "be_conn_free" and
18205 "srv_conn" fetch methods.
18206
18207 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: If the server maxconn is 0, then this fetch clearly
18208 does not make sense, in which case the value returned will be -1.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018209
18210srv_is_up([<backend>/]<server>) : boolean
18211 Returns true when the designated server is UP, and false when it is either
18212 DOWN or in maintenance mode. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is
18213 looked up in the current backend. It is mainly used to take action based on
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018214 an external status reported via a health check (e.g. a geographical site's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018215 availability). Another possible use which is more of a hack consists in
18216 using dummy servers as boolean variables that can be enabled or disabled from
18217 the CLI, so that rules depending on those ACLs can be tweaked in realtime.
18218
Willy Tarreauff2b7af2017-10-13 11:46:26 +020018219srv_queue([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
18220 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connections currently
18221 pending in the designated server's queue. If <backend> is omitted, then the
18222 server is looked up in the current backend. It can sometimes be used together
18223 with the "use-server" directive to force to use a known faster server when it
18224 is not much loaded. See also the "srv_conn", "avg_queue" and "queue" sample
18225 fetch methods.
18226
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018227srv_sess_rate([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
18228 Returns an integer corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
18229 designated server, in number of new sessions per second. If <backend> is
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030018230 omitted, then the server is looked up in the current backend. This is mostly
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018231 used with ACLs but can make sense with logs too. This is used to switch to an
18232 alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too high a session
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018233 rate, or to limit abuse of service (e.g. prevent latent requests from
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018234 overloading servers).
18235
18236 Example :
18237 # Redirect to a separate back
18238 acl srv1_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv1) gt 50
18239 acl srv2_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv2) gt 50
18240 use_backend be2 if srv1_full or srv2_full
18241
Alexbf1bd5a2021-04-24 13:02:21 +020018242srv_iweight([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
Christopher Faulet1bea8652020-07-10 16:03:45 +020018243 Returns an integer corresponding to the server's initial weight. If <backend>
18244 is omitted, then the server is looked up in the current backend. See also
18245 "srv_weight" and "srv_uweight".
18246
Alexbf1bd5a2021-04-24 13:02:21 +020018247srv_uweight([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
Christopher Faulet1bea8652020-07-10 16:03:45 +020018248 Returns an integer corresponding to the user visible server's weight. If
18249 <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the current
18250 backend. See also "srv_weight" and "srv_iweight".
18251
Alexbf1bd5a2021-04-24 13:02:21 +020018252srv_weight([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
Christopher Faulet1bea8652020-07-10 16:03:45 +020018253 Returns an integer corresponding to the current (or effective) server's
18254 weight. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the current
18255 backend. See also "srv_iweight" and "srv_uweight".
18256
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010018257stopping : boolean
18258 Returns TRUE if the process calling the function is currently stopping. This
18259 can be useful for logging, or for relaxing certain checks or helping close
18260 certain connections upon graceful shutdown.
18261
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020018262str(<string>) : string
18263 Returns a string.
18264
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018265table_avl([<table>]) : integer
18266 Returns the total number of available entries in the current proxy's
18267 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also table_cnt.
18268
18269table_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18270 Returns the total number of entries currently in use in the current proxy's
18271 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also src_conn_cnt and
18272 table_avl for other entry counting methods.
18273
Christopher Faulet34adb2a2017-11-21 21:45:38 +010018274thread : integer
18275 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the thread calling
18276 the function, between 0 and (global.nbthread-1). This is useful for logging
18277 and debugging purposes.
18278
Alexandar Lazic528adc32021-06-01 00:27:01 +020018279uuid([<version>]) : string
18280 Returns a UUID following the RFC4122 standard. If the version is not
18281 specified, a UUID version 4 (fully random) is returned.
18282 Currently, only version 4 is supported.
18283
Willy Tarreau54496a62021-09-03 12:00:13 +020018284var(<var-name>[,<default>]) : undefined
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020018285 Returns a variable with the stored type. If the variable is not set, the
Willy Tarreau54496a62021-09-03 12:00:13 +020018286 sample fetch fails, unless a default value is provided, in which case it will
18287 return it as a string. Empty strings are permitted. The name of the variable
18288 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010018289 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010018290 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
18291 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020018292 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010018293 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
18294 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020018295 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010018296 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020018297
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200182987.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018299----------------------------------
18300
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040018301The layer 4 usually describes just the transport layer which in HAProxy is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018302closest to the connection, where no content is yet made available. The fetch
18303methods described here are usable as low as the "tcp-request connection" rule
18304sets unless they require some future information. Those generally include
18305TCP/IP addresses and ports, as well as elements from stick-tables related to
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018306the incoming connection. For retrieving a value from a sticky counters, the
18307counter number can be explicitly set as 0, 1, or 2 using the pre-defined
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +020018308"sc0_", "sc1_", or "sc2_" prefix. These three pre-defined prefixes can only be
18309used if MAX_SESS_STKCTR value does not exceed 3, otherwise the counter number
18310can be specified as the first integer argument when using the "sc_" prefix.
18311Starting from "sc_0" to "sc_N" where N is (MAX_SESS_STKCTR-1). An optional
18312table may be specified with the "sc*" form, in which case the currently
18313tracked key will be looked up into this alternate table instead of the table
18314currently being tracked.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018315
Christopher Faulet7d081f02021-04-15 09:38:37 +020018316bc_dst : ip
18317 This is the destination ip address of the connection on the server side,
18318 which is the server address HAProxy connected to. It is of type IP and works
18319 on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its
18320 IPv6 equivalent, according to RFC 4291.
18321
18322bc_dst_port : integer
18323 Returns an integer value corresponding to the destination TCP port of the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040018324 connection on the server side, which is the port HAProxy connected to.
Christopher Faulet7d081f02021-04-15 09:38:37 +020018325
Willy Tarreau6f749762021-11-05 17:07:03 +010018326bc_err : integer
18327 Returns the ID of the error that might have occurred on the current backend
18328 connection. See the "fc_err_str" fetch for a full list of error codes
18329 and their corresponding error message.
18330
18331bc_err_str : string
18332 Returns an error message describing what problem happened on the current
18333 backend connection, resulting in a connection failure. See the
18334 "fc_err_str" fetch for a full list of error codes and their
18335 corresponding error message.
18336
Jérôme Magnin35e53a62019-01-16 14:38:37 +010018337bc_http_major : integer
Jérôme Magnin86577422018-12-07 09:03:11 +010018338 Returns the backend connection's HTTP major version encoding, which may be 1
18339 for HTTP/0.9 to HTTP/1.1 or 2 for HTTP/2. Note, this is based on the on-wire
18340 encoding and not the version present in the request header.
18341
Christopher Faulet7d081f02021-04-15 09:38:37 +020018342bc_src : ip
18343 This is the source ip address of the connection on the server side, which is
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040018344 the server address HAProxy connected from. It is of type IP and works on both
Christopher Faulet7d081f02021-04-15 09:38:37 +020018345 IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 addresses are mapped to their IPv6
18346 equivalent, according to RFC 4291.
18347
18348bc_src_port : integer
18349 Returns an integer value corresponding to the TCP source port of the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040018350 connection on the server side, which is the port HAProxy connected from.
Christopher Faulet7d081f02021-04-15 09:38:37 +020018351
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018352be_id : integer
18353 Returns an integer containing the current backend's id. It can be used in
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020018354 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request. It can
18355 also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018356
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010018357be_name : string
18358 Returns a string containing the current backend's name. It can be used in
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020018359 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request. It can
18360 also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010018361
Amaury Denoyelled91d7792020-12-10 13:43:56 +010018362be_server_timeout : integer
18363 Returns the configuration value in millisecond for the server timeout of the
18364 current backend. This timeout can be overwritten by a "set-timeout" rule. See
18365 also the "cur_server_timeout".
18366
18367be_tunnel_timeout : integer
18368 Returns the configuration value in millisecond for the tunnel timeout of the
18369 current backend. This timeout can be overwritten by a "set-timeout" rule. See
18370 also the "cur_tunnel_timeout".
18371
Amaury Denoyellef7719a22020-12-10 13:43:58 +010018372cur_server_timeout : integer
18373 Returns the currently applied server timeout in millisecond for the stream.
18374 In the default case, this will be equal to be_server_timeout unless a
18375 "set-timeout" rule has been applied. See also "be_server_timeout".
18376
18377cur_tunnel_timeout : integer
18378 Returns the currently applied tunnel timeout in millisecond for the stream.
18379 In the default case, this will be equal to be_tunnel_timeout unless a
18380 "set-timeout" rule has been applied. See also "be_tunnel_timeout".
18381
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018382dst : ip
Christopher Faulet888cd702021-10-25 16:58:50 +020018383 This is the destination IP address of the connection on the client side,
18384 which is the address the client connected to. Any tcp/http rules may alter
18385 this address. It can be useful when running in transparent mode. It is of
18386 type IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address
18387 is mapped to its IPv6 equivalent, according to RFC 4291. When the incoming
18388 connection passed through address translation or redirection involving
18389 connection tracking, the original destination address before the redirection
18390 will be reported. On Linux systems, the source and destination may seldom
18391 appear reversed if the nf_conntrack_tcp_loose sysctl is set, because a late
18392 response may reopen a timed out connection and switch what is believed to be
18393 the source and the destination.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018394
18395dst_conn : integer
18396 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
18397 connections on the same socket including the one being evaluated. It is
18398 normally used with ACLs but can as well be used to pass the information to
18399 servers in an HTTP header or in logs. It can be used to either return a sorry
18400 page before hard-blocking, or to use a specific backend to drain new requests
18401 when the socket is considered saturated. This offers the ability to assign
18402 different limits to different listening ports or addresses. See also the
18403 "fe_conn" and "be_conn" fetches.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018404
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020018405dst_is_local : boolean
18406 Returns true if the destination address of the incoming connection is local
18407 to the system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning
18408 that it was intercepted in transparent mode. It can be useful to apply
18409 certain rules by default to forwarded traffic and other rules to the traffic
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018410 targeting the real address of the machine. For example the stats page could
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020018411 be delivered only on this address, or SSH access could be locally redirected.
18412 Please note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do
18413 it only once per connection.
18414
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018415dst_port : integer
18416 Returns an integer value corresponding to the destination TCP port of the
18417 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected to.
Christopher Faulet888cd702021-10-25 16:58:50 +020018418 Any tcp/http rules may alter this address. This might be used when running in
18419 transparent mode, when assigning dynamic ports to some clients for a whole
18420 application session, to stick all users to a same server, or to pass the
18421 destination port information to a server using an HTTP header.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018422
Willy Tarreau6f749762021-11-05 17:07:03 +010018423fc_dst : ip
18424 This is the original destination IP address of the connection on the client
18425 side. Only "tcp-request connection" rules may alter this address. See "dst"
18426 for details.
18427
18428fc_dst_is_local : boolean
18429 Returns true if the original destination address of the incoming connection
18430 is local to the system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the
18431 system. See "dst_is_local" for details.
18432
18433fc_dst_port : integer
18434 Returns an integer value corresponding to the original destination TCP port
18435 of the connection on the client side. Only "tcp-request connection" rules may
18436 alter this address. See "dst-port" for details.
18437
18438fc_err : integer
Remi Tricot-Le Breton3d2093a2021-07-29 09:45:49 +020018439 Returns the ID of the error that might have occurred on the current
18440 connection. Any strictly positive value of this fetch indicates that the
18441 connection did not succeed and would result in an error log being output (as
Willy Tarreauec5c1102021-11-06 09:18:33 +010018442 described in section 8.2.6). See the "fc_err_str" fetch for a full list of
Remi Tricot-Le Breton3d2093a2021-07-29 09:45:49 +020018443 error codes and their corresponding error message.
18444
Willy Tarreau6f749762021-11-05 17:07:03 +010018445fc_err_str : string
Ilya Shipitsin01881082021-08-07 14:41:56 +050018446 Returns an error message describing what problem happened on the current
Remi Tricot-Le Breton3d2093a2021-07-29 09:45:49 +020018447 connection, resulting in a connection failure. This string corresponds to the
Willy Tarreauec5c1102021-11-06 09:18:33 +010018448 "message" part of the error log format (see section 8.2.6). See below for a
Remi Tricot-Le Breton3d2093a2021-07-29 09:45:49 +020018449 full list of error codes and their corresponding error messages :
18450
18451 +----+---------------------------------------------------------------------------+
18452 | ID | message |
18453 +----+---------------------------------------------------------------------------+
18454 | 0 | "Success" |
18455 | 1 | "Reached configured maxconn value" |
18456 | 2 | "Too many sockets on the process" |
18457 | 3 | "Too many sockets on the system" |
18458 | 4 | "Out of system buffers" |
18459 | 5 | "Protocol or address family not supported" |
18460 | 6 | "General socket error" |
18461 | 7 | "Source port range exhausted" |
18462 | 8 | "Can't bind to source address" |
18463 | 9 | "Out of local source ports on the system" |
18464 | 10 | "Local source address already in use" |
18465 | 11 | "Connection closed while waiting for PROXY protocol header" |
18466 | 12 | "Connection error while waiting for PROXY protocol header" |
18467 | 13 | "Timeout while waiting for PROXY protocol header" |
18468 | 14 | "Truncated PROXY protocol header received" |
18469 | 15 | "Received something which does not look like a PROXY protocol header" |
18470 | 16 | "Received an invalid PROXY protocol header" |
18471 | 17 | "Received an unhandled protocol in the PROXY protocol header" |
18472 | 18 | "Connection closed while waiting for NetScaler Client IP header" |
18473 | 19 | "Connection error while waiting for NetScaler Client IP header" |
18474 | 20 | "Timeout while waiting for a NetScaler Client IP header" |
18475 | 21 | "Truncated NetScaler Client IP header received" |
18476 | 22 | "Received an invalid NetScaler Client IP magic number" |
18477 | 23 | "Received an unhandled protocol in the NetScaler Client IP header" |
18478 | 24 | "Connection closed during SSL handshake" |
18479 | 25 | "Connection error during SSL handshake" |
18480 | 26 | "Timeout during SSL handshake" |
18481 | 27 | "Too many SSL connections" |
18482 | 28 | "Out of memory when initializing an SSL connection" |
18483 | 29 | "Rejected a client-initiated SSL renegotiation attempt" |
18484 | 30 | "SSL client CA chain cannot be verified" |
18485 | 31 | "SSL client certificate not trusted" |
18486 | 32 | "Server presented an SSL certificate different from the configured one" |
18487 | 33 | "Server presented an SSL certificate different from the expected one" |
18488 | 34 | "SSL handshake failure" |
18489 | 35 | "SSL handshake failure after heartbeat" |
18490 | 36 | "Stopped a TLSv1 heartbeat attack (CVE-2014-0160)" |
18491 | 37 | "Attempt to use SSL on an unknown target (internal error)" |
18492 | 38 | "Server refused early data" |
18493 | 39 | "SOCKS4 Proxy write error during handshake" |
18494 | 40 | "SOCKS4 Proxy read error during handshake" |
18495 | 41 | "SOCKS4 Proxy deny the request" |
18496 | 42 | "SOCKS4 Proxy handshake aborted by server" |
Remi Tricot-Le Breton61944f72021-09-29 18:56:51 +020018497 | 43 | "SSL fatal error" |
Remi Tricot-Le Breton3d2093a2021-07-29 09:45:49 +020018498 +----+---------------------------------------------------------------------------+
18499
Christopher Faulet7bd21922021-10-25 16:18:15 +020018500fc_fackets : integer
18501 Returns the fack counter measured by the kernel for the client
18502 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
18503 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
18504 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
18505
Willy Tarreau60ca10a2017-08-18 15:26:54 +020018506fc_http_major : integer
18507 Reports the front connection's HTTP major version encoding, which may be 1
18508 for HTTP/0.9 to HTTP/1.1 or 2 for HTTP/2. Note, this is based on the on-wire
18509 encoding and not on the version present in the request header.
18510
Christopher Faulet7bd21922021-10-25 16:18:15 +020018511fc_lost : integer
18512 Returns the lost counter measured by the kernel for the client
18513 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
18514 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
18515 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
18516
Geoff Simmons7185b782019-08-27 18:31:16 +020018517fc_pp_authority : string
18518 Returns the authority TLV sent by the client in the PROXY protocol header,
18519 if any.
18520
Tim Duesterhusd1b15b62020-03-13 12:34:23 +010018521fc_pp_unique_id : string
18522 Returns the unique ID TLV sent by the client in the PROXY protocol header,
18523 if any.
18524
Emeric Brun4f603012017-01-05 15:11:44 +010018525fc_rcvd_proxy : boolean
18526 Returns true if the client initiated the connection with a PROXY protocol
18527 header.
18528
Christopher Faulet7bd21922021-10-25 16:18:15 +020018529fc_reordering : integer
18530 Returns the reordering counter measured by the kernel for the client
18531 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
18532 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
18533 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
18534
18535fc_retrans : integer
18536 Returns the retransmits counter measured by the kernel for the client
18537 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
18538 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
18539 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
18540
Thierry Fournier / OZON.IO6310bef2016-07-24 20:16:50 +020018541fc_rtt(<unit>) : integer
18542 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) measured by the kernel for the client
18543 connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds. <unit>
18544 can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the server
18545 connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
18546 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
18547 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
18548
18549fc_rttvar(<unit>) : integer
18550 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) variance measured by the kernel for the
18551 client connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds.
18552 <unit> can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the
18553 server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
18554 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
18555 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
18556
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020018557fc_sacked : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070018558 Returns the sacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
18559 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
18560 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
18561 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
18562
Christopher Faulet888cd702021-10-25 16:58:50 +020018563fc_src : ip
18564 This is the original destination IP address of the connection on the client
18565 side. Only "tcp-request connection" rules may alter this address. See "src"
18566 for details.
18567
18568fc_src_is_local : boolean
18569 Returns true if the source address of incoming connection is local to the
18570 system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system. See
18571 "src_is_local" for details.
18572
18573fc_src_port : integer
18574
18575 Returns an integer value corresponding to the TCP source port of the
18576 connection on the client side. Only "tcp-request connection" rules may alter
18577 this address. See "src-port" for details.
18578
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070018579
Christopher Faulet7bd21922021-10-25 16:18:15 +020018580fc_unacked : integer
18581 Returns the unacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
18582 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
18583 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
18584 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070018585
Marcin Deranek9a66dfb2018-04-13 14:37:50 +020018586fe_defbe : string
18587 Returns a string containing the frontend's default backend name. It can be
18588 used in frontends to check which backend will handle requests by default.
18589
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018590fe_id : integer
18591 Returns an integer containing the current frontend's id. It can be used in
Marcin Deranek6e413ed2016-12-13 12:40:01 +010018592 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018593 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
18594
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010018595fe_name : string
18596 Returns a string containing the current frontend's name. It can be used in
18597 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
18598 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
18599
Amaury Denoyelleda184d52020-12-10 13:43:55 +010018600fe_client_timeout : integer
18601 Returns the configuration value in millisecond for the client timeout of the
18602 current frontend.
18603
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018604sc_bytes_in_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018605sc0_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
18606sc1_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
18607sc2_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018608 Returns the average client-to-server bytes rate from the currently tracked
18609 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
18610 table. See also src_bytes_in_rate.
18611
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018612sc_bytes_out_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018613sc0_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
18614sc1_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
18615sc2_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018616 Returns the average server-to-client bytes rate from the currently tracked
18617 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
18618 table. See also src_bytes_out_rate.
18619
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020018620sc_clr_gpc(<idx>,<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
18621 Clears the General Purpose Counter at the index <idx> of the array
18622 associated to the designated tracked counter of ID <ctr> from current
18623 proxy's stick table or from the designated stick-table <table>, and
18624 returns its previous value. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99 and
18625 <ctr> an integer between 0 and 2.
18626 Before the first invocation, the stored value is zero, so first invocation
18627 will always return zero.
18628 This fetch applies only to the 'gpc' array data_type (and not to the legacy
18629 'gpc0' nor 'gpc1' data_types).
18630
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018631sc_clr_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018632sc0_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
18633sc1_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
18634sc2_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020018635 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
18636 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010018637 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
18638 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
18639 when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020018640
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030018641 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020018642 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
18643 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020018644 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
18645 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 5
18646 acl save sc0_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020018647 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
18648 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
18649
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010018650sc_clr_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
18651sc0_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
18652sc1_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
18653sc2_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
18654 Clears the second General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
18655 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
18656 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
18657 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
18658 when a first ACL was verified.
18659
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018660sc_conn_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018661sc0_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18662sc1_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18663sc2_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018664 Returns the cumulative number of incoming connections from currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018665 counters. See also src_conn_cnt.
18666
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018667sc_conn_cur(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018668sc0_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
18669sc1_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
18670sc2_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018671 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
18672 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
18673 begins and decremented when tracking stops. See also src_conn_cur.
18674
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018675sc_conn_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018676sc0_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
18677sc1_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
18678sc2_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018679 Returns the average connection rate from the currently tracked counters,
18680 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table.
18681 See also src_conn_rate.
18682
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020018683sc_get_gpc(<idx>,<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
18684 Returns the value of the General Purpose Counter at the index <idx>
18685 in the GPC array and associated to the currently tracked counter of
18686 ID <ctr> from the current proxy's stick-table or from the designated
18687 stick-table <table>. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99 and
18688 <ctr> an integer between 0 and 2. If there is not gpc stored at this
18689 index, zero is returned.
18690 This fetch applies only to the 'gpc' array data_type (and not to the legacy
18691 'gpc0' nor 'gpc1' data_types). See also src_get_gpc and sc_inc_gpc.
18692
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018693sc_get_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018694sc0_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
18695sc1_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
18696sc2_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018697 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018698 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc0 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020018699
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010018700sc_get_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
18701sc0_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
18702sc1_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
18703sc2_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
18704 Returns the value of the second General Purpose Counter associated to the
18705 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc1 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1.
18706
Emeric Brun877b0b52021-06-30 18:57:49 +020018707sc_get_gpt(<idx>,<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
18708 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag at the index <idx> of
18709 the array associated to the tracked counter of ID <ctr> and from the
18710 current proxy's sitck-table or the designated stick-table <table>. <idx>
18711 is an integer between 0 and 99 and <ctr> an integer between 0 and 2.
18712 If there is no GPT stored at this index, zero is returned.
18713 This fetch applies only to the 'gpt' array data_type (and not on
18714 the legacy 'gpt0' data-type). See also src_get_gpt.
18715
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020018716sc_get_gpt0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
18717sc0_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
18718sc1_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
18719sc2_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
18720 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
18721 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpt0.
18722
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020018723sc_gpc_rate(<idx>,<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
18724 Returns the average increment rate of the General Purpose Counter at the
18725 index <idx> of the array associated to the tracked counter of ID <ctr> from
18726 the current proxy's table or from the designated stick-table <table>.
18727 It reports the frequency which the gpc counter was incremented over the
18728 configured period. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99 and <ctr> an integer
18729 between 0 and 2.
18730 Note that the 'gpc_rate' counter array must be stored in the stick-table
18731 for a value to be returned, as 'gpc' only holds the event count.
18732 This fetch applies only to the 'gpc_rate' array data_type (and not to
18733 the legacy 'gpc0_rate' nor 'gpc1_rate' data_types).
18734 See also src_gpc_rate, sc_get_gpc, and sc_inc_gpc.
18735
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018736sc_gpc0_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018737sc0_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
18738sc1_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
18739sc2_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020018740 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
18741 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
18742 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018743 src_gpc0_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
18744 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
18745 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018746
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010018747sc_gpc1_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
18748sc0_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
18749sc1_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
18750sc2_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
18751 Returns the average increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
18752 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
18753 which the gpc1 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
18754 src_gpcA_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc1, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1. Note
18755 that the "gpc1_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
18756 be returned, as "gpc1" only holds the event count.
18757
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018758sc_http_err_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018759sc0_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18760sc1_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18761sc2_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018762 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP errors from the currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018763 counters. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
18764 See also src_http_err_cnt.
18765
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018766sc_http_err_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018767sc0_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
18768sc1_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
18769sc2_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018770 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the currently tracked counters,
18771 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
18772 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. See also
18773 src_http_err_rate.
18774
Willy Tarreau826f3ab2021-02-10 12:07:15 +010018775sc_http_fail_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
18776sc0_http_fail_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18777sc1_http_fail_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18778sc2_http_fail_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18779 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP response failures from the currently
18780 tracked counters. This includes the both response errors and 5xx status codes
18781 other than 501 and 505. See also src_http_fail_cnt.
18782
18783sc_http_fail_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
18784sc0_http_fail_rate([<table>]) : integer
18785sc1_http_fail_rate([<table>]) : integer
18786sc2_http_fail_rate([<table>]) : integer
18787 Returns the average rate of HTTP response failures from the currently tracked
18788 counters, measured in amount of failures over the period configured in the
18789 table. This includes the both response errors and 5xx status codes other than
18790 501 and 505. See also src_http_fail_rate.
18791
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018792sc_http_req_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018793sc0_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18794sc1_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18795sc2_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018796 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018797 counters. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
18798 src_http_req_cnt.
18799
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018800sc_http_req_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018801sc0_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
18802sc1_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
18803sc2_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018804 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
18805 counters, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in
18806 the table. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
18807 src_http_req_rate.
18808
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020018809sc_inc_gpc(<idx>,<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
18810 Increments the General Purpose Counter at the index <idx> of the array
18811 associated to the designated tracked counter of ID <ctr> from current
18812 proxy's stick table or from the designated stick-table <table>, and
18813 returns its new value. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99 and
18814 <ctr> an integer between 0 and 2.
18815 Before the first invocation, the stored value is zero, so first invocation
18816 will increase it to 1 and will return 1.
18817 This fetch applies only to the 'gpc' array data_type (and not to the legacy
18818 'gpc0' nor 'gpc1' data_types).
18819
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018820sc_inc_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018821sc0_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
18822sc1_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
18823sc2_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018824 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010018825 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
18826 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
18827 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
18828 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018829
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030018830 Example:
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020018831 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
18832 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018833 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
18834
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010018835sc_inc_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
18836sc0_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
18837sc1_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
18838sc2_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
18839 Increments the second General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
18840 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
18841 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
18842 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
18843 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified.
18844
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018845sc_kbytes_in(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018846sc0_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
18847sc1_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
18848sc2_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020018849 Returns the total amount of client-to-server data from the currently tracked
18850 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
18851 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018852
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018853sc_kbytes_out(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018854sc0_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
18855sc1_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
18856sc2_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020018857 Returns the total amount of server-to-client data from the currently tracked
18858 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
18859 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018860
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018861sc_sess_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018862sc0_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18863sc1_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18864sc2_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018865 Returns the cumulative number of incoming connections that were transformed
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018866 into sessions, which means that they were accepted by a "tcp-request
18867 connection" rule, from the currently tracked counters. A backend may count
18868 more sessions than connections because each connection could result in many
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040018869 backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is performed over the connection
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018870 with the client. See also src_sess_cnt.
18871
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018872sc_sess_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018873sc0_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
18874sc1_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
18875sc2_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018876 Returns the average session rate from the currently tracked counters,
18877 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
18878 session is a connection that got past the early "tcp-request connection"
18879 rules. A backend may count more sessions than connections because each
18880 connection could result in many backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040018881 performed over the connection with the client. See also src_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018882
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018883sc_tracked(<ctr>[,<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018884sc0_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
18885sc1_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
18886sc2_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau6f1615f2013-06-03 15:15:22 +020018887 Returns true if the designated session counter is currently being tracked by
18888 the current session. This can be useful when deciding whether or not we want
18889 to set some values in a header passed to the server.
18890
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018891sc_trackers(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018892sc0_trackers([<table>]) : integer
18893sc1_trackers([<table>]) : integer
18894sc2_trackers([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010018895 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
18896 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020018897 begins and decremented when tracking stops. It differs from sc0_conn_cur in
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010018898 that it does not rely on any stored information but on the table's reference
18899 count (the "use" value which is returned by "show table" on the CLI). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018900 may sometimes be more suited for layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a
18901 server how many concurrent connections there are from a given address for
18902 example.
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010018903
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018904so_id : integer
18905 Returns an integer containing the current listening socket's id. It is useful
18906 in frontends involving many "bind" lines, or to stick all users coming via a
18907 same socket to the same server.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018908
Jerome Magnineb421b22020-03-27 22:08:40 +010018909so_name : string
18910 Returns a string containing the current listening socket's name, as defined
18911 with name on a "bind" line. It can serve the same purposes as so_id but with
18912 strings instead of integers.
18913
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018914src : ip
Christopher Faulet888cd702021-10-25 16:58:50 +020018915 This is the source IP address of the client of the session. Any tcp/http
18916 rules may alter this address. It is of type IP and works on both IPv4 and
18917 IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 addresses are mapped to their IPv6
18918 equivalent, according to RFC 4291. Note that it is the TCP-level source
18919 address which is used, and not the address of a client behind a
18920 proxy. However if the "accept-proxy" or "accept-netscaler-cip" bind directive
18921 is used, it can be the address of a client behind another PROXY-protocol
18922 compatible component for all rule sets except "tcp-request connection" which
18923 sees the real address. When the incoming connection passed through address
18924 translation or redirection involving connection tracking, the original
18925 destination address before the redirection will be reported. On Linux
18926 systems, the source and destination may seldom appear reversed if the
18927 nf_conntrack_tcp_loose sysctl is set, because a late response may reopen a
18928 timed out connection and switch what is believed to be the source and the
18929 destination.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018930
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010018931 Example:
18932 # add an HTTP header in requests with the originating address' country
18933 http-request set-header X-Country %[src,map_ip(geoip.lst)]
18934
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018935src_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
18936 Returns the average bytes rate from the incoming connection's source address
18937 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
18938 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018939 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_in_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018940
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018941src_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
18942 Returns the average bytes rate to the incoming connection's source address in
18943 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018944 amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018945 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_out_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018946
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020018947src_clr_gpc(<idx>,[<table>]) : integer
18948 Clears the General Purpose Counter at the index <idx> of the array
18949 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
18950 stick-table or in the designated stick-table <table>, and returns its
18951 previous value. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99.
18952 If the address is not found, an entry is created and 0 is returned.
18953 This fetch applies only to the 'gpc' array data_type (and not to the legacy
18954 'gpc0' nor 'gpc1' data_types).
18955 See also sc_clr_gpc.
18956
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018957src_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
18958 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
18959 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
18960 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
18961 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
18962 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
18963 was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020018964
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030018965 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020018966 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
18967 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
18968 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
18969 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 5
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010018970 acl save src_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020018971 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
18972 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
18973
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010018974src_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
18975 Clears the second General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
18976 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
18977 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
18978 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
18979 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
18980 was verified.
18981
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018982src_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018983 Returns the cumulative number of connections initiated from the current
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018984 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018985 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018986 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018987
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018988src_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018989 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections initiated from the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018990 current incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
18991 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. If the address is not found,
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018992 zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cur.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018993
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018994src_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
18995 Returns the average connection rate from the incoming connection's source
18996 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
18997 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table. If
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018998 the address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018999
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020019000src_get_gpc(<idx>,[<table>]) : integer
19001 Returns the value of the General Purpose Counter at the index <idx> of the
19002 array associated to the incoming connection's source address in the
19003 current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table <table>. <idx>
19004 is an integer between 0 and 99.
19005 If the address is not found or there is no gpc stored at this index, zero
19006 is returned.
19007 This fetch applies only to the 'gpc' array data_type (and not on the legacy
19008 'gpc0' nor 'gpc1' data_types).
19009 See also sc_get_gpc and src_inc_gpc.
19010
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019011src_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020019012 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019013 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020019014 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020019015 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0 and src_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020019016
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010019017src_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
19018 Returns the value of the second General Purpose Counter associated to the
19019 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
19020 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
19021 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc1 and src_inc_gpc1.
19022
Emeric Brun877b0b52021-06-30 18:57:49 +020019023src_get_gpt(<idx>[,<table>]) : integer
19024 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag at the index <idx> of
19025 the array associated to the incoming connection's source address in the
19026 current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table <table>.
19027 <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99.
19028 If the address is not found or the GPT is not stored, zero is returned.
19029 See also the sc_get_gpt sample fetch keyword.
19030
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020019031src_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
19032 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
19033 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
19034 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
19035 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpt0.
19036
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020019037src_gpc_rate(<idx>[,<table>]) : integer
19038 Returns the average increment rate of the General Purpose Counter at the
19039 index <idx> of the array associated to the incoming connection's
19040 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
19041 stick-table <table>. It reports the frequency which the gpc counter was
19042 incremented over the configured period. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99.
19043 Note that the 'gpc_rate' counter must be stored in the stick-table for a
19044 value to be returned, as 'gpc' only holds the event count.
19045 This fetch applies only to the 'gpc_rate' array data_type (and not to
19046 the legacy 'gpc0_rate' nor 'gpc1_rate' data_types).
19047 See also sc_gpc_rate, src_get_gpc, and sc_inc_gpc.
19048
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019049src_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020019050 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019051 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020019052 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
19053 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020019054 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc0_rate, src_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
19055 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
19056 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020019057
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010019058src_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
19059 Returns the average increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
19060 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
19061 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
19062 which the gpc1 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
19063 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc1_rate, src_get_gpc1, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1. Note
19064 that the "gpc1_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
19065 be returned, as "gpc1" only holds the event count.
19066
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019067src_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019068 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019069 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020019070 stick-table. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020019071 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_cnt. If the address is not found, zero is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019072 returned.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020019073
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019074src_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
19075 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's source
19076 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
19077 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
19078 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020019079 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020019080
Willy Tarreau826f3ab2021-02-10 12:07:15 +010019081src_http_fail_cnt([<table>]) : integer
19082 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP response failures triggered by the
19083 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Ilya Shipitsin0de36ad2021-02-20 00:23:36 +050019084 the designated stick-table. This includes the both response errors and 5xx
Willy Tarreau826f3ab2021-02-10 12:07:15 +010019085 status codes other than 501 and 505. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_fail_cnt.
19086 If the address is not found, zero is returned.
19087
19088src_http_fail_rate([<table>]) : integer
19089 Returns the average rate of HTTP response failures triggered by the incoming
19090 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
19091 designated stick-table, measured in amount of failures over the period
19092 configured in the table. This includes the both response errors and 5xx
19093 status codes other than 501 and 505. If the address is not found, zero is
19094 returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_fail_rate.
19095
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019096src_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019097 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019098 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
19099 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020019100 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020019101
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019102src_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
19103 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
19104 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
19105 table, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in the
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020019106 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020019107 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020019108
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020019109src_inc_gpc(<idx>,[<table>]) : integer
19110 Increments the General Purpose Counter at index <idx> of the array
19111 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
19112 stick-table or in the designated stick-table <table>, and returns its new
19113 value. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99.
19114 If the address is not found, an entry is created and 1 is returned.
19115 This fetch applies only to the 'gpc' array data_type (and not to the legacy
19116 'gpc0' nor 'gpc1' data_types).
19117 See also sc_inc_gpc.
19118
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019119src_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
19120 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
19121 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
19122 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020019123 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019124 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
19125 connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020019126
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030019127 Example:
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020019128 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010019129 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020019130 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020019131
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010019132src_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
19133 Increments the second General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
19134 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
19135 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
19136 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc1.
19137 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
19138 connection when a first ACL was verified.
19139
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020019140src_is_local : boolean
19141 Returns true if the source address of the incoming connection is local to the
19142 system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning that it
19143 comes from a remote machine. Note that UNIX addresses are considered local.
19144 It can be useful to apply certain access restrictions based on where the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019145 client comes from (e.g. require auth or https for remote machines). Please
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020019146 note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do it only
19147 once per connection.
19148
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019149src_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020019150 Returns the total amount of data received from the incoming connection's
19151 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
19152 stick-table, measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is
19153 returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits
19154 values to 4 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020019155
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019156src_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020019157 Returns the total amount of data sent to the incoming connection's source
19158 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
19159 measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is returned. The
19160 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
19161 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020019162
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019163src_port : integer
19164 Returns an integer value corresponding to the TCP source port of the
Christopher Faulet888cd702021-10-25 16:58:50 +020019165 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected
19166 from. Any tcp/http rules may alter this address. Usage of this function is
19167 very limited as modern protocols do not care much about source ports
19168 nowadays.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010019169
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019170src_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019171 Returns the cumulative number of connections initiated from the incoming
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020019172 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
19173 designated stick-table, that were transformed into sessions, which means that
19174 they were accepted by "tcp-request" rules. If the address is not found, zero
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020019175 is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020019176
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019177src_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
19178 Returns the average session rate from the incoming connection's source
19179 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
19180 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
19181 session is a connection that went past the early "tcp-request" rules. If the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020019182 address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020019183
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019184src_updt_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
19185 Creates or updates the entry associated to the incoming connection's source
19186 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table.
19187 This table must be configured to store the "conn_cnt" data type, otherwise
19188 the match will be ignored. The current count is incremented by one, and the
19189 expiration timer refreshed. The updated count is returned, so this match
19190 can't return zero. This was used to reject service abusers based on their
19191 source address. Note: it is recommended to use the more complete "track-sc*"
19192 actions in "tcp-request" rules instead.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020019193
19194 Example :
19195 # This frontend limits incoming SSH connections to 3 per 10 second for
19196 # each source address, and rejects excess connections until a 10 second
19197 # silence is observed. At most 20 addresses are tracked.
19198 listen ssh
19199 bind :22
19200 mode tcp
19201 maxconn 100
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020019202 stick-table type ip size 20 expire 10s store conn_cnt
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019203 tcp-request content reject if { src_updt_conn_cnt gt 3 }
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020019204 server local 127.0.0.1:22
19205
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019206srv_id : integer
19207 Returns an integer containing the server's id when processing the response.
19208 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020019209 debugging. It can also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Hervé COMMOWICKdaa824e2011-08-05 12:09:44 +020019210
vkill1dfd1652019-10-30 16:58:14 +080019211srv_name : string
19212 Returns a string containing the server's name when processing the response.
19213 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020019214 debugging. It can also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
vkill1dfd1652019-10-30 16:58:14 +080019215
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200192167.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019217----------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0b1cd942010-05-16 22:18:27 +020019218
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040019219The layer 5 usually describes just the session layer which in HAProxy is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019220closest to the session once all the connection handshakes are finished, but
19221when no content is yet made available. The fetch methods described here are
19222usable as low as the "tcp-request content" rule sets unless they require some
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030019223future information. Those generally include the results of SSL negotiations.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020019224
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001922551d.all(<prop>[,<prop>*]) : string
19226 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
19227 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
19228 The device is identified using all the important HTTP headers from the
19229 request. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
19230 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
19231
19232 Example :
19233 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request
19234 # containing the three properties requested using all relevant headers from
19235 # the request.
19236 frontend http-in
19237 bind *:8081
19238 default_backend servers
19239 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
19240 %[51d.all(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
19241
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020019242ssl_bc : boolean
19243 Returns true when the back connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
19244 layer and is locally deciphered. This means the outgoing connection was made
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020019245 other a server with the "ssl" option. It can be used in a tcp-check or an
19246 http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020019247
19248ssl_bc_alg_keysize : integer
19249 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the outgoing
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020019250 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a
19251 tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020019252
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010019253ssl_bc_alpn : string
19254 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
19255 outgoing connection made via a TLS transport layer.
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +020019256 The result is a string containing the protocol name negotiated with the
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010019257 server. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
19258 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
19259 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "server" line specifies a
19260 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the server to pick a protocol from this
19261 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020019262 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_bc_npn". It can be used in a
19263 tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010019264
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020019265ssl_bc_cipher : string
19266 Returns the name of the used cipher when the outgoing connection was made
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020019267 over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a tcp-check or an
19268 http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020019269
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040019270ssl_bc_client_random : binary
19271 Returns the client random of the back connection when the incoming connection
19272 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
19273 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020019274 It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040019275
Remi Tricot-Le Breton1fe0fad2021-09-29 18:56:52 +020019276ssl_bc_err : integer
Remi Tricot-Le Breton163cdeb2021-09-01 15:52:14 +020019277 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Remi Tricot-Le Breton1fe0fad2021-09-29 18:56:52 +020019278 returns the ID of the last error of the first error stack raised on the
19279 backend side. It can raise handshake errors as well as other read or write
19280 errors occurring during the connection's lifetime. In order to get a text
19281 description of this error code, you can either use the "ssl_bc_err_str"
Remi Tricot-Le Breton163cdeb2021-09-01 15:52:14 +020019282 sample fetch or use the "openssl errstr" command (which takes an error code
19283 in hexadecimal representation as parameter). Please refer to your SSL
19284 library's documentation to find the exhaustive list of error codes.
19285
Remi Tricot-Le Breton1fe0fad2021-09-29 18:56:52 +020019286ssl_bc_err_str : string
Remi Tricot-Le Breton163cdeb2021-09-01 15:52:14 +020019287 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Remi Tricot-Le Breton1fe0fad2021-09-29 18:56:52 +020019288 returns a string representation of the last error of the first error stack
19289 that was raised on the connection from the backend's perspective. See also
19290 "ssl_fc_err".
Remi Tricot-Le Breton163cdeb2021-09-01 15:52:14 +020019291
Emeric Brun74f7ffa2018-02-19 16:14:12 +010019292ssl_bc_is_resumed : boolean
19293 Returns true when the back connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
19294 layer and the newly created SSL session was resumed using a cached
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020019295 session or a TLS ticket. It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check
19296 ruleset.
Emeric Brun74f7ffa2018-02-19 16:14:12 +010019297
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010019298ssl_bc_npn : string
19299 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an outgoing connection
19300 made via a TLS transport layer. The result is a string containing the
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +020019301 protocol name negotiated with the server . The SSL library must have been
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010019302 built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that
19303 the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the "npn" keyword on the
19304 "server" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing forces the server to
19305 pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be used. Please note that
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020019306 the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN. It can be used in a tcp-check
19307 or an http-check ruleset.
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010019308
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020019309ssl_bc_protocol : string
19310 Returns the name of the used protocol when the outgoing connection was made
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020019311 over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a tcp-check or an
19312 http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020019313
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020019314ssl_bc_unique_id : binary
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020019315 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020019316 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020019317 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64". It
19318 can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020019319
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040019320ssl_bc_server_random : binary
19321 Returns the server random of the back connection when the incoming connection
19322 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
19323 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020019324 It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040019325
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020019326ssl_bc_session_id : binary
19327 Returns the SSL ID of the back connection when the outgoing connection was
19328 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to log if we want to know
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020019329 if session was reused or not. It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check
19330 ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020019331
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040019332ssl_bc_session_key : binary
19333 Returns the SSL session master key of the back connection when the outgoing
19334 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to decrypt
19335 traffic sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020019336 BoringSSL. It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040019337
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020019338ssl_bc_use_keysize : integer
19339 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the outgoing
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020019340 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a
19341 tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020019342
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019343ssl_c_ca_err : integer
19344 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
19345 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification of the client
19346 certificate at depth > 0, or 0 if no error was encountered during this
19347 verification process. Please refer to your SSL library's documentation to
19348 find the exhaustive list of error codes.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020019349
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019350ssl_c_ca_err_depth : integer
19351 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
19352 returns the depth in the CA chain of the first error detected during the
19353 verification of the client certificate. If no error is encountered, 0 is
19354 returned.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010019355
Christopher Faulet70d10d12020-11-06 12:10:33 +010019356ssl_c_chain_der : binary
William Dauchya598b502020-08-06 18:11:38 +020019357 Returns the DER formatted chain certificate presented by the client when the
19358 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
19359 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form. One
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +050019360 can parse the result with any lib accepting ASN.1 DER data. It currently
William Dauchya598b502020-08-06 18:11:38 +020019361 does not support resumed sessions.
19362
Christopher Faulet70d10d12020-11-06 12:10:33 +010019363ssl_c_der : binary
19364 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the client when the
19365 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
19366 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
19367
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019368ssl_c_err : integer
19369 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
19370 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification at depth 0, or
19371 0 if no error was encountered during this verification process. Please refer
19372 to your SSL library's documentation to find the exhaustive list of error
19373 codes.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020019374
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050019375ssl_c_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019376 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
19377 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
19378 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
19379 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
19380 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
19381 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
19382 For instance, "ssl_c_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
19383 "ssl_c_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050019384 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
19385 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
19386 LDAP v3.
19387 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
19388 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_c_i_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020019389
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019390ssl_c_key_alg : string
19391 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
19392 presented by the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
19393 transport layer.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020019394
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019395ssl_c_notafter : string
19396 Returns the end date presented by the client as a formatted string
19397 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
19398 transport layer.
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020019399
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019400ssl_c_notbefore : string
19401 Returns the start date presented by the client as a formatted string
19402 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
19403 transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010019404
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050019405ssl_c_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019406 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
19407 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
19408 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
19409 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
19410 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
19411 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
19412 For instance, "ssl_c_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
19413 "ssl_c_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050019414 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
19415 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
19416 LDAP v3.
19417 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
19418 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_c_s_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010019419
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019420ssl_c_serial : binary
19421 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the client when the
19422 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
19423 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020019424
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019425ssl_c_sha1 : binary
19426 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the client when
19427 the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This can be
19428 used to stick a client to a server, or to pass this information to a server.
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020019429 Note that the output is binary, so if you want to pass that signature to the
19430 server, you need to encode it in hex or base64, such as in the example below:
19431
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030019432 Example:
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020019433 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-SHA1 %[ssl_c_sha1,hex]
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020019434
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019435ssl_c_sig_alg : string
19436 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
19437 the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
19438 layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020019439
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019440ssl_c_used : boolean
19441 Returns true if current SSL session uses a client certificate even if current
19442 connection uses SSL session resumption. See also "ssl_fc_has_crt".
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020019443
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019444ssl_c_verify : integer
19445 Returns the verify result error ID when the incoming connection was made over
19446 an SSL/TLS transport layer, otherwise zero if no error is encountered. Please
19447 refer to your SSL library's documentation for an exhaustive list of error
19448 codes.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020019449
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019450ssl_c_version : integer
19451 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the client when the
19452 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020019453
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010019454ssl_f_der : binary
19455 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the frontend when the
19456 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
19457 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
19458
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050019459ssl_f_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019460 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
19461 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
19462 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
19463 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020019464 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019465 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
19466 For instance, "ssl_f_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
19467 "ssl_f_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050019468 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
19469 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
19470 LDAP v3.
19471 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
19472 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_f_i_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020019473
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019474ssl_f_key_alg : string
19475 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
19476 presented by the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an
19477 SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020019478
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019479ssl_f_notafter : string
19480 Returns the end date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
19481 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
19482 transport layer.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020019483
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019484ssl_f_notbefore : string
19485 Returns the start date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
19486 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
19487 transport layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020019488
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050019489ssl_f_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019490 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
19491 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
19492 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
19493 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
19494 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
19495 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
19496 For instance, "ssl_f_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
19497 "ssl_f_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050019498 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
19499 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
19500 LDAP v3.
19501 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
19502 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_f_s_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020019503
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019504ssl_f_serial : binary
19505 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
19506 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
19507 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020019508
Emeric Brun55f4fa82014-04-30 17:11:25 +020019509ssl_f_sha1 : binary
19510 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the frontend
19511 when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This
19512 can be used to know which certificate was chosen using SNI.
19513
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019514ssl_f_sig_alg : string
19515 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
19516 the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
19517 layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020019518
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019519ssl_f_version : integer
19520 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
19521 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
19522
19523ssl_fc : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020019524 Returns true when the front connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
19525 layer and is locally deciphered. This means it has matched a socket declared
19526 with a "bind" line having the "ssl" option.
19527
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019528 Example :
19529 # This passes "X-Proto: https" to servers when client connects over SSL
19530 listen http-https
19531 bind :80
19532 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy.pem
19533 http-request add-header X-Proto https if { ssl_fc }
19534
19535ssl_fc_alg_keysize : integer
19536 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the incoming
19537 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
19538
19539ssl_fc_alpn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030019540 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019541 incoming connection made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040019542 HAProxy. The result is a string containing the protocol name advertised by
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019543 the client. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
19544 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
19545 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a
19546 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the client to pick a protocol from this
19547 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
19548 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_fc_npn".
19549
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019550ssl_fc_cipher : string
19551 Returns the name of the used cipher when the incoming connection was made
19552 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020019553
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020019554ssl_fc_cipherlist_bin([<filter_option>]) : binary
19555 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum
19556 returned value length is limited by the shared capture buffer size
Marcin Deranek310a2602021-07-13 19:04:24 +020019557 controlled by "tune.ssl.capture-buffer-size" setting. Setting
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020019558 <filter_option> allows to filter returned data. Accepted values:
19559 0 : return the full list of ciphers (default)
19560 1 : exclude GREASE (RFC8701) values from the output
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010019561
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020019562 Example:
19563 http-request set-header X-SSL-JA3 %[ssl_fc_protocol_hello_id],\
19564 %[ssl_fc_cipherlist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
19565 %[ssl_fc_extlist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
19566 %[ssl_fc_eclist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
19567 %[ssl_fc_ecformats_bin,be2dec(-,1)]
19568 acl is_malware req.fhdr(x-ssl-ja3),digest(md5),hex \
19569 -f /path/to/file/with/malware-ja3.lst
19570 http-request set-header X-Malware True if is_malware
19571 http-request set-header X-Malware False if !is_malware
19572
19573ssl_fc_cipherlist_hex([<filter_option>]) : string
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010019574 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list encoded as
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020019575 hexadecimal. The maximum returned value length is limited by the shared
Marcin Deranek310a2602021-07-13 19:04:24 +020019576 capture buffer size controlled by "tune.ssl.capture-buffer-size" setting.
19577 Setting <filter_option> allows to filter returned data. Accepted values:
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020019578 0 : return the full list of ciphers (default)
19579 1 : exclude GREASE (RFC8701) values from the output
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010019580
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020019581ssl_fc_cipherlist_str([<filter_option>]) : string
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010019582 Returns the decoded text form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020019583 returned value length is limited by the shared capture buffer size
Marcin Deranek310a2602021-07-13 19:04:24 +020019584 controlled by "tune.ssl.capture-buffer-size" setting. Setting
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020019585 <filter_option> allows to filter returned data. Accepted values:
19586 0 : return the full list of ciphers (default)
19587 1 : exclude GREASE (RFC8701) values from the output
19588 Note that this sample-fetch is only available with OpenSSL >= 1.0.2. If the
19589 function is not enabled, this sample-fetch returns the hash like
19590 "ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010019591
19592ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh : integer
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020019593 Returns a xxh64 of the cipher list. This hash can return only if the value
Marcin Deranek310a2602021-07-13 19:04:24 +020019594 "tune.ssl.capture-buffer-size" is set greater than 0, however the hash take
19595 into account all the data of the cipher list.
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020019596
19597ssl_fc_ecformats_bin : binary
19598 Return the binary form of the client hello supported elliptic curve point
19599 formats. The maximum returned value length is limited by the shared capture
Marcin Deranek310a2602021-07-13 19:04:24 +020019600 buffer size controlled by "tune.ssl.capture-buffer-size" setting.
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020019601
19602 Example:
19603 http-request set-header X-SSL-JA3 %[ssl_fc_protocol_hello_id],\
19604 %[ssl_fc_cipherlist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
19605 %[ssl_fc_extlist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
19606 %[ssl_fc_eclist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
19607 %[ssl_fc_ecformats_bin,be2dec(-,1)]
19608 acl is_malware req.fhdr(x-ssl-ja3),digest(md5),hex \
19609 -f /path/to/file/with/malware-ja3.lst
19610 http-request set-header X-Malware True if is_malware
19611 http-request set-header X-Malware False if !is_malware
19612
19613ssl_fc_eclist_bin([<filter_option>]) : binary
19614 Returns the binary form of the client hello supported elliptic curves. The
19615 maximum returned value length is limited by the shared capture buffer size
Marcin Deranek310a2602021-07-13 19:04:24 +020019616 controlled by "tune.ssl.capture-buffer-size" setting. Setting
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020019617 <filter_option> allows to filter returned data. Accepted values:
19618 0 : return the full list of supported elliptic curves (default)
19619 1 : exclude GREASE (RFC8701) values from the output
19620
19621 Example:
19622 http-request set-header X-SSL-JA3 %[ssl_fc_protocol_hello_id],\
19623 %[ssl_fc_cipherlist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
19624 %[ssl_fc_extlist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
19625 %[ssl_fc_eclist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
19626 %[ssl_fc_ecformats_bin,be2dec(-,1)]
19627 acl is_malware req.fhdr(x-ssl-ja3),digest(md5),hex \
19628 -f /path/to/file/with/malware-ja3.lst
19629 http-request set-header X-Malware True if is_malware
19630 http-request set-header X-Malware False if !is_malware
19631
19632ssl_fc_extlist_bin([<filter_option>]) : binary
19633 Returns the binary form of the client hello extension list. The maximum
19634 returned value length is limited by the shared capture buffer size
Marcin Deranek310a2602021-07-13 19:04:24 +020019635 controlled by "tune.ssl.capture-buffer-size" setting. Setting
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020019636 <filter_option> allows to filter returned data. Accepted values:
19637 0 : return the full list of extensions (default)
19638 1 : exclude GREASE (RFC8701) values from the output
19639
19640 Example:
19641 http-request set-header X-SSL-JA3 %[ssl_fc_protocol_hello_id],\
19642 %[ssl_fc_cipherlist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
19643 %[ssl_fc_extlist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
19644 %[ssl_fc_eclist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
19645 %[ssl_fc_ecformats_bin,be2dec(-,1)]
19646 acl is_malware req.fhdr(x-ssl-ja3),digest(md5),hex \
19647 -f /path/to/file/with/malware-ja3.lst
19648 http-request set-header X-Malware True if is_malware
19649 http-request set-header X-Malware False if !is_malware
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010019650
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040019651ssl_fc_client_random : binary
19652 Returns the client random of the front connection when the incoming connection
19653 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
19654 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
19655
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +020019656ssl_fc_client_early_traffic_secret : string
19657 Return the CLIENT_EARLY_TRAFFIC_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
19658 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
19659 transport layer.
19660 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
19661 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
19662 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
19663 "tune.ssl.keylog"
19664
19665ssl_fc_client_handshake_traffic_secret : string
19666 Return the CLIENT_HANDSHAKE_TRAFFIC_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
19667 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
19668 transport layer.
19669 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
19670 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
19671 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
19672 "tune.ssl.keylog"
19673
19674ssl_fc_client_traffic_secret_0 : string
19675 Return the CLIENT_TRAFFIC_SECRET_0 as an hexadecimal string for the
19676 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
19677 transport layer.
19678 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
19679 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
19680 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
19681 "tune.ssl.keylog"
19682
19683ssl_fc_exporter_secret : string
19684 Return the EXPORTER_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
19685 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
19686 transport layer.
19687 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
19688 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
19689 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
19690 "tune.ssl.keylog"
19691
19692ssl_fc_early_exporter_secret : string
19693 Return the EARLY_EXPORTER_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
19694 front connection when the incoming connection was made over an TLS 1.3
19695 transport layer.
19696 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
19697 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
19698 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
19699 "tune.ssl.keylog"
19700
Remi Tricot-Le Breton1fe0fad2021-09-29 18:56:52 +020019701ssl_fc_err : integer
19702 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
19703 returns the ID of the last error of the first error stack raised on the
19704 frontend side, or 0 if no error was encountered. It can be used to identify
19705 handshake related errors other than verify ones (such as cipher mismatch), as
19706 well as other read or write errors occurring during the connection's
19707 lifetime. Any error happening during the client's certificate verification
19708 process will not be raised through this fetch but via the existing
19709 "ssl_c_err", "ssl_c_ca_err" and "ssl_c_ca_err_depth" fetches. In order to get
19710 a text description of this error code, you can either use the
19711 "ssl_fc_err_str" sample fetch or use the "openssl errstr" command (which
19712 takes an error code in hexadecimal representation as parameter). Please refer
19713 to your SSL library's documentation to find the exhaustive list of error
19714 codes.
19715
19716ssl_fc_err_str : string
19717 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
19718 returns a string representation of the last error of the first error stack
19719 that was raised on the frontend side. Any error happening during the client's
19720 certificate verification process will not be raised through this fetch. See
19721 also "ssl_fc_err".
19722
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019723ssl_fc_has_crt : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020019724 Returns true if a client certificate is present in an incoming connection over
19725 SSL/TLS transport layer. Useful if 'verify' statement is set to 'optional'.
Emeric Brun9143d372012-12-20 15:44:16 +010019726 Note: on SSL session resumption with Session ID or TLS ticket, client
19727 certificate is not present in the current connection but may be retrieved
19728 from the cache or the ticket. So prefer "ssl_c_used" if you want to check if
19729 current SSL session uses a client certificate.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020019730
Olivier Houchardccaa7de2017-10-02 11:51:03 +020019731ssl_fc_has_early : boolean
19732 Returns true if early data were sent, and the handshake didn't happen yet. As
19733 it has security implications, it is useful to be able to refuse those, or
19734 wait until the handshake happened.
19735
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019736ssl_fc_has_sni : boolean
19737 This checks for the presence of a Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI)
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020019738 in an incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. Returns
19739 true when the incoming connection presents a TLS SNI field. This requires
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050019740 that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020019741 haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020019742
Nenad Merdanovic1516fe32016-05-17 03:31:21 +020019743ssl_fc_is_resumed : boolean
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020019744 Returns true if the SSL/TLS session has been resumed through the use of
Jérôme Magnin4a326cb2018-01-15 14:01:17 +010019745 SSL session cache or TLS tickets on an incoming connection over an SSL/TLS
19746 transport layer.
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020019747
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019748ssl_fc_npn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030019749 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an incoming connection
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040019750 made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by HAProxy. The result
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019751 is a string containing the protocol name advertised by the client. The SSL
19752 library must have been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
19753 haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the
19754 "npn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing
19755 forces the client to pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be
19756 requested. Please note that the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN.
Willy Tarreaua33c6542012-10-15 13:19:06 +020019757
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019758ssl_fc_protocol : string
19759 Returns the name of the used protocol when the incoming connection was made
19760 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020019761
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020019762ssl_fc_protocol_hello_id : integer
19763 The version of the TLS protocol by which the client wishes to communicate
19764 during the session as indicated in client hello message. This value can
Marcin Deranek310a2602021-07-13 19:04:24 +020019765 return only if the value "tune.ssl.capture-buffer-size" is set greater than
19766 0.
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020019767
19768 Example:
19769 http-request set-header X-SSL-JA3 %[ssl_fc_protocol_hello_id],\
19770 %[ssl_fc_cipherlist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
19771 %[ssl_fc_extlist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
19772 %[ssl_fc_eclist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
19773 %[ssl_fc_ecformats_bin,be2dec(-,1)]
19774 acl is_malware req.fhdr(x-ssl-ja3),digest(md5),hex \
19775 -f /path/to/file/with/malware-ja3.lst
19776 http-request set-header X-Malware True if is_malware
19777 http-request set-header X-Malware False if !is_malware
19778
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020019779ssl_fc_unique_id : binary
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040019780 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020019781 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
Christopher Faulet15ae22c2021-11-09 14:23:36 +010019782 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_fc_unique_id,base64".
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040019783
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +020019784ssl_fc_server_handshake_traffic_secret : string
19785 Return the SERVER_HANDSHAKE_TRAFFIC_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
19786 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
19787 transport layer.
19788 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
19789 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
19790 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
19791 "tune.ssl.keylog"
19792
19793ssl_fc_server_traffic_secret_0 : string
19794 Return the SERVER_TRAFFIC_SECRET_0 as an hexadecimal string for the
19795 front connection when the incoming connection was made over an TLS 1.3
19796 transport layer.
19797 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
19798 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
19799 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
19800 "tune.ssl.keylog"
19801
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040019802ssl_fc_server_random : binary
19803 Returns the server random of the front connection when the incoming connection
19804 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
19805 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
19806
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019807ssl_fc_session_id : binary
19808 Returns the SSL ID of the front connection when the incoming connection was
19809 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to stick a given client to
19810 a server. It is important to note that some browsers refresh their session ID
19811 every few minutes.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020019812
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040019813ssl_fc_session_key : binary
19814 Returns the SSL session master key of the front connection when the incoming
19815 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to decrypt
19816 traffic sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or
19817 BoringSSL.
19818
19819
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019820ssl_fc_sni : string
19821 This extracts the Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI) field from an
19822 incoming connection made via an SSL/TLS transport layer and locally
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040019823 deciphered by HAProxy. The result (when present) typically is a string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019824 matching the HTTPS host name (253 chars or less). The SSL library must have
19825 been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv).
19826
Alex5c866202021-06-05 13:23:08 +020019827 This fetch is different from "req.ssl_sni" above in that it applies to the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040019828 connection being deciphered by HAProxy and not to SSL contents being blindly
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019829 forwarded. See also "ssl_fc_sni_end" and "ssl_fc_sni_reg" below. This
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050019830 requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Cyril Bonté9c1eb1e2012-10-09 22:45:34 +020019831 enabled (check haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020019832
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019833 ACL derivatives :
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019834 ssl_fc_sni_end : suffix match
19835 ssl_fc_sni_reg : regex match
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +020019836
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019837ssl_fc_use_keysize : integer
19838 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the incoming
19839 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020019840
William Lallemandbfa3e812020-06-25 20:07:18 +020019841ssl_s_der : binary
19842 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the server when the
19843 outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
19844 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
19845
William Dauchya598b502020-08-06 18:11:38 +020019846ssl_s_chain_der : binary
19847 Returns the DER formatted chain certificate presented by the server when the
19848 outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
19849 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form. One
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +050019850 can parse the result with any lib accepting ASN.1 DER data. It currently
William Dauchya598b502020-08-06 18:11:38 +020019851 does not support resumed sessions.
19852
William Lallemandbfa3e812020-06-25 20:07:18 +020019853ssl_s_key_alg : string
19854 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
19855 presented by the server when the outgoing connection was made over an
19856 SSL/TLS transport layer.
19857
19858ssl_s_notafter : string
19859 Returns the end date presented by the server as a formatted string
19860 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS
19861 transport layer.
19862
19863ssl_s_notbefore : string
19864 Returns the start date presented by the server as a formatted string
19865 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS
19866 transport layer.
19867
19868ssl_s_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
19869 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
19870 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
19871 presented by the server when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
19872 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
19873 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
19874 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
William Lallemand8f600c82020-06-26 09:55:06 +020019875 For instance, "ssl_s_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
19876 "ssl_s_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
William Lallemandbfa3e812020-06-25 20:07:18 +020019877 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
19878 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
19879 LDAP v3.
19880 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
19881 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_s_i_dn(,0,rfc2253)
19882
19883ssl_s_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
19884 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
19885 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
19886 presented by the server when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
19887 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
19888 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
19889 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
William Lallemand8f600c82020-06-26 09:55:06 +020019890 For instance, "ssl_s_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
19891 "ssl_s_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
William Lallemandbfa3e812020-06-25 20:07:18 +020019892 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
19893 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
19894 LDAP v3.
19895 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
19896 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_s_s_dn(,0,rfc2253)
19897
19898ssl_s_serial : binary
19899 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the server when the
19900 outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
19901 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
19902
19903ssl_s_sha1 : binary
19904 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the server
19905 when the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This
19906 can be used to know which certificate was chosen using SNI.
19907
19908ssl_s_sig_alg : string
19909 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
19910 the server when the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
19911 layer.
19912
19913ssl_s_version : integer
19914 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the server when the
19915 outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020019916
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200199177.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019918------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020019919
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019920Fetching samples from buffer contents is a bit different from the previous
19921sample fetches above because the sampled data are ephemeral. These data can
19922only be used when they're available and will be lost when they're forwarded.
19923For this reason, samples fetched from buffer contents during a request cannot
19924be used in a response for example. Even while the data are being fetched, they
19925can change. Sometimes it is necessary to set some delays or combine multiple
19926sample fetch methods to ensure that the expected data are complete and usable,
19927for example through TCP request content inspection. Please see the "tcp-request
19928content" keyword for more detailed information on the subject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020019929
Christopher Fauleta434a002021-03-25 11:58:51 +010019930Warning : Following sample fetches are ignored if used from HTTP proxies. They
19931 only deal with raw contents found in the buffers. On their side,
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040019932 HTTP proxies use structured content. Thus raw representation of
Christopher Fauleta434a002021-03-25 11:58:51 +010019933 these data are meaningless. A warning is emitted if an ACL relies on
19934 one of the following sample fetches. But it is not possible to detect
19935 all invalid usage (for instance inside a log-format string or a
19936 sample expression). So be careful.
19937
Willy Tarreau3ec14612022-03-10 10:39:58 +010019938distcc_body(<token>[,<occ>]) : binary
19939 Parses a distcc message and returns the body associated to occurrence #<occ>
19940 of the token <token>. Occurrences start at 1, and when unspecified, any may
19941 match though in practice only the first one is checked for now. This can be
19942 used to extract file names or arguments in files built using distcc through
19943 HAProxy. Please refer to distcc's protocol documentation for the complete
19944 list of supported tokens.
19945
19946distcc_param(<token>[,<occ>]) : integer
19947 Parses a distcc message and returns the parameter associated to occurrence
19948 #<occ> of the token <token>. Occurrences start at 1, and when unspecified,
19949 any may match though in practice only the first one is checked for now. This
19950 can be used to extract certain information such as the protocol version, the
19951 file size or the argument in files built using distcc through HAProxy.
19952 Another use case consists in waiting for the start of the preprocessed file
19953 contents before connecting to the server to avoid keeping idle connections.
19954 Please refer to distcc's protocol documentation for the complete list of
19955 supported tokens.
19956
19957 Example :
19958 # wait up to 20s for the pre-processed file to be uploaded
19959 tcp-request inspect-delay 20s
19960 tcp-request content accept if { distcc_param(DOTI) -m found }
19961 # send large files to the big farm
19962 use_backend big_farm if { distcc_param(DOTI) gt 1000000 }
19963
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019964payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary (deprecated)
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019965 This is an alias for "req.payload" when used in the context of a request (e.g.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019966 "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload" when used in the context of
19967 a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010019968
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019969payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary (deprecated)
19970 This is an alias for "req.payload_lv" when used in the context of a request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019971 (e.g. "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload_lv" when used in the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019972 context of a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010019973
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019974req.len : integer
19975req_len : integer (deprecated)
19976 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
19977 request buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
19978 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
19979 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
19980 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040019981 that data to come in and return false only when HAProxy is certain that no
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019982 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP request
19983 content inspection.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020019984
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019985req.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
19986 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020019987 in the request buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
19988 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
19989 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
19990 any location.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020019991
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010019992 ACL derivatives :
19993 req.payload(<offset>,<length>) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020019994
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019995req.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
19996 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
19997 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
19998 the request buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets if
19999 prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020020000
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010020001 ACL derivatives :
20002 req.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020020003
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020004 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020020005
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020006req.proto_http : boolean
20007req_proto_http : boolean (deprecated)
20008 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like HTTP and correctly
20009 parses as such. It is the same parser as the common HTTP request parser which
20010 is used so there should be no surprises. The test does not match until the
20011 request is complete, failed or timed out. This test may be used to report the
20012 protocol in TCP logs, but the biggest use is to block TCP request analysis
20013 until a complete HTTP request is present in the buffer, for example to track
20014 a header.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020020015
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020016 Example:
20017 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
20018 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
20019 tcp-request content reject if !HTTP
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020020020 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020020021
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020022req.rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string
20023rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
20024 When the request buffer looks like the RDP protocol, extracts the RDP cookie
20025 <name>, or any cookie if unspecified. The parser only checks for the first
20026 cookie, as illustrated in the RDP protocol specification. The cookie name is
20027 case insensitive. Generally the "MSTS" cookie name will be used, as it can
20028 contain the user name of the client connecting to the server if properly
20029 configured on the client. The "MSTSHASH" cookie is often used as well for
20030 session stickiness to servers.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020020031
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020032 This differs from "balance rdp-cookie" in that any balancing algorithm may be
20033 used and thus the distribution of clients to backend servers is not linked to
20034 a hash of the RDP cookie. It is envisaged that using a balancing algorithm
20035 such as "balance roundrobin" or "balance leastconn" will lead to a more even
20036 distribution of clients to backend servers than the hash used by "balance
20037 rdp-cookie".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020020038
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020039 ACL derivatives :
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010020040 req.rdp_cookie([<name>]) : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020020041
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020042 Example :
20043 listen tse-farm
20044 bind 0.0.0.0:3389
20045 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
20046 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
20047 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
20048 # apply RDP cookie persistence
20049 persist rdp-cookie
20050 # Persist based on the mstshash cookie
20051 # This is only useful makes sense if
20052 # balance rdp-cookie is not used
20053 stick-table type string size 204800
20054 stick on req.rdp_cookie(mstshash)
20055 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
20056 server srv1 1.1.1.2:3389
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020020057
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020058 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "persist rdp-cookie", "tcp-request" and the
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010020059 "req.rdp_cookie" ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020020060
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020061req.rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer
20062rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer (deprecated)
20063 Tries to parse the request buffer as RDP protocol, then returns an integer
20064 corresponding to the number of RDP cookies found. If an optional cookie name
20065 is passed, only cookies matching this name are considered. This is mostly
20066 used in ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020020067
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020068 ACL derivatives :
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010020069 req.rdp_cookie_cnt([<name>]) : integer match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020020070
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110020071req.ssl_alpn : string
20072 Returns a string containing the values of the Application-Layer Protocol
20073 Negotiation (ALPN) TLS extension (RFC7301), sent by the client within the SSL
20074 ClientHello message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the
20075 request buffer and not to the contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so
20076 this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This is useful
20077 in ACL to make a routing decision based upon the ALPN preferences of a TLS
Jarno Huuskonene504f812019-01-03 07:56:49 +020020078 client, like in the example below. See also "ssl_fc_alpn".
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110020079
20080 Examples :
20081 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
20082 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010020083 tcp-request content accept if { req.ssl_hello_type 1 }
Jarno Huuskonene504f812019-01-03 07:56:49 +020020084 use_backend bk_acme if { req.ssl_alpn acme-tls/1 }
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110020085 default_backend bk_default
20086
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020020087req.ssl_ec_ext : boolean
20088 Returns a boolean identifying if client sent the Supported Elliptic Curves
20089 Extension as defined in RFC4492, section 5.1. within the SSL ClientHello
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020020090 message. This can be used to present ECC compatible clients with EC
20091 certificate and to use RSA for all others, on the same IP address. Note that
20092 this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and not to
20093 contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind"
20094 lines having the "ssl" option.
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020020095
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020096req.ssl_hello_type : integer
20097req_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
20098 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
20099 in the request buffer if the buffer contains data that parse as a complete
20100 SSL (v3 or superior) client hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
20101 contents found in the request buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
20102 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl"
20103 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
20104 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020020105
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020106req.ssl_sni : string
20107req_ssl_sni : string (deprecated)
20108 Returns a string containing the value of the Server Name TLS extension sent
20109 by a client in a TLS stream passing through the request buffer if the buffer
20110 contains data that parse as a complete SSL (v3 or superior) client hello
20111 message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
20112 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
Lukas Tribusa267b5d2020-07-19 00:25:06 +020020113 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This will only work for actual
20114 implicit TLS based protocols like HTTPS (443), IMAPS (993), SMTPS (465),
20115 however it will not work for explicit TLS based protocols, like SMTP (25/587)
20116 or IMAP (143). SNI normally contains the name of the host the client tries to
20117 connect to (for recent browsers). SNI is useful for allowing or denying access
20118 to certain hosts when SSL/TLS is used by the client. This test was designed to
20119 be used with TCP request content inspection. If content switching is needed,
20120 it is recommended to first wait for a complete client hello (type 1), like in
20121 the example below. See also "ssl_fc_sni".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020020122
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020123 ACL derivatives :
Alex5c866202021-06-05 13:23:08 +020020124 req.ssl_sni : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020020125
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020126 Examples :
20127 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
20128 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010020129 tcp-request content accept if { req.ssl_hello_type 1 }
Alex5c866202021-06-05 13:23:08 +020020130 use_backend bk_allow if { req.ssl_sni -f allowed_sites }
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020131 default_backend bk_sorry_page
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020020132
Pradeep Jindalbb2acf52015-09-29 10:12:57 +053020133req.ssl_st_ext : integer
20134 Returns 0 if the client didn't send a SessionTicket TLS Extension (RFC5077)
20135 Returns 1 if the client sent SessionTicket TLS Extension
20136 Returns 2 if the client also sent non-zero length TLS SessionTicket
20137 Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and
20138 not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with
20139 "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This can for example be used to detect
20140 whether the client sent a SessionTicket or not and stick it accordingly, if
20141 no SessionTicket then stick on SessionID or don't stick as there's no server
20142 side state is there when SessionTickets are in use.
20143
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020144req.ssl_ver : integer
20145req_ssl_ver : integer (deprecated)
20146 Returns an integer value containing the version of the SSL/TLS protocol of a
20147 stream present in the request buffer. Both SSLv2 hello messages and SSLv3
20148 messages are supported. TLSv1 is announced as SSL version 3.1. The value is
20149 composed of the major version multiplied by 65536, added to the minor
20150 version. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
20151 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
20152 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. The ACL version of the test
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020153 matches against a decimal notation in the form MAJOR.MINOR (e.g. 3.1). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020154 fetch is mostly used in ACL.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010020155
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020156 ACL derivatives :
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010020157 req.ssl_ver : decimal match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010020158
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020020159res.len : integer
20160 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
20161 response buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
20162 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
20163 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
20164 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020165 that data to come in and return false only when HAProxy is certain that no
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020020166 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP response
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020020167 content inspection. But it may also be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020020168
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020169res.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
20170 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020020171 in the response buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020020172 the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020020173 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020020174 any location. It may also be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010020175
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020176res.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
20177 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
20178 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
20179 the response buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020020180 if prepended with a '+' or '-' sign. It may also be used in tcp-check based
20181 expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010020182
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020183 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010020184
Willy Tarreau971f7b62015-09-29 14:06:59 +020020185res.ssl_hello_type : integer
20186rep_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
20187 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
20188 in the response buffer if the buffer contains data that parses as a complete
20189 SSL (v3 or superior) hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
20190 contents found in the response buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
20191 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "server" lines having the "ssl"
20192 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
20193 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
20194
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020195wait_end : boolean
20196 This fetch either returns true when the inspection period is over, or does
20197 not fetch. It is only used in ACLs, in conjunction with content analysis to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020198 avoid returning a wrong verdict early. It may also be used to delay some
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020199 actions, such as a delayed reject for some special addresses. Since it either
20200 stops the rules evaluation or immediately returns true, it is recommended to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020201 use this acl as the last one in a rule. Please note that the default ACL
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020202 "WAIT_END" is always usable without prior declaration. This test was designed
20203 to be used with TCP request content inspection.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010020204
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020205 Examples :
20206 # delay every incoming request by 2 seconds
20207 tcp-request inspect-delay 2s
20208 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010020209
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020210 # don't immediately tell bad guys they are rejected
20211 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
20212 acl goodguys src 10.0.0.0/24
20213 acl badguys src 10.0.1.0/24
20214 tcp-request content accept if goodguys
20215 tcp-request content reject if badguys WAIT_END
20216 tcp-request content reject
20217
20218
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200202197.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020220--------------------------------------
20221
20222It is possible to fetch samples from HTTP contents, requests and responses.
20223This application layer is also called layer 7. It is only possible to fetch the
20224data in this section when a full HTTP request or response has been parsed from
20225its respective request or response buffer. This is always the case with all
20226HTTP specific rules and for sections running with "mode http". When using TCP
20227content inspection, it may be necessary to support an inspection delay in order
20228to let the request or response come in first. These fetches may require a bit
20229more CPU resources than the layer 4 ones, but not much since the request and
20230response are indexed.
20231
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +010020232Note : Regarding HTTP processing from the tcp-request content rules, everything
20233 will work as expected from an HTTP proxy. However, from a TCP proxy,
20234 without an HTTP upgrade, it will only work for HTTP/1 content. For
20235 HTTP/2 content, only the preface is visible. Thus, it is only possible
20236 to rely to "req.proto_http", "req.ver" and eventually "method" sample
20237 fetches. All other L7 sample fetches will fail. After an HTTP upgrade,
20238 they will work in the same manner than from an HTTP proxy.
20239
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020240base : string
20241 This returns the concatenation of the first Host header and the path part of
20242 the request, which starts at the first slash and ends before the question
20243 mark. It can be useful in virtual hosted environments to detect URL abuses as
20244 well as to improve shared caches efficiency. Using this with a limited size
20245 stick table also allows one to collect statistics about most commonly
20246 requested objects by host/path. With ACLs it can allow simple content
20247 switching rules involving the host and the path at the same time, such as
20248 "www.example.com/favicon.ico". See also "path" and "uri".
20249
20250 ACL derivatives :
20251 base : exact string match
20252 base_beg : prefix match
20253 base_dir : subdir match
20254 base_dom : domain match
20255 base_end : suffix match
20256 base_len : length match
20257 base_reg : regex match
20258 base_sub : substring match
20259
20260base32 : integer
20261 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value returned by the "base" fetch method
20262 above. This is useful to track per-URL activity on high traffic sites without
20263 having to store all URLs. Instead a shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020020264 memory. The output type is an unsigned integer. The hash function used is
20265 SDBM with full avalanche on the output. Technically, base32 is exactly equal
20266 to "base,sdbm(1)".
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020267
20268base32+src : binary
20269 This returns the concatenation of the base32 fetch above and the src fetch
20270 below. The resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes
20271 depending on the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP,
20272 per-URL counters.
20273
Yves Lafonb4d37082021-02-11 11:01:28 +010020274baseq : string
20275 This returns the concatenation of the first Host header and the path part of
20276 the request with the query-string, which starts at the first slash. Using this
20277 instead of "base" allows one to properly identify the target resource, for
20278 statistics or caching use cases. See also "path", "pathq" and "base".
20279
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010020280capture.req.hdr(<idx>) : string
20281 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture request
20282 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
20283 The first entry is an index of 0. See also: "capture request header".
20284
20285capture.req.method : string
20286 This extracts the METHOD of an HTTP request. It can be used in both request
20287 and response. Unlike "method", it can be used in both request and response
20288 because it's allocated.
20289
20290capture.req.uri : string
20291 This extracts the request's URI, which starts at the first slash and ends
20292 before the first space in the request (without the host part). Unlike "path"
20293 and "url", it can be used in both request and response because it's
20294 allocated.
20295
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020020296capture.req.ver : string
20297 This extracts the request's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
20298 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "req.ver", it can be used in both request, response, and
20299 logs because it relies on a persistent flag.
20300
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010020301capture.res.hdr(<idx>) : string
20302 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture response
20303 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
20304 The first entry is an index of 0.
20305 See also: "capture response header"
20306
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020020307capture.res.ver : string
20308 This extracts the response's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
20309 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "res.ver", it can be used in logs because it relies on a
20310 persistent flag.
20311
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020020312req.body : binary
Christopher Fauletaf4dc4c2020-05-05 17:33:25 +020020313 This returns the HTTP request's available body as a block of data. It is
20314 recommended to use "option http-buffer-request" to be sure to wait, as much
20315 as possible, for the request's body.
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020020316
Thierry FOURNIER9826c772015-05-20 15:50:54 +020020317req.body_param([<name>) : string
20318 This fetch assumes that the body of the POST request is url-encoded. The user
20319 can check if the "content-type" contains the value
20320 "application/x-www-form-urlencoded". This extracts the first occurrence of the
20321 parameter <name> in the body, which ends before '&'. The parameter name is
20322 case-sensitive. If no name is given, any parameter will match, and the first
20323 one will be returned. The result is a string corresponding to the value of the
20324 parameter <name> as presented in the request body (no URL decoding is
20325 performed). Note that the ACL version of this fetch iterates over multiple
20326 parameters and will iteratively report all parameters values if no name is
20327 given.
20328
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020020329req.body_len : integer
20330 This returns the length of the HTTP request's available body in bytes. It may
20331 be lower than the advertised length if the body is larger than the buffer. It
Christopher Fauletaf4dc4c2020-05-05 17:33:25 +020020332 is recommended to use "option http-buffer-request" to be sure to wait, as
20333 much as possible, for the request's body.
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020020334
20335req.body_size : integer
20336 This returns the advertised length of the HTTP request's body in bytes. It
Christopher Fauletaf4dc4c2020-05-05 17:33:25 +020020337 will represent the advertised Content-Length header, or the size of the
20338 available data in case of chunked encoding.
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020020339
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020340req.cook([<name>]) : string
20341cook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
20342 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
20343 header line from the request, and returns its value as string. If no name is
20344 specified, the first cookie value is returned. When used with ACLs, all
20345 matching cookies are evaluated. Spaces around the name and the value are
20346 ignored as requested by the Cookie header specification (RFC6265). The cookie
20347 name is case-sensitive. Empty cookies are valid, so an empty cookie may very
20348 well return an empty value if it is present. Use the "found" match to detect
20349 presence. Use the res.cook() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
20350
20351 ACL derivatives :
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010020352 req.cook([<name>]) : exact string match
20353 req.cook_beg([<name>]) : prefix match
20354 req.cook_dir([<name>]) : subdir match
20355 req.cook_dom([<name>]) : domain match
20356 req.cook_end([<name>]) : suffix match
20357 req.cook_len([<name>]) : length match
20358 req.cook_reg([<name>]) : regex match
20359 req.cook_sub([<name>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010020360
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020361req.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
20362cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
20363 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
20364 <name> in the request, or all cookies if <name> is not specified.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010020365
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020366req.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
20367cook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
20368 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
20369 header line from the request, and converts its value to an integer which is
20370 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned. When
20371 used in ACLs, all matching names are iterated over until a value matches.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020020372
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020373cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
20374 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
20375 header line from the request, or a "Set-Cookie" header from the response, and
20376 returns its value as a string. A typical use is to get multiple clients
20377 sharing a same profile use the same server. This can be similar to what
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020020378 "appsession" did with the "request-learn" statement, but with support for
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020379 multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts. If no name is
20380 specified, the first cookie value is returned. This fetch should not be used
20381 anymore and should be replaced by req.cook() or res.cook() instead as it
20382 ambiguously uses the direction based on the context where it is used.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010020383
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020384hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
20385 This is equivalent to req.hdr() when used on requests, and to res.hdr() when
20386 used on responses. Please refer to these respective fetches for more details.
20387 In case of doubt about the fetch direction, please use the explicit ones.
20388 Note that contrary to the hdr() sample fetch method, the hdr_* ACL keywords
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030020389 unambiguously apply to the request headers.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010020390
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020391req.fhdr(<name>[,<occ>]) : string
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010020392 This returns the full value of the last occurrence of header <name> in an
20393 HTTP request. It differs from req.hdr() in that any commas present in the
20394 value are returned and are not used as delimiters. This is sometimes useful
20395 with headers such as User-Agent.
20396
20397 When used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is
20398 found.
20399
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020400 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
20401 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
20402 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010020403 with -1 being the last one.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010020404
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020405req.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
20406 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
20407 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010020408 not specified. Like req.fhdr() it differs from res.hdr_cnt() by not splitting
20409 headers at commas.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010020410
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020411req.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010020412 This returns the last comma-separated value of the header <name> in an HTTP
20413 request. The fetch considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct values.
20414 This is useful if you need to process headers that are defined to be a list
20415 of values, such as Accept, or X-Forwarded-For. If full-line headers are
20416 desired instead, use req.fhdr(). Please carefully check RFC 7231 to know how
20417 certain headers are supposed to be parsed. Also, some of them are case
20418 insensitive (e.g. Connection).
20419
20420 When used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is
20421 found.
20422
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020423 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
20424 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
20425 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010020426 with -1 being the last one.
20427
20428 A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header once converted to IP,
20429 associated with an IP stick-table.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010020430
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020431 ACL derivatives :
20432 hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
20433 hdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
20434 hdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
20435 hdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
20436 hdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
20437 hdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
20438 hdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
20439 hdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
20440
20441req.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
20442hdr_cnt([<header>]) : integer (deprecated)
20443 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
20444 header field name <name>, or the total number of header field values if
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010020445 <name> is not specified. Like req.hdr() it counts each comma separated
20446 part of the header's value. If counting of full-line headers is desired,
20447 then req.fhdr_cnt() should be used instead.
20448
20449 With ACLs, it can be used to detect presence, absence or abuse of a specific
20450 header, as well as to block request smuggling attacks by rejecting requests
20451 which contain more than one of certain headers.
20452
20453 Refer to req.hdr() for more information on header matching.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020454
20455req.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
20456hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
20457 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request,
20458 converts it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. When used
20459 with ACLs, all occurrences are checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value
Willy Tarreau7b0e00d2021-03-25 14:12:29 +010020460 of every header is checked. The parser strictly adheres to the format
20461 described in RFC7239, with the extension that IPv4 addresses may optionally
20462 be followed by a colon (':') and a valid decimal port number (0 to 65535),
20463 which will be silently dropped. All other forms will not match and will
20464 cause the address to be ignored.
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010020465
20466 The <occ> parameter is processed as with req.hdr().
20467
20468 A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For and X-Client-IP headers.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020469
20470req.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
20471hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
20472 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request, and
20473 converts it to an integer value. When used with ACLs, all occurrences are
20474 checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value of every header is checked.
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010020475
20476 The <occ> parameter is processed as with req.hdr().
20477
20478 A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020479
Christopher Faulet687a68e2020-11-24 17:13:24 +010020480req.hdrs : string
20481 Returns the current request headers as string including the last empty line
20482 separating headers from the request body. The last empty line can be used to
20483 detect a truncated header block. This sample fetch is useful for some SPOE
20484 headers analyzers and for advanced logging.
20485
20486req.hdrs_bin : binary
20487 Returns the current request headers contained in preparsed binary form. This
20488 is useful for offloading some processing with SPOE. Each string is described
20489 by a length followed by the number of bytes indicated in the length. The
20490 length is represented using the variable integer encoding detailed in the
20491 SPOE documentation. The end of the list is marked by a couple of empty header
20492 names and values (length of 0 for both).
20493
20494 *(<str:header-name><str:header-value>)<empty string><empty string>
Frédéric Lécailleec891192019-02-26 15:02:35 +010020495
Christopher Faulet687a68e2020-11-24 17:13:24 +010020496 int: refer to the SPOE documentation for the encoding
20497 str: <int:length><bytes>
Frédéric Lécailleec891192019-02-26 15:02:35 +010020498
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020499http_auth(<userlist>) : boolean
20500 Returns a boolean indicating whether the authentication data received from
20501 the client match a username & password stored in the specified userlist. This
20502 fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
20503 basic auth is supported.
20504
Remi Tricot-Le Bretonf5dd3372021-10-01 15:36:53 +020020505http_auth_bearer([<header>]) : string
20506 Returns the client-provided token found in the authorization data when the
20507 Bearer scheme is used (to send JSON Web Tokens for instance). No check is
20508 performed on the data sent by the client.
20509 If a specific <header> is supplied, it will parse this header instead of the
20510 Authorization one.
20511
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010020512http_auth_group(<userlist>) : string
20513 Returns a string corresponding to the user name found in the authentication
20514 data received from the client if both the user name and password are valid
20515 according to the specified userlist. The main purpose is to use it in ACLs
20516 where it is then checked whether the user belongs to any group within a list.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020517 This fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
20518 basic auth is supported.
20519
20520 ACL derivatives :
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010020521 http_auth_group(<userlist>) : group ...
20522 Returns true when the user extracted from the request and whose password is
20523 valid according to the specified userlist belongs to at least one of the
20524 groups.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020525
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020020526http_auth_pass : string
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010020527 Returns the user's password found in the authentication data received from
20528 the client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are
20529 performed by this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020020530
20531http_auth_type : string
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010020532 Returns the authentication method found in the authentication data received from
20533 the client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are
20534 performed by this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020020535
20536http_auth_user : string
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010020537 Returns the user name found in the authentication data received from the
20538 client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are performed by
20539 this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020020540
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020541http_first_req : boolean
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020020542 Returns true when the request being processed is the first one of the
20543 connection. This can be used to add or remove headers that may be missing
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020544 from some requests when a request is not the first one, or to help grouping
20545 requests in the logs.
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020020546
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020547method : integer + string
20548 Returns an integer value corresponding to the method in the HTTP request. For
20549 example, "GET" equals 1 (check sources to establish the matching). Value 9
20550 means "other method" and may be converted to a string extracted from the
20551 stream. This should not be used directly as a sample, this is only meant to
20552 be used from ACLs, which transparently convert methods from patterns to these
20553 integer + string values. Some predefined ACL already check for most common
20554 methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020020555
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020556 ACL derivatives :
20557 method : case insensitive method match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020020558
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020559 Example :
20560 # only accept GET and HEAD requests
20561 acl valid_method method GET HEAD
20562 http-request deny if ! valid_method
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020020563
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020564path : string
20565 This extracts the request's URL path, which starts at the first slash and
20566 ends before the question mark (without the host part). A typical use is with
20567 prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate multiple
20568 information from databases and keep them in caches. Note that with outgoing
20569 caches, it would be wiser to use "url" instead. With ACLs, it's typically
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020570 used to match exact file names (e.g. "/login.php"), or directory parts using
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020571 the derivative forms. See also the "url" and "base" fetch methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020020572
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020573 ACL derivatives :
20574 path : exact string match
20575 path_beg : prefix match
20576 path_dir : subdir match
20577 path_dom : domain match
20578 path_end : suffix match
20579 path_len : length match
20580 path_reg : regex match
20581 path_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020020582
Christopher Faulete720c322020-09-02 17:25:18 +020020583pathq : string
20584 This extracts the request's URL path with the query-string, which starts at
20585 the first slash. This sample fetch is pretty handy to always retrieve a
20586 relative URI, excluding the scheme and the authority part, if any. Indeed,
20587 while it is the common representation for an HTTP/1.1 request target, in
20588 HTTP/2, an absolute URI is often used. This sample fetch will return the same
20589 result in both cases.
20590
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010020591query : string
20592 This extracts the request's query string, which starts after the first
20593 question mark. If no question mark is present, this fetch returns nothing. If
20594 a question mark is present but nothing follows, it returns an empty string.
20595 This means it's possible to easily know whether a query string is present
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010020596 using the "found" matching method. This fetch is the complement of "path"
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010020597 which stops before the question mark.
20598
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010020599req.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
20600 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
20601 appear in the request when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
20602 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
20603 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
20604
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020605req.ver : string
20606req_ver : string (deprecated)
20607 Returns the version string from the HTTP request, for example "1.1". This can
20608 be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL. Some predefined ACL already
20609 check for versions 1.0 and 1.1.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010020610
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020611 ACL derivatives :
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010020612 req.ver : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020020613
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020020614res.body : binary
20615 This returns the HTTP response's available body as a block of data. Unlike
20616 the request side, there is no directive to wait for the response's body. This
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010020617 sample fetch is really useful (and usable) in the health-check context.
20618
20619 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020020620
20621res.body_len : integer
20622 This returns the length of the HTTP response available body in bytes. Unlike
20623 the request side, there is no directive to wait for the response's body. This
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010020624 sample fetch is really useful (and usable) in the health-check context.
20625
20626 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020020627
20628res.body_size : integer
20629 This returns the advertised length of the HTTP response body in bytes. It
20630 will represent the advertised Content-Length header, or the size of the
20631 available data in case of chunked encoding. Unlike the request side, there is
20632 no directive to wait for the response body. This sample fetch is really
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010020633 useful (and usable) in the health-check context.
20634
20635 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020020636
Remi Tricot-Le Bretonbf971212020-10-27 11:55:57 +010020637res.cache_hit : boolean
20638 Returns the boolean "true" value if the response has been built out of an
20639 HTTP cache entry, otherwise returns boolean "false".
20640
20641res.cache_name : string
20642 Returns a string containing the name of the HTTP cache that was used to
20643 build the HTTP response if res.cache_hit is true, otherwise returns an
20644 empty string.
20645
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020646res.comp : boolean
20647 Returns the boolean "true" value if the response has been compressed by
20648 HAProxy, otherwise returns boolean "false". This may be used to add
20649 information in the logs.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020020650
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020651res.comp_algo : string
20652 Returns a string containing the name of the algorithm used if the response
20653 was compressed by HAProxy, for example : "deflate". This may be used to add
20654 some information in the logs.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010020655
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020656res.cook([<name>]) : string
20657scook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
20658 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
20659 header line from the response, and returns its value as string. If no name is
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010020660 specified, the first cookie value is returned.
20661
20662 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020020663
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020664 ACL derivatives :
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010020665 res.scook([<name>] : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020020666
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020667res.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
20668scook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
20669 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
20670 <name> in the response, or all cookies if <name> is not specified. This is
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010020671 mostly useful when combined with ACLs to detect suspicious responses.
20672
20673 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010020674
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020675res.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
20676scook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
20677 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
20678 header line from the response, and converts its value to an integer which is
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010020679 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned.
20680
20681 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010020682
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020683res.fhdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010020684 This fetch works like the req.fhdr() fetch with the difference that it acts
20685 on the headers within an HTTP response.
20686
20687 Like req.fhdr() the res.fhdr() fetch returns full values. If the header is
20688 defined to be a list you should use res.hdr().
20689
20690 This fetch is sometimes useful with headers such as Date or Expires.
20691
20692 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020020693
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020694res.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010020695 This fetch works like the req.fhdr_cnt() fetch with the difference that it
20696 acts on the headers within an HTTP response.
20697
20698 Like req.fhdr_cnt() the res.fhdr_cnt() fetch acts on full values. If the
20699 header is defined to be a list you should use res.hdr_cnt().
20700
20701 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020020702
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020703res.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
20704shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string (deprecated)
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010020705 This fetch works like the req.hdr() fetch with the difference that it acts
20706 on the headers within an HTTP response.
20707
Ilya Shipitsinacf84592021-02-06 22:29:08 +050020708 Like req.hdr() the res.hdr() fetch considers the comma to be a delimiter. If
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010020709 this is not desired res.fhdr() should be used.
20710
20711 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020020712
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020713 ACL derivatives :
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010020714 res.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
20715 res.hdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
20716 res.hdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
20717 res.hdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
20718 res.hdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
20719 res.hdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
20720 res.hdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
20721 res.hdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020722
20723res.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
20724shdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010020725 This fetch works like the req.hdr_cnt() fetch with the difference that it
20726 acts on the headers within an HTTP response.
20727
20728 Like req.hdr_cnt() the res.hdr_cnt() fetch considers the comma to be a
Ilya Shipitsinacf84592021-02-06 22:29:08 +050020729 delimiter. If this is not desired res.fhdr_cnt() should be used.
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010020730
20731 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020020732
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020733res.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
20734shdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010020735 This fetch works like the req.hdr_ip() fetch with the difference that it
20736 acts on the headers within an HTTP response.
20737
20738 This can be useful to learn some data into a stick table.
20739
20740 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020020741
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010020742res.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
20743 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
20744 appear in the response when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
20745 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010020746 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
20747
20748 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010020749
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020750res.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
20751shdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010020752 This fetch works like the req.hdr_val() fetch with the difference that it
20753 acts on the headers within an HTTP response.
20754
20755 This can be useful to learn some data into a stick table.
20756
20757 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020020758
20759res.hdrs : string
20760 Returns the current response headers as string including the last empty line
20761 separating headers from the request body. The last empty line can be used to
20762 detect a truncated header block. This sample fetch is useful for some SPOE
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010020763 headers analyzers and for advanced logging.
20764
20765 It may also be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020020766
20767res.hdrs_bin : binary
20768 Returns the current response headers contained in preparsed binary form. This
20769 is useful for offloading some processing with SPOE. It may be used in
20770 tcp-check based expect rules. Each string is described by a length followed
20771 by the number of bytes indicated in the length. The length is represented
20772 using the variable integer encoding detailed in the SPOE documentation. The
20773 end of the list is marked by a couple of empty header names and values
20774 (length of 0 for both).
20775
20776 *(<str:header-name><str:header-value>)<empty string><empty string>
20777
20778 int: refer to the SPOE documentation for the encoding
20779 str: <int:length><bytes>
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010020780
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020781res.ver : string
20782resp_ver : string (deprecated)
20783 Returns the version string from the HTTP response, for example "1.1". This
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010020784 can be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL.
20785
20786 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020020787
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020788 ACL derivatives :
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010020789 resp.ver : exact string match
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010020790
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020791set-cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
20792 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
20793 header line from the response and uses the corresponding value to match. This
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020020794 can be comparable to what "appsession" did with default options, but with
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020795 support for multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010020796
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020797 This fetch function is deprecated and has been superseded by the "res.cook"
20798 fetch. This keyword will disappear soon.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010020799
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020800status : integer
20801 Returns an integer containing the HTTP status code in the HTTP response, for
20802 example, 302. It is mostly used within ACLs and integer ranges, for example,
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010020803 to remove any Location header if the response is not a 3xx.
20804
20805 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020020806
Thierry Fournier0e00dca2016-04-07 15:47:40 +020020807unique-id : string
20808 Returns the unique-id attached to the request. The directive
20809 "unique-id-format" must be set. If it is not set, the unique-id sample fetch
20810 fails. Note that the unique-id is usually used with HTTP requests, however this
20811 sample fetch can be used with other protocols. Obviously, if it is used with
20812 other protocols than HTTP, the unique-id-format directive must not contain
20813 HTTP parts. See: unique-id-format and unique-id-header
20814
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020815url : string
20816 This extracts the request's URL as presented in the request. A typical use is
20817 with prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate
20818 multiple information from databases and keep them in caches. With ACLs, using
20819 "path" is preferred over using "url", because clients may send a full URL as
20820 is normally done with proxies. The only real use is to match "*" which does
20821 not match in "path", and for which there is already a predefined ACL. See
20822 also "path" and "base".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020020823
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020824 ACL derivatives :
20825 url : exact string match
20826 url_beg : prefix match
20827 url_dir : subdir match
20828 url_dom : domain match
20829 url_end : suffix match
20830 url_len : length match
20831 url_reg : regex match
20832 url_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020020833
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020834url_ip : ip
20835 This extracts the IP address from the request's URL when the host part is
20836 presented as an IP address. Its use is very limited. For instance, a
20837 monitoring system might use this field as an alternative for the source IP in
20838 order to test what path a given source address would follow, or to force an
Willy Tarreau25241232021-07-18 19:18:56 +020020839 entry in a table for a given source address. It may be used in combination
20840 with 'http-request set-dst' to emulate the older 'option http_proxy'.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020020841
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020842url_port : integer
20843 This extracts the port part from the request's URL. Note that if the port is
Willy Tarreau25241232021-07-18 19:18:56 +020020844 not specified in the request, port 80 is assumed..
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020020845
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020020846urlp([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
20847url_param([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020848 This extracts the first occurrence of the parameter <name> in the query
20849 string, which begins after either '?' or <delim>, and which ends before '&',
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020020850 ';' or <delim>. The parameter name is case-sensitive. If no name is given,
20851 any parameter will match, and the first one will be returned. The result is
20852 a string corresponding to the value of the parameter <name> as presented in
20853 the request (no URL decoding is performed). This can be used for session
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020854 stickiness based on a client ID, to extract an application cookie passed as a
20855 URL parameter, or in ACLs to apply some checks. Note that the ACL version of
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020020856 this fetch iterates over multiple parameters and will iteratively report all
20857 parameters values if no name is given
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020020858
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020859 ACL derivatives :
20860 urlp(<name>[,<delim>]) : exact string match
20861 urlp_beg(<name>[,<delim>]) : prefix match
20862 urlp_dir(<name>[,<delim>]) : subdir match
20863 urlp_dom(<name>[,<delim>]) : domain match
20864 urlp_end(<name>[,<delim>]) : suffix match
20865 urlp_len(<name>[,<delim>]) : length match
20866 urlp_reg(<name>[,<delim>]) : regex match
20867 urlp_sub(<name>[,<delim>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020020868
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020020869
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020870 Example :
20871 # match http://example.com/foo?PHPSESSIONID=some_id
20872 stick on urlp(PHPSESSIONID)
20873 # match http://example.com/foo;JSESSIONID=some_id
20874 stick on urlp(JSESSIONID,;)
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020020875
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030020876urlp_val([<name>[,<delim>]]) : integer
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020877 See "urlp" above. This one extracts the URL parameter <name> in the request
20878 and converts it to an integer value. This can be used for session stickiness
20879 based on a user ID for example, or with ACLs to match a page number or price.
Willy Tarreaua9fddca2012-07-31 07:51:48 +020020880
Dragan Dosen0070cd52016-06-16 12:19:49 +020020881url32 : integer
20882 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value obtained by concatenating the first
20883 Host header and the whole URL including parameters (not only the path part of
20884 the request, as in the "base32" fetch above). This is useful to track per-URL
20885 activity. A shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of memory. The output type
20886 is an unsigned integer.
20887
20888url32+src : binary
20889 This returns the concatenation of the "url32" fetch and the "src" fetch. The
20890 resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes depending on
20891 the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP, per-URL counters.
20892
Christopher Faulet16032ab2020-04-30 11:30:00 +020020893
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +0200208947.3.7. Fetching samples for developers
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010020895---------------------------------------
20896
20897This set of sample fetch methods is reserved to developers and must never be
20898used on a production environment, except on developer demand, for debugging
20899purposes. Moreover, no special care will be taken on backwards compatibility.
20900There is no warranty the following sample fetches will never change, be renamed
20901or simply removed. So be really careful if you should use one of them. To avoid
20902any ambiguity, these sample fetches are placed in the dedicated scope "internal",
20903for instance "internal.strm.is_htx".
20904
20905internal.htx.data : integer
20906 Returns the size in bytes used by data in the HTX message associated to a
20907 channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
20908
20909internal.htx.free : integer
20910 Returns the free space (size - used) in bytes in the HTX message associated
20911 to a channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
20912
20913internal.htx.free_data : integer
20914 Returns the free space for the data in bytes in the HTX message associated to
20915 a channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
20916
20917internal.htx.has_eom : boolean
Christopher Fauletd1ac2b92020-12-02 19:12:22 +010020918 Returns true if the HTX message associated to a channel contains the
20919 end-of-message flag (EOM). Otherwise, it returns false. The channel is chosen
20920 depending on the sample direction.
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010020921
20922internal.htx.nbblks : integer
20923 Returns the number of blocks present in the HTX message associated to a
20924 channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
20925
20926internal.htx.size : integer
20927 Returns the total size in bytes of the HTX message associated to a
20928 channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
20929
20930internal.htx.used : integer
20931 Returns the total size used in bytes (data + metadata) in the HTX message
20932 associated to a channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
20933 direction.
20934
20935internal.htx_blk.size(<idx>) : integer
20936 Returns the size of the block at the position <idx> in the HTX message
20937 associated to a channel or 0 if it does not exist. The channel is chosen
20938 depending on the sample direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one
20939 of the special value :
20940 * head : The oldest inserted block
20941 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050020942 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010020943
20944internal.htx_blk.type(<idx>) : string
20945 Returns the type of the block at the position <idx> in the HTX message
20946 associated to a channel or "HTX_BLK_UNUSED" if it does not exist. The channel
20947 is chosen depending on the sample direction. <idx> may be any positive
20948 integer or one of the special value :
20949 * head : The oldest inserted block
20950 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050020951 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010020952
20953internal.htx_blk.data(<idx>) : binary
20954 Returns the value of the DATA block at the position <idx> in the HTX message
20955 associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist or if it is
20956 not a DATA block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
20957 <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
20958
20959 * head : The oldest inserted block
20960 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050020961 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010020962
20963internal.htx_blk.hdrname(<idx>) : string
20964 Returns the header name of the HEADER block at the position <idx> in the HTX
20965 message associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist or if
20966 it is not an HEADER block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
20967 direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
20968
20969 * head : The oldest inserted block
20970 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050020971 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010020972
20973internal.htx_blk.hdrval(<idx>) : string
20974 Returns the header value of the HEADER block at the position <idx> in the HTX
20975 message associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist or if
20976 it is not an HEADER block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
20977 direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
20978
20979 * head : The oldest inserted block
20980 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050020981 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010020982
20983internal.htx_blk.start_line(<idx>) : string
20984 Returns the value of the REQ_SL or RES_SL block at the position <idx> in the
20985 HTX message associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist
20986 or if it is not a SL block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
20987 direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
20988
20989 * head : The oldest inserted block
20990 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050020991 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010020992
20993internal.strm.is_htx : boolean
20994 Returns true if the current stream is an HTX stream. It means the data in the
20995 channels buffers are stored using the internal HTX representation. Otherwise,
20996 it returns false.
20997
20998
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200209997.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020021000---------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010021001
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020021002Some predefined ACLs are hard-coded so that they do not have to be declared in
21003every frontend which needs them. They all have their names in upper case in
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020021004order to avoid confusion. Their equivalence is provided below.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010021005
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020021006ACL name Equivalent to Usage
Christopher Faulet779184e2021-04-01 17:24:04 +020021007---------------+----------------------------------+------------------------------------------------------
21008FALSE always_false never match
21009HTTP req.proto_http match if request protocol is valid HTTP
21010HTTP_1.0 req.ver 1.0 match if HTTP request version is 1.0
21011HTTP_1.1 req.ver 1.1 match if HTTP request version is 1.1
Christopher Faulet8043e832021-03-26 16:00:54 +010021012HTTP_2.0 req.ver 2.0 match if HTTP request version is 2.0
Christopher Faulet779184e2021-04-01 17:24:04 +020021013HTTP_CONTENT req.hdr_val(content-length) gt 0 match an existing content-length in the HTTP request
21014HTTP_URL_ABS url_reg ^[^/:]*:// match absolute URL with scheme
21015HTTP_URL_SLASH url_beg / match URL beginning with "/"
21016HTTP_URL_STAR url * match URL equal to "*"
Björn Jacke20d0f502021-10-15 16:32:15 +020021017LOCALHOST src 127.0.0.1/8 ::1 match connection from local host
Christopher Faulet779184e2021-04-01 17:24:04 +020021018METH_CONNECT method CONNECT match HTTP CONNECT method
21019METH_DELETE method DELETE match HTTP DELETE method
21020METH_GET method GET HEAD match HTTP GET or HEAD method
21021METH_HEAD method HEAD match HTTP HEAD method
21022METH_OPTIONS method OPTIONS match HTTP OPTIONS method
21023METH_POST method POST match HTTP POST method
21024METH_PUT method PUT match HTTP PUT method
21025METH_TRACE method TRACE match HTTP TRACE method
21026RDP_COOKIE req.rdp_cookie_cnt gt 0 match presence of an RDP cookie in the request buffer
21027REQ_CONTENT req.len gt 0 match data in the request buffer
21028TRUE always_true always match
21029WAIT_END wait_end wait for end of content analysis
21030---------------+----------------------------------+------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010021031
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010021032
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200210338. Logging
21034----------
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010021035
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021036One of HAProxy's strong points certainly lies is its precise logs. It probably
21037provides the finest level of information available for such a product, which is
21038very important for troubleshooting complex environments. Standard information
21039provided in logs include client ports, TCP/HTTP state timers, precise session
21040state at termination and precise termination cause, information about decisions
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010021041to direct traffic to a server, and of course the ability to capture arbitrary
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021042headers.
21043
21044In order to improve administrators reactivity, it offers a great transparency
21045about encountered problems, both internal and external, and it is possible to
21046send logs to different sources at the same time with different level filters :
21047
21048 - global process-level logs (system errors, start/stop, etc..)
21049 - per-instance system and internal errors (lack of resource, bugs, ...)
21050 - per-instance external troubles (servers up/down, max connections)
21051 - per-instance activity (client connections), either at the establishment or
21052 at the termination.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021053 - per-request control of log-level, e.g.
Jim Freeman9e8714b2015-05-26 09:16:34 -060021054 http-request set-log-level silent if sensitive_request
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021055
21056The ability to distribute different levels of logs to different log servers
21057allow several production teams to interact and to fix their problems as soon
21058as possible. For example, the system team might monitor system-wide errors,
21059while the application team might be monitoring the up/down for their servers in
21060real time, and the security team might analyze the activity logs with one hour
21061delay.
21062
21063
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200210648.1. Log levels
21065---------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021066
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090021067TCP and HTTP connections can be logged with information such as the date, time,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021068source IP address, destination address, connection duration, response times,
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090021069HTTP request, HTTP return code, number of bytes transmitted, conditions
21070in which the session ended, and even exchanged cookies values. For example
21071track a particular user's problems. All messages may be sent to up to two
21072syslog servers. Check the "log" keyword in section 4.2 for more information
21073about log facilities.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021074
21075
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200210768.2. Log formats
21077----------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021078
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010021079HAProxy supports 5 log formats. Several fields are common between these formats
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090021080and will be detailed in the following sections. A few of them may vary
21081slightly with the configuration, due to indicators specific to certain
21082options. The supported formats are as follows :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021083
21084 - the default format, which is very basic and very rarely used. It only
21085 provides very basic information about the incoming connection at the moment
21086 it is accepted : source IP:port, destination IP:port, and frontend-name.
21087 This mode will eventually disappear so it will not be described to great
21088 extents.
21089
21090 - the TCP format, which is more advanced. This format is enabled when "option
21091 tcplog" is set on the frontend. HAProxy will then usually wait for the
21092 connection to terminate before logging. This format provides much richer
21093 information, such as timers, connection counts, queue size, etc... This
21094 format is recommended for pure TCP proxies.
21095
21096 - the HTTP format, which is the most advanced for HTTP proxying. This format
21097 is enabled when "option httplog" is set on the frontend. It provides the
21098 same information as the TCP format with some HTTP-specific fields such as
21099 the request, the status code, and captures of headers and cookies. This
21100 format is recommended for HTTP proxies.
21101
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +020021102 - the CLF HTTP format, which is equivalent to the HTTP format, but with the
21103 fields arranged in the same order as the CLF format. In this mode, all
21104 timers, captures, flags, etc... appear one per field after the end of the
21105 common fields, in the same order they appear in the standard HTTP format.
21106
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010021107 - the custom log format, allows you to make your own log line.
21108
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021109Next sections will go deeper into details for each of these formats. Format
21110specification will be performed on a "field" basis. Unless stated otherwise, a
21111field is a portion of text delimited by any number of spaces. Since syslog
21112servers are susceptible of inserting fields at the beginning of a line, it is
21113always assumed that the first field is the one containing the process name and
21114identifier.
21115
21116Note : Since log lines may be quite long, the log examples in sections below
21117 might be broken into multiple lines. The example log lines will be
21118 prefixed with 3 closing angle brackets ('>>>') and each time a log is
21119 broken into multiple lines, each non-final line will end with a
21120 backslash ('\') and the next line will start indented by two characters.
21121
21122
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200211238.2.1. Default log format
21124-------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021125
21126This format is used when no specific option is set. The log is emitted as soon
21127as the connection is accepted. One should note that this currently is the only
21128format which logs the request's destination IP and ports.
21129
21130 Example :
21131 listen www
21132 mode http
21133 log global
21134 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
21135
21136 >>> Feb 6 12:12:09 localhost \
21137 haproxy[14385]: Connect from 10.0.1.2:33312 to 10.0.3.31:8012 \
21138 (www/HTTP)
21139
21140 Field Format Extract from the example above
21141 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14385]:
21142 2 'Connect from' Connect from
21143 3 source_ip ':' source_port 10.0.1.2:33312
21144 4 'to' to
21145 5 destination_ip ':' destination_port 10.0.3.31:8012
21146 6 '(' frontend_name '/' mode ')' (www/HTTP)
21147
21148Detailed fields description :
21149 - "source_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the connection.
21150 - "source_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
21151 - "destination_ip" is the IP address the client connected to.
21152 - "destination_port" is the TCP port the client connected to.
21153 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
21154 and processed the connection.
21155 - "mode is the mode the frontend is operating (TCP or HTTP).
21156
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010021157In case of a UNIX socket, the source and destination addresses are marked as
21158"unix:" and the ports reflect the internal ID of the socket which accepted the
21159connection (the same ID as reported in the stats).
21160
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021161It is advised not to use this deprecated format for newer installations as it
21162will eventually disappear.
21163
21164
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200211658.2.2. TCP log format
21166---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021167
21168The TCP format is used when "option tcplog" is specified in the frontend, and
21169is the recommended format for pure TCP proxies. It provides a lot of precious
21170information for troubleshooting. Since this format includes timers and byte
21171counts, the log is normally emitted at the end of the session. It can be
21172emitted earlier if "option logasap" is specified, which makes sense in most
21173environments with long sessions such as remote terminals. Sessions which match
21174the "monitor" rules are never logged. It is also possible not to emit logs for
21175sessions for which no data were exchanged between the client and the server, by
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020021176specifying "option dontlognull" in the frontend. Successful connections will
Willy Tarreau2ed73502021-11-05 18:09:06 +010021177not be logged if "option dontlog-normal" is specified in the frontend.
21178
21179The TCP log format is internally declared as a custom log format based on the
21180exact following string, which may also be used as a basis to extend the format
Willy Tarreauec5c1102021-11-06 09:18:33 +010021181if required. Refer to section 8.2.6 "Custom log format" to see how to use this:
Willy Tarreau2ed73502021-11-05 18:09:06 +010021182
21183 # strict equivalent of "option tcplog"
21184 log-format "%ci:%cp [%t] %ft %b/%s %Tw/%Tc/%Tt %B %ts \
21185 %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq"
21186
21187A few fields may slightly vary depending on some configuration options, those
21188are marked with a star ('*') after the field name below.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021189
21190 Example :
21191 frontend fnt
21192 mode tcp
21193 option tcplog
21194 log global
21195 default_backend bck
21196
21197 backend bck
21198 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
21199
21200 >>> Feb 6 12:12:56 localhost \
21201 haproxy[14387]: 10.0.1.2:33313 [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443] fnt \
21202 bck/srv1 0/0/5007 212 -- 0/0/0/0/3 0/0
21203
21204 Field Format Extract from the example above
21205 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14387]:
21206 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33313
21207 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443]
21208 4 frontend_name fnt
21209 5 backend_name '/' server_name bck/srv1
21210 6 Tw '/' Tc '/' Tt* 0/0/5007
21211 7 bytes_read* 212
21212 8 termination_state --
21213 9 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 0/0/0/0/3
21214 10 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
21215
21216Detailed fields description :
21217 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021218 connection to HAProxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010021219 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
21220 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010021221 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021222 and the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol is correctly used, then the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010021223 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021224
21225 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010021226 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
21227 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
21228 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021229
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021230 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the connection was received by HAProxy
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021231 (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on the
21232 network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is usually
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020021233 the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log. When used in
21234 HTTP mode, the accept_date field will be reset to the first moment the
21235 connection is ready to receive a new request (end of previous response for
21236 HTTP/1, immediately after previous request for HTTP/2).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021237
21238 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
21239 and processed the connection.
21240
21241 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
21242 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
21243 frontend if no switching rule has been applied, which is common for TCP
21244 applications.
21245
21246 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
21247 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
21248 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
21249 which processed the request. If the connection was aborted before reaching
21250 a server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name.
21251
21252 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
21253 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
21254 See "Timers" below for more details.
21255
21256 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
21257 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
21258 connection was aborted before a connection could be established. See
21259 "Timers" below for more details.
21260
21261 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030021262 last close. It covers all possible processing. There is one exception, if
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021263 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
21264 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
21265 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
21266 details.
21267
21268 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted from the server to
21269 the client when the log is emitted. If "option logasap" is specified, the
21270 this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that the final one
21271 may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit counter, so log
21272 analysis tools must be able to handle it without overflowing.
21273
21274 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
21275 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
21276 session to happen, and for what reason (timeout, error, ...). The normal
21277 flags should be "--", indicating the session was closed by either end with
21278 no data remaining in buffers. See below "Session state at disconnection"
21279 for more details.
21280
21281 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040021282 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021283 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 when
21284 multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system limits
21285 the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all of them
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020021286 are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the system.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021287
21288 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
21289 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
21290 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
21291 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
21292 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
21293 caused by a denial of service attack.
21294
21295 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
21296 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
21297 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
21298 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
21299 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
21300 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
21301 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
21302 denial of service attack.
21303
21304 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
21305 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
21306 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
21307 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
21308 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
21309 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
21310 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
21311 that this server has some trouble causing the connections to take longer to
21312 be processed than on other servers.
21313
21314 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
21315 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
21316 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
21317 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021318 HAProxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021319 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
21320 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
21321 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
21322 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
21323 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
21324 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
21325 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
21326 should not be attributed to the logged server.
21327
21328 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
21329 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
21330 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
21331 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
21332 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
21333 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021334 cumulative. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021335 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
21336
21337 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
21338 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
21339 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
21340 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
21341 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
21342 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021343 and then both positions will be cumulative. A request should not pass
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021344 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
21345 occurs.
21346
21347
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200213488.2.3. HTTP log format
21349----------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021350
21351The HTTP format is the most complete and the best suited for HTTP proxies. It
21352is enabled by when "option httplog" is specified in the frontend. It provides
21353the same level of information as the TCP format with additional features which
21354are specific to the HTTP protocol. Just like the TCP format, the log is usually
21355emitted at the end of the session, unless "option logasap" is specified, which
21356generally only makes sense for download sites. A session which matches the
21357"monitor" rules will never logged. It is also possible not to log sessions for
21358which no data were sent by the client by specifying "option dontlognull" in the
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020021359frontend. Successful connections will not be logged if "option dontlog-normal"
21360is specified in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021361
Willy Tarreau2ed73502021-11-05 18:09:06 +010021362The HTTP log format is internally declared as a custom log format based on the
21363exact following string, which may also be used as a basis to extend the format
Willy Tarreauec5c1102021-11-06 09:18:33 +010021364if required. Refer to section 8.2.6 "Custom log format" to see how to use this:
Willy Tarreau2ed73502021-11-05 18:09:06 +010021365
21366 # strict equivalent of "option httplog"
21367 log-format "%ci:%cp [%tr] %ft %b/%s %TR/%Tw/%Tc/%Tr/%Ta %ST %B %CC \
21368 %CS %tsc %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq %hr %hs %{+Q}r"
21369
21370And the CLF log format is internally declared as a custom log format based on
21371this exact string:
21372
21373 # strict equivalent of "option httplog clf"
21374 log-format "%{+Q}o %{-Q}ci - - [%trg] %r %ST %B \"\" \"\" %cp \
21375 %ms %ft %b %s %TR %Tw %Tc %Tr %Ta %tsc %ac %fc \
21376 %bc %sc %rc %sq %bq %CC %CS %hrl %hsl"
21377
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021378Most fields are shared with the TCP log, some being different. A few fields may
21379slightly vary depending on some configuration options. Those ones are marked
21380with a star ('*') after the field name below.
21381
21382 Example :
21383 frontend http-in
21384 mode http
21385 option httplog
21386 log global
21387 default_backend bck
21388
21389 backend static
21390 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
21391
21392 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
21393 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
21394 static/srv1 10/0/30/69/109 200 2750 - - ---- 1/1/1/1/0 0/0 {1wt.eu} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010021395 {} "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021396
21397 Field Format Extract from the example above
21398 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14389]:
21399 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33317
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021400 3 '[' request_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655]
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021401 4 frontend_name http-in
21402 5 backend_name '/' server_name static/srv1
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021403 6 TR '/' Tw '/' Tc '/' Tr '/' Ta* 10/0/30/69/109
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021404 7 status_code 200
21405 8 bytes_read* 2750
21406 9 captured_request_cookie -
21407 10 captured_response_cookie -
21408 11 termination_state ----
21409 12 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 1/1/1/1/0
21410 13 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
21411 14 '{' captured_request_headers* '}' {haproxy.1wt.eu}
21412 15 '{' captured_response_headers* '}' {}
21413 16 '"' http_request '"' "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010021414
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021415Detailed fields description :
21416 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021417 connection to HAProxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010021418 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
21419 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010021420 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021421 and the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol is correctly used, then the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010021422 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021423
21424 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010021425 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
21426 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
21427 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021428
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021429 - "request_date" is the exact date when the first byte of the HTTP request
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021430 was received by HAProxy (log field %tr).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021431
21432 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
21433 and processed the connection.
21434
21435 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
21436 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
21437 frontend if no switching rule has been applied.
21438
21439 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
21440 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
21441 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
21442 which processed the request. If the request was aborted before reaching a
21443 server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name. If the request was
21444 intercepted by the stats subsystem, "<STATS>" is indicated instead.
21445
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021446 - "TR" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for a full HTTP
21447 request from the client (not counting body) after the first byte was
21448 received. It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before a complete
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050021449 request could be received or a bad request was received. It should
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021450 always be very small because a request generally fits in one single packet.
21451 Large times here generally indicate network issues between the client and
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021452 HAProxy or requests being typed by hand. See section 8.4 "Timing Events"
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020021453 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021454
21455 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
21456 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020021457 See section 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021458
21459 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
21460 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020021461 request was aborted before a connection could be established. See section
21462 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021463
21464 - "Tr" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the server to send
21465 a full HTTP response, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the request was
21466 aborted before a complete response could be received. It generally matches
21467 the server's processing time for the request, though it may be altered by
21468 the amount of data sent by the client to the server. Large times here on
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020021469 "GET" requests generally indicate an overloaded server. See section 8.4
21470 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021471
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021472 - "Ta" is the time the request remained active in HAProxy, which is the total
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021473 time in milliseconds elapsed between the first byte of the request was
21474 received and the last byte of response was sent. It covers all possible
21475 processing except the handshake (see Th) and idle time (see Ti). There is
21476 one exception, if "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting
21477 stops at the moment the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is
21478 prepended before the value, indicating that the final one will be larger.
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020021479 See section 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021480
21481 - "status_code" is the HTTP status code returned to the client. This status
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021482 is generally set by the server, but it might also be set by HAProxy when
21483 the server cannot be reached or when its response is blocked by HAProxy.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021484
21485 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted to the client when
21486 the log is emitted. This does include HTTP headers. If "option logasap" is
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050021487 specified, this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021488 the final one may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit
21489 counter, so log analysis tools must be able to handle it without
21490 overflowing.
21491
21492 - "captured_request_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating that
21493 the client had this cookie in the request. The cookie name and its maximum
21494 length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend
21495 configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is not
21496 set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track session
21497 ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session crossing
21498 between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please consult
21499 the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
21500
21501 - "captured_response_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating
21502 that the server has returned a cookie with its response. The cookie name
21503 and its maximum length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the
21504 frontend configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is
21505 not set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track
21506 session ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session
21507 crossing between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please
21508 consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
21509
21510 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
21511 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
21512 session to happen, for what reason (timeout, error, ...), just like in TCP
21513 logs, and information about persistence operations on cookies in the last
21514 two characters. The normal flags should begin with "--", indicating the
21515 session was closed by either end with no data remaining in buffers. See
21516 below "Session state at disconnection" for more details.
21517
21518 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040021519 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021520 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 or 1024
21521 when multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system
21522 limits the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020021523 of them are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021524 system.
21525
21526 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
21527 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
21528 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
21529 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
21530 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
21531 caused by a denial of service attack.
21532
21533 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
21534 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
21535 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
21536 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
21537 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
21538 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
21539 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
21540 denial of service attack.
21541
21542 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
21543 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
21544 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
21545 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
21546 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
21547 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
21548 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
21549 that this server has some trouble causing the requests to take longer to be
21550 processed than on other servers.
21551
21552 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
21553 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
21554 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
21555 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021556 HAProxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021557 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
21558 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
21559 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
21560 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
21561 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
21562 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
21563 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
21564 should not be attributed to the logged server.
21565
21566 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
21567 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
21568 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
21569 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
21570 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
21571 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021572 cumulative. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021573 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
21574
21575 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
21576 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
21577 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
21578 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
21579 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
21580 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021581 and then both positions will be cumulative. A request should not pass
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021582 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
21583 occurs.
21584
21585 - "captured_request_headers" is a list of headers captured in the request due
21586 to the presence of the "capture request header" statement in the frontend.
21587 Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar
21588 ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear, causing a
21589 shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this field may
21590 contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser than when
21591 it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and
21592 cookies" below for more details.
21593
21594 - "captured_response_headers" is a list of headers captured in the response
21595 due to the presence of the "capture response header" statement in the
21596 frontend. Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a
21597 vertical bar ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear,
21598 causing a shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this
21599 field may contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser
21600 than when it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers
21601 and cookies" below for more details.
21602
21603 - "http_request" is the complete HTTP request line, including the method,
21604 request and HTTP version string. Non-printable characters are encoded (see
21605 below the section "Non-printable characters"). This is always the last
21606 field, and it is always delimited by quotes and is the only one which can
21607 contain quotes. If new fields are added to the log format, they will be
21608 added before this field. This field might be truncated if the request is
21609 huge and does not fit in the standard syslog buffer (1024 characters). This
21610 is the reason why this field must always remain the last one.
21611
Remi Tricot-Le Breton98b930d2021-07-29 09:45:52 +020021612
216138.2.4. HTTPS log format
21614----------------------
21615
21616The HTTPS format is the best suited for HTTP over SSL connections. It is an
21617extension of the HTTP format (see section 8.2.3) to which SSL related
21618information are added. It is enabled when "option httpslog" is specified in the
21619frontend. Just like the TCP and HTTP formats, the log is usually emitted at the
21620end of the session, unless "option logasap" is specified. A session which
21621matches the "monitor" rules will never logged. It is also possible not to log
21622sessions for which no data were sent by the client by specifying "option
21623dontlognull" in the frontend. Successful connections will not be logged if
21624"option dontlog-normal" is specified in the frontend.
21625
Willy Tarreau2ed73502021-11-05 18:09:06 +010021626The HTTPS log format is internally declared as a custom log format based on the
21627exact following string, which may also be used as a basis to extend the format
Willy Tarreauec5c1102021-11-06 09:18:33 +010021628if required. Refer to section 8.2.6 "Custom log format" to see how to use this:
Willy Tarreau2ed73502021-11-05 18:09:06 +010021629
21630 # strict equivalent of "option httpslog"
21631 log-format "%ci:%cp [%tr] %ft %b/%s %TR/%Tw/%Tc/%Tr/%Ta %ST %B %CC \
21632 %CS %tsc %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq %hr %hs %{+Q}r \
21633 %[fc_err]/%[ssl_fc_err,hex]/%[ssl_c_err]/\
Willy Tarreau68574dd2021-11-05 19:14:55 +010021634 %[ssl_c_ca_err]/%[ssl_fc_is_resumed] %[ssl_fc_sni]/%sslv/%sslc"
Willy Tarreau2ed73502021-11-05 18:09:06 +010021635
Remi Tricot-Le Breton98b930d2021-07-29 09:45:52 +020021636This format is basically the HTTP one (see section 8.2.3) with new fields
21637appended to it. The new fields (lines 17 and 18) will be detailed here. For the
21638HTTP ones, refer to the HTTP section.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021639
Remi Tricot-Le Breton98b930d2021-07-29 09:45:52 +020021640 Example :
21641 frontend https-in
21642 mode http
21643 option httpslog
21644 log global
21645 bind *:443 ssl crt mycerts/srv.pem ...
21646 default_backend bck
21647
21648 backend static
21649 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000 ssl crt mycerts/clt.pem ...
21650
21651 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
21652 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] https-in \
21653 static/srv1 10/0/30/69/109 200 2750 - - ---- 1/1/1/1/0 0/0 {1wt.eu} \
Willy Tarreau68574dd2021-11-05 19:14:55 +010021654 {} "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1" 0/0/0/0/0 \
21655 1wt.eu/TLSv1.3/TLS_AES_256_GCM_SHA384
Remi Tricot-Le Breton98b930d2021-07-29 09:45:52 +020021656
21657 Field Format Extract from the example above
21658 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14389]:
21659 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33317
21660 3 '[' request_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655]
21661 4 frontend_name https-in
21662 5 backend_name '/' server_name static/srv1
21663 6 TR '/' Tw '/' Tc '/' Tr '/' Ta* 10/0/30/69/109
21664 7 status_code 200
21665 8 bytes_read* 2750
21666 9 captured_request_cookie -
21667 10 captured_response_cookie -
21668 11 termination_state ----
21669 12 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 1/1/1/1/0
21670 13 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
21671 14 '{' captured_request_headers* '}' {haproxy.1wt.eu}
21672 15 '{' captured_response_headers* '}' {}
21673 16 '"' http_request '"' "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreau6f749762021-11-05 17:07:03 +010021674 17 fc_err '/' ssl_fc_err '/' ssl_c_err
William Lallemand1d58b012021-10-14 14:27:48 +020021675 '/' ssl_c_ca_err '/' ssl_fc_is_resumed 0/0/0/0/0
Willy Tarreau68574dd2021-11-05 19:14:55 +010021676 18 ssl_fc_sni '/' ssl_version
21677 '/' ssl_ciphers 1wt.eu/TLSv1.3/TLS_AES_256_GCM_SHA384
Remi Tricot-Le Breton98b930d2021-07-29 09:45:52 +020021678
21679Detailed fields description :
Willy Tarreau6f749762021-11-05 17:07:03 +010021680 - "fc_err" is the status of the connection on the frontend's side. It
21681 corresponds to the "fc_err" sample fetch. See the "fc_err" and "fc_err_str"
21682 sample fetch functions for more information.
Remi Tricot-Le Breton98b930d2021-07-29 09:45:52 +020021683
Remi Tricot-Le Breton1fe0fad2021-09-29 18:56:52 +020021684 - "ssl_fc_err" is the last error of the first SSL error stack that was
21685 raised on the connection from the frontend's perspective. It might be used
21686 to detect SSL handshake errors for instance. It will be 0 if everything
Ilya Shipitsinbd6b4be2021-10-15 16:18:21 +050021687 went well. See the "ssl_fc_err" sample fetch's description for more
Remi Tricot-Le Breton1fe0fad2021-09-29 18:56:52 +020021688 information.
Remi Tricot-Le Breton98b930d2021-07-29 09:45:52 +020021689
21690 - "ssl_c_err" is the status of the client's certificate verification process.
21691 The handshake might be successful while having a non-null verification
21692 error code if it is an ignored one. See the "ssl_c_err" sample fetch and
21693 the "crt-ignore-err" option.
21694
21695 - "ssl_c_ca_err" is the status of the client's certificate chain verification
21696 process. The handshake might be successful while having a non-null
21697 verification error code if it is an ignored one. See the "ssl_c_ca_err"
21698 sample fetch and the "ca-ignore-err" option.
21699
William Lallemand1d58b012021-10-14 14:27:48 +020021700 - "ssl_fc_is_resumed" is true if the incoming TLS session was resumed with
21701 the stateful cache or a stateless ticket. Don't forgot that a TLS session
21702 can be shared by multiple requests.
21703
Willy Tarreau68574dd2021-11-05 19:14:55 +010021704 - "ssl_fc_sni" is the SNI (Server Name Indication) presented by the client
21705 to select the certificate to be used. It usually matches the host name for
21706 the first request of a connection. An absence of this field may indicate
21707 that the SNI was not sent by the client, and will lead haproxy to use the
21708 default certificate, or to reject the connection in case of strict-sni.
21709
Remi Tricot-Le Breton98b930d2021-07-29 09:45:52 +020021710 - "ssl_version" is the SSL version of the frontend.
21711
21712 - "ssl_ciphers" is the SSL cipher used for the connection.
21713
21714
Willy Tarreauec5c1102021-11-06 09:18:33 +0100217158.2.5. Error log format
21716-----------------------
21717
21718When an incoming connection fails due to an SSL handshake or an invalid PROXY
21719protocol header, HAProxy will log the event using a shorter, fixed line format,
21720unless a dedicated error log format is defined through an "error-log-format"
21721line. By default, logs are emitted at the LOG_INFO level, unless the option
21722"log-separate-errors" is set in the backend, in which case the LOG_ERR level
21723will be used. Connections on which no data are exchanged (e.g. probes) are not
21724logged if the "dontlognull" option is set.
21725
21726The default format looks like this :
21727
21728 >>> Dec 3 18:27:14 localhost \
21729 haproxy[6103]: 127.0.0.1:56059 [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380] frt/f1: \
21730 Connection error during SSL handshake
21731
21732 Field Format Extract from the example above
21733 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[6103]:
21734 2 client_ip ':' client_port 127.0.0.1:56059
21735 3 '[' accept_date ']' [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380]
21736 4 frontend_name "/" bind_name ":" frt/f1:
21737 5 message Connection error during SSL handshake
21738
21739These fields just provide minimal information to help debugging connection
21740failures.
21741
21742By using the "error-log-format" directive, the legacy log format described
21743above will not be used anymore, and all error log lines will follow the
21744defined format.
21745
21746An example of reasonably complete error-log-format follows, it will report the
21747source address and port, the connection accept() date, the frontend name, the
21748number of active connections on the process and on thit frontend, haproxy's
21749internal error identifier on the front connection, the hexadecimal OpenSSL
21750error number (that can be copy-pasted to "openssl errstr" for full decoding),
21751the client certificate extraction status (0 indicates no error), the client
21752certificate validation status using the CA (0 indicates no error), a boolean
21753indicating if the connection is new or was resumed, the optional server name
21754indication (SNI) provided by the client, the SSL version name and the SSL
21755ciphers used on the connection, if any. Note that backend connection errors
21756are never reported here since in order for a backend connection to fail, it
21757would have passed through a successful stream, hence will be available as
21758regular traffic log (see option httplog or option httpslog).
21759
21760 # detailed frontend connection error log
Lukas Tribus2b949732021-12-09 01:27:14 +010021761 error-log-format "%ci:%cp [%tr] %ft %ac/%fc %[fc_err]/\
Willy Tarreauec5c1102021-11-06 09:18:33 +010021762 %[ssl_fc_err,hex]/%[ssl_c_err]/%[ssl_c_ca_err]/%[ssl_fc_is_resumed] \
21763 %[ssl_fc_sni]/%sslv/%sslc"
21764
21765
217668.2.6. Custom log format
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020021767------------------------
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010021768
Willy Tarreau2ed73502021-11-05 18:09:06 +010021769When the default log formats are not sufficient, it is possible to define new
21770ones in very fine details. As creating a log-format from scratch is not always
21771a trivial task, it is strongly recommended to first have a look at the existing
21772formats ("option tcplog", "option httplog", "option httpslog"), pick the one
21773looking the closest to the expectation, copy its "log-format" equivalent string
21774and adjust it.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010021775
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021776HAProxy understands some log format variables. % precedes log format variables.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010021777Variables can take arguments using braces ('{}'), and multiple arguments are
21778separated by commas within the braces. Flags may be added or removed by
21779prefixing them with a '+' or '-' sign.
21780
21781Special variable "%o" may be used to propagate its flags to all other
21782variables on the same format string. This is particularly handy with quoted
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010021783("Q") and escaped ("E") string formats.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010021784
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010021785If a variable is named between square brackets ('[' .. ']') then it is used
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020021786as a sample expression rule (see section 7.3). This it useful to add some
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010021787less common information such as the client's SSL certificate's DN, or to log
21788the key that would be used to store an entry into a stick table.
21789
Dragan Dosen1e3b16f2020-06-23 18:16:44 +020021790Note: spaces must be escaped. In configuration directives "log-format",
21791"log-format-sd" and "unique-id-format", spaces are considered as
21792delimiters and are merged. In order to emit a verbatim '%', it must be
21793preceded by another '%' resulting in '%%'.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010021794
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010021795Note: when using the RFC5424 syslog message format, the characters '"',
21796'\' and ']' inside PARAM-VALUE should be escaped with '\' as prefix (see
21797https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3.3 for more details). In
21798such cases, the use of the flag "E" should be considered.
21799
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010021800Flags are :
21801 * Q: quote a string
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040021802 * X: hexadecimal representation (IPs, Ports, %Ts, %rt, %pid)
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010021803 * E: escape characters '"', '\' and ']' in a string with '\' as prefix
21804 (intended purpose is for the RFC5424 structured-data log formats)
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010021805
21806 Example:
21807
21808 log-format %T\ %t\ Some\ Text
21809 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
21810
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010021811 log-format-sd %{+Q,+E}o\ [exampleSDID@1234\ header=%[capture.req.hdr(0)]]
21812
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010021813Please refer to the table below for currently defined variables :
21814
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010021815 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020021816 | R | var | field name (8.2.2 and 8.2.3 for description) | type |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010021817 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
21818 | | %o | special variable, apply flags on all next var | |
21819 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010021820 | | %B | bytes_read (from server to client) | numeric |
21821 | H | %CC | captured_request_cookie | string |
21822 | H | %CS | captured_response_cookie | string |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020021823 | | %H | hostname | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000021824 | H | %HM | HTTP method (ex: POST) | string |
Maciej Zdeb21acc332020-11-26 10:45:52 +000021825 | H | %HP | HTTP request URI without query string | string |
Maciej Zdebfcdfd852020-11-30 18:27:47 +000021826 | H | %HPO | HTTP path only (without host nor query string)| string |
Andrew Hayworthe63ac872015-07-31 16:14:16 +000021827 | H | %HQ | HTTP request URI query string (ex: ?bar=baz) | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000021828 | H | %HU | HTTP request URI (ex: /foo?bar=baz) | string |
21829 | H | %HV | HTTP version (ex: HTTP/1.0) | string |
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010021830 | | %ID | unique-id | string |
Willy Tarreau4bf99632014-06-13 12:21:40 +020021831 | | %ST | status_code | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020021832 | | %T | gmt_date_time | date |
Christopher Faulet3010e002021-12-03 10:48:36 +010021833 | H | %Ta | Active time of the request (from TR to end) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010021834 | | %Tc | Tc | numeric |
Willy Tarreau27b639d2016-05-17 17:55:27 +020021835 | | %Td | Td = Tt - (Tq + Tw + Tc + Tr) | numeric |
Yuxans Yao4e25b012012-10-19 10:36:09 +080021836 | | %Tl | local_date_time | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021837 | | %Th | connection handshake time (SSL, PROXY proto) | numeric |
21838 | H | %Ti | idle time before the HTTP request | numeric |
21839 | H | %Tq | Th + Ti + TR | numeric |
21840 | H | %TR | time to receive the full request from 1st byte| numeric |
21841 | H | %Tr | Tr (response time) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020021842 | | %Ts | timestamp | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010021843 | | %Tt | Tt | numeric |
Damien Claisse57c8eb92020-04-28 12:09:19 +000021844 | | %Tu | Tu | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010021845 | | %Tw | Tw | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010021846 | | %U | bytes_uploaded (from client to server) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010021847 | | %ac | actconn | numeric |
21848 | | %b | backend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010021849 | | %bc | beconn (backend concurrent connections) | numeric |
21850 | | %bi | backend_source_ip (connecting address) | IP |
21851 | | %bp | backend_source_port (connecting address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010021852 | | %bq | backend_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010021853 | | %ci | client_ip (accepted address) | IP |
21854 | | %cp | client_port (accepted address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010021855 | | %f | frontend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010021856 | | %fc | feconn (frontend concurrent connections) | numeric |
21857 | | %fi | frontend_ip (accepting address) | IP |
21858 | | %fp | frontend_port (accepting address) | numeric |
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020021859 | | %ft | frontend_name_transport ('~' suffix for SSL) | string |
Willy Tarreau7346acb2014-08-28 15:03:15 +020021860 | | %lc | frontend_log_counter | numeric |
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020021861 | | %hr | captured_request_headers default style | string |
21862 | | %hrl | captured_request_headers CLF style | string list |
21863 | | %hs | captured_response_headers default style | string |
21864 | | %hsl | captured_response_headers CLF style | string list |
Willy Tarreau812c88e2015-08-09 10:56:35 +020021865 | | %ms | accept date milliseconds (left-padded with 0) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020021866 | | %pid | PID | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020021867 | H | %r | http_request | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010021868 | | %rc | retries | numeric |
Willy Tarreau1f0da242014-01-25 11:01:50 +010021869 | | %rt | request_counter (HTTP req or TCP session) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010021870 | | %s | server_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010021871 | | %sc | srv_conn (server concurrent connections) | numeric |
21872 | | %si | server_IP (target address) | IP |
21873 | | %sp | server_port (target address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010021874 | | %sq | srv_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020021875 | S | %sslc| ssl_ciphers (ex: AES-SHA) | string |
21876 | S | %sslv| ssl_version (ex: TLSv1) | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010021877 | | %t | date_time (with millisecond resolution) | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021878 | H | %tr | date_time of HTTP request | date |
21879 | H | %trg | gmt_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
Jens Bissinger15c64ff2018-08-23 14:11:27 +020021880 | H | %trl | local_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010021881 | | %ts | termination_state | string |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020021882 | H | %tsc | termination_state with cookie status | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010021883 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010021884
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020021885 R = Restrictions : H = mode http only ; S = SSL only
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010021886
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010021887
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200218888.3. Advanced logging options
21889-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021890
21891Some advanced logging options are often looked for but are not easy to find out
21892just by looking at the various options. Here is an entry point for the few
21893options which can enable better logging. Please refer to the keywords reference
21894for more information about their usage.
21895
21896
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200218978.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
21898------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021899
21900It is quite common to have some monitoring tools perform health checks on
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021901HAProxy. Sometimes it will be a layer 3 load-balancer such as LVS or any
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021902commercial load-balancer, and sometimes it will simply be a more complete
21903monitoring system such as Nagios. When the tests are very frequent, users often
21904ask how to disable logging for those checks. There are three possibilities :
21905
21906 - if connections come from everywhere and are just TCP probes, it is often
21907 desired to simply disable logging of connections without data exchange, by
21908 setting "option dontlognull" in the frontend. It also disables logging of
21909 port scans, which may or may not be desired.
21910
Willy Tarreau9e9919d2020-10-14 15:55:23 +020021911 - it is possible to use the "http-request set-log-level silent" action using
21912 a variety of conditions (source networks, paths, user-agents, etc).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021913
21914 - if the tests are performed on a known URI, use "monitor-uri" to declare
21915 this URI as dedicated to monitoring. Any host sending this request will
21916 only get the result of a health-check, and the request will not be logged.
21917
21918
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200219198.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
21920----------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021921
21922The problem with logging at end of connection is that you have no clue about
21923what is happening during very long sessions, such as remote terminal sessions
21924or large file downloads. This problem can be worked around by specifying
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021925"option logasap" in the frontend. HAProxy will then log as soon as possible,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021926just before data transfer begins. This means that in case of TCP, it will still
21927log the connection status to the server, and in case of HTTP, it will log just
21928after processing the server headers. In this case, the number of bytes reported
21929is the number of header bytes sent to the client. In order to avoid confusion
21930with normal logs, the total time field and the number of bytes are prefixed
21931with a '+' sign which means that real numbers are certainly larger.
21932
21933
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200219348.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
21935------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020021936
21937Sometimes it is more convenient to separate normal traffic from errors logs,
21938for instance in order to ease error monitoring from log files. When the option
21939"log-separate-errors" is used, connections which experience errors, timeouts,
21940retries, redispatches or HTTP status codes 5xx will see their syslog level
21941raised from "info" to "err". This will help a syslog daemon store the log in
21942a separate file. It is very important to keep the errors in the normal traffic
21943file too, so that log ordering is not altered. You should also be careful if
21944you already have configured your syslog daemon to store all logs higher than
21945"notice" in an "admin" file, because the "err" level is higher than "notice".
21946
21947
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200219488.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
21949--------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020021950
21951Although this may sound strange at first, some large sites have to deal with
21952multiple thousands of logs per second and are experiencing difficulties keeping
21953them intact for a long time or detecting errors within them. If the option
21954"dontlog-normal" is set on the frontend, all normal connections will not be
21955logged. In this regard, a normal connection is defined as one without any
21956error, timeout, retry nor redispatch. In HTTP, the status code is checked too,
21957and a response with a status 5xx is not considered normal and will be logged
21958too. Of course, doing is is really discouraged as it will remove most of the
21959useful information from the logs. Do this only if you have no other
21960alternative.
21961
21962
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200219638.4. Timing events
21964------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021965
21966Timers provide a great help in troubleshooting network problems. All values are
21967reported in milliseconds (ms). These timers should be used in conjunction with
21968the session termination flags. In TCP mode with "option tcplog" set on the
21969frontend, 3 control points are reported under the form "Tw/Tc/Tt", and in HTTP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021970mode, 5 control points are reported under the form "TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/Ta". In
21971addition, three other measures are provided, "Th", "Ti", and "Tq".
21972
Guillaume de Lafondf27cddc2016-12-23 17:32:43 +010021973Timings events in HTTP mode:
21974
21975 first request 2nd request
21976 |<-------------------------------->|<-------------- ...
21977 t tr t tr ...
21978 ---|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|--
21979 : Th Ti TR Tw Tc Tr Td : Ti ...
21980 :<---- Tq ---->: :
21981 :<-------------- Tt -------------->:
Damien Claisse57c8eb92020-04-28 12:09:19 +000021982 :<-- -----Tu--------------->:
Guillaume de Lafondf27cddc2016-12-23 17:32:43 +010021983 :<--------- Ta --------->:
21984
21985Timings events in TCP mode:
21986
21987 TCP session
21988 |<----------------->|
21989 t t
21990 ---|----|----|----|----|---
21991 | Th Tw Tc Td |
21992 |<------ Tt ------->|
21993
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021994 - Th: total time to accept tcp connection and execute handshakes for low level
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021995 protocols. Currently, these protocols are proxy-protocol and SSL. This may
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021996 only happen once during the whole connection's lifetime. A large time here
21997 may indicate that the client only pre-established the connection without
21998 speaking, that it is experiencing network issues preventing it from
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021999 completing a handshake in a reasonable time (e.g. MTU issues), or that an
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020022000 SSL handshake was very expensive to compute. Please note that this time is
22001 reported only before the first request, so it is safe to average it over
22002 all request to calculate the amortized value. The second and subsequent
22003 request will always report zero here.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022004
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020022005 - Ti: is the idle time before the HTTP request (HTTP mode only). This timer
22006 counts between the end of the handshakes and the first byte of the HTTP
22007 request. When dealing with a second request in keep-alive mode, it starts
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020022008 to count after the end of the transmission the previous response. When a
22009 multiplexed protocol such as HTTP/2 is used, it starts to count immediately
22010 after the previous request. Some browsers pre-establish connections to a
22011 server in order to reduce the latency of a future request, and keep them
22012 pending until they need it. This delay will be reported as the idle time. A
22013 value of -1 indicates that nothing was received on the connection.
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020022014
22015 - TR: total time to get the client request (HTTP mode only). It's the time
22016 elapsed between the first bytes received and the moment the proxy received
22017 the empty line marking the end of the HTTP headers. The value "-1"
22018 indicates that the end of headers has never been seen. This happens when
22019 the client closes prematurely or times out. This time is usually very short
22020 since most requests fit in a single packet. A large time may indicate a
22021 request typed by hand during a test.
22022
22023 - Tq: total time to get the client request from the accept date or since the
22024 emission of the last byte of the previous response (HTTP mode only). It's
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010022025 exactly equal to Th + Ti + TR unless any of them is -1, in which case it
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020022026 returns -1 as well. This timer used to be very useful before the arrival of
22027 HTTP keep-alive and browsers' pre-connect feature. It's recommended to drop
22028 it in favor of TR nowadays, as the idle time adds a lot of noise to the
22029 reports.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022030
22031 - Tw: total time spent in the queues waiting for a connection slot. It
22032 accounts for backend queue as well as the server queues, and depends on the
22033 queue size, and the time needed for the server to complete previous
22034 requests. The value "-1" means that the request was killed before reaching
22035 the queue, which is generally what happens with invalid or denied requests.
22036
22037 - Tc: total time to establish the TCP connection to the server. It's the time
22038 elapsed between the moment the proxy sent the connection request, and the
22039 moment it was acknowledged by the server, or between the TCP SYN packet and
22040 the matching SYN/ACK packet in return. The value "-1" means that the
22041 connection never established.
22042
22043 - Tr: server response time (HTTP mode only). It's the time elapsed between
22044 the moment the TCP connection was established to the server and the moment
22045 the server sent its complete response headers. It purely shows its request
22046 processing time, without the network overhead due to the data transmission.
22047 It is worth noting that when the client has data to send to the server, for
22048 instance during a POST request, the time already runs, and this can distort
22049 apparent response time. For this reason, it's generally wise not to trust
22050 too much this field for POST requests initiated from clients behind an
22051 untrusted network. A value of "-1" here means that the last the response
22052 header (empty line) was never seen, most likely because the server timeout
22053 stroke before the server managed to process the request.
22054
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020022055 - Ta: total active time for the HTTP request, between the moment the proxy
22056 received the first byte of the request header and the emission of the last
22057 byte of the response body. The exception is when the "logasap" option is
22058 specified. In this case, it only equals (TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is prefixed with
22059 a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data transmission time,
22060 by subtracting other timers when valid :
22061
22062 Td = Ta - (TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
22063
22064 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. Note that
22065 "Ta" can never be negative.
22066
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022067 - Tt: total session duration time, between the moment the proxy accepted it
22068 and the moment both ends were closed. The exception is when the "logasap"
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020022069 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Th+Ti+TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and
22070 is prefixed with a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030022071 transmission time, by subtracting other timers when valid :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022072
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020022073 Td = Tt - (Th + Ti + TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022074
22075 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. In TCP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020022076 mode, "Ti", "Tq" and "Tr" have to be excluded too. Note that "Tt" can never
22077 be negative and that for HTTP, Tt is simply equal to (Th+Ti+Ta).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022078
Damien Claisse57c8eb92020-04-28 12:09:19 +000022079 - Tu: total estimated time as seen from client, between the moment the proxy
22080 accepted it and the moment both ends were closed, without idle time.
22081 This is useful to roughly measure end-to-end time as a user would see it,
22082 without idle time pollution from keep-alive time between requests. This
22083 timer in only an estimation of time seen by user as it assumes network
22084 latency is the same in both directions. The exception is when the "logasap"
22085 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Th+TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is
22086 prefixed with a '+' sign.
22087
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022088These timers provide precious indications on trouble causes. Since the TCP
22089protocol defines retransmit delays of 3, 6, 12... seconds, we know for sure
22090that timers close to multiples of 3s are nearly always related to lost packets
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020022091due to network problems (wires, negotiation, congestion). Moreover, if "Ta" or
22092"Tt" is close to a timeout value specified in the configuration, it often means
22093that a session has been aborted on timeout.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022094
22095Most common cases :
22096
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020022097 - If "Th" or "Ti" are close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between
22098 the client and the proxy. This is very rare on local networks but might
22099 happen when clients are on far remote networks and send large requests. It
22100 may happen that values larger than usual appear here without any network
22101 cause. Sometimes, during an attack or just after a resource starvation has
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040022102 ended, HAProxy may accept thousands of connections in a few milliseconds.
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020022103 The time spent accepting these connections will inevitably slightly delay
22104 processing of other connections, and it can happen that request times in the
22105 order of a few tens of milliseconds are measured after a few thousands of
22106 new connections have been accepted at once. Using one of the keep-alive
22107 modes may display larger idle times since "Ti" measures the time spent
Patrick Mezard105faca2010-06-12 17:02:46 +020022108 waiting for additional requests.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022109
22110 - If "Tc" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
22111 server and the proxy during the server connection phase. This value should
22112 always be very low, such as 1 ms on local networks and less than a few tens
22113 of ms on remote networks.
22114
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020022115 - If "Tr" is nearly always lower than 3000 except some rare values which seem
22116 to be the average majored by 3000, there are probably some packets lost
22117 between the proxy and the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022118
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020022119 - If "Ta" is large even for small byte counts, it generally is because
22120 neither the client nor the server decides to close the connection while
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040022121 HAProxy is running in tunnel mode and both have agreed on a keep-alive
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020022122 connection mode. In order to solve this issue, it will be needed to specify
22123 one of the HTTP options to manipulate keep-alive or close options on either
22124 the frontend or the backend. Having the smallest possible 'Ta' or 'Tt' is
22125 important when connection regulation is used with the "maxconn" option on
22126 the servers, since no new connection will be sent to the server until
22127 another one is released.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022128
22129Other noticeable HTTP log cases ('xx' means any value to be ignored) :
22130
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020022131 TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/+Ta The "option logasap" is present on the frontend and the log
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022132 was emitted before the data phase. All the timers are valid
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020022133 except "Ta" which is shorter than reality.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022134
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020022135 -1/xx/xx/xx/Ta The client was not able to send a complete request in time
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022136 or it aborted too early. Check the session termination flags
22137 then "timeout http-request" and "timeout client" settings.
22138
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020022139 TR/-1/xx/xx/Ta It was not possible to process the request, maybe because
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022140 servers were out of order, because the request was invalid
22141 or forbidden by ACL rules. Check the session termination
22142 flags.
22143
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020022144 TR/Tw/-1/xx/Ta The connection could not establish on the server. Either it
22145 actively refused it or it timed out after Ta-(TR+Tw) ms.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022146 Check the session termination flags, then check the
22147 "timeout connect" setting. Note that the tarpit action might
22148 return similar-looking patterns, with "Tw" equal to the time
22149 the client connection was maintained open.
22150
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020022151 TR/Tw/Tc/-1/Ta The server has accepted the connection but did not return
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030022152 a complete response in time, or it closed its connection
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020022153 unexpectedly after Ta-(TR+Tw+Tc) ms. Check the session
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022154 termination flags, then check the "timeout server" setting.
22155
22156
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200221578.5. Session state at disconnection
22158-----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022159
22160TCP and HTTP logs provide a session termination indicator in the
22161"termination_state" field, just before the number of active connections. It is
221622-characters long in TCP mode, and is extended to 4 characters in HTTP mode,
22163each of which has a special meaning :
22164
22165 - On the first character, a code reporting the first event which caused the
22166 session to terminate :
22167
22168 C : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the client.
22169
22170 S : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the server, or the
22171 server explicitly refused it.
22172
22173 P : the session was prematurely aborted by the proxy, because of a
22174 connection limit enforcement, because a DENY filter was matched,
22175 because of a security check which detected and blocked a dangerous
22176 error in server response which might have caused information leak
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010022177 (e.g. cacheable cookie).
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020022178
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040022179 L : the session was locally processed by HAProxy and was not passed to
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020022180 a server. This is what happens for stats and redirects.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022181
22182 R : a resource on the proxy has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source
22183 ports, ...). Usually, this appears during the connection phase, and
22184 system logs should contain a copy of the precise error. If this
22185 happens, it must be considered as a very serious anomaly which
22186 should be fixed as soon as possible by any means.
22187
22188 I : an internal error was identified by the proxy during a self-check.
22189 This should NEVER happen, and you are encouraged to report any log
22190 containing this, because this would almost certainly be a bug. It
22191 would be wise to preventively restart the process after such an
22192 event too, in case it would be caused by memory corruption.
22193
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040022194 D : the session was killed by HAProxy because the server was detected
Simon Horman752dc4a2011-06-21 14:34:59 +090022195 as down and was configured to kill all connections when going down.
22196
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040022197 U : the session was killed by HAProxy on this backup server because an
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070022198 active server was detected as up and was configured to kill all
22199 backup connections when going up.
22200
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040022201 K : the session was actively killed by an admin operating on HAProxy.
Willy Tarreaua2a64e92011-09-07 23:01:56 +020022202
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022203 c : the client-side timeout expired while waiting for the client to
22204 send or receive data.
22205
22206 s : the server-side timeout expired while waiting for the server to
22207 send or receive data.
22208
22209 - : normal session completion, both the client and the server closed
22210 with nothing left in the buffers.
22211
22212 - on the second character, the TCP or HTTP session state when it was closed :
22213
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +010022214 R : the proxy was waiting for a complete, valid REQUEST from the client
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022215 (HTTP mode only). Nothing was sent to any server.
22216
22217 Q : the proxy was waiting in the QUEUE for a connection slot. This can
22218 only happen when servers have a 'maxconn' parameter set. It can
22219 also happen in the global queue after a redispatch consecutive to
22220 a failed attempt to connect to a dying server. If no redispatch is
22221 reported, then no connection attempt was made to any server.
22222
22223 C : the proxy was waiting for the CONNECTION to establish on the
22224 server. The server might at most have noticed a connection attempt.
22225
22226 H : the proxy was waiting for complete, valid response HEADERS from the
22227 server (HTTP only).
22228
22229 D : the session was in the DATA phase.
22230
22231 L : the proxy was still transmitting LAST data to the client while the
22232 server had already finished. This one is very rare as it can only
22233 happen when the client dies while receiving the last packets.
22234
22235 T : the request was tarpitted. It has been held open with the client
22236 during the whole "timeout tarpit" duration or until the client
22237 closed, both of which will be reported in the "Tw" timer.
22238
22239 - : normal session completion after end of data transfer.
22240
22241 - the third character tells whether the persistence cookie was provided by
22242 the client (only in HTTP mode) :
22243
22244 N : the client provided NO cookie. This is usually the case for new
22245 visitors, so counting the number of occurrences of this flag in the
22246 logs generally indicate a valid trend for the site frequentation.
22247
22248 I : the client provided an INVALID cookie matching no known server.
22249 This might be caused by a recent configuration change, mixed
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +020022250 cookies between HTTP/HTTPS sites, persistence conditionally
22251 ignored, or an attack.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022252
22253 D : the client provided a cookie designating a server which was DOWN,
22254 so either "option persist" was used and the client was sent to
22255 this server, or it was not set and the client was redispatched to
22256 another server.
22257
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020022258 V : the client provided a VALID cookie, and was sent to the associated
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022259 server.
22260
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020022261 E : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a last date which was
22262 older than what is allowed by the "maxidle" cookie parameter, so
22263 the cookie is consider EXPIRED and is ignored. The request will be
22264 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
22265
22266 O : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a first date which was
22267 older than what is allowed by the "maxlife" cookie parameter, so
22268 the cookie is consider too OLD and is ignored. The request will be
22269 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
22270
Willy Tarreauc89ccb62012-04-05 21:18:22 +020022271 U : a cookie was present but was not used to select the server because
22272 some other server selection mechanism was used instead (typically a
22273 "use-server" rule).
22274
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022275 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
22276
22277 - the last character reports what operations were performed on the persistence
22278 cookie returned by the server (only in HTTP mode) :
22279
22280 N : NO cookie was provided by the server, and none was inserted either.
22281
22282 I : no cookie was provided by the server, and the proxy INSERTED one.
22283 Note that in "cookie insert" mode, if the server provides a cookie,
22284 it will still be overwritten and reported as "I" here.
22285
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020022286 U : the proxy UPDATED the last date in the cookie that was presented by
22287 the client. This can only happen in insert mode with "maxidle". It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030022288 happens every time there is activity at a different date than the
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020022289 date indicated in the cookie. If any other change happens, such as
22290 a redispatch, then the cookie will be marked as inserted instead.
22291
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022292 P : a cookie was PROVIDED by the server and transmitted as-is.
22293
22294 R : the cookie provided by the server was REWRITTEN by the proxy, which
22295 happens in "cookie rewrite" or "cookie prefix" modes.
22296
22297 D : the cookie provided by the server was DELETED by the proxy.
22298
22299 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
22300
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020022301The combination of the two first flags gives a lot of information about what
22302was happening when the session terminated, and why it did terminate. It can be
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022303helpful to detect server saturation, network troubles, local system resource
22304starvation, attacks, etc...
22305
22306The most common termination flags combinations are indicated below. They are
22307alphabetically sorted, with the lowercase set just after the upper case for
22308easier finding and understanding.
22309
22310 Flags Reason
22311
22312 -- Normal termination.
22313
22314 CC The client aborted before the connection could be established to the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040022315 server. This can happen when HAProxy tries to connect to a recently
22316 dead (or unchecked) server, and the client aborts while HAProxy is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022317 waiting for the server to respond or for "timeout connect" to expire.
22318
22319 CD The client unexpectedly aborted during data transfer. This can be
22320 caused by a browser crash, by an intermediate equipment between the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040022321 client and HAProxy which decided to actively break the connection,
22322 by network routing issues between the client and HAProxy, or by a
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022323 keep-alive session between the server and the client terminated first
22324 by the client.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010022325
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022326 cD The client did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
22327 "timeout client" delay. This is often caused by network failures on
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020022328 the client side, or the client simply leaving the net uncleanly.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022329
22330 CH The client aborted while waiting for the server to start responding.
22331 It might be the server taking too long to respond or the client
22332 clicking the 'Stop' button too fast.
22333
22334 cH The "timeout client" stroke while waiting for client data during a
22335 POST request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values
22336 for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized packets. It can
22337 also happen when client timeout is smaller than server timeout and
22338 the server takes too long to respond.
22339
22340 CQ The client aborted while its session was queued, waiting for a server
22341 with enough empty slots to accept it. It might be that either all the
22342 servers were saturated or that the assigned server was taking too
22343 long a time to respond.
22344
22345 CR The client aborted before sending a full HTTP request. Most likely
22346 the request was typed by hand using a telnet client, and aborted
22347 too early. The HTTP status code is likely a 400 here. Sometimes this
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040022348 might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection between HAProxy
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020022349 and the client. "option http-ignore-probes" can be used to ignore
22350 connections without any data transfer.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022351
22352 cR The "timeout http-request" stroke before the client sent a full HTTP
22353 request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values on the
22354 client side for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized
22355 packets, or by clients sending requests by hand and not typing fast
22356 enough, or forgetting to enter the empty line at the end of the
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020022357 request. The HTTP status code is likely a 408 here. Note: recently,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020022358 some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature consisting
22359 in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites just
22360 in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
22361 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408
22362 Request Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when
22363 the browser decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log
22364 and feed the error counters. Some versions of some browsers have even
22365 been reported to display the error code. It is possible to work
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010022366 around the undesirable effects of this behavior by adding "option
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020022367 http-ignore-probes" in the frontend, resulting in connections with
22368 zero data transfer to be totally ignored. This will definitely hide
22369 the errors of people experiencing connectivity issues though.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022370
22371 CT The client aborted while its session was tarpitted. It is important to
22372 check if this happens on valid requests, in order to be sure that no
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020022373 wrong tarpit rules have been written. If a lot of them happen, it
22374 might make sense to lower the "timeout tarpit" value to something
22375 closer to the average reported "Tw" timer, in order not to consume
22376 resources for just a few attackers.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022377
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040022378 LR The request was intercepted and locally handled by HAProxy. Generally
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020022379 it means that this was a redirect or a stats request.
22380
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040022381 SC The server or an equipment between it and HAProxy explicitly refused
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022382 the TCP connection (the proxy received a TCP RST or an ICMP message
22383 in return). Under some circumstances, it can also be the network
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010022384 stack telling the proxy that the server is unreachable (e.g. no route,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022385 or no ARP response on local network). When this happens in HTTP mode,
22386 the status code is likely a 502 or 503 here.
22387
22388 sC The "timeout connect" stroke before a connection to the server could
22389 complete. When this happens in HTTP mode, the status code is likely a
22390 503 or 504 here.
22391
22392 SD The connection to the server died with an error during the data
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040022393 transfer. This usually means that HAProxy has received an RST from
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022394 the server or an ICMP message from an intermediate equipment while
22395 exchanging data with the server. This can be caused by a server crash
22396 or by a network issue on an intermediate equipment.
22397
22398 sD The server did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
22399 "timeout server" setting during the data phase. This is often caused
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010022400 by too short timeouts on L4 equipment before the server (firewalls,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022401 load-balancers, ...), as well as keep-alive sessions maintained
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040022402 between the client and the server expiring first on HAProxy.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022403
22404 SH The server aborted before sending its full HTTP response headers, or
22405 it crashed while processing the request. Since a server aborting at
22406 this moment is very rare, it would be wise to inspect its logs to
22407 control whether it crashed and why. The logged request may indicate a
22408 small set of faulty requests, demonstrating bugs in the application.
22409 Sometimes this might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040022410 between HAProxy and the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022411
22412 sH The "timeout server" stroke before the server could return its
22413 response headers. This is the most common anomaly, indicating too
22414 long transactions, probably caused by server or database saturation.
22415 The immediate workaround consists in increasing the "timeout server"
22416 setting, but it is important to keep in mind that the user experience
22417 will suffer from these long response times. The only long term
22418 solution is to fix the application.
22419
22420 sQ The session spent too much time in queue and has been expired. See
22421 the "timeout queue" and "timeout connect" settings to find out how to
22422 fix this if it happens too often. If it often happens massively in
22423 short periods, it may indicate general problems on the affected
22424 servers due to I/O or database congestion, or saturation caused by
22425 external attacks.
22426
22427 PC The proxy refused to establish a connection to the server because the
Thayne McCombscdbcca92021-01-07 21:24:41 -070022428 process's socket limit has been reached while attempting to connect.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020022429 The global "maxconn" parameter may be increased in the configuration
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022430 so that it does not happen anymore. This status is very rare and
22431 might happen when the global "ulimit-n" parameter is forced by hand.
22432
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010022433 PD The proxy blocked an incorrectly formatted chunked encoded message in
22434 a request or a response, after the server has emitted its headers. In
22435 most cases, this will indicate an invalid message from the server to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010022436 the client. HAProxy supports chunk sizes of up to 2GB - 1 (2147483647
Willy Tarreauf3a3e132013-08-31 08:16:26 +020022437 bytes). Any larger size will be considered as an error.
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010022438
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022439 PH The proxy blocked the server's response, because it was invalid,
22440 incomplete, dangerous (cache control), or matched a security filter.
22441 In any case, an HTTP 502 error is sent to the client. One possible
22442 cause for this error is an invalid syntax in an HTTP header name
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010022443 containing unauthorized characters. It is also possible but quite
22444 rare, that the proxy blocked a chunked-encoding request from the
22445 client due to an invalid syntax, before the server responded. In this
22446 case, an HTTP 400 error is sent to the client and reported in the
Christopher Faulet24dda942022-05-05 12:27:07 +020022447 logs. Finally, it may be due to an HTTP header rewrite failure on the
22448 response. In this case, an HTTP 500 error is sent (see
22449 "tune.maxrewrite" and "http-response strict-mode" for more
22450 inforomation).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022451
22452 PR The proxy blocked the client's HTTP request, either because of an
22453 invalid HTTP syntax, in which case it returned an HTTP 400 error to
22454 the client, or because a deny filter matched, in which case it
Christopher Faulet24dda942022-05-05 12:27:07 +020022455 returned an HTTP 403 error. It may also be due to an HTTP header
22456 rewrite failure on the request. In this case, an HTTP 500 error is
22457 sent (see "tune.maxrewrite" and "http-request strict-mode" for more
22458 inforomation).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022459
22460 PT The proxy blocked the client's request and has tarpitted its
22461 connection before returning it a 500 server error. Nothing was sent
22462 to the server. The connection was maintained open for as long as
22463 reported by the "Tw" timer field.
22464
22465 RC A local resource has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source ports)
22466 preventing the connection to the server from establishing. The error
22467 logs will tell precisely what was missing. This is very rare and can
22468 only be solved by proper system tuning.
22469
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020022470The combination of the two last flags gives a lot of information about how
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040022471persistence was handled by the client, the server and by HAProxy. This is very
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020022472important to troubleshoot disconnections, when users complain they have to
22473re-authenticate. The commonly encountered flags are :
22474
22475 -- Persistence cookie is not enabled.
22476
22477 NN No cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
22478 response. For instance, this can be in insert mode with "postonly"
22479 set on a GET request.
22480
22481 II A cookie designating an invalid server was provided by the client,
22482 a valid one was inserted in the response. This typically happens when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040022483 a "server" entry is removed from the configuration, since its cookie
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020022484 value can be presented by a client when no other server knows it.
22485
22486 NI No cookie was provided by the client, one was inserted in the
22487 response. This typically happens for first requests from every user
22488 in "insert" mode, which makes it an easy way to count real users.
22489
22490 VN A cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
22491 response. This happens for most responses for which the client has
22492 already got a cookie.
22493
22494 VU A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
22495 not completely up-to-date, so an updated cookie was provided in
22496 response. This can also happen if there was no date at all, or if
22497 there was a date but the "maxidle" parameter was not set, so that the
22498 cookie can be switched to unlimited time.
22499
22500 EI A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
22501 too old for the "maxidle" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
22502 new cookie was inserted in the response.
22503
22504 OI A cookie was provided by the client, with a first visit date which is
22505 too old for the "maxlife" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
22506 new cookie was inserted in the response.
22507
22508 DI The server designated by the cookie was down, a new server was
22509 selected and a new cookie was emitted in the response.
22510
22511 VI The server designated by the cookie was not marked dead but could not
22512 be reached. A redispatch happened and selected another one, which was
22513 then advertised in the response.
22514
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022515
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200225168.6. Non-printable characters
22517-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022518
22519In order not to cause trouble to log analysis tools or terminals during log
22520consulting, non-printable characters are not sent as-is into log files, but are
22521converted to the two-digits hexadecimal representation of their ASCII code,
22522prefixed by the character '#'. The only characters that can be logged without
22523being escaped are comprised between 32 and 126 (inclusive). Obviously, the
22524escape character '#' itself is also encoded to avoid any ambiguity ("#23"). It
22525is the same for the character '"' which becomes "#22", as well as '{', '|' and
22526'}' when logging headers.
22527
22528Note that the space character (' ') is not encoded in headers, which can cause
22529issues for tools relying on space count to locate fields. A typical header
22530containing spaces is "User-Agent".
22531
22532Last, it has been observed that some syslog daemons such as syslog-ng escape
22533the quote ('"') with a backslash ('\'). The reverse operation can safely be
22534performed since no quote may appear anywhere else in the logs.
22535
22536
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200225378.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
22538---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022539
22540Cookie capture simplifies the tracking a complete user session. This can be
22541achieved using the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend. Please refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020022542section 4.2 for more details. Only one cookie can be captured, and the same
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022543cookie will simultaneously be checked in the request ("Cookie:" header) and in
22544the response ("Set-Cookie:" header). The respective values will be reported in
22545the HTTP logs at the "captured_request_cookie" and "captured_response_cookie"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020022546locations (see section 8.2.3 about HTTP log format). When either cookie is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022547not seen, a dash ('-') replaces the value. This way, it's easy to detect when a
22548user switches to a new session for example, because the server will reassign it
22549a new cookie. It is also possible to detect if a server unexpectedly sets a
22550wrong cookie to a client, leading to session crossing.
22551
22552 Examples :
22553 # capture the first cookie whose name starts with "ASPSESSION"
22554 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
22555
22556 # capture the first cookie whose name is exactly "vgnvisitor"
22557 capture cookie vgnvisitor= len 32
22558
22559
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200225608.8. Capturing HTTP headers
22561---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022562
22563Header captures are useful to track unique request identifiers set by an upper
22564proxy, virtual host names, user-agents, POST content-length, referrers, etc. In
22565the response, one can search for information about the response length, how the
22566server asked the cache to behave, or an object location during a redirection.
22567
22568Header captures are performed using the "capture request header" and "capture
22569response header" statements in the frontend. Please consult their definition in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020022570section 4.2 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022571
22572It is possible to include both request headers and response headers at the same
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010022573time. Non-existent headers are logged as empty strings, and if one header
22574appears more than once, only its last occurrence will be logged. Request headers
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022575are grouped within braces '{' and '}' in the same order as they were declared,
22576and delimited with a vertical bar '|' without any space. Response headers
22577follow the same representation, but are displayed after a space following the
22578request headers block. These blocks are displayed just before the HTTP request
22579in the logs.
22580
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020022581As a special case, it is possible to specify an HTTP header capture in a TCP
22582frontend. The purpose is to enable logging of headers which will be parsed in
22583an HTTP backend if the request is then switched to this HTTP backend.
22584
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022585 Example :
22586 # This instance chains to the outgoing proxy
22587 listen proxy-out
22588 mode http
22589 option httplog
22590 option logasap
22591 log global
22592 server cache1 192.168.1.1:3128
22593
22594 # log the name of the virtual server
22595 capture request header Host len 20
22596
22597 # log the amount of data uploaded during a POST
22598 capture request header Content-Length len 10
22599
22600 # log the beginning of the referrer
22601 capture request header Referer len 20
22602
22603 # server name (useful for outgoing proxies only)
22604 capture response header Server len 20
22605
22606 # logging the content-length is useful with "option logasap"
22607 capture response header Content-Length len 10
22608
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010022609 # log the expected cache behavior on the response
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022610 capture response header Cache-Control len 8
22611
22612 # the Via header will report the next proxy's name
22613 capture response header Via len 20
22614
22615 # log the URL location during a redirection
22616 capture response header Location len 20
22617
22618 >>> Aug 9 20:26:09 localhost \
22619 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34014 [09/Aug/2004:20:26:09] proxy-out \
22620 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/162/+162 200 +350 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
22621 {fr.adserver.yahoo.co||http://fr.f416.mail.} {|864|private||} \
22622 "GET http://fr.adserver.yahoo.com/"
22623
22624 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
22625 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34020 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
22626 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/182/+182 200 +279 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
22627 {w.ods.org||} {Formilux/0.1.8|3495|||} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010022628 "GET http://trafic.1wt.eu/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022629
22630 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
22631 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34028 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
22632 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/2/126/+128 301 +223 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
22633 {www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr||http://trafic.1wt.eu/} \
22634 {Apache|230|||http://www.sytadin.} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010022635 "GET http://www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022636
22637
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200226388.9. Examples of logs
22639---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022640
22641These are real-world examples of logs accompanied with an explanation. Some of
22642them have been made up by hand. The syslog part has been removed for better
22643reading. Their sole purpose is to explain how to decipher them.
22644
22645 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33318 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.130] px-http \
22646 px-http/srv1 6559/0/7/147/6723 200 243 - - ---- 5/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
22647 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
22648
22649 => long request (6.5s) entered by hand through 'telnet'. The server replied
22650 in 147 ms, and the session ended normally ('----')
22651
22652 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33319 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.149] px-http \
22653 px-http/srv1 6559/1230/7/147/6870 200 243 - - ---- 324/239/239/99/0 \
22654 0/9 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
22655
22656 => Idem, but the request was queued in the global queue behind 9 other
22657 requests, and waited there for 1230 ms.
22658
22659 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.654] px-http \
22660 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
22661 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
22662
22663 => request for a long data transfer. The "logasap" option was specified, so
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010022664 the log was produced just before transferring data. The server replied in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022665 14 ms, 243 bytes of headers were sent to the client, and total time from
22666 accept to first data byte is 30 ms.
22667
22668 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.925] px-http \
22669 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/30 502 243 - - PH-- 3/2/2/0/0 0/0 \
22670 "GET /cgi-bin/bug.cgi? HTTP/1.0"
22671
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020022672 => the proxy blocked a server response either because of an "http-response
22673 deny" rule, or because the response was improperly formatted and not
22674 HTTP-compliant, or because it blocked sensitive information which risked
22675 being cached. In this case, the response is replaced with a "502 bad
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040022676 gateway". The flags ("PH--") tell us that it was HAProxy who decided to
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020022677 return the 502 and not the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022678
22679 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34548 [15/Oct/2003:15:18:55.798] px-http \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010022680 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/8490 -1 0 - - CR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022681
22682 => the client never completed its request and aborted itself ("C---") after
22683 8.5s, while the proxy was waiting for the request headers ("-R--").
22684 Nothing was sent to any server.
22685
22686 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34549 [15/Oct/2003:15:19:06.103] px-http \
22687 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/50001 408 0 - - cR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
22688
22689 => The client never completed its request, which was aborted by the
22690 time-out ("c---") after 50s, while the proxy was waiting for the request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010022691 headers ("-R--"). Nothing was sent to any server, but the proxy could
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022692 send a 408 return code to the client.
22693
22694 >>> haproxy[18989]: 127.0.0.1:34550 [15/Oct/2003:15:24:28.312] px-tcp \
22695 px-tcp/srv1 0/0/5007 0 cD 0/0/0/0/0 0/0
22696
22697 => This log was produced with "option tcplog". The client timed out after
22698 5 seconds ("c----").
22699
22700 >>> haproxy[18989]: 10.0.0.1:34552 [15/Oct/2003:15:26:31.462] px-http \
22701 px-http/srv1 3183/-1/-1/-1/11215 503 0 - - SC-- 205/202/202/115/3 \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010022702 0/0 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022703
22704 => The request took 3s to complete (probably a network problem), and the
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020022705 connection to the server failed ('SC--') after 4 attempts of 2 seconds
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022706 (config says 'retries 3'), and no redispatch (otherwise we would have
22707 seen "/+3"). Status code 503 was returned to the client. There were 115
22708 connections on this server, 202 connections on this proxy, and 205 on
22709 the global process. It is possible that the server refused the
22710 connection because of too many already established.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010022711
Willy Tarreau52b2d222011-09-07 23:48:48 +020022712
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200227139. Supported filters
22714--------------------
22715
22716Here are listed officially supported filters with the list of parameters they
22717accept. Depending on compile options, some of these filters might be
22718unavailable. The list of available filters is reported in haproxy -vv.
22719
22720See also : "filter"
22721
227229.1. Trace
22723----------
22724
Christopher Fauletc41d8bd2020-11-17 10:43:26 +010022725filter trace [name <name>] [random-forwarding] [hexdump]
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020022726
22727 Arguments:
22728 <name> is an arbitrary name that will be reported in
22729 messages. If no name is provided, "TRACE" is used.
22730
Christopher Faulet96a577a2020-11-17 10:45:05 +010022731 <quiet> inhibits trace messages.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020022732
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010022733 <random-forwarding> enables the random forwarding of parsed data. By
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020022734 default, this filter forwards all previously parsed
22735 data. With this parameter, it only forwards a random
22736 amount of the parsed data.
22737
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010022738 <hexdump> dumps all forwarded data to the server and the client.
Christopher Faulet31bfe1f2016-12-09 17:42:38 +010022739
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020022740This filter can be used as a base to develop new filters. It defines all
22741callbacks and print a message on the standard error stream (stderr) with useful
22742information for all of them. It may be useful to debug the activity of other
22743filters or, quite simply, HAProxy's activity.
22744
22745Using <random-parsing> and/or <random-forwarding> parameters is a good way to
22746tests the behavior of a filter that parses data exchanged between a client and
22747a server by adding some latencies in the processing.
22748
22749
227509.2. HTTP compression
22751---------------------
22752
22753filter compression
22754
22755The HTTP compression has been moved in a filter in HAProxy 1.7. "compression"
22756keyword must still be used to enable and configure the HTTP compression. And
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020022757when no other filter is used, it is enough. When used with the cache or the
22758fcgi-app enabled, it is also enough. In this case, the compression is always
22759done after the response is stored in the cache. But it is mandatory to
22760explicitly use a filter line to enable the HTTP compression when at least one
22761filter other than the cache or the fcgi-app is used for the same
22762listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
22763order.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020022764
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020022765See also : "compression", section 9.4 about the cache filter and section 9.5
22766 about the fcgi-app filter.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020022767
22768
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +0200227699.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
22770--------------------------------------------
22771
22772filter spoe [engine <name>] config <file>
22773
22774 Arguments :
22775
22776 <name> is the engine name that will be used to find the right scope in
22777 the configuration file. If not provided, all the file will be
22778 parsed.
22779
22780 <file> is the path of the engine configuration file. This file can
22781 contain configuration of several engines. In this case, each
22782 part must be placed in its own scope.
22783
22784The Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE) is a filter communicating with
22785external components. It allows the offload of some specifics processing on the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010022786streams in tiered applications. These external components and information
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +020022787exchanged with them are configured in dedicated files, for the main part. It
22788also requires dedicated backends, defined in HAProxy configuration.
22789
22790SPOE communicates with external components using an in-house binary protocol,
22791the Stream Processing Offload Protocol (SPOP).
22792
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010022793For all information about the SPOE configuration and the SPOP specification, see
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +020022794"doc/SPOE.txt".
22795
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +0100227969.4. Cache
22797----------
22798
22799filter cache <name>
22800
22801 Arguments :
22802
22803 <name> is name of the cache section this filter will use.
22804
22805The cache uses a filter to store cacheable responses. The HTTP rules
22806"cache-store" and "cache-use" must be used to define how and when to use a
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050022807cache. By default the corresponding filter is implicitly defined. And when no
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020022808other filters than fcgi-app or compression are used, it is enough. In such
22809case, the compression filter is always evaluated after the cache filter. But it
22810is mandatory to explicitly use a filter line to use a cache when at least one
22811filter other than the compression or the fcgi-app is used for the same
Christopher Faulet27d93c32018-12-15 22:32:02 +010022812listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
22813order.
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +010022814
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020022815See also : section 9.2 about the compression filter, section 9.5 about the
22816 fcgi-app filter and section 6 about cache.
22817
22818
228199.5. Fcgi-app
22820-------------
22821
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040022822filter fcgi-app <name>
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020022823
22824 Arguments :
22825
22826 <name> is name of the fcgi-app section this filter will use.
22827
22828The FastCGI application uses a filter to evaluate all custom parameters on the
22829request path, and to process the headers on the response path. the <name> must
22830reference an existing fcgi-app section. The directive "use-fcgi-app" should be
22831used to define the application to use. By default the corresponding filter is
22832implicitly defined. And when no other filters than cache or compression are
22833used, it is enough. But it is mandatory to explicitly use a filter line to a
22834fcgi-app when at least one filter other than the compression or the cache is
22835used for the same backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
22836order.
22837
22838See also: "use-fcgi-app", section 9.2 about the compression filter, section 9.4
22839 about the cache filter and section 10 about FastCGI application.
22840
22841
Miroslav Zagoracdc32cd92020-12-13 18:32:57 +0100228429.6. OpenTracing
22843----------------
22844
22845The OpenTracing filter adds native support for using distributed tracing in
22846HAProxy. This is enabled by sending an OpenTracing compliant request to one
22847of the supported tracers such as Datadog, Jaeger, Lightstep and Zipkin tracers.
22848Please note: tracers are not listed by any preference, but alphabetically.
22849
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040022850This feature is only enabled when HAProxy was built with USE_OT=1.
Miroslav Zagoracdc32cd92020-12-13 18:32:57 +010022851
22852The OpenTracing filter activation is done explicitly by specifying it in the
22853HAProxy configuration. If this is not done, the OpenTracing filter in no way
22854participates in the work of HAProxy.
22855
22856filter opentracing [id <id>] config <file>
22857
22858 Arguments :
22859
22860 <id> is the OpenTracing filter id that will be used to find the
22861 right scope in the configuration file. If no filter id is
22862 specified, 'ot-filter' is used as default. If scope is not
22863 specified in the configuration file, it applies to all defined
22864 OpenTracing filters.
22865
22866 <file> is the path of the OpenTracing configuration file. The same
22867 file can contain configurations for multiple OpenTracing
22868 filters simultaneously. In that case we do not need to define
22869 scope so the same configuration applies to all filters or each
22870 filter must have its own scope defined.
22871
22872More detailed documentation related to the operation, configuration and use
Willy Tarreaua63d1a02021-04-02 17:16:46 +020022873of the filter can be found in the addons/ot directory.
Miroslav Zagoracdc32cd92020-12-13 18:32:57 +010022874
22875
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +02002287610. FastCGI applications
22877-------------------------
22878
22879HAProxy is able to send HTTP requests to Responder FastCGI applications. This
22880feature was added in HAProxy 2.1. To do so, servers must be configured to use
22881the FastCGI protocol (using the keyword "proto fcgi" on the server line) and a
22882FastCGI application must be configured and used by the backend managing these
22883servers (using the keyword "use-fcgi-app" into the proxy section). Several
22884FastCGI applications may be defined, but only one can be used at a time by a
22885backend.
22886
22887HAProxy implements all features of the FastCGI specification for Responder
22888application. Especially it is able to multiplex several requests on a simple
22889connection.
22890
2289110.1. Setup
22892-----------
22893
2289410.1.1. Fcgi-app section
22895--------------------------
22896
22897fcgi-app <name>
22898 Declare a FastCGI application named <name>. To be valid, at least the
22899 document root must be defined.
22900
22901acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
22902 Declare or complete an access list.
22903
22904 See "acl" keyword in section 4.2 and section 7 about ACL usage for
22905 details. ACLs defined for a FastCGI application are private. They cannot be
22906 used by any other application or by any proxy. In the same way, ACLs defined
22907 in any other section are not usable by a FastCGI application. However,
22908 Pre-defined ACLs are available.
22909
22910docroot <path>
22911 Define the document root on the remote host. <path> will be used to build
22912 the default value of FastCGI parameters SCRIPT_FILENAME and
22913 PATH_TRANSLATED. It is a mandatory setting.
22914
22915index <script-name>
22916 Define the script name that will be appended after an URI that ends with a
22917 slash ("/") to set the default value of the FastCGI parameter SCRIPT_NAME. It
22918 is an optional setting.
22919
22920 Example :
22921 index index.php
22922
22923log-stderr global
22924log-stderr <address> [len <length>] [format <format>]
Jan Wagner3e678602020-12-17 22:22:32 +010022925 [sample <ranges>:<sample_size>] <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020022926 Enable logging of STDERR messages reported by the FastCGI application.
22927
22928 See "log" keyword in section 4.2 for details. It is an optional setting. By
22929 default STDERR messages are ignored.
22930
22931pass-header <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
22932 Specify the name of a request header which will be passed to the FastCGI
22933 application. It may optionally be followed by an ACL-based condition, in
22934 which case it will only be evaluated if the condition is true.
22935
22936 Most request headers are already available to the FastCGI application,
22937 prefixed with "HTTP_". Thus, this directive is only required to pass headers
22938 that are purposefully omitted. Currently, the headers "Authorization",
22939 "Proxy-Authorization" and hop-by-hop headers are omitted.
22940
22941 Note that the headers "Content-type" and "Content-length" are never passed to
22942 the FastCGI application because they are already converted into parameters.
22943
22944path-info <regex>
Christopher Faulet28cb3662020-02-14 14:47:37 +010022945 Define a regular expression to extract the script-name and the path-info from
Christopher Faulet6c57f2d2020-02-14 16:55:52 +010022946 the URL-decoded path. Thus, <regex> may have two captures: the first one to
22947 capture the script name and the second one to capture the path-info. The
22948 first one is mandatory, the second one is optional. This way, it is possible
22949 to extract the script-name from the path ignoring the path-info. It is an
22950 optional setting. If it is not defined, no matching is performed on the
22951 path. and the FastCGI parameters PATH_INFO and PATH_TRANSLATED are not
22952 filled.
Christopher Faulet28cb3662020-02-14 14:47:37 +010022953
22954 For security reason, when this regular expression is defined, the newline and
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050022955 the null characters are forbidden from the path, once URL-decoded. The reason
Christopher Faulet28cb3662020-02-14 14:47:37 +010022956 to such limitation is because otherwise the matching always fails (due to a
22957 limitation one the way regular expression are executed in HAProxy). So if one
22958 of these two characters is found in the URL-decoded path, an error is
22959 returned to the client. The principle of least astonishment is applied here.
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020022960
22961 Example :
Christopher Faulet6c57f2d2020-02-14 16:55:52 +010022962 path-info ^(/.+\.php)(/.*)?$ # both script-name and path-info may be set
22963 path-info ^(/.+\.php) # the path-info is ignored
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020022964
22965option get-values
22966no option get-values
22967 Enable or disable the retrieve of variables about connection management.
22968
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040022969 HAProxy is able to send the record FCGI_GET_VALUES on connection
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020022970 establishment to retrieve the value for following variables:
22971
22972 * FCGI_MAX_REQS The maximum number of concurrent requests this
22973 application will accept.
22974
William Lallemand93e548e2019-09-30 13:54:02 +020022975 * FCGI_MPXS_CONNS "0" if this application does not multiplex connections,
22976 "1" otherwise.
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020022977
22978 Some FastCGI applications does not support this feature. Some others close
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +050022979 the connection immediately after sending their response. So, by default, this
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020022980 option is disabled.
22981
22982 Note that the maximum number of concurrent requests accepted by a FastCGI
22983 application is a connection variable. It only limits the number of streams
22984 per connection. If the global load must be limited on the application, the
22985 server parameters "maxconn" and "pool-max-conn" must be set. In addition, if
22986 an application does not support connection multiplexing, the maximum number
22987 of concurrent requests is automatically set to 1.
22988
22989option keep-conn
22990no option keep-conn
22991 Instruct the FastCGI application to keep the connection open or not after
22992 sending a response.
22993
22994 If disabled, the FastCGI application closes the connection after responding
22995 to this request. By default, this option is enabled.
22996
22997option max-reqs <reqs>
22998 Define the maximum number of concurrent requests this application will
22999 accept.
23000
23001 This option may be overwritten if the variable FCGI_MAX_REQS is retrieved
23002 during connection establishment. Furthermore, if the application does not
23003 support connection multiplexing, this option will be ignored. By default set
23004 to 1.
23005
23006option mpxs-conns
23007no option mpxs-conns
23008 Enable or disable the support of connection multiplexing.
23009
23010 This option may be overwritten if the variable FCGI_MPXS_CONNS is retrieved
23011 during connection establishment. It is disabled by default.
23012
23013set-param <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
23014 Set a FastCGI parameter that should be passed to this application. Its
23015 value, defined by <fmt> must follows the log-format rules (see section 8.2.4
23016 "Custom Log format"). It may optionally be followed by an ACL-based
23017 condition, in which case it will only be evaluated if the condition is true.
23018
23019 With this directive, it is possible to overwrite the value of default FastCGI
23020 parameters. If the value is evaluated to an empty string, the rule is
23021 ignored. These directives are evaluated in their declaration order.
23022
23023 Example :
23024 # PHP only, required if PHP was built with --enable-force-cgi-redirect
23025 set-param REDIRECT_STATUS 200
23026
23027 set-param PHP_AUTH_DIGEST %[req.hdr(Authorization)]
23028
23029
2303010.1.2. Proxy section
23031---------------------
23032
23033use-fcgi-app <name>
23034 Define the FastCGI application to use for the backend.
23035
23036 Arguments :
23037 <name> is the name of the FastCGI application to use.
23038
23039 This keyword is only available for HTTP proxies with the backend capability
23040 and with at least one FastCGI server. However, FastCGI servers can be mixed
23041 with HTTP servers. But except there is a good reason to do so, it is not
23042 recommended (see section 10.3 about the limitations for details). Only one
23043 application may be defined at a time per backend.
23044
23045 Note that, once a FastCGI application is referenced for a backend, depending
23046 on the configuration some processing may be done even if the request is not
23047 sent to a FastCGI server. Rules to set parameters or pass headers to an
23048 application are evaluated.
23049
23050
2305110.1.3. Example
23052---------------
23053
23054 frontend front-http
23055 mode http
23056 bind *:80
23057 bind *:
23058
23059 use_backend back-dynamic if { path_reg ^/.+\.php(/.*)?$ }
23060 default_backend back-static
23061
23062 backend back-static
23063 mode http
23064 server www A.B.C.D:80
23065
23066 backend back-dynamic
23067 mode http
23068 use-fcgi-app php-fpm
23069 server php-fpm A.B.C.D:9000 proto fcgi
23070
23071 fcgi-app php-fpm
23072 log-stderr global
23073 option keep-conn
23074
23075 docroot /var/www/my-app
23076 index index.php
23077 path-info ^(/.+\.php)(/.*)?$
23078
23079
2308010.2. Default parameters
23081------------------------
23082
23083A Responder FastCGI application has the same purpose as a CGI/1.1 program. In
23084the CGI/1.1 specification (RFC3875), several variables must be passed to the
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050023085script. So HAProxy set them and some others commonly used by FastCGI
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020023086applications. All these variables may be overwritten, with caution though.
23087
23088 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
23089 | AUTH_TYPE | Identifies the mechanism, if any, used by HAProxy |
23090 | | to authenticate the user. Concretely, only the |
23091 | | BASIC authentication mechanism is supported. |
23092 | | |
23093 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
23094 | CONTENT_LENGTH | Contains the size of the message-body attached to |
23095 | | the request. It means only requests with a known |
23096 | | size are considered as valid and sent to the |
23097 | | application. |
23098 | | |
23099 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
23100 | CONTENT_TYPE | Contains the type of the message-body attached to |
23101 | | the request. It may not be set. |
23102 | | |
23103 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
23104 | DOCUMENT_ROOT | Contains the document root on the remote host under |
23105 | | which the script should be executed, as defined in |
23106 | | the application's configuration. |
23107 | | |
23108 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
23109 | GATEWAY_INTERFACE | Contains the dialect of CGI being used by HAProxy |
23110 | | to communicate with the FastCGI application. |
23111 | | Concretely, it is set to "CGI/1.1". |
23112 | | |
23113 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
23114 | PATH_INFO | Contains the portion of the URI path hierarchy |
23115 | | following the part that identifies the script |
23116 | | itself. To be set, the directive "path-info" must |
23117 | | be defined. |
23118 | | |
23119 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
23120 | PATH_TRANSLATED | If PATH_INFO is set, it is its translated version. |
23121 | | It is the concatenation of DOCUMENT_ROOT and |
23122 | | PATH_INFO. If PATH_INFO is not set, this parameters |
23123 | | is not set too. |
23124 | | |
23125 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
23126 | QUERY_STRING | Contains the request's query string. It may not be |
23127 | | set. |
23128 | | |
23129 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
23130 | REMOTE_ADDR | Contains the network address of the client sending |
23131 | | the request. |
23132 | | |
23133 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
23134 | REMOTE_USER | Contains the user identification string supplied by |
23135 | | client as part of user authentication. |
23136 | | |
23137 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
23138 | REQUEST_METHOD | Contains the method which should be used by the |
23139 | | script to process the request. |
23140 | | |
23141 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
23142 | REQUEST_URI | Contains the request's URI. |
23143 | | |
23144 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
23145 | SCRIPT_FILENAME | Contains the absolute pathname of the script. it is |
23146 | | the concatenation of DOCUMENT_ROOT and SCRIPT_NAME. |
23147 | | |
23148 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
23149 | SCRIPT_NAME | Contains the name of the script. If the directive |
23150 | | "path-info" is defined, it is the first part of the |
23151 | | URI path hierarchy, ending with the script name. |
23152 | | Otherwise, it is the entire URI path. |
23153 | | |
23154 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
23155 | SERVER_NAME | Contains the name of the server host to which the |
23156 | | client request is directed. It is the value of the |
23157 | | header "Host", if defined. Otherwise, the |
23158 | | destination address of the connection on the client |
23159 | | side. |
23160 | | |
23161 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
23162 | SERVER_PORT | Contains the destination TCP port of the connection |
23163 | | on the client side, which is the port the client |
23164 | | connected to. |
23165 | | |
23166 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
23167 | SERVER_PROTOCOL | Contains the request's protocol. |
23168 | | |
23169 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
Christopher Faulet5cd0e522021-06-11 13:34:42 +020023170 | SERVER_SOFTWARE | Contains the string "HAProxy" followed by the |
23171 | | current HAProxy version. |
23172 | | |
23173 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020023174 | HTTPS | Set to a non-empty value ("on") if the script was |
23175 | | queried through the HTTPS protocol. |
23176 | | |
23177 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
23178
23179
2318010.3. Limitations
23181------------------
23182
23183The current implementation have some limitations. The first one is about the
23184way some request headers are hidden to the FastCGI applications. This happens
23185during the headers analysis, on the backend side, before the connection
23186establishment. At this stage, HAProxy know the backend is using a FastCGI
23187application but it don't know if the request will be routed to a FastCGI server
23188or not. But to hide request headers, it simply removes them from the HTX
23189message. So, if the request is finally routed to an HTTP server, it never see
23190these headers. For this reason, it is not recommended to mix FastCGI servers
23191and HTTP servers under the same backend.
23192
23193Similarly, the rules "set-param" and "pass-header" are evaluated during the
23194request headers analysis. So the evaluation is always performed, even if the
23195requests is finally forwarded to an HTTP server.
23196
23197About the rules "set-param", when a rule is applied, a pseudo header is added
23198into the HTX message. So, the same way than for HTTP header rewrites, it may
23199fail if the buffer is full. The rules "set-param" will compete with
23200"http-request" ones.
23201
23202Finally, all FastCGI params and HTTP headers are sent into a unique record
23203FCGI_PARAM. Encoding of this record must be done in one pass, otherwise a
23204processing error is returned. It means the record FCGI_PARAM, once encoded,
23205must not exceeds the size of a buffer. However, there is no reserve to respect
23206here.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010023207
Emeric Brunce325c42021-04-02 17:05:09 +020023208
2320911. Address formats
23210-------------------
23211
23212Several statements as "bind, "server", "nameserver" and "log" requires an
23213address.
23214
23215This address can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6 address, or '*'.
23216The '*' is equal to the special address "0.0.0.0" and can be used, in the case
23217of "bind" or "dgram-bind" to listen on all IPv4 of the system.The IPv6
23218equivalent is '::'.
23219
23220Depending of the statement, a port or port range follows the IP address. This
23221is mandatory on 'bind' statement, optional on 'server'.
23222
23223This address can also begin with a slash '/'. It is considered as the "unix"
23224family, and '/' and following characters must be present the path.
23225
23226Default socket type or transport method "datagram" or "stream" depends on the
23227configuration statement showing the address. Indeed, 'bind' and 'server' will
23228use a "stream" socket type by default whereas 'log', 'nameserver' or
23229'dgram-bind' will use a "datagram".
23230
23231Optionally, a prefix could be used to force the address family and/or the
23232socket type and the transport method.
23233
23234
2323511.1 Address family prefixes
23236----------------------------
23237
23238'abns@<name>' following <name> is an abstract namespace (Linux only).
23239
23240'fd@<n>' following address is a file descriptor <n> inherited from the
23241 parent. The fd must be bound and may or may not already be
23242 listening.
23243
23244'ip@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is considered as an IPv4 or
23245 IPv6 address depending on the syntax. Depending
23246 on the statement using this address, a port or
23247 a port range may or must be specified.
23248
23249'ipv4@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
23250 an IPv4 address. Depending on the statement
23251 using this address, a port or a port range
23252 may or must be specified.
23253
23254'ipv6@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
23255 an IPv6 address. Depending on the statement
23256 using this address, a port or a port range
23257 may or must be specified.
23258
23259'sockpair@<n>' following address is the file descriptor of a connected unix
23260 socket or of a socketpair. During a connection, the initiator
23261 creates a pair of connected sockets, and passes one of them
23262 over the FD to the other end. The listener waits to receive
23263 the FD from the unix socket and uses it as if it were the FD
23264 of an accept(). Should be used carefully.
23265
23266'unix@<path>' following string is considered as a UNIX socket <path>. this
23267 prefix is useful to declare an UNIX socket path which don't
23268 start by slash '/'.
23269
23270
2327111.2 Socket type prefixes
23272-------------------------
23273
23274Previous "Address family prefixes" can also be prefixed to force the socket
23275type and the transport method. The default depends of the statement using
23276this address but in some cases the user may force it to a different one.
23277This is the case for "log" statement where the default is syslog over UDP
23278but we could force to use syslog over TCP.
23279
23280Those prefixes were designed for internal purpose and users should
23281instead use aliases of the next section "11.5.3 Protocol prefixes".
23282
23283If users need one those prefixes to perform what they expect because
23284they can not configure the same using the protocol prefixes, they should
23285report this to the maintainers.
23286
23287'stream+<family>@<address>' forces socket type and transport method
23288 to "stream"
23289
23290'dgram+<family>@<address>' forces socket type and transport method
23291 to "datagram".
23292
23293
2329411.3 Protocol prefixes
23295----------------------
23296
23297'tcp@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is considered as an IPv4
23298 or IPv6 address depending of the syntax but
23299 socket type and transport method is forced to
23300 "stream". Depending on the statement using
23301 this address, a port or a port range can or
23302 must be specified. It is considered as an alias
23303 of 'stream+ip@'.
23304
23305'tcp4@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
23306 an IPv4 address but socket type and transport
23307 method is forced to "stream". Depending on the
23308 statement using this address, a port or port
23309 range can or must be specified.
23310 It is considered as an alias of 'stream+ipv4@'.
23311
23312'tcp6@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
23313 an IPv6 address but socket type and transport
23314 method is forced to "stream". Depending on the
23315 statement using this address, a port or port
23316 range can or must be specified.
23317 It is considered as an alias of 'stream+ipv4@'.
23318
23319'udp@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is considered as an IPv4
23320 or IPv6 address depending of the syntax but
23321 socket type and transport method is forced to
23322 "datagram". Depending on the statement using
23323 this address, a port or a port range can or
23324 must be specified. It is considered as an alias
23325 of 'dgram+ip@'.
23326
23327'udp4@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
23328 an IPv4 address but socket type and transport
23329 method is forced to "datagram". Depending on
23330 the statement using this address, a port or
23331 port range can or must be specified.
23332 It is considered as an alias of 'stream+ipv4@'.
23333
23334'udp6@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
23335 an IPv6 address but socket type and transport
23336 method is forced to "datagram". Depending on
23337 the statement using this address, a port or
23338 port range can or must be specified.
23339 It is considered as an alias of 'stream+ipv4@'.
23340
23341'uxdg@<path>' following string is considered as a unix socket <path> but
23342 transport method is forced to "datagram". It is considered as
23343 an alias of 'dgram+unix@'.
23344
23345'uxst@<path>' following string is considered as a unix socket <path> but
23346 transport method is forced to "stream". It is considered as
23347 an alias of 'stream+unix@'.
23348
23349In future versions, other prefixes could be used to specify protocols like
23350QUIC which proposes stream transport based on socket of type "datagram".
23351
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010023352/*
23353 * Local variables:
23354 * fill-column: 79
23355 * End:
23356 */